Distance Relay D60
Distance Relay D60
Distance Relay D60
GE Industrial Systems
837766A2.CDR
RE
EM
ISO9001:2000
I
GE Multilin
T
GIS ERE
U LT I L
*1601-0089-R1*
Addendum
GE Industrial Systems
ADDENDUM
This addendum contains information that relates to the D60 Line Distance Protection System, version 5.4x. This addendum lists a number of information items that appear in the instruction manual GEK-113343 (revision R1) but are not
included in the current D60 operations.
The following functions/items are not yet available with the current version of the D60 relay:
Signal Sources SRC 5 and SRC 6
STUB BUS: The final Stub Bus protection is not implemented for this release. This feature can be implemented using a
Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent function and the auxiliary contact from the line disconnect, incorporated into a simple
FlexLogic equation.Version 4.0x and higher releases of the D60 relay includes new hardware (CPU and CT/VT modules).
The new CPU modules are specified with the following order codes: 9E, 9G, 9H, 9J, 9K, 9L, 9M, 9N, 9P, and 9R.
The new CT/VT modules are specified with the following order codes: 8F, 8G 8L, 8M.
The following table maps the relationship between the old CPU and CT/VT modules to the newer versions:
MODULE
CPU
CT/VT
OLD
NEW
DESCRIPTION
9A
9E
9C
9G
9D
9H
--
9J
--
9K
--
9L
--
9M
--
9N
--
9P
--
9R
8A
8F
Standard 4CT/4VT
8B
8G
--
8L
--
8M
The new CT/VT modules can only be used with the new CPUs (9E, 9G, 9H, 9J, 9K, 9L, 9M, 9N, 9P, 9R), and the old CT/
VT modules can only be used with the old CPU modules (9A, 9C, 9D). To prevent any hardware mismatches, the new
CPU and CT/VT modules have blue labels and a warning sticker stating Attn.: Ensure CPU and DSP module label
colors are the same!. In the event that there is a mismatch between the CPU and CT/VT module, the relay will not
function and a DSP ERROR or HARDWARE MISMATCH error will be displayed.
All other input/output modules are compatible with the new hardware.
With respect to the firmware, firmware versions 4.0x and higher are only compatible with the new CPU and CT/VT modules. Previous versions of the firmware (3.4x and earlier) are only compatible with the older CPU and CT/VT modules.
Table of Contents
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. GETTING STARTED
1.2 UR OVERVIEW
1.2.1
1.2.2
1.2.3
1.2.4
1.4 UR HARDWARE
1.4.1
1.4.2
1.4.3
2. PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2.1.1
2.1.2
2.1.3
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................ 2-1
ORDERING........................................................................................................ 2-3
REPLACEMENT MODULES ............................................................................. 2-5
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2.2.1
2.2.2
2.2.3
2.2.4
2.2.5
2.2.6
2.2.7
2.2.8
2.2.9
2.2.10
2.2.11
2.2.12
2.2.13
2.2.14
3. HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3.1.1
3.1.2
3.1.3
3.2 WIRING
3.2.1
3.2.2
3.2.3
3.2.4
3.2.5
3.2.6
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
3.2.7
3.2.8
3.2.9
4. HUMAN INTERFACES
DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................3-26
FIBER: LED AND ELED TRANSMITTERS ......................................................3-28
FIBER-LASER TRANSMITTERS .....................................................................3-28
G.703 INTERFACE...........................................................................................3-29
RS422 INTERFACE .........................................................................................3-32
RS422 AND FIBER INTERFACE .....................................................................3-34
G.703 AND FIBER INTERFACE ......................................................................3-34
IEEE C37.94 INTERFACE................................................................................3-35
C37.94SM INTERFACE ...................................................................................3-37
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................4-1
CREATING A SITE LIST ....................................................................................4-1
ENERVISTA UR SETUP OVERVIEW ................................................................4-1
ENERVISTA UR SETUP MAIN WINDOW..........................................................4-3
5. SETTINGS
FACEPLATE .......................................................................................................4-4
LED INDICATORS..............................................................................................4-5
CUSTOM LABELING OF LEDS .........................................................................4-8
DISPLAY...........................................................................................................4-17
KEYPAD ...........................................................................................................4-17
BREAKER CONTROL ......................................................................................4-17
MENUS .............................................................................................................4-18
CHANGING SETTINGS ...................................................................................4-20
5.1 OVERVIEW
5.1.1
5.1.2
5.1.3
PASSWORD SECURITY....................................................................................5-8
DISPLAY PROPERTIES ..................................................................................5-10
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS ..............................................................................5-12
COMMUNICATIONS ........................................................................................5-13
MODBUS USER MAP ......................................................................................5-30
REAL TIME CLOCK .........................................................................................5-31
FAULT REPORTS ............................................................................................5-32
OSCILLOGRAPHY ...........................................................................................5-34
DATA LOGGER ................................................................................................5-36
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS .....................................................................5-37
USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF-TESTS .........................................................5-40
CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS ............................................................................5-41
USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS....................................................5-42
FLEX STATE PARAMETERS ..........................................................................5-46
USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS ........................................................................5-47
DIRECT INPUTS/OUTPUTS ............................................................................5-49
TELEPROTECTION .........................................................................................5-56
INSTALLATION ................................................................................................5-56
vi
AC INPUTS.......................................................................................................5-58
POWER SYSTEM ............................................................................................5-59
SIGNAL SOURCES ..........................................................................................5-60
BREAKERS ......................................................................................................5-62
FLEXCURVES .............................................................................................5-65
PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT ....................................................................5-72
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5.4.1
5.4.2
5.4.3
5.4.4
5.4.5
5.4.6
5.4.7
5.4.8
OVERVIEW.................................................................................................... 5-111
SETTING GROUP ......................................................................................... 5-111
LINE PICKUP................................................................................................. 5-112
DISTANCE ..................................................................................................... 5-114
POWER SWING DETECT ............................................................................. 5-131
LOAD ENCROACHMENT.............................................................................. 5-139
PHASE CURRENT ........................................................................................ 5-141
NEUTRAL CURRENT.................................................................................... 5-151
WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT .................................................................. 5-159
GROUND CURRENT..................................................................................... 5-162
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT ............................................................. 5-164
BREAKER FAILURE ...................................................................................... 5-170
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS .................................................................................. 5-179
OVERVIEW.................................................................................................... 5-187
SETTING GROUPS ....................................................................................... 5-187
SELECTOR SWITCH..................................................................................... 5-188
TRIP OUTPUT ............................................................................................... 5-194
SYNCHROCHECK......................................................................................... 5-199
AUTORECLOSE ............................................................................................ 5-203
DIGITAL ELEMENTS..................................................................................... 5-215
DIGITAL COUNTERS .................................................................................... 5-218
MONITORING ELEMENTS ........................................................................... 5-220
TRIP BUS....................................................................................................... 5-230
PILOT SCHEMES .......................................................................................... 5-232
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5.7.1
5.7.2
5.7.3
5.7.4
5.7.5
5.7.6
5.7.7
5.7.8
5.7.9
5.7.10
5.9 TESTING
5.9.1
5.9.2
5.9.3
5.9.4
6. ACTUAL VALUES
6.1 OVERVIEW
6.1.1
6.2 STATUS
6.2.1
6.2.2
GE Multilin
vii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
6.2.3
6.2.4
6.2.5
6.2.6
6.2.7
6.2.8
6.2.9
6.2.10
6.2.11
6.2.12
6.2.13
6.2.14
6.2.15
6.3 METERING
6.3.1
6.3.2
6.3.3
6.3.4
6.3.5
6.3.6
6.3.7
6.3.8
6.3.9
6.4 RECORDS
6.4.1
6.4.2
6.4.3
6.4.4
6.4.5
7. COMMANDS AND
TARGETS
7.1 COMMANDS
7.1.1
7.1.2
7.1.3
7.1.4
7.1.5
7.1.6
7.2 TARGETS
7.2.1
7.2.2
7.2.3
8. THEORY OF OPERATION
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................8-1
PHASOR ESTIMATION......................................................................................8-1
DISTANCE CHARACTERISTICS.......................................................................8-2
MEMORY POLARIZATION ................................................................................8-6
DISTANCE ELEMENTS ANALYSIS...................................................................8-7
DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................8-10
EXAMPLE .........................................................................................................8-13
viii
DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................8-15
EXAMPLE .........................................................................................................8-15
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
8.4 SERIES COMPENSATED LINES
8.4.1
DESCRIPTION................................................................................................. 8-16
OVERVIEW...................................................................................................... 8-19
PHASE SELECTION........................................................................................ 8-22
COMMUNICATIONS CHANNELS FOR PILOT-AIDED SCHEMES ................ 8-23
PERMISSIVE ECHO SIGNALING ................................................................... 8-30
PILOT SCHEME / PHASE SELECTOR COORDINATION .............................. 8-31
CROSS-COUNTRY FAULT EXAMPLE ........................................................... 8-32
9. APPLICATION OF
SETTINGS
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................ 9-1
IMPACT OF MEMORY POLARIZATION ........................................................... 9-1
HIGH-SET OVERCURRENT ELEMENTS ......................................................... 9-1
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................ 9-6
DIRECT UNDER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP (DUTT) ................................. 9-6
PERMISSIVE UNDER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP (PUTT) ......................... 9-6
PERMISSIVE OVER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP (POTT) ........................... 9-6
HYBRID POTT SCHEME (HYB-POTT) ............................................................. 9-7
DIRECTIONAL COMPARISON BLOCKING ...................................................... 9-8
DIRECTIONAL COMPARISON UNBLOCKING................................................. 9-9
INTRODUCTION.............................................................................................. 9-11
DISTANCE ....................................................................................................... 9-11
GROUND DIRECTIONAL OVERCURRENT ................................................... 9-12
HIGH-SET PHASE OVERCURRENT .............................................................. 9-12
A. FLEXANALOG
PARAMETERS
B. MODBUS
COMMUNICATIONS
A.1.1
B.1.1
B.1.2
B.1.3
B.1.4
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................B-1
PHYSICAL LAYER.............................................................................................B-1
DATA LINK LAYER............................................................................................B-1
CRC-16 ALGORITHM........................................................................................B-2
GE Multilin
ix
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B.4 MEMORY MAPPING
B.4.1
B.4.2
C. IEC 61850
COMMUNICATIONS
C.1 OVERVIEW
C.1.1
C.1.2
E. DNP COMMUNICATIONS
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
E.2.1
E.2.2
E.2.3
E.2.4
F. MISCELLANEOUS
F.2 ABBREVIATIONS
F.2.1
F.3 WARRANTY
F.3.1
INDEX
GE Multilin
xi
TABLE OF CONTENTS
xii
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
Please read this chapter to help guide you through the initial setup of your new relay.
1.1.1 CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS
WARNING
Before attempting to install or use the relay, it is imperative that all WARNINGS and CAUTIONS
in this manual are reviewed to help prevent personal injury, equipment damage, and/or downtime.
CAUTION
Open the relay packaging and inspect the unit for physical damage.
View the rear nameplate and verify that the correct model has been ordered.
RATINGS:
GE Multilin
Technical Support:
Tel: (905) 294-6222
Fax: (905) 201-2098
http://www.GEmultilin.com
D60E00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
000
837774A3
GEK-113270
MAZB98000029
D
2005/01/05
Model:
Mods:
Wiring Diagram:
Inst. Manual:
Serial Number:
Firmware:
Mfg. Date:
Made in
Canada
-
837806A1.CDR
Fill out the registration form and return to GE Multilin (include the serial number located on the rear nameplate).
For product information, instruction manual updates, and the latest software updates, please visit the GE Multilin website at http://www.GEmultilin.com.
If there is any noticeable physical damage, or any of the contents listed are missing, please contact GE
Multilin immediately.
NOTE
GE Multilin
(905) 294-6222,
1-800-547-8629 (North America only)
(905) 201-2098
[email protected]
http://www.GEmultilin.com
1-1
1.2 UR OVERVIEW
1 GETTING STARTED
1.2UR OVERVIEW
Historically, substation protection, control, and metering functions were performed with electromechanical equipment. This
first generation of equipment was gradually replaced by analog electronic equipment, most of which emulated the singlefunction approach of their electromechanical precursors. Both of these technologies required expensive cabling and auxiliary equipment to produce functioning systems.
Recently, digital electronic equipment has begun to provide protection, control, and metering functions. Initially, this equipment was either single function or had very limited multi-function capability, and did not significantly reduce the cabling and
auxiliary equipment required. However, recent digital relays have become quite multi-functional, reducing cabling and auxiliaries significantly. These devices also transfer data to central control facilities and Human Machine Interfaces using electronic communications. The functions performed by these products have become so broad that many users now prefer the
term IED (Intelligent Electronic Device).
It is obvious to station designers that the amount of cabling and auxiliary equipment installed in stations can be even further
reduced, to 20% to 70% of the levels common in 1990, to achieve large cost reductions. This requires placing even more
functions within the IEDs.
Users of power equipment are also interested in reducing cost by improving power quality and personnel productivity, and
as always, in increasing system reliability and efficiency. These objectives are realized through software which is used to
perform functions at both the station and supervisory levels. The use of these systems is growing rapidly.
High speed communications are required to meet the data transfer rates required by modern automatic control and monitoring systems. In the near future, very high speed communications will be required to perform protection signaling with a
performance target response time for a command signal between two IEDs, from transmission to reception, of less than 3
milliseconds. This has been established by the IEC 61850 standard.
IEDs with the capabilities outlined above will also provide significantly more power system data than is presently available,
enhance operations and maintenance, and permit the use of adaptive system configuration for protection and control systems. This new generation of equipment must also be easily incorporated into automation systems, at both the station and
enterprise levels. The GE Multilin Universal Relay (UR) has been developed to meet these goals.
1-2
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
1.2 UR OVERVIEW
1.2.2 HARDWARE ARCHITECTURE
a) UR BASIC DESIGN
The UR is a digital-based device containing a central processing unit (CPU) that handles multiple types of input and output
signals. The UR can communicate over a local area network (LAN) with an operator interface, a programming device, or
another UR device.
Input Elements
CPU Module
Contact Inputs
Contact Outputs
Protective Elements
Pickup
Dropout
Output
Operate
Virtual Inputs
Analog Inputs
Output Elements
Input
CT Inputs
Status
VT Inputs
Table
Status
Logic Gates
Table
Virtual Outputs
Analog Outputs
Remote Outputs
-DNA
-USER
Remote Inputs
Direct Inputs
Direct Outputs
LAN
Programming
Device
Operator
Interface
827822A2.CDR
GE Multilin
1-3
1.2 UR OVERVIEW
1 GETTING STARTED
c) UR SCAN OPERATION
The UR-series devices operate in a cyclic scan fashion. The device reads the inputs into an input status table, solves the
logic program (FlexLogic equation), and then sets each output to the appropriate state in an output status table. Any
resulting task execution is priority interrupt-driven.
Read Inputs
Protection elements
serviced by sub-scan
Protective Elements
Solve Logic
PKP
DPO
OP
Set Outputs
827823A1.CDR
1-4
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
1.3.1 PC REQUIREMENTS
The faceplate keypad and display or the EnerVista UR Setup software interface can be used to communicate with the relay.
The EnerVista UR Setup software interface is the preferred method to edit settings and view actual values because the PC
monitor can display more information in a simple comprehensible format.
The following minimum requirements must be met for the EnerVista UR Setup software to properly operate on a PC.
Windows 95, 98, 98SE, ME, NT 4.0 (Service Pack 4 or higher), 2000, XP
200 MB of available space on system drive and 200 MB of available space on installation drive
Video capable of displaying 800 x 600 or higher in high-color mode (16-bit color)
The following qualified modems have been tested to be compliant with the D60 and the EnerVista UR Setup software.
After ensuring the minimum requirements for using EnerVista UR Setup are met (see previous section), use the following
procedure to install the EnerVista UR Setup from the enclosed GE EnerVista CD.
1.
2.
Click the Install Now button and follow the installation instructions to install the no-charge EnerVista software.
3.
4.
5.
In the EnerVista Launch Pad window, click the Add Product button and select the D60 Line Distance Protection System from the Install Software window as shown below. Select the Web option to ensure the most recent software
GE Multilin
1-5
1 GETTING STARTED
release, or select CD if you do not have a web connection, then click the Add Now button to list software items for
the D60.
6.
EnerVista Launchpad will obtain the software from the Web or CD and automatically start the installation program.
7.
Select the complete path, including the new directory name, where the EnerVista UR Setup will be installed.
8.
Click on Next to begin the installation. The files will be installed in the directory indicated and the installation program
will automatically create icons and add EnerVista UR Setup to the Windows start menu.
9.
Click Finish to end the installation. The UR-series device will be added to the list of installed IEDs in the EnerVista
Launchpad window, as shown below.
1-6
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
To configure the D60 for remote access via the rear RS485 port(s), refer to the Configuring Serial Communications
section.
To configure the D60 for remote access via the rear Ethernet port, refer to the Configuring Ethernet Communications
section. An Ethernet module must be specified at the time of ordering.
To configure the D60 for local access with a laptop through either the front RS232 port or rear Ethernet port, refer to
the Using the Quick Connect Feature section. An Ethernet module must be specified at the time of ordering for Ethernet communications.
Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE EnerVista CD or
online from http://www.GEmultilin.com). See the Software Installation section for installation details.
2.
Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
3.
Click the Device Setup button to open the Device Setup window and click the Add Site button to define a new site.
4.
Enter the desired site name in the Site Name field. If desired, a short description of site can also be entered along
with the display order of devices defined for the site. In this example, we will use Location 1 as the site name. Click
the OK button when complete.
5.
The new site will appear in the upper-left list in the EnerVista UR Setup window. Click the Device Setup button then
select the new site to re-open the Device Setup window.
6.
7.
Enter the desired name in the Device Name field and a description (optional) of the site.
8.
Select Serial from the Interface drop-down list. This will display a number of interface parameters that must be
entered for proper serial communications.
GE Multilin
1-7
9.
1 GETTING STARTED
Enter the relay slave address, COM port, baud rate, and parity settings from the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMmenu in their respective fields.
10. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the D60 device and upload the order code. If an communications
error occurs, ensure that the EnerVista UR Setup serial communications values entered in the previous step correspond to the relay setting values.
11. Click OK when the relay order code has been received. The new device will be added to the Site List window (or
Online window) located in the top left corner of the main EnerVista UR Setup window.
The Site Device has now been configured for RS232 communications. Proceed to the Connecting to the D60 section to
begin communications.
c) CONFIGURING ETHERNET COMMUNICATIONS
Before starting, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the back of the relay. To
setup the relay for Ethernet communications, it will be necessary to define a Site, then add the relay as a Device at that site.
1.
Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE EnerVista CD or
online from http://www.GEmultilin.com). See the Software Installation section for installation details.
2.
Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
3.
Click the Device Setup button to open the Device Setup window, then click the Add Site button to define a new site.
4.
Enter the desired site name in the Site Name field. If desired, a short description of site can also be entered along
with the display order of devices defined for the site. In this example, we will use Location 2 as the site name. Click
the OK button when complete.
5.
The new site will appear in the upper-left list in the EnerVista UR Setup window. Click the Device Setup button then
select the new site to re-open the Device Setup window.
6.
7.
Enter the desired name in the Device Name field and a description (optional) of the site.
8.
Select Ethernet from the Interface drop-down list. This will display a number of interface parameters that must be
entered for proper Ethernet functionality.
1-8
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
9.
Enter the relay IP address specified in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP
in the IP Address field.
ADDRESS)
10. Enter the relay slave address and Modbus port address values from the respective settings in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL menu.
11. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the D60 device and upload the order code. If an communications
error occurs, ensure that the three EnerVista UR Setup values entered in the previous steps correspond to the relay
setting values.
12. Click OK when the relay order code has been received. The new device will be added to the Site List window (or
Online window) located in the top left corner of the main EnerVista UR Setup window.
The Site Device has now been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to the Connecting to the D60 section to
begin communications.
1.3.4 USING THE QUICK CONNECT FEATURE
a) USING QUICK CONNECT VIA THE FRONT PANEL RS232 PORT
Before starting, verify that the serial cable is properly connected from the laptop computer to the front panel RS232 port
with a straight-through 9-pin to 9-pin RS232 cable.
1.
Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE EnerVista CD or
online from http://www.GEmultilin.com). See the Software Installation section for installation details.
2.
Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
3.
Click the Quick Connect button to open the Quick Connect dialog box.
4.
Select the Serial interface and the correct COM Port, then click Connect.
5.
The EnerVista UR Setup software will create a site named Quick Connect with a corresponding device also named
Quick Connect and display them on the upper-left corner of the screen. Expand the sections to view data directly
from the D60 device.
Each time the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communications to the D60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the D60 model number.
b) USING QUICK CONNECT VIA THE REAR ETHERNET PORTS
To use the Quick Connect feature to access the D60 from a laptop through Ethernet, first assign an IP address to the relay
from the front panel keyboard.
1.
2.
3.
Enter an IP address of 1.1.1.1 and select the ENTER key to save the value.
4.
5.
Enter a subnet IP address of 255.0.0.0 and press the ENTER key to save the value.
GE Multilin
1-9
1 GETTING STARTED
Next, use an Ethernet cross-over cable to connect the laptop to the rear Ethernet port. The pinout for an Ethernet crossover cable is shown below.
2
1
4 5 6
7
8
END 1
Pin
Wire color
1
White/orange
2
Orange
3
White/green
4
Blue
5
White/blue
6
Green
7
White/brown
8
Brown
Diagram
END 2
Pin
Wire color
1
White/green
2
Green
3
White/orange
4
Blue
5
White/blue
6
Orange
7
White/brown
8
Brown
Diagram
842799A1.CDR
From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network connections window.
2.
1-10
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
3.
Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
4.
5.
Enter an IP address with the first three numbers the same as the IP address of the D60 relay and the last number different (in this example, 1.1.1.2).
6.
Enter a subnet mask equal to the one set in the D60 (in this example, 255.0.0.0).
7.
Open a Windows console window by selecting Start > Run from the Windows Start menu and typing cmd.
2.
3.
If the connection is successful, the system will return four replies as follows:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Reply
Reply
Reply
Reply
from
from
from
from
1.1.1.1:
1.1.1.1:
1.1.1.1:
1.1.1.1:
bytes=32
bytes=32
bytes=32
bytes=32
time<10ms
time<10ms
time<10ms
time<10ms
TTL=255
TTL=255
TTL=255
TTL=255
4.
Note that the values for time and TTL will vary depending on local network configuration.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
GE Multilin
1-11
1 GETTING STARTED
Request
Request
Request
Request
timed
timed
timed
timed
out.
out.
out.
out.
Verify the physical connection between the D60 and the laptop computer, and double-check the programmed IP address in
the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2 in the above procedure.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Hardware
Hardware
Hardware
Hardware
error.
error.
error.
error.
Verify the physical connection between the D60 and the laptop computer, and double-check the programmed IP address in
the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2 in the above procedure.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Destination
Destination
Destination
Destination
host
host
host
host
unreachable.
unreachable.
unreachable.
unreachable.
Verify the IP address is programmed in the local PC by entering the ipconfig command in the command window.
C:\WINNT>ipconfig
Windows 2000 IP Configuration
Ethernet adapter <F4FE223E-5EB6-4BFB-9E34-1BD7BE7F59FF>:
Connection-specific
IP Address. . . . .
Subnet Mask . . . .
Default Gateway . .
DNS
. .
. .
. .
suffix.
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
:
: 0.0.0.0
: 0.0.0.0
:
.
.
.
.
:
: 1.1.1.2
: 255.0.0.0
:
DNS
. .
. .
. .
suffix
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
C:\WINNT>
It may be necessary to restart the laptop for the change in IP address to take effect (Windows 98 or NT).
1-12
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
Before using the Quick Connect feature through the Ethernet port, it is necessary to disable any configured proxy settings
in Internet Explorer.
1.
2.
Select the Tools > Internet Options menu item and click on Connections tab.
3.
4.
Ensure that the Use a proxy server for your LAN box is not checked.
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the laptop has been disconnected from the D60 relay.
1.
Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE enerVista CD or
online from http://www.GEmultilin.com). See the Software Installation section for installation details.
2.
3.
Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
4.
Click the Quick Connect button to open the Quick Connect dialog box.
5.
Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the D60, then click Connect.
6.
The EnerVista UR Setup software will create a site named Quick Connect with a corresponding device also named
Quick Connect and display them on the upper-left corner of the screen. Expand the sections to view data directly
from the D60 device.
Each time the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communications to the D60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the D60 model number.
When direct communications with the D60 via Ethernet is complete, make the following changes:
1.
From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network connections window.
2.
Right-click the Local Area Connection icon and select the Properties item.
3.
Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
GE Multilin
1-13
4.
1 GETTING STARTED
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the laptop has been disconnected from the D60 relay.
AUTOMATIC DISCOVERY OF ETHERNET DEVICES
The UR Setup Software now has the ability to automatically discover and communicate to all of the URs that are located on
an Ethernet Network.
Using the Quick Connect Feature, a single click of the mouse will trigger the software to automatically detect any UR relays
located on the Ethernet network. The Setup Software will then proceed to configure all settings and order code options in
the Device Setup menu, for the purpose of communicating to multiple relays. Using this feature will allow you to identify
and interrogate in seconds, all UR devices found in a particular location.
1-14
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
1.
Open the Display Properties window through the Site List tree as shown below:
842743A2.CDR
2.
The Display Properties window will open with a status indicator on the lower left of the EnerVista UR Setup window.
3.
If the status indicator is red, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the
back of the relay and that the relay has been properly setup for communications (steps A and B earlier).
If a relay icon appears in place of the status indicator, than a report (such as an oscillography or event record) is open.
Close the report to re-display the green status indicator.
4.
The Display Properties settings can now be edited, printed, or changed according to user specifications.
Refer to Chapter 4 in this manual and the EnerVista UR Setup Help File for more information about the
using the EnerVista UR Setup software interface.
NOTE
GE Multilin
1-15
1 GETTING STARTED
1-16
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
1.4 UR HARDWARE
1.4UR HARDWARE
Please refer to Chapter 3: Hardware for detailed mounting and wiring instructions. Review all WARNINGS and CAUTIONS
carefully.
1.4.2 COMMUNICATIONS
The EnerVista UR Setup software communicates to the relay via the faceplate RS232 port or the rear panel RS485 / Ethernet ports. To communicate via the faceplate RS232 port, a standard straight-through serial cable is used. The DB-9 male
end is connected to the relay and the DB-9 or DB-25 female end is connected to the PC COM1 or COM2 port as described
in the CPU Communications Ports section of Chapter 3.
GE Multilin
1-17
1 GETTING STARTED
Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: Actual Values, Settings, Commands, and Targets. The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is broken down further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys scroll increment or decrement numerical setting
values when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alternatively, values may also be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advance to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point. The HELP key may
be pressed at any time for context sensitive help messages. The ENTER key stores altered setting values.
1.5.2 MENU NAVIGATION
Press the MENU key to select the desired header display page (top-level menu). The header title appears momentarily followed by a header display page menu item. Each press of the MENU key advances through the following main heading
pages:
Actual values
Settings
Commands
Targets
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters (), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters (). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
UP and DOWN keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing
the MESSAGE RIGHT key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, continually pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
HIGHEST LEVEL
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
1.5.4 RELAY ACTIVATION
The relay is defaulted to the Not Programmed state when it leaves the factory. This safeguards against the installation of
a relay whose settings have not been entered. When powered up successfully, the Trouble LED will be on and the In Service LED off. The relay in the Not Programmed state will block signaling of any output relay. These conditions will remain
until the relay is explicitly put in the Programmed state.
Select the menu message SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
1-18
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
To put the relay in the Programmed state, press either of the VALUE keys once and then press ENTER. The faceplate
Trouble LED will turn off and the In Service LED will turn on. The settings for the relay can be programmed manually (refer
to Chapter 5) via the faceplate keypad or remotely (refer to the EnerVista UR Setup help file) via the EnerVista UR Setup
software interface.
1.5.5 RELAY PASSWORDS
It is recommended that passwords be set up for each security level and assigned to specific personnel. There are two user
password security access levels, COMMAND and SETTING:
1. COMMAND
The COMMAND access level restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the following operations:
2. SETTING
The SETTING access level allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values.
Refer to the Changing Settings section in Chapter 4 for complete instructions on setting up security level
passwords.
NOTE
GE Multilin
1-19
1 GETTING STARTED
1.5.7 COMMISSIONING
Tables for recording settings before entering them via the keypad are available from the GE Multilin website at http://
www.GEmultilin.com.
The D60 requires a minimum amount of maintenance when it is commissioned into service. Since the D60 is a microprocessor-based relay, its characteristics do not change over time. As such, no further functional tests are required.
Furthermore, the D60 performs a number of continual self-tests and takes the necessary action in case of any major errors
(see the Relay Self-Test section in Chapter 7 for details). However, it is recommended that D60 maintenance be scheduled
with other system maintenance. This maintenance may involve the in-service, out-of-service, or unscheduled maintenance.
In-service maintenance:
1.
Visual verification of the analog values integrity such as voltage and current (in comparison to other devices on the corresponding system).
2.
Visual verification of active alarms, relay display messages, and LED indications.
3.
LED test.
4.
5.
Out-of-service maintenance:
1.
2.
Analog values (currents, voltages, RTDs, analog inputs) injection test and metering accuracy verification. Calibrated
test equipment is required.
3.
Protection elements setting verification (analog values injection or visual verification of setting file entries against relay
settings schedule).
4.
Contact inputs and outputs verification. This test can be conducted by direct change of state forcing or as part of the
system functional testing.
5.
6.
7.
View the event recorder and oscillography or fault report for correct operation of inputs, outputs, and elements.
If it is concluded that the relay or one of its modules is of concern, contact GE Multilin for prompt service.
1-20
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2.1.1 OVERVIEW
The D60 Line Distance Protection System is a microprocessor-based relay intended for use on transmission lines of any
voltage level, without, with, and in the vicinity of series compensation, in three-pole and single-pole tripping applications.
The primary function of the relay consists of five phase and ground distance zones of protection, either mho or quadrilateral
as per user selection, with built-in logic for the five common pilot-aided schemes. The distance elements are optimized to
provide good measurement accuracy with a fast operating time, even when used with capacitive voltage transformers
(CVTs), and can be supervised by detection of power swings. The relay also provides directional ground overcurrent elements, which are commonly used as part of an overall line protection system.
D60 phase distance zones can be configured to work with voltages and currents fed from VTs and CTs located independently from one another on either side of a three-phase power transformer. The relay compensates accordingly to preserve
reach and correct target information regardless of the location and type of fault. This feature allows backup protection applications for generators and power transformers.
A close-into-fault (or switch-on-to-fault) function is performed by the line pickup element. Out-of-step tripping, three-pole/
single-pole dual-breaker autoreclosing, synchrocheck, fault location, and many other functions are also available. In addition, overcurrent and undervoltage protection, fault diagnostics, power metering, and RTU functions are provided. The D60
provides phase, neutral, and ground time overcurrent protection. The time overcurrent functions can be programmed with
multiple curve shapes or FlexCurve for optimum coordination.
Voltage, current, and power metering is built into the relay as a standard feature. Current parameters are available as total
waveform RMS magnitude, or as fundamental frequency only RMS magnitude and angle (phasor).
Diagnostic features include an event recorder capable of storing 1024 time-tagged events, oscillography capable of storing
up to 64 records with programmable trigger, content and sampling rate, and data logger acquisition of up to 16 channels,
with programmable content and sampling rate. The internal clock used for time-tagging can be synchronized with an IRIGB signal or via the SNTP protocol over the Ethernet port. This precise time stamping allows the sequence of events to be
determined throughout the system. Events can also be programmed (via FlexLogic equations) to trigger oscillography
data capture which may be set to record the measured parameters before and after the event for viewing on a personal
computer (PC). These tools significantly reduce troubleshooting time and simplify report generation in the event of a system fault.
A faceplate RS232 port may be used to connect to a PC for the programming of settings and the monitoring of actual values. A variety of communications modules are available. Two rear RS485 ports allow independent access by operating and
engineering staff. All serial ports use the Modbus RTU protocol. The RS485 ports may be connected to system computers
with baud rates up to 115.2 kbps. The RS232 port has a fixed baud rate of 19.2 kbps. Optional communications modules
include a 10Base-F Ethernet interface which can be used to provide fast, reliable communications in noisy environments.
Another option provides two 10Base-F fiber optic ports for redundancy. The Ethernet port supports IEC 61850, Modbus/
TCP, and TFTP protocols, and allows access to the relay via any standard web browser (D60 web pages). The IEC 608705-104 protocol is supported on the Ethernet port. DNP 3.0 and IEC 60870-5-104 cannot be enabled at the same time.
The D60 IEDs use flash memory technology which allows field upgrading as new features are added. The following single
line diagram illustrates the relay functionality using ANSI (American National Standards Institute) device numbers.
GE Multilin
2-1
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
DEVICE
NUMBER
FUNCTION
DEVICE
NUMBER
FUNCTION
21G
Ground distance
51P
21P
Phase distance
51_2
25
Synchrocheck
52
AC circuit breaker
27P
Phase undervoltage
59N
Neutral overvoltage
27X
Auxiliary undervoltage
59P
Phase overvoltage
32N
59X
Auxiliary overvoltage
50BF
Breaker failure
59_2
Negative-sequence overvoltage
50DD
67N
50G
67P
50N
67_2
50P
68
50_2
78
Out-of-step tripping
51G
79
Automatic recloser
51N
52
52
CLOSE
TRIP
Monitoring
59X
27X
68
78
25 (2)
79
50DD
50P (2)
50_2 (2)
51P (2)
51_2 (2)
Pilot
schemes
50BF (2)
21P (4)
67P (2)
67_2 (2)
50N (2)
51N (2)
67N/G(2)
32N (2)
21G (4)
59P
Metering
FlexElementTM
Transducer
inputs
27P (2)
50G (2)
51G (2)
59N
2-2
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
FUNCTION
FUNCTION
Fault locator
Breaker control
FlexElements (8)
Synchrophasors
FlexLogic equations
Transducer inputs/outputs
Control pushbuttons
Line pickup
User-definable displays
Data logger
User-programmable LEDs
User-programmable self-tests
Non-volatile latches
Event recorder
Oscillography
VT fuse failure
Pilot schemes
User-programmable pushbuttons
2.1.2 ORDERING
The D60 is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit or a reduced size () vertical mount unit, and consists of the
following modules: CPU, faceplate, power supply, CPU, CT/VT, digital input/outputs, and inter-relay communications. Each
of these modules can be supplied in a number of configurations specified at the time of ordering. The information required
to completely specify the relay is provided in the following tables (see chapter 3 for full details of relay modules).
Order codes are subject to change without notice. Refer to the GE Multilin ordering page at
http://www.GEindustrial.com/multilin/order.htm for the latest details concerning D60 ordering options.
NOTE
The order codes for the horizontal mount units are shown below.
GE Multilin
2-3
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
D60
D60
SOFTWARE
(IEC 61850 options
not available with
type E CPUs)
*
|
E
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
R
MOUNT/COATING
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY
POWER SUPPLY
(redundant supply must
be same type as main supply)
CT/VT MODULES
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
(select a maximum of 3 per unit)
INTER-RELAY
COMMUNICATIONS
(select a maximum of 1 per unit)
2-4
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
00
02
03
05
06
07
08
09
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
A
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
C
D
R
A
P
G
S
B
K
M
Q
U
L
N
T
V
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
H
L
L
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8F
8G
8L
8M
- H
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8F
8G
8L
8M
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- P
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- U
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
2A
2B
2E
2F
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
W/X
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RH
|
RL
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
2A
2B
2E
2F
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
The order codes for the reduced size vertical mount units are shown below.
Table 24: D60 ORDER CODES FOR REDUCED SIZE VERTICAL UNITS
D60
D60
BASE UNIT
CPU
SOFTWARE
(IEC 61850 options
not available with
type E CPUs)
*
|
E
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
R
MOUNT/COATING
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY
POWER SUPPLY
CT/VT MODULES
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
00
02
03
05
06
07
08
09
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
V
B
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F
D
R
K
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
L
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8F
8G
8L
8M
- H
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
(select a maximum of 3 per unit)
INTER-RELAY
COMMUNICATIONS
(select a maximum of 1 per unit)
NOTE
For the last module, slot P is used for digital and transducer
input/output modules; slot R is used for inter-relay
communications modules.
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8F
8G
8L
8M
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
P/R
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
2A
2B
2E
2F
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
Base Unit
RS485 and RS485
RS485 and multi-mode ST 10Base-F
RS485 and multi-mode ST redundant 10Base-F
RS485 and multi-mode ST 100Base-FX
RS485 and multi-mode ST redundant 100Base-FX
RS485 and single mode SC 100Base-FX
RS485 and single mode SC redundant 100Base-FX
RS485 and 10/100Base-T
RS485 and single mode ST 100Base-FX
RS485 and single mode ST redundant 100Base-FX
No Software Options
Breaker-and-a-Half software
IEC 61850
Breaker-and-a-Half software and IEC 61850
Phasor measurement unit (PMU)
IEC 61850 and phasor measurement unit (PMU)
Breaker-and-a-Half and phasor measurement unit (PMU)
Breaker-and-a-Half, IEC 61850, and phasor measurement unit (PMU)
Vertical (3/4 rack)
Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
English display
French display
Russian display
Chinese display
125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
Standard 4CT/4VT
Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT
Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
No Module
4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
16 digital inputs with Auto-Burnishing
14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
8 Form-C outputs
16 digital inputs
4 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
8 Fast Form-C outputs
4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 digital inputs
2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 dcmA inputs, 4 dcmA outputs (only one 5A module is allowed)
8 RTD inputs
4 RTD inputs, 4 dcmA outputs (only one 5D module is allowed)
4 RTD inputs, 4 dcmA inputs
8 dcmA inputs
C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
Bi-phase, single channel
Bi-phase, dual channel
1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channel
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, Single-mode LASER
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channels
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode, LED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode LASER
G.703, 1 Channel
G.703, 2 Channels
RS422, 1 Channel
RS422, 2 Channels
Replacement module codes are subject to change without notice. Refer to the GE Multilin ordering page at http://
www.GEindustrial.com/multilin/order.htm for the latest details concerning D60 ordering options.
NOTE
GE Multilin
2-5
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
The replacement module order codes for the horizontal mount units are shown below.
Table 25: ORDER CODES FOR REPLACEMENT MODULES, HORIZONTAL UNITS
POWER SUPPLY
(redundant supply only
available in horizontal units; must
be same type as main supply)
CPU
2
FACEPLATE/DISPLAY
CT/VT
MODULES
(NOT AVAILABLE FOR THE C30)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
2-6
UR
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
1H
1L
RH
RH
9E
9G
9H
9J
9K
9L
9M
9N
9P
9R
3C
3D
3R
3A
3P
3G
3S
3B
3K
3M
3Q
3U
3L
3N
3T
3V
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
8F
8G
8H
8J
8L
8M
8N
8R
2A
2B
2E
2F
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7V
7W
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
The replacement module order codes for the reduced-size vertical mount units are shown below.
Table 26: ORDER CODES FOR REPLACEMENT MODULES, VERTICAL UNITS
POWER SUPPLY
CPU
FACEPLATE/DISPLAY
DIGITAL
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
CT/VT
MODULES
(NOT AVAILABLE FOR THE C30)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
GE Multilin
UR
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
1H
1L
9E
9G
9H
9J
9K
9L
9M
9N
9P
9R
3F
3D
3R
3K
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
8F
8G
8H
8J
8L
8M
8N
8R
2A
2B
2E
2F
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7V
7W
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2-7
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
PHASE DISTANCE
Characteristic:
Number of zones:
Directionality:
Reach (secondary ):
Reach accuracy:
Distance:
SIR = 0.1
SIR = 1
SIR = 10
SIR = 20
SIR = 30
25
Characteristic angle:
30 to 90 in steps of 1
30 to 90 in steps of 1
Limit angle:
30 to 90 in steps of 1
NOTE
The operating times below include the activation time of a trip rated form-A output contact unless otherwise indicated. FlexLogic operands of a given element are 4 ms faster. This should be taken into account when using
FlexLogic to interconnect with other protection or control elements of the relay, building FlexLogic equations, or
interfacing with other IEDs or power system devices via communications or different output contacts.
20
15
10
Reach:
Characteristic angle:
60 to 90 in steps of 1
0
0%
10%
20%
Reach:
Characteristic angle:
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
837717A1.CDR
60 to 90 in steps of 1
Time delay:
Timing accuracy:
Current supervision:
Level:
line-to-line current
Pickup:
Dropout:
97 to 98%
Memory duration:
5 to 25 cycles in steps of 1
VT location:
CT location:
2-8
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
GROUND DISTANCE
Characteristic:
Directionality:
Reach (secondary ):
Reach accuracy:
30 to 90 in steps of 1
Limit angle:
30 to 90 in steps of 1
Zero-sequence compensation
SIR = 0.1
SIR = 1
SIR = 10
SIR = 20
SIR = 30
30
35
25
20
15
10
5
0
0%
Z0/Z1 magnitude:
Z0/Z1 angle:
90 to 90 in steps of 1
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
LINE PICKUP
Z0M/Z1 magnitude:
Z0M/Z1 angle:
90 to 90 in steps of 1
Undervoltage pickup:
0.000 to 3.000 pu
Overvoltage delay:
0.000 to 65.535 s
Characteristic angle:
60 to 90 in steps of 1
Characteristic angle:
60 to 90 in steps of 1
Time delay:
Timing accuracy:
Level:
Pickup:
Dropout:
97 to 98%
Phasor or RMS
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
Level accuracy:
for 0.1 to 2.0 CT:
Curve shapes:
IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely
Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short
Inverse; GE IAC Inverse, Short/Very/
Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves
(programmable); Definite Time (0.01 s
base curve)
Curve multiplier:
5 to 25 cycles in steps of 1
GE Multilin
Current:
Current supervision:
Memory duration:
PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND TOC
Reset type:
Timing accuracy:
2-9
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND IOC
Pickup level:
Relay connection:
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
Quadrature voltage:
ABC phase seq.: phase A (VBC), phase
B (VCA), phase C (VAB)
ACB phase seq.: phase A (VCB), phase
B (VAC), phase C (VBA)
Level accuracy:
1.5% of reading
Overreach:
<2%
Pickup delay:
Reset delay:
Operate time:
<16 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
(Phase/Ground IOC)
<20 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
(Neutral IOC)
Timing accuracy:
Dropout level:
Level accuracy:
Curve shapes:
90 (quadrature)
IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely
Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short
Inverse; GE IAC Inverse, Short/Very/
Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves
(programmable); Definite Time (0.01 s
base curve)
0 to 359 in steps of 1
Angle accuracy:
Polarizing:
Polarizing voltage:
V_0 or VX
Polarizing current:
IG
Operating current:
I_0
Level sensing:
3 (|I_0| K |I_1|), IG
Restraint, K:
Characteristic angle:
90 to 90 in steps of 1
Limit angle:
Angle accuracy:
Offset impedance:
Reset type:
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
97 to 98%
Timing accuracy:
Operation time:
< 16 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
Polarizing:
Voltage
Pickup level:
Polarizing voltage:
V_2
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
Operating current:
I_2
Level accuracy:
0.1 to 2.0 CT rating: 0.5% of reading or 0.4% of rated
(whichever is greater)
> 2.0 CT rating: 1.5% of reading
Overreach:
< 2%
Pickup delay:
Reset delay:
Operate time:
< 20 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
Timing accuracy:
2-10
Level sensing:
Zero-sequence:|I_0| K |I_1|
Negative-sequence:|I_2| K |I_1|
Restraint, K:
Characteristic angle:
0 to 90 in steps of 1
Limit angle:
Angle accuracy:
Offset impedance:
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
97 to 98%
Operation time:
< 16 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
AUXILIARY OVERVOLTAGE
Measured power:
zero-sequence
Pickup level:
Number of elements:
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
Characteristic angle:
0 to 360 in steps of 1
Level accuracy:
Minimum power:
Pickup delay:
Reset delay:
Hysteresis:
Timing accuracy:
Pickup delay:
3% of operate time or 4 ms
(whichever is greater)
Operate time:
Time accuracy:
Operate time:
<30 ms at 60 Hz
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE
Level accuracy:
Pickup level:
Pickup delay:
Dropout level:
Reset delay:
Level accuracy:
Time accuracy:
Curve shapes:
GE IAV Inverse;
Definite Time (0.1s base curve)
Operate time:
Mode:
Curve multiplier:
Timing accuracy:
1-pole, 3-pole
Current supervision:
97 to 98% of pickup
AUXILIARY UNDERVOLTAGE
Pickup level:
BREAKER FAILURE
Dropout level:
Level accuracy:
Curve shapes:
Curve multiplier:
Principle:
Timing accuracy:
3% of operate time or 4 ms
(whichever is greater)
Initiation:
PHASE OVERVOLTAGE
above 2 CT rating:
2.5% of reading
Voltage:
Phasor only
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy:
Pickup delay:
Operate time:
Timing accuracy:
3% or 4 ms (whichever is greater)
Alarm threshold:
BREAKER FLASHOVER
Operating quantity:
NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE
97 to 98% of pickup
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy:
Level accuracy:
Pickup delay:
Pickup delay:
Reset delay:
Time accuracy:
Timing accuracy:
3% or 20 ms (whichever is greater)
Operate time:
Operate time:
GE Multilin
2-11
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
SYNCHROCHECK
Functions:
0 to 100 in steps of 1
Characteristic:
Mho or Quad
Measured impedance:
Positive-sequence
Tripping mode:
AUTORECLOSURE
Two breakers applications
Early or Delayed
Current supervision:
Pickup level:
Dropout level:
97 to 98% of pickup
Impedance accuracy:
PILOT-AIDED SCHEMES
Angle accuracy:
Timers:
Timing accuracy:
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
5%
2
Responds to:
Positive-sequence quantities
Minimum voltage:
TRIP OUTPUT
Reach (sec. ):
Collects trip and reclose input requests and issues outputs to control tripping and reclosing.
Impedance accuracy:
5%
Angle:
5 to 50 in steps of 1
Angle accuracy:
Pickup delay:
Timing accuracy:
Reset delay:
Time accuracy:
Operate time:
< 30 ms at 60 Hz
Detects an open pole condition, monitoring breaker auxiliary contacts, the current in each phase and optional voltages
on the line
2-12
Number of elements:
Number of inputs:
16
Operate time:
<2 ms at 60 Hz
Time accuracy:
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2.2.2 USER PROGRAMMABLE ELEMENTS
FLEXLOGIC
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDs
Number:
Programmability:
Lines of code:
512
Internal variables:
64
Reset mode:
Supported operations:
LED TEST
Inputs:
Number of timers:
32
Pickup delay:
Dropout delay:
Initiation:
Number of tests:
approximately 3 minutes
Test sequence 1:
all LEDs on
Test sequence 2:
Test sequence 3:
USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
FLEXCURVES
Number:
4 (A through D)
Reset points:
40 (0 through 1 of pickup)
Operate points:
80 (1 through 20 of pickup)
Time delay:
0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
FLEX STATES
Number:
Programmability:
Number of displays:
16
Lines of display:
2 20 alphanumeric characters
Parameters:
CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS
Number of pushbuttons: 7
Operation:
Number of elements:
Operating signal:
Mode:
self-reset, latched
Display message:
FLEXELEMENTS
Drop-out timer:
Operating mode:
level, delta
Autoreset timer:
Comparator direction:
over, under
SELECTOR SWITCH
Pickup Level:
Number of elements:
Hysteresis:
1 to 7 in steps of 1
Delta dt:
20 ms to 60 days
Selecting mode:
time-out or acknowledge
Time-out timer:
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Control inputs:
Power-up mode:
Type:
set-dominant or reset-dominant
Number:
16 (individually programmed)
Output:
Execution sequence:
GE Multilin
2-13
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2.3 MONITORING
DATA LOGGER
OSCILLOGRAPHY
Maximum records:
64
Number of channels:
Sampling rate:
Parameters:
Triggers:
Sampling rate:
15 to 3600000 ms in steps of 1
2
Data:
AC input channels
Element state
Digital input state
Digital output state
Data storage:
In non-volatile memory
Trigger:
Mode:
continuous or triggered
Storage capacity:
60-minute rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days
EVENT RECORDER
Capacity:
1024 events
Time-tag:
to 1 microsecond
Triggers:
Data storage:
1 to 16
FAULT LOCATOR
Method:
single-ended
Voltage source:
Relay accuracy:
In non-volatile memory
Worst-case accuracy:
VT%error +
(user data)
CT%error +
(user data)
ZLine%error +
(user data)
METHOD%error +
(see chapter 6)
2.2.4 METERING
RMS CURRENT: PHASE, NEUTRAL, AND GROUND
Accuracy at
Accuracy:
2.0% of reading
Range:
0 to 2 109 MWh
Parameters:
3-phase only
1.0% of reading
Update rate:
50 ms
RMS VOLTAGE
Accuracy:
2.0% of reading
Range:
0 to 2 109 Mvarh
Accuracy:
Parameters:
3-phase only
Update rate:
50 ms
1.0% of reading at
0.8 < PF 1.0 and 0.8 < PF 1.0
2-14
FREQUENCY
Accuracy at
V = 0.8 to 1.2 pu:
1.0% of reading
0.05 Hz
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2.2.5 INPUTS
DCMA INPUTS
AC CURRENT
CT rated primary:
1 to 50000 A
CT rated secondary:
1 A or 5 A by connection
Nominal frequency:
Relay burden:
20 to 65 Hz
Input impedance:
379 10%
Conversion range:
1 to + 20 mA DC
Accuracy:
Type:
Passive
Conversion range:
Standard CT:
0.02 to 46 CT rating RMS symmetrical
Sensitive Ground CT module:
0.002 to 4.6 CT rating RMS symmetrical
Current withstand:
AC VOLTAGE
VT rated secondary:
50.0 to 240.0 V
VT ratio:
1.00 to 24000.00
Nominal frequency:
20 to 65 Hz
Relay burden:
Conversion range:
1 to 275 V
Voltage withstand:
RTD INPUTS
Types (3-wire):
Sensing current:
5 mA
Range:
50 to +250C
Accuracy:
2C
Isolation:
36 V pk-pk
IRIG-B INPUT
Amplitude modulation:
1 to 10 V pk-pk
DC shift:
TTL
Input impedance:
22 k
Isolation:
2 kV
CONTACT INPUTS
Dry contacts:
1000 maximum
Wet contacts:
300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds:
17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
Tolerance:
10%
DIRECT INPUTS
Recognition time:
< 1 ms
Debounce time:
16
Ring configuration:
Data rate:
Yes, No
64 or 128 kbps
32-bit
Dry contacts:
1000 maximum
CRC:
Wet contacts:
300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds:
17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
Tolerance:
10%
CRC alarm:
Responding to:
Rate of messages failing the CRC
Monitoring message count: 10 to 10000 in steps of 1
Alarm threshold:
1 to 1000 in steps of 1
< 1 ms
Debounce time:
TELEPROTECTION
Number of input points: 16
No. of remote devices:
GE Multilin
No
Data rate:
64 or 128 kbps
CRC:
32-bit
2-15
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2.6 POWER SUPPLY
ALL RANGES
LOW RANGE
Nominal DC voltage:
24 to 48 V
Volt withstand:
Min/max DC voltage:
20 / 60 V
Power consumption:
20 ms duration at nominal
typical = 15 to 20 W/VA
maximum = 50 W/VA
contact factory for exact order code consumption
HIGH RANGE
INTERNAL FUSE
Nominal DC voltage:
125 to 250 V
Min/max DC voltage:
88 / 300 V
Nominal AC voltage:
Min/max AC voltage:
88 / 265 V at 25 to 100 Hz
RATINGS
Low range power supply: 8 A / 250 V
High range power supply: 4 A / 250 V
INTERRUPTING CAPACITY
AC:
DC:
10 000 A
2.2.7 OUTPUTS
FORM-C AND CRITICAL FAILURE RELAY
FORM-A RELAY
Carry continuous:
Carry continuous:
6A
VOLTAGE
8A
CURRENT
VOLTAGE
CURRENT
24 V
1A
24 V
1A
48 V
0.5 A
48 V
0.5 A
125 V
0.3 A
125 V
0.3 A
250 V
0.2 A
250 V
0.2 A
Operate time:
< 8 ms
silver alloy
Operate time:
< 4 ms
Contact material:
Contact material:
silver alloy
LATCHING RELAY
Carry continuous:
6A
0.25 A DC max.
Operate time:
< 4 ms
Contact material:
INPUT
VOLTAGE
1 W RESISTOR
250 V DC
20 K
50 K
silver alloy
120 V DC
5 K
2 K
Control:
48 V DC
2 K
2 K
Control mode:
operate-dominant or reset-dominant
24 V DC
2 K
2 K
approx. 15 to 250 V DC
Trickle current:
approx. 1 to 2.5 mA
Operate time:
2-16
< 0.6 ms
approx. 80 to 100 mA
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
Maximum voltage:
Capacity:
100 mA DC at 48 V DC
Isolation:
300 Vpk
265 V DC
for 0.2 s:
for 0.03 s
300 A
Breaking capacity:
UL508
Operations/
interval
5000 ops /
1 s-On, 9 s-Off
1000 ops /
0.5 s-On, 0.5 s-Off
Break
capability
(0 to 250 V
DC)
Utility
application
(autoreclose
scheme)
Industrial
application
5 ops /
0.2 s-On,
0.2 s-Off
within 1
minute
10000 ops /
0.2 s-On,
30 s-Off
10 A
L/R = 40 ms
10 A
L/R = 40 ms
0.8 A
L/R = 40 ms
IRIG-B OUTPUT
Amplitude:
Maximum load:
100 ohms
Time delay:
1 ms for AM input
40 s for DC-shift input
Isolation:
2 kV
DIRECT OUTPUTS
Output points:
32
DCMA OUTPUTS
3.2 A
L/R = 10 ms
1.6 A
L/R = 20 ms
32
Range:
1 to 1 mA, 0 to 1 mA, 4 to 20 mA
12 k for 1 to 1 mA range
12 k for 0 to 1 mA range
600 for 4 to 20 mA range
Accuracy:
1.5 kV
Driving signal:
2.2.8 COMMUNICATIONS
RS232
Front port:
RS485
ETHERNET (FIBER)
PARAMETER
FIBER TYPE
10MB MULTIMODE
1 or 2 rear ports:
Wavelength
Typical distance:
1200 m
Connector
Isolation:
2 kV
820 nm
1310 nm
ST
ST
SC
Transmit power
20 dBm
20 dBm
15 dBm
Receiver sensitivity
30 dBm
30 dBm
30 dBm
10 dB
10 dB
15 dB
Maximum input
power
7.6 dBm
14 dBm
7 dBm
Typical distance
1.65 km
2 km
15 km
Duplex
full/half
full/half
full/half
yes
yes
yes
Power budget
Redundancy
1310 nm
ETHERNET (COPPER)
Modes:
Connector:
RJ45
GE Multilin
2-17
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2.9 INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
INTERFACE TYPE
TYPICAL DISTANCE
RS422
1200 m
G.703
100 m
NOTE
TYPICAL
DISTANCE
820 nm LED
Multimode
ST
1300 nm LED
Multimode
ST
3.8 km
1300 nm ELED
Singlemode
ST
11.4 km
1300 nm Laser
Singlemode
ST
64 km
1550 nm Laser
Singlemode
ST
105 km
1.65 km
Typical distances listed are based on the following assumptions for system loss. As
actual losses will vary from one installation to
another, the distance covered by your system
may vary.
EMITTER,
FIBER TYPE
TRANSMIT
POWER
RECEIVED
SENSITIVITY
POWER
BUDGET
820 nm LED,
Multimode
20 dBm
30 dBm
10 dB
1300 nm LED,
Multimode
21 dBm
30 dBm
9 dB
1300 nm ELED,
Singlemode
23 dBm
30 dBm
9 dB
1300 nm Laser,
Singlemode
1 dBm
30 dBm
29 dB
FIBER LOSSES
1550 nm Laser,
Singlemode
+5 dBm
30 dBm
35 dB
NOTE
NOTE
ST connector
2 dB
820 nm multimode
3 dB/km
1300 nm multimode
1 dB/km
1300 nm singlemode
0.35 dB/km
1550 nm singlemode
0.25 dB/km
Splice losses:
SYSTEM MARGIN
MAX. OPTICAL
INPUT POWER
7.6 dBm
11 dBm
14 dBm
14 dBm
14 dBm
2.2.10 ENVIRONMENTAL
AMBIENT TEMPERATURES
OTHER
Storage:
40 to 80C
OPERATING TEMPERATURES
Cold:
Dry Heat:
Altitude:
Up to 2000 m
Installation Category:
II
2-18
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2.2.11 TYPE TESTS
ANSI/IEEE C37.90.1
IEC 61000-4-12
Insulation resistance:
IEC 60255-5
Dielectric strength:
IEC 60255-6
ANSI/IEEE C37.90
Conducted RFI:
IEC 61000-4-6
Voltage dips/interruptions/variations:
IEC 61000-4-11
IEC 60255-11
Power frequency magnetic field immunity:
IEC 61000-4-8
IEC 60255-21-2
Surge immunity:
EN 61000-4-5
Seismic:
RFI susceptibility:
ANSI/IEEE C37.90.2
IEC 61000-4-3
IEC 60255-22-3
Ontario Hydro C-5047-77
IEC 60255-21-3
IEEE C37.98
Cold:
Dry heat:
2.2.13 APPROVALS
APPROVALS
UL Listed for the USA and Canada
CE:
LVD 73/23/EEC:
IEC 1010-1
EMC 81/336/EEC:
EN 50081-2, EN 50082-2
2.2.14 MAINTENANCE
MOUNTING
CLEANING
NOTE
GE Multilin
2-19
2.2 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2-20
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE 3.1DESCRIPTION
a) HORIZONTAL UNITS
The D60 Line Distance Protection System is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit with a removable faceplate.
The faceplate can be specified as either standard or enhanced at the time of ordering. The enhanced faceplate contains
additional user-programmable pushbuttons and LED indicators.
The modular design allows the relay to be easily upgraded or repaired by a qualified service person. The faceplate is
hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules, and is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with limited rear
depth. There is also a removable dust cover that fits over the faceplate, which must be removed when attempting to access
the keypad or RS232 communications port.
The case dimensions are shown below, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When planning the location of
your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the faceplate to swing open without interference to or from adjacent
equipment.
The relay must be mounted such that the faceplate sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator
access to the keypad and the RS232 communications port. The relay is secured to the panel with the use of four screws
supplied with the relay.
11.016
[279,81 mm]
9.687
[246,05 mm]
17.56
[446,02 mm]
7.460
[189,48 mm]
6.995
[177,67 mm]
6.960
[176,78 mm]
19.040
[483,62 mm]
842807A1.CDR
GE Multilin
3-1
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
18.370
[466,60 mm]
0.280
[7,11 mm]
Typ. x 4
CUT-OUT
4.000
[101,60 mm]
17.750
[450,85 mm]
842808A1.CDR
3-2
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
UR SERIES
GE Multilin
3-3
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
3-4
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
WARNING
Module withdrawal and insertion may only be performed when control power has been removed from the
unit. Inserting an incorrect module type into a slot may result in personal injury, damage to the unit or connected equipment, or undesired operation!
Proper electrostatic discharge protection (for example, a static strap) must be used when coming in contact with modules while the relay is energized!
WARNING
The relay, being modular in design, allows for the withdrawal and insertion of modules. Modules must only be replaced with
like modules in their original factory configured slots.
The enhanced faceplate can be opened to the left, once thumb screw has been removed, as shown below. This allows for
easy accessibility of the modules for withdrawal. The new wide-angle hinge assembly in the enhanced front panel opens
completely and allows easy access to all modules in the D60.
GE Multilin
3-5
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
842812A1.CDR
3-6
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
The 4.0x release of the D60 relay includes new hardware modules.The new CPU modules are specified with codes
9E and higher. The new CT/VT modules are specified with the codes 8F and higher.
NOTE
The new CT/VT modules can only be used with new CPUs; similarly, old CT/VT modules can only be used with old
CPUs. To prevent hardware mismatches, the new modules have blue labels and a warning sticker stating Attn.:
Ensure CPU and DSP module label colors are the same!. In the event that there is a mismatch between the
CPU and CT/VT module, the relay will not function and a DSP ERROR or HARDWARE MISMATCH error will be displayed.
All other input/output modules are compatible with the new hardware. Firmware versions 4.0x and higher are only
compatible with the new hardware modules. Previous versions of the firmware (3.4x and earlier) are only compatible with the older hardware modules.
3.1.3 REAR TERMINAL LAYOUT
837773A1.CDR
The relay follows a convention with respect to terminal number assignments which are three characters long assigned in
order by module slot position, row number, and column letter. Two-slot wide modules take their slot designation from the
first slot position (nearest to CPU module) which is indicated by an arrow marker on the terminal block. See the following
figure for an example of rear terminal assignments.
GE Multilin
3-7
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
3-8
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
3.2WIRING
TYPICAL CONFIGURATION
TRIPPING DIRECTION
(5 Amp)
52
52
H8b
6H
F 8a
V
I
H2
V
I
H3
V
I
H4
V
I
H5
V
I
H6
W7a
W7c
W8a
W8c
W7b
W8b
W1
V
I
W2
W3
W4
6C
( DC ONLY )
U7a
U7c
U8a
U8c
U7b
U8b
P5
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
P4
CONTROL
POWER
SURGE
FILTER
RS485
COM 1
COM
COM
IRIG-B
Output
BNC
6
6
Inputs/ Inputs/
outputs outputs
*
*
6
6
Inputs/ Inputs/
outputs outputs
*
*
H G
J
6
PERSONAL
COMPUTER
25 PIN
CONNECTOR
9 PIN
CONNECTOR
TXD
RXD
SGND
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
UR
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
8
3 RXD
2 TXD
20
7 SGND
6
4
5
22
COMPUTER
837774A5.CDR
MODULE ARRANGEMENT
GROUND BUS
X W
IRIG-B
Input
Co-axial
MODULES MUST BE
GROUNDED IF
TERMINAL IS
PROVIDED
CONTACTS SHOWN
WITH NO
CONTROL POWER
RS485
COM 2
BNC
(front)
48 VDC
OUTPUT
Co-axial
No. 10AWG
Minimum
M1a
M1b
M1c
M2a
M2b
M2c
M3a
M3b
M3c
M4a
M4b
M4c
M5a
M5b
M5c
M6a
M6b
M6c
M7a
M7b
M7c
M8a
M8b
M8c
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
Co-axial *
P8
9E
D1b
D2b
D3b
D1a
D2a
D3a
D4b
D4a
Ground at
Remote
Device
P7
DB-9
CPU
Shielded
twisted pairs
CRITICAL
FAILURE
POWER SUPPLY
DC
AC or DC
RS-232
B1b
B1a
B2b
B3a
B3b
B5b HI
B6b LO
B6a
B8a
B8b
P6
6K
U5a
U5c
U6a
U6c
U5b
6D
P3
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
U3a
U3c
U4a
U4c
U3b
TC 2
P1a
P1b
P1c
P2a
P2b
P2c
P3a
P3b
P3c
P4a
P4b
P4c
P5a
P5b
P5c
P6a
P6b
P6c
P7a
P7b
P7c
P8a
P8b
P8c
P1
P2
ENTRE DE CONTACT U1a
ENTRE DE CONTACT U1c
ENTRE DE CONTACT U2a
ENTRE DE CONTACT U2c
COMMON U1b
TC 1
W1a
W1b
W1c
W2a
W2b
W2c
W3a
W3b
W3c
W4a
W4b
W4c
6A
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
SURGE
U1a
U1c
U2a
U2c
U1b
F 8c
H1a
H1b
H1c
H2a
H2b
H2c
H3a
H3b
H3c
H4a
H4b
H4c
H5a
H5b
H5c
H6a
H6b
H6c
H1
SURGE
W5a
W5c
W6a
W6c
W5b
VX
VX
F 7a
F 7c
VC
VC
F 6a
F 6c
VA
VOLTAGE INPUTS
8F / 8G
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS
VOLTAGE SUPERVISION
VB
F 5a
F 5c
VA
VB
F 4b
F 4c
IG
IG5
IG1
F 3c
F 4a
IC1
F 3a
F 3b
IC5
IC
F 2b
F 2c
IB
IB1
F 1c
F 2a
IA1
IB5
F 1a
F 1b
IA
CURRENT INPUTS
H7a
H7c
H8a
H8c
H7b
3
VOLTAGE AND
CURRENT SUPVERVISION
IA5
CURRENT
POLARIZATION
SOURCE
F
8
Inputs/ CT/VT
outputs
CPU
Power
Supply
(Rear View)
* Optional
GE Multilin
3-9
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3.2.2 DIELECTRIC STRENGTH
The dielectric strength of the UR-series module hardware is shown in the following table:
Table 31: DIELECTRIC STRENGTH OF UR-SERIES MODULE HARDWARE
MODULE
TYPE
MODULE FUNCTION
TERMINALS
DIELECTRIC STRENGTH
(AC)
FROM
TO
Power supply
Chassis
Power supply
48 V DC (+) and ()
Chassis
Power supply
Relay terminals
Chassis
Reserved
N/A
N/A
N/A
Reserved
N/A
N/A
N/A
Reserved
N/A
N/A
N/A
Analog inputs/outputs
All except 8b
Chassis
< 50 V DC
Digital inputs/outputs
All
Chassis
G.703
Chassis
RS422
Chassis
< 50 V DC
CT/VT
All
Chassis
CPU
All
Chassis
Filter networks and transient protection clamps are used in the hardware to prevent damage caused by high peak voltage
transients, radio frequency interference (RFI), and electromagnetic interference (EMI). These protective components can
be damaged by application of the ANSI/IEEE C37.90 specified test voltage for a period longer than the specified one
minute.
3.2.3 CONTROL POWER
CAUTION
NOTE
CONTROL POWER SUPPLIED TO THE RELAY MUST BE CONNECTED TO THE MATCHING POWER SUPPLY
RANGE OF THE RELAY. IF THE VOLTAGE IS APPLIED TO THE WRONG TERMINALS, DAMAGE MAY
OCCUR!
The D60 relay, like almost all electronic relays, contains electrolytic capacitors. These capacitors are well
known to be subject to deterioration over time if voltage is not applied periodically. Deterioration can be
avoided by powering the relays up once a year.
The power supply module can be ordered for two possible voltage ranges, with or without a redundant power option. Each
range has a dedicated input connection for proper operation. The ranges are as shown below (see the Technical Specifications section of chapter 2 for additional details):
LO range: 24 to 48 V (DC only) nominal
HI range: 125 to 250 V nominal
The power supply module provides power to the relay and supplies power for dry contact input connections.
The power supply module provides 48 V DC power for dry contact input connections and a critical failure relay (see the
Typical Wiring Diagram earlier). The critical failure relay is a form-C that will be energized once control power is applied and
the relay has successfully booted up with no critical self-test failures. If on-going self-test diagnostic checks detect a critical
failure (see the Self-Test Errors table in chapter 7) or control power is lost, the relay will de-energize.
For high reliability systems, the D60 has a redundant option in which two D60 power supplies are placed in parallel on the
bus. If one of the power supplies become faulted, the second power supply will assume the full load of the relay without any
interruptions. Each power supply has a green LED on the front of the module to indicate it is functional. The critical fail relay
of the module will also indicate a faulted power supply.
An LED on the front of the module shows the status of the power supply:
LED INDICATION
POWER SUPPLY
ON
OK
ON / OFF CYCLING
Failure
OFF
Failure
3-10
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
CT/VT modules may be ordered with a standard ground current input that is the same as the phase current input. Each AC
current input has an isolating transformer and an automatic shorting mechanism that shorts the input when the module is
withdrawn from the chassis. There are no internal ground connections on the current inputs. Current transformers with 1 to
50000 A primaries and 1 A or 5 A secondaries may be used.
CT/VT modules with a sensitive ground input are also available. These modules are ten times more sensitive than the standard CT/VT modules. Refer to the Technical specifications section for additional details.
The above modules are available with enhanced diagnostics. These modules can automatically detect CT/VT hardware
failure and take the relay out of service.
CT connections for both ABC and ACB phase rotations are identical as shown in the Typical wiring diagram.
The exact placement of a zero-sequence core balance CT to detect ground fault current is shown below. Twisted-pair
cabling on the zero-sequence CT is recommended.
GE Multilin
3-11
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
UNSHIELDED CABLE
Ground connection to neutral
must be on the source side
Source
B
C
SHIELDED CABLE
Stress cone
shields
Source
Ground
outside CT
3
LOAD
LOAD
To ground;
must be on
load side
996630A5
~ 8c
VX
~ 7c
~ 8a
VC
VX
~ 6c
~ 7a
VB
VB
~ 6a
VA
Current inputs
8F and 8G modules (4 CTs and 4 VTs)
VC
~ 5a
~ 5c
VA
~ 4b
~ 4c
IG
IG1
~ 3c
~ 4a
IC1
~ 3b
IC
IG5
~ 2c
~ 3a
IB1
IB
IC5
~ 2a
~ 2b
IB5
~ 1b
~ 1c
IA1
~ 1a
IA
IA5
NOTE
Voltage inputs
842768A1.CDR
3-12
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
3.2.5 CONTACT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
Every digital input/output module has 24 terminal connections. They are arranged as three terminals per row, with eight
rows in total. A given row of three terminals may be used for the outputs of one relay. For example, for form-C relay outputs,
the terminals connect to the normally open (NO), normally closed (NC), and common contacts of the relay. For a form-A
output, there are options of using current or voltage detection for feature supervision, depending on the module ordered.
The terminal configuration for contact inputs is different for the two applications.
The digital inputs are grouped with a common return. The D60 has two versions of grouping: four inputs per common return
and two inputs per common return. When a digital input/output module is ordered, four inputs per common is used. The four
inputs per common allows for high-density inputs in combination with outputs, with a compromise of four inputs sharing one
common. If the inputs must be isolated per row, then two inputs per common return should be selected (4D module).
The tables and diagrams on the following pages illustrate the module types (6A, etc.) and contact arrangements that may
be ordered for the relay. Since an entire row is used for a single contact output, the name is assigned using the module slot
position and row number. However, since there are two contact inputs per row, these names are assigned by module slot
position, row number, and column position.
Some form-A / solid-state relay outputs include circuits to monitor the DC voltage across the output contact when it is open,
and the DC current through the output contact when it is closed. Each of the monitors contains a level detector whose output is set to logic On = 1 when the current in the circuit is above the threshold setting. The voltage monitor is set to On =
1 when the current is above about 1 to 2.5 mA, and the current monitor is set to On = 1 when the current exceeds about
80 to 100 mA. The voltage monitor is intended to check the health of the overall trip circuit, and the current monitor can be
used to seal-in the output contact until an external contact has interrupted current flow.
Block diagrams are shown below for form-A and form-A / solid-state relay outputs with optional voltage monitor, optional
current monitor, and with no monitoring
~#a
~#a
I
If Idc 1mA, Cont Op xxx Von
otherwise Cont Op xxx Voff
~#b
~#c
~#a
V
If Idc 80mA, Cont Op xxx Ion
otherwise Cont Op xxx Ioff
~#c
+
Load
~#b
Load
~#c
V
~#b
~#a
Load
Load
~#c
I
~#b
~#a
~#b
+
Load
c) No monitoring
~#c
827821A6.CDR
GE Multilin
3-13
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
~#a
~#a
I
If Idc 1mA, Cont Op ## Von
otherwise Cont Op ## Voff
~#b
~#c
~#a
V
~#b
~#a
Load
Load
~#c
I
~#b
~#b
Load
~#c
Load
~#c
~#a
~#b
Load
c) No monitoring
~#c
WARNING
Relay contacts must be considered unsafe to touch when the unit is energized! If the relay contacts need to
be used for low voltage accessible applications, it is the customers responsibility to ensure proper insulation levels!
USE OF FORM-A/SSR OUTPUTS IN HIGH IMPEDANCE CIRCUITS
NOTE
For Form-A/SSR output contacts internally equipped with a voltage measuring cIrcuit across the contact, the circuit
has an impedance that can cause a problem when used in conjunction with external high input impedance monitoring equipment such as modern relay test set trigger circuits. These monitoring circuits may continue to read the
Form-A contact as being closed after it has closed and subsequently opened, when measured as an impedance.
The solution to this problem is to use the voltage measuring trigger input of the relay test set, and connect the
Form-A contact through a voltage-dropping resistor to a DC voltage source. If the 48 V DC output of the power supply is used as a source, a 500 , 10 W resistor is appropriate. In this configuration, the voltage across either the
Form-A contact or the resistor can be used to monitor the state of the output.
Wherever a tilde ~ symbol appears, substitute with the slot position of the module; wherever a number
sign "#" appears, substitute the contact number
NOTE
NOTE
3-14
When current monitoring is used to seal-in the Form-A/SSR contact outputs, the FlexLogic operand driving the contact output should be given a reset delay of 10 ms to prevent damage of the output contact (in
situations when the element initiating the contact output is bouncing, at values in the region of the pickup
value).
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
~6B MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~6C MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~6D MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-C
~1a, ~1c
2 Inputs
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-C
~2a, ~2c
2 Inputs
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3a, ~3c
2 Inputs
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4a, ~4c
2 Inputs
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-C
~5
Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-C
~6
Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
Form-C
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Form-C
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~6E MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~6F MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~6G MODULE
~6H MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~1
Form-C
~1
Fast Form-C
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~2
Form-C
~2
Fast Form-C
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Fast Form-C
~3
Form-A
~3
Form-A
~4
Form-C
~4
Fast Form-C
~4
Form-A
~4
Form-A
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Fast Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-A
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Fast Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-A
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
Fast Form-C
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Fast Form-C
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~6K MODULE
~6L MODULE
~6M MODULE
~6N MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1
Form-C
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~2
Form-C
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-A
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-A
~5
Fast Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~6
Fast Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~7
Fast Form-C
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8
Fast Form-C
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~6P MODULE
~6R MODULE
~6S MODULE
~6T MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~3
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-A
~4
Form-A
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-A
~5
Form-A
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-A
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
GE Multilin
3-15
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
~6U MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~67 MODULE
~4A MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
~4B MODULE
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Not Used
~1
Not Used
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Solid-State
~2
Solid-State
~3
Form-A
~3
Form-A
~3
Not Used
~3
Not Used
~4
Form-A
~4
Form-A
~4
Solid-State
~4
Solid-State
~5
Form-A
~5
Form-A
~5
Not Used
~5
Not Used
Solid-State
~6
Form-A
~6
Form-A
~6
Solid-State
~6
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
Form-A
~7
Not Used
~7
Not Used
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Form-A
~8
Solid-State
~8
Solid-State
3
~4C MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
3-16
~4D MODULE
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
~1
Not Used
~2
Solid-State
~3
Not Used
~4
Solid-State
~5
Not Used
~6
Solid-State
~4L MODULE
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1a, ~1c
2 Inputs
~1
2 Outputs
~2a, ~2c
2 Inputs
~2
2 Outputs
~3a, ~3c
2 Inputs
~3
2 Outputs
~4a, ~4c
2 Inputs
~4
2 Outputs
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
2 Outputs
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
2 Outputs
~7
Not Used
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
2 Outputs
~8
Solid-State
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Not Used
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
GE Multilin
3-17
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3-18
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
CONTACT INPUTS:
A dry contact has one side connected to terminal B3b. This is the positive 48 V DC voltage rail supplied by the power supply module. The other side of the dry contact is connected to the required contact input terminal. Each contact input group
has its own common (negative) terminal which must be connected to the DC negative terminal (B3a) of the power supply
module. When a dry contact closes, a current of 1 to 3 mA will flow through the associated circuit.
A wet contact has one side connected to the positive terminal of an external DC power supply. The other side of this contact
is connected to the required contact input terminal. If a wet contact is used, then the negative side of the external source
must be connected to the relay common (negative) terminal of each contact group. The maximum external source voltage
for this arrangement is 300 V DC.
The voltage threshold at which each group of four contact inputs will detect a closed contact input is programmable as
17 V DC for 24 V sources, 33 V DC for 48 V sources, 84 V DC for 110 to 125 V sources, and 166 V DC for 250 V sources.
DIGITAL I/O
~ 7a + CONTACT IN
~ 7c + CONTACT IN
~ 8a + CONTACT IN
~ 8c + CONTACT IN
~ 7b COMMON
SURGE
B 1b
CRITICAL
B 1a
FAILURE
B 2b
B 3a 48 VDC
OUTPUT
B 3b +
B 5b HI+
CONTROL
B 6b LO+
POWER
B 6a B 8a
SURGE
B 8b
FILTER
(Wet)
24-250V
DIGITAL I/O
6B
~ 7a + CONTACT IN ~ 7a
~ 7c + CONTACT IN ~ 7c
~ 8a + CONTACT IN ~ 8a
~ 8c + CONTACT IN ~ 8c
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b
~ 8b
SURGE
~ 8b
6B
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
POWER SUPPLY
(Dry)
827741A4.CDR
CONTACT OUTPUTS:
Contact outputs may be ordered as Form-A or Form-C. The Form A contacts may be connected for external circuit supervision. These contacts are provided with voltage and current monitoring circuits used to detect the loss of DC voltage in the
circuit, and the presence of DC current flowing through the contacts when the Form-A contact closes. If enabled, the current monitoring can be used as a seal-in signal to ensure that the Form-A contact does not attempt to break the energized
inductive coil circuit and weld the output contacts.
There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We
recommend using an external DC supply.
NOTE
GE Multilin
3-19
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3 mA
time
25 to 50 ms
842749A1.CDR
3-20
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
3.2.6 TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS
Transducer input modules can receive input signals from external dcmA output transducers (dcmA In) or resistance temperature detectors (RTD). Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from these external transducers and convert these signals into a digital format for use as required.
Transducer output modules provide DC current outputs in several standard dcmA ranges. Software is provided to configure
virtually any analog quantity used in the relay to drive the analog outputs.
Every transducer input/output module has a total of 24 terminal connections. These connections are arranged as three terminals per row with a total of eight rows. A given row may be used for either inputs or outputs, with terminals in column "a"
having positive polarity and terminals in column "c" having negative polarity. Since an entire row is used for a single input/
output channel, the name of the channel is assigned using the module slot position and row number.
Each module also requires that a connection from an external ground bus be made to Terminal 8b. The current outputs
require a twisted-pair shielded cable, where the shield is grounded at one end only. The figure below illustrates the transducer module types (5A, 5C, 5D, 5E, and 5F) and channel arrangements that may be ordered for the relay.
Wherever a tilde ~ symbol appears, substitute with the Slot Position of the module.
NOTE
GE Multilin
3-21
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3.2.7 RS232 FACEPLATE PORT
A 9-pin RS232C serial port is located on the relays faceplate for programming with a portable (personal) computer. All that
is required to use this interface is a personal computer running the EnerVista UR Setup software provided with the relay.
Cabling for the RS232 port is shown in the following figure for both 9 pin and 25 pin connectors.
The baud rate for this port is fixed at 19200 bps.
NOTE
CPU TYPE
COM1
COM2
9E
RS485
RS485
9G
RS485
9H
Redundant 10Base-F
RS485
9J
100Base-FX
RS485
9K
Redundant 100Base-FX
RS485
9L
100Base-FX
RS485
9M
Redundant 100Base-FX
RS485
9N
10/100Base-T
RS485
9P
100Base-FX
RS485
9R
Redundant 100Base-FX
RS485
3-22
GE Multilin
3.2 WIRING
UCT
3 HARDWARE
UCT
842765A2.CDR
GE Multilin
3-23
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
OBSERVING ANY FIBER TRANSMITTER OUTPUT MAY CAUSE INJURY TO THE EYE.
CAUTION
The fiber optic communication ports allow for fast and efficient communications between relays at 10 or 100Mbps. Optical
fiber may be connected to the relay supporting a wavelength of 820 nm in multi-mode or 1310 nm in multi-mode and singlemode. The 10 Mbps rate is available for CPU modules 9G and 9H; 100Mbps is available for modules 9J, 9K, 9L, and 9M.
The 9H, 9K and 9M modules have a second pair of identical optical fiber transmitter and receiver for redundancy.
The optical fiber sizes supported include 50/125 m, 62.5/125 m and 100/140 m for 10 Mbps. The fiber optic port is
designed such that the response times will not vary for any core that is 100 m or less in diameter, 62.5 m for 100 Mbps.
For optical power budgeting, splices are required every 1 km for the transmitter/receiver pair. When splicing optical fibers,
the diameter and numerical aperture of each fiber must be the same. In order to engage or disengage the ST type connector, only a quarter turn of the coupling is required.
3-24
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
3.2.9 IRIG-B
IRIG-B is a standard time code format that allows stamping of events to be synchronized among connected devices within
1 millisecond. The IRIG time code formats are serial, width-modulated codes which can be either DC level shifted or amplitude modulated (AM). Third party equipment is available for generating the IRIG-B signal; this equipment may use a GPS
satellite system to obtain the time reference so that devices at different geographic locations can also be synchronized.
RELAY
IRIG-B
TIME CODE
GENERATOR
(DC SHIFT OR
AMPLITUDE MODULATED
SIGNAL CAN BE USED)
4B
IRIG-B(+)
4A
IRIG-B(-)
RECEIVER
BNC (IN)
BNC (OUT)
TO OTHER DEVICES
(DC-SHIFT ONLY)
REPEATER
827756A5.CDR
GE Multilin
3-25
3 HARDWARE
3.3.1 DESCRIPTION
The D60 direct inputs/outputs feature makes use of the type 7 series of communications modules. These modules are also
used by the L90 Line Differential Relay for inter-relay communications. The direct input/output feature uses the communications channel(s) provided by these modules to exchange digital state information between relays. This feature is available
on all UR-series relay models except for the L90 Line Differential relay.
The communications channels are normally connected in a ring configuration as shown below. The transmitter of one module is connected to the receiver of the next module. The transmitter of this second module is then connected to the receiver
of the next module in the ring. This is continued to form a communications ring. The figure below illustrates a ring of four
UR-series relays with the following connections: UR1-Tx to UR2-Rx, UR2-Tx to UR3-Rx, UR3-Tx to UR4-Rx, and UR4-Tx
to UR1-Rx. A maximum of sixteen (16) UR-series relays can be connected in a single ring
UR #1
UR #2
UR #3
UR #4
Tx
Rx
Tx
Rx
Tx
Rx
Tx
Rx
842006A1.CDR
UR #1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
UR #2
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
UR #3
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
UR #4
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2
842007A1.CDR
3-26
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
UR #1
Tx
Rx
Channel #1
Tx1
UR #2
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2
Channel #2
UR #3
Tx
Rx
842013A1.CDR
SPECIFICATION
C37.94SM, 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
2B
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
G.703, 1 channel
7S
G.703, 2 channels
7T
RS422, 1 channel
7V
7W
RS422, 2 channels
72
73
74
75
76
77
OBSERVING ANY FIBER TRANSMITTER OUTPUT MAY CAUSE INJURY TO THE EYE.
CAUTION
GE Multilin
3-27
3 HARDWARE
3.3.2 FIBER: LED AND ELED TRANSMITTERS
The following figure shows the configuration for the 7A, 7B, 7C, 7H, 7I, and 7J fiber-only modules.
Module:
Connection Location:
7A / 7B / 7C
7H / 7I / 7J
Slot X
Slot X
RX1
RX1
TX1
TX1
3
RX2
TX2
1 Channel
2 Channels
831719A2.CDR
72/ 7D
73/ 7K
Connection Location:
Slot X
Slot X
TX1
TX1
RX1
RX1
TX2
RX2
1 Channel
2 Channels
831720A3.CDR
3-28
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
a) DESCRIPTION
The following figure shows the 64K ITU G.703 co-directional interface configuration.
The G.703 module is fixed at 64 kbps. The SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O DIRECT I/O DATA RATE
setting is not applicable to this module.
NOTE
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external connections, with the shield grounded only at one end. Connecting the shield to pin X1a or X6a grounds the shield since these pins are internally connected to ground. Thus, if pin X1a
or X6a is used, do not ground at the other end. This interface module is protected by surge suppression devices.
Inter-relay communications
7R
Shield
Tx
G.703
channel 1
Rx
Tx +
Rx +
Surge
Shield
Tx
G.703
channel 2
Rx
Tx +
Rx +
Surge
X 1a
X 1b
X 2a
X 2b
X 3a
X 3b
X 6a
X 6b
X 7a
X 7b
X 8a
X 8b
842773A1.CDR
Rx Tx +
Rx +
SURGE
Shld.
COMM.
Tx -
G.703
CHANNEL 2
Rx Tx +
Rx +
SURGE
X 1a
X 1b
X 2a
X 2b
X 3a
X 3b
X 6a
X 6b
X 7a
X 7b
X 8a
X 8b
X 1a
X 1b
X 2a
X 2b
X 3a
X 3b
X 6a
X 6b
X 7a
X 7b
X 8a
X 8b
Shld.
7R
Tx -
Tx Rx -
G.703
CHANNEL 1
Tx +
Rx +
SURGE
Shld.
Tx Rx -
G.703
CHANNEL 2
Tx +
Rx +
COMM.
7R
Shld.
G.703
CHANNEL 1
SURGE
831727A2.CDR
NOTE
Pin nomenclature may differ from one manufacturer to another. Therefore, it is not uncommon to see
pinouts numbered TxA, TxB, RxA and RxB. In such cases, it can be assumed that A is equivalent to +
and B is equivalent to .
Remove the G.703 module (7R or 7S). The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module,
must be pulled simultaneously in order to release the module for removal. Before performing this action, control
power must be removed from the relay. The original location of the module should be recorded to help ensure that
the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2.
3.
Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
4.
Set the timing selection switches (channel 1, channel 2) to the desired timing modes.
5.
GE Multilin
3-29
3 HARDWARE
Re-insert the G.703 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position.
The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as
the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the
clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
FUNCTION
S1
S5 and S6
Internal Timing Mode: The system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the G.703 timing selection should be in
the internal timing mode for back-to-back (UR-to-UR) connections. For back-to-back connections, set for octet timing
(S1 = OFF) and timing mode to internal timing (S5 = ON and S6 = OFF).
Loop Timing Mode: The system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the G.703 timing selection
should be in loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems. For connection to a higher order system (URto-multiplexer, factory defaults), set to octet timing (S1 = ON) and set timing mode to loop timing (S5 = OFF and S6 =
OFF).
3-30
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
The switch settings for the internal and loop timing modes are shown below:
842752A1.CDR
DMR
G7X
DMX
G7R
842774A1.CDR
DMR
G7X
DMX
G7R
842775A1.CDR
GE Multilin
3-31
3 HARDWARE
3.3.5 RS422 INTERFACE
a) DESCRIPTION
There are two RS422 inter-relay communications modules available: single-channel RS422 (module 7T) and dual-channel
RS422 (module 7W). The modules can be configured to run at 64 or 128 kbps. AWG 24 twisted shielded pair cable is recommended for external connections. These modules are protected by optically-isolated surge suppression devices.
The shield pins (6a and 7b) are internally connected to the ground pin (8a). Proper shield termination is as follows:
The clock terminating impedance should match the impedance of the line.
Single-channel RS422 module
Rx
RS422
Tx +
Rx +
Shield
Clock
COM
Surge
~ 3b
~ 3a
~ 2a
~ 4b
~ 6a
~ 5b
~ 5a
~ 4a
~ 6b
~ 7b
~ 7a
~ 8b
~ 2b
~ 8a
7W
RS422
channel 1
Shield
Tx
Rx
Tx +
Rx +
RS422
channel 2
Shield
Clock
COM
Surge
Inter-relay communications
Tx
7T
~ 3b
~ 3a
~ 2a
~ 4b
~ 6a
~ 7a
~ 8b
~ 2b
~ 8a
Inter-relay comms.
842776A3.CDR
3-32
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
Data module 1
Signal name
7W
Tx1(+)
Tx1(-)
RS422
CHANNEL 1
Rx1(+)
Rx1(-)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
Shld.
+
CLOCK
Tx2(+)
Tx2(-)
RS422
CHANNEL 2
Rx2(+)
Rx2(-)
Shld.
com
SURGE
W 2a
W 3b
W 4b
W 3a
W 6a
W 7a
W 8b
W 4a
W 5b
W 6b
W 5a
W 7b
W 2b
W 8a
Data module 2
Signal name
TT(A) - Terminal timing
TT(B) - Terminal timing
SD(A) - Send data
SD(B) - Send data
RD(A) - Received data
RD(B) - Received data
RS(A) - Request to send (RTS)
RS(B) - Request to send (RTS)
CS(A) - Clear To send
CS(B) - Clear To send
Local loopback
Remote loopback
Signal ground
ST(A) - Send timing
ST(B) - Send timing
831022A3.CDR
Tx Clock
Tx Data
GE Multilin
3-33
3 HARDWARE
To recover the Rx clock from the data-stream, an integrated DPLL (digital phase lock loop) circuit is utilized. The DPLL is
driven by an internal clock, which is 16-times over-sampled, and uses this clock along with the data-stream to generate a
data clock that can be used as the SCC (serial communication controller) receive clock.
3.3.6 RS422 AND FIBER INTERFACE
The following figure shows the combined RS422 plus Fiber interface configuration at 64K baud. The 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, and 74
modules are used in two-terminal with a redundant channel or three-terminal configurations where channel 1 is employed
via the RS422 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and channel 2 via direct fiber.
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external RS422 connections and the shield should be grounded only at
one end. For the direct fiber channel, power budget issues should be addressed properly.
Tx2
Clock
(channel 1)
COM
Tx1 +
Rx1
Tx1
RS422
channel 1
Rx1 +
Shield
Rx2
~ 8a
Fiber
channel 2
Surge
Inter-relay comms.
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 2b
~ 2a
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 4b
~ 6a
WARNING
842777A1.CDR
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 3a
~ 3b
Shield
Tx
Rx
Tx +
G.703
channel 1
Rx +
Surge
Tx2
Rx2
Fiber
channel 2
When using a LASER Interface, attenuators may be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed maximum
optical input power to the receiver.
842778A1.CDR
3-34
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
The UR-series IEEE C37.94 communication modules (76 and 77) are designed to interface with IEEE C37.94 compliant
digital multiplexers and/or an IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converter for use with direct input/output applications for
firmware revisions 3.30 and higher. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link for synchronous data
between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard provides for speeds up to
64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,, 12. The UR-series C37.94 communication module is 64 kbps only with n fixed at 1. The frame
is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern from the standpoint of framing and
data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
IEEE standard: C37.94 for 1 64 kbps optical fiber interface
Fiber optic cable type: 50 mm or 62.5 mm core diameter optical fiber
Fiber optic mode: multi-mode
Fiber optic cable length: up to 2 km
Fiber optic connector: type ST
Wavelength: 830 40 nm
Connection: as per all fiber optic connections, a Tx to Rx connection is required.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports
the IEEE C37.94 standard as shown below.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected to the electrical interface (G.703, RS422, or X.21) of a
non-compliant digital multiplexer via an optical-to-electrical interface converter that supports the IEEE C37.94 standard, as
shown below.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module has six (6) switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The functions of these control switches is shown below.
842753A1.CDR
For the Internal Timing Mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the timing switch selection should be
Internal Timing for Relay 1 and Loop Timed for Relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the Looped Timing Mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in Loop Timing Mode for connections to higher order systems.
The C37.94 communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
GE Multilin
3-35
3 HARDWARE
2.
3.
Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
4.
Set the Timing Selection Switches (Channel 1, Channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
5.
6.
Re-insert the C37.94 module Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position
as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage
the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
3-36
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
The UR-series C37.94SM communication modules (2A and 2B) are designed to interface with modified IEEE C37.94 compliant digital multiplexers and/or IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converters that have been converted from 820 nm multimode fiber optics to 1300 nm ELED single-mode fiber optics. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link
for synchronous data between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard
provides for speeds up to 64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,, 12. The UR-series C37.94SM communication module is 64 kbps
only with n fixed at 1. The frame is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern
from the standpoint of framing and data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
Emulated IEEE standard: emulates C37.94 for 1 64 kbps optical fiber interface (modules set to n = 1 or 64 kbps)
Fiber optic cable type: 9/125 m core diameter optical fiber
Fiber optic mode: single-mode, ELED compatible with HP HFBR-1315T transmitter and HP HFBR-2316T receiver
Fiber optic cable length: up to 10 km
Fiber optic connector: type ST
Wavelength: 1300 40 nm
Connection: as per all fiber optic connections, a Tx to Rx connection is required.
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports C37.94SM as shown below.
It can also can be connected directly to any other UR-series relay with a C37.94SM module as shown below.
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module has six (6) switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The
functions of these control switches is shown below.
842753A1.CDR
For the Internal Timing Mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the timing switch selection should be
Internal Timing for Relay 1 and Loop Timed for Relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the Looped Timing Mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in Loop Timing Mode for connections to higher order systems.
The C37.94SM communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
GE Multilin
3-37
3 HARDWARE
2.
3.
Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
4.
Set the Timing Selection Switches (Channel 1, Channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
5.
6.
Re-insert the C37.94SM module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
3-38
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a graphical user interface (GUI) as one of two human interfaces to a UR device.
The alternate human interface is implemented via the devices faceplate keypad and display (refer to the Faceplate interface section in this chapter).
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a single facility to configure, monitor, maintain, and trouble-shoot the operation
of relay functions, connected over local or wide area communication networks. It can be used while disconnected (off-line)
or connected ( on-line) to a UR device. In off-line mode, settings files can be created for eventual downloading to the
device. In on-line mode, you can communicate with the device in real-time.
The EnerVista UR Setup software, provided with every D60 relay, can be run from any computer supporting Microsoft Windows 95, 98, NT, 2000, ME, and XP. This chapter provides a summary of the basic EnerVista UR Setup software interface
features. The EnerVista UR Setup Help File provides details for getting started and using the EnerVista UR Setup software
interface.
4.1.2 CREATING A SITE LIST
To start using the EnerVista UR Setup software, a site definition and device definition must first be created. See the EnerVista UR Setup Help File or refer to the Connecting EnerVista UR Setup with the D60 section in Chapter 1 for details.
4.1.3 ENERVISTA UR SETUP OVERVIEW
a) ENGAGING A DEVICE
The EnerVista UR Setup software may be used in on-line mode (relay connected) to directly communicate with the D60
relay. Communicating relays are organized and grouped by communication interfaces and into sites. Sites may contain any
number of relays selected from the UR-series of relays.
b) USING SETTINGS FILES
The EnerVista UR Setup software interface supports three ways of handling changes to relay settings:
In off-line mode (relay disconnected) to create or edit relay settings files for later download to communicating relays.
While connected to a communicating relay to directly modify any relay settings via relay data view windows, and then
save the settings to the relay.
You can create/edit settings files and then write them to the relay while the interface is connected to the relay.
Settings files are organized on the basis of file names assigned by the user. A settings file contains data pertaining to the
following types of relay settings:
Device definition
Product setup
System setup
FlexLogic
Grouped elements
Control elements
Inputs/outputs
Testing
Factory default values are supplied and can be restored after any changes.
c) CREATING AND EDITING FLEXLOGIC
You can create or edit a FlexLogic equation in order to customize the relay. You can subsequently view the automatically
generated logic diagram.
GE Multilin
4-1
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Event Recorder facility: The event recorder captures contextual data associated with the last 1024 events, listed in
chronological order from most recent to oldest.
Oscillography facility: The oscillography waveform traces and digital states are used to provide a visual display of
power system and relay operation data captured during specific triggered events.
f) FILE SUPPORT
Execution: Any EnerVista UR Setup file which is double clicked or opened will launch the application, or provide focus
to the already opened application. If the file was a settings file (has a URS extension) which had been removed from
the Settings List tree menu, it will be added back to the Settings List tree menu.
Drag and Drop: The Site List and Settings List control bar windows are each mutually a drag source and a drop target
for device-order-code-compatible files or individual menu items. Also, the Settings List control bar window and any
Windows Explorer directory folder are each mutually a file drag source and drop target.
New files which are dropped into the Settings List window are added to the tree which is automatically sorted alphabetically with respect to settings file names. Files or individual menu items which are dropped in the selected device menu
in the Site List window will automatically be sent to the on-line communicating device.
g) FIRMWARE UPGRADES
The firmware of a D60 device can be upgraded, locally or remotely, via the EnerVista UR Setup software. The corresponding instructions are provided by the EnerVista UR Setup Help file under the topic Upgrading Firmware.
NOTE
4-2
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (i.e. default
values, minimum/maximum values, data type, and item size) may change slightly from version to version of firmware. The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or modified.
The EEPROM DATA ERROR message displayed after upgrading/downgrading the firmware is a resettable, self-test
message intended to inform users that the Modbus addresses have changed with the upgraded firmware. This
message does not signal any problems when appearing after firmware upgrades.
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
The EnerVista UR Setup software main window supports the following primary display components:
1.
Title bar which shows the pathname of the active data view.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Status bar.
3
10
4
842786A2.CDR
GE Multilin
4-3
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.2FACEPLATE INTERFACE
4.2.1 FACEPLATE
a) ENHANCED FACEPLATE
The front panel interface is one of two supported interfaces, the other interface being EnerVista UR Setup software. The
front panel interface consists of LED panels, an RS232 port, keypad, LCD display, control pushbuttons, and optional userprogrammable pushbuttons.
The faceplate is hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules.
Display
Keypad
4
Front panel
RS232 port
User-programmable pushbuttons 1 to 16
842810A1.CDR
LED panel 2
LED panel 3
Display
Front panel
RS232 port
Small user-programmable
(control) pushbuttons 1 to 7
User-programmable
pushbuttons 1 to 12
Keypad
827801A7.CDR
4-4
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
The following figure shows the vertical arrangement of the faceplate panels for relays ordered with the vertical option.
DISPLAY
MENU
HELP
MESSAGE
ESCAPE
ENTER
VALUE
+/-
KEYPAD
LED PANEL 3
LED PANEL 2
827830A1.CDR
STATUS
EVENT CAUSE
IN SERVICE
VOLTAGE
TROUBLE
CURRENT
TEST MODE
FREQUENCY
TRIP
OTHER
ALARM
PHASE A
PICKUP
PHASE B
RESET
USER 1
USER 2
LED PANEL 1
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND
USER 3
842811A1.CDR
IN SERVICE: This LED indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs, outputs, and internal systems are
OK, and that the device has been programmed.
TROUBLE: This LED indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem.
GE Multilin
4-5
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
TEST MODE: This LED indicates that the relay is in test mode.
TRIP: This LED indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as a trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; as such, a reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
ALARM: This LED indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. This indicator is
never latched.
PICKUP: This LED indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator is never latched.
The event cause indicators in the first column are described below. These indicate the input type that was involved in a condition detected by an element that is operated or has a latched flag waiting to be reset.
The user-programmable LEDs consist of 48 amber LED indicators in four columns. The operation of these LEDs is userdefined. Support for applying a customized label beside every LED is provided. The D60 is shipped with the default label
for several user-programmable pushbuttons. However, the LEDs are not pre-programmed to reflect these labels. To match
the pre-printed label, the LED settings must be programmed as described in the User-programmable LEDs section of chapter 5. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used to
communicate with operators. Refer to the User-programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
b) STANDARD FACEPLATE
The standar faceplate consists of three panels with LED indicators, keys, and a communications port. The RESET key is
used to reset any latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these latched conditions
can also be reset via the SETTINGS INPUT/OUTPUTS RESETTING menu). The USER keys are used by the Breaker
Control feature. The RS232 port is intended for connection to a portable PC.
STATUS
EVENT CAUSE
IN SERVICE
VOLTAGE
TROUBLE
CURRENT
TEST MODE
FREQUENCY
TRIP
OTHER
ALARM
PHASE A
PICKUP
PHASE B
RESET
USER 1
USER 2
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND
USER 3
842781A1.CDR
IN SERVICE: Indicates that control power is applied; all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are OK; the
relay has been programmed.
4-6
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
TRIP: Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a Trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; the RESET command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
ALARM: Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as an Alarm switch has operated. This indicator is
never latched.
PICKUP: Indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator is never latched.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE INDICATORS:
The second and third provide 48 amber LED indicators whose operation is controlled by the user. Support for applying a
customized label beside every LED is provided.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used to
communicate with operators. Refer to the User-programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
842782A1.CDR
BREAKER 1(2) TROUBLE: A problem related to the breaker has been detected.
RECLOSE LOCKED OUT: The recloser is not operational and requires a reset.
GE Multilin
4-7
NOTE
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Firmware revisions 2.9x and earlier support eight user setting groups; revisions 3.0x and higher support
six setting groups. For convenience of users using earlier firmware revisions, the relay panel shows eight
setting groups. Please note that the LEDs, despite their default labels, are fully user-programmable.
The relay is shipped with the default label for the LED panel 2. The LEDs, however, are not pre-programmed. To match the
pre-printed label, the LED settings must be entered as shown in the User-Programmable LEDs section of Chapter 5. The
LEDs are fully user-programmable. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels for both panels as explained
in the following section.
842784A1.CDR
The D60 front panel label cutout sheet (GE Multilin part number 1006-0047) has been downloaded from http://
www.GEindustrial.com/multilin/support/ur and printed.
Small-bladed knife.
This procedure describes how to create custom LED labels for the enhance front panel display.
1.
4-8
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
2.
Select the Front Panel Report item at the bottom of the menu tree for the settings file. The front panel report window
will be displayed.
Enter the text to appear next to each LED and above each user-programmable pushbuttons in the fields provided.
4.
Feed the D60 front panel label cutout sheet into a printer and press the Print button in the front panel report window.
5.
When printing is complete, fold the sheet along the perforated lines and punch out the labels.
6.
Remove the D60 label insert tool from the package and bend the tabs as follows.
Bend the two tabs towards centre of the tool upwards (towards you when looking from the printed side) - see figure 4-10 below.
Bend the two tabs towards centre of the tool downwards (away from you when looking from the printed side) - see
figure 4-11below.
Bend the tab at the centre of the tool tail, inward (toward you when looking at the printed side) - see figure 4-12
below.
These tabs will be used for insertion and removal of the default and custom LED labels.
It is important that the tool be adjusted and used, EXACTLY as shown below, with the printed side
containing the GE part number, facing UPWARDS.
NOTE
GE Multilin
4-9
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4-10
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Figure 412: LABEL TOOL - BENDING THE TAB AT THE CENTRE OF THE TOOL TAIL
Figure 413: STEP 1 - USE KNIFE TO LIFT THE LED LABEL AND SLIDE THE LABEL TOOL UNDERNEATH. MAKE
SURE THE BENDED UPPER TABS ARE POINTING OUTWARDS ( IE - AWAY FROM YOU).
GE Multilin
4-11
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Figure 414: STEP 2 - SLIDE THE TOOL IN UNTIL THE TABS SNAP OUT AS SHOWN
Figure 415: STEP 3 - PULL THE TOOL OUT ALONG WITH THE LED LABEL
4-12
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Figure 416: STEP 7 - SLIDE HALF OF THE PRINTED LED LABEL INSIDE THE POCKET
Figure 417: STEP 8 - SLIDE THE LABEL TOOL INSIDE THE POCKET AS SHOWN
GE Multilin
4-13
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4
Figure 418: STEP 9 - PUSH THE LABEL IN UNTIL THE TEXT ALIGNS WITH THE LEDS
INSERTION AND REMOVAL OF PUSHBUTTON LABELS:
Figure 419: STEP 1 - USE KNIFE TO LIFT THE PUSHBUTTON LABEL AND SLIDE TAIL OF THE LABEL TOOL
UNDERNEATH. MAKE SURE THE BENDED TAB IS POINTING OUTWARDS ( IE - AWAY FROM YOU).
4-14
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Figure 420: STEP 2 - SLIDE THE TOOL IN UNTIL THE TAB SNAPS OUT AS SHOWN
Figure 421: STEP 3 - PULL THE TOOL OUT WITH THE PUSHBUTTON LABEL
GE Multilin
4-15
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4
Figure 422: STEP 4 - SLIDE IN THE CUSTOM BUTTON LABEL AS SHOWN
b) STANDARD FACEPLATE
Custom labeling of an LED-only panel is facilitated through a Microsoft Word file available from the following URL:
http://www.GEindustrial.com/multilin/support/ur/
This file provides templates and instructions for creating appropriate labeling for the LED panel. The following procedures
are contained in the downloadable file. The panel templates provide relative LED locations and located example text (x)
edit boxes. The following procedure demonstrates how to install/uninstall the custom panel labeling.
1.
Remove the clear Lexan Front Cover (GE Multilin part number: 1501-0014).
F60
Push in
and gently lift
up the cover.
842771A1.CDR
2.
Pop out the LED module and/or the blank module with a screwdriver as shown below. Be careful not to damage the
plastic covers.
( LED MODULE )
F60
( BLANK MODULE )
842722A1.CDR
3.
Place the left side of the customized module back to the front panel frame, then snap back the right side.
4-16
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.
The following items are required to customize the D60 display module:
1 each of: 8.5" x 11" white paper, exacto knife, ruler, custom display module (GE Multilin Part Number: 1516-0069),
and a custom module cover (GE Multilin Part Number: 1502-0015).
The following procedure describes how to customize the D60 display module:
1.
Open the LED panel customization template with Microsoft Word. Add text in places of the LED x text placeholders on
the template(s). Delete unused place holders as required.
2.
When complete, save the Word file to your local PC for future use.
3.
4.
From the printout, cut-out the Background Template from the three windows, using the cropmarks as a guide.
5.
Put the Background Template on top of the custom display module (GE Multilin Part Number: 1513-0069) and snap the
clear custom module cover (GE Multilin Part Number: 1502-0015) over it and the templates.
4.2.4 DISPLAY
All messages are displayed on a 2 20 backlit liquid crystal display (LCD) to make them visible under poor lighting conditions. Messages are descriptive and should not require the aid of an instruction manual for deciphering. While the keypad
and display are not actively being used, the display will default to user-defined messages. Any high priority event driven
message will automatically override the default message and appear on the display.
4.2.5 KEYPAD
Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: Actual Values, Settings, Commands, and Targets. The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is broken down further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys scroll increment or decrement numerical setting
values when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alternatively, values may also be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advance to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point. The HELP key may
be pressed at any time for context sensitive help messages. The ENTER key stores altered setting values.
4.2.6 BREAKER CONTROL
a) INTRODUCTION
The D60 can interface with associated circuit breakers. In many cases the application monitors the state of the breaker,
which can be presented on faceplate LEDs, along with a breaker trouble indication. Breaker operations can be manually
initiated from faceplate keypad or automatically initiated from a FlexLogic operand. A setting is provided to assign names
to each breaker; this user-assigned name is used for the display of related flash messages. These features are provided for
two breakers; the user may use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
For the following discussion it is assumed the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS BREAKER 1(2) BREAKER
FUNCTION setting is "Enabled" for each breaker.
b) CONTROL MODE SELECTION AND MONITORING
Installations may require that a breaker is operated in the three-pole only mode (3-pole), or in the one and three-pole (1pole) mode, selected by setting. If the mode is selected as 3-pole, a single input tracks the breaker open or closed position.
If the mode is selected as 1-pole, all three breaker pole states must be input to the relay. These inputs must be in agreement to indicate the position of the breaker.
For the following discussion it is assumed the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS BREAKER 1(2) BREAKER
1(2) PUSH BUTTON CONTROL setting is Enabled for each breaker.
GE Multilin
4-17
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
The D60 has features required for single-pole operation. Inputs that trip individual breaker poles and cause a breaker
reclose are passed directly to this element.
c) FACEPLATE (USER KEY) CONTROL
After the 30 minute interval during which command functions are permitted after a correct command password, the user
cannot open or close a breaker via the keypad. The following discussions begin from the not-permitted state.
d) CONTROL OF TWO BREAKERS
For the following example setup, the (Name) field represents the user-programmed variable name.
For this application (setup shown below), the relay is connected and programmed for both breaker 1 and breaker 2. The
USER 1 key performs the selection of which breaker is to be operated by the USER 2 and USER 3 keys. The USER 2 key
is used to manually close the breaker and the USER 3 key is used to manually open the breaker.
ENTER COMMAND
PASSWORD
This message appears when the USER 1, USER 2, or USER 3 key is pressed and a
is required; i.e. if COMMAND PASSWORD is enabled and no commands have been issued within the last 30 minutes.
COMMAND PASSWORD
Press USER 1
To Select Breaker
This message appears if the correct password is entered or if none is required. This message will be maintained for 30 seconds or until the USER 1 key is pressed again.
BKR1-(Name) SELECTED
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP
This message is displayed after the USER 1 key is pressed for the second time. Three
possible actions can be performed from this state within 30 seconds as per items (1), (2)
and (3) below:
(1)
USER 2 OFF/ON
To Close BKR1-(Name)
If the USER 2 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 2 key is
pressed again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an
output relay to close breaker 1.
(2)
USER 3 OFF/ON
To Open BKR1-(Name)
If the USER 3 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 3 key is
pressed again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an
output relay to open breaker 1.
(3)
BKR2-(Name) SELECTED
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP
If the USER 1 key is pressed at this step, this message appears showing that a different
breaker is selected. Three possible actions can be performed from this state as per (1),
(2) and (3). Repeatedly pressing the USER 1 key alternates between available breakers.
Pressing keys other than USER 1, 2 or 3 at any time aborts the breaker control function.
Actual values
Settings
Commands
Targets
4-18
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
b) HIERARCHY
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters (), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters (). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
UP and DOWN keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing
the MESSAGE RIGHT key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, continually pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
HIGHEST LEVEL
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
c) EXAMPLE MENU NAVIGATION
ACTUAL VALUES
STATUS
Press the MENU key until the header for the first Actual Values page appears. This
page contains system and relay status information. Repeatedly press the MESSAGE
keys to display the other actual value headers.
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
Press the MENU key until the header for the first page of Settings appears. This page
contains settings to configure the relay.
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
Press the MESSAGE DOWN key to move to the next Settings page. This page contains settings for System Setup. Repeatedly press the MESSAGE UP and DOWN
keys to display the other setting headers and then back to the first Settings page
header.
From the Settings page one header (Product Setup), press the MESSAGE RIGHT
key once to display the first sub-header (Password Security).
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key once more and this will display the first setting for
Password Security. Pressing the MESSAGE DOWN key repeatedly will display the
remaining setting messages for this sub-header.
Press the MESSAGE LEFT key once to move back to the first sub-header message.
PASSWORD
SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
Pressing the MESSAGE DOWN key will display the second setting sub-header associated with the Product Setup header.
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 1.0 s
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key once more and this will display the first setting for
Display Properties.
DEFAULT MESSAGE
INTENSITY: 25%
GE Multilin
To view the remaining settings associated with the Display Properties subheader,
repeatedly press the MESSAGE DOWN key. The last message appears as shown.
4-19
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.2.8 CHANGING SETTINGS
For example, select the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH
setting.
MESSAGE TIME
MINIMUM:
MAXIMUM:
0.5
10.0
Press the HELP key to view the minimum and maximum values. Press the HELP key
again to view the next context sensitive help message.
Two methods of editing and storing a numerical setting value are available.
0 to 9 and decimal point: The relay numeric keypad works the same as that of any electronic calculator. A number is
entered one digit at a time. The leftmost digit is entered first and the rightmost digit is entered last. Pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key or pressing the ESCAPE key, returns the original value to the display.
VALUE keys: The VALUE UP key increments the displayed value by the step value, up to the maximum value allowed.
While at the maximum value, pressing the VALUE UP key again will allow the setting selection to continue upward
from the minimum value. The VALUE DOWN key decrements the displayed value by the step value, down to the minimum value. While at the minimum value, pressing the VALUE DOWN key again will allow the setting selection to continue downward from the maximum value.
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 2.5 s
NEW SETTING
HAS BEEN STORED
As an example, set the flash message time setting to 2.5 seconds. Press the appropriate
numeric keys in the sequence 2 . 5". The display message will change as the digits are
being entered.
Until ENTER is pressed, editing changes are not registered by the relay. Therefore, press
ENTER to store the new value in memory. This flash message will momentarily appear
as confirmation of the storing process. Numerical values which contain decimal places
will be rounded-off if more decimal place digits are entered than specified by the step
value.
For example, the selections available for ACCESS LEVEL are "Restricted", "Command",
"Setting", and "Factory Service".
Enumeration type values are changed using the VALUE keys. The VALUE UP key displays the next selection while the
VALUE DOWN key displays the previous selection.
ACCESS LEVEL:
Setting
If the ACCESS LEVEL needs to be "Setting", press the VALUE keys until the proper selection is displayed. Press HELP at any time for the context sensitive help messages.
NEW SETTING
HAS BEEN STORED
Changes are not registered by the relay until the ENTER key is pressed. Pressing
ENTER stores the new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as
confirmation of the storing process.
4-20
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
There are several places where text messages may be programmed to allow the relay to be customized for specific applications. One example is the Message Scratchpad. Use the following procedure to enter alphanumeric text messages.
For example: to enter the text, Breaker #1.
1.
2.
Press the VALUE keys until the character 'B' appears; press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
3.
4.
5.
If you have any problem, press HELP to view context sensitive help. Flash messages will sequentially appear for several seconds each. For the case of a text setting message, pressing HELP displays how to edit and store new values.
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
To change the RELAY SETTINGS: "Not Programmed" mode to "Programmed", proceed as follows:
1.
Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message appears on the
display.
2.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the PASSWORD SECURITY message appears on the display.
3.
Press the MESSAGE DOWN key until the INSTALLATION message appears on the display.
4.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message is displayed.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
INSTALLATION
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
5.
After the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message appears on the display, press the VALUE keys change the
selection to "Programmed".
6.
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
7.
RELAY SETTINGS:
Programmed
NEW SETTING
HAS BEEN STORED
When the "NEW SETTING HAS BEEN STORED" message appears, the relay will be in "Programmed" state and the
In Service LED will turn on.
GE Multilin
4-21
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Local access is defined as any access to settings or commands via the faceplate interface. This includes both keypad entry
and the faceplate RS232 connection. Remote access is defined as any access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any changes to the local or remote passwords
enables this functionality.
To enter the initial setting (or command) password, proceed as follows:
1.
Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message appears on the
display.
2.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the ACCESS LEVEL message appears on the display.
3.
Press the MESSAGE DOWN key until the CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS message appears on the display.
4.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD (or CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD) message
appears on the display.
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
CHANGE COMMAND
PASSWORD: No
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
ENCRYPTED COMMAND
PASSWORD: --------ENCRYPTED SETTING
PASSWORD: ---------
5.
After the CHANGE...PASSWORD message appears on the display, press the VALUE UP or DOWN key to change the
selection to Yes.
6.
Press the ENTER key and the display will prompt you to ENTER NEW PASSWORD.
7.
Type in a numerical password (up to 10 characters) and press the ENTER key.
8.
When the VERIFY NEW PASSWORD is displayed, re-type in the same password and press ENTER.
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: Yes
ENTER NEW
PASSWORD: ##########
VERIFY NEW
PASSWORD: ##########
NEW PASSWORD
HAS BEEN STORED
9.
When the NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED message appears, your new Setting (or Command) Password will be
active.
4-22
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
FOR 10 MIN! flash message will appear upon activation of the ten minute timeout or any other time a user attempts any
change to the defined tier during the ten minute timeout. The LOCAL ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand will be set to
GE Multilin
4-23
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4-24
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.1 OVERVIEW
5 SETTINGS 5.1OVERVIEW
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
GE Multilin
PASSWORD
SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
CLEAR RELAY
RECORDS
COMMUNICATIONS
REAL TIME
CLOCK
FAULT REPORTS
OSCILLOGRAPHY
DATA LOGGER
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
SELF TESTS
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
PUSHBUTTONS
FLEX STATE
PARAMETERS
USER-DEFINABLE
DISPLAYS
DIRECT I/O
TELEPROTECTION
INSTALLATION
AC INPUTS
POWER SYSTEM
SIGNAL SOURCES
5-1
5.1 OVERVIEW
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC
SETTINGS
GROUPED ELEMENTS
5 SETTINGS
BREAKERS
FLEXCURVES
PHASOR MEASUREMENT
UNIT
FLEXLOGIC
EQUATION EDITOR
FLEXLOGIC
TIMERS
FLEXELEMENTS
NON-VOLATILE
LATCHES
SETTING GROUP 1
SETTING GROUP 2
SETTING GROUP 6
SETTINGS
CONTROL ELEMENTS
5-2
SETTING GROUPS
SELECTOR SWITCH
TRIP OUTPUT
SYNCHROCHECK
AUTORECLOSE
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
DIGITAL COUNTERS
MONITORING
ELEMENTS
TRIP BUS
PILOT SCHEMES
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTINGS
INPUTS / OUTPUTS
SETTINGS
TRANSDUCER I/O
SETTINGS
TESTING
GE Multilin
5.1 OVERVIEW
CONTACT INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
CONTACT OUTPUTS
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE INPUTS
REMOTE OUTPUTS
DNA BIT PAIRS
REMOTE OUTPUTS
UserSt BIT PAIRS
RESETTING
DIRECT INPUTS
DIRECT OUTPUTS
TELEPROTECTION
DCMA INPUTS
RTD INPUTS
DCMA OUTPUTS
TEST MODE
FUNCTION: Disabled
FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS
FORCE CONTACT
OUTPUTS
PMU
TEST VALUES
5-3
5.1 OVERVIEW
5 SETTINGS
5.1.2 INTRODUCTION TO ELEMENTS
In the design of UR relays, the term element is used to describe a feature that is based around a comparator. The comparator is provided with an input (or set of inputs) that is tested against a programmed setting (or group of settings) to determine if the input is within the defined range that will set the output to logic 1, also referred to as setting the flag. A single
comparator may make multiple tests and provide multiple outputs; for example, the time overcurrent comparator sets a
pickup flag when the current input is above the setting and sets an operate flag when the input current has been at a level
above the pickup setting for the time specified by the time-current curve settings. All comparators, except the digital element which uses a logic state as the input, use analog parameter actual values as the input.
Elements are arranged into two classes, grouped and control. Each element classed as a grouped element is provided with
six alternate sets of settings, in setting groups numbered 1 through 6. The performance of a grouped element is defined by
the setting group that is active at a given time. The performance of a control element is independent of the selected active
setting group.
The main characteristics of an element are shown on the element logic diagram. This includes the inputs, settings, fixed
logic, and the output operands generated (abbreviations used on scheme logic diagrams are defined in Appendix F).
Some settings for current and voltage elements are specified in per-unit (pu) calculated quantities:
pu quantity = (actual quantity) / (base quantity)
For current elements, the base quantity is the nominal secondary or primary current of the CT.
Where the current source is the sum of two CTs with different ratios, the base quantity will be the common secondary or
primary current to which the sum is scaled (that is, normalized to the larger of the two rated CT inputs). For example, if CT1
= 300 / 5 A and CT2 = 100 / 5 A, then in order to sum these, CT2 is scaled to the CT1 ratio. In this case, the base quantity
will be 5 A secondary or 300 A primary.
For voltage elements the base quantity is the nominal primary voltage of the protected system which corresponds (based
on VT ratio and connection) to secondary VT voltage applied to the relay.
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with 14400:120 V Delta-connected VTs, the secondary nominal voltage (1 pu) would be:
13800
---------------- 120 = 115 V
14400
(EQ 5.1)
For Wye-connected VTs, the secondary nominal voltage (1 pu) would be:
13800
---------------- 120
---------- = 66.4 V
14400
3
(EQ 5.2)
Many settings are common to most elements and are discussed below:
FUNCTION setting: This setting programs the element to be operational when selected as Enabled. The factory
default is Disabled. Once programmed to Enabled, any element associated with the Function becomes active and
all options become available.
SOURCE setting: This setting is used to select the parameter or set of parameters to be monitored.
PICKUP setting: For simple elements, this setting is used to program the level of the measured parameter above or
below which the pickup state is established. In more complex elements, a set of settings may be provided to define the
range of the measured parameters which will cause the element to pickup.
PICKUP DELAY setting: This setting sets a time-delay-on-pickup, or on-delay, for the duration between the Pickup
and Operate output states.
RESET DELAY setting: This setting is used to set a time-delay-on-dropout, or off-delay, for the duration between the
Operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input transits outside the defined pickup range.
BLOCK setting: The default output operand state of all comparators is a logic 0 or flag not set. The comparator
remains in this default state until a logic 1 is asserted at the RUN input, allowing the test to be performed. If the RUN
input changes to logic 0 at any time, the comparator returns to the default state. The RUN input is used to supervise
the comparator. The BLOCK input is used as one of the inputs to RUN control.
5-4
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.1 OVERVIEW
TARGET setting: This setting is used to define the operation of an element target message. When set to Disabled, no
target message or illumination of a faceplate LED indicator is issued upon operation of the element. When set to SelfReset, the target message and LED indication follow the Operate state of the element, and self-resets once the operate element condition clears. When set to Latched, the target message and LED indication will remain visible after the
element output returns to logic 0 - until a RESET command is received by the relay.
EVENTS setting: This setting is used to control whether the Pickup, Dropout or Operate states are recorded by the
event recorder. When set to Disabled, element pickup, dropout or operate are not recorded as events. When set to
Enabled, events are created for:
(Element) PKP (pickup)
(Element) DPO (dropout)
(Element) OP (operate)
The DPO event is created when the measure and decide comparator output transits from the pickup state (logic 1) to
the dropout state (logic 0). This could happen when the element is in the operate state if the reset delay time is not 0.
5.1.3 INTRODUCTION TO AC SOURCES
a) BACKGROUND
The D60 may be used on systems with breaker-and-a-half or ring bus configurations. In these applications, each of the two
three-phase sets of individual phase currents (one associated with each breaker) can be used as an input to a breaker failure element. The sum of both breaker phase currents and 3I_0 residual currents may be required for the circuit relaying
and metering functions. For a three-winding transformer application, it may be required to calculate watts and vars for each
of three windings, using voltage from different sets of VTs. These requirements can be satisfied with a single UR, equipped
with sufficient CT and VT input channels, by selecting the parameter to measure. A mechanism is provided to specify the
AC parameter (or group of parameters) used as the input to protection/control comparators and some metering elements.
Selection of the parameter(s) to measure is partially performed by the design of a measuring element or protection/control
comparator by identifying the type of parameter (fundamental frequency phasor, harmonic phasor, symmetrical component,
total waveform RMS magnitude, phase-phase or phase-ground voltage, etc.) to measure. The user completes the process
by selecting the instrument transformer input channels to use and some of the parameters calculated from these channels.
The input parameters available include the summation of currents from multiple input channels. For the summed currents of
phase, 3I_0, and ground current, current from CTs with different ratios are adjusted to a single ratio before summation.
A mechanism called a Source configures the routing of CT and VT input channels to measurement sub-systems.
Sources, in the context of UR series relays, refer to the logical grouping of current and voltage signals such that one source
contains all the signals required to measure the load or fault in a particular power apparatus. A given source may contain all
or some of the following signals: three-phase currents, single-phase ground current, three-phase voltages and an auxiliary
voltage from a single VT for checking for synchronism.
To illustrate the concept of Sources, as applied to current inputs only, consider the breaker-and-a-half scheme below. In this
application, the current flows as shown by the arrows. Some current flows through the upper bus bar to some other location
or power equipment, and some current flows into transformer Winding 1. The current into Winding 1 is the phasor sum (or
difference) of the currents in CT1 and CT2 (whether the sum or difference is used depends on the relative polarity of the CT
connections). The same considerations apply to transformer Winding 2. The protection elements require access to the net
current for transformer protection, but some elements may need access to the individual currents from CT1 and CT2.
GE Multilin
5-5
5.1 OVERVIEW
5 SETTINGS
CT1
through current
CT2
Winding 1
current
UR-series
relay
Winding 1
Power
transformer
Winding 2
CT3
CT4
827791A3.CDR
A major advantage of using internal summation is that the individual currents are available to the protection device; for
example, as additional information to calculate a restraint current, or to allow the provision of additional protection features
that operate on the individual currents such as breaker failure.
Given the flexibility of this approach, it becomes necessary to add configuration settings to the platform to allow the user to
select which sets of CT inputs will be added to form the net current into the protected device.
The internal grouping of current and voltage signals forms an internal source. This source can be given a specific name
through the settings, and becomes available to protection and metering elements in the UR platform. Individual names can
be given to each source to help identify them more clearly for later use. For example, in the scheme shown in the above
diagram, the configures one Source to be the sum of CT1 and CT2 and can name this Source as Wdg 1 Current.
Once the sources have been configured, the user has them available as selections for the choice of input signal for the protection elements and as metered quantities.
b) CT/VT MODULE CONFIGURATION
CT and VT input channels are contained in CT/VT modules. The type of input channel can be phase/neutral/other voltage,
phase/ground current, or sensitive ground current. The CT/VT modules calculate total waveform RMS levels, fundamental
frequency phasors, symmetrical components and harmonics for voltage or current, as allowed by the hardware in each
channel. These modules may calculate other parameters as directed by the CPU module.
A CT/VT module contains up to eight input channels, numbered 1 through 8. The channel numbering corresponds to the
module terminal numbering 1 through 8 and is arranged as follows: Channels 1, 2, 3 and 4 are always provided as a group,
hereafter called a bank, and all four are either current or voltage, as are channels 5, 6, 7 and 8. Channels 1, 2, 3 and 5, 6,
7 are arranged as phase A, B and C respectively. Channels 4 and 8 are either another current or voltage.
Banks are ordered sequentially from the block of lower-numbered channels to the block of higher-numbered channels, and
from the CT/VT module with the lowest slot position letter to the module with the highest slot position letter, as follows:
INCREASING SLOT POSITION LETTER -->
CT/VT MODULE 1
CT/VT MODULE 2
CT/VT MODULE 3
5-6
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.1 OVERVIEW
The UR platform allows for a maximum of three sets of three-phase voltages and six sets of three-phase currents. The
result of these restrictions leads to the maximum number of CT/VT modules in a chassis to three. The maximum number of
sources is six. A summary of CT/VT module configurations is shown below.
ITEM
MAXIMUM NUMBER
CT/VT Module
GE Multilin
5-7
5 SETTINGS
5.2PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
MESSAGE
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
The command and setting passwords are defaulted to Null when the relay is shipped from the factory. When a password
is set to Null, the password security feature is disabled.
The D60 supports password entry from a local or remote connection.
Local access is defined as any access to settings or commands via the faceplate interface. This includes both keypad entry
and the faceplate RS232 connection. Remote access is defined as any access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any changes to the local or remote passwords
enables this functionality.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the D60, the remote password must be used. If the connection
is to the RS232 port of the faceplate, the local password must be used.
The local password settings are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP PASSWORD SECURITY CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS
CHANGE COMMAND
PASSWORD: No
MESSAGE
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
MESSAGE
ENCRYPTED COMMAND
PASSWORD: ----------
Range: 0 to 9999999999
Note: ---------- indicates no password
MESSAGE
ENCRYPTED SETTING
PASSWORD: ----------
Range: 0 to 9999999999
Note: ---------- indicates no password
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
Programming a password code is required to enable each access level. A password consists of 1 to 10 numerical characters. When a CHANGE ... PASSWORD setting is set to "Yes", the following message sequence is invoked:
1.
5-8
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
2.
3.
To gain write access to a "Restricted" setting, set ACCESS LEVEL to "Setting" and then change the setting, or attempt to
change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the password is correctly entered, access
will be allowed. If no keys are pressed for longer than 30 minutes or control power is cycled, accessibility will automatically
revert to the "Restricted" level.
If an entered password is lost (or forgotten), consult the factory with the corresponding ENCRYPTED PASSWORD.
In the event that an incorrect Command or Setting password has been entered via the faceplate interface three times within
a three-minute time span, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand will be set to On and the D60 will not allow
Settings or Command access via the faceplate interface for the next ten minutes. The TOO MANY ATTEMPTS BLOCKED
FOR 10 MIN! flash message will appear upon activation of the ten minute timeout or any other time a user attempts any
change to the defined tier during the ten minute timeout. The LOCAL ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand will be set to
Off after the expiration of the ten-minute timeout.
In the event that an incorrect Command or Setting password has been entered via the any external communications interface three times within a three-minute time span, the REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand will be set to On and
the D60 will not allow Settings or Command access via the any external communications interface for the next ten minutes.
The REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand will be set to Off after the expiration of the ten-minute timeout.
The D60 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. Should password verification fail while accessing
a password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic operand is
asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature can be
used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
The UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS RESET UNAUTHORIZED
ALARMS command. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, the command level should be password-protected.
The operand does not generate events or targets. If these are required, the operand can be assigned to a digital element
programmed with event logs and/or targets enabled.
If the SETTING and COMMAND passwords are identical, this one password allows access to both commands
and settings.
NOTE
NOTE
When EnerVista UR Setup is used to access a particular level, the user will continue to have access to that
level as long as there are open windows in the EnerVista UR Setup software. To re-establish the Password
Security feature, all windows must be closed for at least 30 minutes.
GE Multilin
5-9
5 SETTINGS
5.2.2 DISPLAY PROPERTIES
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
LANGUAGE:
English
MESSAGE
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 1.0 s
MESSAGE
DEFAULT MESSAGE
TIMEOUT: 300 s
MESSAGE
DEFAULT MESSAGE
INTENSITY: 25 %
MESSAGE
SCREEN SAVER
FEATURE: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CURRENT CUT-OFF
LEVEL: 0.020 pu
MESSAGE
VOLTAGE CUT-OFF
LEVEL: 1.0 V
Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the display properties settings.
LANGUAGE: This setting selects the language used to display settings, actual values, and targets. The range is
dependent on the order code of the relay.
FLASH MESSAGE TIME: Flash messages are status, warning, error, or information messages displayed for several
seconds in response to certain key presses during setting programming. These messages override any normal messages. The duration of a flash message on the display can be changed to accommodate different reading rates.
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT: If the keypad is inactive for a period of time, the relay automatically reverts to a
default message. The inactivity time is modified via this setting to ensure messages remain on the screen long enough
during programming or reading of actual values.
DEFAULT MESSAGE INTENSITY: To extend phosphor life in the vacuum fluorescent display, the brightness can be
attenuated during default message display. During keypad interrogation, the display always operates at full brightness.
SCREEN SAVER FEATURE and SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME: These settings are only visible if the D60 has a liquid
crystal display (LCD) and control its backlighting. When the SCREEN SAVER FEATURE is Enabled, the LCD backlighting
is turned off after the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT followed by the SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME, providing that no keys
have been pressed and no target messages are active. When a keypress occurs or a target becomes active, the LCD
backlighting is turned on.
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the current cut-off threshold. Very low currents (1 to 2% of the
rated value) are very susceptible to noise. Some customers prefer very low currents to display as zero, while others
prefer the current be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The D60 applies a cutoff value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured currents. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This applies to phase and ground current phasors as well as true RMS values and symmetrical components. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by
communications protocols. Note that the cut-off level for the sensitive ground input is 10 times lower that the CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value. Raw current samples available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.
VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the voltage cut-off threshold. Very low secondary voltage measurements (at the fractional volt level) can be affected by noise. Some customers prefer these low voltages to be displayed
as zero, while others prefer the voltage to be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The D60 applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured voltages. If the magnitude is below
the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This operation applies to phase and auxiliary voltages, and symmetrical
5-10
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
components. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those
used by communications protocols. Raw samples of the voltages available via oscillography are not subject cut-off.
The CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are used to determine the metered power cut-off levels. The
power cut-off level is calculated as shown below. For Delta connections:
3 CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL VT primary CT primary
3-phase power cut-off = ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------VT secondary
(EQ 5.3)
(EQ 5.4)
(EQ 5.5)
We have:
NOTE
Lower the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL and CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL with care as the relay accepts lower signals
as valid measurements. Unless dictated otherwise by a specific application, the default settings of 0.02
pu for CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and 1.0 V for VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are recommended.
GE Multilin
5-11
5 SETTINGS
5.2.3 CLEAR RELAY RECORDS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY?
No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CLEAR ENERGY:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CLEAR RELAY
RECORDS
Selected records can be cleared from user-programmable conditions with FlexLogic operands. Assigning user-programmable pushbuttons to clear specific records are typical applications for these commands. Since the D60 responds to rising
edges of the configured FlexLogic operands, they must be asserted for at least 50 ms to take effect.
Clearing records with user-programmable operands is not protected by the command password. However, user-programmable pushbuttons are protected by the command password. Thus, if they are used to clear records, the user-programmable pushbuttons can provide extra security if required.
For example, to assign User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 to clear demand records, the following settings should be
applied.
1.
Assign the clear demand function to Pushbutton 1 by making the following change in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS menu:
CLEAR DEMAND: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
2.
Set the properties for User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
menu:
5-12
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
COMMUNICATIONS
SERIAL PORTS
See below.
MESSAGE
NETWORK
MESSAGE
MODBUS PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
DNP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
DNP / IEC104
POINT LISTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
WEB SERVER
HTTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
TFTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
IEC 60870-5-104
PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
SNTP PROTOCOL
b) SERIAL PORTS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SERIAL PORTS
SERIAL PORTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The D60 is equipped with up to three independent serial communication ports. The faceplate RS232 port is intended for
local use and is fixed at 19200 baud and no parity. The rear COM1 port type is selected when ordering: either an Ethernet
or RS485 port. The rear COM2 port is RS485. The RS485 ports have settings for baud rate and parity. It is important that
these parameters agree with the settings used on the computer or other equipment that is connected to these ports. Any of
these ports may be connected to a computer running EnerVista UR Setup. This software can download and upload setting
files, view measured parameters, and upgrade the relay firmware. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained and connected to a DCS, PLC or PC using the RS485 ports.
GE Multilin
5-13
NOTE
5 SETTINGS
For each RS485 port, the minimum time before the port will transmit after receiving data from a host can be
set. This feature allows operation with hosts which hold the RS485 transmitter active for some time after
each transmission.
c) NETWORK
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
IP ADDRESS:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
SUBNET IP MASK:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
GATEWAY IP ADDRESS:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
OSI NETWORK
ADDRESS (NSAP)
MESSAGE
ETHERNET OPERATION
MODE: Full-Duplex
NETWORK
These messages appear only if the D60 is ordered with an Ethernet card.
The IP addresses are used with the DNP, Modbus/TCP, IEC 61580, IEC 60870-5-104, TFTP, and HTTP protocols. The
NSAP address is used with the IEC 61850 protocol over the OSI (CLNP/TP4) stack only. Each network protocol has a setting for the TCP/UDP port number. These settings are used only in advanced network configurations and should normally
be left at their default values, but may be changed if required (for example, to allow access to multiple UR-series relays
behind a router). By setting a different TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER for a given protocol on each UR-series relay, the router can
map the relays to the same external IP address. The client software (EnerVista UR Setup, for example) must be configured
to use the correct port number if these settings are used.
When the NSAP address, any TCP/UDP port number, or any user map setting (when used with DNP) is changed, it
will not become active until power to the relay has been cycled (off-on).
NOTE
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER, as this will result in unreliable operation of those protocols.
WARNING
d) MODBUS PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL
MODBUS PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
MODBUS SLAVE
ADDRESS: 254
The serial communication ports utilize the Modbus protocol, unless configured for DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 operation (see
descriptions below). This allows the EnerVista UR Setup software to be used. The UR operates as a Modbus slave device
only. When using Modbus protocol on the RS232 port, the D60 will respond regardless of the MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS programmed. For the RS485 ports each D60 must have a unique address from 1 to 254. Address 0 is the broadcast address
which all Modbus slave devices listen to. Addresses do not have to be sequential, but no two devices can have the same
address or conflicts resulting in errors will occur. Generally, each device added to the link should use the next higher
address starting at 1. Refer to Appendix B for more information on the Modbus protocol.
Changes to the MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER setting will not take effect until the D60 is restarted.
NOTE
5-14
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
e) DNP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL
DNP CHANNELS
MESSAGE
DNP ADDRESS:
65519
MESSAGE
DNP NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 60 s in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP PF SCALE
FACTOR: 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP PF DEFAULT
DEADBAND: 30000
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP PROTOCOL
GE Multilin
5-15
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 1
DEFAULT VARIATION: 2
Range: 1, 2
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 2
DEFAULT VARIATION: 2
Range: 1, 2
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 20
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 5, 6
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 21
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 9, 10
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 22
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 5, 6
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 23
DEFAULT VARIATION: 2
Range: 1, 2, 5, 6
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 30
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 32
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 32 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
The D60 supports the Distributed Network Protocol (DNP) version 3.0. The D60 can be used as a DNP slave device connected to multiple DNP masters (usually an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the D60 maintains two sets of DNP
data change buffers and connection information, two DNP masters can actively communicate with the D60 at one time.
NOTE
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols cannot be simultaneously. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNCTION setting is set to Enabled, the DNP protocol will not be operational. When this setting is changed it will not
become active until power to the relay has been cycled (off-to-on).
DNP CHANNELS
The DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT settings select the communications port assigned to the DNP protocol for each channel. Once
DNP is assigned to a serial port, the Modbus protocol is disabled on that port. Note that COM1 can be used only in nonEthernet UR relays. When this setting is set to Network - TCP, the DNP protocol can be used over TCP/IP on channels 1
or 2. When this value is set to Network - UDP, the DNP protocol can be used over UDP/IP on channel 1 only. Refer to
Appendix E for additional information on the DNP protocol.
Changes to the DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT settings will take effect only after power has been cycled to the relay.
NOTE
The DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS settings can force the D60 to respond to a maximum of five specific DNP masters. The
settings in this sub-menu are shown below.
5-16
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESSES
CLIENT ADDRESS 1:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 2:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 3:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 4:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 5:
0.0.0.0
DNP NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE FUNCTION should be Disabled for RS485 applications since there is no collision avoidance
mechanism. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE TIMEOUT sets the time the D60 waits for a DNP master to confirm an unsolicited
response. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE MAX RETRIES setting determines the number of times the D60 retransmits an unsolicited response without receiving confirmation from the master; a value of 255 allows infinite re-tries. The DNP UNSOL
RESPONSE DEST ADDRESS is the DNP address to which all unsolicited responses are sent. The IP address to which unsolicited responses are sent is determined by the D60 from the current TCP connection or the most recent UDP message.
The DNP scale factor settings are numbers used to scale analog input point values. These settings group the D60 analog
input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other. Each setting represents the
scale factor for all analog input points of that type. For example, if the DNP VOLTAGE SCALE FACTOR setting is set to 1000,
all DNP analog input points that are voltages will be returned with values 1000 times smaller (for example, a value of 72000
V on the D60 will be returned as 72). These settings are useful when analog input values must be adjusted to fit within certain ranges in DNP masters. Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (that is, the value will be 10
times larger).
The DNP DEFAULT DEADBAND settings determine when to trigger unsolicited responses containing analog input data. These
settings group the D60 analog input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other.
Each setting represents the default deadband value for all analog input points of that type. For example, to trigger unsolicited responses from the D60 when any current values change by 15 A, the DNP CURRENT DEFAULT DEADBAND setting
should be set to 15. Note that these settings are the deadband default values. DNP object 34 points can be used to
change deadband values, from the default, for each individual DNP analog input point. Whenever power is removed and
re-applied to the D60, the default deadbands will be in effect.
The DNP TIME SYNC IIN PERIOD setting determines how often the Need Time Internal Indication (IIN) bit is set by the D60.
Changing this time allows the DNP master to send time synchronization commands more or less often, as required.
The DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT SIZE setting determines the size, in bytes, at which message fragmentation occurs. Large
fragment sizes allow for more efficient throughput; smaller fragment sizes cause more application layer confirmations to be
necessary which can provide for more robust data transfer over noisy communication channels.
NOTE
When the DNP data points (analog inputs and/or binary inputs) are configured for Ethernet-enabled relays,
check the DNP Points Lists D60 web page to view the points lists. This page can be viewed with a web
browser by entering the D60 IP address to access the D60 Main Menu, then by selecting the Device
Information Menu > DNP Points Lists menu item.
The DNP OBJECT 1(32) DEFAULT VARIATION settings allow the user to select the DNP default variation number for object types
1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32. The default variation refers to the variation response when variation 0 is requested and/or
in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. Refer to the DNP Implementation section in Appendix E for additional details.
The DNP binary outputs typically map one-to-one to IED data points. That is, each DNP binary output controls a single
physical or virtual control point in an IED. In the D60 relay, DNP binary outputs are mapped to virtual inputs. However, some
legacy DNP implementations use a mapping of one DNP binary output to two physical or virtual control points to support
the concept of trip/close (for circuit breakers) or raise/lower (for tap changers) using a single control point. That is, the DNP
master can operate a single point for both trip and close, or raise and lower, operations. The D60 can be configured to support paired control points, with each paired control point operating two virtual inputs. The DNP NUMBER OF PAIRED CONTROL
POINTS setting allows configuration of from 0 to 32 binary output paired controls. Points not configured as paired operate on
a one-to-one basis.
GE Multilin
5-17
5 SETTINGS
The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the D60 on a DNP communications link. Each
DNP slave should be assigned a unique address.
The DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting specifies a time delay for the detection of dead network TCP connections. If
there is no data traffic on a DNP TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection will be
aborted by the D60. This frees up the connection to be re-used by a client.
Relay power must be re-cycled after changing the DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting for the changes to take
effect.
NOTE
DNP / IEC104
POINT LISTS
MESSAGE
The binary and analog inputs points for the DNP protocol, or the MSP and MME points for IEC 60870-5-104 protocol, can
configured to a maximum of 256 points. The value for each point is user-programmable and can be configured by assigning
FlexLogic operands for binary inputs / MSP points or FlexAnalog parameters for analog inputs / MME points.
The menu for the binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS
Point:
Off
Point:
Off
MESSAGE
Point:
Off
255
Up to 256 binary input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The points are configured by
assigning an appropriate FlexLogic operand. Refer to the Introduction to FlexLogic section in this chapter for the full
range of assignable operands.
The menu for the analog input points (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS ANALOG INPUT / MME POINTS
Point:
Off
Point:
Off
MESSAGE
Point:
Off
255
Up to 256 analog input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The analog point list is configured by assigning an appropriate FlexAnalog parameter to each point. Refer to Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters for the
full range of assignable parameters.
NOTE
5-18
The DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists always begin with point 0 and end at the first Off value. Since DNP /
IEC 60870-5-104 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points assigned after the first Off point
are ignored.
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists will not take effect until the D60 is restarted.
NOTE
GSSE / GOOSE
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
SERVER
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MMXU DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
GGIO1 STATUS
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GGIO2 CONTROL
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
REPORT CONTROL
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
XCBR
CONFIGURATION
The D60 Line Distance Protection System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability.
This feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. Refer to the Ordering section of chapter 2 for additional details. The IEC 61850 protocol features are not available if CPU Type E is ordered.
The D60 supports the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) protocol as specified by IEC 61850. MMS is supported
over two protocol stacks: TCP/IP over ethernet and TP4/CLNP (OSI) over ethernet. The D60 operates as an IEC 61850
server. The Remote Inputs/Outputs section in this chapter describe the peer-to-peer GSSE/GOOSE message scheme.
The GSSE/GOOSE configuration main menu is divided into two areas: transmission and reception.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
GSSE / GOOSE
CONFIGURATION
TRANSMISSION
MESSAGE
RECEPTION
GE Multilin
5-19
5 SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE... TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
GENERAL
MESSAGE
GSSE
MESSAGE
FIXED GOOSE
MESSAGE
CONFIGURABLE
GOOSE
GENERAL
DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE
UPDATE TIME: 60 s
Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1
The DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE UPDATE TIME sets the time between GSSE or GOOSE messages when there are no remote output state changes to be sent. When remote output data changes, GSSE or GOOSE messages are sent immediately. This
setting controls the steady-state heartbeat time interval.
The DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE UPDATE TIME setting is applicable to GSSE, fixed D60 GOOSE, and configurable GOOSE.
The GSSE settings are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850... GSSE/GOOSE... TRANSMISSION GSEE
GSSE FUNCTION:
Enabled
MESSAGE
GSSE ID:
GSSEOut
MESSAGE
DESTINATION MAC:
000000000000
GSSE
These settings are applicable to GSSE only. If the fixed GOOSE function is enabled, GSSE messages are not transmitted.
The GSSE ID setting represents the IEC 61850 GSSE application ID name string sent as part of each GSSE message. This
string identifies the GSSE message to the receiving device. In D60 releases previous to 5.0x, this name string was represented by the RELAY NAME setting.
The fixed GOOSE settings are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT... COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850... GSSE/GOOSE... TRANSMISSION FIXED GOOSE
GOOSE FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
GOOSE ID:
GOOSEOut
MESSAGE
DESTINATION MAC:
000000000000
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 7 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
FIXED GOOSE
5-20
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CONFIG GSE 1
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
VLAN PRIORITY: 4
Range: 0 to 7 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
VLAN ID:
0
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
ETYPE APPID:
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
CONFREV:
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
DATASET ITEMS
CONFIGURABLE
GOOSE 1
The configurable GOOSE settings allow the D60 to be configured to transmit a number of different datasets within IEC
61850 GOOSE messages. Up to eight different configurable datasets can be configured and transmitted. This is useful for
intercommunication between D60 IEDs and devices from other manufacturers that support IEC 61850.
The configurable GOOSE feature allows for the configuration of the datasets to be transmitted or received from the D60.
The D60 supports the configuration of eight (8) transmission and reception datasets, allowing for the optimization of data
transfer between devices.
Items programmed for dataset 1 will have changes in their status transmitted as soon as the change is detected. Dataset 1
should be used for high-speed transmission of data that is required for applications such as transfer tripping, blocking, and
breaker fail initiate. At least one digital status value needs to be configured in dataset 1 to enable transmission of all data
configured for dataset 1. Configuring analog data only to dataset 1 will not activate transmission.
Items programmed for datasets 2 through 8 will have changes in their status transmitted at a maximum rate of every
100 ms. Datasets 2 through 8 will regularly analyze each data item configured within them every 100 ms to identify if any
changes have been made. If any changes in the data items are detected, these changes will be transmitted through a
GOOSE message. If there are no changes detected during this 100 ms period, no GOOSE message will be sent.
For all datasets 1 through 8, the integrity GOOSE message will still continue to be sent at the pre-configured rate even if no
changes in the data items are detected.
The GOOSE functionality was enhanced to prevent the relay from flooding a communications network with GOOSE messages due to an oscillation being created that is triggering a message.
GE Multilin
5-21
5 SETTINGS
The D60 has the ability of detecting if a data item in one of the GOOSE datasets is erroneously oscillating. This can be
caused by events such as errors in logic programming, inputs improperly being asserted and de-asserted, or failed station
components. If erroneously oscillation is detected, the D60 will stop sending GOOSE messages from the dataset for a minimum period of one second. Should the oscillation persist after the one second time-out period, the D60 will continue to
block transmission of the dataset. The D60 will assert the MAINTENANCE ALERT: GGIO Ind XXX oscill self-test error message on the front panel display, where XXX denotes the data item detected as oscillating.
The configurable GOOSE feature is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers. Fixed GOOSE is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data
transfer between UR-series IEDs.
IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging contains a number of configurable parameters, all of which must be correct to achieve the
successful transfer of data. It is critical that the configured datasets at the transmission and reception devices are an exact
match in terms of data structure, and that the GOOSE addresses and name strings match exactly. Manual configuration is
possible, but third-party substation configuration software may be used to automate the process. The EnerVista UR Setupsoftware can produce IEC 61850 ICD files and import IEC 61850 SCD files produced by a substation configurator (refer to
the IEC 61850 IED configuration section later in this appendix).
The following example illustrates the configuration required to transfer IEC 61850 data items between two devices. The
general steps required for transmission configuration are:
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
This example shows how to configure the transmission and reception of three IEC 61850 data items: a single point status
value, its associated quality flags, and a floating point analog value.
The following procedure illustrates the transmission configuration.
1.
Configure the transmission dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO1 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO1 status indication 1.
The transmission dataset now contains a set of quality flags and a single point status Boolean value. The reception
dataset on the receiving device must exactly match this structure.
2.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1 settings menu:
Set CONFIG GSE 1 ID to an appropriate descriptive string (the default value is GOOSEOut_1).
Set CONFIG GSE 1 DST MAC to a multicast address (for example, 01 00 00 12 34 56).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN PRIORITY; the default value of 4 is OK for this example.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN ID value; the default value is 0, but some switches may require this value to be 1.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 ETYPE APPID value. This setting represents the Ethertype application ID and must match the
configuration on the receiver (the default value is 0).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 CONFREV value. This value changes automatically as described in IEC 61850 part 7-2. For
this example it can be left at its default value.
5-22
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
3.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC 61850 PROTOsettings menu:
Set GGIO1 INDICATION 1 to a FlexLogic operand used to provide the status of GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal (for example,
a contact input, virtual input, a protection element status, etc.).
The D60 must be rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The following procedure illustrates the reception configuration.
1.
Configure the reception dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC
61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO3 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO3 status indication 1.
The reception dataset now contains a set of quality flags, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog value. This matches the transmission dataset configuration above.
2.
3.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 settings menu:
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID to match the GOOSE ID string for the transmitting device. Enter GOOSEOut_1.
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID to match the Ethertype application ID from the transmitting device. This is 0 in
the example above.
Set the REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET value. This value represents the dataset number in use. Since we are using
configurable GOOSE 1 in this example, program this value as GOOSEIn 1.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE INPUTS REMOTE INPUT 1
settings menu:
Set REMOTE IN 1 ITEM to Dataset Item 2. This assigns the value of the GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal single point status
item to remote input 1.
Remote input 1 can now be used in FlexLogic equations or other settings. The D60 must be rebooted (control power
removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of remote input 1 (Boolean on or off) in the receiving device will be determined by the GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal value
in the sending device. The above settings will be automatically populated by the EnerVista UR Setup software when a complete SCD file is created by third party substation configurator software.
For intercommunication between D60 IEDs, the fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset can be used. The DNA/UserSt dataset contains the same DNA and UserSt bit pairs that are included in GSSE messages. All GOOSE messages transmitted by the
D60 (DNA/UserSt dataset and configurable datasets) use the IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging services (for example, VLAN
support).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 FUNCTION function to Disabled when configuration changes are required. Once changes are
entered, return the CONFIG GSE 1 FUNCTION to Enabled and restart the unit for changes to take effect.
NOTE
PATH:...TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(8) CONIFIG GSE 1(64) DATA TIMES ITEM 1(64)
CONFIG GSE 1
DATASET ITEMS
ITEM 1:
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
To create a configurable GOOSE dataset that contains an IEC 61850 Single Point Status indication and its associated quality flags, the following dataset items can be selected: GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal and GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q. The D60 will then create a dataset containing these two data items. The status value for GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal is determined by the FlexLogic
operand assigned to GGIO1 indication 1. Changes to this operand will result in the transmission of GOOSE messages containing the defined dataset.
GE Multilin
5-23
5 SETTINGS
The main reception menu is applicable to configurable GOOSE only and contains the configurable GOOSE dataset items
for reception:
PATH:...RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(8) CONIFIG GSE 1(64) DATA ITEMS
CONFIG GSE 1
DATASET ITEMS
ITEM 1:
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
The configurable GOOSE settings allow the D60 to be configured to receive a number of different datasets within IEC
61850 GOOSE messages. Up to eight different configurable datasets can be configured for reception. This is useful for
intercommunication between D60 IEDs and devices from other manufacturers that support IEC 61850.
For intercommunication between D60 IEDs, the fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset can be used. The DNA/UserSt dataset contains the same DNA and UserSt bit pairs that are included in GSSE messages.
To set up a D60 to receive a configurable GOOSE dataset that contains two IEC 61850 single point status indications, the
following dataset items can be selected (for example, for configurable GOOSE dataset 1): GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal and
GGIO3.ST.Ind2.stVal. The D60 will then create a dataset containing these two data items. The Boolean status values from
these data items can be utilized as remote input FlexLogic operands. First, the REMOTE DEVICE 1(16) DATASET setting
must be set to contain dataset GOOSEIn 1 (that is, the first configurable dataset). Then REMOTE IN 1(16) ITEM settings
must be set to Dataset Item 1 and Dataset Item 2. These remote input FlexLogic operands will then change state in
accordance with the status values of the data items in the configured dataset.
Floating point analog values originating from MMXU logical nodes may be included in GOOSE datasets. Deadband (noninstantaneous) values can be transmitted. Received values are used to populate the GGIO3.XM.AnIn1... items. Received
values are also available as FlexAnalog parameters (GOOSE Analog In1...).
The main menu for the IEC 61850 server configuration is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL SERVER CONFIGURATION
LD INST: LDInst
LOCATION: Location
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
INCLUDE NON-IEC
DATA: Enabled
MESSAGE
SERVER SCANNING:
Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SERVER
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The IED NAME and LD INST settings represent the MMS domain name (IEC 61850 logical device) where all IEC/MMS logical
nodes are located. Valid characters for these values are upper and lowercase letters, numbers, and the underscore (_)
character, and the first character in the string must be a letter. This conforms to the IEC 61850 standard. The LOCATION is a
variable string and can be composed of ASCII characters. This string appears within the PhyName of the LPHD node.
The IEC/MMS TCP PORT NUMBER setting allows the user to change the TCP port number for MMS connections. The INCLUDE
NON-IEC DATA setting determines whether or not the UR MMS domain will be available. This domain contains a large number of UR-series specific data items that are not available in the IEC 61850 logical nodes. This data does not follow the IEC
61850 naming conventions. For communications schemes that strictly follow the IEC 61850 standard, this setting should be
Disabled.
5-24
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The SERVER SCANNING feature should be set to Disabled when IEC 61850 client/server functionality is not required. IEC
61850 has two modes of functionality: GOOSE/GSSE inter-device communication and client/server communication. If the
GOOSE/GSSE functionality is required without the IEC 61850 client server feature, then server scanning can be disabled
to increase CPU resources. When server scanning is disabled, there will be not updated to the IEC 61850 logical node status values in the D60. Clients will still be able to connect to the server (D60 relay), but most data values will not be updated.
This setting does not affect GOOSE/GSSE operation.
Changes to the IED NAME setting, LD INST setting, and GOOSE dataset will not take effect until the D60 is restarted.
NOTE
The CLEAR XCBR1(2) OpCnt settings represent the breaker operating counters. As breakers operate by opening and closing,
the XCBR operating counter status attribute (OpCnt) increments with every operation. Frequent breaker operation may
result in very large OpCnt values over time. This setting allows the OpCnt to be reset to 0 for XCBR1 and XCBR2.
The main menu for the IEC 61850 logical node name prefixes is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850... IEC 61850 LOGICAL NODE NAME PREFIXES
MESSAGE
The IEC 61850 logical node name prefix settings are used to create name prefixes to uniquely identify each logical node.
For example, the logical node PTOC1 may have the name prefix abc. The full logical node name will then be
abcMMXU1. Valid characters for the logical node name prefixes are upper and lowercase letters, numbers, and the
underscore (_) character, and the first character in the prefix must be a letter. This conforms to the IEC 61850 standard.
Changes to the logical node prefixes will not take effect until the D60 is restarted.
The main menu for the IEC 61850 MMXU deadbands is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL MMXU DEADBANDS
MMXU DEADBANDS
MMXU1 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU2 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU3 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU4 DEADBANDS
The MMXU deadband settings represent the deadband values used to determine when the update the MMXU mag and
cVal values from the associated instmag and instcVal values. The mag and cVal values are used for the IEC 61850
buffered and unbuffered reports. These settings correspond to the associated db data items in the CF functional constraint of the MMXU logical node, as per the IEC 61850 standard. According to IEC 61850-7-3, the db value shall represent the percentage of difference between the maximum and minimum in units of 0.001%. Thus, it is important to know the
maximum value for each MMXU measured quantity, since this represents the 100.00% value for the deadband.
The minimum value for all quantities is 0; the maximum values are as follows:
GE Multilin
5-25
5 SETTINGS
power (real, reactive, and apparent): 46 phase CT primary setting 275 VT ratio setting
frequency: 90 Hz
power factor: 2
GGIO1 STATUS
CONFIGURATION
NUMBER OF STATUS
POINTS IN GGIO1: 8
MESSAGE
GGIO1 INDICATION
Off
MESSAGE
GGIO1 INDICATION
Off
MESSAGE
The NUMBER OF STATUS POINTS IN GGIO1 setting determines the number of Ind (single point status indications) that are
instantiated in the GGIO1 logical node. Changes to the NUMBER OF STATUS POINTS IN GGIO1 setting will not take effect until
the D60 is restarted.
The GGIO2 control configuration points are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850... GGIO2 CONTROL... GGIO2 CF SPSCO 1(64)
GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1
Range: 0, 1, 2
GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1
CTLMODEL: 1
The GGIO2 control configuration settings are used to set the control model for each input. The available choices are 0
(status only), 1 (direct control), and 2 (SBO with normal security). The GGIO2 control points are used to control the D60
virtual inputs.
The GGIO4 analog configuration points are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850... GGIO4 ANALOG CONFIGURATION
GGIO4 ANALOG
CONFIGURATION
NUMBER OF ANALOG
POINTS IN GGIO4:
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 1
MEASURED VALUE
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 2
MEASURED VALUE
Range: 4 to 32 in steps of 4
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 32
MEASURED VALUE
The NUMBER OF ANALOG POINTS setting determines how many analog data points will exist in GGIO4. When this value is
changed, the D60 must be rebooted in order to allow the GGIO4 logical node to be re-instantiated and contain the newly
configured number of analog points.
5-26
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The measured value settings for each of the 32 analog values are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT... COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850... GGIO4... GGIO4 ANALOG 1(32) MEASURED VALUE
ANALOG IN
Off
1 VALUE:
MESSAGE
ANALOG IN
0.000
1 DB:
MESSAGE
ANALOG IN
0.000
1 MIN:
MESSAGE
ANALOG IN
0.000
1 MAX:
GGIO4 ANALOG 1
MEASURED VALUE
ANALOG IN 1(32) VALUE: This setting selects the FlexAnalog value to drive the instantaneous value of each GGIO4
analog status value (GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.instMag.f).
ANALOG IN 1(32) DB: This setting specifies the deadband for each analog value. Refer to IEC 61850-7-1 and 618507-3 for details. The deadband is used to determine when to update the deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous
magnitude. The deadband is a percentage of the difference between the maximum and minimum values.
ANALOG IN 1(32) MIN: This setting specifies the minimum value for each analog value. Refer to IEC 61850-7-1 and
61850-7-3 for details. This minimum value is used to determine the deadband. The deadband is used in the determination of the deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous magnitude.
ANALOG IN 1(32) MAX: This setting defines the maximum value for each analog value. Refer to IEC 61850-7-1 and
61850-7-3 for details. This maximum value is used to determine the deadband. The deadband is used in the determination of the deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous magnitude.
NOTE
Note that the ANALOG IN 1(32) MIN and ANALOG IN 1(32) MAX settings are stored as IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating
point numbers. Because of the large range of these settings, not all values can be stored. Some values may be
rounded to the closest possible floating point number.
REPORT 1
RptID:
MESSAGE
REPORT 1
OptFlds:
MESSAGE
REPORT 1
BufTm:
MESSAGE
REPORT 1
TrgOps:
MESSAGE
REPORT 1
IntgPd:
REPORT 1
CONFIGURATION
0
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
0
Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
0
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Changes to the report configuration will not take effect until the D60 is restarted.
The breaker configuration settings are shown below. Changes to these values will not take effect until the UR is restarted:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL XCBR CONFIGURATION
XCBR
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
5-27
NOTE
5 SETTINGS
Since GSSE/GOOSE messages are multicast Ethernet by specification, they will not usually be forwarded by network routers. However, GOOSE messages may be fowarded by routers if the router has been configured for VLAN
functionality.
WEB SERVER
HTTP PROTOCOL
The D60 contains an embedded web server and is capable of transferring web pages to a web browser such as Microsoft
Internet Explorer or Netscape Navigator. This feature is available only if the D60 has the ethernet option installed. The web
pages are organized as a series of menus that can be accessed starting at the D60 Main Menu. Web pages are available
showing DNP and IEC 60870-5-104 points lists, Modbus registers, Event Records, Fault Reports, etc. The web pages can
be accessed by connecting the UR and a computer to an ethernet network. The Main Menu will be displayed in the web
browser on the computer simply by entering the IP address of the D60 into the Address box on the web browser.
i) TFTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS TFTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
TFTP PROTOCOL
The Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) can be used to transfer files from the D60 over a network. The D60 operates as a
TFTP server. TFTP client software is available from various sources, including Microsoft Windows NT. The dir.txt file
obtained from the D60 contains a list and description of all available files (event records, oscillography, etc.).
5-28
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
IEC 60870-5-104
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
IEC NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
IEC 60870-5-104
PROTOCOL
The D60 supports the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. The D60 can be used as an IEC 60870-5-104 slave device connected to
a maximum of two masters (usually either an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the D60 maintains two sets of IEC
60870-5-104 data change buffers, no more than two masters should actively communicate with the D60 at one time.
The IEC ------- DEFAULT THRESHOLD settings are used to determine when to trigger spontaneous responses containing
M_ME_NC_1 analog data. These settings group the D60 analog data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other.
Each setting represents the default threshold value for all M_ME_NC_1 analog points of that type. For example, to trigger
spontaneous responses from the D60 when any current values change by 15 A, the IEC CURRENT DEFAULT THRESHOLD setting should be set to 15. Note that these settings are the default values of the deadbands. P_ME_NC_1 (parameter of measured value, short floating point value) points can be used to change threshold values, from the default, for each individual
M_ME_NC_1 analog point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the D60, the default thresholds will be in effect.
NOTE
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols cannot be simultaneously. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNCTION setting is set to Enabled, the DNP protocol will not be operational. When this setting is changed it will not
become active until power to the relay has been cycled (off-to-on).
k) SNTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SNTP PROTOCOL
SNTP FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SNTP PROTOCOL
The D60 supports the Simple Network Time Protocol specified in RFC-2030. With SNTP, the D60 can obtain clock time
over an Ethernet network. The D60 acts as an SNTP client to receive time values from an SNTP/NTP server, usually a dedicated product using a GPS receiver to provide an accurate time. Both unicast and broadcast SNTP are supported.
GE Multilin
5-29
5 SETTINGS
If SNTP functionality is enabled at the same time as IRIG-B, the IRIG-B signal provides the time value to the D60 clock for
as long as a valid signal is present. If the IRIG-B signal is removed, the time obtained from the SNTP server is used. If
either SNTP or IRIG-B is enabled, the D60 clock value cannot be changed using the front panel keypad.
To use SNTP in unicast mode, SNTP SERVER IP ADDR must be set to the SNTP/NTP server IP address. Once this address is
set and SNTP FUNCTION is Enabled, the D60 attempts to obtain time values from the SNTP/NTP server. Since many time
values are obtained and averaged, it generally takes three to four minutes until the D60 clock is closely synchronized with
the SNTP/NTP server. It may take up to two minutes for the D60 to signal an SNTP self-test error if the server is offline.
To use SNTP in broadcast mode, set the SNTP SERVER IP ADDR setting to 0.0.0.0 and SNTP FUNCTION to Enabled. The
D60 then listens to SNTP messages sent to the all ones broadcast address for the subnet. The D60 waits up to eighteen
minutes (>1024 seconds) without receiving an SNTP broadcast message before signaling an SNTP self-test error.
The UR-series relays do not support the multicast or anycast SNTP functionality.
5.2.5 MODBUS USER MAP
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP MODBUS USER MAP
MESSAGE
ADDRESS
VALUE:
1:
0
ADDRESS
VALUE:
2:
0
MESSAGE
ADDRESS 256:
VALUE:
0
The Modbus User Map provides read-only access for up to 256 registers. To obtain a memory map value, enter the desired
address in the ADDRESS line (this value must be converted from hex to decimal format). The corresponding value is displayed in the VALUE line. A value of 0 in subsequent register ADDRESS lines automatically returns values for the previous
ADDRESS lines incremented by 1. An address value of 0 in the initial register means none and values of 0 will be displayed for all registers. Different ADDRESS values can be entered as required in any of the register positions.
5-30
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS
TIME: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
REAL TIME
CLOCK
The date and time can be synchronized a known time base and to other relays using an IRIG-B signal. It has the same
accuracy as an electronic watch, approximately 1 minute per month. If an IRIG-B signal is connected to the relay, only the
current year needs to be entered. See the COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME menu to manually set the relay clock.
The REAL TIME CLOCK EVENTS setting allows changes to the date and/or time to be captured in the event record.
The LOCAL TIME OFFSET FROM UTC setting is used to specify the local time zone offset from Universal Coordinated Time
(Greenwich Mean Time) in hours. This setting has two uses. When the D60 is time synchronized with IRIG-B, or has no
permanent time synchronization, the offset is used to calculate UTC time for IEC 61850 features. When the D60 is time
synchronized with SNTP, the offset is used to determine the local time for the D60 clock, since SNTP provides UTC time.
The daylight savings time (DST) settings can be used to allow the D60 clock can follow the DST rules of the local time
zone. Note that when IRIG-B time synchronization is active, the DST settings are ignored. The DST settings are used when
the D60 is synchronized with SNTP, or when neither SNTP nor IRIG-B is used.
GE Multilin
5-31
5 SETTINGS
5.2.7 FAULT REPORTS
FAULT REPORT 1
SOURCE: SRC 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
MAG: 3.00
MESSAGE
FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
ANGLE: 75
Range: 25 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0
MAG: 9.00
MESSAGE
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0
ANGLE: 75
Range: 25 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
FAULT REPORT 1 VT
SUBSTITUTION: None
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 25 to 90 in steps of 1
FAULT REPORT 1
The D60 relay supports one fault report and an associated fault locator. The signal source and trigger condition, as well as
the characteristics of the line or feeder, are entered in this menu.
The fault report stores data, in non-volatile memory, pertinent to an event when triggered. The captured data contained in
the FaultReport.txt file includes:
Pre-fault current and voltage phasors (two cycles before either a 50DD disturbance associated with fault report source
or the trigger operate)
Fault current and voltage phasors (one cycle after the trigger)
Events: 9 before trigger and 7 after trigger (only available via the relay webpage)
Fault duration times for each breaker (created by the breaker arcing current feature)
5-32
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The captured data also includes the fault type and the distance to the fault location, as well as the reclose shot number
(when applicable) To include fault duration times in the fault report, the user must enable and configure breaker arcing current feature for each of the breakers. Fault duration is reported on a per-phase basis.
The relay allows locating faults, including ground faults, from delta-connected VTs. In this case, the missing zero-sequence
voltage is substituted either by the externally provided neutral voltage (broken delta VT) connected to the auxiliary voltage
channel of a VT bank, or by the zero-sequence voltage approximated as a voltage drop developed by the zero-sequence
current, and user-provided zero-sequence equivalent impedance of the system behind the relay.
The trigger can be any FlexLogic operand, but in most applications it is expected to be the same operand, usually a virtual output, that is used to drive an output relay to trip a breaker. To prevent the overwriting of fault events, the disturbance
detector should not be used to trigger a fault report. A FAULT RPT TRIG event is automatically created when the report is
triggered.
If a number of protection elements are ORed to create a fault report trigger, the first operation of any element causing the
OR gate output to become high triggers a fault report. However, If other elements operate during the fault and the first operated element has not been reset (the OR gate output is still high), the fault report is not triggered again. Considering the
reset time of protection elements, there is very little chance that fault report can be triggered twice in this manner. As the
fault report must capture a usable amount of pre and post-fault data, it can not be triggered faster than every 20 ms.
Each fault report is stored as a file; the relay capacity is fifteen (15) files. An sixteenth (16th) trigger overwrites the oldest
file.
The EnerVista UR Setup software is required to view all captured data. The relay faceplate display can be used to view the
date and time of trigger, the fault type, the distance location of the fault, and the reclose shot number.
The FAULT REPORT 1 SOURCE setting selects the source for input currents and voltages and disturbance detection. The
FAULT 1 REPORT TRIG setting assigns the FlexLogic operand representing the protection element/elements requiring operational fault location calculations. The distance to fault calculations are initiated by this signal. The FAULT REPORT 1 Z1 MAG
and FAULT REPORT 1 Z0 MAG impedances are entered in secondary ohms.
The FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting shall be set to None if the relay is fed from wye-connected VTs. If delta-connected VTs are used, and the relay is supplied with the neutral (3V0) voltage, this setting shall be set to V0. The method is
still exact, as the fault locator would combine the line-to-line voltage measurements with the neutral voltage measurement
to re-create the line-to-ground voltages. See the ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS FAULT REPORTS menu for additional
details. It required to configure the delta and neutral voltages under the source indicated as input for the fault report. Also,
the relay will check if the auxiliary signal configured is marked as Vn by the user (under VT setup), and inhibit the fault
location if the auxiliary signal is labeled differently.
If the broken-delta neutral voltage is not available to the relay, an approximation is possible by assuming the missing zerosequence voltage to be an inverted voltage drop produced by the zero-sequence current and the user-specified equivalent
zero-sequence system impedance behind the relay: V0 = Z0 I0. In order to enable this mode of operation, the FAULT
REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting shall be set to I0.
The FAULT REP 1 SYSTEM Z0 MAG and FAULT REP 1 SYSTEM Z0 ANGLE settings are used only when the VT SUBSTITUTION setting value is I0. The magnitude is to be entered in secondary ohms. This impedance is an average system equivalent
behind the relay. It can be calculated as zero-sequence Thevenin impedance at the local bus with the protected line/feeder
disconnected. The method is accurate only if this setting matches perfectly the actual system impedance during the fault. If
the system exhibits too much variability, this approach is questionable and the fault location results for single-line-to-ground
faults shall be trusted with accordingly. It should be kept in mind that grounding points in vicinity of the installation impact
the system zero-sequence impedance (grounded loads, reactors, zig-zag transformers, shunt capacitor banks, etc.).
GE Multilin
5-33
5 SETTINGS
5.2.8 OSCILLOGRAPHY
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY
NUMBER OF RECORDS:
15
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
TRIGGER MODE:
Automatic Overwrite
MESSAGE
TRIGGER POSITION:
50%
MESSAGE
TRIGGER SOURCE:
Off
MESSAGE
AC INPUT WAVEFORMS:
16 samples/cycle
MESSAGE
DIGITAL CHANNELS
MESSAGE
ANALOG CHANNELS
OSCILLOGRAPHY
Oscillography records contain waveforms captured at the sampling rate as well as other relay data at the point of trigger.
Oscillography records are triggered by a programmable FlexLogic operand. Multiple oscillography records may be captured simultaneously.
The NUMBER OF RECORDS is selectable, but the number of cycles captured in a single record varies considerably based on
other factors such as sample rate and the number of operational modules. There is a fixed amount of data storage for oscillography; the more data captured, the less the number of cycles captured per record. See the ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY menu to view the number of cycles captured per record. The following table provides sample configurations with corresponding cycles/record.
Table 51: OSCILLOGRAPHY CYCLES/RECORD EXAMPLE
# RECORDS
# CT/VTS
SAMPLE
RATE
# DIGITALS
# ANALOGS
CYCLES/
RECORD
1872.0
16
16
1685.0
16
16
276.0
16
16
219.5
16
16
93.5
16
64
16
93.5
32
64
16
57.6
64
64
16
32.3
32
64
64
16
9.5
A new record may automatically overwrite an older record if TRIGGER MODE is set to Automatic Overwrite.
Set the TRIGGER POSITION to a percentage of the total buffer size (e.g. 10%, 50%, 75%, etc.). A trigger position of 25% consists of 25% pre- and 75% post-trigger data. The TRIGGER SOURCE is always captured in oscillography and may be any
FlexLogic parameter (element state, contact input, virtual output, etc.). The relay sampling rate is 64 samples per cycle.
The AC INPUT WAVEFORMS setting determines the sampling rate at which AC input signals (i.e. current and voltage) are
stored. Reducing the sampling rate allows longer records to be stored. This setting has no effect on the internal sampling
rate of the relay which is always 64 samples per cycle, i.e. it has no effect on the fundamental calculations of the device.
When changes are made to the oscillography settings, all existing oscillography records will be CLEARED.
WARNING
5-34
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
b) DIGITAL CHANNELS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY DIGITAL CHANNELS
DIGITAL CHANNELS
MESSAGE
DIGITAL CHANNEL
Off
1:
DIGITAL CHANNEL
Off
2:
MESSAGE
A DIGITAL 1(63) CHANNEL setting selects the FlexLogic operand state recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of
each oscillography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to Off are ignored.
Upon startup, the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list.
c) ANALOG CHANNELS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY ANALOG CHANNELS
ANALOG CHANNELS
MESSAGE
ANALOG CHANNEL
Off
1:
ANALOG CHANNEL
Off
2:
MESSAGE
An ANALOG 1(16) CHANNEL setting selects the metering actual value recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each
oscillography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to Off are ignored. The
parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: (a) the type of relay, (b) the type and number of CT/VT hardware
modules installed, and (c) the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup, the relay will
automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is presented in
Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to expedite the
selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list of parameters via the
relay keypad/display - entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding parameter to be displayed.
All eight CT/VT module channels are stored in the oscillography file. The CT/VT module channels are named as follows:
<slot_letter><terminal_number><I or V><phase A, B, or C, or 4th input>
The fourth current input in a bank is called IG, and the fourth voltage input in a bank is called VX. For example, F2-IB designates the IB signal on Terminal 2 of the CT/VT module in slot F. If there are no CT/VT modules and analog input modules,
no analog traces will appear in the file; only the digital traces will appear.
GE Multilin
5-35
5 SETTINGS
5.2.9 DATA LOGGER
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
1:
MESSAGE
2:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DATA LOGGER
The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a user-defined sampling rate. This recorded data may
be downloaded to EnerVista UR Setup and displayed with parameters on the vertical axis and time on the horizontal axis.
All data is stored in non-volatile memory, meaning that the information is retained when power to the relay is lost.
For a fixed sampling rate, the data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period or a larger number of
channels for a shorter period. The relay automatically partitions the available memory between the channels in use. Example storage capacities for a system frequency of 60 Hz are shown in the following table.
Table 52: DATA LOGGER STORAGE CAPACITY EXAMPLE
SAMPLING RATE
CHANNELS
DAYS
STORAGE CAPACITY
15 ms
0.1
954 s
0.1
120 s
0.1
107 s
16
0.1
60 s
0.7
65457 s
0.1
8182 s
0.1
7273 s
16
0.1
4091 s
45.4
3927420 s
5.6
490920 s
436380 s
16
2.8
254460 s
2727.5
235645200 s
340.9
29455200 s
303
26182800 s
1000 ms
60000 ms
3600000 ms
Changing any setting affecting data logger operation will clear any data that is currently in the log.
NOTE
DATA LOGGER MODE: This setting configures the mode in which the data logger will operate. When set to Continuous, the data logger will actively record any configured channels at the rate as defined by the DATA LOGGER RATE. The
5-36
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
data logger will be idle in this mode if no channels are configured. When set to Trigger, the data logger will begin to
record any configured channels at the instance of the rising edge of the DATA LOGGER TRIGGER source FlexLogic
operand. The Data Logger will ignore all subsequent triggers and will continue to record data until the active record is
full. Once the data logger is full a CLEAR DATA LOGGER command is required to clear the data logger record before a
new record can be started. Performing the CLEAR DATA LOGGER command will also stop the current record and reset
the data logger to be ready for the next trigger.
DATA LOGGER TRIGGER: This setting selects the signal used to trigger the start of a new data logger record. Any
FlexLogic operand can be used as the trigger source. The DATA LOGGER TRIGGER setting only applies when the
mode is set to Trigger.
DATA LOGGER RATE: This setting selects the time interval at which the actual value data will be recorded.
DATA LOGGER CHNL 1(16): This setting selects the metering actual value that is to be recorded in Channel 1(16) of
the data log. The parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: the type of relay, the type and number of CT/
VT hardware modules installed, and the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup,
the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is
shown in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to
expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list of
parameters via the relay keypad/display entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding
parameter to be displayed.
DATA LOGGER CONFIG: This display presents the total amount of time the Data Logger can record the channels not
selected to Off without over-writing old data.
5.2.10 USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
a) MAIN MENU
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LEDS
LED TEST
See below
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED1
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED2
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED48
b) LED TEST
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST
LED TEST
MESSAGE
When enabled, the LED Test can be initiated from any digital input or user-programmable condition such as user-programmable pushbutton. The control operand is configured under the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The test covers all LEDs,
including the LEDs of the optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
The test consists of three stages.
Stage 1: All 62 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is burned. This stage
lasts as long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of 1 minute. After 1 minute, the test will end.
GE Multilin
5-37
5 SETTINGS
Stage 2: All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on for 1 second, then back off. The test routine
starts at the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom of each LED column. This test checks for hardware failures
that lead to more than one LED being turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
Stage 3: All the LEDs are turned on. One LED at a time turns off for 1 second, then back on. The test routine starts at
the top left panel moving from top to bottom of each column of the LEDs. This test checks for hardware failures that
lead to more than one LED being turned off from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
When testing is in progress, the LEDs are controlled by the test sequence, rather than the protection, control, and monitoring features. However, the LED control mechanism accepts all the changes to LED states generated by the relay and
stores the actual LED states (On or Off) in memory. When the test completes, the LEDs reflect the actual state resulting
from relay response during testing. The Reset pushbutton will not clear any targets when the LED Test is in progress.
A dedicated FlexLogic operand, LED TEST IN PROGRESS, is set for the duration of the test. When the test sequence is initiated, the LED Test Initiated event is stored in the Event Recorder.
The entire test procedure is user-controlled. In particular, Stage 1 can last as long as necessary, and Stages 2 and 3 can be
interrupted. The test responds to the position and rising edges of the control input defined by the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The control pulses must last at least 250 ms to take effect. The following diagram explains how the test is executed.
READY TO TEST
Reset the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
Set the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
control input is on
STAGE 1
(all LEDs on)
time-out
(1 minute)
STAGE 2
(one LED on at a time)
Wait 1 second
STAGE 3
(one LED off at a time)
rising edge
of the control
input
842011A1.CDR
5-38
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Configure the LED test to recognize User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST menu:
LED TEST FUNCTION: Enabled
LED TEST CONTROL: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
The test will be initiated when the User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 is pressed. The pushbutton should remain pressed for
as long as the LEDs are being visually inspected. When finished, the pushbutton should be released. The relay will then
automatically start Stage 2. At this point forward, test may be aborted by pressing the pushbutton.
APPLICATION EXAMPLE 2:
Assume one needs to check if any LEDs are burned as well as exercise one LED at a time to check for other failures. This
is to be performed via User-Programmable Pushbutton 1.
After applying the settings in Application Example 1, hold down the pushbutton as long as necessary to test all LEDs. Next,
release the pushbutton to automatically start Stage 2. Once Stage 2 has started, the pushbutton can be released. When
Stage 2 is completed, Stage 3 will automatically start. The test may be aborted at any time by pressing the pushbutton.
c) TRIP AND ALARM LEDS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS TRIP & ALARM LEDS
MESSAGE
The Trip and Alarm LEDs are in the first LED column (enhanced faceplate) and on LED panel 1 (standard faceplate). Each
indicator can be programmed to become illuminated when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
d) USER-PROGRAMMABLE LED 1(48)
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS USER-PROGRAMMABLE LED 1(48)
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED 1
MESSAGE
LED 1 OPERAND:
Off
LED 1 TYPE:
Self-Reset
There are 48 amber LEDs across the relay faceplate LED panels. Each of these indicators can be programmed to illuminate when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
For the standard faceplate, the LEDs are located as follows.
Refer to the LED indicators section in chapter 4 for additional information on the location of these indexed LEDs.
The user-programmable LED settings select the FlexLogic operands that control the LEDs. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is
Self-Reset (the default setting), the LED illumination will track the state of the selected LED operand. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is Latched, the LED, once lit, remains so until reset by the faceplate RESET button, from a remote device via a communications channel, or from any programmed operand, even if the LED operand state de-asserts.
GE Multilin
5-39
5 SETTINGS
PARAMETER
SETTING
PARAMETER
LED 1 Operand
LED 13 Operand
Off
LED 2 Operand
LED 14 Operand
BREAKER 2 OPEN
LED 3 Operand
LED 15 Operand
BREAKER 2 CLOSED
LED 4 Operand
LED 16 Operand
BREAKER 2 TROUBLE
LED 5 Operand
LED 17 Operand
SYNC 1 SYNC OP
LED 6 Operand
LED 18 Operand
SYNC 2 SYNC OP
LED 7 Operand
Off
LED 19 Operand
Off
LED 8 Operand
Off
LED 20 Operand
Off
LED 9 Operand
BREAKER 1 OPEN
LED 21 Operand
AR ENABLED
LED 10 Operand
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
LED 22 Operand
AR DISABLED
LED 11 Operand
BREAKER 1 TROUBLE
LED 23 Operand
AR RIP
LED 12 Operand
Off
LED 24 Operand
AR LO
Refer to the Control of setting groups example in the Control elements section of this chapter for group activation.
5.2.11 USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF-TESTS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF TESTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BATTERY FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
SNTP FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
IRIG-B FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
SELF TESTS
All major self-test alarms are reported automatically with their corresponding FlexLogic operands, events, and targets.
Most of the Minor Alarms can be disabled if desired.
When in the Disabled mode, minor alarms will not assert a FlexLogic operand, write to the event recorder, or display
target messages. Moreover, they will not trigger the ANY MINOR ALARM or ANY SELF-TEST messages. When in the Enabled
mode, minor alarms continue to function along with other major and minor alarms. Refer to the Relay Self-Tests section in
Chapter 7 for additional information on major and minor self-test alarms.
5-40
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTON 1
MESSAGE
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1
EVENTS: Disabled
There are three standard control pushbuttons, labeled USER 1, USER 2, and USER 3, on the standard and enhanced front
panels. These are user-programmable and can be used for various applications such as performing an LED test, switching
setting groups, and invoking and scrolling though user-programmable displays, etc.
Firmware revisions 3.2x and older use these three pushbuttons for manual breaker control. This functionality has been
retained if the breaker control feature is configured to use the three pushbuttons, they cannot be used as user-programmable control pushbuttons.
The location of the control pushbuttons are shown in the following figures.
Control pushbuttons
842813A1.CDR
EVENT CAUSE
IN SERVICE
VOLTAGE
TROUBLE
CURRENT
TEST MODE
FREQUENCY
TRIP
OTHER
ALARM
PHASE A
PICKUP
PHASE B
RESET
USER 1
USER 2
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND
USER 3
THREE
STANDARD
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
USER 4
USER 5
USER 6
USER 7
FOUR EXTRA
OPTIONAL
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
842733A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-41
5 SETTINGS
The control pushbuttons become user-programmable only if the breaker control feature is not configured for manual control
via the USER 1 through 3 pushbuttons as shown below. If configured for manual control, breaker control typically uses the
larger, optional user-programmable pushbuttons, making the control pushbuttons available for other user applications.
When applicable
SETTING
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON
1 FUNCTION:
Enabled=1
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 1/
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
Enabled=1
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 2/
BREAKER 2 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
AND
RUN
OFF
ON
TIMER
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
100 msec
CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
842010A2.CDR
Enabled=1
PUSHBUTTON 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT:
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT:
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 SET:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST:
Disabled
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST
DELAY: 1.0 s
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT
TIME: 0.00 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE:
Disabled
MESSAGE
PUSHBUTTON 1
EVENTS: Disabled
USER PUSHBUTTON 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
5-42
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The optional user-programmable pushbuttons (specified in the order code) provide an easy and error-free method of entering digital state (on, off) information. The number of available pushbuttons is dependent on the faceplate module ordered
with the relay.
The digital state can be entered locally (by directly pressing the front panel pushbutton) or remotely (via FlexLogic operands) into FlexLogic equations, protection elements, and control elements. Typical applications include breaker control,
autorecloser blocking, and setting groups changes. The user-programmable pushbuttons are under the Control level of
password protection.
The user-configurable pushbuttons for the enhanced faceplate are shown below.
USER
LABEL 1
USER
LABEL 2
USER
LABEL 3
USER
LABEL 4
USER
LABEL 5
USER
LABEL 6
USER
LABEL 7
USER
LABEL 8
USER
LABEL 9
USER
LABEL 10
USER
LABEL 11
USER
LABEL 12
USER
LABEL 13
USER
LABEL 14
USER
LABEL 15
USER
LABEL 16
842814A1.CDR
11
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
10
12
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
842779A1.CDR
Latched mode: In latched mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting or by directly pressing the associated front panel pushbutton. The pushbutton maintains the set state
until deactivated by the reset command or after a user-specified time delay. The state of each pushbutton is stored in
non-volatile memory and maintained through a loss of control power.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in latched mode by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 RESET setting or by directly pressing the associated active front panel pushbutton.
GE Multilin
5-43
5 SETTINGS
It can also be programmed to reset automatically through the PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST and PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY settings. These settings enable the autoreset timer and specify the associated time delay. The autoreset timer can be
used in select-before-operate (SBO) breaker control applications, where the command type (close/open) or breaker
location (feeder number) must be selected prior to command execution. The selection must reset automatically if control is not executed within a specified time period.
Self-reset mode: In self-reset mode, a pushbutton will remain active for the time it is pressed (the pulse duration) plus
the dropout time specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting. If the pushbutton is activated via FlexLogic, the
pulse duration is specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME only. The time the operand remains assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting has no effect on the pulse duration.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in self-reset mode when the dropout delay specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT
setting expires.
TIME
NOTE
The pulse duration of the remote set, remote reset, or local pushbutton must be at least 50 ms to operate the pushbutton. This allows the user-programmable pushbuttons to properly operate during power cycling events and various system disturbances that may cause transient assertion of the operating signals.
The local and remote operation of each user-programmable pushbutton can be inhibited through the PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL and
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE settings, respectively. If local locking is applied, the pushbutton will ignore set and reset commands
executed through the front panel pushbuttons. If remote locking is applied, the pushbutton will ignore set and reset commands executed through FlexLogic operands.
The locking functions are not applied to the autorestart feature. In this case, the inhibit function can be used in SBO control
operations to prevent the pushbutton function from being activated and ensuring one-at-a-time select operation.
The locking functions can also be used to prevent the accidental pressing of the front panel pushbuttons. The separate
inhibit of the local and remote operation simplifies the implementation of local/remote control supervision.
Pushbutton states can be logged by the event recorder and displayed as target messages. In latched mode, user-defined
messages can also be associated with each pushbutton and displayed when the pushbutton is on or changing to off.
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: This setting selects the characteristic of the pushbutton. If set to Disabled, the pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both On and Off) are de-asserted. If set to SelfReset, the control logic is activated by the pulse (longer than 100 ms) issued when the pushbutton is being physically
pressed or virtually pressed via a FlexLogic operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting.
When in Self-Reset mode and activated locally, the pushbutton control logic asserts the On corresponding FlexLogic operand as long as the pushbutton is being physically pressed, and after being released the deactivation of
the operand is delayed by the drop out timer. The Off operand is asserted when the pushbutton element is deactivated. If the pushbutton is activated remotely, the control logic of the pushbutton asserts the corresponding On FlexLogic operand only for the time period specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting.
If set to Latched, the control logic alternates the state of the corresponding FlexLogic operand between On and
Off on each button press or by virtually activating the pushbutton (assigning set and reset operands). When in the
Latched mode, the states of the FlexLogic operands are stored in a non-volatile memory. Should the power supply
be lost, the correct state of the pushbutton is retained upon subsequent power up of the relay.
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT: This setting specifies the top 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
intended to provide ID information of the pushbutton. Refer to the User-definable displays section for instructions on
how to enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is in the on position. Refer to the User-definable displays section for instructions on
entering alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is activated from the on to the off position and the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is
Latched. This message is not displayed when the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is Self-reset as the pushbutton operand
status is implied to be Off upon its release. The length of the Off message is configured with the PRODUCT SETUP
DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
PUSHBTN 1 SET: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to operate the pushbutton element and to
assert PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand. The duration of the incoming set signal must be at least 100 ms.
5-44
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PUSHBTN 1 RESET: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to reset pushbutton element and to assert
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF operand. This setting is applicable only if pushbutton is in latched mode. The duration of the
incoming reset signal must be at least 50 ms.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST: This setting enables the user-programmable pushbutton autoreset feature. This setting is
applicable only if the pushbutton is in the Latched mode.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY: This setting specifies the time delay for automatic reset of the pushbutton when in
the latched mode.
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit pushbutton operation from the
operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET or PUSHBTN 1 RESET settings.
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit pushbutton operation from the
front panel pushbuttons. This locking functionality is not applicable to pushbutton autoreset.
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: This setting applies only to Self-Reset mode and specifies the duration of the pushbutton active status after the pushbutton has been released. This setting is required to set the duration of the pushbutton operating pulse.
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to drive pushbutton LED. If this setting is
Off, then LED operation is directly linked to PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand.
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE: If pushbutton message is set to High Priority, the message programmed in the PUSHBTN 1
and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT settings will be displayed undisturbed as long as PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is asserted.
The high priority option is not applicable to the PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT setting.
ID
This message can be temporary removed if any front panel keypad button is pressed. However, ten seconds of keypad
inactivity will restore the message if the PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is still active.
If the PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE is set to Normal, the message programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT
settings will be displayed as long as PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is asserted, but not longer than time period specified
by FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. After the flash time is expired, the default message or other active target message is
displayed. The instantaneous reset of the flash message will be executed if any relay front panel button is pressed or
any new target or message becomes active.
The PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT setting is linked to PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF operand and will be displayed in
PUSHBTN 1 ID only if pushbutton element is in the Latched mode. The PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT message
as Normal if the PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE setting is High Priority or Normal.
conjunction with
will be displayed
PUSHBUTTON 1 EVENTS: If this setting is enabled, each pushbutton state change will be logged as an event into
event recorder.
GE Multilin
5-45
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
0
msec
SETTING
PUSHBUTTON 1
FUNCTION
Disabled
Latched
SETTING
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME
OR
SETTING
LCD MESSAGE
AND
Self-Reset
t RST
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL
ENGAGE MESSAGE
SETTING
Non Volatile Latch
AND
SETTING
AND
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE
Off (FlexLogic operand)
OR
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT
INSTANTANEOUS
RESET *
SET
XXXXXXXXXX
PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT
XXXXXXXXXX
LATCH
50
msec
RST
0
msec
OR
SETTING
AND
PUSHBTN 1 SET
50
msec
0
msec
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
SETTING
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
AND
PUSHBTN 1 RESET
Off (FlexLogic operand)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
OR
AND
Enabled
AND
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST
DELAY
Disabled
0
200
msec
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
0
msec
SETTING
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME
SETTING
AND
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT
PUSH
TIME
OR
OR
LCD MESSAGE
ENGAGE MESSAGE
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
t RST
SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT
t RST
INSTANTANEOUS
RESET *
XXXXXXXXXX
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT
XXXXXXXXXX
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 2 ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PKP
AND
OR
SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST
AND
SETTING
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE
ANY PB ON
Disable
PUSHBUTTON 3 ON
PUSHBUTTON 12 ON
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
2. IF PUSHBUTTON 1 LED CONTROL IS NOT SET TO OFF
High Priority
Normal
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
PB1
LED
ANY FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND
842021A1.DWG
NOTE
FLEX STATE
PARAMETERS
MESSAGE
PARAMETER
Off
1:
PARAMETER
Off
2:
PARAMETER 256:
Off
MESSAGE
5-46
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
This feature provides a mechanism where any of 256 selected FlexLogic operand states can be used for efficient monitoring. The feature allows user-customized access to the FlexLogic operand states in the relay. The state bits are packed
so that 16 states may be read out in a single Modbus register. The state bits can be configured so that all of the states
which are of interest to the user are available in a minimum number of Modbus registers.
The state bits may be read out in the Flex States register array beginning at Modbus address 0900h. Sixteen states are
packed into each register, with the lowest-numbered state in the lowest-order bit. There are sixteen registers to accommodate the 256 state bits.
5.2.15 USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
MESSAGE
USER DISPLAY
MESSAGE
USER DISPLAY
USER DISPLAY 16
USER-DEFINABLE
DISPLAYS
MESSAGE
This menu provides a mechanism for manually creating up to 16 user-defined information displays in a convenient viewing
sequence in the USER DISPLAYS menu (between the TARGETS and ACTUAL VALUES top-level menus). The sub-menus facilitate text entry and Modbus Register data pointer options for defining the User Display content.
Once programmed, the user-definable displays can be viewed in two ways.
KEYPAD: Use the Menu key to select the USER DISPLAYS menu item to access the first user-definable display (note
that only the programmed screens are displayed). The screens can be scrolled using the Up and Down keys. The display disappears after the default message time-out period specified by the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE CONTROL INPUT: The user-definable displays also respond to the INVOKE AND SCROLL
setting. Any FlexLogic operand (in particular, the user-programmable pushbutton operands), can be used to navigate the programmed displays.
On the rising edge of the configured operand (such as when the pushbutton is pressed), the displays are invoked by
showing the last user-definable display shown during the previous activity. From this moment onward, the operand
acts exactly as the Down key and allows scrolling through the configured displays. The last display wraps up to the first
one. The INVOKE AND SCROLL input and the Down keypad key operate concurrently.
When the default timer expires (set by the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting), the relay will start to cycle through the
user displays. The next activity of the INVOKE AND SCROLL input stops the cycling at the currently displayed user display, not at the first user-defined display. The INVOKE AND SCROLL pulses must last for at least 250 ms to take effect.
GE Multilin
5-47
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 1
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 2
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 3
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 4
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 5:
0
USER DISPLAY 1
MESSAGE
Any existing system display can be automatically copied into an available user display by selecting the existing display and
pressing the ENTER key. The display will then prompt ADD TO USER DISPLAY LIST?. After selecting Yes, a message indicates that the selected display has been added to the user display list. When this type of entry occurs, the sub-menus are
automatically configured with the proper content this content may subsequently be edited.
This menu is used to enter user-defined text and/or user-selected Modbus-registered data fields into the particular user
display. Each user display consists of two 20-character lines (top and bottom). The tilde (~) character is used to mark the
start of a data field - the length of the data field needs to be accounted for. Up to 5 separate data fields (ITEM 1(5)) can be
entered in a user display - the nth tilde (~) refers to the nth item.
A User Display may be entered from the faceplate keypad or the EnerVista UR Setup interface (preferred for convenience).
The following procedure shows how to enter text characters in the top and bottom lines from the faceplate keypad:
1.
2.
3.
Use either value key to scroll through the characters. A space is selected like a character.
4.
Press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
5.
Repeat step 3 and continue entering characters until the desired text is displayed.
6.
The HELP key may be pressed at any time for context sensitive help information.
7.
To enter a numerical value for any of the 5 items (the decimal form of the selected Modbus address) from the faceplate keypad, use the number keypad. Use the value of 0 for any items not being used. Use the HELP key at any selected system
display (setting, actual value, or command) which has a Modbus address, to view the hexadecimal form of the Modbus
address, then manually convert it to decimal form before entering it (EnerVista UR Setup usage conveniently facilitates this
conversion).
Use the MENU key to go to the user displays menu to view the user-defined content. The current user displays will show in
sequence, changing every 4 seconds. While viewing a user display, press the ENTER key and then select the Yes option
to remove the display from the user display list. Use the MENU key again to exit the user displays menu.
5-48
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 1:
6016
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 2:
6357
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 3:
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 4:
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 5:
0
USER DISPLAYS
Current X
Current Y
0.850 A
0.327 A
DIRECT OUTPUT
DEVICE ID: 1
Range: 1 to 16
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH1
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH2
DIRECT I/O
Direct inputs and outputs are intended for exchange of status information (inputs and outputs) between UR-series relays
connected directly via type 7 digital communications cards. The mechanism is very similar to IEC 61850 GSSE, except that
communications takes place over a non-switchable isolated network and is optimized for speed. On type 7 cards that support two channels, direct output messages are sent from both channels simultaneously. This effectively sends direct output
GE Multilin
5-49
5 SETTINGS
messages both ways around a ring configuration. On type 7 cards that support one channel, direct output messages are
sent only in one direction. Messages will be resent (forwarded) when it is determined that the message did not originate at
the receiver.
Direct output message timing is similar to GSSE message timing. Integrity messages (with no state changes) are sent at
least every 1000 ms. Messages with state changes are sent within the main pass scanning the inputs and asserting the
outputs unless the communication channel bandwidth has been exceeded. Two self-tests are performed and signaled by
the following FlexLogic operands:
1.
DIRECT RING BREAK (direct input/output ring break). This FlexLogic operand indicates that direct output messages
sent from a UR-series relay are not being received back by the relay.
2.
DIRECT DEVICE 1(16) OFF (direct device offline). This FlexLogic operand indicates that direct output messages from
at least one direct device are not being received.
Direct input and output settings are similar to remote input and output settings. The equivalent of the remote device name
strings for direct inputs and outputs is the DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID. The DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID identifies the relay in all
direct output messages. All UR-series IEDs in a ring should have unique numbers assigned. The IED ID is used to identify
the sender of the direct input/output message.
If the direct input/output scheme is configured to operate in a ring (DIRECT I/O RING CONFIGURATION: Yes), all direct output
messages should be received back. If not, the DIRECT INPUT/OUTPUT RING BREAK self-test is triggered. The self-test error
is signaled by the DIRECT RING BREAK FlexLogic operand.
Select the DIRECT I/O DATA RATE to match the data capabilities of the communications channel. All IEDs communicating
over direct inputs/outputs must be set to the same data rate. UR-series IEDs equipped with dual-channel communications
cards apply the same data rate to both channels. Delivery time for direct input/output messages is approximately 0.2 of a
power system cycle at 128 kbps and 0.4 of a power system cycle at 64 kbps, per each bridge.
5-50
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CHANNEL
74
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
7L
Channel 1
Channel 2
7M
Channel 1
Channel 2
7P
Channel 1
Channel 2
7T
Channel 1
7W
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 1
Channel 2
7V
2A
Channel 1
64 kHz
2B
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
76
Channel 1
64 kHz
77
Channel 1
64 kHz
75
7E
7F
7G
Channel 2
64 kHz
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
7R
Channel 1
64 kHz
7S
Channel 1
64 kHz
Channel 2
64 kHz
7Q
The G.703 modules are fixed at 64 kbps. The DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not applicable to these modules.
NOTE
The DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting applies to D60s with dual-channel communication cards and allows crossing
over messages from channel 1 to channel 2. This places all UR-series IEDs into one direct input/output network regardless
of the physical media of the two communication channels.
The following application examples illustrate the basic concepts for direct input/output configuration. Please refer to the
Inputs/Outputs section in this chapter for information on configuring FlexLogic operands (flags, bits) to be exchanged.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTENDING THE INPUT/OUTPUT CAPABILITIES OF A UR-SERIES RELAY
Consider an application that requires additional quantities of digital inputs and/or output contacts and/or lines of programmable logic that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series
IED, such as the C30, to satisfy the additional input/output and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are connected via single-channel digital communication cards as shown in the figure below.
GE Multilin
5-51
5 SETTINGS
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
842711A1.CDR
UR IED 2:
The message delivery time is about 0.2 of power cycle in both ways (at 128 kbps); i.e., from Device 1 to Device 2, and from
Device 2 to Device 1. Different communications cards can be selected by the user for this back-to-back connection (fiber,
G.703, or RS422).
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme could be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3, and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown below.
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
BLOCK
UR IED 4
UR IED 3
842712A1.CDR
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX2
RX1
TX2
TX2
RX2
UR IED 2
TX1
TX1
UR IED 4
RX2
TX2
TX2
RX1
RX2
UR IED 3
RX1
TX1
842716A1.CDR
5-52
UR IED 2:
Yes
Yes
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
UR IED 3:
UR IED 4:
Yes
Yes
Message delivery time is approximately 0.2 of power system cycle (at 128 kbps) times number of bridges between the origin and destination. Dual-ring configuration effectively reduces the maximum communications distance by a factor of two.
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps) if both rings are healthy:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle; IED 1 to IED 3: 0.4 of power system cycle;
IED 1 to IED 4: 0.2 of power system cycle; IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle;
IED 2 to IED 4: 0.4 of power system cycle; IED 3 to IED 4: 0.2 of power system cycle
If one ring is broken (say TX2/RX2) the delivery times are as follows:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle; IED 1 to IED 3: 0.4 of power system cycle;
IED 1 to IED 4: 0.6 of power system cycle; IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle;
IED 2 to IED 4: 0.4 of power system cycle; IED 3 to IED 4: 0.2 of power system cycle
A coordinating timer for this bus protection scheme could be selected to cover the worst case scenario (0.4 of power system cycle). Upon detecting a broken ring, the coordination time should be adaptively increased to 0.6 of power system
cycle. The complete application requires addressing a number of issues such as failure of both the communications rings,
failure or out-of-service conditions of one of the relays, etc. Self-monitoring flags of the direct inputs/outputs feature would
be primarily used to address these concerns.
EXAMPLE 3: PILOT-AIDED SCHEMES
Consider the three-terminal line protection application shown below:
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
UR IED 3
842713A1.CDR
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX2
UR IED 2
RX1
TX1
TX2
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR
Yes
UR IED 2:
"Yes"
Yes
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps):
GE Multilin
5-53
5 SETTINGS
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle; IED 1 to IED 3: 0.5 of power system cycle;
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
In the above scheme, IEDs 1 and 3 do not communicate directly. IED 2 must be configured to forward the messages as
explained in the Inputs/Outputs section. A blocking pilot-aided scheme should be implemented with more security and, ideally, faster message delivery time. This could be accomplished using a dual-ring configuration as shown below.
TX2
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX1
RX2
UR IED 2
RX2
TX2
TX1
TX1
RX1
UR IED 3
RX2
TX2
842715A1.CDR
Yes
UR IED 2:
"Yes"
Yes
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps) if both the rings are healthy:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle; IED 1 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle;
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle
The two communications configurations could be applied to both permissive and blocking schemes. Speed, reliability and
cost should be taken into account when selecting the required architecture.
b) CRC ALARM CH1(2)
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O CRC ALARM CH1(2)
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The D60 checks integrity of the incoming direct input/output messages using a 32-bit CRC. The CRC Alarm function is
available for monitoring the communication medium noise by tracking the rate of messages failing the CRC check. The
monitoring function counts all incoming messages, including messages that failed the CRC check. A separate counter adds
up messages that failed the CRC check. When the failed CRC counter reaches the user-defined level specified by the CRC
ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting within the user-defined message count CRC ALARM 1 CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 CRC ALARM
FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions - if required - should be programmed accordingly.
5-54
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The CRC Alarm function is available on a per-channel basis. The total number of direct input/output messages that failed
the CRC check is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS CRC FAIL COUNT CH1(2) actual value.
Message Count and Length of the Monitoring Window: To monitor communications integrity, the relay sends 1
message per second (at 64 kbps) or 2 messages per second (128 kbps) even if there is no change in the direct outputs. For example, setting the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT to 10000, corresponds a time window of about 160
minutes at 64 kbps and 80 minutes at 128 kbps. If the messages are sent faster as a result of direct outputs activity, the
monitoring time interval will shorten. This should be taken into account when determining the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting. For example, if the requirement is a maximum monitoring time interval of 10 minutes at 64 kbps, then
the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT should be set to 10 60 1 = 600.
Correlation of Failed CRC and Bit Error Rate (BER): The CRC check may fail if one or more bits in a packet are corrupted. Therefore, an exact correlation between the CRC fail rate and the BER is not possible. Under certain assumptions an approximation can be made as follows. A direct input/output packet containing 20 bytes results in 160 bits of
data being sent and therefore, a transmission of 63 packets is equivalent to 10,000 bits. A BER of 104 implies 1 bit
error for every 10,000 bits sent/received. Assuming the best case of only 1 bit error in a failed packet, having 1 failed
packet for every 63 received is about equal to a BER of 104.
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH1
The D60 checks integrity of the direct input/output communication ring by counting unreturned messages. In the ring configuration, all messages originating at a given device should return within a pre-defined period of time. The Unreturned
Messages Alarm function is available for monitoring the integrity of the communication ring by tracking the rate of unreturned messages. This function counts all the outgoing messages and a separate counter adds the messages have failed
to return. When the unreturned messages counter reaches the user-definable level specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM
CH1 THRESHOLD setting and within the user-defined message count UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 UNRET
ALM FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions, if required, should be programmed accordingly.
The Unreturned Messages Alarm function is available on a per-channel basis and is active only in the ring configuration.
The total number of unreturned input/output messages is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS
UNRETURNED MSG COUNT CH1(2) actual value.
GE Multilin
5-55
5 SETTINGS
5.2.17 TELEPROTECTION
TELEPROTECTION
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
NUMBER OF TERMINALS:
2
Range: 2, 3
MESSAGE
NUMBER OF COMM
CHANNELS: 1
Range: 1, 2
MESSAGE
LOCAL RELAY ID
NUMBER: 0
MESSAGE
TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID
NUMBER: 0
MESSAGE
TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID
NUMBER: 0
TELEPROTECTION
Digital teleprotection functionality is designed to transfer protection commands between 2 or 3 relays in a secure, fast,
dependable, and deterministic fashion. Possible applications are permissive or blocking pilot schemes and direct transfer
trip (DTT). Teleprotection can be applied over any analog or digital channels and any communications media, such as
direct fiber, copper wires, optical networks, or microwave radio links. A mixture of communication media is possible.
Once teleprotection is enabled and the teleprotection input/outputs are configured, data packets are transmitted continuously every 1/4 cycle (3/8 cycle if using C37.94 modules) from peer-to-peer. Security of communication channel data is
achieved by using CRC-32 on the data packet.
Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive as such, they cannot be used simulatneously. Once teleprotection inputs/outputs are enabled, direct inputs/outputs are blocked, and vice versa.
NOTE
NUMBER OF TERMINALS: Specifies whether the teleprotection system operates between 2 peers or 3 peers.
NUMBER OF CHANNELS: Specifies how many channels are used. If the NUMBER OF TERMINALS is 3 (three-terminal
system), set the NUMBER OF CHANNELS to 2. For a two-terminal system, the NUMBER OF CHANNELS can set to 1 or
2 (redundant channels).
LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER, TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID NUMBER, and TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID NUMBER: In installations that use multiplexers or modems, it is desirable to ensure that the data used by the relays protecting a given line
is from the correct relays. The teleprotection function performs this check by reading the message ID sent by transmitting relays and comparing it to the programmed ID in the receiving relay. This check is also used to block inputs if inadvertently set to loopback mode or data is being received from a wrong relay by checking the ID on a received channel.
If an incorrect ID is found on a channel during normal operation, the TELEPROT CH1(2) ID FAIL FlexLogic operand is
set, driving the event with the same name and blocking the teleprotection inputs. For commissioning purposes, the
result of channel identification is also shown in the STATUS CHANNEL TESTS VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION actual value. The default value of 0 for the LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER indicates that relay ID is not to be checked.
On two- terminals two-channel systems, the same LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER is transmitted over both channels; as such,
only the TERMINAL 1 ID NUMBER has to be programmed on the receiving end.
5.2.18 INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION
MESSAGE
5-56
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
RELAY NAME:
Relay-1
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
To safeguard against the installation of a relay without any entered settings, the unit will not allow signaling of any output
relay until RELAY SETTINGS is set to "Programmed". This setting is defaulted to "Not Programmed" when at the factory. The
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED self-test error message is displayed until the relay is put into the "Programmed" state.
The RELAY NAME setting allows the user to uniquely identify a relay. This name will appear on generated reports. This name
is also used to identify specific devices which are engaged in automatically sending/receiving data over the Ethernet communications channel using the IEC 61850 protocol.
GE Multilin
5-57
5 SETTINGS
5.3SYSTEM SETUP
5.3.1 AC INPUTS
a) CURRENT BANKS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS CURRENT BANK F1(M5)
CURRENT BANK F1
PHASE CT F1
PRIMARY:
1 A
MESSAGE
PHASE CT F1
SECONDARY: 1 A
Range: 1 A, 5 A
MESSAGE
GROUND CT F1
PRIMARY:
1 A
MESSAGE
GROUND CT F1
SECONDARY: 1 A
Range: 1 A, 5 A
Because energy parameters are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately
prior to changing CT characteristics.
NOTE
Four banks of phase/ground CTs can be set, where the current banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {1, 5}.
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional details.
These settings are critical for all features that have settings dependent on current measurements. When the relay is
ordered, the CT module must be specified to include a standard or sensitive ground input. As the phase CTs are connected
in Wye (star), the calculated phasor sum of the three phase currents (IA + IB + IC = Neutral Current = 3Io) is used as the
input for the neutral overcurrent elements. In addition, a zero-sequence (core balance) CT which senses current in all of the
circuit primary conductors, or a CT in a neutral grounding conductor may also be used. For this configuration, the ground
CT primary rating must be entered. To detect low level ground fault currents, the sensitive ground input may be used. In this
case, the sensitive ground CT primary rating must be entered. Refer to Chapter 3 for more details on CT connections.
Enter the rated CT primary current values. For both 1000:5 and 1000:1 CTs, the entry would be 1000. For correct operation, the CT secondary rating must match the setting (which must also correspond to the specific CT connections used).
The following example illustrates how multiple CT inputs (current banks) are summed as one source current. Given If the
following current banks:
F1: CT bank with 500:1 ratio; F5: CT bank with 1000: ratio; M1: CT bank with 800:1 ratio
The following rule applies:
SRC 1 = F1 + F5 + M1
(EQ 5.6)
1 pu is the highest primary current. In this case, 1000 is entered and the secondary current from the 500:1 ratio CT will be
adjusted to that created by a 1000:1 CT before summation. If a protection element is set up to act on SRC 1 currents, then
a pickup level of 1 pu will operate on 1000 A primary.
The same rule applies for current sums from CTs with different secondary taps (5 A and 1 A).
5-58
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
b) VOLTAGE BANKS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK F5(M5)
PHASE VT F5
CONNECTION: Wye
MESSAGE
PHASE VT F5
SECONDARY: 66.4 V
MESSAGE
PHASE VT F5
RATIO: 1.00 :1
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY VT F5
CONNECTION: Vag
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY VT F5
SECONDARY: 66.4 V
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY VT F5
RATIO: 1.00 :1
VOLTAGE BANK F5
Because energy parameters are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately
prior to changing VT characteristics.
CAUTION
Two banks of phase/auxiliary VTs can be set, where voltage banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {5}.
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional details.
With VTs installed, the relay can perform voltage measurements as well as power calculations. Enter the PHASE VT F5 CONNECTION made to the system as Wye or Delta. An open-delta source VT connection would be entered as Delta.
The nominal PHASE VT F5 SECONDARY voltage setting is the voltage across the relay input terminals when nominal
voltage is applied to the VT primary.
NOTE
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with a 14400:120 volt VT in a Delta connection, the secondary voltage would be 115, i.e. (13800 / 14400) 120. For a Wye connection, the voltage value
entered must be the phase to neutral voltage which would be 115 / 3 = 66.4.
On a 14.4 kV system with a Delta connection and a VT primary to secondary turns ratio of 14400:120, the voltage
value entered would be 120, i.e. 14400 / 120.
5.3.2 POWER SYSTEM
NOMINAL FREQUENCY:
60 Hz
Range: 25 to 60 Hz in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PHASE ROTATION:
ABC
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
FREQUENCY TRACKING:
Enabled
POWER SYSTEM
The power system NOMINAL FREQUENCY value is used as a default to set the digital sampling rate if the system frequency
cannot be measured from available signals. This may happen if the signals are not present or are heavily distorted. Before
reverting to the nominal frequency, the frequency tracking algorithm holds the last valid frequency measurement for a safe
period of time while waiting for the signals to reappear or for the distortions to decay.
GE Multilin
5-59
5 SETTINGS
The phase sequence of the power system is required to properly calculate sequence components and power parameters.
The PHASE ROTATION setting matches the power system phase sequence. Note that this setting informs the relay of the
actual system phase sequence, either ABC or ACB. CT and VT inputs on the relay, labeled as A, B, and C, must be connected to system phases A, B, and C for correct operation.
The FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting determines which signal source is used (and hence which AC signal) for
phase angle reference. The AC signal used is prioritized based on the AC inputs that are configured for the signal source:
phase voltages takes precedence, followed by auxiliary voltage, then phase currents, and finally ground current.
For three phase selection, phase A is used for angle referencing ( V ANGLE REF = V A ), while Clarke transformation of the
phase signals is used for frequency metering and tracking ( V FREQUENCY = ( 2V A V B V C ) 3 ) for better performance during fault, open pole, and VT and CT fail conditions.
The phase reference and frequency tracking AC signals are selected based upon the Source configuration, regardless of
whether or not a particular signal is actually applied to the relay.
Phase angle of the reference signal will always display zero degrees and all other phase angles will be relative to this signal. If the pre-selected reference signal is not measurable at a given time, the phase angles are not referenced.
The phase angle referencing is done via a phase locked loop, which can synchronize independent UR-series relays if they
have the same AC signal reference. These results in very precise correlation of time tagging in the event recorder between
different UR-series relays provided the relays have an IRIG-B connection.
should only be set to "Disabled" in very unusual circumstances; consult the factory for special variable-frequency applications.
FREQUENCY TRACKING
NOTE
SOURCE 1 NAME:
SRC 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SOURCE 1
Four identical source menus are available. The "SRC 1" text can be replaced by with a user-defined name appropriate for
the associated source.
F and M represent the module slot position. The number directly following these letters represents either the first bank of
four channels (1, 2, 3, 4) called 1 or the second bank of four channels (5, 6, 7, 8) called 5 in a particular CT/VT module.
Refer to the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional details on this concept.
It is possible to select the sum of up to six (6) CTs. The first channel displayed is the CT to which all others will be referred.
For example, the selection F1+F5 indicates the sum of each phase from channels F1 and F5, scaled to whichever CT
has the higher ratio. Selecting None hides the associated actual values.
The approach used to configure the AC sources consists of several steps; first step is to specify the information about each
CT and VT input. For CT inputs, this is the nominal primary and secondary current. For VTs, this is the connection type,
ratio and nominal secondary voltage. Once the inputs have been specified, the configuration for each source is entered,
including specifying which CTs will be summed together.
5-60
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1
I_2
I_0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
SRC 1 50DD OP
SETTING
ACTUAL
SOURCE 2
CURRENT PHASOR
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1
I_2
I_0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SRC 2 50DD OP
SETTING
ACTUAL
SOURCE 6
CURRENT PHASOR
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1
I_2
I_0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
SRC 6 50DD OP
827092A3.CDR
CT/VT MODULE 2
CT/VT MODULE 3
CTs
VTs
not applicable
This configuration could be used on a two-winding transformer, with one winding connected into a breaker-and-a-half system. The following figure shows the arrangement of sources used to provide the functions required in this application, and
the CT/VT inputs that are used to provide the data.
GE Multilin
5-61
5 SETTINGS
F1
DSP Bank
F5
Source 1
Source 2
Amps
Amps
51BF-1
51BF-2
Source 3
U1
Volts Amps
A
Var
87T
Var
51P
Volts Amps
M1
Source 4
M1
UR Relay
M5
BREAKER 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 NAME:
Bkr 1
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 MODE:
3-Pole
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 CLOSE:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 A/3-POLE:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 B:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 C:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 ALARM
DELAY:
0.000 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1
5-62
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
A description of the operation of the breaker control and status monitoring features is provided in chapter 4. Only information concerning programming of the associated settings is covered here. These features are provided for two breakers; a
user may use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
BREAKER 1(2) FUNCTION: Set to "Enable" to allow the operation of any breaker control feature.
BREAKER1(2) PUSH BUTTON CONTROL: Set to "Enable" to allow faceplate push button operations.
BREAKER 1(2) NAME: Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the breaker. This name will be used in
flash messages related to breaker 1.
BREAKER 1(2) MODE: Selects "3-pole" mode, where all breaker poles are operated simultaneously, or "1-pole" mode
where all breaker poles are operated either independently or simultaneously.
BREAKER 1(2) OPEN: Selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate an output relay to open
Breaker No. 1.
BREAKER 1(2) CLOSE: Selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate an output relay to close
Breaker No. 1.
BREAKER 1(2) A/3-POLE: Selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a breaker auxiliary position
tracking mechanism. This input can be either a 52/a or 52/b contact, or a combination the 52/a and 52/b contacts, that
must be programmed to create a logic 0 when the breaker is open. If BREAKER 1 MODE is selected as "3-Pole", this setting selects a single input as the operand used to track the breaker open or closed position. If the mode is selected as
"1-Pole", the input mentioned above is used to track phase A and settings BREAKER 1 B and BREAKER 1 C select
operands to track phases B and C, respectively.
BREAKER 1(2) FB: If the mode is selected as 3-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as 1-pole,
this input is used to track phase B as above for phase A.
BREAKER 1(2) FC: If the mode is selected as 3-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as 1-pole,
this input is used to track phase C as above for phase A.
BREAKER 1(2) EXT ALARM: Selects an operand, usually an external contact input, connected to a breaker alarm
reporting contact.
BREAKER 1(2) ALARM DELAY: Sets the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the three pole
position tracking operands will not declare a pole disagreement, to allow for non-simultaneous operation of the poles. If
single-pole tripping and reclosing is used, the breaker may trip unsymmetrically for faults. In this case, the minimum
alarm delay setting must exceed the maximum time required for fault clearing and reclosing by a suitable margin.
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME: Sets the interval required to maintain setting changes in effect after an operator has
initiated a manual close command to operate a circuit breaker.
BREAKER 1(2) OUT OF SV: Selects an operand indicating that breaker 1(2) is out-of-service.
GE Multilin
5-63
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
BREAKER 1
FUNCTION:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Enabled
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 TRIP A
AND
BREAKER 1 TRIP B
AND
BREAKER 1 TRIP C
SETTING
BREAKER 1
OPEN:
OR
Off = 0
USER 3 OFF/ON
To Open BRK1-(Name)
AND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
Enabled
AND
USER 2 OFF/ON
To Close BRK1-(Name)
OR
SETTING
AND
BREAKER 1
CLOSE:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
Off = 0
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
AR CLOSE BKR 1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
1s
AND
SETTING
BREAKER 1
MODE:
AND
BREAKER 1 ON CMD
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
3-Pole
1-Pole
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
OR
BREAKER 1
CLOSED
(DEFAULT)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 OPEN
OR
BREAKER 1
OPEN
(DEFAULT)
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
SETTING
AND
BREAKER 1 DISCREP
BREAKER 1 ALARM
DELAY:
SETTING
AND
BREAKER 1 B:
Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 C:
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 TROUBLE
OR
Off
BREAKER 1
TROUBLE*
(DEFAULT)
SETTING
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off
AND
BREAKER 1 A CLSD
AND
BREAKER 1 B CLSD
AND
BREAKER 1 C CLSD
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 1P OPEN
AND
XOR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV:
AND
BREAKER 1 OOS
Off
827061AP.CDR
5-64
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP FLEXCURVES FLEXCURVE A(D)
FLEXCURVE A
FLEXCURVE A TIME AT
0.00 xPKP:
0 ms
FlexCurves A through D have settings for entering times to reset/operate at the following pickup levels: 0.00 to 0.98 and
1.03 to 20.00. This data is converted into two continuous curves by linear interpolation between data points. To enter a custom FlexCurve, enter the reset/operate time (using the VALUE keys) for each selected pickup point (using the MESSAGE UP/DOWN keys) for the desired protection curve (A, B, C, or D).
Table 55: FLEXCURVE TABLE
RESET
TIME
MS
RESET
TIME
MS
OPERATE
TIME
MS
OPERATE
TIME
MS
OPERATE
TIME
MS
OPERATE
0.00
0.68
1.03
2.9
4.9
10.5
0.05
0.70
1.05
3.0
5.0
11.0
0.10
0.72
1.1
3.1
5.1
11.5
0.15
0.74
1.2
3.2
5.2
12.0
0.20
0.76
1.3
3.3
5.3
12.5
0.25
0.78
1.4
3.4
5.4
13.0
0.30
0.80
1.5
3.5
5.5
13.5
0.35
0.82
1.6
3.6
5.6
14.0
0.40
0.84
1.7
3.7
5.7
14.5
0.45
0.86
1.8
3.8
5.8
15.0
0.48
0.88
1.9
3.9
5.9
15.5
0.50
0.90
2.0
4.0
6.0
16.0
0.52
0.91
2.1
4.1
6.5
16.5
0.54
0.92
2.2
4.2
7.0
17.0
0.56
0.93
2.3
4.3
7.5
17.5
0.58
0.94
2.4
4.4
8.0
18.0
0.60
0.95
2.5
4.5
8.5
18.5
0.62
0.96
2.6
4.6
9.0
19.0
0.64
0.97
2.7
4.7
9.5
19.5
0.66
0.98
2.8
4.8
10.0
20.0
NOTE
TIME
MS
The relay using a given FlexCurve applies linear approximation for times between the user-entered
points. Special care must be applied when setting the two points that are close to the multiple of pickup of
1; that is, 0.98 pu and 1.03 pu. It is recommended to set the two times to a similar value; otherwise, the linear approximation may result in undesired behavior for the operating quantity that is close to 1.00 pu.
GE Multilin
5-65
5 SETTINGS
Addr: Adds the time specified in this field (in ms) to each
curve operating time value.
Minimum Response Time (MRT): If enabled, the MRT setting
defines the shortest operating time even if the curve suggests
a shorter time at higher current multiples. A composite operating
characteristic is effectively defined. For current multiples lower
than the intersection point, the curve dictates the operating time;
otherwise, the MRT does. An information message appears
when attempting to apply an MRT shorter than the minimum
curve time.
5-66
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
d) EXAMPLE
A composite curve can be created from the GE_111 standard with MRT = 200 ms and HCT initially disabled and then
enabled at eight (8) times pickup with an operating time of 30 ms. At approximately four (4) times pickup, the curve operating time is equal to the MRT and from then onwards the operating time remains at 200 ms (see below).
842719A1.CDR
842720A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-67
5 SETTINGS
2
1
GE106
TIME (sec)
0.5
0.2
GE103
GE104
0.1
GE105
0.05
GE102
GE101
0.02
0.01
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842723A1.CDR
50
GE142
20
10
5
TIME (sec)
GE138
2
GE120
1
GE113
0.5
0.2
0.1
0.05
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842725A1.CDR
5-68
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
50
20
TIME (sec)
10
GE201
GE151
2
GE140
GE134
GE137
0.5
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842730A1.CDR
Figure 523: RECLOSER CURVES GE134, GE137, GE140, GE151 AND GE201
50
GE152
TIME (sec)
20
GE141
10
GE131
GE200
2
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842728A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-69
5 SETTINGS
50
20
GE164
10
TIME (sec)
5
2
GE162
1
0.5
GE133
0.2
GE165
0.1
0.05
GE161
GE163
0.02
0.01
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842729A1.CDR
Figure 525: RECLOSER CURVES GE133, GE161, GE162, GE163, GE164 AND GE165
20
GE132
10
5
TIME (sec)
2
1
0.5
GE139
0.2
GE136
0.1
GE116
0.05
GE117
GE118
0.02
0.01
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842726A1.CDR
Figure 526: RECLOSER CURVES GE116, GE117, GE118, GE132, GE136, AND GE139
5-70
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
20
10
5
GE122
TIME (sec)
1
0.5
GE114
0.2
0.1
GE111
GE121
0.05
GE107
GE115
GE112
0.02
0.01
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842724A1.CDR
Figure 527: RECLOSER CURVES GE107, GE111, GE112, GE114, GE115, GE121, AND GE122
50
20
GE202
TIME (sec)
10
5
GE135
GE119
1
0.5
0.2
1
1.2
1.5
2.5 3
4
5
6 7 8 9 10 12
CURRENT (multiple of pickup)
15
20
842727A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-71
5 SETTINGS
5.3.6 PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT
PHASOR MEASUREMENT
UNIT
MESSAGE
PHASOR MEASUREMENT
UNIT 1
See below.
REPORTING OVER
NETWORK
The D60 Line Distance Protection System is provided with an optional phasor measurement unit feature.
This feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. The number of phasor measurement
units available is also dependent on this option. Refer to the Ordering section of chapter 2 for additional
details.
The PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT menu allows specifying basic parameters of the measurements process such as signal
source, ID and station name, calibration data, triggering, recording, and content for transmission on each of the supported
ports. The reporting ports menus allow specifying the content and rate of reporting on each of the supported ports.
Precise IRIG-B input is vital for correct synchrophasor measurement and reporting. A DC level shift IRIG-B receiver
must be used for the phasor measurement unit to output proper synchrophasor values.
NOTE
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT 1
PHASOR MEASUREMENT
UNIT 1
5-72
PMU 1 BASIC
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
PMU 1
CALIBRATION
MESSAGE
PMU 1
COMMUNICATION
MESSAGE
PMU 1
TRIGGERING
MESSAGE
PMU 1
RECORDING
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
b) BASIC CONFIGURATION
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR... PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT 1(4) PMU 1 BASIC CONFIGURATION
PMU 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
PMU 1 IDCODE: 1
MESSAGE
PMU 1 STN:
GE-UR-PMU
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1 POST-FILTER:
Symm-3-point
PMU 1 BASIC
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
This section contains basic phasor measurement unit (PMU) data, such as functions, source settings, and names.
PMU 1 FUNCTION: This setting enables the PMU 1 functionality. Any associated functions (such as the recorder or
triggering comparators) will not function if this setting is Disabled. Use the command frame to force the communication portion of the feature to start/stop transmission of data. When the transmission is turned off, the PMU is fully operational in terms of calculating and recording the phasors.
PMU 1 IDCODE: This setting assigns a numerical ID to the PMU. It corresponds to the IDCODE field of the data, configuration, header, and command frames of the C37.118 protocol. The PMU uses this value when sending data, configuration, and header frames and responds to this value when receiving the command frame.
PMU 1 STN: This setting assigns an alphanumeric ID to the PMU station. It corresponds to the STN field of the configuration frame of the C37.118 protocol. This value is a 16-character ASCII string as per the C37.118 standard.
PMU 1 SIGNAL SOURCE: This setting specifies one of the available D60 signal sources for processing in the PMU.
Note that any combination of voltages and currents can be configured as a source. The current channels could be configured as sums of physically connected currents. This facilitates PMU applications in breaker-and-a-half, ring-bus, and
similar arrangements. The PMU feature calculates voltage phasors for actual voltage (A, B, C, and auxiliary) and current (A, B, C, and ground) channels of the source, as well as symmetrical components (0, 1, and 2) of both voltages
and currents. When configuring communication and recording features of the PMU, the user could select from the
above superset the content to be sent out or recorded.
PMU 1 POST-FILTER: This setting specifies amount of post-filtering applied to raw synchrophasor measurements.
The raw measurements are produced at the rate of nominal system frequency using one-cycle data windows. This setting is provided to deal with interfering frequencies and to balance speed and accuracy of synchrophasor measurements for different applications. The following filtering choices are available:
Table 56: POST-FILTER CHOICES
SELECTION
None
No post-filtering
Symm-3-point
Symm-5-point
Symm-7-point
This setting applies to all channels of the PMU. It is effectively for recording and transmission on all ports configured to
use data of this PMU.
GE Multilin
5-73
5 SETTINGS
c) CALIBRATION
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR... PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT 1(4) PMU 1 CALIBRATION
PMU 1 VA CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VB CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VC CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VX CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IA CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IB CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IC CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IG CALIBRATION
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1
CALIBRATION
This menu contains user angle calibration data for the phasor measurement unit (PMU). This data is combined with the factory adjustments to shift the phasors for better accuracy.
PMU 1 VA... IG CALIBRATION ANGLE: These settings recognize applications with protection class voltage and current sources, and allow the user to calibrate each channel (four voltages and four currents) individually to offset errors
introduced by VTs, CTs, and cabling. The setting values are effectively added to the measured angles. Therefore, enter
a positive correction of the secondary signal lags the true signal; and negative value if the secondary signal leads the
true signal.
PMU 1 SEQ VOLT SHIFT ANGLE: This setting allows correcting positive- and negative-sequence voltages for vector
groups of power transformers located between the PMU voltage point, and the reference node. This angle is effectively
added to the positive-sequence voltage angle, and subtracted from the negative-sequence voltage angle. Note that:
1.
When this setting is not 0, the phase and sequence voltages will not agree. Unlike sequence voltages, the
phase voltages cannot be corrected in a general case, and therefore are reported as measured.
2.
When receiving synchrophasor date at multiple locations, with possibly different reference nodes, it may be more
beneficial to allow the central locations to perform the compensation of sequence voltages.
3.
This setting applies to PMU data only. The D60 calculates symmetrical voltages independently for protection and
control purposes without applying this correction.
4.
When connected to line-to-line voltages, the PMU calculates symmetrical voltages with the reference to the AG
voltage, and not to the physically connected AB voltage (see the Metering Conventions section in Chapter 6).
PMU 1 SEQ CURR SHIFT ANGLE: This setting allows correcting positive and negative-sequence currents for vector
groups of power transformers located between the PMU current point and the reference node. The setting has the
same meaning for currents as the PMU 1 SEQ VOLT SHIFT ANGLE setting has for voltages. Normally, the two correcting
angles are set identically, except rare applications when the voltage and current measuring points are located at different windings of a power transformer.
5-74
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
d) PMU COMMUNICATION
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR MEASUREMENT... PMU 1 COMMUNICATION PMU 1 COMM PORT 1(3)
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1
COMM PORT 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
This section configures the phasor measurement unit (PMU) communication functions. Three identical menus are available
to configure independent transmission on ports 1, 2 and 3. Multiple transmissions can be used for redundancy or to serve
similar data to multiple different recipients.
PMU1 COMM PORT 1: This setting specifies the first communication port for transmission of the PMU data. The four
ports are configured under individual menus.
GE Multilin
5-75
5 SETTINGS
PMU1 PORT 1 PHS-1(14): These settings specify synchrophasors to be transmitted from the superset of all synchronized measurements. The available synchrophasor values are tabulated below.
SELECTION
MEANING
Va
Vb
Vc
Vx
Ia
Ib
Ic
Ig
V1
V2
V0
Zero-sequence voltage
I1
I2
I0
Zero-sequence current
These settings allow for optimizing the frame size and maximizing transmission channel usage, depending on a given
application. Select Off to suppress transmission of a given value.
PMU1 PORT 1 PHS-1(14) NM: These settings allow for custom naming of the synchrophasor channels. Sixteen-character ASCII strings are allowed as in the CHNAM field of the configuration frame. These names are typically based on
station, bus, or breaker names.
PMU1 PORT 1 A-CH-1(8): These settings specify any analog data measured by the relay to be included as a userselectable analog channel of the data frame. Up to eight analog channels can be configured to send any FlexAnalog
value from the relay. Examples include active and reactive power, per phase or three-phase power, power factor, temperature via RTD inputs, and THD. The configured analog values are sampled concurrently with the synchrophasor
instant and sent as 32-bit floating point values.
PMU1 PORT 1 A-CH-1(8) NM: These settings allow for custom naming of the analog channels. Sixteen-character
ASCII strings are allowed as in the CHNAM field of the configuration frame.
PMU1 PORT 1 D-CH-1(16): These settings specify any digital flag measured by the relay to be included as a userselectable digital channel of the data frame. Up to sixteen digital channels can be configured to send any FlexLogic
operand from the relay. The configured digital flags are sampled concurrently with the synchrophasor instant. The values are mapped into a two-byte integer number, with byte 1 LSB corresponding to the digital channel 1 and byte 2
MSB corresponding to digital channel 16.
PMU1 PORT 1 D-CH-1(16) NM: These settings allow for custom naming of the digital channels. Sixteen-character
ASCII strings are allowed as in the CHNAM field of the configuration frame.
PMU1 PORT 1 D-CH-1(16) NORMAL STATE: These settings allow for specifying a normal state for each digital
channel. These states are transmitted in configuration frames to the data concentrator.
5-76
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PMU 1
TRIGGERING
MESSAGE
PMU 1 FREQUENCY
TRIGGER
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VOLTAGE
TRIGGER
MESSAGE
PMU 1 CURRENT
TRIGGER
MESSAGE
PMU 1 POWER
TRIGGER
MESSAGE
PMU 1 df/dt
TRIGGER
Each logical phasor measurement unit (PMU) contains five triggering mechanisms to facilitate triggering of the associated
PMU recorder, and/or cross-triggering of other PMUs of the system. They are:
overcurrent
overpower
The pre-configured triggers could be augmented with a user-specified condition built freely using programmable logic of the
relay. The entire triggering logic is refreshed once every two power system cycles.
All five triggering functions and the user-definable condition are consolidated (ORed) and connected to the PMU recorder.
Each trigger can be programmed to log its operation into the event recorder, and to signal its operation via targets. The five
triggers drive the STAT bits of the data frame to inform the destination of the synchrophasor data regarding the cause of
trigger. The following convention is adopted to drive bits 11, 3, 2, 1, and 0 of the STAT word.
SETTING
PMU 1 USER TRIGGER:
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
bit 1
OR
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
bit 0
OR
bit 3, bit 11
PMU 1 TRIGGERED
bit 2
PMU 1 recorder
847004A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-77
5 SETTINGS
f) FREQUENCY TRIGGERING
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR MEASUREMENT... PMU 1 TRIGGERING PMU 1 FREQUENCY TRIGGER
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1 FREQUENCY
TRIGGER
PMU 1 FREQ TRIGGER LOW-FREQ: This setting specifies the low threshold for the abnormal frequency trigger. The
comparator applies a 0.03 Hz hysteresis.
PMU 1 FREQ TRIGGER HIGH-FREQ: This setting specifies the high threshold for the abnormal frequency trigger. The
comparator applies a 0.03 Hz hysteresis.
PMU 1 FREQ TRIGGER PKP TIME: This setting could be used to filter out spurious conditions and avoid unnecessary
triggering of the recorder.
PMU 1 FREQ TRIGGER DPO TIME: This setting could be used to extend the trigger after the situation returned to normal. This setting is of particular importance when using the recorder in the forced mode (recording as long as the triggering condition is asserted).
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER
PMU 1 CURR TRIGGER
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER
PMU 1 ROCOF TRIGGER
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
SETTINGS
PMU 1 TRIGGERED
SETTING
PMU 1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
FREQUENCY, f
Off = 0
AND
The trigger responds to the frequency signal of the phasor measurement unit (PMU) source. The frequency is calculated
from either phase voltages, auxiliary voltage, phase currents and ground current, in this hierarchy, depending on the source
configuration as per D60 standards. This element requires the frequency is above the minimum measurable value. If the
frequency is below this value, such as when the circuit is de-energized, the trigger will drop out.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
RUN
f < LOW-FREQ
OR
f > HIGH-FREQ
to STAT bits of
the data frame
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
847002A1.CDR
5-78
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
g) VOLTAGE TRIGGERING
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR MEASUREMENT... PMU 1 TRIGGERING PMU 1 VOLTAGE TRIGGER
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VOLTAGE
TRIGGER
This element responds to abnormal voltage. Separate thresholds are provided for low and high voltage. In terms of signaling its operation, the element does not differentiate between the undervoltage and overvoltage events. The trigger
responds to the phase voltage signal of the phasor measurement unit (PMU) source. All voltage channels (A, B, and C or
AB, BC, and CA) are processed independently and could trigger the recorder. A minimum voltage supervision of 0.1 pu is
implemented to prevent pickup on a de-energized circuit, similarly to the undervoltage protection element.
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER LOW-VOLT: This setting specifies the low threshold for the abnormal voltage trigger, in perunit of the PMU source. 1 pu is a nominal voltage value defined as the nominal secondary voltage times VT ratio. The
comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER HIGH-VOLT: This setting specifies the high threshold for the abnormal voltage trigger, in perunit of the PMU source. 1 pu is a nominal voltage value defined as the nominal secondary voltage times VT ratio. The
comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER PKP TIME: This setting could be used to filter out spurious conditions and avoid unnecessary
triggering of the recorder.
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER DPO TIME: This setting could be used to extend the trigger after the situation returned to normal. This setting is of particular importance when using the recorder in the forced mode (recording as long as the triggering condition is asserted).
GE Multilin
5-79
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTINGS
Enabled = 1
OR
SETTING
Off = 0
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
Off = 0
PMU 1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
DELTA
VA
VAB
VB
VBC
VC
VCA
to STAT bits of
the data frame
WYE
PMU 1 TRIGGERED
SETTINGS
RUN
VT CONNECTION:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
tDPO
847005A1.CDR
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1 CURRENT
TRIGGER
This element responds to elevated current. The trigger responds to the phase current signal of the phasor measurement
unit (PMU) source. All current channel (A, B, and C) are processed independently and could trigger the recorder.
PMU 1 CURR TRIGGER PICKUP: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the overcurrent trigger, in per unit of
the PMU source. A value of 1 pu is a nominal primary current. The comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 CURR TRIGGER PKP TIME: This setting could be used to filter out spurious conditions and avoid unnecessary triggering of the recorder.
PMU 1 CURR TRIGGER DPO TIME: This setting could be used to extend the trigger after the situation returned to normal. This setting is of particular importance when using the recorder in the forced mode (recording as long as the triggering condition is asserted).
5-80
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PMU 1 FREQ TRIGGER
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER
SETTINGS
Enabled = 1
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
AND
PMU 1 TRIGGERED
Off = 0
Off = 0
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
PMU 1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
RUN
to STAT bits of
the data frame
IA
I > PICKUP
IB
I > PICKUP
IC
I > PICKUP
OR
tPKP
847000A1.CDR
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1 POWER
TRIGGER
This element responds to abnormal power. Separate thresholds are provided for active, reactive, and apparent powers. In
terms of signaling its operation the element does not differentiate between the three types of power. The trigger responds to
the single-phase and three-phase power signals of the phasor measurement unit (PMU) source.
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER ACTIVE: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the active power of the source. For
single-phase power, 1 pu is a product of 1 pu voltage and 1 pu current, or the product of nominal secondary voltage,
the VT ratio and the nominal primary current. For the three-phase power, 1 pu is three times that for a single-phase
power. The comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER REACTIVE: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the reactive power of the
source. For single-phase power, 1 pu is a product of 1 pu voltage and 1 pu current, or the product of nominal secondary voltage, the VT ratio and the nominal primary current. For the three-phase power, 1 pu is three times that for a single-phase power. The comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
GE Multilin
5-81
5 SETTINGS
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER APPARENT: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the apparent power of the
source. For single-phase power, 1 pu is a product of 1 pu voltage and 1 pu current, or the product of nominal secondary voltage, the VT ratio and the nominal primary current. For the three-phase power, 1 pu is three times that for a single-phase power. The comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER PKP TIME: This setting could be used to filter out spurious conditions and avoid unnecessary triggering of the recorder.
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER DPO TIME: This setting could be used to extend the trigger after the situation returned to
normal. This setting is of particular importance when using the recorder in the forced mode (recording as long as the
triggering condition is asserted).
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Enabled = 1
Off = 0
SETTINGS
SETTING
RUN
ACTIVE POWER, PA
ACTIVE POWER, PB
ACTIVE POWER, PC
3P ACTIVE POWER, P
REACTIVE POWER, QB
REACTIVE POWER, QC
3P REACTIVE POWER, Q
APPARENT POWER, SA
APPARENT POWER, SB
APPARENT POWER, SC
3P APPARENT POWER, S
SETTINGS
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER PKP TIME:
REACTIVE POWER, QA
PMU 1 TRIGGERED
Off = 0
to STAT bits of
the data frame
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
AND
PMU 1 POWER
TRIGGER FUNCTION:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
847003A1.CDR
5-82
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
j) DF/DT TRIGGERING
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR MEASUREMENT... PMU 1 TRIGGERING PMU 1 df/dt TRIGGER
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1 df/dt
TRIGGER
This element responds to frequency rate of change. Separate thresholds are provided for rising and dropping frequency.
The trigger responds to the rate of change of frequency (df/dt) of the phasor measurement unit (PMU) source.
PMU 1 df/dt TRIGGER RAISE: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the rate of change of frequency in the
raising direction (positive df/dt). The comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 df/dt TRIGGER FALL: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the rate of change of frequency in the falling direction (negative df/dt). The comparator applies a 3% hysteresis.
PMU 1 df/dt TRIGGER PKP TIME: This setting could be used to filter out spurious conditions and avoid unnecessary
triggering of the recorder.
PMU 1 df/dt TRIGGER DPO TIME: This setting could be used to extend the trigger after the situation returned to normal. This setting is of particular importance when using the recorder in the forced mode (recording as long as the triggering condition is asserted).
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PMU 1 FREQ TRIGGER
PMU 1 VOLT TRIGGER
PMU 1 CURR TRIGGER
PMU 1 POWER TRIGGER
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
SETTINGS
PMU 1 TRIGGERED
Off = 0
SETTING
PMU 1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
ROCOF, df/dt
Off = 0
AND
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
RUN
to STAT bits of
the data frame
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
847000A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-83
5 SETTINGS
k) PMU RECORDING
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR... PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT 1(4) PMU 1 RECORDING
PMU 1 RECORDING
RATE: 10/sec
Range: 1, 2, 5, 10, 12, 15, 20, 25, 30, 50, or 60 times per
second
MESSAGE
PMU 1 NO OF TIMED
RECORDS: 10
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PMU 1
RECORDING
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Each logical phasor measurement unit (PMU) is associated with a recorder. The triggering condition is programmed via the
PMU 1 TRIGGERING menu. The recorder works with polar values using resolution as in the PMU actual values.
5-84
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
TRIGGER
REC
847709A2.CDR
PMU 1 RECORDING RATE: This setting specifies the recording rate for the record content. Not all recording rates are
applicable to either 50 or 60 Hz systems (for example, recording at 25 phasors a second in a 60 Hz system). The relay
supports decimation by integer number of phasors from the nominal system frequency. If the rate of 25 is selected for
the 60 Hz system, the relay would decimate the rate of 60 phasors a second by round (60 / 25) = 2; that is, it would
record at 60 / 2 = 30 phasors a second.
REC
847709A2.CDR
Figure 536:
PMU 1 NO OF TIMED RECORDS: This setting specifies how many timed records are available for a given logical
PMU. The length of each record equals available memory divided by the content size and number of records. The
higher the number of records, the shorter each record. The relay supports a maximum of 128 records.
PMU 1 TRIGGER MODE: This setting specifies what happens when the recorder uses its entire available memory
storage. If set to Automatic Overwrite, the last record is erased to facilitate new recording, when triggered.
If set to Protected, the recorder stops creating new records when the entire memory is used up by the old un-cleared
records. Refer to chapter 7 for more information on clearing PMU records.
The following set of figures illustrate the concept of memory management via the PMU 1 TRIGGER MODE setting.
Total memory for all logical PMUs
Memory available for the logical PMU
Record
1
Record
2
Record
3
Free
Free
memory memory
Record
1
Record
2
Record
3
Record
4
Free
memory
Record
1
Record
2
Record
3
Record
4
Record
5
Record
6
Record
2
Record
3
Record
4
Record
5
GE Multilin
5-85
5 SETTINGS
Record
1
Record
2
Record
3
Free
Free
memory memory
Record
1
Record
2
Record
3
Record
4
Free
memory
Record
1
Record
2
Record
3
Record
4
Record
5
847706A1.CDR
PMU 1 TIMED TRIGGER POSITION: This setting specifies the amount of pre-trigger data in percent of the entire
record. This setting applies only to the timed mode of recording.
PMU1 PORT 1 PHS-1(14): These settings specify synchrophasors to be recorded from the superset of all synchronized measurements as indicated in the following table. These settings allow for optimizing the record size and content
depending on a given application. Select Off to suppress recording of a given value.
VALUE
DESCRIPTION
Va
Vb
Vc
Vx
Ia
Ib
Ic
Ig
V1
V2
V0
Zero-sequence voltage
I1
I2
I0
Zero-sequence current
PMU 1 REC PHS-1(14) NM: These settings allow for custom naming of the synchrophasor channels. Sixteen-character ASCII strings are allowed as in the CHNAM field of the configuration frame. Typically these names would be based
on station, bus, or breaker names.
PMU 1 REC A-CH-1(8): These settings specify analog data measured by the relay to be included as a user-selectable
analog channel of the record. Up to eight analog channels can be configured to record any FlexAnalog value from the
relay. Examples include active and reactive power, per phase or three-phase power, power factor, temperature via
RTD inputs, and THD. The configured analogs are sampled concurrently with the synchrophasor instant.
PMU 1 REC A-CH-1(8) NM: These settings allow for custom naming of the analog channels. Sixteen-character ASCII
strings are allowed as in the CHNAM field of the configuration frame.
PMU 1 REC D-CH-1(16): These settings specify any digital flag measured by the relay to be included as a user-selectable digital channel in the record. Up to digital analog channels can be configured to record any FlexLogic operand
from the relay. The configured digital flags are sampled concurrently with the synchrophasor instant.
PMU 1 REC D-CH-1(16) NM: This setting allows custom naming of the digital channels. Sixteen-character ASCII
strings are allowed as in the CHNAM field of the configuration frame.
5-86
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
l) NETWORK CONNECTION
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP PHASOR... PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT 1(4) REPORTING OVER NETWORK
NETWORK REPORTING
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
NETWORK REPORTING
IDCODE: 1
MESSAGE
NETWORK REPORTING
RATE: 10 per sec
Range: 1, 2, 5, 10, 12, 15, 20, 25, 30, 50, or 60 times per
second
MESSAGE
NETWORK REPORTING
STYLE: Polar
MESSAGE
NETWORK REPORTING
FORMAT: Integer
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
REPORTING OVER
NETWORK
The Ethernet connection works simultaneously with other communication means working over the Ethernet and is configured as follows.
NETWORK REPORTING IDCODE: This setting specifies an IDCODE for the entire port. Individual PMU streams
transmitted over this port are identified via their own IDCODES as per the PMU IDCODE settings. This IDCODE is to be
used by the command frame to start/stop transmission, and request configuration or header frames.
NETWORK REPORTING RATE: This setting specifies the reporting rate for the network (Ethernet) port. This value
applies to all PMU streams of the device that are assigned to transmit over this port.
NETWORK REPORTING STYLE: This setting selects between reporting synchrophasors in rectangular (real and
imaginary) or in polar (magnitude and angle) coordinates. This setting complies with bit-0 of the format field of the
C37.118 configuration frame.
NETWORK REPORTING FORMAT: This setting selects between reporting synchrophasors as 16-bit integer or 32-bit
IEEE floating point numbers. This setting complies with bit 1 of the format field of the C37.118 configuration frame.
Note that this setting applies to synchrophasors only the user-selectable FlexAnalog channels are always transmitted as 32-bit floating point numbers.
NETWORK PDC CONTROL: The synchrophasor standard allows for user-defined controls originating at the PDC, to
be executed on the PMU. The control is accomplished via an extended command frame. The relay decodes the first
word of the extended field, EXTFRAME, to drive 16 dedicated FlexLogic operands: PDC NETWORK CNTRL 1 (from the
least significant bit) to PDC NETWORK CNTRL 16 (from the most significant bit). Other words, if any, in the EXTFRAME
are ignored. The operands are asserted for 5 seconds following reception of the command frame. If the new command
frame arrives within the 5 second period, the FlexLogic operands are updated, and the 5 second timer is re-started.
This setting enables or disables the control. When enabled, all 16 operands are active; when disabled all 16 operands
remain reset.
NETWORK TCP PORT: This setting selects the TCP port number that will be used for network reporting.
NETWORK UDP PORT: This setting selects the UDP port number that will be used for network reporting.
GE Multilin
5-87
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5.4FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
5.4.1 INTRODUCTION TO FLEXLOGIC
To provide maximum flexibility to the user, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed and user-programmed
parameters. Logic upon which individual features are designed is fixed, and all other logic, from digital input signals through
elements or combinations of elements to digital outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic
through FlexLogic. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs which it uses to produce analog and digital
outputs. The major sub-systems of a generic UR-series relay involved in this process are shown below.
5-88
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs is field programmable through the use
of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is available
internally and on the communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic).
FlexLogic allows users to customize the relay through a series of equations that consist of operators and operands. The
operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers and latches (with
set and reset inputs). A system of sequential operations allows any combination of specified operands to be assigned as
inputs to specified operators to create an output. The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual output. Virtual outputs can be used as an input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a
seal-in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators. Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0.
Operators provide a defined function, such as an AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of parameters to be used to set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, i.e. flag set) or 0 (=OFF, i.e.
flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least 4 times every power system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances; e.g. contact and remote inputs. These types of operands are grouped together (for presentation purposes only) on the faceplate display. The characteristics of the different
types of operands are listed in the table below.
Table 57: D60 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND TYPES
OPERAND TYPE
STATE
EXAMPLE FORMAT
CHARACTERISTICS
[INPUT IS 1 (= ON) IF...]
Contact Input
On
Cont Ip On
Off
Cont Ip Off
Contact Output
(type Form-A contact
only)
Voltage On
Cont Op 1 VOn
Voltage Off
Cont Op 1 VOff
Current On
Cont Op 1 IOn
Current Off
Cont Op 1 IOff
Direct Input
On
DIRECT INPUT 1 On
Element
(Analog)
Pickup
Dropout
Operate
PHASE TOC1 OP
Element
(Digital)
Element
(Digital Counter)
Block
Pickup
Dropout
Operate
Dig Element 1 OP
Higher than
Counter 1 HI
Equal to
Counter 1 EQL
Lower than
Counter 1 LO
On
On
Logic 1
Off
Off
Logic 0
Remote Input
On
REMOTE INPUT 1 On
Virtual Input
On
Virt Ip 1 On
Virtual Output
On
Virt Op 1 On
Fixed
GE Multilin
5-89
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
The operands available for this relay are listed alphabetically by types in the following table.
Table 58: D60 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS (Sheet 1 of 9)
OPERAND TYPE
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 2 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 3 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 4 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 5 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 6 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 7 ON
DIRECT DEVICES
DIRECT INPUT/
OUTPUT
CHANNEL
MONITORING
The rate of direct input messages received on channel 1 and failing the CRC
exceeded the user-specified level.
The rate of direct input messages received on channel 2 and failing the CRC
exceeded the user-specified level.
The rate of direct input messages failing the CRC exceeded the userspecified level on channel 1 or 2.
The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 1 exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only).
The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 2 exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only).
The rate of returned direct input/output messages exceeded the userspecified level on channel 1 or 2 (ring configurations only).
ELEMENT:
Autoreclose
(1P/3P)
AR ENABLED
AR DISABLED
AR RIP
AR 1-P RIP
AR 3-P/1 RIP
AR 3-P/2 RIP
AR 3-P/3 RIP
AR 3-P/4 RIP
AR LO
AR BKR1 BLK
AR BKR2 BLK
AR CLOSE BKR1
AR CLOSE BKR2
AR FORCE 3-P TRIP
AR SHOT CNT > 0
AR SHOT CNT = 1
AR SHOT CNT = 2
AR SHOT CNT = 3
AR SHOT CNT = 4
AR ZONE 1 EXTENT
AR INCOMPLETE SEQ
AR RESET
ELEMENT:
Auxiliary
overvoltage
ELEMENT:
Auxiliary
undervoltage
ELEMENT:
Breaker arcing
BKR ARC 1 OP
BKR ARC 2 OP
ELEMENT
Breaker failure
BKR FAIL 2
5-90
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT
Breaker flashover
BKR 2 FLSHOVR...
ELEMENT:
Breaker control
BREAKER 2
ELEMENT:
Digital counters
Counter 1 HI
Counter 1 EQL
Counter 1 LO
Counter 2 to Counter 8
ELEMENT:
Directional
comparison
unblocking scheme
DCUB TX1
DCUB TX2
DCUB TX3
DCUB TX4
DCUB TRIP A
DCUB TRIP B
DCUB TRIP C
DCUB TRIP 3P
DCUB OP
ELEMENT:
Digital elements
ELEMENT:
Blocking Scheme
ELEMENT:
DUTT
(Direct underreach
transfer trip)
DUTT TX1
DUTT TX2
DUTT TX3
DUTT TX4
DUTT TRIP A
DUTT TRIP B
DUTT TRIP C
DUTT TRIP 3P
DUTT OP
GE Multilin
5-91
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
OPERAND TYPE
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
FlexElements
FxE 1 PKP
FxE 1 OP
FxE 1 DPO
FxE 2 to FxE 8
ELEMENT:
Ground distance
GND DIST Z2 to Z5
ELEMENT:
Ground
instantaneous
overcurrent
GROUND IOC2
ELEMENT:
Ground time
overcurrent
GROUND TOC2
ELEMENT:
Hybrid POTT
(Hybrid permissive
overreach transfer
trip)
ELEMENT
Non-volatile latches
LATCH 1 ON
LATCH 1 OFF
LATCH 2 to LATCH 16
ELEMENT:
Line pickup
LINE PICKUP OP
LINE PICKUP PKP
LINE PICKUP DPO
LINE PICKUP I<A
LINE PICKUP I<B
LINE PICKUP I<C
LINE PICKUP UV PKP
LINE PICKUP LEO PKP
LINE PICKUP RCL TRIP
ELEMENT:
Load encroachment
ELEMENT:
Negative-sequence
directional
overcurrent
ELEMENT:
Negative-sequence
instantaneous
overcurrent
ELEMENT:
Negative-sequence
overvoltage
5-92
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
Negative-sequence
time overcurrent
ELEMENT:
Neutral
instantaneous
overcurrent
NEUTRAL IOC2
ELEMENT:
Neutral overvoltage
ELEMENT:
Neutral time
overcurrent
NEUTRAL TOC2
ELEMENT:
Neutral directional
overcurrent
ELEMENT:
Open pole detector
OPEN POLE OP A
OPEN POLE OP B
OPEN POLE OP C
OPEN POLE BKR A OP
ELEMENT:
Synchrophasor
phasor data
concentrator
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 1 as received via direct channel 1
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 2 as received via direct channel 1
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 16 received via direct channel 1
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 1 as received via direct channel 2
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 2 as received via direct channel 2
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 16 received via direct channel 2
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 1 as received via the network
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 2 as received via the network
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 16 as received via the network
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 1 as received via RS485
Phasor data concentrator asserts control bit 2 as received via RS485
ELEMENT:
Phase directional
overcurrent
PH DIR1 BLK A
PH DIR1 BLK B
PH DIR1 BLK C
PH DIR1 BLK
PH DIR2
GE Multilin
5-93
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
Phase distance
PH DIST Z1 PKP
PH DIST Z1 OP
PH DIST Z1 OP AB
PH DIST Z1 OP BC
PH DIST Z1 OP CA
PH DIST Z1 PKP AB
PH DIST Z1 PKP BC
PH DIST Z1 PKP CA
PH DIST Z1 SUPN IAB
PH DIST Z1 SUPN IBC
PH DIST Z1 SUPN ICA
PH DIST Z1 DPO AB
PH DIST Z1 DPO BC
PH DIST Z1 DPO CA
PH DIST Z2 to Z5
ELEMENT:
Phase
instantaneous
overcurrent
PHASE IOC2
ELEMENT:
Phase overvoltage
ELEMENT
Phase select
PHASE SELECT AG
PHASE SELECT BG
PHASE SELECT CG
PHASE SELECT SLG
PHASE SELECT AB
PHASE SELECT BC
PHASE SELECT CA
PHASE SELECT ABG
PHASE SELECT BCG
PHASE SELECT CAG
PHASE SELECT 3P
PHASE SELECT MULTI-P
PHASE SELECT VOID
ELEMENT:
Phase time
overcurrent
PHASE TOC2
5-94
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
Phase undervoltage
PHASE UV2
ELEMENT:
Synchrophasor
phasor
measurement unit
(PMU)
ELEMENT:
Synchrophasor oneshot
PMU ONE-SHOT OP
PMU ONE-SHOT PENDING
Indicates the one-shot operation has been executed, and the present time is
at least 30 seconds past the scheduled one-shot time
Indicates the one-shot operation is pending; that is, the present time is before
the scheduled one-shot time
Indicates the one-shot operation and remains asserted for 30 seconds
afterwards
ELEMENT:
POTT
(Permissive
overreach transfer
trip)
POTT OP
POTT TX1
POTT TX2
POTT TX3
POTT TX4
POTT TRIP A
POTT TRIP B
POTT TRIP C
POTT TRIP 3P
ELEMENT:
Power swing detect
ELEMENT:
PUTT
(Permissive
underreach transfer
trip)
PUTT OP
PUTT TX1
PUTT TX2
PUTT TX3
PUTT TX4
PUTT TRIP A
PUTT TRIP B
PUTT TRIP C
PUTT TRIP 3P
ELEMENT:
Selector switch
SELECTOR 1 POS Y
SELECTOR 1 BIT 0
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2
SELECTOR 1 STP ALARM
GE Multilin
5-95
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
Setting group
ELEMENT:
Disturbance
detector
SRC1 50DD OP
SRC2 50DD OP
SRC3 50DD OP
SRC4 50DD OP
ELEMENT:
VTFF (Voltage
transformer fuse
failure)
SYNC 1 DEAD S OP
SYNC 1 DEAD S DPO
SYNC 1 SYNC OP
SYNC 1 SYNC DPO
SYNC 1 CLS OP
SYNC 1 CLS DPO
SYNC 1 V1 ABOVE MIN
SYNC 1 V1 BELOW MAX
SYNC 1 V2 ABOVE MIN
SYNC 1 V2 BELOW MAX
SYNC 2
ELEMENT:
Teleprotection
channel tests
Channel 1 failed
Channel 2 failed
The ID check for a peer relay on channel 1 has failed
The ID check for a peer relay on channel 2 has failed
CRC detected packet corruption on channel 1
CRC detected packet corruption on channel 2
CRC detected lost packet on channel 1
CRC detected lost packet on channel 2
ELEMENT:
Teleprotection
inputs/outputs
ELEMENT
Trip output
TRIP 3-POLE
TRIP 1-POLE
TRIP PHASE A
TRIP PHASE B
TRIP PHASE C
TRIP AR INIT 3-POLE
TRIP FORCE 3-POLE
ELEMENT
Trip bus
ELEMENT:
Synchrocheck
ELEMENT:
Wattmetric zerosequence
directional
WATTMETRIC 1 PKP
WATTMETRIC 1 OP
WATTMETRIC 2...
FIXED OPERANDS
Off
On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Contact inputs
5-96
Cont Ip 1
Cont Ip 2
Cont Ip 1
Cont Ip 2
On
On
Off
Off
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Contact outputs,
current
(from detector on
form-A output only)
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
IOn
IOn
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
IOff
IOff
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Contact outputs,
voltage
(from detector on
form-A output only)
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
VOn
VOn
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
VOff
VOff
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
Direct inputs
DIRECT INPUT 1 On
DIRECT INPUT 32 On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Remote inputs
REMOTE INPUT 1 On
REMOTE INPUT 32 On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Virtual inputs
Virt Ip 1 On
Virt Ip 64 On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Virtual outputs
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 96 On
LED INDICATORS:
Fixed front panel
LEDs
LED IN SERVICE
LED TROUBLE
LED TEST MODE
LED TRIP
LED ALARM
LED PICKUP
LED VOLTAGE
LED CURRENT
LED FREQUENCY
LED OTHER
LED PHASE A
LED PHASE B
LED PHASE C
LED NEUTRAL/GROUND
LED INDICATORS:
LED test
LED INDICATORS:
User-programmable
LEDs
REMOTE DEVICES
RESETTING
LED USER 1
LED USER 2 to 48
REMOTE DEVICE 1 On
REMOTE DEVICE 16 On
RESET OP
RESET OP (COMMS)
RESET OP (OPERAND)
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON)
GE Multilin
5-97
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
OPERAND TYPE
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
SELFDIAGNOSTICS
UNAUTHORIZED
ACCESS ALARM
UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS
USERPROGRAMMABLE
PUSHBUTTONS
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
ANY PB ON
PUSHBUTTON 2 to 12
Some operands can be re-named by the user. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker control feature, the ID
(identification) of contact inputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of virtual outputs. If the user changes the default name/
ID of any of these operands, the assigned name will appear in the relay list of operands. The default names are shown in
the FlexLogic operands table above.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated below, and the operators available in FlexLogic are listed in the FlexLogic operators table.
Table 59: FLEXLOGIC GATE CHARACTERISTICS
5-98
GATES
NUMBER OF INPUTS
NOT
OR
2 to 16
any input is 1
AND
2 to 16
NOR
2 to 16
NAND
2 to 16
any input is 0
XOR
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
SYNTAX
DESCRIPTION
Editor
INSERT
DELETE
End
END
One-shot
Logic
gate
POSITIVE ONE SHOT One shot that responds to a positive going edge.
NOTES
NEGATIVE ONE
SHOT
NOT
Logical NOT
OR(2)
OR(16)
2 input OR gate
16 input OR gate
AND(2)
AND(16)
NOR(2)
NOR(16)
NAND(2)
NAND(16)
XOR(2)
LATCH (S,R)
Timer
TIMER 1
TIMER 32
Assign
virtual
output
= Virt Op 1
= Virt Op 96
GE Multilin
5-99
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
5.4.2 FLEXLOGIC RULES
When forming a FlexLogic equation, the sequence in the linear array of parameters must follow these general rules:
1.
Operands must precede the operator which uses the operands as inputs.
2.
Operators have only one output. The output of an operator must be used to create a virtual output if it is to be used as
an input to two or more operators.
3.
4.
A timer operator (e.g. "TIMER 1") or virtual output assignment (e.g. " = Virt Op 1") may only be used once. If this rule is
broken, a syntax error will be declared.
5.4.3 FLEXLOGIC EVALUATION
Each equation is evaluated in the order in which the parameters have been entered.
FlexLogic provides latches which by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set state after the
set input has been asserted. However, they are volatile; i.e. they reset on the re-application of control
power.
NOTE
When making changes to settings, all FlexLogic equations are re-compiled whenever any new setting
value is entered, so all latches are automatically reset. If it is necessary to re-initialize FlexLogic during
testing, for example, it is suggested to power the unit down and then back up.
5.4.4 FLEXLOGIC EXAMPLE
This section provides an example of implementing logic for a typical application. The sequence of the steps is quite important as it should minimize the work necessary to develop the relay settings. Note that the example presented in the figure
below is intended to demonstrate the procedure, not to solve a specific application situation.
In the example below, it is assumed that logic has already been programmed to produce virtual outputs 1 and 2, and is only
a part of the full set of equations used. When using FlexLogic, it is important to make a note of each virtual output used
a virtual output designation (1 to 96) can only be properly assigned once.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
State=ON
Set
LATCH
OR #1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
Reset
Timer 2
XOR
OR #2
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
State=Pickup
Time Delay
on Dropout
Operate Output
Relay H1
(200 ms)
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
Timer 1
AND
Time Delay
on Pickup
(800 ms)
827025A2.vsd
Inspect the example logic diagram to determine if the required logic can be implemented with the FlexLogic operators. If this is not possible, the logic must be altered until this condition is satisfied. Once this is done, count the inputs
to each gate to verify that the number of inputs does not exceed the FlexLogic limits, which is unlikely but possible. If
the number of inputs is too high, subdivide the inputs into multiple gates to produce an equivalent. For example, if 25
inputs to an AND gate are required, connect Inputs 1 through 16 to AND(16), 17 through 25 to AND(9), and the outputs
from these two gates to AND(2).
Inspect each operator between the initial operands and final virtual outputs to determine if the output from the operator
is used as an input to more than one following operator. If so, the operator output must be assigned as a virtual output.
5-100
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
For the example shown above, the output of the AND gate is used as an input to both OR#1 and Timer 1, and must
therefore be made a virtual output and assigned the next available number (i.e. Virtual Output 3). The final output must
also be assigned to a virtual output as virtual output 4, which will be programmed in the contact output section to operate relay H1 (that is, contact output H1).
Therefore, the required logic can be implemented with two FlexLogic equations with outputs of virtual output 3 and
virtual output 4 as shown below.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
State=ON
Set
LATCH
OR #1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
Reset
Timer 2
XOR
Time Delay
on Dropout
OR #2
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
State=Pickup
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 4
(200 ms)
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
Timer 1
Time Delay
on Pickup
AND
(800 ms)
CONTACT INPUT H1c
State=Closed
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3
827026A2.VSD
Prepare a logic diagram for the equation to produce virtual output 3, as this output will be used as an operand in the
virtual output 4 equation (create the equation for every output that will be used as an operand first, so that when these
operands are required they will already have been evaluated and assigned to a specific virtual output). The logic for
virtual output 3 is shown below with the final output assigned.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
AND(2)
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3
Prepare a logic diagram for virtual output 4, replacing the logic ahead of virtual output 3 with a symbol identified as virtual output 3, as shown below.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
State=ON
Set
LATCH
OR #1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
Reset
Timer 2
XOR
OR #2
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
State=Pickup
Time Delay
on Dropout
VIRTUAL
OUTPUT 4
(200 ms)
Timer 1
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3
State=ON
Time Delay
on Pickup
(800 ms)
827028A2.VSD
Program the FlexLogic equation for virtual output 3 by translating the logic into available FlexLogic parameters.
The equation is formed one parameter at a time until the required logic is complete. It is generally easier to start at the
output end of the equation and work back towards the input, as shown in the following steps. It is also recommended to
list operator inputs from bottom to top. For demonstration, the final output will be arbitrarily identified as parameter 99,
GE Multilin
5-101
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
and each preceding parameter decremented by one in turn. Until accustomed to using FlexLogic, it is suggested that
a worksheet with a series of cells marked with the arbitrary parameter numbers be prepared, as shown below.
01
02
03
04
05
.....
97
98
99
827029A1.VSD
97: This lower input to the AND gate must be passed through an inverter (the NOT operator) so the next parameter is
NOT. The NOT operator acts upon the operand immediately preceding it, so specify the inverter input next.
96: The input to the NOT gate is to be contact input H1c. The ON state of a contact input can be programmed to be
set when the contact is either open or closed. Assume for this example the state is to be ON for a closed contact.
The operand is therefore Cont Ip H1c On.
95: The last step in the procedure is to specify the upper input to the AND gate, the operated state of digital element 2.
This operand is "DIG ELEM 2 OP".
Writing the parameters in numerical order can now form the equation for virtual output 3:
[95]
[96]
[97]
[98]
[99]
DIG ELEM 2 OP
Cont Ip H1c On
NOT
AND(2)
= Virt Op 3
It is now possible to check that this selection of parameters will produce the required logic by converting the set of parameters into a logic diagram. The result of this process is shown below, which is compared to the logic for virtual output 3 diagram as a check.
95
96
97
98
99
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
DIG ELEM 2 OP
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Cont Ip H1c On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
NOT
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
AND (2)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
=Virt Op 3
AND
VIRTUAL
OUTPUT 3
827030A2.VSD
Repeating the process described for virtual output 3, select the FlexLogic parameters for Virtual Output 4.
5-102
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
99: The final output of the equation is virtual output 4 which is parameter = Virt Op 4".
98: The operator preceding the output is timer 2, which is operand TIMER 2". Note that the settings required for the
timer are established in the timer programming section.
97: The operator preceding timer 2 is OR #2, a 3-input OR, which is parameter OR(3).
96: The lowest input to OR #2 is operand Cont Ip H1c On.
95: The center input to OR #2 is operand TIMER 1".
94: The input to timer 1 is operand Virt Op 3 On".
93: The upper input to OR #2 is operand LATCH (S,R).
92: There are two inputs to a latch, and the input immediately preceding the latch reset is OR #1, a 4-input OR, which
is parameter OR(4).
91: The lowest input to OR #1 is operand Virt Op 3 On".
90: The input just above the lowest input to OR #1 is operand XOR(2).
89: The lower input to the XOR is operand DIG ELEM 1 PKP.
88: The upper input to the XOR is operand Virt Ip 1 On".
87: The input just below the upper input to OR #1 is operand Virt Op 2 On".
86: The upper input to OR #1 is operand Virt Op 1 On".
85: The last parameter is used to set the latch, and is operand Virt Op 4 On".
The equation for virtual output 4 is:
[85]
[86]
[87]
[88]
[89]
[90]
[91]
[92]
[93]
[94]
[95]
[96]
[97]
[98]
[99]
Virt Op 4 On
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Ip 1 On
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
Virt Op 3 On
OR(4)
LATCH (S,R)
Virt Op 3 On
TIMER 1
Cont Ip H1c On
OR(3)
TIMER 2
= Virt Op 4
It is now possible to check that the selection of parameters will produce the required logic by converting the set of parameters into a logic diagram. The result of this process is shown below, which is compared to the logic for virtual output 4 diagram as a check.
GE Multilin
5-103
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 4 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 1 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 2 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Ip 1 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
XOR
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 3 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
OR (4)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
LATCH (S,R)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 3 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
TIMER 1
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Cont Ip H1c On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
OR (3)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
TIMER 2
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
=Virt Op 4
Set
LATCH
XOR
OR
Reset
OR
T2
VIRTUAL
OUTPUT 4
T1
827031A2.VSD
Now write the complete FlexLogic expression required to implement the logic, making an effort to assemble the
equation in an order where Virtual Outputs that will be used as inputs to operators are created before needed. In cases
where a lot of processing is required to perform logic, this may be difficult to achieve, but in most cases will not cause
problems as all logic is calculated at least four times per power frequency cycle. The possibility of a problem caused by
sequential processing emphasizes the necessity to test the performance of FlexLogic before it is placed in service.
In the following equation, virtual output 3 is used as an input to both latch 1 and timer 1 as arranged in the order shown
below:
DIG ELEM 2 OP
Cont Ip H1c On
NOT
AND(2)
= Virt Op 3
Virt Op 4 On
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Ip 1 On
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
Virt Op 3 On
OR(4)
LATCH (S,R)
Virt Op 3 On
TIMER 1
Cont Ip H1c On
OR(3)
TIMER 2
= Virt Op 4
END
In the expression above, the virtual output 4 input to the four-input OR is listed before it is created. This is typical of a
form of feedback, in this case, used to create a seal-in effect with the latch, and is correct.
5-104
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
8.
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
The logic should always be tested after it is loaded into the relay, in the same fashion as has been used in the past.
Testing can be simplified by placing an "END" operator within the overall set of FlexLogic equations. The equations
will then only be evaluated up to the first "END" operator.
The "On" and "Off" operands can be placed in an equation to establish a known set of conditions for test purposes, and
the "INSERT" and "DELETE" commands can be used to modify equations.
5.4.5 FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR
FLEXLOGIC
EQUATION EDITOR
1:
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY
END
MESSAGE
There are 512 FlexLogic entries available, numbered from 1 to 512, with default END entry settings. If a "Disabled" Element is selected as a FlexLogic entry, the associated state flag will never be set to 1. The +/ key may be used when
editing FlexLogic equations from the keypad to quickly scan through the major parameter types.
5.4.6 FLEXLOGIC TIMERS
PATH: SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC FLEXLOGIC TIMERS FLEXLOGIC TIMER 1(32)
TIMER 1
TYPE: millisecond
MESSAGE
TIMER 1 PICKUP
DELAY:
0
MESSAGE
TIMER 1 DROPOUT
DELAY:
0
FLEXLOGIC
TIMER 1
There are 32 identical FlexLogic timers available. These timers can be used as operators for FlexLogic equations.
TIMER 1 TYPE: This setting is used to select the time measuring unit.
TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set this function to "0".
TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY: Sets the time delay to dropout. If a dropout delay is not required, set this function to "0".
GE Multilin
5-105
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
5.4.7 FLEXELEMENTS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 NAME:
FxE1
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN:
Off
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN:
Off
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
MODE: Signed
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP
MODE: Level
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
DIRECTION: Over
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
HYSTERESIS: 3.0%
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt
UNIT: milliseconds
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt:
20
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
Off
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
FLEXELEMENT 1
A FlexElement is a universal comparator that can be used to monitor any analog actual value calculated by the relay or a
net difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. The effective operating signal could be treated as a signed
number or its absolute value could be used as per user's choice.
The element can be programmed to respond either to a signal level or to a rate-of-change (delta) over a pre-defined period
of time. The output operand is asserted when the operating signal is higher than a threshold or lower than a threshold as
per user's choice.
5-106
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
SETTING
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION:
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
MODE:
Enabled = 1
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP
MODE:
Disabled = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1
DIRECTION:
SETTING
FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP:
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
AND
Off = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
HYSTERESIS:
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT:
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt:
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
DELAY:
RUN
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST
DELAY:
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN:
Actual Value
FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN:
Actual Value
tPKP
+
-
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
FxE 1 OP
tRST
FxE 1 DPO
FxE 1 PKP
ACTUAL VALUE
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842004A3.CDR
GE Multilin
5-107
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over
HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP
PICKUP
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under
HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP
PICKUP
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842705A1.CDR
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Signed;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Absolute;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Signed;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Absolute;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842706A2.CDR
5-108
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP setting specifies the operating threshold for the effective operating signal of the element. If set
to Over, the element picks up when the operating signal exceeds the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value. If set to Under, the
element picks up when the operating signal falls below the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting controls the element dropout. It should be noticed that both the operating signal
and the pickup threshold can be negative facilitating applications such as reverse power alarm protection. The FlexElement can be programmed to work with all analog actual values measured by the relay. The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP setting is entered in per-unit values using the following definitions of the base units:
Table 511: FLEXELEMENT BASE UNITS
BREAKER ARCING AMPS
(Brk X Arc Amp A, B, and C)
dcmA
BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and IN inputs.
FREQUENCY
fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE
POWER FACTOR
PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs
BASE = 100C
SOURCE CURRENT
IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE ENERGY
(Positive and Negative Watthours,
Positive and Negative Varhours)
SOURCE POWER
PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE VOLTAGE
VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SYNCHROCHECK
(Max Delta Volts)
VBASE = maximum primary RMS value of all the sources related to the +IN and IN inputs
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting defines the pickupdropout relation of the element by specifying the width of the
hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown in the FlexElement Direction, Pickup, and Hysteresis diagram.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT UNIT setting specifies the time unit for the setting FLEXELEMENT 1 dt. This setting is applicable only if
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to Delta. The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT setting specifies duration of the time interval for the
rate of change mode of operation. This setting is applicable only if FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to Delta.
This FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP DELAY setting specifies the pickup delay of the element. The FLEXELEMENT 1 RST DELAY setting
specifies the reset delay of the element.
GE Multilin
5-109
5.4 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
5.4.8 NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
LATCH 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
LATCH 1 TYPE:
Reset Dominant
MESSAGE
LATCH 1 SET:
Off
MESSAGE
LATCH 1 RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
LATCH 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
LATCH 1
EVENTS: Disabled
LATCH 1
The non-volatile latches provide a permanent logical flag that is stored safely and will not reset upon reboot after the relay
is powered down. Typical applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently block relay functions, such as
Autorecloser, until a deliberate interface action resets the latch. The settings element operation is described below:
LATCH N
TYPE
LATCH N
SET
LATCH N
RESET
LATCH N
ON
LATCH N
OFF
Reset
Dominant
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Set
Dominant
OFF
OFF
Previous
State
Previous
State
SETTING
LATCH 1 FUNCTION:
LATCH 1 TYPE:
Disabled=0
RUN
Enabled=1
ON
ON
OFF
ON
SETTING
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
LATCH 1 SET:
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
Previous
State
Previous
State
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SET
Off=0
LATCH 1 ON
LATCH 1 OFF
SETTING
LATCH 1 SET:
Off=0
RESET
842005A1.CDR
5-110
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5GROUPED ELEMENTS
5.5.1 OVERVIEW
Each protection element can be assigned up to six different sets of settings according to Setting Group designations 1 to 6.
The performance of these elements is defined by the active Setting Group at a given time. Multiple setting groups allow the
user to conveniently change protection settings for different operating situations (e.g. altered power system configuration,
season of the year). The active setting group can be preset or selected via the SETTING GROUPS menu (see the Control Elements section later in this chapter). See also the Introduction to Elements section at the beginning of this chapter.
5.5.2 SETTING GROUP
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6)
SETTING GROUP 1
LINE PICKUP
MESSAGE
DISTANCE
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
DETECT
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
MESSAGE
PHASE CURRENT
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL CURRENT
MESSAGE
WATTMETRIC
GROUND FAULT
MESSAGE
GROUND CURRENT
MESSAGE
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE
CURRENT
MESSAGE
BREAKER FAILURE
MESSAGE
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
Each of the six setting group menus is identical. SETTING GROUP 1 (the default active group) automatically becomes active if
no other group is active (see the Control Elements section for additional details).
GE Multilin
5-111
5 SETTINGS
5.5.3 LINE PICKUP
LINE PICKUP
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AR CO-ORD BYPASS:
Enabled
MESSAGE
AR CO-ORD PICKUP
DELAY: 0.045 s
MESSAGE
AR CO-ORD RESET
DELAY: 0.005 s
MESSAGE
TERMINAL OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
AR ACCELERATE:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
LINE PICKUP
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
LINE PICKUP
EVENTS: Disabled
LINE PICKUP
The line pickup feature uses a combination of undercurrent and undervoltage to identify a line that has been de-energized
(line end open). Alternately, the user may assign a FlexLogic operand to the TERMINAL OPEN setting that specifies the terminal status. Three instantaneous overcurrent elements are used to identify a previously de-energized line that has been
closed onto a fault. Faults other than close-in faults can be identified satisfactorily with the distance elements.
Co-ordination features are included to ensure satisfactory operation when high speed automatic reclosure (AR) is
employed. The AR CO-ORD DELAY setting allows the overcurrent setting to be below the expected load current seen after
reclose. Co-ordination is achieved by all of the LINE PICKP UV elements resetting and blocking the trip path before the AR
CO-ORD DELAY times out. The AR CO-ORD BYPASS setting is normally enabled. It is disabled if high speed autoreclosure is
implemented.
The line pickup protection incorporates zone 1 extension capability. When the line is being re-energized from the local terminal, pickup of an overreaching zone 2 or excessive phase current within eight power cycles after the autorecloser issues
a close command results in the LINE PICKUP RCL TRIP FlexLogic operand. For security, the overcurrent trip is supervised
5-112
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
by an undervoltage condition, which in turn is controlled by the VT FUSE FAIL OP operand with a 10 ms coordination timer. If
a trip from distance in not required, then it can be disabled with the LINE PICKUP DISTANCE TRIP setting. Configure the LINE
PICKUP RCL TRIP operand to perform a trip action if the intent is apply zone 1 extension.
The zone 1 extension philosophy used here normally operates from an under-reaching zone, and uses an overreaching
distance zone when reclosing the line with the other line end open. The AR ACCELERATE setting is provided to achieve
zone 1 extension functionality if external autoreclosure is employed. Another zone 1 extension approach is to permanently
apply an overreaching zone, and reduce the reach when reclosing. This philosophy can be programmed via the autoreclose scheme.
GE Multilin
5-113
5 SETTINGS
5.5.4 DISTANCE
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) DISTANCE
DISTANCE
SOURCE: SRC 1
MESSAGE
MEMORY
DURATION: 10 cycles
MESSAGE
FORCE SELF-POLAR:
Off
MESSAGE
FORCE MEM-POLAR:
Off
MESSAGE
PHASE DISTANCE Z1
MESSAGE
PHASE DISTANCE Z2
MESSAGE
PHASE DISTANCE Z3
MESSAGE
PHASE DISTANCE Z4
MESSAGE
PHASE DISTANCE Z5
MESSAGE
GROUND DISTANCE Z1
MESSAGE
GROUND DISTANCE Z2
MESSAGE
GROUND DISTANCE Z3
MESSAGE
GROUND DISTANCE Z4
MESSAGE
GROUND DISTANCE Z5
DISTANCE
Four common settings are available for distance protection. The DISTANCE SOURCE identifies the signal source for all distance functions. The mho distance functions use a dynamic characteristic: the positive-sequence voltage either memorized or actual is used as a polarizing signal. The memory voltage is also used by the built-in directional supervising
functions applied for both the mho and quad characteristics.
The MEMORY DURATION setting specifies the length of time a memorized positive-sequence voltage should be used in the
distance calculations. After this interval expires, the relay checks the magnitude of the actual positive-sequence voltage. If
it is higher than 10% of the nominal, the actual voltage is used, if lower the memory voltage continues to be used.
The memory is established when the positive-sequence voltage stays above 80% of its nominal value for five power system
cycles. For this reason it is important to ensure that the nominal secondary voltage of the VT is entered correctly under the
SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK menu.
Set MEMORY DURATION long enough to ensure stability on close-in reverse three-phase faults. For this purpose, the maximum fault clearing time (breaker fail time) in the substation should be considered. On the other hand, the MEMORY DURATION cannot be too long as the power system may experience power swing conditions rotating the voltage and current
phasors slowly while the memory voltage is static, as frozen at the beginning of the fault. Keeping the memory in effect for
too long may eventually lead to incorrect operation of the distance functions.
5-114
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The distance zones can be forced to become self-polarized through the FORCE SELF-POLAR setting. Any user-selected condition (FlexLogic operand) can be configured to force self-polarization. When the selected operand is asserted (logic 1),
the distance functions become self-polarized regardless of other memory voltage logic conditions. When the selected operand is de-asserted (logic 0), the distance functions follow other conditions of the memory voltage logic as shown below.
The distance zones can be forced to become memory-polarized through the FORCE MEM-POLAR setting. Any user-selected
condition (any FlexLogic operand) can be configured to force memory polarization. When the selected operand is
asserted (logic 1), the distance functions become memory-polarized regardless of the positive-sequence voltage magnitude at this time. When the selected operand is de-asserted (logic 0), the distance functions follow other conditions of the
memory voltage logic.
The FORCE SELF-POLAR and FORCE MEM-POLAR settings should never be asserted simultaneously. If this happens, the logic
will give higher priority to forcing self-polarization as indicated in the logic below. This is consistent with the overall philosophy of distance memory polarization.
The memory polarization cannot be applied permanently but for a limited time only; the self-polarization may be
applied permanently and therefore should take higher priority.
NOTE
SETTING
FORCE MEM-POLAR:
UPDATE MEMORY
Off=0
AND
RUN
SETTING
SETTING
DISTANCE SOURCE:
MEMORY DURATION:
V_1 < 1.15 pu
V_A, V_RMS_A
V_B, V_RMS_B
V_C, V_RMS_C
V_1
IA
IA < 0.05 pu
IB
IB < 0.05 pu
IC
IC < 0.05 pu
V_1 < 0.1 pu
AND
AND
5 cy
S Q
t RST
AND
Use V_1 mem
OR
AND
OR
Use V_1
R
AND
SETTING
FORCE SELF-POLAR:
Off=0
827842A6.CDR
PHS DIST Z1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
SHAPE: Mho
MESSAGE
Range: None, Dy1, Dy3, Dy5, Dy7, Dy9, Dy11, Yd1, Yd3,
Yd5, Yd7, Yd9, Yd11
MESSAGE
Range: None, Dy1, Dy3, Dy5, Dy7, Dy9, Dy11, Yd1, Yd3,
Yd5, Yd7, Yd9, Yd11
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
REACH:
2.00 ohms
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
RCA: 85
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PHASE DISTANCE Z1
GE Multilin
5-115
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
COMP LIMIT: 90
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
DIR RCA: 85
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
DIR COMP LIMIT: 90
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 60 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 60 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
SUPV: 0.200 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PHS DIST Z1
EVENTS: Disabled
The phase mho distance function uses a dynamic 100% memory-polarized mho characteristic with additional reactance,
directional, and overcurrent supervising characteristics. When set to Non-directional, the mho function becomes an offset
mho with the reverse reach controlled independently from the forward reach, and all the directional characteristics
removed.
The phase quadrilateral distance function is comprised of a reactance characteristic, right and left blinders, and 100%
memory-polarized directional and current supervising characteristics. When set to Non-directional, the quadrilateral function applies a reactance line in the reverse direction instead of the directional comparators. Refer to Chapter 8 for additional
information.
Each phase distance zone is configured individually through its own setting menu. All of the settings can be independently
modified for each of the zones except:
1.
2.
The MEMORY DURATION setting (common for the distance elements of all zones as entered under SETTINGS
GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) DISTANCE).
The common distance settings described earlier must be properly chosen for correct operation of the phase distance elements. Additional details may be found in Chapter 8: Theory of Operation.
Although all zones can be used as either instantaneous elements (pickup [PKP] and dropout [DPO] FlexLogic operands)
or time-delayed elements (operate [OP] FlexLogic operands), only zone 1 is intended for the instantaneous under-reaching tripping mode.
5-116
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Ensure that the PHASE VT SECONDARY VOLTAGE setting (see the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS
VOLTAGE BANK menu) is set correctly to prevent improper operation of associated memory action.
WARNING
PHS DIST Z1 DIR: All phase distance zones are reversible. The forward direction is defined by the PHS DIST Z1 RCA
setting, whereas the reverse direction is shifted 180 from that angle. The non-directional zone spans between the forward reach impedance defined by the PHS DIST Z1 REACH and PHS DIST Z1 RCA settings, and the reverse reach impedance defined by PHS DIST Z1 REV REACH and PHS DIST Z1 REV REACH RCA as illustrated below.
PHS DIST Z1 SHAPE: This setting selects the shape of the phase distance function between the mho and quadrilateral characteristics. The selection is available on a per-zone basis. The two characteristics and their possible variations are shown in the following figures.
COMP LIMIT
REAC
H
837720A1.CDR
R E AC H
COMP LIMIT
RCA
REV REACH
RCA
REV R
E AC H
837802A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-117
5 SETTINGS
COMP LIMIT
COMP LIMIT
REACH
R
RGT BLD
-LFT BLD
837721A1.CDR
COMP LIMIT
COMP LIMIT
R E AC H
RCA
R
-LFT BLD
COMP LIMIT
R E V R E AC H
RGT BLD
REV REACH
RCA
COMP LIMIT
837803A1.CDR
5-118
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
RCA
= 80o
COMP LIMIT
= 90o
DIR RCA
= 80o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 60o
REAC
H
REAC
H
RCA
= 80o
COMP LIMIT
= 90o
DIR RCA
= 80o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 90o
RCA
= 80o
COMP LIMIT
= 60o
DIR RCA
= 80o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 60o
REAC
H
REACH
RCA
= 90o
COMP LIMIT
= 90o
DIR RCA
= 45o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 90o
R
837722A1.CDR
REAC
H
RCA
= 90o
COMP LIMIT
= 90o
DIR RCA
= 45o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 90o
RGT BLD RCA = 90o
LFT BLD RCA
= 90o
RCA
= 80o
COMP LIMIT
= 80o
DIR RCA
= 45o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 60o
RGT BLD RCA = 80o
LFT BLD RCA
= 80o
REAC
H
REACH
RCA
= 80o
COMP LIMIT
= 90o
DIR RCA
= 80o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 60o
RGT BLD RCA = 80o
LFT BLD RCA
= 80o
REAC
H
RCA
= 80o
COMP LIMIT
= 90o
DIR RCA
= 80o
DIR COMP LIMIT = 90o
RGT BLD RCA = 80o
LFT BLD RCA
= 80o
837723A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-119
5 SETTINGS
PHS DIST Z1 XFMR VOL CONNECTION: The phase distance elements can be applied to look through a three-phase
delta-wye or wye-delta power transformer. In addition, VTs and CTs could be located independently from one another
at different windings of the transformer. If the potential source is located at the correct side of the transformer, this setting shall be set to None.
This setting specifies the location of the voltage source with respect to the involved power transformer in the direction
of the zone. The following figure illustrates the usage of this setting. In section (a), Zone 1 is looking through a transformer from the delta into the wye winding. Therefore, the Z1 setting shall be set to Dy11. In section (b), Zone 4 is
looking through a transformer from the wye into the delta winding. Therefore, the Z4 setting shall be set to Yd1. The
zone is restricted by the potential point (location of the VTs) as illustrated in Figure (e).
PHS DIST Z1 XFMR CUR CONNECTION: This setting specifies the location of the current source with respect to the
involved power transformer in the direction of the zone. In section (a) of the following figure, Zone 1 is looking through
a transformer from the delta into the wye winding. Therefore, the Z1 setting shall be set to Dy11. In section (b), the
CTs are located at the same side as the read point. Therefore, the Z4 setting shall be set to None.
See the Theory of Operation chapter for more details, and the Application of Settings chapter for information on calculating distance reach settings in applications involving power transformers.
(a)
delta
(b)
Z4
Z4
delta
Z1
Z1
(c)
delta
(e)
L1
Z4
L2
Zone 4
Zone 1
ZL1
ZT
ZL2
Z1
Z1 XFRM VOL CONNECTION = Dy11
Z1 XFRM CUR CONNECTION = None
PHS DIST Z1 REACH: This setting defines the zone reach for the forward and reverse applications. In the non-directional applications, this setting defines the forward reach of the zone. The reverse reach impedance in non-directional
applications is set independently. The reach impedance is entered in secondary ohms. The reach impedance angle is
entered as the PHS DIST Z1 RCA setting.
Zone 1 is characterized by transient overreach of less than 5% under source impedance ratios of up to 30. When setting an under-reaching Zone 1 for direct tripping and under-reaching pilot schemes (DUTT, PUTT) other factors should
be also considered as per rules of distance relaying. In non-directional applications, this 5% transient accuracy applies
to the forward reach only.
PHS DIST Z1 RCA: This setting specifies the characteristic angle (similar to the maximum torque angle in previous
technologies) of the phase distance characteristic for the forward and reverse applications. In the non-directional applications, this setting defines the angle of the forward reach impedance. The reverse reach impedance in the non-direc-
5-120
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
tional applications is set independently. The setting is an angle of reach impedance as shown in the distance
characteristic figures shown earlier. This setting is independent from PHS DIST Z1 DIR RCA, the characteristic angle of an
extra directional supervising function.
PHS DIST Z1 REV REACH: This setting defines the reverse reach of the zone set to non-directional (PHS DIST Z1 DIR
setting). The value must be entered in secondary ohms. This setting does not apply when the zone direction is set to
Forward or Reverse.
PHS DIST Z1 REV REACH RCA: This setting defines the angle of the reverse reach impedance if the zone is set to
non-directional (PHS DIST Z1 DIR setting). This setting does not apply when the zone direction is set to Forward or
Reverse.
PHS DIST Z1 COMP LIMIT: This setting shapes the operating characteristic. In particular, it produces the lens-type
characteristic of the mho function and a tent-shaped characteristic of the reactance boundary of the quadrilateral function. If the mho shape is selected, the same limit angle applies to both the mho and supervising reactance comparators. In conjunction with the mho shape selection, the setting improves loadability of the protected line. In conjunction
with the quadrilateral characteristic, this setting improves security for faults close to the reach point by adjusting the
reactance boundary into a tent-shape.
PHS DIST Z1 DIR RCA: This setting selects the characteristic angle (or maximum torque angle) of the directional
supervising function. If the mho shape is applied, the directional function is an extra supervising function as the
dynamic mho characteristic is itself directional. In conjunction with the quadrilateral shape, this setting defines the only
directional function built into the phase distance element. The directional function uses the memory voltage for polarization. This setting typically equals the distance characteristic angle PHS DIST Z1 RCA.
PHS DIST Z1 DIR COMP LIMIT: Selects the comparator limit angle for the directional supervising function.
PHS DIST Z1 QUAD RGT BLD: This setting defines the right blinder position of the quadrilateral characteristic along
the resistive axis of the impedance plane (see the Quadrilateral Distance Characteristic figures). The angular position
of the blinder is adjustable with the use of the PHS DIST Z1 QUAD RGT BLD RCA setting. This setting applies only to the
quadrilateral characteristic and should be set giving consideration to the maximum load current and required resistive
coverage.
PHS DIST Z1 QUAD RGT BLD RCA: This setting defines the angular position of the right blinder of the quadrilateral
characteristic (see the Quadrilateral Distance Characteristic figures).
PHS DIST Z1 QUAD LFT BLD: This setting defines the left blinder position of the quadrilateral characteristic along the
resistive axis of the impedance plane (see the Quadrilateral Distance Characteristic figure). The angular position of the
blinder is adjustable with the use of the PHS DIST Z1 QUAD LFT BLD RCA setting. This setting applies only to the quadrilateral characteristic and should be set with consideration to the maximum load current.
PHS DIST Z1 QUAD LFT BLD RCA: This setting defines the angular position of the left blinder of the quadrilateral
characteristic (see the Quadrilateral Distance Characteristic figures).
PHS DIST Z1 SUPV: The phase distance elements are supervised by the magnitude of the line-to-line current (fault
loop current used for the distance calculations). For convenience, 3 is accommodated by the pickup (i.e., before
being used, the entered value of the threshold setting is multiplied by 3 ).
If the minimum fault current level is sufficient, the current supervision pickup should be set above maximum full load
current preventing maloperation under VT fuse fail conditions. This requirement may be difficult to meet for remote
faults at the end of Zones 2 through 5. If this is the case, the current supervision pickup would be set below the full load
current, but this may result in maloperation during fuse fail conditions.
Zone 1 is sealed-in with the current supervision.
PHS DIST Z1 VOLT LEVEL: This setting is relevant for applications on series-compensated lines, or in general, if
series capacitors are located between the relaying point and a point where the zone shall not overreach. For plain
(non-compensated) lines, set to zero. Otherwise, the setting is entered in per unit of the phase VT bank configured
under the DISTANCE SOURCE. Effectively, this setting facilitates dynamic current-based reach reduction. In non-directional applications (PHS DIST Z1 DIR set to Non-directional), this setting applies only to the forward reach of the nondirectional zone. See Chapters 8 and 9 for information on calculating this setting for series compensated lines.
PHS DIST Z1 DELAY: This setting allows the user to delay operation of the distance elements and implement stepped
distance protection. The distance element timers for Zones 2 through 5 apply a short dropout delay to cope with faults
located close to the zone boundary when small oscillations in the voltages and/or currents could inadvertently reset the
timer. Zone 1 does not need any drop out delay since it is sealed-in by the presence of current.
GE Multilin
5-121
5 SETTINGS
PHS DIST Z1 BLK: This setting enables the user to select a FlexLogic operand to block a given distance element.
VT fuse fail detection is one of the applications for this setting.
AND
OR
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
PH DIST Z1 PKP AB
t PKP
PH DIST Z1 PKP BC
t PKP
PH DIST Z1 PKP CA
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
PHS DIST Z1
DELAY:
OR
AND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PH DIST Z1 OP AB
AND
PH DIST Z1 OP BC
AND
PH DIST Z1 OP
PH DIST Z1 OP CA
AND
OPEN POLE OP *
NOTE: * D60 Only. Other UR models apply regular current seal-in for Z1.
837017A6.CDR
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 PKP AB
PH DIST Z2 DELAY:
AND
20 ms
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 OP AB
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 PKP BC
PH DIST Z2 DELAY:
AND
20 ms
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 OP BC
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 PKP CA
PH DIST Z2 DELAY:
AND
20 ms
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 OP CA
0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIST Z2 OP
837020A7.CDR
5-122
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTINGS
PHS DIST Z1 DIR:
PHS DIST Z1 SHAPE:
PHS DIST Z1 XFMR
VOL CONNECTION:
PHS DIST Z1 XFMR
CUR CONNECTION:
SETTINGS
Disable=0
Enable=1
SETTING
AND
SETTING
DISTANCE SOURCE:
IA-IB
QUAD ONLY
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
A-B ELEMENT
IB-IC
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IC-IA
RUN
DELTA
VAG-VBG
VAB
VBG-VCG
VBC
VCG-VAG
V_1
VCA
B-C ELEMENT
RUN
AND
PH DIST Z1 PKP AB
PH DIST Z1 DPO AB
D60 ONLY
VT CONNECTION
WYE
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE BLK BC
AND
PH DIST Z1 PKP BC
PH DIST Z1 DPO BC
C-A ELEMENT
I_1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
MEMORY
AND
PH DIST Z1 PKP CA
PH DIST Z1 DPO CA
1 CYCLE
1 CYCLE
OR
PH DIST Z1 PKP
SETTING
PHS DIST Z1
SUPV:
RUN
IA - IB > 3 PICKUP
RUN
IB - IC > 3 PICKUP
RUN
IC - IA > 3 PICKUP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
837002AH.CDR
GND DIST Z1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
SHAPE: Mho
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
Z0/Z1 MAG: 2.70
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
Z0/Z1 ANG: 0
Range: 90 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
ZOM/Z1 MAG: 0.00
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
ZOM/Z1 ANG: 0
Range: 90 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
REACH: 2.00
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
RCA: 85
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
GROUND DISTANCE Z1
GE Multilin
5-123
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
COMP LIMIT: 90
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
DIR RCA: 85
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
DIR COMP LIMIT: 90
Range: 30 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 60 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 60 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
SUPV: 0.200 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
DELAY:0.000 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
TARGET: Self-Reset
MESSAGE
GND DIST Z1
EVENTS: Disabled
The ground mho distance function uses a dynamic 100% memory-polarized mho characteristic with additional reactance,
directional, current, and phase selection supervising characteristics. The ground quadrilateral distance function is composed of a reactance characteristic, right and left blinders, and 100% memory-polarized directional, overcurrent, and phase
selection supervising characteristics.
When set to non-directional, the mho function becomes an offset mho with the reverse reach controlled independently from
the forward reach, and all the directional characteristics removed. When set to non-directional, the quadrilateral function
applies a reactance line in the reverse direction instead of the directional comparators.
The reactance supervision for the mho function uses the zero-sequence current for polarization. The reactance line of the
quadrilateral function uses either zero-sequence or negative-sequence current as a polarizing quantity. The selection is
controlled by a user setting and depends on the degree of non-homogeneity of the zero-sequence and negative-sequence
equivalent networks.
The directional supervision uses memory voltage as polarizing quantity and both zero- and negative-sequence currents as
operating quantities.
5-124
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The phase selection supervision restrains the ground elements during double-line-to-ground faults as they by principles
of distance relaying may be inaccurate in such conditions. Ground distance zones 2 through 5 apply additional zerosequence directional supervision. See Chapter 8 for additional details.
Each ground distance zone is configured individually through its own setting menu. All of the settings can be independently
modified for each of the zones except:
1.
The SIGNAL SOURCE setting (common for both phase and ground elements for all zones as entered under the SETTINGS
GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) DISTANCE menu).
2.
The MEMORY DURATION setting (common for both phase and ground elements for all zones as entered under the SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) DISTANCE menu).
The common distance settings noted at the start of the Distance section must be properly chosen for correct operation of
the ground distance elements.
Although all ground distance zones can be used as either instantaneous elements (pickup [PKP] and dropout [DPO] FlexLogic signals) or time-delayed elements (operate [OP] FlexLogic signals), only zone 1 is intended for the instantaneous
under-reaching tripping mode.
Ensure that the PHASE VT SECONDARY VOLTAGE (see the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE
menu) is set correctly to prevent improper operation of associated memory action.
BANK
WARNING
GND DIST Z1 DIR: All ground distance zones are reversible. The forward direction is defined by the GND DIST Z1 RCA
setting and the reverse direction is shifted by 180 from that angle. The non-directional zone spans between the forward reach impedance defined by the GND DIST Z1 REACH and GND DIST Z1 RCA settings, and the reverse reach impedance defined by the GND DIST Z1 REV REACH and GND DIST Z1 REV REACH RCA settings.
GND DIST Z1 SHAPE: This setting selects the shape of the ground distance characteristic between the mho and
quadrilateral characteristics. The selection is available on a per-zone basis.
The directional and non-directional quadrilateral ground distance characteristics are shown below. The directional and
non-directional mho ground distance characteristics are the same as those shown for the phase distance element in
the previous sub-section.
X
"+" NON-HOMOGEN. ANG
"-" NON-HOMOGEN. ANG
COMP LIMIT
COMP LIMIT
REACH
RCA
R
RGT BLD
-LFT BLD
837769A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-125
5 SETTINGS
X
"+" NON-HOMOGEN. ANG
"-" NON-HOMOGEN. ANG
COMP LIMIT
REACH
COMP LIMIT
RCA
R
RGT BLD
REV REACH
RCA
COMP LIMIT
RE V REACH
-LFT BLD
COMP LIMIT
GND DIST Z1 Z0/Z1 MAG: This setting specifies the ratio between the zero-sequence and positive-sequence impedance required for zero-sequence compensation of the ground distance elements. This setting is available on a perzone basis, enabling precise settings for tapped, non-homogeneous, and series compensated lines.
GND DIST Z1 Z0/Z1 ANG: This setting specifies the angle difference between the zero-sequence and positivesequence impedance required for zero-sequence compensation of the ground distance elements. The entered value is
the zero-sequence impedance angle minus the positive-sequence impedance angle. This setting is available on a perzone basis, enabling precise values for tapped, non-homologous, and series-compensated lines.
GND DIST Z1 ZOM/Z1 MAG: The ground distance elements can be programmed to apply compensation for the zerosequence mutual coupling between parallel lines. If this compensation is required, the ground current from the parallel
line (3I_0) measured in the direction of the zone being compensated must be connected to the ground input CT of the
CT bank configured under the DISTANCE SOURCE. This setting specifies the ratio between the magnitudes of the mutual
zero-sequence impedance between the lines and the positive-sequence impedance of the protected line. It is imperative to set this setting to zero if the compensation is not to be performed.
GND DIST Z1 ZOM/Z1 ANG: This setting specifies the angle difference between the mutual zero-sequence impedance between the lines and the positive-sequence impedance of the protected line.
GND DIST Z1 REACH: This setting defines the reach of the zone for the forward and reverse applications. In nondirectional applications, this setting defines the forward reach of the zone. The reverse reach impedance in non-directional applications is set independently. The angle of the reach impedance is entered as the GND DIST Z1 RCA setting.
The reach impedance is entered in secondary ohms.
GND DIST Z1 RCA: This setting specifies the characteristic angle (similar to the maximum torque angle in previous
technologies) of the ground distance characteristic for the forward and reverse applications. In the non-directional
applications this setting defines the forward reach of the zone. The reverse reach impedance in the non-directional
applications is set independently. This setting is independent from the GND DIST Z1 DIR RCA setting (the characteristic
angle of an extra directional supervising function).
NOTE
5-126
The relay internally performs zero-sequence compensation for the protected circuit based on the values
entered for GND DIST Z1 Z0/Z1 MAG and GND DIST Z1 Z0/Z1 ANG, and if configured to do so, zero-sequence compensation for mutual coupling based on the values entered for GND DIST Z1 Z0M/Z1 MAG and GND DIST Z1 Z0M/Z1
ANG. The GND DIST Z1 REACH and GND DIST Z1 RCA should, therefore, be entered in terms of positive sequence
quantities. Refer to chapters 8 for additional information
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
GND DIST Z1 REV REACH: This setting defines the reverse reach of the zone set to non-directional (GND DIST Z1 DIR
setting). The value must be entered in secondary ohms. This setting does not apply when the zone direction is set to
Forward or Reverse.
GND DIST Z1 REV REACH RCA: This setting defines the angle of the reverse reach impedance if the zone is set to
non-directional (GND DIST Z1 DIR setting). This setting does not apply when the zone direction is set to Forward or
Reverse.
GND DIST Z1 POL CURRENT: This setting applies only if the GND DIST Z1 SHAPE is set to Quad and controls the
polarizing current used by the reactance comparator of the quadrilateral characteristic. Either the zero-sequence or
negative-sequence current could be used. In general, a variety of system conditions must be examined to select an
optimum polarizing current. This setting becomes less relevant when the resistive coverage and zone reach are set
conservatively. Also, this setting is more relevant in lower voltage applications such as on distribution lines or cables,
as compared with high-voltage transmission lines. This setting applies to both the Z1 and reverse reactance lines if the
zone is set to non-directional. Refer to chapters 8 and 9 for additional information.
GND DIST Z1 NON-HOMOGEN ANG: This setting applies only if the GND DIST Z1 SHAPE is set to Quad and provides
a method to correct the angle of the polarizing current of the reactance comparator for non-homogeneity of the zerosequence or negative-sequence networks. In general, a variety of system conditions must be examined to select this
setting. In many applications this angle is used to reduce the reach at high resistances in order to avoid overreaching
under far-out reach settings and/or when the sequence networks are greatly non-homogeneous. This setting applies to
both the forward and reverse reactance lines if the zone is set to non-directional. Refer to chapters 8 and 9 for additional information.
GND DIST Z1 COMP LIMIT: This setting shapes the operating characteristic. In particular, it enables a lens-shaped
characteristic of the mho function and a tent-shaped characteristic of the quadrilateral function reactance boundary. If
the mho shape is selected, the same limit angle applies to mho and supervising reactance comparators. In conjunction
with the mho shape selection, this setting improves loadability of the protected line. In conjunction with the quadrilateral characteristic, this setting improves security for faults close to the reach point by adjusting the reactance boundary
into a tent-shape.
GND DIST Z1 DIR RCA: Selects the characteristic angle (or maximum torque angle) of the directional supervising
function. If the mho shape is applied, the directional function is an extra supervising function, as the dynamic mho
characteristic itself is a directional one. In conjunction with the quadrilateral shape selection, this setting defines the
only directional function built into the ground distance element. The directional function uses memory voltage for polarization.
GND DIST Z1 DIR COMP LIMIT: This setting selects the comparator limit angle for the directional supervising function.
GND DIST Z1 QUAD RGT BLD: This setting defines the right blinder position of the quadrilateral characteristic along
the resistive axis of the impedance plane (see the Quadrilateral Distance Characteristic figure). The angular position of
the blinder is adjustable with the use of the GND DIST Z1 QUAD RGT BLD RCA setting. This setting applies only to the
quadrilateral characteristic and should be set with consideration to the maximum load current and required resistive
coverage.
GND DIST Z1 QUAD RGT BLD RCA: This setting defines the angular position of the right blinder of the quadrilateral
characteristic (see the Quadrilateral distance characteristic figure).
GND DIST Z1 QUAD LFT BLD: This setting defines the left blinder position of the quadrilateral characteristic along the
resistive axis of the impedance plane (see the Quadrilateral distance characteristic figure). The angular position of the
blinder is adjustable with the use of the GND DIST Z1 QUAD LFT BLD RCA setting. This setting applies only to the quadrilateral characteristic and should be set with consideration to the maximum load current.
GND DIST Z1 QUAD LFT BLD RCA: This setting defines the angular position of the left blinder of the quadrilateral
characteristic (see the Quadrilateral distance characteristic figure).
GND DIST Z1 SUPV: The ground distance elements are supervised by the magnitude of the neutral (3I_0) current.
The current supervision pickup should be set above the maximum unbalance current under maximum load conditions
preventing maloperation due to VT fuse failure.
Zone 1 is sealed in with the current supervision.
GND DIST Z1 VOLT LEVEL: This setting is relevant for applications on series-compensated lines, or in general, if
series capacitors are located between the relaying point and a point for which the zone shall not overreach. For plain
(non-compensated) lines, this setting shall be set to zero. Otherwise, the setting is entered in per unit of the VT bank
configured under the DISTANCE SOURCE. Effectively, this setting facilitates dynamic current-based reach reduction. In
GE Multilin
5-127
5 SETTINGS
non-directional applications (GND DIST Z1 DIR set to Non-directional), this setting applies only to the forward reach of
the non-directional zone. See Chapter 8 and 9 for additional details and information on calculating this setting value for
applications on series compensated lines.
GND DIST Z1 DELAY: This setting enables the user to delay operation of the distance elements and implement a
stepped distance backup protection. The distance element timer applies a short drop out delay to cope with faults
located close to the boundary of the zone when small oscillations in the voltages or currents could inadvertently reset
the timer.
GND DIST Z1 BLK: This setting enables the user to select a FlexLogic operand to block the given distance element.
VT fuse fail detection is one of the applications for this setting.
SETTINGS
GND DIST Z1 DIR:
GND DIST Z1 SHAPE:
GND DIST Z1 Z0/Z1 MAG:
GND DIST Z1 Z0/Z1 ANG:
GND DIST Z1 Z0M/Z1 MAG:
GND DIST Z1 Z0M/Z1 ANG:
GND DIST Z1 REACH:
SETTINGS
Disable=0
Enable=1
SETTING
AND
Off=0
SETTING
DISTANCE SOURCE:
RUN
IA
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
A ELEMENT
IB
IC
RUN
VT CONNECTION
WYE
DELTA
VAG-VBG
VAB
VBG-VCG
VBC
VCG-VAG
VCA
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
B ELEMENT
RUN
I_2
C ELEMENT
I_0
V_1
I_1
AND
OPEN POLE OP A
D60 ONLY
QUAD ONLY
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
MEMORY
AND
OPEN POLE OP B
AND
OPEN POLE OP C
IN
V_1 > 0.80pu
OR
1 CYCLE
OR
1 CYCLE
SETTING
GND DIST Z1
SUPV:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RUN
IN
PICKUP
837007AC.CDR
5-128
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTINGS
GND DIST Z2 DIR:
GND DIST Z2 SHAPE:
GND DIST Z2 Z0/Z2 MAG:
GND DIST Z2 Z0/Z2 ANG:
GND DIST Z2 Z0M/Z1 MAG:
GND DIST Z2 Z0M/Z1 ANG:
GND DIST Z2 REACH:
SETTINGS
Disable=0
Enable=1
SETTING
AND
Off=0
SETTING
QUAD ONLY
DISTANCE SOURCE:
IA
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
A ELEMENT
IB
IC
RUN
VT CONNECTION
DELTA
VAB
VBC
VCG-VAG
VCA
B ELEMENT
RUN
I_2
C ELEMENT
I_0
V_1
I_1
OPEN POLE OP A
D60 ONLY
WYE
VAG-VBG
VBG-VCG
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
MEMORY
OPEN POLE OP B
OPEN POLE OP C
IN
V_1 > 0.80pu
OR
1 CYCLE
OR
1 CYCLE
SETTING
GND DIST Z2
SUPV:
RUN
IN
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GND DIST Z2 SUPN IN
PICKUP
OR
837011AE.CDR
GND DIST Z1 OP A
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GND DIST Z1
DELAY:
AND
GND DIST Z1 OP C
OR
t PKP
GND DIST Z1 OP B
0
t PKP
0
t PKP
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
OR
GND DIST Z1 OP
OPEN POLE OP *
OR
NOTE: * D60 Only. Other UR models apply regular current seal-in for Z1.
837018A5.CDR
GE Multilin
5-129
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE OP*
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 PKP A
AND
20 ms
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 OP A
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 PKP B
AND
20 ms
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 OP B
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 PKP C
AND
20 ms
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 OP C
0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GND DIST Z2 OP
837019A7.CDR
Ground distance zones 2 through 5 use an additional ground directional supervision to enhance directional integrity. The
elements directional characteristic angle is used as a maximum torque angle together with a 90 limit angle.
The supervision is biased toward operation in order to avoid compromising the sensitivity of ground distance elements at
low signal levels. Otherwise, the reverse fault condition that generates concern will have high polarizing levels so that a correct reverse fault decision can be reliably made. The supervision for zones 2, 3, and 5 is removed during open pole conditions.
RUN
ZERO SEQ
DIRECTIONAL
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE OP
AND
t RST
CO-ORDINATING TIME
Pickup 4.5 cycles, Reset 1.0 cycle
837009A6.CDR
5-130
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) POWER SWING DETECT
POWER SWING
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
SOURCE: SRC 1
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
SHAPE: Mho Shape
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
MODE: Two Step
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
SUPV: 0.600 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 40 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 40 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
DETECT
GE Multilin
5-131
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
TARGET: Self-Reset
MESSAGE
POWER SWING
EVENTS: Disabled
The power swing detect element provides both power swing blocking and out-of-step tripping functions. The element measures the positive-sequence apparent impedance and traces its locus with respect to either two or three user-selectable
operating characteristic boundaries. Upon detecting appropriate timing relations, the blocking and/or tripping indication is
given through FlexLogic operands. The element incorporates an adaptive disturbance detector. This function does not
trigger on power swings, but is capable of detecting faster disturbances faults in particular that may occur during power
swings. Operation of this dedicated disturbance detector is signaled via the POWER SWING 50DD operand.
The power swing detect element asserts two outputs intended for blocking selected protection elements on power swings:
POWER SWING BLOCK is a traditional signal that is safely asserted for the entire duration of the power swing, and POWER
SWING UN/BLOCK is established in the same way, but resets when an extra disturbance is detected during the power swing.
The POWER SWING UN/BLOCK operand may be used for blocking selected protection elements if the intent is to respond to
Three-step operation: The power swing blocking sequence essentially times the passage of the locus of the positivesequence impedance between the outer and the middle characteristic boundaries. If the locus enters the outer characteristic (indicated by the POWER SWING OUTER FlexLogic operand) but stays outside the middle characteristic (indicated by the POWER SWING MIDDLE FlexLogic operand) for an interval longer than POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 1,
the power swing blocking signal (POWER SWING BLOCK FlexLogic operand) is established and sealed-in. The blocking signal resets when the locus leaves the outer characteristic, but not sooner than the POWER SWING RESET DELAY 1
time.
Two-step operation: If the 2-step mode is selected, the sequence is identical, but it is the outer and inner characteristics that are used to time the power swing locus.
5-132
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The out-of-step tripping feature operates as follows for three-step and two-step power swing detection modes:
Three-step operation: The out-of-step trip sequence identifies unstable power swings by determining if the impedance locus spends a finite time between the outer and middle characteristics and then a finite time between the middle
and inner characteristics. The first step is similar to the power swing blocking sequence. After timer POWER SWING
PICKUP DELAY 1 times out, latch 1 is set as long as the impedance stays within the outer characteristic.
If afterwards, at any time (given the impedance stays within the outer characteristic), the locus enters the middle characteristic but stays outside the inner characteristic for a period of time defined as POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 2, latch
2 is set as long as the impedance stays inside the outer characteristic. If afterwards, at any time (given the impedance
stays within the outer characteristic), the locus enters the inner characteristic and stays there for a period of time
defined as POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 3, latch 2 is set as long as the impedance stays inside the outer characteristic;
the element is now ready to trip.
If the "Early" trip mode is selected, the POWER SWING TRIP operand is set immediately and sealed-in for the interval
set by the POWER SWING SEAL-IN DELAY. If the "Delayed" trip mode is selected, the element waits until the impedance
locus leaves the inner characteristic, then times out the POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 2 and sets Latch 4; the element is
now ready to trip. The trip operand is set later, when the impedance locus leaves the outer characteristic.
Two-step operation: The 2-step mode of operation is similar to the three-step mode with two exceptions. First, the initial stage monitors the time spent by the impedance locus between the outer and inner characteristics. Second, the
stage involving the POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 2 timer is bypassed. It is up to the user to integrate the blocking
(POWER SWING BLOCK) and tripping (POWER SWING TRIP) FlexLogic operands with other protection functions and
output contacts in order to make this element fully operational.
The element can be set to use either lens (mho) or rectangular (quad) characteristics as illustrated below. When set to
Mho, the element applies the right and left blinders as well. If the blinders are not required, their settings should be set
high enough to effectively disable the blinders.
X
R
NE
IN
ID
FWD RE
DL
ACH
TE
OU
CA
DR
FW
RE
VR
IT
REV REAC
H
CA
E
NN
LIM
AN
LE
DD
MI
I
LIM
LE
NG
TA
E
GL
827843A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-133
5 SETTINGS
842734A1.CDR
5
ACH OUT
ACH MID
REV REACH
FWD RCA
QUAD FWD RE
QUAD FWD RE
OUTER RGT BL
H OUT
BLD
QUAD REV RE
AC
OUTER LFT BL
MIDDLE RGT
FWD REACH
INNER RGT BL
CH MID
MIDDLE LFT BL
INNER LFT BL
842735A1.CDR
The POWER SWING OUTER, POWER SWING MIDDLE, POWER SWING INNER, POWER SWING TMR2 PKP, POWER SWING
TMR3 PKP, and POWER SWING TMR4 PKP FlexLogic operands are auxiliary operands that could be used to facilitate
testing and special applications.
The POWER SWING BLOCK FlexLogic operand shall be used to block selected protection elements such as distance
functions.
5-134
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The POWER SWING UN/BLOCK FlexLogic operand shall be used to block those protection elements that are intended
to be blocked under power swings, but subsequently unblocked should a fault occur after the power swing blocking
condition has been established.
The POWER SWING 50DD FlexLogic operand indicates that an adaptive disturbance detector integrated with the element has picked up. This operand will trigger on faults occurring during power swing conditions. This includes both
three-phase and single-pole-open conditions.
The POWER SWING INCOMING FlexLogic operand indicates an unstable power swing with an incoming locus (the
locus enters the inner characteristic).
The POWER SWING OUTGOING FlexLogic operand indicates an unstable power swing with an outgoing locus (the
locus leaving the outer characteristic). This operand can be used to count unstable swings and take certain action only
after pre-defined number of unstable power swings.
The settings for the power swing detect element are described below:
POWER SWING FUNCTION: This setting enables/disables the entire power swing detection element. The setting
applies to both power swing blocking and out-of-step tripping functions.
POWER SWING SOURCE: The source setting identifies the signal source for both blocking and tripping functions.
POWER SWING SHAPE: This setting selects the shapes (either Mho or Quad) of the outer, middle and, inner characteristics of the power swing detect element. The operating principle is not affected. The Mho characteristics use the
left and right blinders.
POWER SWING MODE: This setting selects between the two-step and three-step operating modes and applies to
both power swing blocking and out-of-step tripping functions. The three-step mode applies if there is enough space
between the maximum load impedances and distance characteristics of the relay that all three (outer, middle, and
inner) characteristics can be placed between the load and the distance characteristics. Whether the spans between
the outer and middle as well as the middle and inner characteristics are sufficient should be determined by analysis of
the fastest power swings expected in correlation with settings of the power swing timers.
The two-step mode uses only the outer and inner characteristics for both blocking and tripping functions. This leaves
more space in heavily loaded systems to place two power swing characteristics between the distance characteristics
and the maximum load, but allows for only one determination of the impedance trajectory.
POWER SWING SUPV: A common overcurrent pickup level supervises all three power swing characteristics. The
supervision responds to the positive sequence current.
POWER SWING FWD REACH: This setting specifies the forward reach of all three mho characteristics and the inner
quad characteristic. For a simple system consisting of a line and two equivalent sources, this reach should be higher
than the sum of the line and remote source positive-sequence impedances. Detailed transient stability studies may be
needed for complex systems in order to determine this setting. The angle of this reach impedance is specified by the
POWER SWING FWD RCA setting.
POWER SWING QUAD FWD REACH MID: This setting specifies the forward reach of the middle quad characteristic.
The angle of this reach impedance is specified by the POWER SWING FWD RCA setting. The setting is not used if the
shape setting is Mho.
POWER SWING QUAD FWD REACH OUT: This setting specifies the forward reach of the outer quad characteristic.
The angle of this reach impedance is specified by the POWER SWING FWD RCA setting. The setting is not used if the
shape setting is Mho.
POWER SWING FWD RCA: This setting specifies the angle of the forward reach impedance for the mho characteristics, angles of all the blinders, and both forward and reverse reach impedances of the quad characteristics.
POWER SWING REV REACH: This setting specifies the reverse reach of all three mho characteristics and the inner
quad characteristic. For a simple system of a line and two equivalent sources, this reach should be higher than the
positive-sequence impedance of the local source. Detailed transient stability studies may be needed for complex systems to determine this setting. The angle of this reach impedance is specified by the POWER SWING REV RCA setting for
Mho, and the POWER SWING FWD RCA setting for Quad.
POWER SWING QUAD REV REACH MID: This setting specifies the reverse reach of the middle quad characteristic.
The angle of this reach impedance is specified by the POWER SWING FWD RCA setting. The setting is not used if the
shape setting is Mho.
GE Multilin
5-135
5 SETTINGS
POWER SWING QUAD REV REACH OUT: This setting specifies the reverse reach of the outer quad characteristic.
The angle of this reach impedance is specified by the POWER SWING FWD RCA setting. The setting is not used if the
shape setting is Mho.
POWER SWING REV RCA: This setting specifies the angle of the reverse reach impedance for the mho characteristics. This setting applies to mho shapes only.
POWER SWING OUTER LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines the outer power swing characteristic. The convention
depicted in the Power swing detect characteristic diagram should be observed: values greater than 90 result in an
apple-shaped characteristic; values less than 90 result in a lens shaped characteristic. This angle must be selected in
consideration of the maximum expected load. If the maximum load angle is known, the outer limit angle should be
coordinated with a 20 security margin. Detailed studies may be needed for complex systems to determine this setting.
This setting applies to mho shapes only.
POWER SWING MIDDLE LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines the middle power swing detect characteristic. It is relevant only for the 3-step mode. A typical value would be close to the average of the outer and inner limit angles. This
setting applies to mho shapes only.
POWER SWING INNER LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines the inner power swing detect characteristic. The inner
characteristic is used by the out-of-step tripping function: beyond the inner characteristic out-of-step trip action is definite (the actual trip may be delayed as per the TRIP MODE setting). Therefore, this angle must be selected in consideration to the power swing angle beyond which the system becomes unstable and cannot recover.
The inner characteristic is also used by the power swing blocking function in the two-step mode. In this case, set this
angle large enough so that the characteristics of the distance elements are safely enclosed by the inner characteristic.
This setting applies to mho shapes only.
POWER SWING OUTER, MIDDLE, and INNER RGT BLD: These settings specify the resistive reach of the right
blinder. The blinder applies to both Mho and Quad characteristics. Set these value high if no blinder is required for
the Mho characteristic.
POWER SWING OUTER, MIDDLE, and INNER LFT BLD: These settings specify the resistive reach of the left blinder.
Enter a positive value; the relay automatically uses a negative value. The blinder applies to both Mho and Quad
characteristics. Set this value high if no blinder is required for the Mho characteristic.
POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 1: All the coordinating timers are related to each other and should be set to detect
the fastest expected power swing and produce out-of-step tripping in a secure manner. The timers should be set in
consideration to the power swing detect characteristics, mode of power swing detect operation and mode of out-ofstep tripping. This timer defines the interval that the impedance locus must spend between the outer and inner characteristics (two-step operating mode), or between the outer and middle characteristics (three-step operating mode)
before the power swing blocking signal is established. This time delay must be set shorter than the time required for
the impedance locus to travel between the two selected characteristics during the fastest expected power swing. This
setting is relevant for both power swing blocking and out-of-step tripping.
POWER SWING RESET DELAY 1: This setting defines the dropout delay for the power swing blocking signal. Detection of a condition requiring a block output sets latch 1 after PICKUP DELAY 1 time. When the impedance locus leaves
the outer characteristic, timer POWER SWING RESET DELAY 1 is started. When the timer times-out the latch is reset. This
setting should be selected to give extra security for the power swing blocking action.
POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 2: Controls the out-of-step tripping function in the three-step mode only. This timer
defines the interval the impedance locus must spend between the middle and inner characteristics before the second
step of the out-of-step tripping sequence is completed. This time delay must be set shorter than the time required for
the impedance locus to travel between the two characteristics during the fastest expected power swing.
POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 3: Controls the out-of-step tripping function only. It defines the interval the impedance locus must spend within the inner characteristic before the last step of the out-of-step tripping sequence is completed and the element is armed to trip. The actual moment of tripping is controlled by the TRIP MODE setting. This time
delay is provided for extra security before the out-of-step trip action is executed.
POWER SWING PICKUP DELAY 4: Controls the out-of-step tripping function in Delayed trip mode only. This timer
defines the interval the impedance locus must spend outside the inner characteristic but within the outer characteristic
before the element is armed for the delayed trip. The delayed trip occurs when the impedance leaves the outer characteristic. This time delay is provided for extra security and should be set considering the fastest expected power swing.
5-136
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
POWER SWING SEAL-IN DELAY: The out-of-step trip FlexLogic operand (POWER SWING TRIP) is sealed-in for the
specified period of time. The sealing-in is crucial in the delayed trip mode, as the original trip signal is a very short
pulse occurring when the impedance locus leaves the outer characteristic after the out-of-step sequence is completed.
POWER SWING TRIP MODE: Selection of the Early trip mode results in an instantaneous trip after the last step in
the out-of-step tripping sequence is completed. The early trip mode will stress the circuit breakers as the currents at
that moment are high (the electromotive forces of the two equivalent systems are approximately 180 apart). Selection
of the Delayed trip mode results in a trip at the moment when the impedance locus leaves the outer characteristic.
delayed trip mode will relax the operating conditions for the breakers as the currents at that moment are low. The
selection should be made considering the capability of the breakers in the system.
POWER SWING BLK: This setting specifies the FlexLogic operand used for blocking the out-of-step function only.
The power swing blocking function is operational all the time as long as the element is enabled. The blocking signal
resets the output POWER SWING TRIP operand but does not stop the out-of-step tripping sequence.
SETTINGS
SETTING
POWER SWING
FUNCTION:
POWER SWING
SHAPE:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
RUN
V_1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OUTER IMPEDANCE
REGION
I_1
AND
RUN
MIDDLE IMPEDANCE
REGION
AND
RUN
INNER IMPEDANCE
REGION
AND
SETTING
POWER SWING
SUPV:
RUN
I_1 > PICKUP
827840A3.CDR
Enabled = 1
0
SETTING
10 cycles
I_0
I_1
I_2
TIMER
AND
RUN
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POWER SWING 50DD
4 cycles
842008A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-137
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
SETTINGS
POWER SWING
DELAY 1 PICKUP:
POWER SWING
DELAY 1 RESET:
3-step
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
tPKP
tRST
AND
S Q1
L1
2-step
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
L5
S Q5
OR
OR
SETTING
POWER SWING
DELAY 2 PICKUP:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POWER SWING TMR2 PKP
tPKP
AND
S Q2
L2
R
3-step
2-step
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
POWER SWING
DELAY 3 PICKUP:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
0
S Q3
L3
R
SETTING
POWER SWING TRIP
MODE:
SETTING
SETTING
POWER SWING
DELAY 4 PICKUP:
AND
Early
tPKP
0
S Q4
L4
R
POWER SWING
SEAL-IN DELAY:
0
tRST
AND
Delayed
SETTING
NOTE:
L1 AND L4 LATCHES ARE SET DOMINANT
L2, L3 AND L5 LATCHES ARE RESET DOMINANT
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off=0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POWER SWING OUTGOING
827841A4.CDR
5-138
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
SOURCE: SRC 1
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
MIN VOLT: 0.250 pu
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
REACH: 1.00
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
ANGLE: 30
Range: 5 to 50 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
PKP DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
RST DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
EVENTS: Disabled
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
The load encroachment element responds to the positive-sequence voltage and current and applies a characteristic shown
in the figure below.
ANGLE
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
OPERATE
REACH
ANGLE
REACH
R
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
OPERATE
827846A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-139
5 SETTINGS
837731A1.CDR
LOAD ENCROACHMENT MIN VOLT: This setting specifies the minimum positive-sequence voltage required for operation of the element. If the voltage is below this threshold a blocking signal will not be asserted by the element. When
selecting this setting one must remember that the D60 measures the phase-to-ground sequence voltages regardless
of the VT connection.
The nominal VT secondary voltage as specified with the SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK X5 PHASE
setting is the per-unit base for this setting.
VT SECONDARY
LOAD ENCROACHMENT REACH: This setting specifies the resistive reach of the element as shown in the Load
encroachment characteristic diagram. This setting should be entered in secondary ohms and be calculated as the positive-sequence resistance seen by the relay under maximum load conditions and unity power factor.
LOAD ENCROACHMENT ANGLE: This setting specifies the size of the blocking region as shown on the Load
encroachment characteristic diagram and applies to the positive-sequence impedance.
SETTING
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SETTINGS
SETTING
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
REACH:
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
ANGLE:
AND
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
RST DELAY:
SETTING
SETTING
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
SOURCE:
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
MIN VOLT:
RUN
SETTINGS
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
PKP DELAY:
Load Encroachment
Characteristic
t PKP
t RST
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
LOAD ENCHR PKP
LOAD ENCHR DPO
LOAD ENCHR OP
5-140
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) PHASE CURRENT
PHASE CURRENT
PHASE TOC1
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC2
MESSAGE
PHASE IOC1
MESSAGE
PHASE IOC2
MESSAGE
PHASE
DIRECTIONAL 1
MESSAGE
PHASE
DIRECTIONAL 2
IEC
GE TYPE IAC
OTHER
I2t
FlexCurves A, B, C, and D
IAC Inverse
Recloser Curves
Definite Time
A time dial multiplier setting allows selection of a multiple of the base curve shape (where the time dial multiplier = 1) with
the curve shape (CURVE) setting. Unlike the electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional
to the time multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10 times the multiplier 1
or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
Time overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal energy capacity memory variable. When this variable indicates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a time overcurrent element will operate. If less than 100% energy capacity is accumulated in this variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the pickup value, the
variable must be reduced. Two methods of this resetting operation are available: Instantaneous and Timed. The Instantaneous selection is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy capacity
directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The Timed selection can be used where the relay must
coordinate with electromechanical relays.
GE Multilin
5-141
5 SETTINGS
IEEE CURVES:
The IEEE time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE C37.112-1996 curve classifications
for extremely, very, and moderately inverse. The IEEE curves are derived from the formulae:
A
tr
---------------------------------- + B
----------------------------------2
I - p
T = TDM --------------,
T
TDM
=
I
RESET
1 ----------------
I pickup 1
I pickup
where:
(EQ 5.7)
T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = input current, Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants, TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is Timed),
tr = characteristic constant
TR
28.2
0.1217
2.0000
29.1
19.61
0.491
2.0000
21.6
0.0515
0.1140
0.02000
4.85
CURRENT ( I / Ipickup)
1.5
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
10.0
0.5
11.341
4.761
1.823
1.001
0.648
0.464
0.355
0.285
0.237
0.203
1.0
22.682
9.522
3.647
2.002
1.297
0.927
0.709
0.569
0.474
0.407
2.0
45.363
19.043
7.293
4.003
2.593
1.855
1.418
1.139
0.948
0.813
4.0
90.727
38.087
14.587
8.007
5.187
3.710
2.837
2.277
1.897
1.626
6.0
136.090
57.130
21.880
12.010
7.780
5.564
4.255
3.416
2.845
2.439
8.0
181.454
76.174
29.174
16.014
10.374
7.419
5.674
4.555
3.794
3.252
10.0
226.817
95.217
36.467
20.017
12.967
9.274
7.092
5.693
4.742
4.065
8.090
3.514
1.471
0.899
0.654
0.526
0.450
0.401
0.368
0.345
1.0
16.179
7.028
2.942
1.798
1.308
1.051
0.900
0.802
0.736
0.689
2.0
32.358
14.055
5.885
3.597
2.616
2.103
1.799
1.605
1.472
1.378
4.0
64.716
28.111
11.769
7.193
5.232
4.205
3.598
3.209
2.945
2.756
6.0
97.074
42.166
17.654
10.790
7.849
6.308
5.397
4.814
4.417
4.134
8.0
129.432
56.221
23.538
14.387
10.465
8.410
7.196
6.418
5.889
5.513
10.0
161.790
70.277
29.423
17.983
13.081
10.513
8.995
8.023
7.361
6.891
3.220
1.902
1.216
0.973
0.844
0.763
0.706
0.663
0.630
0.603
1.0
6.439
3.803
2.432
1.946
1.688
1.526
1.412
1.327
1.260
1.207
2.0
12.878
7.606
4.864
3.892
3.377
3.051
2.823
2.653
2.521
2.414
4.0
25.756
15.213
9.729
7.783
6.753
6.102
5.647
5.307
5.041
4.827
6.0
38.634
22.819
14.593
11.675
10.130
9.153
8.470
7.960
7.562
7.241
8.0
51.512
30.426
19.458
15.567
13.507
12.204
11.294
10.614
10.083
9.654
10.0
64.390
38.032
24.322
19.458
16.883
15.255
14.117
13.267
12.604
12.068
5-142
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
IEC CURVES
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and British standard BS142. These
are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The formulae for these curves are:
K
tr
---------------------------------------------------------------------------2
T = TDM ( I I pickup ) E 1 , T RESET = TDM 1 ( I I
pickup )
where:
(EQ 5.8)
T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = input current, Ipickup = Pickup Current setting, K, E =
constants, tr = characteristic constant, and TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100%
and RESET is Timed)
TR
0.140
0.020
9.7
13.500
1.000
43.2
80.000
2.000
58.2
0.050
0.040
0.500
CURRENT ( I / Ipickup)
1.5
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
10.0
0.05
0.860
0.501
0.315
0.249
0.214
0.192
0.176
0.165
0.156
0.149
0.10
1.719
1.003
0.630
0.498
0.428
0.384
0.353
0.330
0.312
0.297
0.20
3.439
2.006
1.260
0.996
0.856
0.767
0.706
0.659
0.623
0.594
0.40
6.878
4.012
2.521
1.992
1.712
1.535
1.411
1.319
1.247
1.188
0.60
10.317
6.017
3.781
2.988
2.568
2.302
2.117
1.978
1.870
1.782
0.80
13.755
8.023
5.042
3.984
3.424
3.070
2.822
2.637
2.493
2.376
1.00
17.194
10.029
6.302
4.980
4.280
3.837
3.528
3.297
3.116
2.971
0.05
1.350
0.675
0.338
0.225
0.169
0.135
0.113
0.096
0.084
0.075
0.10
2.700
1.350
0.675
0.450
0.338
0.270
0.225
0.193
0.169
0.150
0.20
5.400
2.700
1.350
0.900
0.675
0.540
0.450
0.386
0.338
0.300
0.40
10.800
5.400
2.700
1.800
1.350
1.080
0.900
0.771
0.675
0.600
0.60
16.200
8.100
4.050
2.700
2.025
1.620
1.350
1.157
1.013
0.900
0.80
21.600
10.800
5.400
3.600
2.700
2.160
1.800
1.543
1.350
1.200
1.00
27.000
13.500
6.750
4.500
3.375
2.700
2.250
1.929
1.688
1.500
0.05
3.200
1.333
0.500
0.267
0.167
0.114
0.083
0.063
0.050
0.040
0.10
6.400
2.667
1.000
0.533
0.333
0.229
0.167
0.127
0.100
0.081
0.20
12.800
5.333
2.000
1.067
0.667
0.457
0.333
0.254
0.200
0.162
0.40
25.600
10.667
4.000
2.133
1.333
0.914
0.667
0.508
0.400
0.323
0.60
38.400
16.000
6.000
3.200
2.000
1.371
1.000
0.762
0.600
0.485
0.80
51.200
21.333
8.000
4.267
2.667
1.829
1.333
1.016
0.800
0.646
1.00
64.000
26.667
10.000
5.333
3.333
2.286
1.667
1.270
1.000
0.808
0.026
IEC CURVE A
IEC CURVE B
IEC CURVE C
0.153
0.089
0.056
0.044
0.038
0.034
0.031
0.029
0.027
0.10
0.306
0.178
0.111
0.088
0.075
0.067
0.062
0.058
0.054
0.052
0.20
0.612
0.356
0.223
0.175
0.150
0.135
0.124
0.115
0.109
0.104
0.40
1.223
0.711
0.445
0.351
0.301
0.269
0.247
0.231
0.218
0.207
0.60
1.835
1.067
0.668
0.526
0.451
0.404
0.371
0.346
0.327
0.311
0.80
2.446
1.423
0.890
0.702
0.602
0.538
0.494
0.461
0.435
0.415
1.00
3.058
1.778
1.113
0.877
0.752
0.673
0.618
0.576
0.544
0.518
GE Multilin
5-143
5 SETTINGS
IAC CURVES:
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formulae:
D
E
B
tr
T = TDM A + ------------------------------ + -------------------------------------2- + -------------------------------------3- , T RESET = TDM ------------------------------(
C
I
I
2
I
I
I
I
(
(
C
)
(
(
C
)
pkp
pkp
pkp
1 ( I I pkp )
where:
(EQ 5.9)
T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = Input current, Ipkp = Pickup Current setting, A to E =
constants, tr = characteristic constant, and TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100%
and RESET is Timed)
TR
0.0040
0.6379
0.0900
0.7955
0.6200
1.7872
0.2461
6.008
0.1000
1.2885
7.9586
IAC Inverse
0.2078
4.678
0.8630
0.8000
0.4180
0.1947
0.990
0.0428
0.0609
0.6200
0.0010
0.0221
0.222
CURRENT ( I / Ipickup)
1.5
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
10.0
0.5
1.699
0.749
0.303
0.178
0.123
0.093
0.074
0.062
0.053
0.046
1.0
3.398
1.498
0.606
0.356
0.246
0.186
0.149
0.124
0.106
0.093
2.0
6.796
2.997
1.212
0.711
0.491
0.372
0.298
0.248
0.212
0.185
4.0
13.591
5.993
2.423
1.422
0.983
0.744
0.595
0.495
0.424
0.370
6.0
20.387
8.990
3.635
2.133
1.474
1.115
0.893
0.743
0.636
0.556
8.0
27.183
11.987
4.846
2.844
1.966
1.487
1.191
0.991
0.848
0.741
10.0
33.979
14.983
6.058
3.555
2.457
1.859
1.488
1.239
1.060
0.926
1.451
0.656
0.269
0.172
0.133
0.113
0.101
0.093
0.087
0.083
1.0
2.901
1.312
0.537
0.343
0.266
0.227
0.202
0.186
0.174
0.165
2.0
5.802
2.624
1.075
0.687
0.533
0.453
0.405
0.372
0.349
0.331
4.0
11.605
5.248
2.150
1.374
1.065
0.906
0.810
0.745
0.698
0.662
6.0
17.407
7.872
3.225
2.061
1.598
1.359
1.215
1.117
1.046
0.992
8.0
23.209
10.497
4.299
2.747
2.131
1.813
1.620
1.490
1.395
1.323
10.0
29.012
13.121
5.374
3.434
2.663
2.266
2.025
1.862
1.744
1.654
0.5
0.578
0.375
0.266
0.221
0.196
0.180
0.168
0.160
0.154
0.148
1.0
1.155
0.749
0.532
0.443
0.392
0.360
0.337
0.320
0.307
0.297
2.0
2.310
1.499
1.064
0.885
0.784
0.719
0.674
0.640
0.614
0.594
4.0
4.621
2.997
2.128
1.770
1.569
1.439
1.348
1.280
1.229
1.188
6.0
6.931
4.496
3.192
2.656
2.353
2.158
2.022
1.921
1.843
1.781
8.0
9.242
5.995
4.256
3.541
3.138
2.878
2.695
2.561
2.457
2.375
10.0
11.552
7.494
5.320
4.426
3.922
3.597
3.369
3.201
3.072
2.969
0.025
IAC INVERSE
0.072
0.047
0.035
0.031
0.028
0.027
0.026
0.026
0.025
1.0
0.143
0.095
0.070
0.061
0.057
0.054
0.052
0.051
0.050
0.049
2.0
0.286
0.190
0.140
0.123
0.114
0.108
0.105
0.102
0.100
0.099
4.0
0.573
0.379
0.279
0.245
0.228
0.217
0.210
0.204
0.200
0.197
6.0
0.859
0.569
0.419
0.368
0.341
0.325
0.314
0.307
0.301
0.296
8.0
1.145
0.759
0.559
0.490
0.455
0.434
0.419
0.409
0.401
0.394
10.0
1.431
0.948
0.699
0.613
0.569
0.542
0.524
0.511
0.501
0.493
5-144
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
I2t CURVES:
The curves for the I2t are derived from the formulae:
100
100
----------------------------------------------------I 2 , T RESET = TDM I 2
T = TDM ----------------------------- I pickup
I pickup
where:
(EQ 5.10)
T = Operate Time (sec.); TDM = Multiplier Setting; I = Input Current; Ipickup = Pickup Current Setting;
TRESET = Reset Time in sec. (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
CURRENT ( I / Ipickup)
1.5
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
10.0
0.44
0.25
0.11
0.06
0.04
0.03
0.02
0.02
0.01
0.01
0.10
4.44
2.50
1.11
0.63
0.40
0.28
0.20
0.16
0.12
0.10
1.00
44.44
25.00
11.11
6.25
4.00
2.78
2.04
1.56
1.23
1.00
10.00
444.44
250.00
111.11
62.50
40.00
27.78
20.41
15.63
12.35
10.00
100.00
4444.4
2500.0
1111.1
625.00
400.00
277.78
204.08
156.25
123.46
100.00
600.00
26666.7
15000.0
6666.7
3750.0
2400.0
1666.7
1224.5
937.50
740.74
600.00
FLEXCURVES:
The custom FlexCurves are described in detail in the FlexCurves section of this chapter. The curve shapes for the
FlexCurves are derived from the formulae:
I
T = TDM FlexCurve Time at ----------------
I pickup
I
when ---------------- 1.00
I pickup
I
T RESET = TDM FlexCurve Time at ----------------
I pickup
where:
I
when ---------------- 0.98
I pickup
(EQ 5.11)
(EQ 5.12)
where:
(EQ 5.13)
(EQ 5.14)
RECLOSER CURVES:
The D60 uses the FlexCurve feature to facilitate programming of 41 recloser curves. Please refer to the FlexCurve
section in this chapter for additional details.
GE Multilin
5-145
5 SETTINGS
PHASE TOC1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
INPUT: Phasor
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
RESET: Instantaneous
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PHASE TOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
PHASE TOC1
1.00
The phase time overcurrent element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or
be used as a simple Definite Time element. The phase current input quantities may be programmed as fundamental phasor
magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: Timed and Instantaneous (refer to the Inverse TOC Curves Characteristic sub-section earlier for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to Instantaneous and the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
The PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting can be dynamically reduced by a voltage restraint feature (when enabled). This is accomplished via the multipliers (Mvr) corresponding to the phase-phase voltages of the voltage restraint characteristic curve (see
the figure below); the pickup level is calculated as Mvr times the PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting. If the voltage restraint feature
is disabled, the pickup level always remains at the setting value.
5-146
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-B:
Off=0
SETTING
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
INPUT:
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-C:
Off=0
PHASE TOC1
PICKUP:
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
CURVE:
PHASE TOC1
SOURCE:
PHASE TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
IA
PHASE TOC1
RESET:
IB
AND
IC
Seq=ABC Seq=ACB
VAB
VBC
VCA
VAC
VBA
VCB
RUN
MULTIPLY INPUTS
RUN
Set Pickup
Multiplier-Phase A
RUN
Set Pickup
Multiplier-Phase B
Set
Calculate Multiplier
Set
Calculate Multiplier
Set
Calculate Multiplier
Set Pickup
Multiplier-Phase C
RUN
IA
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PHASE TOC1 A PKP
PICKUP
t
AND
RUN
IB
PHASE TOC1 A OP
PHASE TOC1 B PKP
PICKUP
t
AND
RUN
IC
PHASE TOC1 B OP
PHASE TOC1 C PKP
PICKUP
PHASE TOC1 C OP
SETTING
OR
OR
PHASE TOC1 OP
Enabled
AND
GE Multilin
5-147
5 SETTINGS
PHASE IOC1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE IOC1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE IOC1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PHASE IOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
PHASE IOC1
The phase instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
Definite Time element. The input current is the fundamental phasor magnitude.
SETTING
PHASE IOC1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
Disabled = 0
SETTING
PHASE IOC1
SOURCE:
IA
IB
IC
AND
SETTING
PHASE IOC1
PICKUP:
RUN
IA PICKUP
AND
RUN
AND
RUN
SETTINGS
PHASE IOC1
PICKUPDELAY:
PHASE IOC1 RESET
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC
OPERANDS
PHASE IOC1 A PKP
PHASE IOC1 A DPO
tPKP
tRST
IB PICKUP
IC PICKUP
tPKP
tRST
tPKP
SETTING
PHASE IOC1
BLOCK-A:
Off = 0
PHASE IOC1 A OP
PHASE IOC1 B OP
PHASE IOC1 C OP
SETTING
PHASE IOC1
BLOCK-B:
Off = 0
OR
OR
PHASE IOC1 OP
AND
SETTING
PHASE IOC1
BLOCK-C:
Off = 0
827033A6.VSD
5-148
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PHASE DIR 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE DIR 1
ECA: 30
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE DIR 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PHASE DIR 1
EVENTS: Disabled
PHASE
DIRECTIONAL 1
The phase directional elements (one for each of phases A, B, and C) determine the phase current flow direction for steady
state and fault conditions and can be used to control the operation of the phase overcurrent elements via the BLOCK inputs
of these elements.
S
UT
TP
OU
90
VAG (Unfaulted)
Fault angle
set at 60 Lag
VPol
VAG(Faulted)
IA
ECA
set at 30
VBC
VBC
VCG
VBG
+90
827800A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-149
5 SETTINGS
To increase security for three phase faults very close to the VTs used to measure the polarizing voltage, a voltage memory
feature is incorporated. This feature stores the polarizing voltage the moment before the voltage collapses, and uses it to
determine direction. The voltage memory remains valid for one second after the voltage has collapsed.
The main component of the phase directional element is the phase angle comparator with two inputs: the operating signal
(phase current) and the polarizing signal (the line voltage, shifted in the leading direction by the characteristic angle, ECA).
The following table shows the operating and polarizing signals used for phase directional control:
PHASE
OPERATING
SIGNAL
angle of IA
angle of IB
angle of IC
MODE OF OPERATION:
When the function is Disabled, or the operating current is below 5% CT nominal, the element output is 0.
When the function is Enabled, the operating current is above 5% CT nominal, and the polarizing voltage is above
the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL value, the element output is dependent on
the phase angle between the operating and polarizing signals:
The element output is logic 0 when the operating current is within polarizing voltage 90.
For all other angles, the element output is logic 1.
Once the voltage memory has expired, the phase overcurrent elements under directional control can be set to block or
trip on overcurrent as follows:
When BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to Yes, the directional element will block the operation of any phase
overcurrent element under directional control when voltage memory expires.
When BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to No, the directional element allows tripping of phase overcurrent elements
under directional control when voltage memory expires.
In all cases, directional blocking will be permitted to resume when the polarizing voltage becomes greater than the polarizing voltage threshold.
SETTINGS:
PHASE DIR 1 SIGNAL SOURCE: This setting is used to select the source for the operating and polarizing signals.
The operating current for the phase directional element is the phase current for the selected current source. The polarizing voltage is the line voltage from the phase VTs, based on the 90 or quadrature connection and shifted in the
leading direction by the element characteristic angle (ECA).
PHASE DIR 1 ECA: This setting is used to select the element characteristic angle, i.e. the angle by which the polarizing voltage is shifted in the leading direction to achieve dependable operation. In the design of the UR-series elements,
a block is applied to an element by asserting logic 1 at the blocking input. This element should be programmed via the
ECA setting so that the output is logic 1 for current in the non-tripping direction.
PHASE DIR 1 POL V THRESHOLD: This setting is used to establish the minimum level of voltage for which the phase
angle measurement is reliable. The setting is based on VT accuracy. The default value is 0.700 pu.
PHASE DIR 1 BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP: This setting is used to select the required operation upon expiration of
voltage memory. When set to "Yes", the directional element blocks the operation of any phase overcurrent element
under directional control, when voltage memory expires; when set to "No", the directional element allows tripping of
phase overcurrent elements under directional control.
NOTE
5-150
The phase directional element responds to the forward load current. In the case of a following reverse fault,
the element needs some time in the order of 8 ms to establish a blocking signal. Some protection elements such as instantaneous overcurrent may respond to reverse faults before the blocking signal is
established. Therefore, a coordination time of at least 10 ms must be added to all the instantaneous protection elements under the supervision of the phase directional element. If current reversal is of a concern, a
longer delay in the order of 20 ms may be needed.
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
PHASE DIR 1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SETTING
AND
PHASE DIR 1
BLOCK:
Off=0
SETTING
SETTING
0.05 pu
AND
IA
Seq=ABC
Seq=ACB
VBC
VCB
RUN
1
SETTING
0
Vpol
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
MINIMUM
PH DIR1 BLK
PH DIR1 BLK A
OR
MEMORY TIMER
1 cycle
1 sec
AND
SETTING
PHASE DIR 1 BLOCK OC
WHEN V MEM EXP:
No
Yes
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIR1 BLK B
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PH DIR1 BLK C
827078A6.CDR
NEUTRAL CURRENT
GE Multilin
NEUTRAL TOC1
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC2
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL IOC1
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL IOC2
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL
DIRECTIONAL 1
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL
DIRECTIONAL 2
5-151
5 SETTINGS
NEUTRAL TOC1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
INPUT: Phasor
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
RESET: Instantaneous
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL TOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
NEUTRAL TOC1
1.00
The neutral time overcurrent element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current
or be used as a simple definite time element. The neutral current input value is a quantity calculated as 3Io from the phase
currents and may be programmed as fundamental phasor magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the
application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: Timed and Instantaneous (refer to the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics section for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator
will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to Instantaneous and
the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
SOURCE:
IN
AND
SETTINGS
NEUTRAL TOC1
INPUT:
NEUTRAL TOC1
PICKUP:
NEUTRAL TOC1
CURVE:
NEUTRAL TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
NEUTRAL TOC 1
RESET:
IN PICKUP
RUN
t
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEUTRAL TOC1 PKP
NEUTRAL TOC1 DPO
NEUTRAL TOC1 OP
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
BLOCK:
Off = 0
827034A3.VSD
5-152
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
NEUTRAL IOC1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL IOC1
PICKUP:
1.000 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL IOC1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL IOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
NEUTRAL IOC1
The neutral instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional delay or as a
definite time function. The element essentially responds to the magnitude of a neutral current fundamental frequency phasor calculated from the phase currents. A positive-sequence restraint is applied for better performance. A small portion
(6.25%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-sequence current magnitude when forming
the operating quantity of the element as follows:
I op = 3 ( I_0 K I_1 ) where K = 1 16
(EQ 5.15)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on how test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
I op = 0.9375 I injected ; three-phase pure zero-sequence injection: I op = 3 I injected ).
SETTING
SETTINGS
Disabled=0
SETTING
Enabled=1
SETTING
NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK:
AND
RUN
3( I_0 - K I_1 ) PICKUP
NEUTRAL IOC1
PICKUP DELAY :
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEUTRAL IOC1
RESET DELAY :
tPKP
NEUTRAL IOC1 OP
Off=0
SETTING
NEUTRAL IOC1 SOURCE:
827035A4.CDR
I_0
GE Multilin
5-153
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 90 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
Range: 40 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 40 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL
DIRECTIONAL OC1
There are two Neutral Directional Overcurrent protection elements available. The element provides both forward and
reverse fault direction indications the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD and NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV operands, respectively. The output operand is asserted if the magnitude of the operating current is above a pickup level (overcurrent unit) and the fault
direction is seen as forward or reverse, respectively (directional unit).
The overcurrent unit responds to the magnitude of a fundamental frequency phasor of the either the neutral current calculated from the phase currents or the ground current. There are two separate pickup settings for the forward- and reverselooking functions, respectively. If set to use the calculated 3I_0, the element applies a positive-sequence restraint for better performance: a small user-programmable portion of the positivesequence current magnitude is subtracted from the
zero-sequence current magnitude when forming the operating quantity.
I op = 3 ( I_0 K I_1 )
(EQ 5.16)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
5-154
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults.
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on the way the test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
Iop = (1 K) Iinjected ; three-phase pure zero-sequence injection: Iop = 3 Iinjected).
The positive-sequence restraint is removed for low currents. If the positive-sequence current is below 0.8 pu, the restraint is
removed by changing the constant K to zero. This facilitates better response to high-resistance faults when the unbalance
is very small and there is no danger of excessive CT errors as the current is low.
The directional unit uses the zero-sequence current (I_0) or ground current (IG) for fault direction discrimination and may
be programmed to use either zero-sequence voltage (Calculated V0 or Measured VX), ground current (IG), or both for
polarizing. The following tables define the neutral directional overcurrent element.
Table 520: QUANTITIES FOR "CALCULATED 3I0" CONFIGURATION
DIRECTIONAL UNIT
POLARIZING MODE
Voltage
Current
DIRECTION
OVERCURRENT UNIT
COMPARED PHASORS
Forward
I_0 1ECA
Reverse
I_0 1ECA
Forward
IG
I_0
Reverse
IG
I_0
I_0 1ECA
or
Forward
Dual
IG
I_0
I_0 1ECA
or
Reverse
IG
I_0
where:
DIRECTION
COMPARED PHASORS
Forward
IG 1ECA
Reverse
IG 1ECA
OVERCURRENT UNIT
Iop = |IG|
1
V_0 = --- ( VAG + VBG + VCG ) = zero sequence voltage ,
3
1
1
I_0 = --- IN = --- ( IA + IB + IC ) = zero sequence current ,
3
3
ECA = element characteristic angle and IG = ground current
When NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT is set to Measured VX, one-third of this voltage is used in place of V_0. The following
figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional unit of the element.
The figure below shows the voltage-polarized phase angle comparator characteristics for a phase A to ground fault, with:
ECA = 90 (element characteristic angle = centerline of operating characteristic)
FWD LA = 80 (forward limit angle = the angular limit with the ECA for operation)
REV LA = 80 (reverse limit angle = the angular limit with the ECA for operation)
The element incorporates a current reversal logic: if the reverse direction is indicated for at least 1.25 of a power system
cycle, the prospective forward indication will be delayed by 1.5 of a power system cycle. The element is designed to emulate an electromechanical directional device. Larger operating and polarizing signals will result in faster directional discrimination bringing more security to the element operation.
The forward-looking function is designed to be more secure as compared to the reverse-looking function, and therefore,
should be used for the tripping direction. The reverse-looking function is designed to be faster as compared to the forwardlooking function and should be used for the blocking direction. This allows for better protection coordination.
GE Multilin
5-155
5 SETTINGS
The above bias should be taken into account when using the neutral directional overcurrent element to directionalize other
protection elements.
REV LA
line
FWD LA
line
3V_0 line
VAG
(reference)
REV Operating
Region
FWD Operating
Region
LA
LA
3I_0 line
ECA
ECA line
ECA line
LA
3I_0 line
VCG
LA
VBG
REV LA
line
3V_0 line
FWD LA
line
827805A1.CDR
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POLARIZING: This setting selects the polarizing mode for the directional unit.
If Voltage polarizing is selected, the element uses the zero-sequence voltage angle for polarization. The user
can use either the zero-sequence voltage V_0 calculated from the phase voltages, or the zero-sequence voltage
supplied externally as the auxiliary voltage Vx, both from the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE.
The calculated V_0 can be used as polarizing voltage only if the voltage transformers are connected in Wye. The
auxiliary voltage can be used as the polarizing voltage provided SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK
AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION is set to Vn and the auxiliary voltage is connected to a zero-sequence voltage
source (such as open delta connected secondary of VTs).
The zero-sequence (V_0) or auxiliary voltage (Vx), accordingly, must be higher than the PRODUCT SETUP DIS VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL value to be validated for use as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing
signal is invalid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
PLAY PROPERTIES
If Current polarizing is selected, the element uses the ground current angle connected externally and configured
under NEUTRAL OC1 SOURCE for polarization. The Ground CT must be connected between the ground and neutral
point of an adequate local source of ground current. The ground current must be higher than 0.05 pu to be validated as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is not valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
For a choice of current polarizing, it is recommended that the polarizing signal be analyzed to ensure that a known
direction is maintained irrespective of the fault location. For example, if using an autotransformer neutral current
as a polarizing source, it should be ensured that a reversal of the ground current does not occur for a high-side
fault. The low-side system impedance should be assumed minimal when checking for this condition. A similar situation arises for a Wye/Delta/Wye transformer, where current in one transformer winding neutral may reverse
when faults on both sides of the transformer are considered.
5-156
If "Dual" polarizing is selected, the element performs both directional comparisons as described above. A given
direction is confirmed if either voltage or current comparators indicate so. If a conflicting (simultaneous forward
and reverse) indication occurs, the forward direction overrides the reverse direction.
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT: Selects the polarizing voltage used by the directional unit when "Voltage" or "Dual"
polarizing mode is set. The polarizing voltage can be programmed to be either the zero-sequence voltage calculated
from the phase voltages ("Calculated V0") or supplied externally as an auxiliary voltage ("Measured VX").
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP CURR: This setting indicates whether the 3I_0 current calculated from the phase currents, or
the ground current shall be used by this protection. This setting acts as a switch between the neutral and ground
modes of operation (67N and 67G). If set to Calculated 3I0 the element uses the phase currents and applies the positive-sequence restraint; if set to Measured IG the element uses ground current supplied to the ground CT of the CT
bank configured as NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE. If this setting is Measured IG, then the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POLARIZING
setting must be Voltage, as it is not possible to use the ground current as an operating and polarizing signal simultaneously.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POS-SEQ RESTRAINT: This setting controls the amount of the positive-sequence restraint. Set
to 0.063 for backward compatibility with firmware revision 3.40 and older. Set to zero to remove the restraint. Set
higher if large system unbalances or poor CT performance are expected.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OFFSET: This setting specifies the offset impedance used by this protection. The primary application for the offset impedance is to guarantee correct identification of fault direction on series compensated lines. See
the Chapter 9 for information on how to calculate this setting. In regular applications, the offset impedance ensures
proper operation even if the zero-sequence voltage at the relaying point is very small. If this is the intent, the offset
impedance shall not be larger than the zero-sequence impedance of the protected circuit. Practically, it shall be several
times smaller. See Chapter 8 for additional details. The offset impedance shall be entered in secondary ohms.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD ECA: This setting defines the characteristic angle (ECA) for the forward direction in the
"Voltage" polarizing mode. The "Current" polarizing mode uses a fixed ECA of 0. The ECA in the reverse direction is
the angle set for the forward direction shifted by 180.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the forward direction.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
forward direction. When selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence
restraint technique for the Calculated 3I0 mode of operation.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the reverse direction.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
reverse direction. When selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence
restraint technique for the Calculated 3I0 mode of operation.
GE Multilin
5-157
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD
PICKUP:
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP
CURR:
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POSSEQ RESTRAINT:
SETTING
RUN
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SETTING
AND
SETTINGS
AND
Off=0
SETTING
NEUTRAL DIR OC1
SOURCE:
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
RUN
FWD
FWD
REV
OR
-3V_0
AND
1.25 cy
1.5 cy
3I_0 REV
Voltage Polarization
SETTING
IG
0.05 pu
AND
RUN
FWD
Current Polarization
OR
Current
Dual
REV
OR
NOTE:
1) CURRENT POLARIZING IS POSSIBLE ONLY IN RELAYS WITH
THE GROUND CURRENT INPUTS CONNECTED TO
AN ADEQUATE CURRENT POLARIZING SOURCE
2) GROUND CURRENT CAN NOT BE USED FOR POLARIZATION
AND OPERATION SIMULTANEOUSLY
3) POSITIVE SEQUENCE RESTRAINT IS NOT APPLIED WHEN
I_1 IS BELOW 0.8pu
OR
SETTING
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV
PICKUP:
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP
CURR:
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV
827077AB.CDR
5-158
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
WATTMETRIC
GROUND FAULT 1
The wattmetric zero-sequence directional element responds to power derived from zero-sequence voltage and current in a
direction specified by the element characteristic angle. The angle can be set within all four quadrants and the power can be
active or reactive. Therefore, the element may be used to sense either forward or reverse ground faults in either inductive,
capacitive or resistive networks. The inverse time characteristic allows time coordination of elements across the network.
Typical applications include ground fault protection in solidly grounded transmission networks, grounded/ungrounded/resistor-grounded/resonant-grounded distribution networks, or for directionalizing other non-directional ground elements.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 VOLT: The element uses neutral voltage (that is, three times the zero-sequence voltage).
This setting allows selecting between the internally calculated neutral voltage, or externally supplied voltage (broken
delta VT connected to the auxiliary channel bank of the relay). When the latter selection is made, the auxiliary channel
must be identified by the user as a neutral voltage under the VT bank settings. This element will operate only if the auxiliary voltage is configured as neutral.
GE Multilin
5-159
5 SETTINGS
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 OV PKP: This setting specifies the minimum zero sequence voltage supervising the directional power measurement. This threshold should be higher than possible unbalance during normal operation of the
system. Typically, this setting would be selected at 0.1 to 0.2 pu for the ungrounded or resonant grounded systems,
and at 0.05 to 0.1 pu for solidly or resistor-grounded systems. When using externally supplied voltage via the auxiliary
voltage channel, 1 pu is the nominal voltage of this channel as per VT bank settings. When using internally calculated
neutral voltage, 1 pu is the nominal phase to ground voltage as per the VT bank settings.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 CURR: The element responds to the neutral current (that is, three times zero-sequence
current), either calculated internally from the phase currents or supplied externally via the ground CT input from more
accurate sources such as the core balanced CT. This setting allows selecting the source of the operating current.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 OC PKP: This setting specifies the current supervision level for the measurement of the
zero-sequence power.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 OC PKP DEL: This setting specifies delay for the overcurrent portion of this element. The
delay applies to the WATTMETRIC 1 PKP operand driven from the overcurrent condition.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 PWR PKP: This setting specifies the operating point of the element. A value of 1 pu is a
product of the 1 pu voltage as specified for the overvoltage condition of this element, and 1 pu current as specified for
the overcurrent condition of this element.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 REF PWR: This setting is used to calculate the inverse time characteristic delay (defined
by Sref in the following equations). A value of 1 pu represents the product of a 1 pu voltage (as specified in the overvoltage condition for this element) and a 1 pu current (as specified in the overcurrent condition for this element.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 ECA: This setting adjusts the maximum torque angle of the element. The operating power
is calculated as:
S_op = Re ( V n ( I n 1 ECA ) )
(EQ 5.17)
where * indicates complex conjugate. By varying the element characteristic angle (ECA), the element can be made to
respond to forward or reverse direction in inductive, resistive, or capacitive networks as shown in the Wattmetric characteristic angle response diagram.
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 PWR PKP DEL: This setting defines a definite time delay before the inverse time characteristic is activated. If the curve selection is set as Definite Time, the element would operate after this security time
delay. If the curve selection is Inverse or one of the FlexCurves, the element uses both the definite and inverse time
timers simultaneously. The definite time timer, specified by this setting, is used and when expires it releases the
inverse time timer for operation (torque control).
WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 CURVE: This setting allows choosing one of three methods to delay operate signal once all
conditions are met to discriminate fault direction.
The Definite Time selection allows for a fixed time delay defined by the WATTMETRIC GND FLT 1 PWR PKP DEL setting.
The Inverse selection allows for inverse time characteristics delay defined by the following formula:
S ref
t = m ---------S op
(EQ 5.18)
where m is a multiplier defined by the multiplier setting, Sref is the multiplier setting, and Sop is the operating power at
the time. This timer starts after the definite time timer expires.
The four FlexCurves allow for custom user-programmable time characteristics. When working with FlexCurves, the
element uses the operate to pickup ratio, and the multiplier setting is not applied:
S op
t = FlexCurve ----------
S ref
(EQ 5.19)
Again, the FlexCurve timer starts after the definite time timer expires.
5-160
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
FORWARD FAULT
REVERSE FAULT
INDUCTIVE NETWORK
ECA = 0 to 90
Vn
Vn
RESISTIVE NETWORK
In
In
ECA = 180
ECA = 0
Vn
Vn
In
In
CAPACITIIVE NETWORK
In
In
5
Vn
Vn
ECA = 90 to 180
837804A1.CDR
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
SETTING
Calculated: Measured:
Neutral, In Ground, Ig
S = V*conj (I*exp(-j*ECA))
Calculated: Measured:
Neutral, Vn Auxiliary, Vx
tPKP
AND
RUN
0
t = m
AND
SETTING
SETTINGS
Enabled = 1
WATT GND FLT 1 BLK:
Off = 0
SETTINGS
AND
SETTING
SREF
SOP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
WATTMETRIC 1 OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
tPKP
WATTMETRIC 1 PKP
0
837033A4.CDR
GE Multilin
5-161
5 SETTINGS
5.5.10 GROUND CURRENT
GROUND TOC1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
INPUT: Phasor
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
CURVE: IEEE Mod Inv
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
RESET: Instantaneous
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
GROUND TOC1
1.00
This element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or be used as a simple
definite time element. The ground current input value is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the fundamental phasor or RMS magnitude. Two methods of resetting operation are available: Timed and Instantaneous (refer to
the Inverse time overcurrent curve characteristics section for details). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator
will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to Instantaneous and
the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.
NOTE
This channel may be also equipped with a sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is from
0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.
NOTE
SETTING
GROUND TOC1
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
GROUND TOC1
SOURCE:
IG
AND
SETTINGS
GROUND TOC1
INPUT:
GROUND TOC1
PICKUP:
GROUND TOC1
CURVE:
GROUND TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
GROUND TOC 1
RESET:
RUN
IG PICKUP
t
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GROUND TOC1 PKP
GROUND TOC1 DPO
GROUND TOC1 OP
I
SETTING
GROUND TOC1
BLOCK:
Off = 0
827036A3.VSD
5-162
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
GROUND IOC1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GROUND IOC1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GROUND IOC1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
GROUND IOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
GROUND IOC1
The ground instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
definite time element. The ground current input is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the fundamental
phasor magnitude.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.
NOTE
This channel may be equipped with a standard or sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is
from 0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.
NOTE
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
SOURCE:
IG
AND
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
PICKUP:
RUN
IG PICKUP
SETTINGS
GROUND IOC1 PICKUP
DELAY:
GROUND IOC1 RESET
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GROUND IOC1 PKP
GROUND IOIC DPO
GROUND IOC1 OP
tPKP
tRST
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
BLOCK:
Off = 0
827037A4.VSD
GE Multilin
5-163
5 SETTINGS
5.5.11 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) NEGATIVE SEQUENCE CURRENT
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE
CURRENT
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The D60 relay provides two (2) negative-sequence time overcurrent elements, two (2) negative-sequence instantaneous
overcurrent elements, and two (2) negative-sequence directional overcurrent elements. For additional information on the
negative sequence time overcurrent curves, refer to the Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves section earlier.
5-164
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The negative-sequence time overcurrent element may be used to determine and clear unbalance in the system. The input
for calculating negative-sequence current is the fundamental phasor value.
Two methods of resetting operation are available; Timed and Instantaneous (refer to the Inverse Time Overcurrent Characteristics sub-section for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to Instantaneous and the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
SETTING
NEG SEQ TOC1 INPUT:
NEG SEQ TOC1 PICKUP:
SETTING
NEG SEQ TOC1 CURVE:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
NEG SEQ TOC1 RESET:
SETTING
AND
Off=0
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEG SEQ TOC1 PKP
NEG SEQ TOC1 DPO
NEG SEQ TOC1 OP
SETTING
NEG SEQ TOC1 SOURCE:
Neg Seq
827057A4.CDR
GE Multilin
5-165
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional
delay or as a definite time function. The element responds to the negative-sequence current fundamental frequency phasor
magnitude (calculated from the phase currents) and applies a positive-sequence restraint for better performance: a small
portion (12.5%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the negative-sequence current magnitude
when forming the operating quantity:
I op = I_2 K I_1
where K = 1 8
(EQ 5.20)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious negative-sequence currents resulting from:
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on the way the test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
I op = 0.2917 I injected ; three-phase injection, opposite rotation: I op = I injected ).
SETTING
SETTING
Disabled=0
SETTING
Enabled=1
SETTING
NEG SEQ IOC1 BLOCK:
AND
RUN
I_2 - K I_1
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PICKUP
Off=0
SETTING
NEG SEQ IOC1 SOURCE:
I_2
827058A5.CDR
5-166
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 40 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 40 to 90 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
There are two negative-sequence directional overcurrent protection elements available. The element provides both forward
and reverse fault direction indications through its output operands NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD and NEG SEQ DIR OC1 REV,
respectively. The output operand is asserted if the magnitude of the operating current is above a pickup level (overcurrent
unit) and the fault direction is seen as forward or reverse, respectively (directional unit).
The overcurrent unit of the element essentially responds to the magnitude of a fundamental frequency phasor of either
the negative-sequence or zero-sequence current as per user selection. The zero-sequence current should not be mistaken
with the neutral current (factor 3 difference).
A positive-sequence restraint is applied for better performance: a small user-programmable portion of the positive
sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the negative- or zero-sequence current magnitude, respectively, when
forming the element operating quantity.
I op = I_2 K I_1
or
I op = I_0 K I_1
(EQ 5.21)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious negative- and zerosequence currents resulting from:
GE Multilin
5-167
5 SETTINGS
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pick-up accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on the way the test currents are injected into the relay:
the directional unit uses the negative-sequence current and voltage for fault direction discrimination
DIRECTIONAL UNIT
MODE
OPERATING CURRENT
DIRECTION
Negative-sequence
Forward
COMPARED PHASORS
I_2 1ECA
Reverse
(I_2 1ECA)
Zero-sequence
Forward
I_2 1ECA
Reverse
(I_2 1ECA)
The negative-sequence voltage must be higher than the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES VOLTAGE CUT-OFF
value to be validated for use as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is not validated neither forward nor reverse
indication is given. The following figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional unit of the element.
LEVEL
The figure below shows the phase angle comparator characteristics for a Phase A to ground fault, with settings of:
ECA
FWD LA
REV LA
The element incorporates a current reversal logic: if the reverse direction is indicated for at least 1.25 of a power system
cycle, the prospective forward indication will be delayed by 1.5 of a power system cycle. The element is designed to emulate an electromechanical directional device. Larger operating and polarizing signals will result in faster directional discrimination bringing more security to the element operation.
V_2 line
REV
LA
FWD
LA
VAG (reference)
REV Operating
Region
LA
ECA line
LA
ECA
I_2 line
LA
I_2 line
FWD Operating
Region
ECA line
LA
VCG
VBG
V_2 line
REV
LA
FWD
LA
827806A2.CDR
5-168
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 OFFSET: This setting specifies the offset impedance used by this protection. The primary application for the offset impedance is to guarantee correct identification of fault direction on series compensated lines (see
the Application of Settings chapter for information on how to calculate this setting). In regular applications, the offset
impedance ensures proper operation even if the negative-sequence voltage at the relaying point is very small. If this is
the intent, the offset impedance shall not be larger than the negative-sequence impedance of the protected circuit.
Practically, it shall be several times smaller. The offset impedance shall be entered in secondary ohms. See the Theory
of Operation chapter for additional details.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 TYPE: This setting selects the operating mode for the overcurrent unit of the element. The
choices are Neg Sequence and Zero Sequence. In some applications it is advantageous to use a directional negative-sequence overcurrent function instead of a directional zero-sequence overcurrent function as inter-circuit mutual
effects are minimized.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 POS-SEQ RESTRAINT: This setting controls the amount of the positive-sequence restraint. Set
to 0.063 (in Zero Sequence mode) or 0.125 (in Neg Sequence mode) for backward compatibility with firmware revision 3.40 and older. Set to zero to remove the restraint. Set higher if large system unbalances or poor CT performance
are expected.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD ECA: This setting select the element characteristic angle (ECA) for the forward direction.
The element characteristic angle in the reverse direction is the angle set for the forward direction shifted by 180.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the forward direction.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit in the forward direction. Upon NEG SEQ DIR OC1 TYPE selection, this pickup threshold applies to zero- or negative-sequence current. When
selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence restraint technique.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 REV LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the reverse direction.
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 REV PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit in the reverse direction. Upon NEG SEQ DIR OC1 TYPE selection, this pickup threshold applies to zero- or negative-sequence current. When
selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence restraint technique.
SETTING
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD
PICKUP:
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 POSSEQ RESTRAINT:
AND
RUN
I_0 - K I_1
PICKUP
AND
RUN
I_2 - K I_1
PICKUP
SETTING
OR
AND
SETTINGS
Enabled=1
SETTING
AND
SETTING
Voltage Polarization
SETTING
Neg Sequence
AND
1.5 cy
REV
SETTING
AND
1.25 cy
FWD
V_2 pol
AND
FWD
REV.
Zero Sequence
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
RUN
I_2 - K I_1
PICKUP
RUN
I_0 - K I_1
PICKUP
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
NEG SEQ DIR OC1 REV
OR
827091A4.CDR
GE Multilin
5-169
5 SETTINGS
5.5.12 BREAKER FAILURE
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) BREAKER FAILURE BREAKER FAILURE 1(4)
BF1 FUNCTION:
Disabled
BF1 MODE:
3-Pole
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BF1 SOURCE:
SRC 1
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BF1 BLOCK:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER FAILURE 1
5-170
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BF1 TARGET
Self-Reset
MESSAGE
BF1 EVENTS
Disabled
MESSAGE
BF1 PH A INITIATE:
Off
MESSAGE
BF1 PH B INITIATE:
Off
MESSAGE
BF1 PH C INITIATE:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
In general, a breaker failure scheme determines that a breaker signaled to trip has not cleared a fault within a definite time,
so further tripping action must be performed. Tripping from the breaker failure scheme should trip all breakers, both local
and remote, that can supply current to the faulted zone. Usually operation of a breaker failure element will cause clearing of
a larger section of the power system than the initial trip. Because breaker failure can result in tripping a large number of
breakers and this affects system safety and stability, a very high level of security is required.
Two schemes are provided: one for three-pole tripping only (identified by the name "3BF") and one for three pole plus single-pole operation (identified by the name "1BF"). The philosophy used in these schemes is identical. The operation of a
breaker failure element includes three stages: initiation, determination of a breaker failure condition, and output.
INITIATION STAGE:
A FlexLogic operand representing the protection trip signal initially sent to the breaker must be selected to initiate the
scheme, except for the D60 relay were this is already programmed as a trip output (the protection trip signal does not
include other breaker commands that are not indicative of a fault in the protected zone). The initiating signal should be
sealed-in if primary fault detection can reset before the breaker failure timers have finished timing. The seal-in is supervised
by current level, so it is reset when the fault is cleared. If desired, an incomplete sequence seal-in reset can be implemented by using the initiating operand to also initiate a FlexLogic timer, set longer than any breaker failure timer, whose
output operand is selected to block the breaker failure scheme.
Schemes can be initiated either directly or with current level supervision. It is particularly important in any application to
decide if a current-supervised initiate is to be used. The use of a current-supervised initiate results in the breaker failure element not being initiated for a breaker that has very little or no current flowing through it, which may be the case for transformer faults. For those situations where it is required to maintain breaker fail coverage for fault levels below the BF1 PH
AMP SUPV PICKUP or the BF1 N AMP SUPV PICKUP setting, a current supervised initiate should not be used. This feature
should be utilized for those situations where coordinating margins may be reduced when high speed reclosing is used.
Thus, if this choice is made, fault levels must always be above the supervision pickup levels for dependable operation of
GE Multilin
5-171
5 SETTINGS
the breaker fail scheme. This can also occur in breaker-and-a-half or ring bus configurations where the first breaker closes
into a fault; the protection trips and attempts to initiate breaker failure for the second breaker, which is in the process of
closing, but does not yet have current flowing through it.
When the scheme is initiated, it immediately sends a trip signal to the breaker initially signaled to trip (this feature is usually
described as re-trip). This reduces the possibility of widespread tripping that results from a declaration of a failed breaker.
DETERMINATION OF A BREAKER FAILURE CONDITION:
The schemes determine a breaker failure condition via three paths. Each of these paths is equipped with a time delay,
after which a failed breaker is declared and trip signals are sent to all breakers required to clear the zone. The delayed
paths are associated with breaker failure timers 1, 2, and 3, which are intended to have delays increasing with increasing
timer numbers. These delayed paths are individually enabled to allow for maximum flexibility.
Timer 1 logic (early path) is supervised by a fast-operating breaker auxiliary contact. If the breaker is still closed (as indicated by the auxiliary contact) and fault current is detected after the delay interval, an output is issued. Operation of the
breaker auxiliary switch indicates that the breaker has mechanically operated. The continued presence of current indicates
that the breaker has failed to interrupt the circuit.
Timer 2 logic (main path) is not supervised by a breaker auxiliary contact. If fault current is detected after the delay interval,
an output is issued. This path is intended to detect a breaker that opens mechanically but fails to interrupt fault current; the
logic therefore does not use a breaker auxiliary contact.
The timer 1 and 2 paths provide two levels of current supervision, high-set and low-set, that allow the supervision level to
change from a current which flows before a breaker inserts an opening resistor into the faulted circuit to a lower level after
resistor insertion. The high-set detector is enabled after timeout of timer 1 or 2, along with a timer that will enable the lowset detector after its delay interval. The delay interval between high-set and low-set is the expected breaker opening time.
Both current detectors provide a fast operating time for currents at small multiples of the pickup value. The overcurrent
detectors are required to operate after the breaker failure delay interval to eliminate the need for very fast resetting overcurrent detectors.
Timer 3 logic (slow path) is supervised by a breaker auxiliary contact and a control switch contact used to indicate that the
breaker is in or out-of-service, disabling this path when the breaker is out-of-service for maintenance. There is no current
level check in this logic as it is intended to detect low magnitude faults and it is therefore the slowest to operate.
OUTPUT:
The outputs from the schemes are:
FlexLogic operands that initiate tripping required to clear the faulted zone. The trip output can be sealed-in for an
adjustable period.
Illumination of the faceplate Trip LED (and the Phase A, B or C LED, if applicable)
FAILED INTERRUPTION
0
AMP
CORRECT INTERRUPTION
Rampdown
PROTECTION OPERATION
(ASSUMED 1.5 cycles)
cycles
1
10
11
827083A6.CDR
5-172
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The current supervision elements reset in less than 0.7 of a power cycle up to the multiple of pickup of 100 (threshold set at
0.01 of the actual fault current) as shown below.
BF1 MODE: This setting is used to select the breaker failure operating mode: single or three pole.
BF1 USE AMP SUPV: If set to "Yes", the element will only be initiated if current flowing through the breaker is above
the supervision pickup level.
BF1 USE SEAL-IN: If set to "Yes", the element will only be sealed-in if current flowing through the breaker is above the
supervision pickup level.
BF1 3-POLE INITIATE: This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that will initiate 3-pole tripping of the breaker.
BF1 PH AMP SUPV PICKUP: This setting is used to set the phase current initiation and seal-in supervision level.
Generally this setting should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker. It can be set as low as
necessary (lower than breaker resistor current or lower than load current) - Hiset and Loset current supervision will
guarantee correct operation.
BF1 N AMP SUPV PICKUP: This setting is used to set the neutral current initiate and seal-in supervision level. Generally this setting should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker. Neutral current supervision is
used only in the three phase scheme to provide increased sensitivity. This setting is valid only for three-pole tripping
schemes.
BF1 TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY: Timer 1 is set to the shortest time required for breaker auxiliary contact Status-1 to
open, from the time the initial trip signal is applied to the breaker trip circuit, plus a safety margin.
BF1 TIMER 2 PICKUP DELAY: Timer 2 is set to the expected opening time of the breaker, plus a safety margin. This
safety margin was historically intended to allow for measuring and timing errors in the breaker failure scheme equipment. In microprocessor relays this time is not significant. In D60 relays, which use a Fourier transform, the calculated
current magnitude will ramp-down to zero one power frequency cycle after the current is interrupted, and this lag
should be included in the overall margin duration, as it occurs after current interruption. The Breaker Failure Main Path
Sequence diagram below shows a margin of two cycles; this interval is considered the minimum appropriate for most
applications.
Note that in bulk oil circuit breakers, the interrupting time for currents less than 25% of the interrupting rating can be
significantly longer than the normal interrupting time.
GE Multilin
5-173
5 SETTINGS
BF1 TIMER 3 PICKUP DELAY: Timer 3 is set to the same interval as Timer 2, plus an increased safety margin.
Because this path is intended to operate only for low level faults, the delay can be in the order of 300 to 500 ms.
BF1 BKR POS1 A/3P: This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the protected breaker early-type
auxiliary switch contact (52/a). When using 1-Pole breaker failure scheme, this operand represents the protected
breaker early-type auxiliary switch contact on pole A. This is normally a non-multiplied Form-A contact. The contact
may even be adjusted to have the shortest possible operating time.
BF1 BKR POS2 A/3P: This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the breaker normal-type auxiliary
switch contact (52/a). When using 1-Pole breaker failure scheme, this operand represents the protected breaker auxiliary switch contact on pole A. This may be a multiplied contact.
BF1 BREAKER TEST ON: This setting is used to select the FlexLogic operand that represents the breaker In-Service/Out-of-Service switch set to the Out-of-Service position.
BF1 PH AMP HISET PICKUP: This setting sets the phase current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, before a breaker opening resistor is inserted.
BF1 N AMP HISET PICKUP: This setting sets the neutral current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, before a breaker opening resistor is inserted.
Neutral current supervision is used only in the three pole scheme to provide increased sensitivity. This setting is valid
only for 3-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 PH AMP LOSET PICKUP: This setting sets the phase current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, after a breaker opening resistor is inserted
(approximately 90% of the resistor current).
BF1 N AMP LOSET PICKUP: This setting sets the neutral current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, after a breaker opening resistor is inserted
(approximately 90% of the resistor current). This setting is valid only for 3-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 LOSET TIME DELAY: Sets the pickup delay for current detection after opening resistor insertion.
BF1 TRIP DROPOUT DELAY: This setting is used to set the period of time for which the trip output is sealed-in. This
timer must be coordinated with the automatic reclosing scheme of the failed breaker, to which the breaker failure element sends a cancel reclosure signal. Reclosure of a remote breaker can also be prevented by holding a Transfer Trip
signal on longer than the "reclaim" time.
BF1 PH A INITIATE / BF1 PH B INITIATE / BF 1 PH C INITIATE: These settings select the FlexLogic operand to initiate phase A, B, or C single-pole tripping of the breaker and the phase A, B, or C portion of the scheme, accordingly.
This setting is only valid for 1-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 BKR POS1 B / BF1 BKR POS 1 C: These settings select the FlexLogic operand to represents the protected
breaker early-type auxiliary switch contact on poles B or C, accordingly. This contact is normally a non-multiplied FormA contact. The contact may even be adjusted to have the shortest possible operating time. This setting is valid only for
1-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 BKR POS2 B: Selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the protected breaker normal-type auxiliary
switch contact on pole B (52/a). This may be a multiplied contact. This setting is valid only for 1-pole breaker failure
schemes.
BF1 BKR POS2 C: This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the protected breaker normal-type
auxiliary switch contact on pole C (52/a). This may be a multiplied contact. For single-pole operation, the scheme has
the same overall general concept except that it provides re-tripping of each single pole of the protected breaker. The
approach shown in the following single pole tripping diagram uses the initiating information to determine which pole is
supposed to trip. The logic is segregated on a per-pole basis. The overcurrent detectors have ganged settings. This
setting is valid only for 1-pole breaker failure schemes.
Upon operation of the breaker failure element for a single pole trip command, a 3-pole trip command should be given
via output operand BKR FAIL 1 TRIP OP.
5-174
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
In D60 Only
From Trip Output
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
TRIP PHASE C
TRIP PHASE B
TRIP 3-POLE
TRIP PHASE A
SETTING
BF1 FUNCTION:
Enable=1
Disable=0
SETTING
AND
BF1 BLOCK :
Off=0
SETTING
BF1 PH A INITIATE:
OR
Off=0
SETTING
BF1 3-POLE INITIATE :
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR FAIL 1 RETRIPA
OR
OR
AND
Off=0
Initiated Ph A
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
SETTING
BF1 USE SEAL-IN:
YES=1
SETTING
AND
NO=0
SEAL-IN PATH
AND
OR
OR
NO=0
OR
SETTING
BF1 PH B INITIATE :
OR
OR
AND
Off=0
SEAL-IN PATH
AND
Initiated Ph B
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
OR
SETTING
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BF1 PH C INITIATE :
OR
Off=0
SETTING
BF1 SOURCE :
IB
IC
AND
SETTING
IA
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
(Initiated)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RUN
RUN
RUN
IA
SEAL-IN PATH
Initiated Ph C
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
PICKUP
IB
PICKUP
IC
PICKUP
AND
OR
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
(827070.CDR)
827069A5.CDR
GE Multilin
5-175
FROM SHEET 1 OF 2
(Initiated)
SETTING
SETTING
YES=1
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR FAIL 1 T1 OP
NO=0
SETTING
BF1 BKR POS1
A/3P:
Off=0
AND
FROM SHEET 1 OF 2
Initiated Ph A
OR
SETTING
SETTING
NO=0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
YES=1
BKR FAIL 1 T2 OP
SETTING
BF1 BKR POS1
B:
Off=0
AND
FROM SHEET 1 OF 2
Initiated Ph B
OR
AND
SETTING
BF1 BKR POS1
C:
Off=0
AND
FROM SHEET 1 OF 2
Initiated Ph C
OR
AND
SETTING
BF1 PH AMP HISET
PICKUP:
FROM SHEET 1 OF 2
(827069.CDR)
RUN
IA
RUN
IB
RUN
IC
IA
PICKUP
IB
PICKUP
IC
PICKUP
SETTING
SETTING
YES=1
NO=0
OR
SETTING
BF1 BKR POS2
A/3P:
SETTING
SETTING
B:
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
RUN
Off=0
SETTING
RUN
IA
PICKUP
IB
PICKUP
IC
PICKUP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off=0
BKR FAIL 1 T3 OP
SETTING
BF1 BKR POS2
C:
Off=0
SETTING
BF1 BREAKER TEST ON:
Off=0
827070A4.CDR
5-176
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
GE Multilin
5-177
5 SETTINGS
5-178
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
PHASE
UNDERVOLTAGE1
MESSAGE
PHASE
UNDERVOLTAGE2
MESSAGE
PHASE
OVERVOLTAGE1
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL OV1
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL OV2
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL OV3
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY UV1
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY UV2
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY OV1
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY OV2
These protection elements can be used for a variety of applications such as:
Undervoltage Protection: For voltage sensitive loads, such as induction motors, a drop in voltage increases the
drawn current which may cause dangerous overheating in the motor. The undervoltage protection feature can be used
to either cause a trip or generate an alarm when the voltage drops below a specified voltage setting for a specified time
delay.
Permissive Functions: The undervoltage feature may be used to block the functioning of external devices by operating an output relay when the voltage falls below the specified voltage setting. The undervoltage feature may also be
used to block the functioning of other elements through the block feature of those elements.
Source Transfer Schemes: In the event of an undervoltage, a transfer signal may be generated to transfer a load
from its normal source to a standby or emergency power source.
The undervoltage elements can be programmed to have a definite time delay characteristic. The definite time curve operates when the voltage drops below the pickup level for a specified period of time. The time delay is adjustable from 0 to
600.00 seconds in steps of 0.01. The undervoltage elements can also be programmed to have an inverse time delay characteristic.
GE Multilin
5-179
5 SETTINGS
The undervoltage delay setting defines the family of curves shown below.
D
T = --------------------------------V
1 -----------------
(EQ 5.22)
pickup
T = operating time
D = undervoltage delay setting (D = 0.00 operates instantaneously)
V = secondary voltage applied to the relay
Vpickup = pickup level
Time (seconds)
where:
5
% of voltage pickup
842788A1.CDR
5-180
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PHASE UV1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE UV1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
PHASE UV1
CURVE: Definite Time
MESSAGE
PHASE UV1
DELAY:
1.00 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE UV1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PHASE UV1
EVENTS: Disabled
PHASE
UNDERVOLTAGE1
This element may be used to give a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied fundamental voltage
(phase-to-ground or phase-to-phase for Wye VT connection, or phase-to-phase for Delta VT connection) or as a Definite
Time element. The element resets instantaneously if the applied voltage exceeds the dropout voltage. The delay setting
selects the minimum operating time of the phase undervoltage. The minimum voltage setting selects the operating voltage
below which the element is blocked (a setting of 0 will allow a dead source to be considered a fault condition).
SETTING
SETTING
PHASE UV1
FUNCTION:
PHASE UV1
PICKUP:
Disabled = 0
PHASE UV1
CURVE:
Enabled = 1
SETTING
AND
PHASE UV1
BLOCK:
AND
PHASE UV1
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PHASE UV1 A OP
Off = 0
SETTING
SETTING
PHASE UV1 SOURCE:
Source VT = Delta
VAB
VBC
VCA
Source VT = Wye
SETTING
PHASE UV1 MODE:
Phase to Ground Phase to Phase
VAG
VAB
VBG
VBC
VCG
VCA
PHASE UV1
MINIMUM VOLTAGE:
VAG or VAB < Minimum
VBG or VBC < Minimum
VCG or VCA < Minimum
AND
V
RUN VBG or VBC< PICKUP
PHASE UV1 B OP
AND
V
RUN VCG or VCA < PICKUP
OR
PHASE UV1 OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
GE Multilin
5-181
5 SETTINGS
PHASE OV1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE OV1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PHASE OV1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PHASE OV1
EVENTS: Disabled
PHASE
OVERVOLTAGE1
The phase overvoltage element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional time delay or as a definite
time element. The input voltage is the phase-to-phase voltage, either measured directly from delta-connected VTs or as calculated from phase-to-ground (wye) connected VTs. The specific voltages to be used for each phase are shown below.
SETTINGS
SETTING
PHASE OV1
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
PHASE OV1
PICKUP:
RUN
tPKP
VAB PICKUP
SETTING
AND
RUN
PHASE OV1
BLOCK:
RUN
Off = 0
VBC PICKUP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PHASE OV1 A PKP
PHASE OV1 A DPO
PHASE OV1 A OP
tRST
tPKP
PHASE OV1 B OP
tRST
VCA PICKUP
tPKP
PHASE OV1 C OP
tRST
SETTING
PHASE OV1
SOURCE:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Source VT = Delta
OR
PHASE OV1 OP
VAB
VBC
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
VCA
AND
Source VT = Wye
OR
5-182
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
NEUTRAL OV1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL OV1
There are three neutral overvoltage elements available. The neutral overvoltage element can be used to detect asymmetrical system voltage condition due to a ground fault or to the loss of one or two phases of the source. The element responds
to the system neutral voltage (3V_0), calculated from the phase voltages. The nominal secondary voltage of the phase voltage channels entered under SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK PHASE VT SECONDARY is the
p.u. base used when setting the pickup level.
The neutral overvoltage element can provide a time-delayed operating characteristic versus the applied voltage (initialized
from FlexCurves A, B, or C) or be used as a definite time element. The NEUTRAL OV1(3) PICKUP DELAY setting applies only if
the NEUTRAL OV1(3) CURVE setting is Definite time. The source assigned to this element must be configured for a phase
VT.
VT errors and normal voltage unbalance must be considered when setting this element. This function requires the VTs to
be wye-connected.
GE Multilin
5-183
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SETTING
Enabled = 1
AND
RUN
SETTINGS
NEG SEQ OV1 PICKUP
DELAY:
NEG SEQ OV1 RESET
DELAY:
Off = 0
t PKP
SETTING
NEG SEQ OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
Wye VT
V_2
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEG SEQ OV1 PKP
NEG SEQ OV1 DPO
t RST
Delta VT
3 V_2
827839A3.CDR
5-184
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
AUX UV1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY UV1
The D60 contains one auxiliary overvoltage element for each VT bank. This element is intended for monitoring undervoltage conditions of the auxiliary voltage. The AUX UV1 PICKUP selects the voltage level at which the time undervoltage element starts timing. The nominal secondary voltage of the auxiliary voltage channel entered under SETTINGS SYSTEM
SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK X5 AUXILIARY VT X5 SECONDARY is the per-unit base used when setting the
pickup level.
The AUX UV1 DELAY setting selects the minimum operating time of the auxiliary undervoltage element. Both AUX UV1 PICKUP
and AUX UV1 DELAY settings establish the operating curve of the undervoltage element. The auxiliary undervoltage element
can be programmed to use either definite time delay or inverse time delay characteristics. The operating characteristics
and equations for both definite and inverse time delay are as for the phase undervoltage element.
The element resets instantaneously. The minimum voltage setting selects the operating voltage below which the element is
blocked.
SETTING
AUX UV1
FUNCTION:
SETTING
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SETTING
Off=0
SETTING
AUX UV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
AUX VOLT Vx
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Vx < Pickup
RUN
SETTING
AUX UV1 MINIMUM
VOLTAGE:
AUX UV1 OP
Vx < Minimum
V
827849A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-185
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The negative-sequence time overcurrent element may be used to determine and clear unbalance in the system. The input
for calculating negative-sequence current is the fundamental phasor value.
Two methods of resetting operation are available; Timed and Instantaneous (refer to the Inverse Time Overcurrent Characteristics sub-section for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to Instantaneous and the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
SETTING
NEG SEQ TOC1 INPUT:
NEG SEQ TOC1 PICKUP:
SETTING
NEG SEQ TOC1 CURVE:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
NEG SEQ TOC1 RESET:
SETTING
AND
Off=0
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEG SEQ TOC1 PKP
NEG SEQ TOC1 DPO
NEG SEQ TOC1 OP
SETTING
NEG SEQ TOC1 SOURCE:
Neg Seq
827057A4.CDR
5-186
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.6CONTROL ELEMENTS
5.6.1 OVERVIEW
Control elements are generally used for control rather than protection. See the Introduction to Elements section at the
beginning of this chapter for further information.
5.6.2 SETTING GROUPS
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SETTINGS GROUPS
SETTING GROUPS
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SETTING GROUPS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GROUP 1 NAME:
GROUP 2 NAME:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GROUP 6 NAME:
SETTING GROUP
EVENTS: Disabled
The Setting Groups menu controls the activation/deactivation of up to six possible groups of settings in the GROUPED ELEsettings menu. The faceplate Settings In Use LEDs indicate which active group (with a non-flashing energized
LED) is in service.
MENTS
The SETTING GROUPS BLK setting prevents the active setting group from changing when the FlexLogic parameter is set to
"On". This can be useful in applications where it is undesirable to change the settings under certain conditions, such as the
breaker being open.
Each GROUP n ACTIVATE ON setting selects a FlexLogic operand which, when set, will make the particular setting group
active for use by any grouped element. A priority scheme ensures that only one group is active at a given time the highest-numbered group which is activated by its GROUP n ACTIVATE ON parameter takes priority over the lower-numbered
groups. There is no activate on setting for Group 1 (the default active group), because Group 1 automatically becomes
active if no other group is active.
The SETTING GROUP 1(6) NAME settings allows to user to assign a name to each of the six settings groups. Once programmed, this name will appear on the second line of the GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) menu display.
The relay can be set up via a FlexLogic equation to receive requests to activate or de-activate a particular non-default
settings group. The following FlexLogic equation (see the figure below) illustrates requests via remote communications
(e.g. VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ON) or from a local contact input (e.g. CONTACT IP 1 ON) to initiate the use of a particular settings
group, and requests from several overcurrent pickup measuring elements to inhibit the use of the particular settings group.
The assigned VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 operand is used to control the On state of a particular settings group.
GE Multilin
5-187
5 SETTINGS
VIRT IP 1 ON (VI1)
CONT IP 1 ON (H5A)
OR (2)
NOT
NOT
AND (3)
= VIRT OP 1 (VO1)
10
END
OR (2)
AND (3)
= VIRT OP 1 (VO1)
842789A1.CDR
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 FULL
RANGE: 7
Range: 1 to 7 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT:
5.0 s
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP:
Off
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP
MODE: Time-out
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 ACK:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 3BIT
MODE: Time-out
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP
MODE: Restore
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 TARGETS:
Self-reset
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
SELECTOR SWITCH 1
5-188
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The Selector Switch element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic.
The element provides for two control inputs. The step-up control allows stepping through selector position one step at a
time with each pulse of the control input, such as a user-programmable pushbutton. The 3-bit control input allows setting
the selector to the position defined by a 3-bit word.
The element allows pre-selecting a new position without applying it. The pre-selected position gets applied either after timeout or upon acknowledgement via separate inputs (user setting). The selector position is stored in non-volatile memory.
Upon power-up, either the previous position is restored or the relay synchronizes to the current 3-bit word (user setting).
Basic alarm functionality alerts the user under abnormal conditions; e.g. the 3-bit control input being out of range.
SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE: This setting defines the upper position of the selector. When stepping up through available positions of the selector, the upper position wraps up to the lower position (Position 1). When using a direct 3-bit
control word for programming the selector to a desired position, the change would take place only if the control word is
within the range of 1 to the SELECTOR FULL RANGE. If the control word is outside the range, an alarm is established by
setting the SELECTOR ALARM FlexLogic operand for 3 seconds.
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: This setting defines the time-out period for the selector. This value is used by the relay in
the following two ways. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is Time-out, the setting specifies the required period of
inactivity of the control input after which the pre-selected position is automatically applied. When the SELECTOR STEPUP MODE is Acknowledge, the setting specifies the period of time for the acknowledging input to appear. The timer is
re-started by any activity of the control input. The acknowledging input must come before the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT
timer expires; otherwise, the change will not take place and an alarm will be set.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: This setting specifies a control input for the selector switch. The switch is shifted to a new
position at each rising edge of this signal. The position changes incrementally, wrapping up from the last (SELECTOR 1
FULL RANGE) to the first (Position 1). Consecutive pulses of this control operand must not occur faster than every
50 ms. After each rising edge of the assigned operand, the time-out timer is restarted and the SELECTOR SWITCH 1:
POS Z CHNG INITIATED target message is displayed, where Z the pre-selected position. The message is displayed for
the time specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. The pre-selected position is applied after the selector times out
(Time-out mode), or when the acknowledging signal appears before the element times out (Acknowledge mode).
When the new position is applied, the relay displays the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POSITION Z IN USE message. Typically,
a user-programmable pushbutton is configured as the stepping up control input.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to Time-out, the
selector will change its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and
does not require any explicit confirmation of the intent to change the selector's position. When set to Acknowledge,
the selector will change its position only after the intent is confirmed through a separate acknowledging signal. If the
acknowledging signal does not appear within a pre-defined period of time, the selector does not accept the change
and an alarm is established by setting the SELECTOR STP ALARM output FlexLogic operand for 3 seconds.
SELECTOR 1 ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the stepping up control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned operand. This setting is active only under Acknowledge mode of
operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT setting after the
last activity of the control input. A user-programmable pushbutton is typically configured as the acknowledging input.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0, A1, and A2: These settings specify a 3-bit control input of the selector. The 3-bit control word
pre-selects the position using the following encoding convention:
GE Multilin
A2
A1
A0
POSITION
rest
5-189
5 SETTINGS
The rest position (0, 0, 0) does not generate an action and is intended for situations when the device generating the
3-bit control word is having a problem. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is Time-out, the pre-selected position is applied
in SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT seconds after the last activity of the 3-bit input. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is Acknowledge, the pre-selected position is applied on the rising edge of the SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK acknowledging input.
The stepping up control input (SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP) and the 3-bit control inputs (SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0 through A2) lockout mutually: once the stepping up sequence is initiated, the 3-bit control input is inactive; once the 3-bit control
sequence is initiated, the stepping up input is inactive.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to Time-out, the selector
changes its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not
require explicit confirmation to change the selector position. When set to Acknowledge, the selector changes its position only after confirmation via a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging signal does not appear within a
pre-defined period of time, the selector rejects the change and an alarm established by invoking the SELECTOR BIT
ALARM FlexLogic operand for 3 seconds.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the 3-bit control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned FlexLogic operand. This setting is active only under the
Acknowledge mode of operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR
TIME-OUT setting after the last activity of the 3-bit control inputs. Note that the stepping up control input and 3-bit control
input have independent acknowledging signals (SELECTOR 1 ACK and SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK, accordingly).
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: This setting specifies the element behavior on power up of the relay.
When set to Restore, the last position of the selector (stored in the non-volatile memory) is restored after powering up
the relay. If the position restored from memory is out of range, position 0 (no output operand selected) is applied and
an alarm is set (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
When set to Synchronize selector switch acts as follows. For two power cycles, the selector applies position 0 to the
switch and activates SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM. After two power cycles expire, the selector synchronizes to the position
dictated by the 3-bit control input. This operation does not wait for time-out or the acknowledging input. When the synchronization attempt is unsuccessful (i.e., the 3-bit input is not available (0,0,0) or out of range) then the selector switch
output is set to position 0 (no output operand selected) and an alarm is established (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
The operation of Synch/Restore mode is similar to the Synchronize mode. The only difference is that after an
unsuccessful synchronization attempt, the switch will attempt to restore the position stored in the relay memory. The
Synch/Restore mode is useful for applications where the selector switch is employed to change the setting group in
redundant (two relay) protection schemes.
5-190
DESCRIPTION
SELECTOR 1 POS Z
The selector position pre-selected via the stepping up control input has not been
confirmed before the time out.
The selector position pre-selected via the 3-bit control input has not been confirmed
before the time out.
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The following figures illustrate the operation of the Selector Switch. In these diagrams, T represents a time-out setting.
pre-existing
position 2
changed to 4 with
a pushbutton
changed to 1 with
a 3-bit input
changed to 2 with a
pushbutton
changed to 7 with
a 3-bit input
STEP-UP
T
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
T
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842737A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-191
pre-existing
position 2
5 SETTINGS
changed to 4 with
a pushbutton
changed to 1 with
a 3-bit input
changed to 2 with
a pushbutton
STEP-UP
ACK
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
3BIT ACK
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842736A1.CDR
5-192
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
APPLICATION EXAMPLE
Consider an application where the selector switch is used to control Setting Groups 1 through 4 in the relay. The setting
groups are to be controlled from both User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 and from an external device via Contact Inputs 1
through 3. The active setting group shall be available as an encoded 3-bit word to the external device and SCADA via output contacts 1 through 3. The pre-selected setting group shall be applied automatically after 5 seconds of inactivity of the
control inputs. When the relay powers up, it should synchronize the setting group to the 3-bit control input.
Make the following changes to Setting Group Control in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SETTING GROUPS menu:
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION: Enabled
SETTING GROUPS BLK: Off
GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON: SELECTOR 1 POS
GROUP 3 ACTIVATE ON: SELECTOR 1 POS
2"
3"
Make the following changes to Selector Switch element in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SELECTOR SWITCH
menu to assign control to User Programmable Pushbutton 1 and Contact Inputs 1 through 3:
SELECTOR SWITCH 1
ON
Now, assign the contact output operation (assume the H6E module) to the Selector Switch element by making the following
changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS menu:
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE:
OUTPUT H2 OPERATE:
OUTPUT H3 OPERATE:
Finally, assign configure User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: Self-reset
PUSHBUTTON 1 DROP-OUT TIME: 0.10 s
SETTINGS
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT:
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
RUN
SELECTOR 1 POSITION
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP:
Off = 0
step up
SELECTOR 1 ACK:
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 POS 1
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2:
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 POS 3
SELECTOR 1 POS 2
acknowledge
ON
SELECTOR 1 POS 4
SELECTOR 1 POS 5
SELECTOR 1 POS 6
SELECTOR 1 POS 7
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 ALARM
SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM
SELECTOR 1 BIT 0
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2
842012A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-193
5 SETTINGS
5.6.4 TRIP OUTPUT
TRIP MODE:
Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
TRIP OUTPUT
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
5-194
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
REVERSE FAULT:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BKR A OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
BKR B OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
BKR C OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
TRIP EVENTS:
Disabled
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The trip output element is primarily used to collect trip requests from protection elements and other inputs to generate output operands to initiate trip operations. Three pole trips will only initiate reclosure if programmed to do so, whereas single
pole trips will always automatically initiate reclosure. The TRIP 3-POLE and TRIP 1-POLE output operands can also be used
as inputs to a FlexLogic OR gate to operate the faceplate Trip indicator LED.
THREE POLE OPERATION:
In applications where single-pole tripping is not required this element provides a convenient method of collecting inputs to
initiate tripping of circuit breakers, the reclose element and breaker failure elements.
SINGLE POLE OPERATION:
This element must be used in single pole operation applications.
NOTE
Collect inputs to initiate three pole tripping, the recloser and breaker failure elements.
Collect inputs to initiate single pole tripping, the recloser and breaker failure elements.
Assign a higher priority to pilot aided scheme outputs than to exclusively local inputs.
The trip output element works in association with other D60 elements (refer to chapter 8 for a complete description of single
pole operations) that must be programmed and in-service for successful operation. The necessary elements are: recloser,
breaker control, open pole detector, and phase selector. The recloser must also be in the Reset state before a single pole
trip can be issued. Outputs from this element are also directly connected as initiate signals to the breaker failure elements.
At least one internal protection element or digital input representing detection of a fault must be available as an input to this
element. In pilot-aided scheme applications, a timer can be used to delay the output decision until data from a remote terminal is received from communications facilities, to prevent a three pole operation where a single pole operation is permitted.
TRIP MODE: This setting is used to select the required mode of operation. If selected to 3 Pole Only outputs for all
three phases are always set simultaneously. If selected to 3 Pole & 1 Pole outputs for all three phases are set simultaneously unless the phase selector or a pilot aided scheme determines the fault is single-phase-to-ground. If the fault
is identified as being AG, BG or CG only the operands for the faulted phase will be asserted.
TRIP 3-POLE INPUT-1 to TRIP 3-POLE INPUT-6: These settings are used to select an operand representing a fault
condition that is not desired to initiate a single pole operation (for example, phase undervoltage). Use a FlexLogic ORgate if more than six inputs are required.
TRIP 1-POLE INPUT-1 to TRIP 1-POLE INPUT-6: These settings are used to select an operand representing a fault
condition that is desired to initiate a single pole trip-and-reclose if the fault is single phase to ground (for example, distance zone 1). Use a FlexLogic OR-gate if more than six inputs are required. The inputs do not have to be phasespecific as the phase selector determines the fault type.
The AR FORCE 3-P TRIP operand is asserted by the autorecloser 1.5 cycles after single-pole reclosing is initiated. This
operand calls for a three-pole trip if any protection element configured under TRIP 1-POLE INPUT remains picked-up. The
open pole detector provides blocking inputs to distance elements, and therefore the latter will reset immediately after
the TRIP 1-POLE operand is asserted. For other protection elements used in single-pole tripping, the user must ensure
they will reset immediately after tripping, otherwise the fact that they are still picked up will be detected as an evolving
fault and the relay will trip three-poles. For example, if high-set phase instantaneous overcurrent is used (TRIP 1-POLE
INPUT X: PHASE IOC1 OP), then OPEN POLE OP A shall be used for blocking phase A of the instantaneous overcurrent element. In this way, after tripping phase A, the phase a instantaneous overcurrent element is forced to reset.
Phases B and C are still operational and can detect an evolving fault as soon as 8 ms after tripping phase A. Neutral
and negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent elements shall be blocked from the OPEN POLE BLK N operand
unless the pickup setting is high enough to prevent pickup during single-pole reclosing.
TRIP RECLOSE INPUT-1 to TRIP RECLOSE INPUT-6: These settings select an operand representing a fault condition that is desired to initiate three pole reclosing (for example, phase distance zone 1). Use a FlexLogic OR-gate if
more than six inputs are required.
GE Multilin
5-195
5 SETTINGS
TRIP FORCE 3-POLE: Selects an operand that will force an input selected for single pole operation to produce a three
pole operation. The AR DISABLED FlexLogic operand is the recommended value for this setting. Power system configurations or conditions which require such operations may be considered as well.
TRIP PILOT PRIORITY: This setting is used to set an interval equal to the inter-relay channel communications time,
plus an appropriate margin, during which outputs are not asserted. This delay permits fault identification information
from a remote terminal to be used instead of local data only.
REVERSE FAULT: This setting should be used to guarantee accuracy of single-pole tripping under evolving external to
internal faults. When a close-in external fault occurs, the relay is biased toward very fast operation on a following internal fault. This is primarily due to depressed voltages and elevated currents in response to the first, external fault. The
phase selector may exhibit some time lag compared to the main protection elements. This may potentially result in a
spurious three-pole operation on a single-line-to-ground internal fault. Delaying tripping on internal faults that follow
detection of reverse faults solves the problem.
As long as the operand indicated under this setting is asserted the trip action will be delayed by TRIP DELAY ON EVOLV
FAULTS time. Typically this operand should combine reverse zone indications (such as zone 4 pickup) with a half-cycle
pickup delay, and two-cycle dropout delay. This setting should be used only in single-pole tripping applications, when
evolving faults are of importance, and slightly delayed operation on evolving faults could be traded for enhanced accuracy of single-pole tripping.
TRIP DELAY ON EVOLV FAULTS: This setting should be used in conjunction with the REVERSE FAULT setting (see
above). Typically this value should be set around half a power system cycle. This setting should be used only in singlepole tripping applications, when evolving faults are of importance, and slightly delayed operation on evolving faults
could be traded for enhanced accuracy of single-pole tripping.
5-196
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTINGS
TRIP MODE
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP FORCE
POTT
TRIP 3P3-POLE
3P
= 3 Pole Only
= 3 Pole and 1 Pole
TRIP FORCE 3-POLE
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE OP
OR
OR
AND
2 cyc
OR
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LINE PICKUP OP
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP 3P
D60 only
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DUTT TRIP 3P
PUTT TRIP 3P
HYBRID POTT TRIP 3P
DIR BLOCK TRIP 3P
DCUB TRIP 3P
L90 only
87L TRIP 3P OP
AND
OR
SETTING
TRIP 3-POLE INPUT 1
= Off
AND
SETTING
TRIP 3-POLE INPUT 6
OR
OR
= Off
SETTING
TRIP 1-POLE INPUT 1
AND
= Off
SETTING
TRIP 1-POLE INPUT 6
OR
AND
AND
SETTING
= Off
TRIP PILOT
PRIORITY
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PHASE SELECT MULTI-P
PHASE SELECT VOID
PHASE SELECT AG
PHASE SELECT BG
PHASE SELECT CG
OR
AND
D60 only
L90 only
OR
PHASE A
OR
PHASE B
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP A
3P
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DUTT TRIP A
3P
PUTT TRIP A
3P
HYBRID POTT TRIP A
3P
DIR BLOCK TRIP A
3P
DCUB TRIP A
3P
87L TRIP OP A
AND
AND
OR
PHASE C
To trip output
logic sheet 2,
837034A1
0
OR
OR
Only 1 of 3 can
be asserted
3P
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP A
3P
D60 only
L90 only
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DUTT TRIP A
3P
PUTT TRIP A
3P
HYBRID POTT TRIP A
3P
DIR BLOCK TRIP A
3P
DCUB TRIP A
3P
87L TRIP OP A
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP A
3P
D60 only
L90 only
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DUTT TRIP A
3P
PUTT TRIP A
3P
HYBRID POTT TRIP A
3P
DIR BLOCK TRIP A
3P
DCUB TRIP A
3P
87L TRIP OP A
OR
837025AD.CDR
GE Multilin
5-197
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
TRIP DELAY ON EVOLV
FAULTS
PHASE A
From trip output
logic sheet 1,
837025AD
PHASE B
OR
PHASE C
Latch
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP PHASE A
Latch
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP PHASE B
AND
SETTING
TRIP DELAY ON EVOLV
FAULTS
0
SETTING
REVERSE FAULT
OR
AND
= Off
SETTING
TRIP DELAY ON EVOLV
FAULTS
0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP PHASE C
Latch
AND
R
3P
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch
TRIP 3-POLE
SETTING
BKR A OPEN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
= Off
TRIP 1-POLE
AND
XOR
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP
OPEN
POLE3PBKR A OP
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
0
20 ms
SETTING
BKR B OPEN
= Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP
OPEN
POLE3PBKR B OP
SETTING
BKR C OPEN
= Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT TRIP
OPEN
POLE3PBKR C OP
SETTING
TRIP RECLOSE INPUT 1
= Off
SETTING
TRIP RECLOSE INPUT 6
OR
= Off
837034A1.CDR
5-198
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SYNCHK1 FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 BLOCK:
Off
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 V1 SOURCE:
SRC 1
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 V2 SOURCE:
SRC 2
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: None, LV1 and DV2, DV1 and LV2, DV1 or DV2,
DV1 Xor DV2, DV1 and DV2
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 DEAD V1
MAX VOLT: 0.30 pu
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 DEAD V2
MAX VOLT: 0.30 pu
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 LIVE V1
MIN VOLT: 0.70 pu
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 LIVE V2
MIN VOLT: 0.70 pu
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 TARGET:
Self-reset
MESSAGE
SYNCHK1 EVENTS:
Disabled
SYNCHROCHECK 1
(EQ 5.23)
GE Multilin
5-199
5 SETTINGS
As an example; for the default values ( = 30, F = 0.1 Hz), the time while the angle between the two voltages will be
less than the set value is:
1
1
T = ------------------------------- = ------------------------------------------ = 1.66 sec.
360
360
------------------ F
------------------- 0.1 Hz
2
2 30
(EQ 5.24)
If one or both sources are de-energized, the synchrocheck programming can allow for closing of the circuit breaker using
undervoltage control to by-pass the synchrocheck measurements (Dead Source function).
SYNCHK1 V1 SOURCE: This setting selects the source for voltage V1 (see NOTES below).
SYNCHK1 V2 SOURCE: This setting selects the source for voltage V2, which must not be the same as used for the
V1 (see NOTES below).
SYNCHK1 MAX VOLT DIFF: This setting selects the maximum primary voltage difference in volts between the two
sources. A primary voltage magnitude difference between the two input voltages below this value is within the permissible limit for synchronism.
SYNCHK1 MAX ANGLE DIFF: This setting selects the maximum angular difference in degrees between the two
sources. An angular difference between the two input voltage phasors below this value is within the permissible limit
for synchronism.
SYNCHK1 MAX FREQ DIFF: This setting selects the maximum frequency difference in Hz between the two sources.
A frequency difference between the two input voltage systems below this value is within the permissible limit for synchronism.
SYNCHK1 MAX FREQ HYSTERESIS: This setting specifies the required hysteresis for the maximum frequency difference condition. The condition becomes satisfied when the frequency difference becomes lower than SYNCHK1 MAX
FREQ DIFF. Once the Synchrocheck element has operated, the frequency difference must increase above the SYNCHK1
MAX FREQ DIFF + SYNCHK1 MAX FREQ HYSTERESIS sum to drop out (assuming the other two conditions, voltage and
angle, remain satisfied).
SYNCHK1 DEAD SOURCE SELECT: This setting selects the combination of dead and live sources that will by-pass
synchronism check function and permit the breaker to be closed when one or both of the two voltages (V1 or/and V2)
are below the maximum voltage threshold. A dead or live source is declared by monitoring the voltage level. Six
options are available:
None:
LV1 and DV2:
DV1 and LV2:
DV1 or DV2:
DV1 Xor DV2:
DV1 and DV2:
SYNCHK1 DEAD V1 MAX VOLT: This setting establishes a maximum voltage magnitude for V1 in 1 pu. Below this
magnitude, the V1 voltage input used for synchrocheck will be considered Dead or de-energized.
SYNCHK1 DEAD V2 MAX VOLT: This setting establishes a maximum voltage magnitude for V2 in pu. Below this
magnitude, the V2 voltage input used for synchrocheck will be considered Dead or de-energized.
SYNCHK1 LIVE V1 MIN VOLT: This setting establishes a minimum voltage magnitude for V1 in pu. Above this magnitude, the V1 voltage input used for synchrocheck will be considered Live or energized.
SYNCHK1 LIVE V2 MIN VOLT: This setting establishes a minimum voltage magnitude for V2 in pu. Above this magnitude, the V2 voltage input used for synchrocheck will be considered Live or energized.
5-200
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The selected sources for synchrocheck inputs V1 and V2 (which must not be the same source) may include both a
three-phase and an auxiliary voltage. The relay will automatically select the specific voltages to be used by the synchrocheck element in accordance with the following table.
NO.
V1 OR V2
(SOURCE Y)
V2 OR V1
(SOURCE Z)
AUTO-SELECTED
COMBINATION
AUTO-SELECTED VOLTAGE
SOURCE Y
SOURCE Z
Phase
Phase
VAB
Phase VT
Phase
Phase
VAB
Phase VT
Phase VT
Phase
Phase
VAB
Phase VT and
Auxiliary VT
Auxiliary VT
Phase
Auxiliary
V auxiliary
(as set for Source z)
Auxiliary VT
Auxiliary VT
Auxiliary
Auxiliary
V auxiliary
(as set for selected sources)
The voltages V1 and V2 will be matched automatically so that the corresponding voltages from the two sources will be
used to measure conditions. A phase to phase voltage will be used if available in both sources; if one or both of the
Sources have only an auxiliary voltage, this voltage will be used. For example, if an auxiliary voltage is programmed to
VAG, the synchrocheck element will automatically select VAG from the other source. If the comparison is required on a
specific voltage, the user can externally connect that specific voltage to auxiliary voltage terminals and then use this
"Auxiliary Voltage" to check the synchronism conditions.
If using a single CT/VT module with both phase voltages and an auxiliary voltage, ensure that only the auxiliary voltage
is programmed in one of the sources to be used for synchrocheck.
Exception: Synchronism cannot be checked between Delta connected phase VTs and a Wye connected auxiliary voltage.
NOTE
2.
The relay measures frequency and Volts/Hz from an input on a given source with priorities as established by the configuration of input channels to the source. The relay will use the phase channel of a three-phase set of voltages if programmed as part of that source. The relay will use the auxiliary voltage channel only if that channel is programmed as
part of the Source and a three-phase set is not.
GE Multilin
5-201
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SYNCHK1 FUNCTION:
Enable=1
Disable=0
SETTING
AND
SYNCHK1 BLOCK:
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off=0
SYNC1 DEAD S OP
SYNC1 DEAD S DPO
None
AND
AND
AND
DV1 or DV2
AND
OR
AND
SETTING
SYNCHK1 DEAD V1
MAX VOLT:
V1
Max
XOR
SETTING
SYNCHK1 DEAD V2
MAX VOLT:
V2
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
Max
OR
SYNC1 CLS OP
SYNC1 CLS DPO
SETTING
SYNCHK1 LIVE V1
MIN VOLT:
V1
AND
Min
SETTING
SYNCHK1 LIVE V2
MIN VOLT:
V2
AND
Min
SETTING
SETTING
CALCULATE
SYNCHK1 V1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
Magnitude V1
SRC 1
Frequency F1
Angle
Calculate
I V1-V2 I=
SETTING
SYNC1:
Calculate
I 1- 2 I=
SETTING
CALCULATE
SYNCHK1 V2 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
Magnitude V2
SRC 2
Frequency F2
Angle
Calculate
I F1-F2 I=
Max
ACTUAL VALUE
AND
Max
ACTUAL VALUE
SETTING
SYNC1:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
IN SYNCH 1
SYNC1 SYNC OP
Max
ACTUAL VALUE
SYNC1:
827076AA.CDR
5-202
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
AR FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
AR MODE:
1 & 3 Pole
MESSAGE
AR MAX NUMBER OF
SHOTS: 2
Range: 1, 2, 3, 4
MESSAGE
AR BLOCK BKR1:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AR 1P INIT:
Off
MESSAGE
AR 3P INIT:
Off
MESSAGE
AR 3P TD INIT:
Off
MESSAGE
AR MULTI-P FAULT:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AR EXTEND DEAD T 1:
Off
MESSAGE
AR DEAD TIME 1
EXTENSION: 0.50 s
MESSAGE
AR RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
AR RESET TIME:
60.00 s
AUTORECLOSE
GE Multilin
5-203
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
AR BKR CLOSED:
Off
MESSAGE
AR BLOCK:
Off
MESSAGE
AR PAUSE:
Off
MESSAGE
AR INCOMPLETE SEQ
TIME: 5.00 s
MESSAGE
AR BLOCK BKR2:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AR TRANSFER 1 TO 2:
No
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
AR TRANSFER 2 TO 1:
No
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AR BKR SEQUENCE:
1-2
MESSAGE
AR TRANSFER TIME:
4.00 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
AR EVENT:
Disabled
The autoreclose scheme is intended for use on transmission lines with circuit breakers operated in both the single pole and
three pole modes, in one or two breaker arrangements. The autoreclose scheme provides four programs with different
operating cycles, depending on the fault type. Each of the four programs can be set to trigger up to four reclosing attempts.
The second, third, and fourth attempts always perform three-pole reclosing and have independent dead time delays.
When used in two breaker applications, the reclosing sequence is selectable. The reclose signal can be sent to one
selected breaker only, to both breakers simultaneously or to both breakers in sequence (one breaker first and then, after a
delay to check that the reclose was successful, to the second breaker). When reclosing in sequence, the first breaker
should reclose with either the single-pole or three-pole dead time according to the fault type and reclose mode; the second
breaker should follow the successful reclosure of the first breaker. When reclosing simultaneously, for the first shot both
breakers should reclose with either the single-pole or three-pole dead time, according to the fault type and the reclose
mode.
The signal used to initiate the autoreclose scheme is the trip output from protection. This signal can be single pole tripping
for single phase faults and three phase tripping for multi-phase faults. The autoreclose scheme has five operating states.
5-204
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
STATE
CHARACTERISTICS
Enabled
Disabled
Reset
Reclose in progress
Scheme has been initiated but the reclose cycle is not finished (successful or not)
Lockout
AR PROGRAMS:
The autorecloser provides four programs that can cause from one to four reclose attempts (shots). After the first shot, all
subsequent recloses will always be three-pole. If the maximum number of shots selected is 1 (only one reclose attempt)
and the fault is persistent, after the first reclose the scheme will go to lockout upon another Initiate signal.
For the 3-pole reclose programs (modes 3 and 4), an AR FORCE 3-P FlexLogic operand is set. This operand can be used
in connection with the tripping logic to cause a three-pole trip for single-phase faults.
Table 522: AUTORECLOSE PROGRAMS
MODE
AR MODE
FIRST SHOT
SECOND SHOT
THIRD SHOT
FOURTH SHOT
SINGLEPHASE
FAULT
MULTIPHASE
FAULT
SINGLEPHASE
FAULT
MULTIPHASE
FAULT
SINGLEPHASE
FAULT
MULTIPHASE
FAULT
SINGLEPHASE
FAULT
MULTIPHASE
FAULT
1 & 3 POLE
1 POLE
3 POLE
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
1 POLE
1 POLE
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE-A
3 POLE
LO
3 POLE or
LO
LO
3 POLE or
LO
LO
3 POLE or
LO
LO
3 POLE-B
3 POLE
3 POLE
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
3 POLE or
LO
1 & 3 Pole: In this mode, the autorecloser starts the AR 1-P DEAD TIME timer for the first shot if the autoreclose is single-phase initiated, the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 1 timer if the autoreclose is three-pole initiated, and the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2
timer if the autoreclose is three-phase time delay initiated. If two or more shots are enabled, the second, third, and
fourth shots are always three-pole and start the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2(4) timers.
2.
1 Pole: In this mode, the autorecloser starts the AR 1-P DEAD TIME for the first shot if the fault is single phase. If the
fault is three-phase or a three-pole trip on the breaker occurred during the single-pole initiation, the scheme goes to
lockout without reclosing. If two or more shots are enabled, the second, third, and fourth shots are always three-pole
and start the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2(4) timers.
3.
3 Pole-A: In this mode, the autorecloser is initiated only for single phase faults, although the trip is three pole. The
autorecloser uses the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 1 for the first shot if the fault is single phase. If the fault is multi phase the
scheme will go to Lockout without reclosing. If two or more shots are enabled, the second, third, and fourth shots are
always three-phase and start the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2(4) timers.
4.
3 Pole-B: In this mode, the autorecloser is initiated for any type of fault and starts the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 1 for the first
shot. If the initiating signal is AR 3P TD INIT the scheme starts AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2 for the first shot. If two or more shots
are enabled, the second, third, and fourth shots are always three-phase and start the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2(4) timers.
GE Multilin
5-205
5 SETTINGS
There are three initiate programs: single pole initiate, three pole initiate and three pole, time delay initiate. Any of these
reclose initiate signals will start the reclose cycle and set the reclose-in-progress (AR RIP) operand. The reclose-in-progress
operand is sealed-in until the Lockout or Reset signal appears.
The three-pole initiate and three-pole time delay initiate signals are latched until the CLOSE BKR1 OR BKR2 or Lockout or
Reset signal appears.
AR PAUSE:
The pause input offers the possibility of freezing the autoreclose cycle until the pause signal disappears. This may be done
when a trip occurs and simultaneously or previously, some conditions are detected such as out-of step or loss of guard frequency, or a remote transfer trip signal is received. The pause signal blocks all three dead timers. When the pause signal
disappears the autoreclose cycle is resumed by initiating AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2.
This feature can be also used when a transformer is tapped from the protected line and a reclose is not desirable until the
transformer is removed from the line. In this case, the reclose scheme is paused until the transformer is disconnected. The
AR PAUSE input will force a three-pole trip through the 3-P DEADTIME 2 path.
EVOLVING FAULTS:
1.25 cycles after the single pole dead time has been initiated, the AR FORCE 3P TRIP operand is set and it will be reset only
when the scheme is reset or goes to Lockout. This will ensure that when a fault on one phase evolves to include another
phase during the single pole dead time of the auto-recloser the scheme will force a 3 pole trip and reclose.
RECLOSING SCHEME OPERATION FOR ONE BREAKER:
Permanent Fault: Consider Mode 1, which calls for 1-Pole or 3-Pole Time Delay 1 for the first reclosure and 3-Pole
Time Delay 2 for the second reclosure, and assume a permanent fault on the line. Also assume the scheme is in the
Reset state. For the first single-phase fault the AR 1-P DEAD TIME timer will be started, while for the first multi-phase fault
the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 1 timer will be started. If the AR 3P TD INIT signal is high, the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2 will be started for
the first shot.
If AR MAX NO OF SHOTS is set to 1, upon the first reclose the shot counter is set to 1. Upon reclosing, the fault is again
detected by protection and reclose is initiated. The breaker is tripped three-pole through the AR SHOT COUNT >0 operand that will set the AR FORCE 3P operand. Because the shot counter has reached the maximum number of shots permitted the scheme is sent to the Lockout state.
If AR MAX NO OF SHOTS is set to 2, upon the first reclose the shot counter is set to 1. Upon reclosing, the fault is again
detected by protection and reclose is initiated. The breaker is tripped three-pole through the AR SHOT COUNT >0 operand that will set the AR FORCE 3P operand. After the second reclose the shot counter is set to 2. Upon reclosing, the
fault is again detected by protection, the breaker is tripped three-pole, and reclose is initiated again. Because the shot
counter has reached the maximum number of shots permitted the scheme is sent to the lockout state.
Transient Fault: When a reclose output signal is sent to close the breaker the reset timer is started. If the reclosure
sequence is successful (there is no initiating signal and the breaker is closed) the reset timer will time out returning the
scheme to the reset state with the shot counter set to "0" making it ready for a new reclose cycle.
Permanent Fault: The general method of operation is the same as that outlined for the one breaker applications
except for the following description, which assumes AR BKR SEQUENCE is 1-2 (reclose Breaker 1 before Breaker 2)
The signal output from the dead time timers passes through the breaker selection logic to initiate reclosing of Breaker
1. The Close Breaker 1 signal will initiate the Transfer Timer. After the reclose of the first breaker the fault is again
detected by the protection, the breaker is tripped three pole and the autoreclose scheme is initiated. The Initiate signal
will stop the transfer timer. After the 3-P dead time times out the Close Breaker 1 signal will close first breaker again
and will start the transfer timer. Since the fault is permanent the protection will trip again initiating the autoreclose
scheme that will be sent to Lockout by the SHOT COUNT = MAX signal.
Transient Fault: When the first reclose output signal is sent to close Breaker 1, the reset timer is started. The close
Breaker 1 signal initiates the transfer timer that times out and sends the close signal to the second breaker. If the reclosure sequence is successful (both breakers closed and there is no initiating signal) the reset timer will time out, returning the scheme to the reset state with the shot counter set to 0. The scheme will be ready for a new reclose cycle.
5-206
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The reclosing program logic: when a 3P Initiate is present and the autoreclose mode is either 1 Pole or 3Pole-A (3 pole
autoreclose for single pole faults only)
If at the end of the reset time at least one breaker, which is not in the out-of-service state, is open the scheme will be
sent to Lockout. The scheme will be also sent to Lockout if one breaker fails to reclose and the setting AR BKR FAIL
OPTION is set to Lockout.
Once the Lockout state is set it will be latched until one or more of the following occurs:
The scheme is intentionally reset from Lockout, employing the Reset setting of the Autorecloser;
The Breaker(s) is(are) manually closed from panel switch, SCADA or other remote control through the AR BRK MAN
setting;
CLOSE
When the reclosing sequence 1-2 is selected and Breaker 1 is blocked (AR BKR1 BLK operand is set) the reclose signal
can be transferred direct to the Breaker 2 if AR TRANSFER 1 TO 2 is set to Yes. If set to No, the scheme will be sent to
Lockout by the incomplete sequence timer.
2.
When the reclosing sequence 2-1 is selected and Breaker 2 is blocked (AR BKR2 BLK operand is set) the reclose signal
can be transferred direct to the Breaker 1 if AR TRANSFER 2 TO 1 is set to Yes. If set to No the scheme will be sent to
Lockout by the incomplete sequence timer.
GE Multilin
5-207
5 SETTINGS
The shot counter is not at 0, i.e. the scheme is not in the reset state. This ensures a second trip will be three-pole when
reclosing onto a permanent single phase fault.
1.25 cycles after the single-pole reclose is initiated by the AR 1P INIT signal.
ZONE 1 EXTENT:
The Zone 1 extension philosophy here is to apply an overreaching zone permanently as long as the relay is ready to
reclose, and reduce the reach when reclosing. Another Zone 1 extension approach is to operate normally from an underreaching zone, and use an overreaching distance zone when reclosing the line with the other line end open. This philosophy could be programmed via the Line Pickup scheme.
The Extended Zone 1" is 0 when Autoreclose is in Lockout or Disabled and 1 when Autoreclose is in Reset.
1.
When "Extended Zone 1" is 0, the distance functions shall be set to normal underreach Zone 1 setting.
2.
When "Extended Zone 1" is 1, the distance functions may be set to Extended Zone 1 Reach, which is an overreaching
setting.
3.
During a reclose cycle, "Extended Zone 1" goes to 0 as soon as the first CLOSE BREAKER signal is issued (AR SHOT
COUNT > 0) and remains 0 until the recloser goes back to Reset.
USE OF SETTINGS:
The single-phase autoreclose settings are described below.
AR MODE: This setting selects the Autoreclose operating mode, which functions in conjunction with signals received
at the initiation inputs as described previously.
AR MAX NUMBER OF SHOTS: This setting specifies the number of reclosures that can be attempted before reclosure goes to Lockout when the fault is permanent.
AR BLOCK BKR1: This input selects an operand that will block the reclose command for Breaker 1. This condition
can be for example: breaker low air pressure, reclose in progress on another line (for the central breaker in a breaker
and a half arrangement), or a sum of conditions combined in FlexLogic.
AR CLOSE TIME BKR1:This setting represents the closing time for the Breaker 1 from the moment the Close command is sent to the moment the contacts are closed.
AR BKR MAN CLOSE: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that represents manual close command to a
breaker associated with the autoreclose scheme.
AR BLK TIME UPON MAN CLS: The autoreclose scheme can be disabled for a programmable time delay after an
associated circuit breaker is manually commanded to close, preventing reclosing onto an existing fault such as
grounds on the line. This delay must be longer than the slowest expected trip from any protection not blocked after
manual closing. If the autoreclose scheme is not initiated after a manual close and this time expires the autoreclose
scheme is set to the Reset state.
AR 1P INIT: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that is intended to initiate single-pole autoreclosure.
AR 3P INIT: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that is intended to initiate three-pole autoreclosure, first timer
(AR 3P DEAD TIME 1) that can be used for a high-speed autoreclosure.
AR 3P TD INIT: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand intended to initiate three-pole autoreclosure. second timer
(AR 3P DEAD TIME 2) can be used for a time-delay autoreclosure.
AR MULTI-P FAULT: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that indicates a multi-phase fault. The operand value
should be zero for single-phase to ground faults.
BKR ONE POLE OPEN: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand which indicates that the breaker(s) has opened
correctly following a single phase to ground fault and the autoreclose scheme can start timing the single pole dead
time (for 1-2 reclose sequence for example, Breaker 1 should trip single pole and Breaker 2 should trip 3 pole).
The scheme has a pre-wired input that indicates breaker(s) status.
BKR 3 POLE OPEN: This setting selects a FlexLogic operand which indicates that the breaker(s) has opened three
pole and the autoreclose scheme can start timing the three pole dead time. The scheme has a pre-wired input that indicates breaker(s) status.
5-208
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
AR 3-P DEAD TIME 1: This is the dead time following the first three pole trip. This intentional delay can be used for a
high-speed three-pole autoreclose. However, it should be set longer than the estimated de-ionizing time following the
three-pole trip.
AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2: This is the dead time following the second three-pole trip or initiated by the AR 3P TD INIT input.
This intentional delay is typically used for a time delayed three-pole autoreclose (as opposed to high speed three-pole
autoreclose).
AR 3-P DEAD TIME 3(4): These settings represent the dead time following the third (fourth) three-pole trip.
AR EXTEND DEAD T 1: This setting selects an operand that will adapt the duration of the dead time for the first shot
to the possibility of non-simultaneous tripping at the two line ends. Typically this is the operand set when the communication channel is out of service
AR DEAD TIME 1 EXTENSION: This timer is used to set the length of the dead time 1 extension for possible nonsimultaneous tripping of the two ends of the line.
AR RESET: This setting selects the operand that forces the autoreclose scheme from any state to Reset. Typically this
is a manual reset from lockout, local or remote.
AR RESET TIME: A reset timer output resets the recloser following a successful reclosure sequence. The setting is
based on the breaker time which is the minimum time required between successive reclose sequences.
AR BKR CLOSED: This setting selects an operand that indicates that the breaker(s) are closed at the end of the reset
time and the scheme can reset.
AR BLOCK: This setting selects the operand that blocks the Autoreclose scheme (it can be a sum of conditions such
as: time delayed tripping, breaker failure, bus differential protection, etc.). If the block signal is present before autoreclose scheme initiation the AR DISABLED FlexLogic operand will be set. If the block signal occurs when the scheme
is in the RIP state the scheme will be sent to Lockout.
AR PAUSE: The pause input offers the ability to freeze the autoreclose cycle until the pause signal disappears. This
may be done when a trip occurs and simultaneously or previously, some conditions are detected such as out-of step or
loss of guard frequency, or a remote transfer trip signal is received. When the pause signal disappears the autoreclose cycle is resumed. This feature can also be used when a transformer is tapped from the protected line and a
reclose is not desirable until the it is disconnected from the line. In this situation, the reclose scheme is paused until
the transformer is disconnected.
AR INCOMPLETE SEQ TIME: This timer is used to set the maximum time interval allowed for a single reclose shot. It
is started whenever a reclosure is initiated and is active until the CLOSE BKR1 or CLOSE BKR2 signal is sent. If all conditions allowing a breaker closure are not satisfied when this time expires, the scheme goes to Lockout. The minimum permissible setting is established by the AR 3-P DEAD TIME 2 timer setting. Settings beyond this will determine the
wait time for the breaker to open so that the reclose cycle can continue and/or for the AR PAUSE signal to reset and
allow the reclose cycle to continue and/or for the AR BKR1(2) BLK signal to disappear and allow the AR CLOSE BKR1(2)
signal to be sent.
AR BLOCK BKR2: This input selects an operand that will block the reclose command for Breaker 2. This condition
can be for example: breaker low air pressure, reclose in progress on another line (for the central breaker in a breaker
and a half arrangement), or a sum of conditions combined in FlexLogic.
AR CLOSE TIME BKR2: This setting represents the closing time for the Breaker 2 from the moment the Close command is sent to the moment the contacts are closed.
AR TRANSFER 1 TO 2: This setting establishes how the scheme performs when the breaker closing sequence is 1-2
and Breaker 1 is blocked. When set to Yes the closing command will be transferred direct to Breaker 2 without waiting the transfer time. When set to No the closing command will be blocked by the AR BKR1 BLK signal and the
scheme will be sent to Lockout by the incomplete sequence timer.
AR TRANSFER 2 TO 1: This setting establishes how the scheme performs when the breaker closing sequence is 2-1
and Breaker 2 is blocked. When set to Yes the closing command will be transferred direct to Breaker 1 without waiting the transfer time. When set to No, the closing command will be blocked by the AR BKR2 BLK signal and the
scheme will be sent to Lockout by the incomplete sequence timer.
AR BKR1 FAIL OPTION: This setting establishes how the scheme performs when the breaker closing sequence is 12 and Breaker 1 has failed to close. When set to Continue the closing command will be transferred to Breaker 2
which will continue the reclosing cycle until successful (the scheme will reset) or unsuccessful (the scheme will go to
Lockout). When set to Lockout the scheme will go to lockout without attempting to reclose Breaker 2.
GE Multilin
5-209
5 SETTINGS
AR BKR2 FAIL OPTION: This setting establishes how the scheme performs when the breaker closing sequence is 21 and Breaker 2 has failed to close. When set to Continue the closing command will be transferred to Breaker 1
which will continue the reclosing cycle until successful (the scheme will reset) or unsuccessful (the scheme will go to
Lockout). When set to Lockout the scheme will go to lockout without attempting to reclose Breaker 1.
AR 1-P DEAD TIME: Set this intentional delay longer than the estimated de-ionizing time after the first single-pole trip.
AR BREAKER SEQUENCE: This setting selects the breakers reclose sequence: Select 1 for reclose breaker 1 only,
2 for reclose breaker 2 only, 1&2 for reclose both breakers simultaneously, 1-2 for reclose breakers sequentially;
Breaker 1 first, and 2-1 for reclose breakers sequentially; Breaker 2 first.
AR TRANSFER TIME: The transfer time is used only for breaker closing sequence 1-2 or 2-1, when the two breakers
are reclosed sequentially. The transfer timer is initiated by a close signal to the first breaker. The transfer timer transfers the reclose signal from the breaker selected to close first to the second breaker. The time delay setting is based on
the maximum time interval between the autoreclose signal and the protection trip contact closure assuming a permanent fault (unsuccessful reclose). Therefore, the minimum setting is equal to the maximum breaker closing time plus
the maximum line protection operating time plus a suitable margin. This setting will prevent the autoreclose scheme
from transferring the close signal to the second breaker unless a successful reclose of the first breaker occurs.
AR BUS FLT INIT: This setting is used in breaker-and-a-half applications to allow the autoreclose control function to
perform reclosing with only one breaker previously opened by bus protection. For line faults, both breakers must open
for the autoreclose reclosing cycles to take effect.
5-210
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
AR FUNCTION:
Enable = 1
Disable = 0
D60 and L90 relays only
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LINE PICKUP OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
AR ENABLED
SETTING
AR DISABLED
OR
AR INITIATE
AR BLOCK:
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
AR RIP
Latch
SETTING
Off = 0
OR
AND
Latch
(Evolving fault)
(From sheet 3)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
AND
AR 1-P RIP
LO
AR 1P INIT:
1.25 cycle
SETTING
SETTING
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
SETTING
SETTING
AR 3-P/1 RIP
OR
Off = 0
S
AND
Latch
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
AND
AR 3-P/2 RIP
OR
SETTING
AR 3P TD INIT:
AND
Off = 0
OR
SHOT COUNT=1
(From Sheet 2)
SETTING
AND
CLOSE
(to page 2)
0
OR
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
From sheet 3
SETTING
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
AR 3-P/3 RIP
(Reset DOM)
OR
BKR ONE POLE OPEN
SETTING
(NOR)
Latch
AND
SETTING
OR
OR
AND
SHOT
COUNT=2
(from
sheet 2)
Off = 0
OR
BKR 3 POLE OPEN
OR
OR
RESET
CLOSE BKR1 OR BKR2
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR 3-P/4 RIP
AND
Latch
OR
SETTING
OR
AR SHOT
COUNT > 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
From Sheet 2
OR
AR DEAD TIME 1
EXTENSION:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
AR 3P INIT:
AND
Off = 0
OR
TRIP 1-POLE
OR
OR
AR SHOT COUNT>0
SETTING
AND
AND
SHOT COUNT=3
(from sheet 2)
AR PAUSE
BKR FAIL TO RECLS
(from sheet 2)
Off = 0
AR PAUSE
AND
SETTING
AND
AR M0DE:
AND
1 Pole
3 Pole - A
3 Pole -B
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
AR INCOMPLETE SEQ.
TIMER:
OR
AR LO
1 & 3 Pole
AND
AND
OR
OR
0
5 ms
SETTING
AND
OR
AR MULTI-P FAULT:
RESET (to sheet 2)
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
SETTING
From Sheet 3
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR INCOMPLETE SEQ
Evolving fault
AR RESET:
AR DISABLED
Off = 0
OR
BKR CLOSED
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
10 s
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
AR ZONE 1 EXTENT
AND
827089AN.CDR
GE Multilin
5-211
5-212
FROM
SHEET 1
(From Sheet 1)
RESET
Off=0
AR BKR CLOSED:
SETTING
BREAKER 2 OPEN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off=0
AR BLOCK BKR 2:
SETTING
BREAKER 2 OOS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Continue=0
SETTING
No = 0
AR TRANSFER 2 TO 1:
SETTING
CLOSE
AR LO
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR INITIATE
AR RIP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
2-1
1-2
1&2
AND
To sheet 3
AND
OR
OR
AND
AND
30ms
OR
OR
30ms
OR
OR
OR
OR
AND
AND
OR
AND
S
Latch
TO
SHEET 3
TO
SHEET 3
OR
AR BKR 1 BLK
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
AND
AND
LO
LO
AND
OR
OR
AR BKR 2 BLK
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
0ms
AR TRANSFER TIME:
SETTING
AND
AND
AND
AR RESET TIME:
SETTING
AND
AND
AND
AND
AR BKR SEQUENCE:
SETTING
Continue=0
SETTING
No = 0
AR TRANSFER 1 TO 2:
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OOS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off=0
AR BLOCK BKR 1:
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OPEN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
OR
OR
AND
AND
OR
AND
AND
LO
LO
OR
AND
OR
Reset Count
Increm Shot
Counter
Decrem Shot
Counter
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AR RESET
BREAKER 2 CLOSED
From bkr control
Sh=Max
Sh=0
Sh=1
Sh=2
Sh=3
Sh=4
AR MAX NO OF SHOTS:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
S
Latch
S
R
Latch
AR SHOT CNT=4
AR SHOT CNT=3
AR SHOT CNT>0
AR CLOSE BKR 2
2ms
827090AB.CDR
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SHOT COUNT=MAX
OR
AR CLOSE BKR 1
SETTING
AR SHOT CNT=1
AR SHOT CNT=2
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
ACTUAL VALUES
2ms
SETTING
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
From sheet 2
From
Breaker Control
scheme
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 OOS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 2 OOS
OR
From sheet 2
From
Breaker Control
scheme
OR
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 MNL CLS
OR
OR
BKR CLOSED
(To sheet 1 and 2)
OR
OR
OR
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 2 MNL CLS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
BREAKER 2 CLOSED
AND
OR
AND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
BREAKER 1 OPEN
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
BREAKER 2 OPEN
OR
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BUS-FLT INIT
OR
OFF = 0
AND
AND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
OR
AND
OR
AND
OR
OR
AND
OR
AND
827833AA.CDR
GE Multilin
5-213
5-214
AR TRANSFER TIME
AR CLOSE BKR2
BREAKER 2 CLOSED
AR 3P/2 RIP
AR 3P INIT
PREFAULT
T
R
I
P
1.25 cycle
T PROT RESET
T TRIP BKR
T PROT
1ST SHOT
T PROT
T TRIP BKR
T CLOSE BKR1
T PROT RESET
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
AR RESET TIME
AR CLOSE BKR1
CLOSE
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
AR 1-P RIP
AR RIP
AR 1P INIT
F
A
U
L
T
T CLOSE BKR1
TRANSFER TIME
2ND SHOT
RESET TIME
T CLOSE BKR2
R
E
S
E
T
842703A4.CDR
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
Off
1 INPUT:
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
DELAY:
1 PICKUP
0.000 s
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
DELAY:
1 RESET
0.000 s
MESSAGE
DIG ELEMENT 1
PICKUP LED: Enabled
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
Off
MESSAGE
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
1 BLOCK:
There are 48 identical digital elements available, numbered 1 to 48. A digital element can monitor any FlexLogic operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state. The digital element
settings include a name which will be referenced in any target message, a blocking input from any selected FlexLogic
operand, and a timer for pickup and reset delays for the output operand.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 INPUT: Selects a FlexLogic operand to be monitored by the digital element.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set to "0".
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 RESET DELAY: Sets the time delay to reset. If a reset delay is not required, set to 0.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP LED: This setting enables or disabled the digital element pickup LED. When set to
Disabled, the operation of the pickup LED is blocked.
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
INPUT:
Off = 0
AND
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
NAME:
RUN
INPUT = 1
SETTINGS
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
PICKUP DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
RESET DELAY:
tPKP
tRST
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
BLOCK:
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DIG ELEM 01 DPO
DIG ELEM 01 PKP
DIG ELEM 01 OP
827042A1.VSD
GE Multilin
5-215
5 SETTINGS
As long as the current through the voltage monitor is above a threshold (see technical specifications for form-A), the FlexLogic operand Cont Op # VOn will be set (# represents the output contact number). If the output circuit has a high resistance or the DC current is interrupted, the trickle current will drop below the threshold and the FlexLogic operand Cont
Op # VOff will be set. Consequently, the state of these operands can be used as indicators of the integrity of the circuits in
which Form-A contacts are inserted.
EXAMPLE 1: BREAKER TRIP CIRCUIT INTEGRITY MONITORING
In many applications it is desired to monitor the breaker trip circuit integrity so problems can be detected before a trip operation is required. The circuit is considered to be healthy when the voltage monitor connected across the trip output contact
detects a low level of current, well below the operating current of the breaker trip coil. If the circuit presents a high resistance, the trickle current will fall below the monitor threshold and an alarm would be declared.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact which is open when the
breaker is open (see diagram below). To prevent unwanted alarms in this situation, the trip circuit monitoring logic must
include the breaker position.
DC+
UR Relay - Form-A
H1a
I
I = Current Monitor
H1b
V = Voltage Monitor
H1c
52a
Trip
Coil
827073A1.vsd
DC
The PICKUP DELAY setting should be greater than the operating time of the breaker to avoid nuisance
alarms.
NOTE
5-216
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
DC+
UR Relay - Form-A
H1a
I
I = Current Monitor
H1c
V = Voltage Monitor
H1b
52a
By-pass
Resistor
POWER
SUPPLY (V DC)
RESISTANCE
(OHMS)
POWER
(WATTS)
24
1000
30
5000
48
10000
110
25000
125
25000
250
50000
Trip
Coil
827074A2.VSD
DC
GE Multilin
5-217
5 SETTINGS
5.6.8 DIGITAL COUNTERS
COUNTER 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
COUNTER 1 NAME:
Counter 1
COUNTER 1 UNITS:
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 PRESET:
0
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 COMPARE:
0
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 UP:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 DOWN:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNT1 FREEZE/RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNT1 FREEZE/COUNT:
Off
COUNTER 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
There are 8 identical digital counters, numbered from 1 to 8. A digital counter counts the number of state transitions from
Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element, the changes of state of an
external contact (e.g. breaker auxiliary switch), or pulses from a watt-hour meter.
COUNTER 1 UNITS: Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure pertaining to the digital transitions to be counted.
The units label will appear in the corresponding actual values status.
COUNTER 1 PRESET: Sets the count to a required preset value before counting operations begin, as in the case
where a substitute relay is to be installed in place of an in-service relay, or while the counter is running.
COUNTER 1 COMPARE: Sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three FlexLogic output
operands are provided to indicate if the present value is more than (HI), equal to (EQL), or less than (LO) the set
value.
COUNTER 1 UP: Selects the FlexLogic operand for incrementing the counter. If an enabled UP input is received
when the accumulated value is at the limit of +2,147,483,647 counts, the counter will rollover to 2,147,483,648.
COUNTER 1 DOWN: Selects the FlexLogic operand for decrementing the counter. If an enabled DOWN input is
received when the accumulated value is at the limit of 2,147,483,648 counts, the counter will rollover to
+2,147,483,647.
COUNTER 1 BLOCK: Selects the FlexLogic operand for blocking the counting operation. All counter operands are
blocked.
5-218
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CNT1 SET TO PRESET: Selects the FlexLogic operand used to set the count to the preset value. The counter will
be set to the preset value in the following situations:
1.
2.
When the counter is enabled and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1 (when the counter is enabled
and CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand is 0, the counter will be set to 0).
When the counter is running and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand changes the state from 0 to 1 (CNT1 SET TO
changing from 1 to 0 while the counter is running has no effect on the count).
PRESET
3.
When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value
1 (when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the
value 0, the counter will be set to 0).
COUNTER 1 RESET: Selects the FlexLogic operand for setting the count to either 0 or the preset value depending
on the state of the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand.
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/RESET: Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and resetting the count to 0.
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/COUNT: Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and continuing counting. The present accumulated
value and captured frozen value with the associated date/time stamp are available as actual values. If control power is
interrupted, the accumulated and frozen values are saved into non-volatile memory during the power down operation.
SETTING
COUNTER 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
SETTINGS
COUNTER 1 NAME:
COUNTER 1 UNITS:
COUNTER 1 PRESET:
RUN
AND
COUNTER 1 UP:
Off = 0
5
SETTING
COUNTER 1 COMPARE:
SETTING
CALCULATE
VALUE
COUNTER 1 DOWN:
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC
OPERANDS
COUNTER 1 HI
COUNTER 1 EQL
COUNTER 1 LO
SETTING
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off = 0
SETTING
CNT 1 SET TO PRESET:
Off = 0
AND
SETTING
AND
ACTUAL VALUES
COUNTER 1 RESET:
Off = 0
ACTUAL VALUE
COUNTER 1 ACCUM:
COUNTER 1 FROZEN:
OR
SETTING
COUNT1 FREEZE/RESET:
Off = 0
OR
827065A1.VSD
SETTING
COUNT1 FREEZE/COUNT:
Off = 0
GE Multilin
5-219
5 SETTINGS
5.6.9 MONITORING ELEMENTS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS
MONITORING
ELEMENTS
BREAKER 1
ARCING CURRENT
See below.
MESSAGE
BREAKER 2
ARCING CURRENT
See below.
MESSAGE
BREAKER
FLASHOVER 1
MESSAGE
BREAKER
FLASHOVER 2
MESSAGE
VT FUSE FAILURE 1
MESSAGE
VT FUSE FAILURE 2
MESSAGE
VT FUSE FAILURE 3
MESSAGE
VT FUSE FAILURE 4
MESSAGE
OPEN POLE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1
ARCING CURRENT
5-220
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
There is one Breaker Arcing Current element available per CT bank, with a minimum of 2 elements. This element calculates an estimate of the per-phase wear on the breaker contacts by measuring and integrating the current squared passing
through the breaker contacts as an arc. These per-phase values are added to accumulated totals for each phase and compared to a programmed threshold value. When the threshold is exceeded in any phase, the relay can set an output operand
to 1. The accumulated value for each phase can be displayed as an actual value.
The operation of the scheme is shown in the following logic diagram. The same output operand that is selected to operate
the output relay used to trip the breaker, indicating a tripping sequence has begun, is used to initiate this feature. A time
delay is introduced between initiation and the starting of integration to prevent integration of current flow through the
breaker before the contacts have parted. This interval includes the operating time of the output relay, any other auxiliary
relays and the breaker mechanism. For maximum measurement accuracy, the interval between change-of-state of the
operand (from 0 to 1) and contact separation should be measured for the specific installation. Integration of the measured
current continues for 100 ms, which is expected to include the total arcing period.
The feature is programmed to perform fault duration calculations. Fault duration is defined as a time between operation of
the disturbance detector occurring before initiation of this feature, and reset of an internal low-set overcurrent function. Correction is implemented to account for a non-zero reset time of the overcurrent function.
Breaker arcing currents and fault duration values are available under the ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS MAINTENANCE
BREAKER 1(4) menus.
BKR 1(4) ARC AMP INT-A(C): Select the same output operands that are configured to operate the output relays used
to trip the breaker. In three-pole tripping applications, the same operand should be configured to initiate arcing current
calculations for poles A, B and C of the breaker. In single-pole tripping applications, per-pole tripping operands should
be configured to initiate the calculations for the poles that are actually tripped.
BKR 1(4) ARC AMP DELAY: This setting is used to program the delay interval between the time the tripping sequence
is initiated and the time the breaker contacts are expected to part, starting the integration of the measured current.
BKR 1(4) ARC AMP LIMIT: Selects the threshold value above which the output operand is set.
Initiate
Breaker
Contacts
Part
Arc
Extinguished
Total Area =
Breaker
Arcing
Current
(kAcycle)
Programmable
Start Delay
Start
Integration
100 ms
Stop
Integration
GE Multilin
5-221
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP FUNCTION:
AND
SETTING
Disabled=0
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP DELAY:
Enabled=1
OR
SETTING
100 ms
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP BLOCK:
Off=0
AND
SETTINGS
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT-A:
Off=0
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT-B:
Off=0
OR
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT-C:
Off=0
AND
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP SOURCE:
RUN
Integrate
SETTING
AND
RUN
Integrate
IB
IB 2 -Cycle
IC 2 -Cycle
IC
AND
SETTING
Add to
Accumulator
IA 2 -Cycle
IA
Select
Highest
Value
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP LIMIT:
2
KA * Cycle Limit
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
BKR1 ARC OP
BKR1 ARC DPO
RUN
COMMAND
CLEAR BREAKER 1
ARCING AMPS:
Integrate
ACTUAL VALUE
NO=0
YES=1
827071A3.CDR
5-222
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
c) BREAKER FLASHOVER
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS BREAKER FLASHOVER 1(4)
BKR 1 FLSHOVR
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BKR 1 FLSHOVR
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
BKR 1 FLSHOVR
EVENTS: Disabled
BREAKER
FLASHOVER 1
Breaker open,
2.
Voltage drop measured from either side of the breaker during the flashover period,
3.
4.
Furthermore, the scheme is applicable for cases where either one or two sets of three-phase voltages are available across
the breaker.
GE Multilin
5-223
5 SETTINGS
NOTE
Voltages must be present prior to flashover conditions. If the three VTs are placed after the breaker on the
line (or feeder), and the downstream breaker is open, the measured voltage would be zero and the flashover element will not be initiated.
The flashover detection will reset if the current drops back to zero, the breaker closes, or the selected FlexLogic operand
for supervision changes to high. Using supervision through the BRK FLSHOVR SPV setting is recommended by selecting a
trip operand that will not allow the flashover element to pickup prior to the trip.
The flashover detection can be used for external alarm, re-tripping the breaker, or energizing the lockout relay.
Consider the following configuration:
Bus
CTs
Breaker
Line/Feeder
Bus VTs
842746A1.CDR
The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are feeder CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs, and Contact Input 1 is set as Breaker
52a contact. The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
1.
52a status = 0
2.
3.
4.
52a status = 0
2.
3.
IA, IB, or IC is greater than the pickup current flowing through the breaker
4.
5-224
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Bus
CTs
Breaker
Line/Feeder
VTs
VTs
842745A1.CDR
The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs. The source 2 (SRC2) phase voltages are
line VTs. Contact input 1 is set as the breaker 52a contact (optional).
The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
1.
2.
3.
4.
2.
3.
IA, IB, or IC is greater than the pickup current flowing through the breaker
4.
The element is operational only when phase-to-ground voltages are connected to relay terminals. The
flashover element will not operate if delta voltages are applied.
NOTE
BRK FLSHOVR SIDE 1 SRC: This setting specifies a signal source used to provide three-phase voltages and threephase currents from one side of the current breaker. The source selected as a setting and must be configured with
breaker phase voltages and currents, even if only three (3) VTs are available across the breaker.
BRK FLSHOVR SIDE 2 SRC: This setting specifies a signal source used to provide another set of three phase voltages whenever six (6) VTs are available across the breaker.
BRK STATUS CLSD A(C): These settings specify FlexLogic operands to indicate the open status of the breaker. A
separate FlexLogic operand can be selected to detect individual breaker pole status and provide flashover detection.
The recommended setting is 52a breaker contact or another operand defining the breaker poles open status.
BRK FLSHOVR V PKP: This setting specifies a pickup level for the phase voltages from both sides of the breaker. If
six VTs are available, opening the breaker leads to two possible combinations live voltages from only one side of the
breaker, or live voltages from both sides of the breaker. Either case will set the scheme ready for flashover detection
upon detection of voltage above the selected value. Set BRK FLSHOVR V PKP to 85 to 90% of the nominal voltage.
BRK FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP: This setting specifies a pickup level for the phase voltage difference when two VTs per
phase are available across the breaker. The pickup voltage difference should be below the monitored voltage difference when close or open breaker resistors are left in service. The setting is selected as primary volts difference
between the sources.
BRK FLSHOVR AMP PKP: This setting specifies the normal load current which can flow through the breaker.
Depending on the flashover protection application, the flashover current can vary from levels of the charging current
when the line is de-energized (all line breakers open), to well above the maximum line (feeder) load (line/feeder connected to load).
BRK FLSHOVR SPV A(C): This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand (per breaker pole) that supervises the operation of the element per phase. Supervision can be provided by operation of other protection elements, breaker failure,
and close and trip commands. A 6-cycle time delay applies after the selected FlexLogic operand resets.
GE Multilin
5-225
5 SETTINGS
BRK FLSHOVR PKP DELAY: This setting specifies the time delay to operate after a pickup condition is detected.
SETTINGS
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SUPV A:
0
6 cycle
Phase B
logic
Phase C
logic
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
BREAKER FLASHOVER
FUNCTION:
Enable=1
Block: OFF=0
AND
AND
0
5 cycle
SET
dominant
Phase C logic
Phase B logic
RESET
SETTINGS
5 cycle
OR
RUN
FlexLogic operand: On=1
BRK 1 STATUS CLSD B:
RUN
SET
dominant
SETTING
BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP
DELAY:
tPKP
Phase B
logic
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
0
BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP A
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
RESET
Phase B logic
BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP B
Phase C logic
BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP C
OR
BRK 1 FLSHOVR OP
SETTING
VB
VC
RUN
IA
IA > PKP
IB
AND
IC
SETTINGS
SETTING
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Va > PKP
Vb
OR
OR
Va
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RUN
VA = | VA - Va |
VA > PKP
842018A2.CDR
Vc
5-226
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
d) VT FUSE FAILURE
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS VT FUSE FAILURE 1(4)
VT FUSE FAILURE 1
VT FUSE FAILURE 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
Different means of detection are required for each class. An indication of Class A failures is a significant level of negative
sequence voltage, whereas an indication of class B failures is when positive sequence current is present and there is an
insignificant amount of positive sequence voltage. These noted indications of fuse failure could also be present when faults
are present on the system, so a means of detecting faults and inhibiting fuse failure declarations during these events is provided. Once the fuse failure condition is declared, it will be sealed-in until the cause that generated it disappears.
An additional condition is introduced to inhibit a fuse failure declaration when the monitored circuit is de-energized; positive
sequence voltage and current are both below threshold levels.
The function setting enables and disables the fuse failure feature for each source.
AND
Reset-dominant
OR
SET
LATCH
AND
SETTING
FAULT
RESET
VT FUSE FAILURE
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SOURCE 1
AND
COMPARATORS
RUN
V_2 > 0.1 p.u.
V_2
RUN
OR
V_1 < 0.05 p.u.
V_1
RUN
OR
AND
I_1
FUSE
FAIL
SET
RUN
V_1 < 0.7 p.u.
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
2 CYCLES
AND
20 CYCLES
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
LATCH
SRC1 50DD OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE OP
D60, L60, and L90 only
AND
OR
AND
RESET
Reset-dominant
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
GE Multilin
5-227
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
OPEN POLE
The open pole detector is intended to identify an open pole of the line circuit breaker. The scheme monitors the breakers
auxiliary contacts, current in the circuit and optionally voltage on the line. The scheme generates output operands used to
block the phase selector and some specific protection elements, thus preventing maloperation during the dead time of a
single pole autoreclose cycle or any other open pole conditions.
The scheme declares an open pole at the moment a single-pole trip is issued.
In two breaker and breaker and a half applications, an open pole condition is declared when:
The Open Pole feature uses signals defined by the GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) DISTANCE DISTANCE
setting. Voltage supervision can be used only with wye VTs on the line side of the breaker(s).
SOURCE
The OPEN POLE CURRENT PICKUP setting establishes the current threshold below which an open pole is declared.
The OPEN POLE LINE XC1 setting specifies positive-sequence reactance of the entire line. If shunt reactors are applied, this
value should be a net capacitive reactance of the line and the reactors installed between the line breakers. The value is
entered in secondary ohms. This setting is relevant if open pole condition at the remote end of the line is to be sensed and
utilized by the relay.
The OPEN POLE LINE XC0 setting specifies zero-sequence reactance of the entire line. If shunt reactors are applied, this
value should be a net capacitive reactance of the line and the reactors installed between the line breakers. The value shall
be entered in secondary ohms. This setting is relevant if open pole condition at the remote end of the line is to be sensed
and utilized by the relay (OPEN POLE REM OP FlexLogic operand).
The OPEN POLE REM CURR PKP setting specifies pickup level for the remote-end current estimated by the relay as the local
current compensated by the calculated charging current. The latter is calculated based on the local voltages and the capacitive reactances of the line. This setting is relevant if open pole condition at the remote end of the line is to be sensed and
utilized by the relay (OPEN POLE REM OP FlexLogic operand).
For convenience, the position of the breaker poles defined in the Breaker Control feature and available as FlexLogic
operand BREAKER 1/2 A CLSD through BREAKER 1/2 C CLSD and BREAKER 1/2 OOS are used by the Open Pole feature.
For correct operation of the Open Pole Detector, the Breaker Control, Trip Output, and Single Pole Autoreclose features
5-228
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
must be enabled and configured properly. When used in configuration with only one breaker, the BREAKER 2 FUNCTION
should be Enabled and the BREAKER 2 OUT OF SV setting should be On (see the Breaker Control section earlier in this
Chapter for additional details).
SETTING
OPEN POLE
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
AND
SETTING
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP PHASE A
IA < PKP
IB < PKP
AND
OR
IC < PKP
AND
AND
AND
20 ms
AND
From
Trip
Output
AND
SETTINGS
XOR
0.5 cycle
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP PHASE B
0.5 cycle
0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE OP B
20 ms
AND
Disabled = 0
AND
Enabled = 1
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
VAG > 0.7 pu
DISTANCE SOURCE:
IA
IB
TRIP PHASE C
0.5 cycle
0
AND
OR
IC
VAG
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OPEN POLE OP C
20 ms
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
VBG
VCG
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 A CLSD
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 B CLSD
Charging
Current
Calculations
OR
BREAKER 1 C CLSD
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 2 B CLSD
OPEN POLE OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
BREAKER 1 OOS
BREAKER 2 A CLSD
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Charging
Current
Calculations
OR
To Trip Output
Scheme
SETTINGS
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 2 C CLSD
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
BREAKER 2 OOS
SETTING
OPEN POLE REM
CURR PKP:
RUN
IA REM < PKP
IB REM < PKP
IC REM < PKP
2 cycles
2 cycles
2 cycles
2 cycles
2 cycles
2 cycles
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OPEN POLE REM OP A
OPEN POLE REM OP B
OPEN POLE REM OP C
837024AB.CDR
GE Multilin
5-229
5 SETTINGS
5.6.10 TRIP BUS
TRIP BUS 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
TRIP BUS 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
TRIP BUS 1
EVENTS: Disabled
The trip bus element allows aggregating outputs of protection and control elements without using FlexLogic and assigning them a simple and effective manner. Each trip bus can be assigned for either trip or alarm actions. Simple trip conditioning such as latch, delay, and seal-in delay are available.
The easiest way to assign element outputs to a trip bus is through the EnerVista UR Setup software A protection summary
is displayed by navigating to a specific protection or control protection element and checking the desired bus box. Once the
desired element is selected for a specific bus, a list of element operate-type operands are displayed and can be assigned
to a trip bus. If more than one operate-type operand is required, it may be assigned directly from the trip bus menu.
5-230
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK: The trip bus output is blocked when the operand assigned to this setting is asserted.
TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP DELAY: This setting specifies a time delay to produce an output depending on how output is
used.
TRIP BUS 1 RESET DELAY: This setting specifies a time delay to reset an output command. The time delay should be
set long enough to allow the breaker or contactor to perform a required action.
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1 to TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16: These settings select a FlexLogic operand to be assigned as an
input to the trip bus.
TRIP BUS 1 LATCHING: This setting enables or disables latching of the trip bus output. This is typically used when
lockout is required or user acknowledgement of the relay response is required.
TRIP BUS 1 RESET: The trip bus output is reset when the operand assigned to this setting is asserted. Note that the
RESET OP operand is pre-wired to the reset gate of the latch, As such, a reset command the front panel interface or via
communications will reset the trip bus output.
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1
SETTINGS
= Off
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 2
= Off
Non-volatile,
set-dominant
***
OR
AND
TPKP
Latch
= Off
R
TRST
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
FUNCTION
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP BUS 1 PKP
AND
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
= Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET OP
842023A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-231
5 SETTINGS
5.6.11 PILOT SCHEMES
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS PILOT SCHEMES
PILOT SCHEMES
DUTT SCHEME
MESSAGE
PUTT SCHEME
MESSAGE
POTT SCHEME
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BLOCKING SCHEME
MESSAGE
DCUB SCHEME
This menu contains settings for selecting and configuring protection signaling schemes. All schemes are available for single-pole tripping applications and can be used with one, two, or four-bit communications channels. Choices of communications channels include remote inputs/outputs and telecommunications interfaces.
DUTT SCHEME
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DUTT SEAL-IN
DELAY: 0.010 s
MESSAGE
DUTT NO OF COMM
BITS: 1
Range: 1, 2, or 4
MESSAGE
DUTT RX1:
Off
MESSAGE
DUTT RX2:
Off
MESSAGE
DUTT RX3:
Off
MESSAGE
DUTT RX4:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DUTT SCHEME
This scheme uses an under-reaching Zone 1 distance element to key a transfer trip signal(s) to the remote end(s), where
on receipt, the DUTT pilot scheme operates without additional protection supervision. For proper operation of the scheme
the Zone 1 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured, and set per rules of distance relaying.
5-232
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
In single-pole tripping applications, the scheme uses local fault type identification provided by the Phase Selector together
with information received from the remote terminal(s). The latter may be coded into one, two or four bits over the communications channel.
The scheme generates output operands (DUTT TX1 through DUTT TX4) that are used to transmit the direct under-reaching
signals to the remote end(s). Choices of communications channel include remote inputs/outputs and telecommunications
interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operands should be assigned to operate output contacts connected to assert the individual bits at the interface.
To make the scheme a fully operational stand-alone feature, the scheme output operands must be configured to interface
with other relay functions, output contacts in particular. Typically, the output operands should be programmed to initiate a
trip, breaker fail, and autoreclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application. When used in conjunction
with the trip output element, the scheme is pre-configured to initiate trip, breaker fail, and single-pole autoreclose actions.
DUTT SCHEME BLOCK: This setting allows the user to assign any FlexLogic operand to block the scheme. Contact
inputs from a pilot cut-out switch are typically used for this purpose.
DUTT SEAL-IN DELAY: The output FlexLogic operand (DUTT OP) is produced according to the DUTT scheme logic.
A seal-in time delay is applied to this operand for coping with noisy communication channels such as a power line carrier. The DUTT SEAL-IN DELAY is a minimum guaranteed duration of the DUTT OP pulse. As this operand activates the
Trip Table of the DUTT scheme, the trip operands DUTT TRIP A, B, C and 3P are sealed-in for the same period of time.
DUTT NO OF COMM BITS: This setting specifies the number of bits available on the communications channel. With
only one bit available, the scheme sends the direct under-reaching transfer trip command on bit no.1 (DUTT TX1 operand) and responds to the direct trip command received on bit no. 1 (DUTT RX1 setting). The scheme uses only local
fault type identification provided by the Phase Selector to assert the output operands DUTT TRIP A, B, C and 3P (see
Chapter 8: Theory of Operation for details on the use of communication channels).
DUTT RX1 through DUTT RX4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands that represent the
receive signals for the scheme. Typically input contacts interfacing with a signaling system are used.
The DUTT scheme requires a secure and dependable signaling system. For this reason, a series/parallel combination
of receive signal contacts is often used. This is accomplished by using a multi-bit communications system to transmit
redundant copies of the TX signal (often via different paths) and building appropriate security logic (such as series
(AND gate) or 2-out-of-3 voting logic) with FlexLogic. The DUTT RX1(4) settings should be associated with the final
(secure) TX signals.
GE Multilin
5-233
5 SETTINGS
In single-bit applications, DUTT RX1 must be used. In two-bit applications, DUTT RX1 and DUTT RX2 must be used. In
four-bit applications, DUTT RX1, DUTT RX2, DUTT RX3, and DUTT RX4 must be used. In multi-terminal applications, the RX
signals from two or more remote terminals should be connected through OR gates in the FlexLogic and the resulting
signals should be configured as the DUTT RX inputs.
SETTING
DUTT SCHEME
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
DUTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
AND
SETTING
RUN
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OFF = 0
DUTT TX1
Phase
Selector
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PH DIST Z1 PKP
GND DIST Z1 PKP
OR
TRANSMIT TABLE
DUTT TX2
DUTT TX3
DUTT TX4
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
SETTINGS
DUTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
SETTINGS
DUTT RX1:
DUTT SEAL-IN
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
AND
DUTT OP
t RST
DUTT RX2:
Off = 0
DUTT RX3:
OR
DUTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
Off = 0
RUN
DUTT RX4:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
RX
DUTT TRIP A
Off = 0
Phase
Selector
TRIP TABLE
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DUTT TRIP B
DUTT TRIP C
DUTT TRIP 3P
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
837012AD.CDR
5-234
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PUTT SCHEME
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PUTT RX PICKUP
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
PUTT SEAL-IN
DELAY: 0.010 s
MESSAGE
PUTT NO OF COMM
BITS: 1
Range: 1, 2, or 4
MESSAGE
PUTT RX1:
Off
MESSAGE
PUTT RX2:
Off
MESSAGE
PUTT RX3:
Off
MESSAGE
PUTT RX4:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PUTT SCHEME
This scheme uses an under-reaching zone 1 distance element to key a transfer trip signal(s) to the remote terminal(s)
where it is supervised by an over-reaching zone 2 distance element. For proper operation, the zone 1 and 2 phase and
ground distance elements must be enabled, configured, and set per rules of distance relaying.
In single-pole tripping applications, the scheme uses local fault type identification provided by the phase selector together
with information received from the remote terminal(s). The scheme generates output operands (PUTT TX1 through PUTT
TX4) that are used to transmit the signal to the remote end(s). Choices of communications channel include remote inputs/
outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operands should be
assigned to operate output contacts connected to assert the individual bits at the interface.
To make the scheme a fully operational stand-alone feature, the scheme output operands must be configured to interface
with other relay functions, output contacts in particular. Typically, the output operands should be programmed to initiate a
trip, breaker fail, and autoreclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application. When used in conjunction
with the Trip Output element, the scheme is pre-configured to initiate trip, breaker fail and single-pole autoreclose actions.
PUTT SCHEME BLOCK: This setting allows the user to assign any FlexLogic operand to block the scheme. Contact
inputs from a pilot cut-out switch are typically used for this purpose.
PUTT RX PICKUP DELAY: This setting enables the relay to cope with spurious receive signals. This delay should be
set longer than the longest spurious TX signal that can be received simultaneously with the zone 1 pickup. The
selected delay will increase the response time of the scheme.
PUTT SEAL-IN DELAY: The output FlexLogic operand (PUTT OP) is produced according to the PUTT scheme logic.
A seal-in time delay is applied to this operand for coping with noisy communication channels such as a power line carrier. The PUTT SEAL-IN DELAY is a minimum guaranteed duration of the PUTT OP pulse. As this operand activates the
trip table of the PUTT scheme, the trip operands PUTT TRIP A, B, C and 3P are sealed-in for the same period of time.
PUTT NO OF COMM BITS: This setting specifies the number of bits of the communications channel available for the
scheme. The transmit codes and trip table of the PUTT scheme are identical as those for the direct under-reaching
transfer trip scheme. Please refer to Chapter 8: Theory of Operation for more information.
GE Multilin
5-235
5 SETTINGS
PUTT RX1 through PUTT RX4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands that represent the
receive signals for the scheme. Typically input contacts interfacing with a signaling system are used. In single-bit applications, PUTT RX1 must be used. In two-bit applications, PUTT RX1 and PUTT RX2 must be used. In four-bit applications, PUTT RX1, PUTT RX2, PUTT RX3, and PUTT RX4 must be used. In multi-terminal applications, the RX signals from
two or more remote terminals should be connected through OR gates in the FlexLogic and the resulting signals
should be configured as the PUTT RX inputs.
SETTING
PUTT SCHEME
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
AND
SETTING
PUTT SCHEME BLOCK:
OFF = 0
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
PUTT RX PICKUP
DELAY:
PUTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
AND
SETTINGS
tPKP
PUTT SEAL-IN
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUTT RX1:
t RST
AND
PUTT OP
Off = 0
PUTT RX2:
PUTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
Off = 0
PUTT RX3:
OR
RUN
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
RX
PUTT TRIP A
Phase
Selector
PUTT RX4:
TRIP TABLE
Off = 0
PUTT TRIP C
PUTT TRIP 3P
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PUTT TRIP B
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
PH DIST Z2 PKP
OPEN POLE OP
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PH DIST Z1 PKP
AND
RUN
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PUTT TX1
Phase
Selector
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
TRANSMIT TABLE
PUTT TX2
PUTT TX3
PUTT TX4
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
837013AD.CDR
5-236
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
POTT SCHEME
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POTT PERMISSIVE
ECHO: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POTT RX PICKUP
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ECHO DURATION:
0.100 s
MESSAGE
ECHO LOCKOUT:
0.250 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POTT SEAL-IN
DELAY: 0.010 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POTT NO OF COMM
BITS: 1
Range: 1, 2, or 4
MESSAGE
POTT RX1:
Off
MESSAGE
POTT RX2:
Off
MESSAGE
POTT RX3:
Off
MESSAGE
POTT RX4:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
POTT SCHEME
This scheme is intended for two-terminal line applications only. The scheme uses an over-reaching Zone 2 distance element to essentially compare the direction to a fault at both terminals of the line. Ground directional overcurrent functions
available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the Zone 2 distance element to key the scheme and initiate its operation. This provides increased coverage for high-resistance faults.
GE Multilin
5-237
5 SETTINGS
For proper operation, the Zone 2 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured and set per rules of
distance relaying. The Line Pickup element should be enabled, configured and set properly to detect line-end-open/weakinfeed conditions. If used by this scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be enabled, configured and set accordingly.
In single-pole tripping applications, the scheme uses local fault type identification provided by the Phase Selector together
with information received from the remote terminal. The scheme generates output operands (POTT TX1 through POTT TX4)
that are used to transmit the signal to the remote end. Choices of communications channel include remote inputs/outputs
and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operands should be assigned
to operate output contacts connected to assert the individual bits at the interface.
To make the scheme fully operational as a stand-alone feature, the scheme output operands must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output contacts in particular. Typically, the output operands should be programmed to initiate
a trip, breaker fail, and autoreclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
When used in conjunction with the Trip Output element, the scheme is pre-configured to initiate trip, breaker fail, and singlepole autoreclose actions.
POTT SCHEME BLOCK: This setting allows the user to assign any FlexLogic operand to block the scheme. Contact
inputs from a pilot cut-out switch are typically used for this purpose.
POTT PERMISSIVE ECHO: If this setting is set to Enabled, the scheme sends a permissive echo signal to the
remote end(s) using a pre-programmed logic (see the following logic diagram). If set to Custom, the echo signal is
sent if a condition selected via the POTT ECHO COND setting is satisfied. The echo is sent only once and then the logic
locks out for the time specified by the ECHO LOCKOUT. The duration of the echo pulse is settable as ECHO DURATION.
Operation of the overreaching protection elements (Distance Zone 2 or GND DIR O/C FWD setting) inhibits the echo.
POTT ECHO COND: This setting specifies a user-selected echo condition and applies only if the HYB POTT PERMISis set to Custom.
SIVE ECHO
POTT RX PICKUP DELAY: This setting enables the relay to cope with spurious receive signals. The delay should be
set longer than the longest spurious TX signal that can be received simultaneously with the Zone 2 pickup. The
selected delay will increase the response time of the scheme.
TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the POTT
scheme for coping with the exposure of a ground directional overcurrent function (if used) to current reversal conditions. The transient blocking mechanism applies to the ground overcurrent path only as the reach settings for the Zone
2 distance functions is not expected to be long for two-terminal applications, and the security of the distance functions
is not endangered by the current reversal conditions.
Upon receiving the POTT RX signal, the transient blocking mechanism allows the RX signal to be passed and aligned
with the GND DIR O/C FWD indication only for a period of time set by TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY. After that the ground
directional overcurrent path will be virtually disabled for a period of time specified as TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY.
The TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY should be long enough to give the selected ground directional overcurrent function
time to operate, but not longer than the fastest possible operation time of the protection system that can create current
reversal conditions within the reach of the selected ground directional overcurrent function.
This setting should take into account the POTT RX PICKUP DELAY. The POTT RX signal is shaped for aligning with the
ground directional indication as follows: the original RX signal is delayed by the POTT RX PICKUP DELAY, then terminated
at TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY after the pickup of the original POTT TX signal, and eventually locked-out for TRANS
BLOCK RESET DELAY.
TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the POTT scheme
for coping with the exposure of a ground directional overcurrent function (if used) to current reversal conditions (see
the TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY). This delay should be selected long enough to cope with transient conditions including not only current reversals but also spurious negative- and zero-sequence currents occurring during breaker operations. The breaker failure time of the surrounding protection systems within the reach of the ground directional function
used by the POTT scheme may be considered to make sure that the ground directional function is not jeopardized during delayed breaker operations.
ECHO DURATION: This setting defines the guaranteed and exact duration of the echo pulse. The duration does not
depend on the duration and shape of the received RX signal. This setting enables the relay to avoid a permanent lockup of the transmit/receive loop.
ECHO LOCKOUT: This setting defines the lockout period for the echo logic after sending the echo pulse.
5-238
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
LINE END OPEN PICKUP DELAY: This setting defines the pickup value for validation of the line end open conditions
as detected by the Line Pickup logic through the LINE PICKUP LEO PKP FlexLogic operand. The validated line end
open condition is a requirement for the POTT scheme to return a received echo signal (if the echo feature is enabled).
This value should take into account the principle of operation and settings of the Line Pickup element.
POTT SEAL-IN DELAY: The output FlexLogic operand (POTT OP) is produced according to the POTT scheme logic.
A seal-in time delay is applied to this operand for coping with noisy communication channels. The POTT SEAL-IN DELAY
defines a minimum guaranteed duration of the POTT OP pulse. As this operand activates the trip table of the POTT
scheme, the trip operands POTT TRIP A, B, C and 3P are sealed-in for the same period of time.
GND DIR O/C FWD: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element that is used in addition to the Zone 2 for identifying faults on the protected line, and thus, for keying the communication channel and initiating operation of the scheme. Good directional integrity is the key requirement for an over-reaching forward-looking
protection element used as GND DIR O/C FWD. Even though any FlexLogic operand could be used as GND DIR O/C
FWD allowing the user to combine responses of various protection elements, or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is primarily meant to be the output operand from either the Negative-Sequence
Directional Overcurrent or Neutral Directional Overcurrent. Both of these elements have separate forward (FWD) and
reverse (REV) output operands. The forward indication should be used (NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD or NEUTRAL DIR OC1
FWD).
POTT NO OF COMM BITS: This setting specifies the number of bits of the communications channel available for the
scheme. The transmit codes and Trip Tables of the POTT scheme are the same as those for the permissive underreaching transfer trip scheme. Please refer to the description of the PUTT scheme for more information.
POTT RX1 through POTT RX4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands that represent the
receive signals for the scheme. Typically input contacts interfacing with a signaling system are used. In single-bit applications, POTT RX1 must be used. In two-bit applications, POTT RX1 and POTT RX2 must be used. In four-bit applications,
POTT RX1, POTT RX2, POTT RX3, and POTT RX4 must be used.
GE Multilin
5-239
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
POTT SCHEME
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
AND
SETTING
POTT SCHEME BLOCK:
OFF = 0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PH DIST Z2 PKP
GND DIST Z2 PKP
AND
OR
SETTINGS
SETTING
POTT SEAL-IN
DELAY:
Off = 0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
POTT OP
t RST
POTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
POTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
POTT RX1:
AND
Off = 0
POTT RX2:
AND
OR
POTT TRIP B
POTT TRIP C
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
POTT TRIP 3P
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
t PKP
POTT RX4:
POTT TRIP A
TRIP TABLE
RX
OPEN POLE OP
AND
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Phase
Selector
t PKP
SETTINGS
Off = 0
POTT RX3:
RUN
POTT RX PICKUP
DELAY:
POTT NO OF COMM
BITS:
t RST
RUN
OR
Off = 0
0
100 msec
TRANSMIT TABLE
SETTING
POTT PERMISSIVE ECHO:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LINE PICKUP LEO PKP
Disabled
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
ECHO DURATION:
POTT TX1
RUN
AND
POTT TX2
POTT TX3
AND
t PKP
POTT TX4
ECHO LOCKOUT:
0
SETTING
RX
POTT ECHO COND:
Off = 0
ECHO TABLE
Phase
Selector
Custom
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
837014AG.CDR
5-240
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ECHO DURATION:
0.100 s
MESSAGE
ECHO LOCKOUT:
0.250 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 1, 2, or 4
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
5-241
5 SETTINGS
Generally, this scheme uses an overreaching zone 2 distance element to essentially compare the direction to a fault at all
terminals of the line. Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the D60 can be used in conjunction with the zone
2 distance element to key the scheme and initiate operation. This increases the coverage for high-resistance faults.
The scheme is intended for three-terminal applications and for weak-infeed conditions. As a long reach of the overreaching
distance element may be required for three-terminal applications, transient blocking logic is provided for both distance and
ground directional overcurrent elements. In order to cope with weak-infeed conditions an echo feature is made available.
By default the scheme uses the reverse-looking zone 4 distance element to identify reverse faults. Additionally, reverselooking ground directional overcurrent functions can be used in conjunction with the zone 4.
For proper operation, the zone 2 and 4 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured and set per rules
of distance relaying. The line pickup element should be enabled, configured and set properly to detect line-end-open/weakinfeed and undervoltage conditions. If used by the scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be
enabled, configured, and set accordingly.
In single-pole tripping applications, the scheme uses local fault type identification provided by the phase selector together
with information received from the remote terminal. The scheme generates output operands (HYBRID POTT TX1 through
HYBRID POTT TX4) that are used to transmit the signal to the remote terminal(s). Choices of communications channel
include remote inputs/outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output
operand should be assigned to operate an output contact connected to key the transmitter at the interface. When used with
telecommunications facilities the output operands should be assigned to operate output contacts connected to assert the
individual bits at the interface.
To make the scheme fully operational as a stand-alone feature, the scheme output operands must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output contacts in particular. Typically, the output operands should be programmed to initiate
a trip, breaker fail, and autoreclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
When used in conjunction with the trip output element, the scheme is pre-configured to initiate trip, breaker fail and singlepole autoreclose actions.
HYB POTT BLOCK: This setting allows the user to assign any FlexLogic operand to block the scheme. Contact
inputs from a pilot cut-out switch are typically used for this purpose.
HYB POTT PERMISSIVE ECHO: If set to Enabled, the scheme sends a permissive echo signal to the remote end(s)
using a pre-programmed logic (refer to the logic diagram below). If set to Custom, the echo signal is sent if a condition selected via the HYB POTT ECHO COND setting is satisfied. The echo is sent only once and then the logic locks out
for the time specified by the ECHO LOCKOUT setting. The duration of the echo pulse is settable as ECHO DURATION.
Operation of the overreaching protection elements (distance zone 2 or GND DIR O/C FWD setting) inhibits the echo.
HYB POTT ECHO COND: This setting specifies a user-selected echo condition and applies only if the HYB POTT PERis set to Custom.
MISSIVE ECHO
HYB POTT WEAK INFEED: If this setting is set to Enabled, the scheme activates both the keying and operating
paths using a pre-programmed weak infeed logic (refer to the logic diagram below). If this setting is set to Custom,
the weak infeed condition is to be specified by the user via the HYB POTT W/I COND setting.
HYB POTT W/I COND: This setting specifies user-selected weak infeed condition and applies only if the HYB POTT
WEAK INFEED is set to Custom.
HYB POTT RX PICKUP DELAY: This setting enables the relay to cope with spurious received signals. The delay
should be set longer than the longest spurious TX signal that can be received simultaneously with the zone 2 pickup.
The selected delay will increase the response time of the scheme.
TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the hybrid POTT
scheme for coping with the exposure of both the over-reaching zone 2 and ground directional overcurrent function to
current reversal conditions.
The transient blocking logic applies to both operate (trip) and send (transmit) paths. Identifying the fault as a reverse
fault prevents the scheme from both operating and keying the channel. If the reverse fault condition prevails for TRANS
BLOCK PICKUP DELAY, the blocking operation will be extended by the transient blocking timer for TRANS BLOCK RESET
DELAY. This allows riding through current reversal conditions.
However, if distance zone 1 picks up during the transient blocking condition, the blocking action is removed. This is to
cope with evolving faults when an external fault is followed by an internal fault. Without the zone 1 feedback, the trip
would be delayed unnecessarily.
5-242
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY should not be longer than the fastest possible trip time for faults on an adjacent line
so that extended blocking action could be established. This should take into account the pickup time of the reverselooking elements of the scheme.
The delay defined by this setting should not be too short in order to avoid locking up a spurious reverse fault indication
that can occur during internal fault conditions.
TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the hybrid POTT
scheme for coping with the exposure of the overreaching protection functions to current reversal conditions (see also
the TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY).
This delay should be selected long enough to cope with transient conditions including not only current reversals but
also spurious negative- and zero-sequence currents occurring during breaker operations (in the case when neutral
directional or negative-sequence directional overcurrent functions are used). The breaker failure time of the surrounding protection systems within the reach of the ground directional function used by the hybrid POTT scheme should be
considered to make sure that the ground directional function is not jeopardized during delayed breaker operations.
ECHO DURATION: This setting defines the guaranteed and exact duration of the echo pulse. The duration is not
dependent on the duration and shape of received RX signals. This setting enables the relay to avoid a permanent lockup of the transmit/receive loop.
ECHO LOCKOUT: This setting defines the lockout period for the echo logic after sending the echo pulse. This enables
the relay to avoid oscillations of the echo pulses during an autoreclosure dead-time after clearing an internal fault.
HYB POTT SEAL-IN DELAY: The output FlexLogic operand (HYB POTT OP) is produced according to the hybrid
POTT scheme logic. The HYB POTT SEAL-IN DELAY defines a minimum guaranteed duration of the HYB POTT OP pulse.
As this operand runs the trip table of the hybrid POTT scheme, the trip operands HYB POTT TRIP A, B, C and 3P are
sealed-in for the same period of time.
GND DIR O/C FWD: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element that is used in addition to zone 2 for identifying faults on the protected line, and thus, for keying the communication channel and initiating
operation of the scheme (both through the transient blocking logic). Good directional integrity is the key requirement for
an over-reaching forward-looking protection element used as GND DIR O/C FWD.
Even though any FlexLogic operand could be used as GND DIR O/C FWD enabling the user to combine responses of
various protection elements or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is primarily
meant to be the output operand from either the negative-sequence directional or neutral directional overcurrent elements. Both these elements have separate forward (FWD) and reverse (REV) output operands. The forward indication
should be used (NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD or NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD).
The selected protection element (or elements in combination) should be coordinated with the selection of GND DIR O/C
REV. For all the forward external faults seen by an element used as GND DIR O/C FWD at one end of the line, the reverselooking element used as GND DIR O/C REV at the other end should pickup and provide a blocking signal.
GND DIR O/C REV: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element used in addition to
zone 4 for identifying reverse faults, and thus, for stopping the transmit signal and initiating the transient blocking timer.
Good directional integrity is the key requirement for a reverse-looking protection element used as GND DIR O/C REV.
Even though any FlexLogic operand could be used as GND DIR O/C REV enabling the user to combine responses of
various protection elements or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is primarily
meant to be the output operand from either the negative sequence directional or neutral directional overcurrent element. Both these elements have separate forward (FWD) and reverse (REV) output operands. The reverse indication
should be used (NEG SEQ DIR OC1 REV or NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV).
The selected protection element (or elements in combination) should be coordinated with the selection of GND DIR O/C
For all the forward external faults seen by an element used as GND DIR O/C FWD at one end of the line, the
reverse-looking element used as GND DIR O/C REV at the other end should pickup and provide a blocking signal.
FWD.
HYB POTT NO OF COMM BITS: This setting specifies the number of bits of the communications channel available for
the scheme. The transmit codes and trip table of the hybrid POTT scheme are the same as those for the permissive
under-reaching transfer trip scheme. Please refer to the description of the PUTT scheme for more information.
HYB POTT RX1 through HYB POTT RX4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands that represent the receive signals for the scheme. Typically input contacts interfacing with a signaling system are used. In single-bit applications, HYB POTT RX1 must be used. In two-bit applications, HYB POTT RX1 and HYB POTT RX2 must be
used. In four-bit applications, HYB POTT RX1, HYB POTT RX2, HYB POTT RX3, and HYB POTT RX4 must be used.
GE Multilin
5-243
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
SETTING
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
PH DIST Z2 PKP
GND DIST Z2 PKP
Disabled
Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LINE PICKUP LEO PKP
OPEN POLE OP
AND
Enabled
SETTING
HYB POTT W/I COND:
Custom
Off = 0
SETTING
HYB POTT SCHEME
FUNCTION:
SETTING
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
AND
AND
SETTING
Off = 0
HYB POTT NO OF
COMM BITS:
SETTINGS
RUN
SETTING
AND
HYB POTT NO OF
COMM BITS:
RX
TRIP TABLE
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
0
Off = 0
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Phase
Selector
HYB POTT OP
t RST
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
0
100 msec
OR
Off = 0
SETTING
SETTINGS
HYB POTT
PERMISSIVE ECHO:
Off = 0
ECHO DURATION:
SETTING
ECHO LOCKOUT:
HYB POTT NO OF
COMM BITS:
Disabled
Off
SETTING
AND
Enabled
AND
RUN
AND
ECHO TABLE
Off=0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
HYB POTT TX1
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GND DIST Z4 PKP
RUN
AND
OR
RX
Phase
Selector
t PKP
t RST
OR
OR
Off = 0
PH DIST Z4 PKP
SETTINGS
SETTING
TRANSMIT TABLE
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
837015AK.CDR
PH DIST Z1 PKP
GND DIST Z1 PKP
5-244
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
BLOCKING SCHEME
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BLOCK SCHEME NO OF
COMM BITS: 1
Range: 1, 2, or 4
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BLOCKING SCHEME
Generally, the scheme compares the direction to a fault at all terminals of the line. Unlike the permissive schemes, the
absence of a blocking signal permits operation of the scheme. Consequently, the scheme is biased toward dependability
and requires an "on/off" type of signaling.
By default this scheme uses only a forward-looking over-reaching Zone 2 distance element to identify forward faults.
Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the Zone 2 distance element
to increase the coverage for high-resistance faults. Also by default, only a reverse-looking Zone 4 distance element to identify reverse faults. Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the Zone
4 distance element for better time and sensitivity coordination.
For proper operation, the Zone 2 and 4 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured and set per rules
of distance relaying. If used by this scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be enabled, configured and set accordingly.
In single-pole tripping applications, the scheme uses local fault type identification provided by the Phase Selector together
with information received from the remote terminal.
The scheme generates output operands (DIR BLOCK TX INIT and DIR BLOCK TX1 STOP through DIR BLOCK TX4 STOP) that
control the transmission of signals to the remote end(s). When used with telecommunications facilities the output operands
should be assigned to operate output contacts connected to key the transmitter at the interface.
GE Multilin
5-245
5 SETTINGS
The output operands from the scheme (DIR BLOCK A, B, C and 3P) must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output contacts in particular, in order to make the scheme fully operational. Typically, the output operand should be
programmed to initiate a trip, breaker fail, and autoreclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
When used in conjunction with the Trip Output element, the scheme is pre-configured to initiate trip, breaker fail, and singlepole autoreclose actions.
BLOCK SCHEME BLOCK: This setting allows the user to assign any FlexLogic operand to block the scheme. Contact inputs from a pilot cut-out switch are typically used for this purpose.
BLOCK RX CO-ORD PKP DELAY: This setting defines a delay for the forward-looking protection elements used by
the scheme for coordination with the blocking response from the remote end(s). This setting should include both the
response time of the protection elements used to establish a blocking signal and the total transmission time of that signal including the relay communications equipment interfacing and the communications channel itself.
TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the Blocking
scheme for coping with the exposure of both the over-reaching Zone 2 and ground directional overcurrent function to
current reversal conditions.
The transient blocking logic applies to the send path only. Identifying the fault as a reverse fault establishes the blocking signal. If the reverse fault condition prevails for TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY, the blocking operation will be
extended by the transient blocking timer for TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY. This allows riding through current reversal
conditions. However, if Zone 1 picks up during the transient blocking condition, the blocking action is removed. This is
done to cope with evolving faults when an external fault is followed by an internal fault. Without the Zone 1 feedback,
the trip would be unnecessarily delayed.
The TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY should not be longer than the fastest possible trip time for faults on an adjacent line
so that the extended blocking action could be established. This should take into account the pickup time of the reverselooking elements of the scheme. The delay defined by this setting should not be too short in order to avoid locking up a
spurious reverse fault indication that can occur during internal fault conditions.
TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the Blocking
scheme for coping with the exposure of the overreaching protection functions to current reversal conditions (see also
the TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY).
This delay should be selected long enough to cope with transient conditions including not only current reversals but
also spurious negative and zero-sequence currents occurring during breaker operations (in the case when Neutral
Directional or Negative Sequence Directional overcurrent functions are used). Breaker failure time of the surrounding
protection systems within the reach of the ground directional function used by the Blocking scheme should be considered to make sure that the ground directional function is not jeopardized during delayed breaker operations.
BLOCK SCHEME SEAL-IN DELAY: The output FlexLogic operand (DIR BLOCK OP) is produced according to the
Blocking scheme logic. The BLOCK SCHEME SEAL-IN DELAY defines a minimum guaranteed duration of the DIR BLOCK
OP pulse. As this operand runs the Trip Table of the Blocking scheme, the trip operands DIR BLOCK TRIP A, B, C and 3P
are sealed-in for the same period of time.
GND DIR O/C FWD: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element used in addition to
zone 2 for identifying faults on the protected line, and thus, for initiating operation of the scheme. Good directional
integrity is the key requirement for an over-reaching forward-looking protection element used as GND DIR O/C FWD.
Even though any FlexLogic operand could be used as GND DIR O/C FWD enabling the user to combine responses of
various protection elements or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is primarily
meant to be the output operand from either the Negative-Sequence Directional or Neutral Directional Overcurrent elements. Both these elements have separate forward (FWD) and reverse (REV) output operands.
The forward indication should be used (NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD or NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD). The selected protection element (or elements in combination) should be coordinated with the selection of GND DIR O/C REV. For all the forward
external faults seen by an element used as GND DIR O/C FWD at one end of the line, the reverse-looking element used
as GND DIR O/C REV at the other end should pickup and provide a blocking signal.
GND DIR O/C REV: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element that is used in addition to zone 4 for identifying reverse faults, and thus, for initiating the blocking signal. Either reverse-looking directional
or non-directional overcurrent protection element may be used as GND DIR O/C REV.
5-246
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Even though any FlexLogic operand could be used as GND DIR O/C REV, enabling the user to combine responses of
various protection elements or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is primarily
meant to be the output operand from either the Negative Sequence Directional, Neutral Directional, or a non-directional instantaneous overcurrent element.
The selected protection element (or elements in combination) should be coordinated with the selection of GND DIR O/C
For all the forward external faults seen by an element used as GND DIR O/C FWD at one end of the line, the
reverse-looking element used as GND DIR O/C REV at the other end should pickup and provide a blocking signal.
FWD.
BLOCK SCHEME NO OF COMM BITS: This setting specifies the number of bits of the communications channel available for the scheme. With only one bit available, the scheme sends the blocking signal by asserting the DIR BLOCK TX
INIT FlexLogic operand. This operand should be used to start the channel (set the blocking signal). On internal faults,
the scheme removes the blocking signal by asserting the DIR BLOCK TX1 FlexLogic operand.
For tripping the scheme responds to lack of the blocking signal on Bit 1 (BLOCK SCHEME RX1 setting). The scheme uses
only local fault type identification provided by the Phase Selector to assert the output operands DIR BLOCK TRIP A, B, C
and 3P. Please refer to Chapter 8: Theory of Operation for more information on communications.
To take advantage of the four-bit blocking scheme, the blocking signals should be initiated from a disturbance detector.
This can be accomplished by using both 50DD and DIR BLOCK TX INIT to assert the blocking signal. Subsequently, specific bits will be de-asserted by the scheme based on the phase selection providing the peer relay with more information on the fault type. Otherwise, the peer relay issues a three-pole trip upon receiving the bit pattern (0, 0, 0, 0).
BLOCK SCHEME RX1 through BLOCK SCHEME RX4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands that represent the receive signals for the scheme. Typically input contacts interfacing with a signaling system are
used. In single-bit applications, BLOCK SCHEME RX1 must be used. In two-bit applications, BLOCK SCHEME RX1 and
BLOCK SCHEME RX2 must be used. In four-bit applications, BLOCK SCHEME RX1, BLOCK SCHEME RX2, BLOCK SCHEME
RX3, and BLOCK SCHEME RX4 must be used.
SETTING
BLOCKING SCHEME
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
AND
SETTING
BLOCK SCHEME BLOCK:
OFF = 0
SETTING
BLOCKING RX CO-ORD PKP
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
PH DIST Z2 PKP
GND DIST Z2 PKP
SETTING
t PKP
0
OR
BLOCK SCHEME
SEAL-IN DELAY:
SETTING
BLOCK SCHEME NO OF
COMM BITS:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
SETTING
DIR BLOCK OP
t RST
BLOCK SCHEME NO OF
COMM BITS:
BLOCK SCHEME NO OF
COMM BITS:
RUN
RUN
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Phase
Selector
RX
Off = 0
TRIP TABLE
PATTERN RECEIVED
(see Chapter 8 of the
instruction manual)
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
Off = 0
RUN
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Phase
Selector
SETTING
RX
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
OPEN POLE OP
OR
SETTINGS
PH DIST Z4 PKP
GND DIST Z4 PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
t PKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PH DIST Z1 PKP
GND DIST Z1 PKP
t RST
OR
OR
837016AE.CDR
GE Multilin
5-247
5 SETTINGS
DCUB SCHEME
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
DCUB BLOCK:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB PERMISSIVE
ECHO: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ECHO DURATION:
0.100 s
MESSAGE
ECHO LOCKOUT:
0.250 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DCUB SEAL-IN
DELAY: 0.010 s
MESSAGE
DCUB NO OF COMM
BITS: 1
Range: 1, 2, or 4
MESSAGE
DCUB RX1:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB LOG1:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB RX2:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB LOG2:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB RX3:
Off
DCUB SCHEME
5-248
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
DCUB LOG3:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB RX4:
Off
MESSAGE
DCUB LOG4:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
This menu allows selecting and setting up protection signaling of the directional comparison unblocking scheme. This
scheme is available for single-pole tripping applications and can be used with one, two, or four bit communications channels. Choices of communications channel include remote inputs/outputs and telecommunications interfaces.
Generally, this scheme uses an over-reaching zone 2 distance element to compare the direction to a fault at all terminals of
the line. Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the zone 2 distance
element to key the scheme and initiate its operation. This increases the coverage for high-resistance faults.
The scheme is intended for two or three-terminal applications. As a long reach of the overreaching distance element may
be required for three-terminal applications, transient blocking logic is provided for both distance and ground directional
overcurrent elements. An echo feature is made available to cope with line open conditions.
By default the scheme uses the reverse-looking zone 4 distance element to identify reverse faults. Additionally, reverselooking ground directional overcurrent functions can be used in conjunction with the zone 4.
For proper operation of the scheme the zone 2 and 4 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured
and set per rules of distance relaying. The line pickup element should be enabled, configured and set properly to detect
line-end-open conditions. If used by this scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be enabled,
configured and set accordingly.
In single-pole tripping applications, the scheme uses local fault type identification provided by the phase selector together
with information received from the remote terminal. The scheme generates output operands (DCUB TX1 through DCUB TX4)
that are used to transmit the signal to the remote terminal(s). The directional comparison unblocking scheme was developed for use with frequency shift keying communications channels, though different telecommunications interfaces can be
used (for example, digital communication channels utilizing the D60 teleprotection input/outputs).
To make the scheme fully operational as a stand-alone feature, the scheme output operands must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output contacts in particular. Typically, the output operands should be programmed to initiate
a trip, breaker fail, and autoreclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per the intended application.
When used in conjunction with the trip output element, the scheme is pre-configured to initiate trip, breaker fail and autoreclose actions.
DCUB BLOCK: This setting allows the user to assign any FlexLogic operand to block the scheme. Contact inputs
from a pilot cut-out switch are typically used for this purpose.
DCUB PERMISSIVE ECHO: Enabling this setting will send a permissive echo signal to the remote end(s) under certain conditions (see the logic diagram for details). If set to Custom, the echo signal is sent if a condition selected with
the DCUB ECHO COND setting is satisfied. The echo is sent only once and then the echo logic locks out for the time
specified by the ECHO LOCKOUT setting. The duration of the echo pulse is programmable by the ECHO DURATION setting. The echo is returned only if no overreaching and reverse protection elements operate.
DCUB ECHO COND: This setting specifies a user-selected echo condition and applies only if the DCUB PERMISSIVE
ECHO setting is Custom.
GND DIR O/C FWD: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element used in addition to
zone 2 for identifying faults on the protected line, and thus, for keying the communication channel(s) and initiating
operation of the scheme (both through the transient blocking logic).
Good directional integrity is the key requirement for an over-reaching forward-looking protection element set as GND
DIR O/C FWD. Even though any FlexLogic operand could be set as GND DIR O/C FWD, thereby enabling the user to
combine responses of various protection elements or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this
GE Multilin
5-249
5 SETTINGS
extra signal is primarily meant to be the output operand from either the negative-sequence directional or neutral directional overcurrent elements. As both these elements have separate forward and reverse output operands, the forward
indication should be used (that is, NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD or NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD).
The selected protection element (or elements in combination) should be coordinated with the selection of GND DIR O/C
For all forward external faults seen by an element set as GND DIR O/C FWD at one end of the line, the reverse-looking element set as GND DIR O/C REV at the other end should pickup and provide a blocking signal.
REV.
GND DIR O/C REV: This setting defines the FlexLogic operand (if any) of a protection element used in addition to
zone 4 for identifying reverse faults, and thus, for stopping the transmit signal and initiating the transient blocking timer.
Good directional integrity is the key requirement for a reverse-looking protection element set as GND DIR O/C REV. Even
though any FlexLogic operand could be set as GND DIR O/C REV, thereby enabling the user to combine responses of
various protection elements or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is primarily
meant to be the output operand from either the negative-sequence directional or neutral directional overcurrent element. As both these elements have separate forward and reverse output operands, the reverse indication should be
used (that is, NEG SEQ DIR OC1 REV or NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV).
The selected protection element (or elements in combination) should be coordinated with the selection of GND DIR O/C
For all the forward external faults seen by an element set as GND DIR O/C FWD at one end of the line, the reverselooking element set as GND DIR O/C REV at the other end should pickup and provide a blocking signal.
FWD.
TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the directional
comparison unblocking scheme for coping with the exposure of both the over-reaching zone 2 and ground directional
overcurrent function to current reversal conditions.
The transient blocking logic applies to both operate (trip) and send (transmit) paths. Identifying the fault as a reverse
fault prevents the scheme from both operating and keying the channel. If the reverse fault condition prevails for TRANS
BLOCK PICKUP DELAY value, the blocking operation will be extended by the transient blocking timer for the TRANS
BLOCK RESET DELAY value. This allows riding through current reversal conditions.
However, if distance zone 1 picks up during the transient blocking condition, the blocking action is removed. This is to
cope with evolving faults when an external fault is followed by an internal fault. Without the zone 1 feedback, the trip
would be delayed unnecessarily.
The TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY should not be longer than the fastest possible trip time for faults on an adjacent line
so that extended blocking action could be established. This should take into account the pickup time of the reverselooking elements of the scheme. To avoid locking up a spurious reverse fault indication that can occur during internal
fault conditions, the delay defined by this setting should not be too short.
TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY: This setting defines a transient blocking mechanism embedded in the directional
comparison unblocking scheme for coping with the exposure of the overreaching protection functions to current reversal conditions (see also the TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY setting above).
This delay should be selected long enough to cope with transient conditions including not only current reversals but
also spurious negative and zero-sequence currents occurring during breaker operations (in the case when neutral
directional or negative-sequence directional overcurrent functions are used). The breaker failure time of the surrounding protection systems within the reach of the ground directional function used by the directional comparison unblocking scheme should be considered to make sure that the ground directional function is not jeopardized during delayed
breaker operations.
ECHO DURATION: This setting defines the guaranteed and exact duration of the echo pulse. The duration does not
depend on the duration and shape of the received RX signals. This setting enables the relay to avoid a permanent lockup of the transmit/receive loop.
ECHO LOCKOUT: This setting defines the lockout period for the echo logic after sending the echo pulse. This setting
enables the relay to avoid oscillations of the echo pulses during an autoreclosure dead-time after clearing an internal
fault.
LINE END OPEN PICKUP DELAY: This setting defines the pickup value for validation of the line end open conditions
as detected by the line pickup logic via the LINE PICKUP LEO PKP FlexLogic operand. The validated line end open
condition is a requirement for the directional comparison unblocking scheme to return a received echo signal (if the
echo feature is enabled).
The value of this setting should take into account the principle of operation and settings of the line pickup element,
which should thus be enabled.
5-250
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
DCUB LOG PICKUP DELAY: This setting represents the directional comparison unblocking duration time delay, and is
the amount of time that the loss-of-guard without receipt of permissive trip must be present before the logic provides
permission to operate if a forward fault is detected. It is set relatively short, but long enough to ride through the transition period of loss-of-guard with the receipt of a permissive signal that occurs with a normal trip. Typical setting values
are from 4 to 32 ms. For most cases, a value of 8 ms may be used.
The tripping or unblocking window for loss-of-guard without permission is the difference between the DCUB LOG TRIP
and DCUB LOG PICKUP DELAY timers. For the default settings, this difference is 150 8 = 142 ms and occurs
8 ms after loss-of-guard was received, when the DCUB LOG PICKUP DELAY timer has timed out. During this interval, the
scheme has permission to operate if a forward fault is sensed, and no reverse faults or transient blocking.
WINDOW
GUARD HEALTHY RESET DELAY: This setting represents the guard healthy security time delay, and is the time after
the channel is restored that the guard signal must be present before the directional comparison unblocking scheme is
put back in service. This reset timer allows the scheme to ride through any chattering in the channel. Typical values are
from 100 to 500 ms, with a value of 150 ms commonly used.
DCUB LOG TRIP WINDOW: This setting represents the directional comparison unblocking lockout time delay, and is
the amount of time from when any loss-of-guard signal is received until the directional comparison unblocking scheme
is locked out without the presence of any RX1 to RX4 receive signal or any forward element. This timer seals-in when it
expires, creating a blocking signal for all scheme functions and disabling the scheme until the guard signal is restored
and the GUARD HEALTHY RESET DELAY timer expires. Typical values for this setting are from 160 to 180 ms; for most
cases, a setting of about 150 ms may be used.
DCUB SEAL-IN DELAY: The output FlexLogic operand (DCUB OP) is produced according to the directional comparison unblocking scheme logic. The DCUB SEAL-IN DELAY defines a minimum guaranteed duration of the DCUB OP pulse.
As this operand runs the trip table of the directional comparison unblocking scheme, the DCUB TRIP A, DCUB TRIP B,
DCUB TRIP C, and DCUB TRIP 3P trip operands are sealed-in for the same period of time.
DCUB NO OF COMM BITS: This setting specifies the number of bits available on the communications channel for the
scheme. With only one bit available, the scheme sends the direct under-reaching transfer trip command on bit 1 (DCUB
TX1 operand) and responds to the direct trip command received on bit 1 (DCUB RX1 setting). The scheme uses only
local fault type identification provided by the phase selector to assert the DCUB TRIP A, DCUB TRIP B, DCUB TRIP C and
DCUB TRIP 3P output operands (see Chapter 8: Theory of Operation for details on the use of communication channels).
DCUB RX1 through DCUB RX4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands to represent the
permission receive signals for the scheme. Contact inputs interfacing with a signaling system(s) are typically used.
These settings must be used in conjunction with the loss-of-guard signals, otherwise the scheme will not unblock and
thus fail to operate.
In single-bit applications, DCUB RX1 must be used. In two-bit applications, DCUB RX1 and DCUB RX2 must be used. In
four-bit applications, DCUB RX1, DCUB RX2, DCUB RX3, and DCUB RX4 must be used.
DCUB LOG1 through DCUB LOG4: These settings allow the user to select the FlexLogic operands to represent the
loss-of-guard receive signals for the scheme. Contact inputs interfacing with a signaling system(s) are typically used.
Each loss-of-guard signal must correspond to the same receive signal from the same communications channel (that is,
RX1 and LOG1 must be from the same communications channel, and the same for channels 2, 3 and 4, if used).
In single-bit applications, DCUB RX1 and DCUB LOG1 must be used. In two-bit applications, DCUB RX1 with DCUB LOG1
and DCUB RX2 with DCUB LOG2 must be used. In four-bit applications, all receive and loss-of-guard signals must be
used.
GE Multilin
5-251
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
DCUB SCHEME
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING
SETTINGS
AND
DCUB BLOCKED:
DCUB SEAL-IN
DELAY:
Off = 0
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
DCUB OP
tRST
tPKP
SETTING
OR
AND
DCUB NO OF COMM
BITS:
Phase
Selector
RX
AND
Off = 0
OR
AND
SETTING
DCUB NO OF COMM
BITS:
DCUB TRIP B
DCUB TRIP C
DCUB TRIP 3P
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
OPEN POLE OP
SETTINGS
Off = 0
AND
OR
DCUB LOG1:
Off = 0
OR
tPKP
0
DCUB RX2:
DCUB NO OF COMM
BITS:
SETTINGS
Off = 0
OR
DCUB LOG2:
RUN
GUARD HEALTHY
RESET DELAY:
Off = 0
Phase
Selector
DCUB RX3:
tRST
AND
TRANSMIT TABLE
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AR FORCE 3P TRIP
0
DCUB LOG3:
DCUB TX1
OPEN POLE OP
DCUB RX4:
SETTINGS
Off = 0
TRANS BLOCK
PICKUP DELAY:
DCUB LOG4:
Off = 0
AND
SETTING
DCUB TX2
SETTING
100ms
Off = 0
RUN
DCUB PERMISSIVE
ECHO:
Phase
Selector
RX
SETTINGS
TRANS BLOCK
RESET DELAY:
Off = 0
tPKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
tRST
Disabled
Enabled
tPKP
SETTING
OR
837032A1.CDR
Custom
ECHO DURATION:
ECHO LOCKOUT:
Off = 0
OR
DCUB TX4
ECHO TABLE
SETTING
Off = 0
DCUB TX3
LOG
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DCUB TRIP A
TRIP TABLE
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DCUB RX1:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
LOG
AND
AND
RUN
AND
OR
5-252
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5.7INPUTS/OUTPUTS
CONTACT INPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CONTACT INPUT
THRESHOLDS
MESSAGE
Ips H5a,H5c,H6a,H6c
THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
MESSAGE
Ips H7a,H7c,H8a,H8c
THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
MESSAGE
Ips xxx,xxx,xxx,xxx
THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
The contact inputs menu contains configuration settings for each contact input as well as voltage thresholds for each group
of four contact inputs. Upon startup, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed modules) which
contact inputs are available and then display settings for only those inputs.
An alphanumeric ID may be assigned to a contact input for diagnostic, setting, and event recording purposes. The CONTACT IP X On (Logic 1) FlexLogic operand corresponds to contact input X being closed, while CONTACT IP X Off corresponds to contact input X being open. The CONTACT INPUT DEBNCE TIME defines the time required for the contact to
overcome contact bouncing conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers, set it as a maximum contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some margin to ensure proper operation. If CONTACT
INPUT EVENTS is set to Enabled, every change in the contact input state will trigger an event.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of 0.5 ms as shown in the figure below.
The DC input voltage is compared to a user-settable threshold. A new contact input state must be maintained for a usersettable debounce time in order for the D60 to validate the new contact state. In the figure below, the debounce time is set
at 2.5 ms; thus the 6th sample in a row validates the change of state (mark no. 1 in the diagram). Once validated (debounced), the contact input asserts a corresponding FlexLogic operand and logs an event as per user setting.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when logging the change of the contact input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 2 in the diagram).
Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic equations and timers, are executed eight times in a power system
cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic operand reflecting
the debounced state of the contact is updated at the protection pass following the validation (marks no. 3 and 4 on the figure below). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all protection and control functions, as well
as FlexLogic equations, are fed with the updated states of the contact inputs.
GE Multilin
5-253
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
The FlexLogic operand response time to the contact input change is equal to the debounce time setting plus up to one
protection pass (variable and depending on system frequency if frequency tracking enabled). If the change of state occurs
just after a protection pass, the recognition is delayed until the subsequent protection pass; that is, by the entire duration of
the protection pass. If the change occurs just prior to a protection pass, the state is recognized immediately. Statistically a
delay of half the protection pass is expected. Owing to the 0.5 ms scan rate, the time resolution for the input contact is
below 1msec.
For example, 8 protection passes per cycle on a 60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a contact debounce time setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic operand-assert time limits are: 3.0 + 0.0 = 3.0 ms and 3.0 + 2.1 = 5.1
ms. These time limits depend on how soon the protection pass runs after the debouncing time.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the contact input event is time-stamped with a 1 s accuracy using the
time of the first scan corresponding to the new state (mark no. 2 below). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the
DC voltage across the contact input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently validated using the debounce
timer. Keep in mind that the associated FlexLogic operand is asserted/de-asserted later, after validating the change.
INPUT
VOLTAGE
The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks
no.1, 2, 3, and 4 in the figure below) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 5, 6, 7, and 8 below) transitions.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE THRESHOLD
3
TM
The FlexLogic
operand is going to
be asserted at this
protection pass
RAW CONTACT
STATE
7
The FlexLogicTM
operand is going to be
de-asserted at this
protection pass
DEBOUNCE TIME
(user setting)
4
FLEXLOGICTM
OPERAND
SCAN TIME
(0.5 msec)
DEBOUNCE TIME
(user setting)
PROTECTION PASS
(8 times a cycle controlled by the
frequency tracking mechanism)
842709A1.cdr
Figure 5137: INPUT CONTACT DEBOUNCING MECHANISM AND TIME-STAMPING SAMPLE TIMING
Contact inputs are isolated in groups of four to allow connection of wet contacts from different voltage sources for each
group. The CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLDS determine the minimum voltage required to detect a closed contact input. This
value should be selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V
sources and 166 for 250 V sources.
For example, to use contact input H5a as a status input from the breaker 52b contact to seal-in the trip relay and record it in
the Event Records menu, make the following settings changes:
CONTACT INPUT H5A ID: "Breaker Closed
CONTACT INPUT H5A EVENTS: "Enabled"
(52b)"
Note that the 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.
5-254
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5.7.2 VIRTUAL INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUT
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUT
Virt Ip 1
1 ID:
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUT
TYPE: Latched
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
There are 64 virtual inputs that can be individually programmed to respond to input signals from the keypad (via the COMmenu) and communications protocols. All virtual input operands are defaulted to Off (logic 0) unless the appropriate input signal is received.
MANDS
If the VIRTUAL INPUT x FUNCTION is to Disabled, the input will be forced to off (logic 0) regardless of any attempt to alter the
input. If set to Enabled, the input operates as shown on the logic diagram and generates output FlexLogic operands in
response to received input signals and the applied settings.
There are two types of operation: self-reset and latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x TYPE is Self-Reset, when the input signal transits from off to on, the output operand will be set to on for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic equations and then return
to off. If set to Latched, the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state as the most recent received
input.
NOTE
The self-reset operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the FlexLogic
equations. If the operand is to be used anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic equation, it will
likely have to be lengthened in time. A FlexLogic timer with a delayed reset can perform this function.
SETTING
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
S
AND
Latch
Virtual Input 1 to ON = 1
Virtual Input 1 to OFF = 0
SETTING
AND
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
TYPE:
Latched
SETTING
(Flexlogic Operand)
Virt Ip 1
AND
Self - Reset
827080A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-255
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
5.7.3 CONTACT OUTPUTS
a) DIGITAL OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID
Cont Op 1
MESSAGE
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE:
Off
MESSAGE
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN:
Off
MESSAGE
CONTACT OUTPUT H1
EVENTS: Enabled
CONTACT OUTPUT H1
Upon startup of the relay, the main processor will determine from an assessment of the modules installed in the chassis
which contact outputs are available and present the settings for only these outputs.
An ID may be assigned to each contact output. The signal that can OPERATE a contact output may be any FlexLogic
operand (virtual output, element state, contact input, or virtual input). An additional FlexLogic operand may be used to
SEAL-IN the relay. Any change of state of a contact output can be logged as an Event if programmed to do so.
For example, the trip circuit current is monitored by providing a current threshold detector in series with some Form-A contacts (see the trip circuit example in the Digital Elements section). The monitor will set a flag (see the specifications for
Form-A). The name of the FlexLogic operand set by the monitor, consists of the output relay designation, followed by the
name of the flag; e.g. Cont Op 1 IOn or Cont Op 1 IOff.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact used to interrupt current
flow after the breaker has tripped, to prevent damage to the less robust initiating contact. This can be done by monitoring
an auxiliary contact on the breaker which opens when the breaker has tripped, but this scheme is subject to incorrect operation caused by differences in timing between breaker auxiliary contact change-of-state and interruption of current in the
trip circuit. The most dependable protection of the initiating contact is provided by directly measuring current in the tripping
circuit, and using this parameter to control resetting of the initiating relay. This scheme is often called trip seal-in.
This can be realized in the D60 using the Cont Op 1 IOn FlexLogic operand to seal-in the contact output as follows:
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID: Cont Op 1"
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: any suitable FlexLogic
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: Cont Op 1 IOn
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 EVENTS: Enabled
operand
b) LATCHING OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a
OUTPUT H1a ID
L-Cont Op 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
5-256
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
The D60 latching output contacts are mechanically bi-stable and controlled by two separate (open and close) coils. As such
they retain their position even if the relay is not powered up. The relay recognizes all latching output contact cards and populates the setting menu accordingly. On power up, the relay reads positions of the latching contacts from the hardware
before executing any other functions of the relay (such as protection and control features or FlexLogic).
The latching output modules, either as a part of the relay or as individual modules, are shipped from the factory with all
latching contacts opened. It is highly recommended to double-check the programming and positions of the latching contacts when replacing a module.
Since the relay asserts the output contact and reads back its position, it is possible to incorporate self-monitoring capabilities for the latching outputs. If any latching outputs exhibits a discrepancy, the LATCHING OUTPUT ERROR self-test error is
declared. The error is signaled by the LATCHING OUT ERROR FlexLogic operand, event, and target message.
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the close coil of the contact. The
relay will seal-in this input to safely close the contact. Once the contact is closed and the RESET input is logic 0 (off),
any activity of the OPERATE input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and
RESET inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a RESET: This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the trip coil of the contact. The relay
will seal-in this input to safely open the contact. Once the contact is opened and the OPERATE input is logic 0 (off), any
activity of the RESET input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET
inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a TYPE: This setting specifies the contact response under conflicting control inputs; that is, when both the
OPERATE and RESET signals are applied. With both control inputs applied simultaneously, the contact will close if set to
Operate-dominant and will open if set to Reset-dominant.
Application Example 1:
A latching output contact H1a is to be controlled from two user-programmable pushbuttons (buttons number 1 and 2). The
following settings should be applied.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
OUTPUT H1a RESET: PUSHBUTTON 2 ON
Program the pushbuttons by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 and USER PUSHBUTTON 2 menus:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: Self-reset
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: 0.00 s
Application Example 2:
A relay, having two latching contacts H1a and H1c, is to be programmed. The H1a contact is to be a Type-a contact, while
the H1c contact is to be a Type-b contact (Type-a means closed after exercising the operate input; Type-b means closed
after exercising the reset input). The relay is to be controlled from virtual outputs: VO1 to operate and VO2 to reset.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: VO1
OUTPUT H1a RESET: VO2
Since the two physical contacts in this example are mechanically separated and have individual control inputs, they will not
operate at exactly the same time. A discrepancy in the range of a fraction of a maximum operating time may occur. Therefore, a pair of contacts programmed to be a multi-contact relay will not guarantee any specific sequence of operation (such
as make before break). If required, the sequence of operation must be programmed explicitly by delaying some of the control inputs as shown in the next application example.
Application Example 3:
A make before break functionality must be added to the preceding example. An overlap of 20 ms is required to implement
this functionality as described below:
GE Multilin
5-257
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
Both timers (Timer 1 and Timer 2) should be set to 20 ms pickup and 0 ms dropout.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: VO1
OUTPUT H1a RESET: VO4
Application Example 4:
A latching contact H1a is to be controlled from a single virtual output VO1. The contact should stay closed as long as VO1
is high, and should stay opened when VO1 is low. Program the relay as follows.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: VO1
OUTPUT H1a RESET: VO2
VIRTUAL OUTPUT
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL OUTPUT
Virt Op 1
1 ID
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
There are 96 virtual outputs that may be assigned via FlexLogic. If not assigned, the output will be forced to OFF (Logic
0). An ID may be assigned to each virtual output. Virtual outputs are resolved in each pass through the evaluation of the
FlexLogic equations. Any change of state of a virtual output can be logged as an event if programmed to do so.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic and the trip relay is used to signal events, the settings
would be programmed as follows:
5-258
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
The sharing of digital point state information between GSSE/GOOSE equipped relays is essentially an extension to FlexLogic, allowing distributed FlexLogic by making operands available to/from devices on a common communications network. In addition to digital point states, GSSE/GOOSE messages identify the originator of the message and provide other
information required by the communication specification. All devices listen to network messages and capture data only from
messages that have originated in selected devices.
IEC 61850 GSSE messages are compatible with UCA GOOSE messages and contain a fixed set of digital points. IEC
61850 GOOSE messages can, in general, contain any configurable data items. When used by the remote input/output feature, IEC 61850 GOOSE messages contain the same data as GSSE messages.
Both GSSE and GOOSE messages are designed to be short, reliable, and high priority. GOOSE messages have additional
advantages over GSSE messages due to their support of VLAN (virtual LAN) and Ethernet priority tagging functionality.
The GSSE message structure contains space for 128 bit pairs representing digital point state information. The IEC 61850
specification provides 32 DNA bit pairs that represent the state of two pre-defined events and 30 user-defined events. All
remaining bit pairs are UserSt bit pairs, which are status bits representing user-definable events. The D60 implementation
provides 32 of the 96 available UserSt bit pairs.
The IEC 61850 specification includes features that are used to cope with the loss of communication between transmitting
and receiving devices. Each transmitting device will send a GSSE/GOOSE message upon a successful power-up, when
the state of any included point changes, or after a specified interval (the default update time) if a change-of-state has not
occurred. The transmitting device also sends a hold time which is set greater than three times the programmed default
time required by the receiving device.
Receiving devices are constantly monitoring the communications network for messages they require, as recognized by the
identification of the originating device carried in the message. Messages received from remote devices include the message time allowed to live. The receiving relay sets a timer assigned to the originating device to this time interval, and if it
has not received another message from this device at time-out, the remote device is declared to be non-communicating, so
it will use the programmed default state for all points from that specific remote device. If a message is received from a
remote device before the time allowed to live expires, all points for that device are updated to the states contained in the
message and the hold timer is restarted. The status of a remote device, where Offline indicates non-communicating, can
be displayed.
The remote input/output facility provides for 32 remote inputs and 64 remote outputs.
b) LOCAL DEVICES: ID OF DEVICE FOR TRANSMITTING GSSE MESSAGES
In a D60 relay, the device ID that identifies the originator of the message is programmed in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
INSTALLATION RELAY NAME setting.
GE Multilin
5-259
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
REMOTE DEVICE
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 1
ETYPE APPID: 0
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 1
DATASET: Fixed
Remote devices are available for setting purposes. A receiving relay must be programmed to capture messages from only
those originating remote devices of interest. This setting is used to select specific remote devices by entering (bottom row)
the exact identification (ID) assigned to those devices.
The REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID setting is only used with GOOSE messages; they are not applicable to GSSE messages. This setting identifies the Ethernet application identification in the GOOSE message. It should match the corresponding settings on the sending device.
The REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET setting provides for the choice of the D60 fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset (that is, containing
DNA and UserSt bit pairs), or one of the configurable datasets.
Note that the dataset for the received data items must be made up of existing items in an existing logical node. For this reason, logical node GGIO3 is instantiated to hold the incoming data items. GGIO3 is not necessary to make use of the
received data. The remote input data item mapping takes care of the mapping of the inputs to remote input FlexLogic
operands. However, GGIO3 data can be read by IEC 61850 clients.
REMOTE INPUT 1
REMOTE INPUT
Remote Ip 1
1 ID:
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE:
Remote Device 1
Range: 1 to 16 inclusive
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN
None
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT
STATE: Off
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN 1
EVENTS: Disabled
1 ITEM:
Remote Inputs that create FlexLogic operands at the receiving relay are extracted from GSSE/GOOSE messages originating in remote devices. Each remote input can be selected from a list consisting of 64 selections: DNA-1 through DNA-32
and UserSt-1 through UserSt-32. The function of DNA inputs is defined in the IEC 61850 specification and is presented in
the IEC 61850 DNA Assignments table in the Remote outputs section. The function of UserSt inputs is defined by the user
selection of the FlexLogic operand whose state is represented in the GSSE/GOOSE message. A user must program a
DNA point from the appropriate FlexLogic operand.
Remote input 1 must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a specific remote device for local
use. This programming is performed via the three settings shown above.
The REMOTE INPUT 1 ID setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the remote input. The REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE setting
selects the number (1 to 16) of the remote device which originates the required signal, as previously assigned to the remote
device via the setting REMOTE DEVICE 1(16) ID (see the Remote devices section). The REMOTE IN 1 ITEM setting selects the
specific bits of the GSSE/GOOSE message required.
The REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE setting selects the logic state for this point if the local relay has just completed startup or
the remote device sending the point is declared to be non-communicating. The following choices are available:
5-260
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to Off value defaults the input to logic 0.
Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/On freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to logic 1.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/Off freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to logic 0.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
For additional information on GSSE/GOOOSE messaging, refer to the Remote devices section in this chapter.
NOTE
REMOTE OUTPUTS
DNA- 1 BIT PAIR
MESSAGE
DNA- 1 OPERAND:
Off
DNA- 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
Remote outputs (1 to 32) are FlexLogic operands inserted into GSSE/GOOSE messages that are transmitted to remote
devices on a LAN. Each digital point in the message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic operand. The above operand setting represents a specific DNA function (as shown in the following table) to be transmitted.
Table 524: IEC 61850 DNA ASSIGNMENTS
DNA
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Test
ConfRev
REMOTE OUTPUTS
UserSt- 1 BIT PAIR
MESSAGE
UserSt- 1 OPERAND:
Off
UserSt- 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
Remote outputs 1 to 32 originate as GSSE/GOOSE messages to be transmitted to remote devices. Each digital point in the
message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic operand. The setting above is used to select the
operand which represents a specific UserSt function (as selected by the user) to be transmitted.
The following setting represents the time between sending GSSE/GOOSE messages when there has been no change of
state of any selected digital point. This setting is located in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION settings menu.
DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE
UPDATE TIME: 60 s
Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1
For more information on GSSE/GOOSE messaging, refer to Remote Inputs/Outputs Overview in the
Remote Devices section.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-261
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
5.7.8 RESETTING
RESETTING
RESET OPERAND:
Off
Some events can be programmed to latch the faceplate LED event indicators and the target message on the display. Once
set, the latching mechanism will hold all of the latched indicators or messages in the set state after the initiating condition
has cleared until a RESET command is received to return these latches (not including FlexLogic latches) to the reset
state. The RESET command can be sent from the faceplate Reset button, a remote device via a communications channel,
or any programmed operand.
When the RESET command is received by the relay, two FlexLogic operands are created. These operands, which are
stored as events, reset the latches if the initiating condition has cleared. The three sources of RESET commands each create the RESET OP FlexLogic operand. Each individual source of a RESET command also creates its individual operand
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON), RESET OP (COMMS) or RESET OP (OPERAND) to identify the source of the command. The setting
shown above selects the operand that will create the RESET OP (OPERAND) operand.
5.7.9 DIRECT INPUTS/OUTPUTS
a) DIRECT INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT INPUTS DIRECT INPUT 1(32)
DIRECT INPUT
DIRECT INPUT 1
NAME: Dir Ip 1
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT
DEVICE ID: 1
Range: 1 to 16
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT 1
BIT NUMBER: 1
Range: 1 to 32
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT 1
DEFAULT STATE: Off
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
These settings specify how the direct input information is processed. The DIRECT INPUT 1 NAME setting allows the user to
assign a descriptive name to the direct input. The DIRECT INPUT 1 DEVICE ID represents the source of direct input 1. The
specified direct input is driven by the device identified here.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER is the bit number to extract the state for direct input 1. Direct Input 1 is driven by the bit
identified as DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER. This corresponds to the direct output number of the sending device.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE represents the state of the direct input when the associated direct device is offline. The
following choices are available:
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to On value defaults the input to Logic 1.
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to Off value defaults the input to Logic 0.
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/On freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest
state is not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to
Logic 1. When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/Off freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest
state is not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to
Logic 0. When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
5-262
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
b) DIRECT OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUT 1(32)
DIRECT OUTPUT
DIRECT OUT
Dir Out 1
1 NAME:
MESSAGE
DIRECT OUT
Off
1 OPERAND:
MESSAGE
DIRECT OUTPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
The DIRECT OUT 1 NAME setting allows the user to assign a descriptive name to the direct output. The DIR OUT 1 OPERAND is
the FlexLogic operand that determines the state of this direct output.
c) APPLICATION EXAMPLES
The examples introduced in the earlier Direct Inputs/Outputs section (part of the Product Setup section) direct inputs/outputs are continued below to illustrate usage of the direct inputs and outputs.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTENDING INPUT/OUTPUT CAPABILITIES OF A D60 RELAY
Consider an application that requires additional quantities of digital inputs and/or output contacts and/or lines of programmable logic that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series
IED, such as the C30, to satisfy the additional inputs/outputs and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are connected via single-channel digital communication cards as shown below.
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
UR IED 2:
= Cont Ip 1 On
The Cont Ip 1 On operand of UR IED 2 is now available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 5 ON.
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme can be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3 and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown in the figure below.
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
UR IED 3
BLOCK
UR IED 4
842712A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-263
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
Assume that Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 is used by Devices 2, 3, and 4 to block Device 1. If not blocked, Device 1
would trip the bus upon detecting a fault and applying a short coordination time delay.
The following settings should be applied (assume Bit 3 is used by all 3 devices to sent the blocking signal and Direct Inputs
7, 8, and 9 are used by the receiving device to monitor the three blocking signals):
UR IED 2:
UR IED 3:
UR IED 4:
UR IED 1:
Now the three blocking signals are available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 7 ON, DIRECT INPUT 8 ON, and DIRECT INPUT 9
ON. Upon losing communications or a device, the scheme is inclined to block (if any default state is set to On), or to trip
the bus on any overcurrent condition (all default states set to Off).
UR IED 2
UR IED 3
842713A1.CDR
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX2
UR IED 2
RX1
TX1
TX2
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR
5-264
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
In the above architecture, Devices 1 and 3 do not communicate directly. Therefore, Device 2 must act as a bridge. The following settings should be applied:
UR IED 1:
UR IED 3:
UR IED 2:
IED 3)
IED 1)
Signal flow between the three IEDs is shown in the figure below:
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 6
UR IED 3
DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 6
GE Multilin
5-265
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
5 SETTINGS
5.7.10 TELEPROTECTION INPUTS/OUTPUTS
a) OVERVIEW
The relay provides sixteen teleprotection inputs on communications channel 1 (numbered 1-1 through 1-16) and sixteen
teleprotection inputs on communications channel 2 (on two-terminals two-channel and three-terminal systems only, numbered 2-1 through 2-16). The remote relay connected to channels 1 and 2 of the local relay is programmed by assigning
FlexLogic operands to be sent via the selected communications channel. This allows the user to create distributed protection and control schemes via dedicated communications channels. Some examples are directional comparison pilot
schemes and direct transfer tripping. It should be noted that failures of communications channels will affect teleprotection
functionality. The teleprotection function must be enabled to utilize the inputs.
b) TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS TELEPROTECTION TELEPROT INPUTS
TELEPROT INPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Setting the TELEPROT INPUT ~~ DEFAULT setting to On defaults the input to logic 1 when the channel fails. A value of Off
defaults the input to logic 0 when the channel fails.
The Latest/On and Latest/Off values freeze the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not known,
such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, then the input defaults to logic 1 for Latest/On
and logic 0 for Latest/Off.
5-266
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.7 INPUTS/OUTPUTS
c) TELEPROTECTION OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS TELEPROTECTION TELEPROT OUTPUTS
TELEPROT OUTPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
As the following figure demonstrates, processing of the teleprotection inputs/outputs is dependent on the number of communication channels and terminals. On two-terminal two-channel systems, they are processed continuously on each channel and mapped separately per channel. Therefore, to achieve redundancy, the user must assign the same operand on
both channels (teleprotection outputs at the sending end or corresponding teleprotection inputs at the receiving end). On
three-terminal two-channel systems, redundancy is achieved by programming signal re-transmittal in the case of channel
failure between any pair of relays.
UR-1
UR-2
ACTUAL VALUES
SETTING
CHANNEL 1 STATUS:
SETTING
TELEPROT OUTPUT 1-1:
(same for 1-2...1-16)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
CHANNEL 1 STATUS:
SETTING
(same for 1-2...1-16)
Fail
Off
OK
SETTING
TELEPROT INPUT 2-1
DEFAULT:
(same for 2-2...2-16)
Fail
OK
OR
Off
On
Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
ACTUAL VALUES
SETTING
UR-2 or UR-3
ACTUAL VALUES
CHANNEL 2 STATUS:
On
Communication channel #1
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
On
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
ACTUAL VALUES
Off
OK
SETTING
On
Fail
CHANNEL 2 STATUS:
Communication channel #2
(On 3-terminal system or 2-terminal
with redundant channel)
SETTING
TELEPROT OUTPUT 2-1:
Fail
OK
842750A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-267
5 SETTINGS
5.8TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS
DCMA INPUT H1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DCMA INPUT H1
UNITS: A
MESSAGE
DCMA INPUT H1
RANGE: 0 to -1 mA
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DCMA INPUT H1
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external transducers and convert these signals into a digital format for use as required. The relay will accept inputs in the range of 1 to +20 mA DC, suitable for use with most common
transducer output ranges; all inputs are assumed to be linear over the complete range. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
Before the dcmA input signal can be used, the value of the signal measured by the relay must be converted to the range
and quantity of the external transducer primary input parameter, such as DC voltage or temperature. The relay simplifies
this process by internally scaling the output from the external transducer and displaying the actual primary parameter.
dcmA input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels
with the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel of
a type 5F transducer module installed in slot H.
The function of the channel may be either Enabled or Disabled. If Disabled, no actual values are created for the channel. An alphanumeric ID is assigned to each channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual value, along with the
programmed units associated with the parameter measured by the transducer, such as volts, C, megawatts, etc. This ID is
also used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. The
DCMA INPUT H1 RANGE setting specifies the mA DC range of the transducer connected to the input channel.
The DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE and DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE settings are used to program the span of the transducer in
primary units. For example, a temperature transducer might have a span from 0 to 250C; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1
MIN VALUE value is 0 and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE value is 250. Another example would be a watts transducer with
a span from 20 to +180 MW; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE value would be 20 and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX
VALUE value 180. Intermediate values between the min and max values are scaled linearly.
5-268
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
RTD INPUT H1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
RTD INPUT H1
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external resistance temperature detectors and convert these
signals into a digital format for use as required. These channels are intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in
common use. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
RTD input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with
the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel of
a type 5C transducer module installed in the first available slot.
The function of the channel may be either Enabled or Disabled. If Disabled, there will not be an actual value created for
the channel. An alphanumeric ID is assigned to the channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual values. It is also
used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. Selecting the
type of RTD connected to the channel configures the channel.
Actions based on RTD overtemperature, such as trips or alarms, are done in conjunction with the FlexElements feature.
In FlexElements, the operate level is scaled to a base of 100C. For example, a trip level of 150C is achieved by setting
the operate level at 1.5 pu. FlexElement operands are available to FlexLogic for further interlocking or to operate an
output contact directly.
Refer to the following table for reference temperature values for each RTD type.
GE Multilin
5-269
5 SETTINGS
TEMPERATURE
100 W PT
(DIN 43760)
120 W NI
100 W NI
10 W CU
50
58
80.31
86.17
71.81
7.10
40
40
84.27
92.76
77.30
7.49
30
22
88.22
99.41
82.84
7.88
20
92.16
106.15
88.45
8.26
10
14
96.09
113.00
94.17
8.65
32
100.00
120.00
100.00
9.04
10
50
103.90
127.17
105.97
9.42
20
68
107.79
134.52
112.10
9.81
30
86
111.67
142.06
118.38
10.19
40
104
115.54
149.79
124.82
10.58
50
122
119.39
157.74
131.45
10.97
60
140
123.24
165.90
138.25
11.35
70
158
127.07
174.25
145.20
11.74
80
176
130.89
182.84
152.37
12.12
90
194
134.70
191.64
159.70
12.51
100
212
138.50
200.64
167.20
12.90
110
230
142.29
209.85
174.87
13.28
120
248
146.06
219.29
182.75
13.67
130
266
149.82
228.96
190.80
14.06
140
284
153.58
238.85
199.04
14.44
150
302
157.32
248.95
207.45
14.83
160
320
161.04
259.30
216.08
15.22
170
338
164.76
269.91
224.92
15.61
180
356
168.47
280.77
233.97
16.00
190
374
172.46
291.96
243.30
16.39
200
392
175.84
303.46
252.88
16.78
210
410
179.51
315.31
262.76
17.17
220
428
183.17
327.54
272.94
17.56
230
446
186.82
340.14
283.45
17.95
240
464
190.45
353.14
294.28
18.34
250
482
194.08
366.53
305.44
18.73
DCMA OUTPUT H1
SOURCE: Off
MESSAGE
DCMA OUTPUT H1
RANGE: 1 to 1 mA
MESSAGE
DCMA OUTPUT H1
MIN VAL: 0.000 pu
MESSAGE
DCMA OUTPUT H1
MAX VAL: 1.000 pu
DCMA OUTPUT H1
5-270
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Hardware and software is provided to generate dcmA signals that allow interfacing with external equipment. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3. The dcmA output channels are arranged in a manner similar to transducer input or
CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with the settings shown below.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up, the
relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same manner used
for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as
the channel number.
Both the output range and a signal driving a given output are user-programmable via the following settings menu (an example for channel M5 is shown).
The relay checks the driving signal (x in equations below) for the minimum and maximum limits, and subsequently rescales so the limits defined as MIN VAL and MAX VAL match the output range of the hardware defined as RANGE. The following equation is applied:
I out
where:
(EQ 5.25)
(EQ 5.26)
The feature is intentionally inhibited if the MAX VAL and MIN VAL settings are entered incorrectly, e.g. when MAX VAL MIN
< 0.1 pu. The resulting characteristic is illustrated in the following figure.
VAL
OUTPUT CURRENT
Imax
Imin
DRIVING SIGNAL
MIN VAL
MAX VAL
842739A1.CDR
DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE: This setting specifies an internal analog value to drive the analog output. Actual values
(FlexAnalog parameters) such as power, current amplitude, voltage amplitude, power factor, etc. can be configured as
sources driving dcmA outputs. Refer to Appendix A for a complete list of FlexAnalog parameters.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 RANGE: This setting allows selection of the output range. Each dcmA channel may be set independently to work with different ranges. The three most commonly used output ranges are available.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL: This setting allows setting the minimum limit for the signal that drives the output. This
setting is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current (see the following
examples). The setting is entered in per-unit values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL: This setting allows setting the maximum limit for the signal that drives the output. This
setting is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current (see the following
GE Multilin
5-271
5 SETTINGS
examples). The setting is entered in per-unit values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
The DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL and DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL settings are ignored for power factor base units (i.e. if
the DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE is set to FlexAnalog value based on power factor measurement).
NOTE
(EQ 5.27)
(EQ 5.28)
The base unit for power (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
P BASE = 115 V 120 1.2 kA = 16.56 MW
(EQ 5.29)
The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:
20.65 MW = 1.247 pu,
minimum power = -----------------------------16.56 MW
MW- = 1.247 pu
maximum power = 20.65
-------------------------16.56 MW
(EQ 5.30)
With the above settings, the output will represent the power with the scale of 1 mA per 20.65 MW. The worst-case error for
this application can be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or 0.005 ( 1 ( 1 ) ) 20.65 MW = 0.207 MW
For example at the reading of 20 MW, the worst-case error is 0.01 20 MW + 0.207 MW = 0.407 MW.
EXAMPLE 2:
The phase A current (true RMS value) is to be monitored via the H2 current output working with the range from 4 to 20 mA.
The CT ratio is 5000:5 and the maximum load current is 4200 A. The current should be monitored from 0 A upwards, allowing for 50% overload.
The phase current with the 50% overload margin is:
I max = 1.5 4.2 kA = 6.3 kA
(EQ 5.31)
The base unit for current (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
I BASE = 5 kA
(EQ 5.32)
The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:
kA- = 0 pu,
minimum current = 0
----------5 kA
kA- = 1.26 pu
maximum current = 6.3
---------------5 kA
(EQ 5.33)
5-272
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The worst-case error for this application could be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or 0.005 ( 20 4 ) 6.3 kA = 0.504 kA
0.25% of reading or 0.1% of rated (whichever is greater) for currents between 0.1 and 2.0 of nominal
For example, at the reading of 4.2 kA, the worst-case error is max(0.0025 4.2 kA, 0.001 5 kA) + 0.504 kA = 0.515 kA.
EXAMPLE 3:
A positive-sequence voltage on a 400 kV system measured via Source 2 is to be monitored by the dcmA H3 output with a
range of 0 to 1 mA. The VT secondary setting is 66.4 V, the VT ratio setting is 6024, and the VT connection setting is
Delta. The voltage should be monitored in the range from 70% to 110% of nominal.
The minimum and maximum positive-sequence voltages to be monitored are:
400 kV
V min = 0.7 ------------------- = 161.66 kV,
3
400 kV
V max = 1.1 ------------------- = 254.03 kV
3
(EQ 5.34)
The base unit for voltage (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
V BASE = 0.0664 kV 6024 = 400 kV
(EQ 5.35)
The minimum and maximum voltage values to be monitored (in pu) are:
kV- = 0.404 pu,
minimum voltage = 161.66
-------------------------400 kV
kV- = 0.635 pu
maximum voltage = 254.03
-------------------------400 kV
(EQ 5.36)
mag
The limit settings differ from the expected 0.7 pu and 1.1 pu because the relay calculates the positive-sequence quantities
scaled to the phase-to-ground voltages, even if the VTs are connected in Delta (refer to the Metering Conventions section
in Chapter 6), while at the same time the VT nominal voltage is 1 pu for the settings. Consequently the settings required in
this example differ from naturally expected by the factor of 3 .
The worst-case error for this application could be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or 0.005 ( 1 0 ) 254.03 kV = 1.27 kV
0.5% of reading
For example, under nominal conditions, the positive-sequence reads 230.94 kV and the worst-case error is
0.005 x 230.94 kV + 1.27 kV = 2.42 kV.
GE Multilin
5-273
5.9 TESTING
5 SETTINGS
5.9TESTING
SETTINGS
TESTING
MESSAGE
TEST MODE
FUNCTION: Disabled
The relay provides test settings to verify that functionality using simulated conditions for contact inputs and outputs. The
Test Mode is indicated on the relay faceplate by a flashing Test Mode LED indicator.
To initiate the Test mode, the TEST MODE FUNCTION setting must be Enabled and the TEST MODE INITIATE setting must be
set to Logic 1. In particular:
To initiate Test Mode through relay settings, set TEST MODE INITIATE to On. The Test Mode starts when the TEST MODE
FUNCTION setting is changed from Disabled to Enabled.
To initiate Test Mode through a user-programmable condition, such as FlexLogic operand (pushbutton, digital input,
communication-based input, or a combination of these), set TEST MODE FUNCTION to Enabled and set TEST MODE INITIATE to the desired operand. The Test Mode starts when the selected operand assumes a Logic 1 state.
When in Test Mode, the D60 remains fully operational, allowing for various testing procedures. In particular, the protection
and control elements, FlexLogic, and communication-based inputs and outputs function normally.
The only difference between the normal operation and the Test Mode is the behavior of the input and output contacts. The
former can be forced to report as open or closed or remain fully operational; the latter can be forced to open, close, freeze,
or remain fully operational. The response of the digital input and output contacts to the Test Mode is programmed individually for each input and output using the Force Contact Inputs and Force Contact Outputs test functions described in the following sections.
5.9.2 FORCE CONTACT INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS TESTING FORCE CONTACT INPUTS
FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Ip 1
:Disabled
FORCE Cont Ip 2
:Disabled
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Ip xx
:Disabled
The relay digital inputs (contact inputs) could be pre-programmed to respond to the Test Mode in the following ways:
If set to Disabled, the input remains fully operational. It is controlled by the voltage across its input terminals and can
be turned on and off by external circuitry. This value should be selected if a given input must be operational during the
test. This includes, for example, an input initiating the test, or being a part of a user pre-programmed test sequence.
If set to Open, the input is forced to report as opened (Logic 0) for the entire duration of the Test Mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
If set to Closed, the input is forced to report as closed (Logic 1) for the entire duration of the Test Mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
The Force Contact Inputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact inputs. Once
enabled, the relay is placed into Test Mode, allowing this feature to override the normal function of contact inputs. The Test
Mode LED will be On, indicating that the relay is in Test Mode. The state of each contact input may be programmed as Disabled, Open, or Closed. All contact input operations return to normal when all settings for this feature are disabled.
5-274
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.9 TESTING
5.9.3 FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS
FORCE CONTACT
OUTPUTS
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Op 1
:Disabled
FORCE Cont Op 2
:Disabled
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Op xx
:Disabled
The relay contact outputs can be pre-programmed to respond to the test mode.
If set to Disabled, the contact output remains fully operational. If operates when its control operand is logic 1 and will
resets when its control operand is logic 0. If set to Energized, the output will close and remain closed for the entire duration of the test mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact. If set to De-energized, the output will open and remain opened for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of the status of the
operand configured to control the output contact. If set to Freeze, the output retains its position from before entering the
test mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact.
These settings are applied two ways. First, external circuits may be tested by energizing or de-energizing contacts. Second, by controlling the output contact state, relay logic may be tested and undesirable effects on external circuits avoided.
Example 1: Initiating test mode through user-programmable pushbutton 1
For example, the test mode can be initiated from user-programmable pushbutton 1. The pushbutton will be programmed as
Latched (pushbutton pressed to initiate the test, and pressed again to terminate the test). During the test, digital input 1
should remain operational, digital inputs 2 and 3 should open, and digital input 4 should close. Also, contact output 1 should
freeze, contact output 2 should open, contact output 3 should close, and contact output 4 should remain fully operational.
The required settings are shown below.
To enable user-programmable pushbutton 1 to initiate the test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS
TESTING TEST MODE menu: TEST MODE FUNCTION: Enabled and TEST MODE INITIATE: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
Make the following changes to configure the contact inputs and outputs. In the SETTINGS TESTING FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS and FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS menus, set:
FORCE Cont Ip 1: Disabled, FORCE Cont Ip 2: Open, FORCE Cont Ip 3: Open, and FORCE Cont Ip 4:
FORCE Cont Op 1: Freeze, FORCE Cont Op 2: De-energized, FORCE Cont Op 3: Energized,
and FORCE Cont Op 4: Disabled
Closed
Set the user-programmable pushbutton as latching by changing SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE
USER PUSHBUTTON 1 PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION to Latched. To enable either pushbutton 1 or remote
input 1 to initiate the Test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS TESTING TEST MODE menu:
PUSHBUTTONS
GE Multilin
5-275
5.9 TESTING
5 SETTINGS
5.9.4 PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT TEST VALUES
PMU 1 TEST
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VA TEST
MAGNITUDE: 500.00 kV
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VA TEST
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VB TEST
MAGNITUDE: 500.00 kV
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VB TEST
ANGLE: 120.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VC TEST
MAGNITUDE: 500.00 kV
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VC TEST
ANGLE: 120.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VX TEST
MAGNITUDE: 500.00 kV
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VX TEST
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IA TEST
MAGNITUDE: 1.000 kA
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IA TEST
ANGLE: 10.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IB TEST
MAGNITUDE: 1.000 kA
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IB TEST
ANGLE: 130.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IC TEST
MAGNITUDE: 1.000 kA
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IC TEST
ANGLE: 110.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IG TEST
MAGNITUDE: 0.000 kA
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IG TEST
ANGLE: 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 TEST
FREQUENCY: 60.000 Hz
MESSAGE
PMU 1 TEST
df/dt: 0.000 Hz/s
PMU 1
TEST VALUES
The relay must be in test mode to use the PMU test mode. That is, the TESTING TEST MODE FUNCTION setting must be
Enabled and the TESTING TEST MODE INITIATE initiating signal must be On.
5-276
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.9 TESTING
During the PMU test mode, the physical channels (VA, VB, VC, VX, IA, IB, IC, and IG), frequency, and rate of change of frequency are substituted with user values, while the symmetrical components are calculated from the physical channels. The
test values are not explicitly marked in the outgoing data frames. When required, it is recommended to use the user-programmable digital channels to signal the C37.118 client that test values are being sent in place of the real measurements.
GE Multilin
5-277
5.9 TESTING
5 SETTINGS
5-278
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.1 OVERVIEW
ACTUAL VALUES
STATUS
ACTUAL VALUES
METERING
CONTACT INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
REMOTE INPUTS
TELEPROTECTION
INPUTS
CONTACT OUTPUTS
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
AUTORECLOSE
REMOTE DEVICES
STATUS
REMOTE DEVICES
STATISTICS
DIGITAL COUNTERS
SELECTOR SWITCHES
FLEX STATES
ETHERNET
DIRECT INPUTS
DIRECT DEVICES
STATUS
TELEPROT CH TESTS
SOURCE SRC 1
SOURCE SRC 2
SOURCE SRC 3
SOURCE SRC 4
SYNCHROCHECK
GE Multilin
6-1
6.1 OVERVIEW
ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS
6
ACTUAL VALUES
PRODUCT INFO
6-2
6 ACTUAL VALUES
TRACKING FREQUENCY
FLEXELEMENTS
IEC 61850
GOOSE ANALOGS
WATTMETRIC
GROUND FAULT 1
WATTMETRIC
GROUND FAULT 2
PHASOR MEASUREMENT
UNIT
TRANSDUCER I/O
DCMA INPUTS
TRANSDUCER I/O
RTD INPUTS
FAULT REPORTS
EVENT RECORDS
OSCILLOGRAPHY
DATA LOGGER
MAINTENANCE
MODEL INFORMATION
FIRMWARE REVISIONS
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
6.2STATUS
For status reporting, On represents Logic 1 and Off represents Logic 0.
NOTE
CONTACT INPUTS
Cont Ip 1
Off
MESSAGE
Cont Ip xx
Off
The present status of the contact inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
input. For example, Cont Ip 1 refers to the contact input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the contact input.
6.2.2 VIRTUAL INPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS VIRTUAL INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
Virt Ip 1
Off
MESSAGE
Virt Ip 64
Off
The present status of the 64 virtual inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
input. For example, Virt Ip 1 refers to the virtual input in terms of the default name. The second line of the display indicates
the logic state of the virtual input.
6.2.3 REMOTE INPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE INPUTS
REMOTE INPUTS
REMOTE INPUT 32
STATUS: Off
REMOTE INPUT
STATUS: Off
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
6-3
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.4 TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
TELEPROTECTION
INPUTS
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 1-1: Off
Range: Off, On
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 1-2: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 1-16: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 2-1: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 2-2: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 2-16: Off
Range: Off, On
The present state of teleprotection inputs from communication channels 1 and 2 are shown here. The state displayed will
be that of corresponding remote output unless the channel is declared failed.
6.2.5 CONTACT OUTPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS CONTACT OUTPUTS
CONTACT OUTPUTS
Cont Op 1
Off
MESSAGE
Cont Op xx
Off
The present state of the contact outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
output. For example, Cont Op 1 refers to the contact output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of
the display indicates the logic state of the contact output.
For Form-A outputs, the state of the voltage(V) and/or current(I) detectors will show as: Off, VOff, IOff, On,
VOn, and/or IOn. For Form-C outputs, the state will show as Off or On.
NOTE
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
Virt Op 1
Off
MESSAGE
Virt Op 96
Off
The present state of up to 96 virtual outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
output. For example, Virt Op 1 refers to the virtual output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the virtual output, as calculated by the FlexLogic equation for that output.
6-4
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
6.2.7 AUTORECLOSE
AUTORECLOSE
Range: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4
AUTORECLOSE
SHOT COUNT:
REMOTE DEVICES
STATUS
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
REMOTE DEVICE 1
STATUS: Offline
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 16
STATUS: Offline
The present state of up to 16 programmed remote devices is shown here. The ALL REMOTE DEVICES ONLINE message indicates whether or not all programmed remote devices are online. If the corresponding state is "No", then at least one
required remote device is not online.
b) STATISTICS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATISTICS REMOTE DEVICE 1(16)
REMOTE DEVICE
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE
StNum:
REMOTE DEVICE
SqNum:
0
0
Statistical data (two types) for up to 16 programmed remote devices is shown here.
The StNum number is obtained from the indicated remote device and is incremented whenever a change of state of at
least one DNA or UserSt bit occurs. The SqNum number is obtained from the indicated remote device and is incremented
whenever a GSSE message is sent. This number will rollover to zero when a count of 4,294,967,295 is incremented.
GE Multilin
6-5
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.9 DIGITAL COUNTERS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIGITAL COUNTERS DIGITAL COUNTERS Counter 1(8)
DIGITAL COUNTERS
Counter 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Counter 1
ACCUM:
0
Counter 1
FROZEN:
0
Counter 1
FROZEN:
YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS
Counter 1
MICROS:
0
The present status of the eight digital counters is shown here. The status of each counter, with the user-defined counter
name, includes the accumulated and frozen counts (the count units label will also appear). Also included, is the date/time
stamp for the frozen count. The Counter n MICROS value refers to the microsecond portion of the time stamp.
6.2.10 SELECTOR SWITCHES
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS SELECTOR SWITCHES
SELECTOR SWITCHES
MESSAGE
SELECTOR SWITCH 1
POSITION: 0/7
SELECTOR SWITCH 2
POSITION: 0/7
The display shows both the current position and the full range. The current position only (an integer from 0 through 7) is the
actual value.
FLEX STATES
MESSAGE
PARAM
Off
1: Off
Range: Off, On
PARAM
Off
2: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
Range: Off, On
There are 256 FlexState bits available. The second line value indicates the state of the given FlexState bit.
6.2.12 ETHERNET
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS ETHERNET
ETHERNET
MESSAGE
Range: Fail, OK
Range: Fail, OK
These values indicate the status of the primary and secondary Ethernet links.
6-6
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
6.2.13 DIRECT INPUTS
DIRECT INPUTS
UNRETURNED MSG
COUNT CH1: 0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED MSG
COUNT CH2: 0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT
On
1:
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT
On
2:
MESSAGE
The AVERAGE MSG RETURN TIME is the time taken for direct output messages to return to the sender in a direct input/output
ring configuration (this value is not applicable for non-ring configurations). This is a rolling average calculated for the last
ten messages. There are two return times for dual-channel communications modules.
The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the direct output messages that do not
make the trip around the communications ring. The CRC FAIL COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the
direct output messages that have been received but fail the CRC check. High values for either of these counts may indicate
on a problem with wiring, the communication channel, or the relay(s). The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT and CRC FAIL COUNT
values can be cleared using the CLEAR DIRECT I/O COUNTERS command.
The DIRECT INPUT 1(32) values represent the state of each direct input.
6.2.14 DIRECT DEVICES STATUS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT DEVICES STATUS
DIRECT DEVICES
STATUS
DIRECT DEVICE 1
STATUS: Offline
MESSAGE
DIRECT DEVICE 2
STATUS: Offline
MESSAGE
DIRECT DEVICE 16
STATUS: Offline
These actual values represent the state of direct devices 1 through 16.
GE Multilin
6-7
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.15 TELEPROTECTION CHANNEL TESTS
CHANNEL 1
STATUS: n/a
MESSAGE
CHANNEL 1 LOST
PACKETS:
1
MESSAGE
CHANNEL 2
STATUS: n/a
MESSAGE
CHANNEL 2 LOST
PACKETS:
1
MESSAGE
VALIDITY OF CHANNEL
CONFIGURATION: FAIL
TELEPROT CH TESTS
CHANNEL 1 STATUS: This represents the receiver status of each channel. If the value is OK, teleprotection is
enabled and data is being received from the remote terminal; If the value is FAIL, teleprotection enabled and data is
not being received from the remote terminal. If n/a, teleprotection is disabled.
CHANNEL 1 LOST PACKETS: Data is transmitted to the remote terminals in data packets at a rate of two packets per
cycle. The number of lost packets represents data packets lost in transmission; this count can be reset to 0 through the
COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu.
VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION: This value displays the current state of the communications channel
identification check, and hence validity. If a remote relay ID does not match the programmed ID at the local relay, the
FAIL message will be displayed. The N/A value appears if the local relay ID is set to a default value of 0, the channel is failed, or if the teleprotection inputs/outputs are not enabled.
6-8
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3 METERING
6.3METERING
Generator
PARAMETERS AS SEEN
BY THE UR RELAY
G
Voltage
+Q
VCG
IC
WATTS = Positive
PF = Lead
PF = Lag
VARS = Positive
IA
PF = Lag
-P
VAG
Current
IB
+P
IA
PF = Lag
PF = Lead
UR RELAY
LOAD
Inductive
Resistive
VBG
-Q
-
S=VI
Generator
G
+Q
VCG
Voltage
PF = Lead
WATTS = Positive
PF = Lead
-P
VAG
+P
IA
Current
PF = Lag
IB
UR RELAY
Resistive
LOAD
PF = Lead
VBG
-Q
S=VI
LOAD
Resistive
Inductive
PF = Lag
IA
IC
VARS = Negative
+Q
VCG
Voltage
PF = Lead
IB
IA
WATTS = Negative
VAG
VARS = Negative
PF = Lag
-P
PF = Lag
+P
IA
PF = Lag
IC
Current
PF = Lead
VBG
-Q
UR RELAY
G
-
Generator
S=VI
3
Resistive
LOAD
+Q
VCG
Voltage
IB
PF = Lead
VARS = Positive
-P
VAG
PF = Lead
IA
G
Generator
+P
IC
PF = Lag
Current
UR RELAY
PF = Lag
IA
WATTS = Negative
VBG
PF = Lead
-Q
827239AC.CDR
S=VI
Figure 61: FLOW DIRECTION OF SIGNED VALUES FOR WATTS AND VARS
GE Multilin
6-9
6.3 METERING
6 ACTUAL VALUES
-225o
-315o
positive
angle
direction
-180o
UR phase angle
reference
-135o
0o
-45o
-90o
827845A1.CDR
1
V_0 = --- ( V AG + V BG + V CG )
3
1
2
V_1 = --- ( V AG + aV BG + a V CG )
3
1
2
V_2 = --- ( V AG + a V BG + aV CG )
3
6-10
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3 METERING
V_0 = N/A
1 30
2
V_1 = -------------------- ( V AB + aV BC + a V CA )
3 3
1
30
2
V_2 = ----------------- ( V AB + a V BC + aV CA )
3 3
The zero-sequence voltage is not measurable under the Delta connection of instrument transformers and is defaulted to
zero. The table below shows an example of symmetrical components calculations for the ABC phase rotation.
Table 61: SYMMETRICAL COMPONENTS CALCULATION EXAMPLE
SYSTEM VOLTAGES, SEC. V *
F5AC
F6AC
F7AC
V0
V1
V2
85.4
241
WYE
13.9
0
76.2
125
79.7
250
19.5
192
56.5
7
23.3
187
85.4
288
DELTA
84.9
0
138.3
144
85.4
288
N/A
56.5
54
23.3
234
VBG
VCG
VAB
VBC
VCA
13.9
0
76.2
125
79.7
250
84.9
313
138.3
97
84.9
0
138.3
144
VT
CONN.
VAG
The power system voltages are phase-referenced for simplicity to VAG and VAB, respectively. This, however, is a
relative matter. It is important to remember that the D60 displays are always referenced as specified under SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE.
UR phase angle
reference
SYMMETRICAL
COMPONENTS
UR phase angle
reference
SYSTEM VOLTAGES
WYE VTs
C
B
2
U
re R ph
fe a
re se
nc a
e ng
le
A
DELTA VTs
U
re R ph
fe a
re se
nc a
e ng
le
C
B
2
827844A1.CDR
GE Multilin
6-11
6.3 METERING
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3.2 SOURCES
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC1
SOURCE SRC 1
PHASE CURRENT
SRC 1
MESSAGE
GROUND CURRENT
SRC 1
MESSAGE
PHASE VOLTAGE
SRC 1
MESSAGE
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE
SRC 1
MESSAGE
POWER
SRC 1
MESSAGE
ENERGY
SRC 1
MESSAGE
FREQUENCY
SRC 1
This menu displays the metered values available for each source.
Metered values presented for each source depend on the phase and auxiliary VTs and phase and ground CTs assignments
for this particular source. For example, if no phase VT is assigned to this source, then any voltage, energy, and power values will be unavailable.
b) PHASE CURRENT METERING
PHASE CURRENT
SRC 1
6-12
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3 METERING
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The metered phase current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
c) GROUND CURRENT METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 GROUND CURRENT
GROUND CURRENT
SRC 1
MESSAGE
The metered ground current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
d) PHASE VOLTAGE METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 PHASE VOLTAGE
PHASE VOLTAGE
SRC 1
GE Multilin
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vag:
V
MESSAGE
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vbg:
V
MESSAGE
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vcg:
V
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vab:
V
MESSAGE
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vbc:
V
MESSAGE
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vca:
V
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
6-13
6.3 METERING
6 ACTUAL VALUES
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The metered phase voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
e) AUXILIARY VOLTAGE METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 AUXILIARY VOLTAGE
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE
SRC 1
MESSAGE
SRC 1
0.00
RMS Vx:
V
The metered auxiliary voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
f) POWER METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 POWER
POWER
SRC 1
6-14
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3 METERING
MESSAGE
SRC 1
3:
POWER FACTOR
1.000
MESSAGE
SRC 1
a:
POWER FACTOR
1.000
MESSAGE
SRC 1
b:
POWER FACTOR
1.000
MESSAGE
SRC 1
c:
POWER FACTOR
1.000
The metered values for real, reactive, and apparent power, as well as power factor, are displayed in this menu. The "SRC
1" text will be replaced by whatever name was programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
g) ENERGY METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 ENERGY
ENERGY
SRC 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The metered values for real and reactive energy are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever
name was programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
Because energy values are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately prior to changing
CT or VT characteristics.
h) FREQUENCY METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 FREQUENCY
FREQUENCY
SRC 1
SRC 1 FREQUENCY:
0.00 Hz
The metered frequency values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
is measured via software-implemented zero-crossing detection of an AC signal. The signal is either a
Clarke transformation of three-phase voltages or currents, auxiliary voltage, or ground current as per source configuration
(see the SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM settings). The signal used for frequency estimation is low-pass filtered. The
final frequency measurement is passed through a validation filter that eliminates false readings due to signal distortions and
transients.
SOURCE FREQUENCY
GE Multilin
6-15
6.3 METERING
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3.3 SYNCHROCHECK
SYNCHROCHECK 1
SYNCHROCHECK 1 DELTA
VOLT: 0.000 V
MESSAGE
SYNCHROCHECK 1 DELTA
PHASE:
0.0
MESSAGE
SYNCHROCHECK 1 DELTA
FREQ:
0.00 Hz
The actual values menu for synchrocheck 2 is identical to that of synchrocheck 1. If a synchrocheck function setting is "Disabled", the corresponding actual values menu item will not be displayed.
6.3.4 TRACKING FREQUENCY
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRACKING FREQUENCY
TRACKING FREQUENCY
TRACKING FREQUENCY:
60.00 Hz
The tracking frequency is displayed here. The frequency is tracked based on the selection of the reference source with the
FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM menu. Refer to the
Power System section of chapter 5 for additional details.
6.3.5 FLEXELEMENTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING FLEXELEMENTS FLEXELEMENT 1(8)
FLEXELEMENT 1
FLEXELEMENT 1
OpSig: 0.000 pu
The operating signals for the FlexElements are displayed in pu values using the following definitions of the base units.
Table 62: FLEXELEMENT BASE UNITS
BREAKER ARCING AMPS
(Brk X Arc Amp A, B, and C)
dcmA
BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and IN inputs.
FREQUENCY
fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE
POWER FACTOR
PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs
BASE = 100C
SOURCE CURRENT
IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE ENERGY
(SRC X Positive and Negative
Watthours); (SRC X Positive and
Negative Varhours)
SOURCE POWER
PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE VOLTAGE
VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SYNCHROCHECK
(Max Delta Volts)
VBASE = maximum primary RMS value of all the sources related to the +IN and IN inputs
6-16
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3 METERING
6.3.6 IEC 61580 GOOSE ANALOG VALUES
IEC 61850
GOOSE ANALOGS
MESSAGE
ANALOG INPUT
0.000
ANALOG INPUT
0.000
MESSAGE
ANALOG INPUT 32
0.000
The D60 Line Distance Protection System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability.
This feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. Refer to the Ordering section of chapter 2 for additional details. The IEC 61850 protocol features are not available if CPU Type E is ordered.
The IEC 61850 GGIO3 analog input data points are displayed in this menu. The GGIO3 analog data values are received
via IEC 61850 GOOSE messages sent from other devices.
6.3.7 WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT 1(2)
WATTMETRIC
GROUND FAULT 1
This menu displays the wattmetric zero-sequence directional element operating power values.
6.3.8 PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT PMU 1(4)
PMU 1 VA:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VB:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VC:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 VX:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 V1:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 V2:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 V0:
0.0000 kV, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IA:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IB:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
PMU 1
GE Multilin
6-17
6.3 METERING
6 ACTUAL VALUES
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IC:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 IG:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 I1:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 I2:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 I0:
0.0000 kA, 0.00
MESSAGE
PMU 1 FREQUENCY:
0.0000 Hz
MESSAGE
PMU 1 df/dt:
0.0000 Hz/s
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 65535
The above actual values are displayed without the corresponding time stamp as they become available per the recording
rate setting. Also, the recording post-filtering setting is applied to these values.
6.3.9 TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O DCMA INPUTS DCMA INPUT xx
DCMA INPUT xx
DCMA INPUT xx
0.000 mA
Actual values for each dcmA input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed Channel ID
and the bottom line as the value followed by the programmed units.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS RTD INPUT xx
RTD INPUT xx
RTD INPUT xx
-50 C
Actual values for each RTD input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed Channel ID
and the bottom line as the value.
6-18
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.4 RECORDS
6.4RECORDS
NO FAULTS TO REPORT
or
FAULT 1
LINE ID: SRC 1
MESSAGE
FAULT 1
2000/08/11
Range: YYYY/MM/DD
MESSAGE
FAULT 1
TIME:
00:00:00.000000
Range: HH:MM:SS.ssssss
MESSAGE
FAULT 1
ABG
TYPE:
MESSAGE
FAULT 1
00.0 km
LOCATION
MESSAGE
FAULT 1
SHOT: 0
RECLOSE
FAULT REPORT 1
DATE:
The latest 15 fault reports can be stored. The most recent fault location calculation (when applicable) is displayed in this
menu, along with the date and time stamp of the event which triggered the calculation. See the SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP FAULT REPORTS menu for assigning the source and trigger for fault calculations. Refer to the COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS menu for manual clearing of the fault reports and to the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP CLEAR RELAY
RECORDS menu for automated clearing of the fault reports.
6.4.2 EVENT RECORDS
EVENT RECORDS
EVENT: XXXX
RESET OP(PUSHBUTTON)
MESSAGE
EVENT: 3
POWER ON
EVENT 3
DATE: 2000/07/14
MESSAGE
EVENT: 2
POWER OFF
EVENT 3
TIME: 14:53:00.03405
MESSAGE
EVENT: 1
EVENTS CLEARED
The event records menu shows the contextual data associated with up to the last 1024 events, listed in chronological order
from most recent to oldest. If all 1024 event records have been filled, the oldest record will be removed as a new record is
added. Each event record shows the event identifier/sequence number, cause, and date/time stamp associated with the
event trigger. Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing event records.
GE Multilin
6-19
6.4 RECORDS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.4.3 OSCILLOGRAPHY
OSCILLOGRAPHY
FORCE TRIGGER?
No
MESSAGE
NUMBER OF TRIGGERS:
0
MESSAGE
AVAILABLE RECORDS:
0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
This menu allows the user to view the number of triggers involved and number of oscillography traces available. The
cycles per record value is calculated to account for the fixed amount of data storage for oscillography. See the Oscillography section of Chapter 5 for further details.
A trigger can be forced here at any time by setting Yes to the FORCE TRIGGER? command. Refer to the COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing the oscillography records.
6.4.4 DATA LOGGER
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS DATA LOGGER
DATA LOGGER
The OLDEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time at which the oldest available samples were taken. It will be static until the log
gets full, at which time it will start counting at the defined sampling rate. The NEWEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time the
most recent samples were taken. It counts up at the defined sampling rate. If the data logger channels are defined, then
both values are static.
Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing data logger records.
6-20
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.4 RECORDS
6.4.5 BREAKER MAINTENANCE
BREAKER 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BKR 1 OPERATING
TIME:
0 ms
There is an identical menu for each of the breakers. The BKR 1 ARCING AMP values are in units of kA2-cycles. Refer to the
COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing breaker arcing current records. The BREAKER OPERATING TIME is
defined as the slowest operating time of breaker poles that were initiated to open.
GE Multilin
6-21
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.5PRODUCT INFORMATION
SERIAL NUMBER:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MANUFACTURING DATE:
0
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
OPERATING TIME:
0:00:00
MODEL INFORMATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The product order code, serial number, Ethernet MAC address, date/time of manufacture, and operating time are shown
here.
6.5.2 FIRMWARE REVISIONS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES PRODUCT INFO FIRMWARE REVISIONS
MESSAGE
MODIFICATION FILE
NUMBER:
0
MESSAGE
BOOT PROGRAM
REVISION:
1.13
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
COMPILE DATE:
2004/09/15 04:55:16
MESSAGE
BOOT DATE:
2004/09/15 16:41:32
FIRMWARE REVISIONS
The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed.
6-22
GE Multilin
7.1 COMMANDS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
SET DATE AND TIME
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
RELAY MAINTENANCE
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
PMU ONE-SHOT
The commands menu contains relay directives intended for operations personnel. All commands can be protected from
unauthorized access via the command password; see the Password Security section of chapter 5 for details. The following
flash message appears after successfully command entry:
COMMAND
EXECUTED
7.1.2 VIRTUAL INPUTS
PATH: COMMANDS VIRTUAL INPUTS
COMMANDS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
Range: Off, On
Virt Ip 1
Off
MESSAGE
Virt Ip 64
Off
Range: Off, On
The states of up to 64 virtual inputs are changed here. The first line of the display indicates the ID of the virtual input. The
second line indicates the current or selected status of the virtual input. This status will be a state off (logic 0) or on (logic 1).
7.1.3 CLEAR RECORDS
PATH: COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS
COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS
GE Multilin
CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY?
No
7-1
7.1 COMMANDS
CLEAR BREAKER 2
ARCING AMPS? No
CLEAR UNAUTHORIZED
ACCESS? No
Range: No, Yes. Valid only for units with Direct Input/
Output module.
CLEAR TELEPROTECT
COUNTERS? No
This menu contains commands for clearing historical data such as the event records. Data is cleared by changing a command setting to Yes and pressing the ENTER key. After clearing data, the command setting automatically reverts to No.
7.1.4 SET DATE AND TIME
PATH: COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME
COMMANDS
SET DATE AND TIME
(YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS)
The date and time can be entered here via the faceplate keypad only if the IRIG-B or SNTP signal is not in use. The time
setting is based on the 24-hour clock. The complete date, as a minimum, must be entered to allow execution of this command. The new time will take effect at the moment the ENTER key is clicked.
7.1.5 RELAY MAINTENANCE
COMMANDS
RELAY MAINTENANCE
PERFORM LAMPTEST?
No
This menu contains commands for relay maintenance purposes. Commands are activated by changing a command setting
to Yes and pressing the ENTER key. The command setting will then automatically revert to No.
The PERFORM LAMPTEST command turns on all faceplate LEDs and display pixels for a short duration. The UPDATE
ORDER CODE command causes the relay to scan the backplane for the hardware modules and update the order code to
match. If an update occurs, the following message is shown.
UPDATING...
PLEASE WAIT
There is no impact if there have been no changes to the hardware modules. When an update does not occur, the ORDER
CODE NOT UPDATED message will be shown.
7-2
GE Multilin
7.1 COMMANDS
7.1.6 PHASOR MEASUREMENT UNIT ONE-SHOT
COMMANDS
PMU ONE-SHOT
PMU ONE-SHOT
FUNCTION: Disabled
PMU ONE-SHOT
SEQUENCE NUMBER: 0
This feature allows pre-scheduling a PMU measurement at a specific point in time. This functionality can be used to test for
accuracy of the PMU, and for manual collection of synchronized measurements through the system, as explained below.
When enabled, the function continuously compares the present time with the pre-set PMU ONE-SHOT TIME. When the two
times match, the function compares the present sequence number of the measured synchrophasors with the pre-set PMU
ONE-SHOT SEQUENCE NUMBER. When the two numbers match, the function freezes the synchrophasor actual values and
the corresponding protocol data items for 30 seconds. This allows manual read-out of the synchrophasor values for the preset time and pre-set sequence number (via the faceplate display, supported communication protocols such as Modbus or
DNP, and the EnerVista UR Setup software).
When freezing the actual values the function also asserts a PMU ONE-SHOT OP FlexLogic operand. This operand may be
configured to drive an output contact and trigger an external measuring device such as a digital scope with the intent to verify the accuracy of the PMU under test.
With reference to the figure below, the PMU one-shot function (when enabled) controls three FlexLogic operands:
The PMU ONE-SHOT EXPIRED operand indicates that the one-shot operation has been executed, and the present time
is at least 30 seconds past the scheduled one-shot time.
The PMU ONE-SHOT PENDING operand indicates that the one-shot operation is pending; that is, the present time is
before the scheduled one-shot time.
The PMU ONE-SHOT OP operand indicates the one-shot operation and remains asserted for 30 seconds afterwards.
When the function is disabled, all three operands are de-asserted. The one-shot function applies to all logical PMUs of a
given D60 relay.
GE Multilin
7-3
7.1 COMMANDS
sured signals are raw inputs to the PMU under test, their independently captured record, processed using third-party software, is a good reference point for accuracy calculations. Such a record proves useful when discussing the test results, and
should be retained as a part of the testing documentation.
Note that the PMU under such test does not have to be connected to a real GPS receiver as the accuracy is measured with
respect to the timing reference provided to the PMU and not to the absolute UTC time. Therefore a simple IRIG-B generator could be used instead. Also, the test set does not have to support GPS synchronization. Any stable signal source can
be used. If both the PMU under test and the test set use the timing reference, they should be driven from the same IRIG-B
signal: either the same GPS receiver or IRIG-B generator. Otherwise, the setpoints of the test set and the PMU measurements should not be compared as they are referenced to different time scales.
Figure 72: USING THE PMU ONE-SHOT FEATURE TO TEST SYNCHROPHASOR MEASUREMENT ACCURACY
COLLECTING SYNCHRONIZED MEASUREMENTS AD HOC:
The one-shot feature can be used for ad hoc collection of synchronized measurements in the network. Two or more PMU
can be pre-scheduled to freeze their measurements at the same time. When frozen the measurements could be collected
using EnerVista UR Setup or a protocol client.
7-4
GE Multilin
7.2 TARGETS
7.2TARGETS
TARGETS
MESSAGE
DIGITAL ELEMENT
LATCHED
1:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The status of any active targets will be displayed in the targets menu. If no targets are active, the display will read No
Active Targets:
7.2.2 TARGET MESSAGES
When there are no active targets, the first target to become active will cause the display to immediately default to that message. If there are active targets and the user is navigating through other messages, and when the default message timer
times out (i.e. the keypad has not been used for a determined period of time), the display will again default back to the target message.
The range of variables for the target messages is described below. Phase information will be included if applicable. If a target message status changes, the status with the highest priority will be displayed.
Table 71: TARGET MESSAGE PRIORITY STATUS
PRIORITY
ACTIVE STATUS
DESCRIPTION
OP
PKP
LATCHED
If a self test error is detected, a message appears indicating the cause of the error. For example UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
indicates that the minimal relay settings have not been programmed.
7.2.3 RELAY SELF-TESTS
a) DESCRIPTION
The relay performs a number of self-test diagnostic checks to ensure device integrity. The two types of self-tests (major and
minor) are listed in the tables below. When either type of self-test error occurs, the Trouble LED Indicator will turn on and a
target message displayed. All errors record an event in the event recorder. Latched errors can be cleared by pressing the
RESET key, providing the condition is no longer present.
Major self-test errors also result in the following:
All other output relays are de-energized and are prevented from further operation.
GE Multilin
7-5
7.2 TARGETS
MODULE FAILURE___:
Contact Factory (xxx)
What to do: Contact the factory and supply the failure code noted in the display. The xxx text identifies the failed module (for example, F8L).
INCOMPATIBLE H/W:
Contact Factory (xxx)
Description of problem: One or more installed hardware modules is not compatible with the D60 order code.
What to do: Contact the factory and supply the failure code noted in the display. The xxx text identifies the failed module (for example, F8L).
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH:
with 2nd line detail
Description of problem: The configuration of modules does not match the order code stored in the D60.
How often the test is performed: On power up. Afterwards, the backplane is checked for missing cards every five seconds.
What to do: Check all modules against the order code, ensure they are inserted properly, and cycle control power. If
the problem persists, contact the factory.
FLEXLOGIC ERROR:
with 2nd line detail
How often the test is performed: The test is event driven, performed whenever FlexLogic equations are modified.
What to do: Finish all equation editing and use self tests to debug any errors.
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED:
Check Settings
Description of problem: The PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS setting indicates the D60 is not programmed.
How often the test is performed: On power up and whenever the PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS
setting is altered.
What to do: Program all settings and then set PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS to Programmed.
7-6
GE Multilin
7.2 TARGETS
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Replace Battery
How often the test is performed: The battery is monitored every five seconds. The error message is displayed after 60
seconds if the problem persists.
What to do: Replace the battery located in the power supply module (1H or 1L).
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Direct I/O Ring Break
Description of problem: Direct input and output settings are configured for a ring, but the connection is not in a ring.
What to do: Check direct input and output configuration and wiring.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
**Bad IRIG-B Signal**
How often the test is performed: Monitored whenever an IRIG-B signal is received.
Proper cable functionality (that is, check for physical damage or perform a continuity test).
Check the input signal level (it may be less than specification).
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Port ## Failure
What to do: Check Ethernet connections. Port 1 is the primary port and port 2 is the secondary port.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
SNTP Failure
GE Multilin
7-7
7.2 TARGETS
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
4L Discrepancy
Description of problem: A discrepancy has been detected between the actual and desired state of a latching contact
output of an installed type 4L module.
How often the test is performed: Upon initiation of a contact output state change.
What to do: Verify the state of the output contact and contact the factory if the problem persists.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
GGIO Ind xxx oscill
How often the test is performed: Upon scanning of each configurable GOOSE data set.
What to do: The xxx text denotes the data item that has been detected as oscillating. Evaluate all logic pertaining to
this item.
What to do: Check direct input and output configuration and wiring.
How often the test is performed: Event driven. The test is performed when a device programmed to receive GOOSE
messages stops receiving. This can be from 1 to 60 seconds, depending on GOOSE packets.
UNEXPECTED RESTART:
Press RESET key
Description of problem: Abnormal restart from modules being removed or inserted while the D60 is powered-up, when
there is an abnormal DC supply, or as a result of internal relay failure.
7-8
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The distance elements use memory voltage for polarization. Additional supervising functions different for ground and
phase distance zones complement a classical mho characteristic to enhance directional integrity and reach accuracy:
To avoid overreaching during resistive faults under heavy pre-fault load conditions, the ground distance elements utilize a load-adaptive (zero-sequence polarized) reactance characteristic to supervise the base mho characteristic.
Both negative and zero-sequence currents are compared with the memory voltage to enhance directional integrity of
the ground distance elements.
It is well known that ground distance elements as per the principle of distance relaying may have limited accuracy
during double-line-to-ground faults. In order to prevent maloperation in such cases the ground elements are blocked by
an extra fault-type comparator that utilizes the phase angle between the negative- and zero-sequence currents.
The phase distance elements use reactance and memory polarized directional characteristics to supervise the mho
characteristic.
Both ground and phase distance elements have the current supervision functions built-in.
The quadrilateral distance characteristic uses the reactance, directional, and current supervising functions as described
above. Right and left blinders adjustable as to both the resistive and angular positions complete the characteristic.
More information regarding the distance characteristics is found in the Distance characteristics section. An example of
analysis of the steady-state operation of the distance elements is found in the Distance elements analysis section.
The relay provides five zones of distance protection. All zones are identical in terms of settings. However, zone 1 has extra
adaptive mechanisms built-in to enhance the transient reach accuracy even when the voltage signals are supplied from
poor quality voltage sources such as capacitive voltage transformers (CVTs). Ground zones 2 through 5, in turn, have an
extra zero-sequence directional supervision implemented for their time-delayed operation after the memory expires. Consequently, zone 1 is recommended as an underreaching element, and zones 2 through 5 are recommended as overreaching elements and for time-delayed tripping.
The relay uses offset ground directional overcurrent functions as an optional supplement of the ground distance protection
for pilot-aided schemes. The elements are described in more details in the Ground directional overcurrent section.
The relay provides for an adaptive distance reach control to cope with the overreaching and sub-synchronous oscillations
when applied to, or in a near vicinity of series compensated lines. More details can be found in the Application on series
compensated Lines section.
The distance elements use phase angle comparators to shape their characteristics as described in the Distance characteristics section. The voltage and current phasors are estimated using optimized techniques as explained in the next section.
8.1.2 PHASOR ESTIMATION
The relay samples its input AC signals at 64 samples per power system cycle. A fast and accurate frequency tracking
mechanism ensures accurate filtering and phasor estimation during off-nominal frequency conditions.
The phasor estimation process for both currents and voltages is based on the commonly used Fourier algorithm. Due to a
different nature of signal distortions in the current and voltage signals digital pre-filtering algorithms have been, however,
designed and optimized separately for the current and voltage channels.
The current signals are pre-filtered using an improved digital MIMIC filter. The filter removes effectively the DC component(s) guaranteeing transient overshoot below 2% regardless of the initial magnitude and time constant of the dc component(s). The filter has significantly better frequency response for higher frequencies as compared with a classical MIMIC
filter. This was possible without introducing any significant phase delay thanks to the high sampling rate used by the relay.
The voltage signals are pre-filtered using a special digital filter designed to cope with CVT transients. The patented filter
combines filtering and memory actions enabling the relay to cope with CVT noise under high Source Impedance Ratios
(SIRs). The filter controls underestimation of the fault voltage magnitude to less than 1% of the nominal and prevents certain phase angle anomalies that can be encountered under heavy CVT noise and high SIRs.
GE Multilin
8-1
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.1.3 DISTANCE CHARACTERISTICS
a) DEFINITIONS
The relay shapes its distance characteristics using phase angle comparators and voltage and current phasors estimated as
described in the previous section.
The following definitions pertain to all of the distance functions:
IA, IB, IC
IG
VA, VB, VC
()_1
()_2
()_0
()M
Z
ZREV
ZD
ZR
ZL
K0
K0M
The limit angle of the comparator is adjustable enabling the user to shape the characteristic as a mho or a lens as shown in
the figures below.The memory-polarized mho characteristic has an excellent directional integrity built-in as explained in the
Memory Polarization section.
X
Reach setting
Reach setting
8
Comparator angle setting= 90
R
MHO CHARACTERISTIC
837715A2.CDR
R
LENS CHARACTERISTIC
837714A2.CDR
8-2
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
(IA IB) Z (VA VB) and (VA VB) (IA IB) ZREV
(IB IC) Z (VB VC) and (VB VC) (IB IC) ZREV
(IC IA) Z (VC VA) and (VC VA) (IC IA) ZREV
IA Z + I_0 K0 Z + IG K0M Z VA
and VA (IA ZREV + I_0 K0 ZREV + IG K0M ZREV)
IB Z + I_0 K0 Z + IG K0M Z VB
and VB (IB ZREV + I_0 K0 ZREV + IG K0M ZREV)
IC Z + I_0 K0 Z + IG K0M Z VC
and VC (IC ZREV + I_0 K0 ZREV + IG K0M ZREV)
If the mho characteristic is selected, the limit angle of the comparator is adjustable concurrently with the limit angle of the
mho characteristic, resulting in a tent shape complementing the lens characteristic being effectively applied.
e) QUADRILATERAL REACTANCE CHARACTERISTIC FOR DIRECTIONAL APPLICATIONS
The quadrilateral reactance characteristic is achieved by checking the angle between:
AB phase element:
BC phase element:
CA phase element:
A ground element:
B ground element:
C ground element:
The ground elements are polarized from either zero-sequence or negative-sequence current as per user-settings to maximize performance in non-homogenous systems. The polarizing current is additionally shifted by the user-selectable nonhomogeneity correction angle.
f) REVERSE QUADRILATERAL REACTANCE CHARACTERISTIC FOR NON-DIRECTIONAL APPLICATIONS
The reverse quadrilateral reactance characteristic is achieved by checking the angle between:
AB phase element:
BC phase element:
CA phase element:
A ground element:
B ground element:
C ground element:
The ground elements are polarized from either zero-sequence or negative-sequence current as per user-settings to maximize performance in non-homogenous systems. The polarizing current is additionally shifted by the user-selectable nonhomogeneity correction angle.
GE Multilin
8-3
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
g) DIRECTIONAL CHARACTERISTIC
The directional characteristic is achieved by checking the angle between:
AB phase element:
BC phase element:
CA phase element:
A ground element:
B ground element:
C ground element:
The characteristic and limit angles of the directional comparator are adjustable independently from the mho and reactance
comparators. The directional characteristic improves directional integrity of the distance functions.
h) RIGHT BLINDER
The right blinder characteristic is achieved by checking the angle between the following signals:
AB phase element:
BC phase element:
CA phase element:
A ground element:
B ground element:
C ground element:
The fault-type characteristic applies to ground elements only and is achieved by checking the angle between:
A ground element:
B ground element:
C ground element:
I_0
I_0
I_0
and
and
and
IA_2;
IB_2
IC_2
The limit angle of the comparator is not adjustable and equals 50. The fault-type characteristic is intended to block the
ground distance elements during double-line-to-ground faults.
k) ZERO-SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL CHARACTERISTIC
The extra zero-sequence characteristic applies to ground zones 2 to 5 only and is achieved by checking angles between:
A ground element:
B ground element:
C ground element:
8-4
I_0 ZD
I_0 ZD
I_0 ZD
and
and
and
V_0
V_0
V_0
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
The limit angle of the comparator is not adjustable and equals 90. The zero-sequence directional characteristic improves
directional integrity for time-delayed operations after the memory expires.
l) OVERCURRENT SUPERVISION
The overcurrent supervision responds to the following currents:
AB phase element:
BC phase element:
CA phase element:
A, B, C ground element:
(IA IB) /
(IB IC) /
(IC IA) /
3 I_0
3
3
3
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Variable mho
IZV
Reactance
IZV
IZ
COMP LIMIT
Directional
I ZD
V_1M
V_1M
COMP LIMIT
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Variable mho
IZV
V_1M
COMP LIMIT
Reactance
IZV
I_0 Z
COMP LIMIT
Directional
I_0 ZD
V_1M
Directional
I_2 ZD
V_1M
Fault-type
I_0
I_2
I_0 ZD
V_0
Zero-sequence
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Reactance
IZV
IZ
COMP LIMIT
Directional
I ZD
V_1M
Right Blinder
I ZR V
I ZR
90
Left Blinder
I ZL V
I ZL
90
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Reactance
IZV
j I_0 ej or j I_2 ej
COMP LIMIT
Directional
I_0 ZD
V_1M
Directional
I_2 ZD
V_1M
Right Blinder
I ZR V
I ZR
90
Left Blinder
I ZL V
I ZL
90
I_0
I_2
I_0 ZD
V_0
Fault-type
Zero-sequence
GE Multilin
COMPARATOR INPUTS
IZV
I ZREV V
LIMIT ANGLE
COMP LIMIT
8-5
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Offset mho
IZV
I ZREV V
COMP LIMIT
Fault-type
I_0
I_2
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Forward Reactance
IZV
IZ
COMP LIMIT
Reverse Reactance
I ZREV V
I ZREV
COMP LIMIT
Right Blinder
I ZR V
I ZR
90
Left Blinder
I ZL V
I ZL
90
COMPARATOR INPUTS
LIMIT ANGLE
Forward Reactance
IZV
j I_0 ej or j I_2 ej
COMP LIMIT
Reverse Reactance
I ZREV V
j I_0 ej or j I_2 ej
COMP LIMIT
90
Right Blinder
I ZR V
I ZR
Left Blinder
I ZL V
I ZL
90
Fault-type
I_0
I_2
Memory-polarized mho
(Reverse fault)
8
Self-polarized mho
Memory-polarized mho
(Forward fault)
R
837719A1.CDR
8-6
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
Memorypolarized
(Reverse fault)
Self-polarized
Memorypolarized
(Forward fault)
837724A1.CDR
IA
IB
IC
= 4.47 A 107.8
= 2.92 A 68.9
= 2.93 A 51.1
ZD = 1 88
ZR = 9.99 2
ZL = 4.99 178
GE Multilin
= 58.83 V 2.1
VA_1M
= 64.71 V 0.0
8-7
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
= 1.37 A 68.2
= 1.37 A 68.1
= 29.18 V 8.4
= 93.35 V 32.0
= 112.08 V 30.0
= 7.39 A 109.1
= 64.71 V 0.0
= 1.37 V 19.8
= 19.11 V 19.8
= 1.37 V 19.8
VA_1
= 58.83 V 2.1
IA_2 ZD
= 1.37 V 19.8
I_0 Z
= 19.11 V 19.8
= 1.37 V 19.8
I_0 ZD
Overcurrent supervision: | 3 I_0 | = 4.09 A > 3 A
Mho difference angle = | 3.9 (2.1) | = 1.8 < 75
Reactance difference angle = | 3.9 19.8 | = 23.7 < 75
Zero-sequence directional difference angle = | 19.8 (2.1) | = 21.9 < 75
Negative-sequence directional difference angle = | 19.8 (2.1) | = 21.9 < 75
Fault-type comparator difference angle = | 19.8 19.8 | = 0.0 < 50
Zero-sequence directional difference angle for Zones 2 through 4 (phase A) = | 19.8 8.4 | = 11.4 < 90.
Zones 2 through 4 phase A ground elements will pick-up, time-out and operate.
8-8
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
VA_1M
j I_0
ej3
= 1.34 A 24.8
IA_2 ZD
= 1.37 V 19.8
I_0 ZD
= 1.37 V 19.8
= 91.5 V 93.0
= 45.8 V 82.9
GE Multilin
8-9
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.2.1 DESCRIPTION
As a Wye-Delta transformer introduces discontinuity for the zero-sequence circuit, the ground distance protection cannot
be applied, except special circumstances, to respond to faults behind the transformer.
The phase distance elements, however, could be developed so that both accurate reach and correct fault phase identification is retained for faults behind the power transformer as seen from the relaying point. Without appropriate compensation,
the relay's reach would depend on a type of fault, creating considerable difficulties in applying the relay.
The D60 provides for any location of the VTs and CTs with respect to the involved power transformer and the direction of
any given zone.
In the following equations, the VT and CT locations are referenced as None if the transformer is not present between the
CT/VT and the intended reach point. Otherwise, the location is to be selected as a type of a transformer as seen from the
VT/CT position towards the intended reach point. The following figure explains the adopted rules.
(a)
delta
(b)
delta
Z4
Z4
Z1
Z1
(c)
delta
(e)
L1
Z4
L2
Zone 4
Zone 1
ZL1
ZT
ZL2
Z1
Z1 XFRM VOL CONNECTION = Dy11
Z1 XFRM CUR CONNECTION = None
Figure 84: APPLICATIONS OF THE PHS DIST XFMR VOL/CUR CONNECTION SETTINGS
8-10
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
LOOP
CURRENT
TRANSFORMATION
VOLTAGE
TRANSFORMATION
None
AB
IA IB
V AB
BC
IB IC
V BC
CA
IC IA
V CA
AB
3I A
1-----( V AB V CA )
3
BC
3I B
1-----( V BC V AB )
3
CA
3I C
1-----( V CA V BC )
3
Dy1
Dy3
Dy5
Dy7
Dy9
Dy11
GE Multilin
AB
I AB_21P = 3I C
1
V AB_21P = ------- ( V BC V CA )
3
BC
I BC_21P = 3I A
1
V BC_21P = ------- ( V CA V AB )
3
CA
I CA_21P = 3I B
1
V CA_21P = ------- ( V AB V BC )
3
AB
I AB_21P = 3I B
1
V AB_21P = ------- ( V BC V AB )
3
BC
I BC_21P = 3I C
1
V BC_21P = ------- ( V CA V BC )
3
CA
I CA_21P = 3I A
1
V CA_21P = ------- ( V AB V CA )
3
AB
I AB_21P = 3I A
1
V AB_21P = ------- ( V CA V AB )
3
BC
I BC_21P = 3I B
1
V BC_21P = ------- ( V AB V BC )
3
CA
I CA_21P = 3I C
1
V CA_21P = ------- ( V BC V CA )
3
AB
I AB_21P = 3I C
1
V AB_21P = ------- ( V CA V BC )
3
BC
I BC_21P = 3I A
1
V BC_21P = ------- ( V AB V CA )
3
CA
I CA_21P = 3I B
1
V CA_21P = ------- ( V BC V AB )
3
AB
I AB_21P = 3I B
1
V AB_21P = ------- ( V AB V BC )
3
BC
I BC_21P = 3I C
1
V BC_21P = ------- ( V BC V CA )
3
CA
I CA_21P = 3I A
1
V CA_21P = ------- ( V CA V AB )
3
8-11
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
LOOP
CURRENT
TRANSFORMATION
VOLTAGE
TRANSFORMATION
Yd1
AB
1
I AB_21P = ------- ( 2I A I B I C )
3
V AB_21P =
3V A
BC
1
I BC_21P = ------- ( 2I B I A I C )
3
V BC_21P =
3V B
CA
1
I CA_21P = ------- ( 2I C I A I B )
3
V CA_21P =
3V C
AB
1
I AB_21P = ------- ( I A + I B 2I C )
3
V AB_21P = 3V C
BC
1
I BC_21P = ------- ( I B + I C 2I A )
3
V BC_21P = 3V A
CA
1
I CA_21P = ------- ( I A + I C 2I B )
3
V CA_21P = 3V B
AB
1
I AB_21P = ------- ( 2I B I A I C )
3
V AB_21P =
3V B
BC
1
I BC_21P = ------- ( 2I C I A I B )
3
V BC_21P =
3V C
CA
1
I CA_21P = ------- ( 2I A I B I C )
3
V CA_21P =
3V A
AB
1
I AB_21P = ------- ( I B + I C 2I A )
3
V AB_21P = 3V A
BC
1
I BC_21P = ------- ( I A + I C 2I B )
3
V BC_21P = 3V B
CA
1
I CA_21P = ------- ( I A + I B 2I C )
3
V CA_21P = 3V C
AB
1
I AB_21P = ------- ( 2I C I A I B )
3
V AB_21P =
3V C
BC
1
I BC_21P = ------- ( 2I A I B I C )
3
V BC_21P =
3V A
CA
1
I CA_21P = ------- ( 2I B I A I C )
3
V CA_21P =
3V B
AB
1
I AB_21P = ------- ( I A + I C 2I B )
3
V AB_21P = 3V B
BC
1
I BC_21P = ------- ( I A + I B 2I C )
3
V BC_21P = 3V C
CA
1
I CA_21P = ------- ( I B + I C 2I A )
3
V CA_21P = 3V A
Yd3
Yd5
Yd7
Yd9
8
Yd11
8-12
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
Equations from the Current Transformation and Voltage Transformation columns are used to derive inputs to the three
(AB, BC, and CA) phase distance elements. For example, if the CTs are located at the delta side of the Delta-Wye 11 transformer, and a given zone is set to look through the transformer into the system connected to the Wye winding, the CT location setting for that zone shall be set to Dy11 and the relay would use 3I B instead of a traditional I A I B for the AB
phase distance element.
The current supervision pickup setting applies to the currents specified in the Current Transformation columns.
A distance zone originates at the location of the VTs (regardless of the location of the CTs). For more information on settings please refer to Chapter 9: Application of Settings.
8.2.2 EXAMPLE
Consider the system shown below:
150 MVA, 10%
13.8kV/315kV
delta
AB
ZL = 30.1185
VT = 13.8kV/120V
CT = 8000:5
VT = 315kV/120V
CT = 300:5
0.68885
2.5788.4
837727A2.CDR
PRIMARY
SECONDARY
VA
100.4 kV 7.32
38.25 V 7.32
VB
97.23 kV 53.4
37.04 V 53.4
VC
181.8 kV 150.0
69.26 V 150.0
IA
1.288 kA 27.6
21.47 A 27.6
IB
1.288 kA 152.4
21.47 A 152.4
IC
If installed at the location X, the relay would use the following input signals for its phase AB distance element:
V = VAB = 77.402 kV 57.5 primary or 29.49 V 57.5 secondary
I = IA IB = 2.576 kA 27.6 primary or 42.93 A 27.6 secondary
And consequently it would see an apparent impedance of:
Zapp = V / I = 30.05 85 primary or 0.687 85 secondary
GE Multilin
8-13
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
PRIMARY
SECONDARY
VA
7.584 kV 5.59
69.95 V 5.59
VB
6.269 kV 120.1
54.52 V 120.1
VC
7.751 kV 125.5
65.84 V 125.5
IA
16.976 kA 27.6
10.61 A 27.6
IB
33.952 kA 152.4
21.22 A 152.4
IC
16.976 kA 27.6
10.61 A 27.6
Consequently, the following signals are applied to the phase AB distance element:
1
V = ------- V AB V BC = 10.861 kV 59.9 primary or 94.45 V 59.9 secondary
3
(EQ 8.1)
(EQ 8.2)
(EQ 8.3)
The above value is a correct measure of the distance from the VT location to the fault. For relay location 2, this certainly
includes the positive-sequence impedance of the transformer:
2
10 ( 13.8 kV )
Z T ( at 13.8 kV ) = ---------- ---------------------------- = 0.127 90
100 150 MVA
(EQ 8.4)
13.8 2
Z L ( at 13.8 kV ) = 30.11 ----------- = 0.05779 85
315
Thus, 0.127 90 + 0.05779 85 = 0.1847 88.4 primary side or 2.569 88.4 on the secondary side.
The above example illustrates how the relay maintains correct reach for fault behind power transformers. When installed at
X, the relay shall be set to 0.687 85 secondary in order to reach to the fault shown in the figure. When installed at H,
the relay shall be set to 2.569 88.4 to ensure exactly same coverage.
See Chapter 9: Application of Settings for more information on setting calculations.
8-14
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.3.1 DESCRIPTION
Consider the negative-sequence directional overcurrent element. As illustrated below, the negative-sequence voltage could
be low during internal fault conditions.
(a)
(b)
S_op
V_2
S_pol
I_2 x Z
-V_2
ECA
V_2
UR
I_2
(c)
(d)
I_2 x Z
S_pol
-V_2
V_2 >
I_2 * Z_2line
S_op
V_2
-V_2
ECA
I_2
UR
where:
ECA = forward ECA angle (maximum torque angle); Z_offset = offset impedance
The effect of the augmentation for forward and reverse fault is shown in the figures above. As long as the offset impedance
is not higher than the negative-sequence line impedance the element will ensure correct and fast fault direction identification for both forward and reverse faults. The same principle applies to the neutral directional overcurrent element.
8.3.2 EXAMPLE
Consider relay input signals as in the Distance Elements Analysis section and assume an offset impedance of 4 and
ECA and limit angles of 88 and 90, respectively. The relay calculates the following negative-sequence quantities:
V_2 = 6.39 V 159.6; I_2 = 1.37 A 68.1; I_1 = 2.94 A 144.2
and the following signals for the directional unit of the negative-sequence directional overcurrent element:
GE Multilin
8-15
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.4.1 DESCRIPTION
Faults on or in a close vicinity of series compensated lines may create problems for distance protection:
Voltage and/or current inversion may lead to false direction discrimination by directional elements. This may potentially
include both a failure to operate on a forward in-zone fault as well as misoperation on a reverse fault. Both distance
and overcurrent directional elements can be affected.
Series-capacitors and their overvoltage protection equipment (air gaps and/or Metal-Oxide Varistors) have a steadystate overreaching effect on the apparent impedance seen by the relay - a forward fault may appear much closer to the
relay as compared with the actual fault location. The apparent impedance may be shifted towards the relay by as much
as the total reactance of the series capacitors placed between the potential source of the relay and the fault point. This
extreme steady-state overreach happens during low-current faults when the air-gaps do not flashover or the MOVs do
not conduct any significant current.
In addition to the above steady-state overreach effect; sub-synchronous oscillations in both currents and voltages may
cause significant transient overreach.
Distance protection elements of the D60 deal with the problem of voltage inversion by using 100% memory polarized directional comparators. As the memory duration is set longer that the slowest fault clearing time for reverse faults, it is guaranteed that the distance element would not pick-up on reverse faults should the voltage inversion happen.
At the same time, it is guaranteed that the distance elements would pick-up for all forward faults regardless of any voltage
inversion as long as the memory voltage is used. Before the memory expires the relay would respond to any fault on the
protected line. Stepped distance backup zones operate after the memory voltage expires. But the backup protection
responds to distant faults that do not cause any inversion of the positive-sequence voltage. As a result, the time-delayed
stepped-distance zones are guaranteed to operate.
Distance protection elements of the D60 deal with the problem of current inversion by using a multi-input-comparator
approach as described in the Distance Characteristics subsection. Should the current inversion happen, the distance elements are secure on reverse faults because multiple conditions involving fault-loop, negative-sequence and zero-sequence
currents and the memory voltage are checked prior to declaring a forward fault.
On close-in forward faults beyond the series capacitors as seen from the relaying point, the current inversion phenomenon
may take place for a short period of time. The condition cannot sustain for a long time as very high fault currents would
occur causing large voltage drops across the series capacitors and prompting the overvoltage protection of the capacitors
to operate quickly. This would effectively remove the series compensation and eliminate the current inversion. However,
when the currents used by distance comparator (fault-loop current for ground and phase distance protection, and the negative- and zero-sequence currents for ground elements) stay shifted by more than 90 degrees from their natural fault position
determined by the user as the element characteristic angle, the distance elements may fail to pick-up on such a forward
fault for the brief period of current inversion. This is an inherent attribute of the 100% memory polarized mho element, and
not a weakness particular to the D60 relay.
Therefore, for dependability, it is recommended to use high-set phase overcurrent protection for direct tripping on close-in
faults potentially causing current inversion, and overreaching ground fault directional overcurrent functions (such as negative-sequence, ground or neutral) for communication-aided schemes.
The problem of steady-state overreaching due to the negative reactance of the series capacitors may be addressed in the
D60 in a traditional way by shortening the reach of an underreaching distance elements to the net inductive reactance of
the line between the potential source and the far end busbar(s). This generic approach has two major drawbacks. First, it
leaves large portion of the line uncovered by the directly tripping distance protection. Second, it does not solve the transient
overreaching problem caused by sub-synchronous oscillations.
Therefore, the D60 offers a unique option for dynamic reach control that is effectively based on the magnitude of the current
flowing through the series capacitor bank(s). The underreaching distance functions can be set as for plain uncompensated
line, i.e. using the impedance of the line alone, and the relay would control an effective reach accordingly using the current
magnitude as illustrated in the figure below.
The reach is reduced sufficiently to cope with both steady-state and transient overreach phenomena. For large degrees of
compensation and small-current faults, the transient overreach may be as high as 100%. This means that fast distance protection is not achievable. The adaptive D60's mechanism would guarantee security on external faults. Overreaching ground
fault directional overcurrent functions (such as negative-sequence, ground or neutral) shall be used for dependability.
8-16
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
THE REACH IS
DYNAMICALLY
REDUCED BY
VL/abs(I)
FAR
-E
BUS ND
BAR
ACTUAL REACH
FOR VERY SMALL
CURRENTS
837729A1.CDR
GE Multilin
8-17
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
(a)
LOW-CURRENT EXTERNAL
FAULT
FAR-E
N
BUSB D
AR
RF
Set reach
Impedance
Trajectory
SC
Z SC&MOV
Steady-state
apparent
impedance
M OV
(b)
HIGH-CURRENT EXTERNAL
FAULT
FAR-E
N
BUSB D
AR
RF
Set reach
Impedance
Trajectory (no
subsynchronous
oscillations)
SC
Steady-state
apparent
impedance
M OV
(c)
HIGH-CURRENT INTERNAL
FAULT
FAR-E
N
BUSB D
AR
Impedance
Trajectory (no
subsynchronous
oscillations)
Set reach
RF
M OV
SC
Steady-state
apparent
impedance
The reach is not
reduced
R
837730A1.CDR
8-18
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.5SINGLE-POLE TRIPPING
8.5.1 OVERVIEW
a) INTRODUCTION
Single pole operations make use of many features of the relay. At the minimum, the Trip Output, Recloser, Breaker Control,
Open Pole Detector, and Phase Selector must be fully programmed and in service; and either protection elements or digital
inputs representing fault detection must be available for successful operation. When single pole trip-and-reclose is required
overall control within the relay is performed by the Trip Output element. This element includes interfaces with pilot aided
schemes, the Line Pickup, Breaker Control, and Breaker Failure elements.
Single pole operations are based on use of the Phase Selector to identify the type of the fault, to eliminate incorrect fault
identification that can be made by distance elements in some circumstances and to provide trip initiation from elements that
are not capable of any fault type identification, such as high-set negative-sequence directional overcurrent element. The
scheme is also designed to make use of the advantages provided by communications channels with multiple-bit capacities
for fault identification.
Phase Selector
AR RIP
Reset
Output
Volts
and
Amps
Fault Locator
Protection
Elements
Setting
Inputs
Setting
1-Pole
Trip
Request
1-Pole
Trip
PilotAided
Schemes
Setting
Setting
Inputs
Outputs
Open
Pole
Detector
Trip
A or B or C
Initiate Breaker
Failure
1-Pole
Operation
Communications
Channels
AG
BG
CG
Volts
and
Amps
Trip Output
Breaker
1 and 2
Pole State
SLG
Faulted
Phase
Setting
Permission
Reset
Multi - Phase
Void
Setting
3-Pole
Trip
Request
Force
3-Pole
Operation
S
e
t
t
i
n
g
Breaker
Control
3-Pole
Trip
Inputs
B
k
r
Outputs
1
&
2
Setting
CLOSE 1
CLOSE 2
CLOSE 1
CLOSE 2
Line Pickup
Breaker
1 and 2
OOS
3-Pole
Operation
Operator
Setting
AR Force 3-P
Reclose Request
Trip
AR Initiate 3-Pole
Initiate
Initiate
Recloser
Multi-Phase
837026A4.CDR
initiate Breaker Failure protection for phases A, B and C, either individually or as a group
notify the Open Pole Detector when a single pole operation is imminent
GE Multilin
8-19
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
When notified that a single pole operation has been initiated Open Pole Detector will:
initiate blocking of protection elements that could potentially maloperate when a breaker pole is open
instruct the Phase Selector to de-assert all outputs, as an Open Pole invalidates calculations.
The operation of the scheme on a line in a single breaker arrangement will be described. The line is protected by a D60
relay using the Line Pickup and Zone 1 Phase and Ground Distance elements, and a Permissive Overreaching Transfer
Trip scheme (using Zone 2 Phase and Ground distance elements as well as Negative-Sequence Directional Overcurrent
elements, GND DIR O/C FWD: NEG SEQ OC1 FWD, GND DIR O/C REV: NEG SEQ OC1 REV). Zone 1 is configured to issue a
single-pole trip when appropriate (TRIP 1-POLE INPUT-1: GND DIST Z1 OP, TRIP 1-POLE INPUT-2: PHS DIST Z1 OP). By
default the POTT scheme will issue a single-pole trip. It is assumed that when tripping three-poles both the Zone 1 and the
POTT shall initiate three-pole reclosing. This is achieved by setting TRIP RECLOSE INPUT-1: POTT TRIP 3P, TRIP RECLOSE
INPUT-2: GND DIST Z1 OP, and TRIP RECLOSE INPUT-3: PHS DIST Z1 OP.
It is assumed for this discussion that the relay features that are shown on Single Pole Operation diagram above have all
been programmed for the application and are in service. The description begins with line breakers open at both the local
and remote ends, and the operation of the scheme is described in chronological order.
Because the line is de-energized the Line Pickup element is armed. The Recloser is presently enabled. An operator
requests that Breaker Control close the breaker, and it operates output relays to close breaker poles A, B and C. This operator manual close request is also forwarded from Breaker Control to recloser, which becomes disabled, de-asserting its
Enabled output. This output is transferred to Trip Output, where it converts any input request for a single pole operation
into a three-pole operation. At the Recloser, the AR1 BLK TIME @ MAN CLOSE timer is started.
The breaker closes and status monitoring contacts on the breaker poles change state; the new breaker pole states are
reported to Breaker Control, which in turn transfers these states to the recloser, Trip Output, Breaker Failure and Open Pole
Detector. Because a fault is not detected the AR1 BLK TIME @ MAN CLOSE times out and the Recloser is enabled, which
asserts the Enabled output, informing the Trip Output element that single pole trip operations are now permitted. When
normal voltage appears on the line the Line Pickup element is disarmed. As the local line breaker has not tripped the operator closes the breaker at the remote end of the line, placing the line in service.
Several scenarios are considered below.
b) SLG FAULT
An AG fault occurs close to the considered relay. Immediately after the fault, the disturbance detector (50DD) picks-up and
activates the phase selector. The phase selector recognizes an AG fault by asserting its PHASE SELECT AG operand.
Ground distance zone 1 (AG element) responds to the fault. As the fault is close to the relay, phase distance zone 1 (AB,
CA elements) may respond to this fault as well. In any case, a single-pole operation is requested by zone 1 via the GND
DIST Z1 OP and/or PHS DIST Z1 OP operands.
At this moment the request to trip is placed for the trip output. As the fault is recognized as an AG fault, the TRIP PHASE A
operand is asserted by the trip output. This signal is passed to the breaker control scheme and results in tripping pole A of
the breaker.
Simultaneously with the TRIP PHASE A operand, the TRIP 1-POLE operand is asserted. This operand activates the open pole
detector. The latter detector responds to the TRIP PHASE A signal by declaring phase A open by asserting OPEN POLE OP
A (even before it is actually opened). The TRIP PHASE A signal resets only after the breaker actually operates as indicated
by its auxiliary contact. At this moment the open pole detector responds to the breaker position and continues to indicate
phase A opened. This indication results in establishing blocking signals for distance elements (OPEN POLE BLK AB, OPEN
POLE BLK CA operands are asserted). If neutral and negative-sequence overcurrent elements are mapped into the trip output to trigger single-pole tripping, they must be blocked with the OPEN POLE BLK N operand, specifically provided for this
purpose. The OPEN POLE BLK N operand must be assigned through the block setting of the overcurrent element. The two
latter operands block phase distance AB and CA elements, respectively (all zones); the OPEN POLE A OP blocks the
ground distance AG elements (all zones). As a result, the Z1 OP and Z2 PKP operands that were picked-up reset immediately. The following distance elements remain operational guarding the line against evolving faults: BG, CG and BC.
8-20
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
As zone 2 and/or negative-sequence directional elements pick up due to the fault, the permission to trip is keyed to the
remote end. Assume here that a single-bit channel is used. If so, no extra information is sent to the remote end, just permission to trip sent over the TX1 operand. Upon receiving permission to trip over RX1, the POTT scheme decides to trip. The
scheme will check the phase selector for phase type identification and will issue a trip for phase A by asserting the POTT
TRIP A operand. This operand is passed to the trip output and results in exactly same action as described above for zone 1.
Depending on response times, the actual trip is initiated either by zone 1 or by the POTT scheme. At the moment TRIP 1POLE operand is asserted, the phase selector resets and no other trip action could take place. After the trip command is
issued all the picked up elements are forced to reset by the open pole detector.
The TRIP 1-POLE operand initiates automatically a single-pole autoreclose. The autoreclose is started and asserts the AR
RIP operand. This operand keeps blocking the phase selector so that it does not respond to any subsequent events. At the
same time the operand removes zero-sequence directional supervision from ground distance zones 2 and 3 so that they
could respond to a single-line-to-ground fault during open pole conditions.
The AR FORCE 3-P TRIP operand is asserted 1.25 cycles following autoreclose initiation. This operand acts as an enabler
for any existing trip request. In this case none of the protection elements is picked up at this time, therefore no more trips
are initiated.
When the recloser dead time interval is complete it signals the breaker control element to close the breaker. The breaker
control element operates output relays to close the breaker.
When pole A of the breaker closes this new status is reported to the breaker control element, which transfers this data to
the breaker failure, autorecloser, open pole detector and trip output elements. The response at breaker failure is dependent
on the programming of that element. The response at the autorecloser is not relevant to this discussion. At the open pole
detector, the blocking signals to protection elements are de-asserted.
If the fault was transient the reset time would expire at the autorecloser and the AR FORCE 3-P TRIP and RIP outputs would
be de-asserted, returning all features to the state described at the beginning of this description.
If the fault was permanent appropriate protection elements would detect it and place a trip request for the trip output element. As the AR FORCE 3-P TRIP is still asserted, the request is executed as a three-pole trip.
The response of the system from this point is as described above for the second trip, except the autorecloser will go to lockout upon the next initiation (depending on the number of shots programmed).
c) SLG FAULT EVOLVING INTO LLG
When an AG fault occurs the events unfold initially as in the previous example. If the fault evolves quickly, the phase selector will change its initial assessment from AG to ABG fault and when the trip request is placed either by the zone 1 or the
POTT scheme, a three-pole trip will be initiated. If this is the case, all three TRIP PHASE A, B and C operands will be
asserted. The command is passed to the breaker control element and results in a three-pole trip. At the same time the
recloser is initiated as per settings of the trip output. As the TRIP 3-POLE operand is asserted (not the TRIP 1-POLE operand)
the open pole is not activated. Because the AR RIP in progress is asserted, the phase selector is blocked as well.
If the fault evolves slowly, the sequence is different: The relay trips phase A as in the previous example. The phase selector
resets, the open pole detector is activated and forces the zone 1 and zone 2 AG, AB, CA and negative-sequence overcurrent elements to reset. If the zone 1 BG element picks up, or the zone 2 BG element picks up resulting in operation of the
POTT scheme, no trip command will be issued until the AR FORCE 3-P TRIP is asserted. This happens 1.25 cycles after the
first trip. If at this time or any time later a request for trip is placed (due to an evolving fault), a three-pole trip is initiated. The
TRIP 1-POLE operand is de-asserted by the TRIP 3-POLE operand, resetting the open pole detector. Shortly all three-poles
are opened.
When the dead time expires, the recloser signals the breaker control to close the breaker. At this time all the protection elements are operational, as the open pole detector is not blocking any elements. If the line-side VTs are used, the line pickup
element is armed as well. If there is a fault on the line, these elements will pickup the fault and issue next request for trip.
This request results in three-pole trip as the AR FORCE 3-P TRIP is still asserted.
The response of the system from this point is as described above for the second trip, except the recloser will go to lockout
upon the next initiation (depending on the number of shots programmed).
GE Multilin
8-21
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.5.2 PHASE SELECTION
The D60 uses phase relations between current symmetrical components for phase selection. First, the algorithm validates
if there is enough zero, positive, and negative-sequence currents for reliable analysis. The comparison is adaptive; that is,
the magnitudes of the three symmetrical components used mutually as restraints confirm if a given component is large
enough to be used for phase selection. Once the current magnitudes are validated, the algorithm analyzes phase relations
between the negative and positive-sequence currents and negative and zero-sequence currents (when applicable) as illustrated below.
CG,
ABG
AB,
ABG
BG
AG
I2F
BC,
BCG
I2F
AG,
BCG
I1F
CG
I0F
CA,
CAG
BG,
CAG
837725A1.CDR
DELAY
TRIP 1-POLE
TRIP 3-POLE
OPEN POLE OP
0.5 cycles
OR
SRCn 50DD OP
RESET
DELAY
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
DELAY
4 cycles
AND
500 ms
PHASE SELECT AG
START
PHASE SELECT BG
PHASE SELECT CG
PHASE SELECTOR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SRCn VT FUSE FAIL OP
SETTING
DISTANCE SOURCE:
PHASE SELECT AB
PHASE SELECT BC
PHASE SELECT CA
PHASE SELECT ABG
PHASE SELECT BCG
PHASE SELECT CAG
PHASE SELECT 3P
I_0
I_1
I_2
V_0
V_1
V_2
837027A4.CDR
8-22
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
a) DESCRIPTION
In the D60 relay pilot-aided schemes transmit a code representing the type of fault determined by the local phase selector
according to the scheme logic. At a receiving terminal the local and remote data is combined to determine the action to be
performed. Schemes can be used with channels that can carry one, two or four bits. Using a one-bit channel, the schemes
at all terminals of the line use their local phase selectors to identify the fault type and initiate appropriate tripping actions. In
single pole operation applications however, a three-pole trip can be performed in the event of an in-line single-phase fault
co-incident with a fault on a different phase (cross-country fault) that is within the reach of the local phase selector, which is
considerably longer than the line. This possibility can be reduced by using a two-bit channel, and eliminated by using a
four-bit channel.
Using two-bit channels, the relays can share limited information about their local phase selection, improving considerably
the accuracy of single-pole tripping on cross-country faults. Two-bit channels however can only provide four different messages, one of which must be no fault has been detected. With only three messages available it is not possible to transmit
sufficient information to eliminate the use of local phase selector data, so a three-pole operation can occur in a cross-country fault condition. Using four-bit channels, the relays share enough information about fault types seen from all the line terminals that local fault selector data can be rejected. In addition, in multiple bit systems the relays do not respond to nonvalid bit combinations, making the protection system more immune to communication problems than in a single bit system.
Each scheme within the relay has a setting that specifies the number of bits available on the associated communications
channel. This setting defines the input (RX1, RX2, RX3, RX4) and output (TX1, TX2, TX3, TX4 for communications and
[Scheme Abbreviation] TRIP A, TRIP B, TRIP C, TRIP 3P for action) operands used by the scheme, the data codes used to
convey fault data between terminals, and the method of combining information from the local and remote terminals to produce an output.
b) SINGLE BIT CHANNELS
The TX1 and RX1 operands are used, and fault data is coded per the following tables.
Table 811: PERMISSIVE SCHEME TRANSMIT CODES FOR 1-BIT CHANNELS
PHASE SELECTOR DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
GE Multilin
8-23
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
Any
AG Fault
Trip Phase A
Any
BG Fault
Trip Phase B
Any
CG Fault
Trip Phase C
Any
RX1
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
Any
AG Fault
Trip Phase A
Any
BG Fault
Trip Phase B
Any
CG Fault
Trip Phase C
Any
RX1
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
DCUB TRIP A
RX1
LOG1
0 or 1
Any
AG Fault
0 or 1
Any
BG Fault
DCUB TRIP B
0 or 1
Any
CG Fault
DCUB TRIP C
0 or 1
Any
DCUB TRIP 3P
The scheme initiates a three-phase trip if the phase selector fails to recognize the fault type or after the AR FORCE 3P
TRIP operand is asserted.
c) TWO-BIT CHANNELS
The TX1, TX2, RX1 and RX2 operands are used and fault data is coded per the following tables.
TX2
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
ASSERTED
TX1
TX2
TX1 STOP
TX2 STOP
8-24
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
ASSERTED
TX1
TX2
TX1 STOP
TX2 STOP
TX2
RX2
LOCAL DATA
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
Trip Phase A
AG
AG
BG
BG
CG
CG
Trip Phase B
Trip Phase C
RX2
LOCAL DATA
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
AG
AG
BG
BG
CG
CG
GE Multilin
8-25
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
RX1
LOG1
RX2
LOG2
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
DCUB TRIP A
AG
AG
BG
BG
CG
CG
DCUB TRIP B
DCUB TRIP C
DCUB TRIP 3P
d) FOUR-BIT CHANNELS
The TX1, TX2, TX3, TX4, RX1, RX2, RX3 and RX4 operands are used.
Table 823: PERMISSIVE SCHEME TRANSMIT CODES FOR 4-BIT CHANNELS
PHASE SELECTOR
DETERMINATION OF FAULT TYPE
TX2
TX3
TX4
AG
BG
CG
8-26
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
TX1
TX2
TX3
TX4
AG
BG
CG
TX2
TX3
TX4
AG
BG
CG
RX2
RX3
LOCAL DATA
RX4
REMOTE
DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
Trip Phase A
MULTI-P
AG
BG
AG
CG
AG
AG
BG
AG
BG
CG
BG
MULTI-P
BG
CG
AG
CG
BG
CG
MULTI-P
CG
AG
BC, BCG
BG
CA, CAG
CG
AB, ABG
MULTI-P
Unrecognized
GE Multilin
Trip Phase B
Trip Phase C
8
Trip Three Phases
8-27
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE
DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
RX1
RX2
RX3
RX4
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
MULTI-P
AG
BG
AG
CG
AG
AG
BG
AG
BG
CG
BG
MULTI-P
BG
CG
AG
CG
BG
CG
MULTI-P
CG
AG
BC, BCG
BG
CA, CAG
CG
AB, ABG
MULTI-P
Unrecognized
8-28
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
LOCAL DATA
LOG1
RX2
LOG2
RX3
LOG3
RX4
LOG4
REMOTE
DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
MULTI-P
GE Multilin
LOCAL
DETERMINATION OF
FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
AG
DCUB TRIP A
BG
CG
AG
BG
AG
BG
DCUB TRIP B
CG
MULTI-P
CG
AG
CG
DCUB TRIP C
BG
MULTI-P
AG
BC, BCG
BG
CA, CAG
CG
AB, ABG
MULTI-P
3P or unrecognized
DCUB TRIP 3P
8-29
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.5.4 PERMISSIVE ECHO SIGNALING
The echo feature can reduce the response time of an over-reaching scheme when a terminal is disconnected from the
line. In this condition, a zone 2 element at the terminal that remains in-service can detect a fault, but cannot trip, as a permissive signal is not received from the remote terminal. This feature is provided in the permissive over-reaching transfer trip
and hybrid permissive over-reaching transfer trip schemes.
PERMISSIVE OVER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP SCHEME:
When used this feature will echo a reliable received permissive signal back to the originating terminal when a lineend-open condition is identified by the line pickup logic. The permissive echo is programmed as a one-shot logic. The
echo is sent only once and then the echo logic locks out for a settable period. The duration of the echo pulse does not
depend on the duration or shape of the received Rx signals but is settable.
The echo is sent back only if none of the overreaching protection elements operates.
HYBRID PERMISSIVE OVER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP PERMISSIVE ECHO:
When used this feature will echo a reliable received permissive signal back to the originating terminal if the line-endopen condition is recognized by the line pickup scheme and the fault is not identified as a reverse fault by the zone 4 or
the ground directional overcurrent function (if used). The permissive echo is programmed as a one-shot logic. The
echo is sent only once and then the echo logic locks out for a settable period. The duration of the echo pulse does not
depend on the duration or shape of the received RX signal but is settable as ECHO DURATION.
The echo is sent back only if none of the overreaching protection elements operates.
PERMISSIVE ECHO OPERANDS AND TRANSMIT CODES:
In single-pole tripping, single-bit channel applications the signal received on bit no. 1 (Rx1) is echoed back on bit no. 1
(Tx1). In two- and four-bit applications the following echo tables apply.
Table 829: ECHO TABLE FOR 2-BIT CHANNELS
LOCAL DETERMINATION OF FAULT TYPE
ECHOED BITS
TX1
TX2
AG
BG
CG
ECHOED BITS
TX1
TX2
TX3
TX4
AG
BG
CG
NOTE
8-30
For the directional comparison unblocking scheme, the echo is performed in the same manner as the Hybrid POTT
echo, but by applying additionally the following logic for both the Rx (received) and LOG (loss-of-guard) for each
channel: ECHON= LOGN AND RXN.
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
For local fault type identification the pilot schemes use the Phase Selector. The latter may fail to respond to certain fault
scenarios. Examples are: simultaneous forward and reverse fault, simultaneous SLG and LL fault involving different phases
(e.g. AG and BC) or two simultaneous faults in the same direction but at very different locations. The Phase Selector is optimized to either indicate correctly the forward fault or to assert the Void flag. For example, a combination of AG and BC is
not a valid fault type - it is two different simultaneous faults and as such cannot be described by any single fault pattern,
therefore, the Phase Selector would assert the Void flag.
The VOID phase selection combined with a local trip request (such as high-set directional overcurrent) will result in threepole trip as per the Trip Output logic.
The Pilot Schemes, however, try to recover more information from the distance elements. Each scheme uses a forward
looking, either underreaching or overreaching, distance zone. A given Pilot Scheme analyzes this zone for fault type identification if the Phase Selector asserts its Void flag: the DUTT scheme uses Z1; all the other schemes use Z2. The schemes
analyze all six fault loops of the zone to determine the fault type.
For example, simultaneous forward AG and reverse BG faults may result in the Void indication. The POTT scheme would
analyze the Z2 response. As only the AG element is picked up, the local phase selection is determined as AG. This is a correct indication.
Depending on the number of bits used for communications, the accuracy of the overall response will be further improved as
illustrated in the next subsection.
This enhanced operation of the pilot-aided schemes is the reason to use a short pilot scheme priority time when setting the
Trip Output logic. The timer will force the scheme to wait for a decision from the pilot scheme for a short period of time
before accepting any local trip request. The advantage, however, materializes only if more than one-bit communications
channels are used, and is important only on parallel lines or when the application requires maximum accuracy of singlepole tripping. In other cases, it is not recommended to delay the local trip decision.
GE Multilin
8-31
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.5.6 CROSS-COUNTRY FAULT EXAMPLE
Assume a single pole operation application where D60 relays are used to protect a two terminal line, (terminals T1 and T2)
using phase and ground distance zone 1, 2 and 3 elements in a permissive over-reaching transfer trip scheme. The performance of the system with one- two and four-bit communications channels is outlined for a mid-line phase A-to-ground fault
and a co-incident phase B-to-ground fault just behind terminal T2. Assume also that the reclosers are enabled and reset.
At T1 the following protection elements will pickup:
At T1 the phase selector will determine the fault is type ABG. This response is independent from the distance elements
the Phase Selector sees two forward faults.
At T2 the following protection elements will pickup:
At T2 the phase selector will determine the fault is type AG. The reverse BG fault is likely to be ignored.
If a one-bit channel is used, terminal T1 will trip three poles but terminal T2 will trip phase A only, (see the Tables below)
which is undesirable.
TERMINAL
REMOTE DATA
BIT PATTERN RECEIVED
RX1
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
T1
Any
MULTI-P (ABG)
T2
Any
AG
Trip Phase A
If a two-bit channel is used both terminals will trip phase A only, (see the Tables below) which is the desired outcome.
TERMINAL
REMOTE DATA
BIT PATTERN RECEIVED
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
AG
ABG
Trip Phase A
ABG
AG
Trip Phase A
RX1
RX2
T1
T2
If a four-bit channel is used both terminals will trip phase A only, (see the Tables below) which is the desired outcome.
TERMINAL
REMOTE DATA
BIT PATTERN RECEIVED
8-32
LOCAL DATA
REMOTE DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
LOCAL DETERMINATION
OF FAULT TYPE
TRIP OUTPUT
RX1
RX2
RX3
RX4
T1
AG
ABG
Trip Phase A
T2
ABG
AG
Trip Phase A
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8.6FAULT LOCATOR
Fault type determination is required for calculation of fault location the algorithm uses the angle between the negative and
positive sequence components of the relay currents. To improve accuracy and speed of operation, the fault components of
the currents are used; that is, the pre-fault phasors are subtracted from the measured current phasors. In addition to the
angle relationships, certain extra checks are performed on magnitudes of the negative and zero-sequence currents.
The single-ended fault location method assumes that the fault components of the currents supplied from the local (A) and
remote (B) systems are in phase. The figure below shows an equivalent system for fault location.
distance to fault
Remote
bus
Local bus
ZA
EA
mZ
IA
(1-m)Z
RF
VF
VA
IB
ZB
VB
EB
842780A1.CDR
(EQ 8.5)
The currents from the local and remote systems can be parted between their fault (F) and pre-fault load (pre) components:
I A = I AF + I Apre
(EQ 8.6)
I B = I BF I Apre
(EQ 8.7)
Inserting the IA and IB equations into the VA equation and solving for the fault resistance yields:
VA m Z IA
R F = ----------------------------------I BF
I AF 1 + ------
I
(EQ 8.8)
AF
Assuming the fault components of the currents, IAF and IBF are in phase, and observing that the fault resistance, as impedance, does not have any imaginary part gives:
VA m Z IA
Im ----------------------------------- = 0
I AF
(EQ 8.9)
where: Im() represents the imaginary part of a complex number. Solving the above equation for the unknown m creates the
following fault location algorithm:
Im ( V A I AF )
m = --------------------------------------Im ( Z I A I AF )
(EQ 8.10)
VA = VA ,
GE Multilin
I A = I A + K 0 I 0A
(EQ 8.11)
8-33
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
For BG faults:
B
VA = VA ,
I A = I A + K 0 I 0A
(EQ 8.12)
For CG faults:
C
VA = VA ,
BC
I A = I A + K 0 I 0A
(EQ 8.13)
IA = IA IA
IA = IA IA
IA = IA IA
VA = VA VA ,
(EQ 8.14)
(EQ 8.15)
(EQ 8.16)
where K0 is the zero sequence compensation factor (for the first six equations above)
For ABC faults, all three AB, BC, and CA loops are analyzed and the final result is selected based upon consistency of the
results
The element calculates the distance to the fault (with m in miles or kilometers) and the phases involved in the fault.
The relay allows locating faults from delta-connected VTs. If the FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting is set to None,
and the VTs are connected in wye, the fault location is performed based on the actual phase to ground voltages. If the VTs
are connected in delta, fault location is suspended.
If the FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting value is V0 and the VTs are connected in a wye configuration, the fault
location is performed based on the actual phase to ground voltages. If the VTs are connected in a delta configuration, fault
location is performed based on the delta voltages and externally supplied neutral voltage:
1
V A = --- ( V N + V AB V CA )
3
1
V B = --- ( V N + V BC V AB )
3
1
V B = --- ( V N + V CA V BC )
3
(EQ 8.17)
If the FAULT REPORT 1 VT SUBSTITUTION setting value is I0 and the VTs are connected in a wye configuration, the fault location is performed based on the actual phase to ground voltages. If the VTs are connected in a delta configuration, fault location is performed based on the delta voltages and zero-sequence voltage approximated based on the zero-sequence
current:
1
V A = --- ( V AB V CA ) Z SYS0 I 0
3
1
V B = --- ( V BC V AB ) Z SYS0 I 0
3
1
V B = --- ( V CA V BC ) Z SYS0 I 0
3
(EQ 8.18)
where ZSYS0 is the equivalent zero-sequence impedance behind the relay as entered under the fault report setting menu.
8-34
GE Multilin
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
SETTINGS
FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
MAG:
FAULT REPORT 1 Z1
ANGLE:
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0
MAG:
FAULT REPORT 1 Z0
ANGLE:
FAULT REPORT 1
LENGTH UNITS:
FAULT REPORT 1
LENGTH:
FAULT REPORT 1 VT
SUBSTITUTION:
SETTING
FAULT REPORT
TRIG:
FAULT REP 1
SYSTEM Z0 MAG:
Off=0
FAULT REP 1
SYSTEM Z0 ANGLE:
SETTINGS
AND
FAULT REPORT
SOURCE:
SRC X 50DD OP
IA
IB
IC
3I_0
RUN
ACTUAL VALUES
FAULT REPORT #
3 SEC
DATE
TIME
FAULT
LOCATOR 1
FAULT TYPE
FAULT LOCATION
FAULT# RECLOSE SHOT
VA or VAB
VB or VBC
VC or VCA
Vn or V_0
SHOT # FROM
AUTO RECLOSURE
827094A5.CDR
GE Multilin
8-35
8 THEORY OF OPERATION
8-36
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
9.1.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter provides general application guidelines for stepped distance, overcurrent and pilot protection. Where relevant,
design details and performance characteristics of the D60 are given to facilitate the process of setting the relay for a given
application.
9.1.2 IMPACT OF MEMORY POLARIZATION
As explained in Chapter 8, the D60 uses a memorized positive sequence voltage as a polarizing signal in order to achieve
dependable operation for forward faults and secure non-operation for reverse faults.
The dynamic shift of the characteristic ensures improved directionality, but it also means that if a backup function is
required for a reverse fault on the bus, then it is appropriate to reverse Zone 4 so that a time delayed backup function may
be obtained. As mentioned earlier, it may be beneficial to also avoid extremely large reach settings by setting a remote
backup so that it is reverse looking. This strategy can be beneficial if the reduced reach enhances the discrimination
between the load and fault conditions.
9.1.3 HIGH-SET OVERCURRENT ELEMENTS
Especially at low SIR values, fast fault clearance times may be seen as extremely important, both from system stability, and
from equipment damage viewpoints. The high-set overcurrent element, when set appropriately, can be extremely useful in
achieving these goals. It helps the setting calculations if the system impedances are reasonably well known.
The overcurrent pick up should be set to the greater of the following values:
1.
The maximum infeed seen by the relay, for a close in reverse fault.
2.
The maximum fault level seen by the relay for a fault at 100% of the protected line.
The maximum error of the phase overcurrent elements is below 2%. A safety factor of 1.25 should be used to account for
relay errors and system impedance uncertainty.
If CT saturation is an issue such as close to a generation where long lasting dc components are likely to saturate the CTs, it
should be noted that the instantaneous overcurrent elements require 1.33 cycle of data to operate for a multiple of pickup of
1.01. For higher multiples of pickup, the relation between the multiple of pickup and the amount of data required for operation before complete CT saturation is approximately linear. For example, for a multiple of pickup of 4, approximately 1.33 /
4 = 0.332 of power cycle is required by the phase instantaneous overcurrent element to operate. The above information
should not be confused with the operating time, which includes some inherent delays such as a trip rated output contact.
GE Multilin
9-1
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
3 factor.
The zone 2 time delay is typically set from 0.2 to 0.6 seconds, although this may have to be reviewed more carefully if a
short line terminates on the remote bus, since the two zone 2 elements may overlap and therefore not coordinate in a satisfactory manner.
d) PHASE DISTANCE ZONE 3
If a remote backup philosophy is followed, then the reach of this element must be set to account for any infeed at the
remote bus, plus the impedance of the longest line which terminates on this remote bus. The time delay must coordinate
with other time-delayed protections on any remote line. Circuit loading limitations created by a long zone reach may be
overcome by using lens or quadrilateral characteristics and/or a load encroachment supervising characteristic. Consider-
9-2
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
ation should also be given to a situation where the load impedance may enter into the relay characteristic for a time longer
than the chosen time delay, which could occur transiently during a system power swing. For this reason the power swing
blocking function should be used.
e) PHASE DISTANCE ZONE 4
A further contribution to remote backup, the reach of this element must be set to account for any infeed at the remote bus.
The time delay must coordinate with other time-delayed protections on the next line. The use of a lens characteristic or the
load encroachment element may be advantageous if load limits are a problem.
To avoid extremely large reach settings, the D60 has the ability to implement any element so that it is reverse looking,
which then can provide a back up for the longest line terminated on the local bus. This strategy can be beneficial if the
reduced reach helps discrimination between the load and fault conditions, but must be implemented at both ends of the
protected line.
f) PHASE DISTANCE ZONE 5
An additional fifth phase distance zone can be used in special applications. This zone may be start zone for arming tripping
from all other zones, in both forward and reverse directions of the of protected line. This zone may also be used as an additional reverse-looking zone for implementation of two reverse-looking zones, thus providing two zone backup reverse-looking protection. The fifth distance zone can be used as an alarm zone, indicating that load impedance is approaching the
zone characteristic.
9.2.2 GROUND DISTANCE
a) NEUTRAL CURRENT SUPERVISION
The current supervision for the ground distance elements responds to an internally calculated neutral current (3 I_0). The
setting for this element should be based on twice the zero-sequence line capacitance current or the maximum zerosequence unbalance under maximum load conditions. This element should not be used to prevent an output when the load
impedance is inside the distance characteristic on a steady state basis.
b) POLARIZING CURRENT AND NON-HOMOGENEITY CORRECTION ANGLE OF THE QUAD CHARACTERISTIC
An ideal reactance line for single-line-to-ground faults is polarized from the fault current flowing through the fault resistance.
Such a line defines constant reach and could be implemented by the following angle comparator:
I Z V vs. j I F
(EQ 9.1)
The relay could only approximate the unknown fault current by the zero-sequence or the negative-sequence currents measured at the relaying point. Depending on system parameters, either the zero-sequence or the negative-sequence current
presents better approximation of the fault current angle.
Given the equivalent systems shown in the figure below, the angular difference between the zero-sequence or negativesequence currents at the relay, and the fault current can be calculated as follows:
where:
Z 0A + Z 0L + Z 0B
IF
0 = angle ---------------------- = angle -------------------------------------------
I 0_RELAY
Z 0B + ( 1 d )Z 0L
(EQ 9.2)
Z 1A + Z 1L + Z 1B
IF
2 = angle ---------------------- = angle -------------------------------------------
Z 1B + ( 1 d )Z 1L
I 2_RELAY
(EQ 9.3)
GE Multilin
9-3
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
IF
Z0A
dZ0L
(1 d)Z0L
Z0B
I0
I0
I2
Z1A
dZ1L
(1 d)Z1L
Z1B
IF
DEPENDING ON SYSTEM
PARAMETERS, I0 OR I2 MAYBE A
BETTER APPROXIMATION OF THE
FAULT CURRENT ANGLE
I2
IF
842742A1.CDR
The zone 1 reach must be set so that nominally instantaneous operation does not extend beyond the end of the protected
line. However this may be somewhat more complicated than for the phase elements, because of zero sequence mutual
induction with an adjacent parallel line, possibly carried on the same tower, which can be out of service and grounded at
multiple points. A fault beyond 100% of the protected line may cause overreach unless the reach is reduced significantly,
sometimes as low as 65% of the line length. If the line being protected does not have a significant interaction with an adjacent circuit, then the typical 80% setting may be used. If there is significant mutual coupling between the parallel lines, then
the mutual compensation feature of the ground distance elements can be used instead of a drastic reduction in the reach.
However, even in this case, there is more uncertainty as compared with the phase distance elements because the zerosequence impedance of the line and thus the zero-sequence-compensating factors may vary significantly due to weather
and other conditions.
9-4
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
GE Multilin
9-5
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
9.3.1 OVERVIEW
This scheme uses an under-reaching Zone 1 distance element to key a transfer trip signal to the remote end(s), where on
receipt, the DUTT pilot scheme operates without any additional supervision.
For proper operation of the scheme the Zone 1 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured and set
per rules of distance relaying.
The scheme generates an output operand (DUTT TX) that is used to transmit the signal to the remote end. Choices of communications channel include Remote Inputs/Outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operand should be assigned to operate an output contact connected to key the transmitter at the
interface.
Note that the same protection signaling may be used by a breaker failure scheme, in which case the signal can be sealed
in by breaker fail for a time longer than the auto-reclose reclaim time which then prevents auto-reclose when not required.
A provision for an optional seal-in of the send signal is made to cover those situations where PLC (Power Line Carrier) signaling is used and the signal must be transmitted in a potentially noisy situation due to the fault.
The scheme output operand (DUTT OP) must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output contacts in particular, in order to make the scheme fully operational. Typically, the output operand should be programmed to initiate a trip,
breaker fail, and auto-reclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
9.3.3 PERMISSIVE UNDER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP (PUTT)
This scheme uses an under-reaching Zone 1 distance element to key a transfer trip signal to the remote end where it is
supervised by the over-reaching Zone 2 distance elements.
For proper operation of the scheme the Zone 1 and 2 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured
and set per rules of distance relaying.
The scheme generates an output operand (PUTT TX) that is used to transmit the signal to the remote end. Choices of communications channel include Remote Inputs/Outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operand should be assigned to operate an output contact connected to key the transmitter at the
interface.
The PUTT RX PICKUP DELAY timer can be used to ride through spurious PLC receive signals.
The scheme output operand (PUTT OP) must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output contacts in particular, in order to make the scheme fully operational. Typically, the output operand should be programmed to initiate a trip,
breaker fail, and auto-reclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
9.3.4 PERMISSIVE OVER-REACHING TRANSFER TRIP (POTT)
This scheme is intended for two-terminal line applications only.
This scheme uses an over-reaching Zone 2 distance element to essentially compare the direction to a fault at both the ends
of the line.
9-6
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the Zone 2 distance element
to key the scheme and initiate its operation. This provides increased coverage for high-resistance faults.
Good directional integrity is the key requirement for an over-reaching forward-looking protection element used to supplement Zone 2. Even though any FlexLogic operand could be used for this purpose allowing the user to combine
responses of various protection elements, or to apply extra conditions through FlexLogic equations, this extra signal is
primarily meant to be the output operand from either the Negative-Sequence Directional IOC or Neutral Directional IOC.
Both of these elements have separate forward (FWD) and reverse (REV) output operands. The forward indication should
be used (NEG SEQ DIR OC1 FWD or NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD).
An important consideration is when one of the line terminals is open. It is then necessary to identify this condition and
arrange for a continuous sending of the permissive signal or use a slower but more secure echo feature to send a signal to
the other terminal, which is producing the fault infeed. With any echo scheme however, a means must be provided to avoid
a permanent lock up of the transmit/receive loop. The echo co-ordination (ECHO DURATION) and lock-out (ECHO LOCKOUT) timers perform this function by ensuring that the permissive signal is echoed once for a guaranteed duration of time
before going to a lockout for a settable period of time.
It should be recognized that in ring bus or breaker and a half situations, it may be the line disconnect or a combination of
the disconnect and/or the breaker(s) status that is the indication that the terminal is open.
The POTT RX PICKUP DELAY timer is included in the permissive receive path to ride through spurious receive outputs that
may be produced during external faults, when power line carrier is utilized as the communications medium.
No current reversal logic is included for the overreaching phase and ground distance elements, because long reaches are
not usually required for two terminal lines. A situation can occur however, where the ground distance element will have an
extended reach. This situation is encountered when it is desired to account for the zero sequence inter-circuit mutual coupling. This is not a problem for the ground distance elements in the D60 which do have a current reversal logic built into
their design as part of the technique used to improve ground fault directionality.
Unlike the distance protection elements the ground directional overcurrent functions do not have their reach well defined,
therefore the current reversal logic is incorporated for the extra signal supplementing Zone 2 in the scheme. The transient
blocking approach for this POTT scheme is to recognize that a permissive signal has been received and then allow a settable time TRANS BLOCK PICKUP DELAY for the local forward looking directional element to pick up.
The scheme generates an output operand (POTT TX) that is used to transmit the signal to the remote end. Choices of communications channel include Remote Inputs/Outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operand should be assigned to operate an output contact connected to key the transmitter at the
interface. Power Line Carrier (PLC) channels are not recommended for this scheme since the PLC signal can be interrupted by a fault.
For proper operation of the scheme the Zone 2 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured and set
per rules of distance relaying. The Line Pickup element should be enabled, configured and set properly to detect line-endopen/weak-infeed conditions.
If used by this scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be enabled, configured and set accordingly The output operand from the scheme (POTT OP) must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output
contacts in particular, in order to make the scheme fully operational. Typically, the output operand should be programmed to
initiate a trip, breaker fail, and auto-reclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
9.3.5 HYBRID POTT SCHEME (HYB-POTT)
Generally, this scheme uses an over-reaching Zone 2 distance element to essentially compare the direction to a fault at
both ends of the line. Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the
Zone 2 distance element to key the scheme and initiate its operation. This increases the coverage for high-resistance
faults.
The scheme is intended for three-terminal applications and for weak-infeed conditions. As a long reach of the overreaching
distance element may be required for three-terminal applications, transient blocking logic is provided for both distance and
ground directional overcurrent elements. In order to cope with weak-infeed conditions an echo feature is made available.
By default the scheme uses the reverse-looking Zone 4 distance element to identify reverse faults. Additionally, reverselooking ground directional overcurrent functions can be used in conjunction with Zone 4.
GE Multilin
9-7
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
For proper operation of the scheme the Zone 2 and 4 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured
and set per rules of distance relaying. The Line Pickup element should be enabled, configured and set properly to detect
line-end-open/weak-infeed and undervoltage conditions.
If used by this scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be enabled, configured, and set
accordingly.
The scheme generates an output operand (HYBRID POTT TX) that is used to transmit the signal to the remote end.
Choices of communications channel include Remote Inputs/Outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with
telecommunications facilities the output operand should be assigned to operate an output contact connected to key the
transmitter at the interface.
For more application recommendation refer to the POTT scheme.
The output operand from the scheme (HYBRID POTT OP) must be configured to interface with other relay functions, output
contacts in particular, in order to make the scheme fully operational. Typically, the output operand should be programmed to
initiate a trip, breaker fail, and auto-reclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
9.3.6 DIRECTIONAL COMPARISON BLOCKING
Generally, the scheme compares the direction to a fault at both ends of the line. Unlike the permissive schemes, the
absence of a blocking signal permits operation of the scheme. Consequently, the scheme is biased toward dependability
and requires an on/off type of signaling.
By default this scheme uses only a forward-looking over-reaching Zone 2 distance element to identify forward faults.
Ground directional overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the Zone 2 distance element
to increase the coverage for high-resistance faults.
By default the scheme uses only a reverse-looking Zone 4 distance element to identify reverse faults. Ground directional
overcurrent functions available in the relay can be used in conjunction with the Zone 4 distance element for better time and
sensitivity coordination.
For proper operation of the scheme the Zone 2 and 4 phase and ground distance elements must be enabled, configured
and set per rules of distance relaying.
If used by this scheme, the selected ground directional overcurrent function(s) must be enabled, configured and set accordingly.
The scheme generates output operands (BLOCKING SCHEME TX INIT and BLOCKING SCHEME TX STOP) that are
used control the transmission of signals to the remote end. Choices of communications channel include Remote Inputs/
Outputs and telecommunications interfaces. When used with telecommunications facilities the output operand should be
assigned to operate an output contact connected to key the transmitter at the interface.
A blocking scheme may be preferred over a Hybrid POTT scheme, because of shorter reach settings for the Zone 2 elements. This follows from the fundamental difference that all zone 2 elements are required to see an internal fault for the
POTT approach, under all system conditions, which in turn, means that the reversed Zone 4 block initiate elements must
also have an increased reach. A blocking scheme on the other hand, can have much shorter Zone 2 reach settings if
sequential clearance can be accepted. The simple rule to ensure that all faults can be cleared, is for each terminal to have
a reach setting equal to the distance to the tap plus twice the distance from the tap to the remote terminal.
The Zone 2 element must have a coordinating timer BLOCK RX CO-ORD PKP DELAY, to ensure that the blocking signal is
received for all external faults that are within the set reach of the local overreaching Zone 2.
Transient blocking logic is implemented via the TRANS BLOCK timer, which continues to send a blocking signal for a settable
time TRANS BLOCK RESET DELAY, if it was being sent for at least 30 ms during the initial reverse fault set via TRANS BLOCK
PICKUP DELAY.
The output operand from the scheme (BLOCKING SCHEME OP) must be configured to interface with other relay functions,
output contacts in particular, in order to make the scheme fully operational. Typically, the output operand should be programmed to initiate a trip, breaker fail, and auto-reclose, and drive a user-programmable LED as per user application.
9-8
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
a) OVERVIEW
The directional comparison unblocking scheme is used with a frequency shift keying (FSK) PLC that produces a loss-ofguard output during an actual loss-of-guard signal condition and during reception of the permissive keyed frequency when
the received carrier signal changed from guard to permissive frequency. The loss-of-guard signal should preferably be a
normally-closed contact, allowing the scheme to get this signal if the communications equipment failed. This loss-of-guard
output should be connected to a contact input of the D60. The power line carrier should also provide an output contact
when the permissive frequency is received. This output should be wired to any other contact input of the D60.
The directional comparison unblocking scheme allows a window of opportunity for tripping the breaker fast if the permissive
signal gets attenuated by the fault to a level below the receiver's threshold. The guard signal is monitored, and the relay is
allowed to trip for a loss of guard without receipt of the permissive signal, if the relay sees the fault in the forward, and not
reverse direction by means of the forward looking distance zone 2 and ground directional forward, if configured, and
reverse looking distance zone 4 and ground directional reverse, if configured.
The scheme is active and ready for operation when the DCUB BLOCK setting is Off the DCUB SCHEME FUNCTION setting is
Enabled. The user can disable or block the scheme by assigning any FlexLogic operand to the DCUB BLOCK setting.
This operand can consist of any pre-defined logic, including a pilot cutout switch connected to any contact input of the D60.
With this pilot cutout switch and the pre-defined logic state on and assigned to DCUB BLOCK, the scheme will be disabled.
The directional comparison unblocking scheme supervises the operation and keying of all scheme functions. The lockout
feature of the scheme also supervises all scheme functions. All timers are fully adjustable, with typical values indicated.
Lockout of the directional comparison unblocking scheme is established as follows. Lockout of the scheme is started for a
time duration set by DCUB LOG TRIP WINDOW setting if:
The scheme is enabled and not blocked (that is, the scheme is active), and
Lockout is sealed-in through an AND gate with the directional comparison unblocking scheme active and any loss-of-guard
through GUARD HEALTHY RESET DELAY timer. The scheme will thus remain blocked during longer loss-of-guard or channel
conditions for any of the configured channels. The GUARD HEALTHY RESET DELAY timer ensures that the scheme will remain
locked out slightly longer after the loss-of-guard signal(s) is reset. This allows for all channel(s) stabilizing and contact
denouncing. This timer determines how long the logic waits before enabling the directional comparison unblocking scheme
when the communications channel is restored.
Operating of the directional comparison unblocking scheme consists of two parts: normal operation and loss-of-guard operation.
b) NORMAL OPERATION
Normal operation picks up under the following conditions:
The scheme is enabled (DCUB FUNCTION is Enabled and DCUB BLOCK is Off), and
any permissive signal is received with its associated loss-of-guard signal (e.g. DCUB RX1 and DCUB LOG1), and
a fault is seen in the forward zone 2 distance elements or ground directional forward function (if configured), and
the reverse zone 4 distance elements or ground directional reverse function (if configured) did not pickup to set the
transient blocking, and
If these conditions are met, the trip table is run, operating the scheme and asserting DCUB OP FlexLogic operand. The
trip table with the aid of the local phase selector and received RX signals will determine what tripping operands will be operated. During normal operation, the loss-of-guard signal will be seen momentarily before the permissive DCUB RX signal is
received for each channel being operated, as the channel transitions from guard to permissive frequency, but the scheme
operates instantaneously after any DCUB RX signal is received.
GE Multilin
9-9
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
c) LOSS-OF-GUARD OPERATION
The loss-of-guard operation picks under the following conditions:
The scheme is enabled (DCUB FUNCTION is Enabled and DCUB BLOCK is Off), and
a fault is seen in the forward zone 2 distance elements or ground directional forward function (if configured), and
the reverse zone 4 distance elements or ground directional reverse function (if configured) did not pickup to set the
transient blocking.
If these conditions are met, then the DCUB LOG PICKUP DELAY timer is started. After this timer times out, the trip table is run,
operating the scheme and asserting the DCUB OP FlexLogic operand. The trip table with the aid of the local phase selector and loss-of-guard signals will determine what tripping operands will be operated. The DCUB LOG PICKUP DELAY timer
allows for any and all channel(s) to transition from guard to permissive before operating due to loss-of-guard in the presence of a forward fault. The time window of allowing the scheme to operate when no DCUB RX signal is received when any
loss-of-guard was received is the difference between the DCUB LOG TRIP WINDOW and DCUB LOG PICKUP DELAY timers.
When using default settings, this value is 150 8 = 142ms. This means the scheme is unblocked and can trip during this
time window if a forward fault is sensed.
d) KEYING OF THE CARRIER(S) UNDER NORMAL CONDITIONS
The keying signals, which allows the relay to key the permissive channel during normal permissive scheme operation by
means of the DCUB TX1 through DCUB TX4 signals, are established as follows:
The scheme is enabled (DCUB FUNCTION is Enabled and DCUB BLOCK is Off), and
a fault is seen in the forward zone 2 distance elements or ground directional forward function (if configured), and
the reverse zone 4 distance elements or ground directional reverse function (if configured) did not pickup to set the
transient blocking.
If these conditions are met, then the scheme will key the channel(s) by means of asserting transmit signals DCUB TX1
through DCUB TX4 with the aid of the local phase selector or zone 2 distance elements.
e) KEYING OF THE CARRIER DURING ECHO CONDITIONS
The echo signal, which allows the relay to key the permissive channel(s) through the DCUB TX1 through DCUB TX4 transmit
operands during echo conditions when the local breaker opened, will key the carrier(s) during the following conditions:
The scheme is enabled (DCUB FUNCTION is Enabled and DCUB BLOCK is Off), and
the LINE PICKUP LEO PKP operand that detects the local breaker to be open picks up for a time set by LINE END OPEN
PICKUP DELAY, and
any permissive signal DCUB RX1 through DCUB RX4 is received and any LOG1 to LOG4 is received, and
a fault is not seen in the forward zone 2 distance elements or ground directional forward function (if configured) for at
least 100 ms, and
the reverse zone 4 distance elements or ground directional reverse function (if configured) did not pickup to set the
transient blocking.
If these conditions are met, then the scheme will echo (transmit the DCUB TX1 through DCUB TX4 operands) the received
permissive DCUB RX signal(s) back to the remote relay based on the echo table.
The keying or transmit signals DCUB TX1 through DCUB TX4 consist of all normal keying or echo keying conditions.
The scheme DCUB TRIP A, DCUB TRIB B, DCUB TRIP C, and DCUB TRIP 3P output operands are hard-wired to the trip output
scheme. As such, if the trip output or breaker control operands (if the breaker control function is used) are used for tripping,
the scheme fully operational. The permissive key carrier signals DCUB TX1 through DCUB TX4 must still be assigned to the
tripping/operating logic, and to output contacts as per the usual D60 logic/output assignments.
9-10
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
9.4.1 INTRODUCTION
For reasons described in Chapter 8: Theory of Operation, it is recommended to apply a combination of distance, ground
directional overcurrent and high-set overcurrent functions for protection of series compensated lines.
The setting rules described below must take into account variety of system configurations, particularly a status of series
capacitors (in-service, by-passed). Either the worst-case topology shall be considered or - if possible - adaptive settings
shall be applied though the multiple settings groups mechanism.
A line compensating capacitor is a bank of three physical capacitors and their overvoltage protecting devices (air gaps and/
or MOVs). If none of the MOV/gaps conducts any significant current, the positive-, negative- and zero-sequence reactance
of the three-phase bank equal the reactance of the actual (phase) capacitors. Under asymmetrical conditions, however,
such as a single line to ground fault, when only one MOV/gap may operate, the series capacitor bank would create extra
(series) asymmetry in addition to the fault (shunt) asymmetry. The positive-, negative- and zero-sequence impedances will
differ from each other and will not equal the impedance of the phase capacitors. Moreover, there may be mutual coupling
between the sequence networks representing the series capacitor bank. This makes analytical analysis of fault conditions
very burdensome. For setting calculations, however, it is justified to assume the zero-, positive-, and negative-sequence
reactance of the capacitor bank equal the reactance of the actual (phase) capacitors. This represents a worst-case low-current fault scenario, when the steady-state effects of series compensation are most weighty.
9.4.2 DISTANCE
Traditionally, the reach setting of an underreaching distance function shall be set based on the net inductive impedance
between the potential source of the relay and the far-end busbar, or location for which the zone must not overreach. Faults
behind series capacitors on the protected and adjacent lines need to be considered for this purpose. For further illustration
a sample system shown in the figure below is considered.
SENDING
BUS
INFINITE
BUS
0.5 pu
-2
F2
RECEIVING
BUS
0.6 pu
-4
10
0.5 pu
-3
A B
B A
0.7 pu
-5
reactance
INFINITE
BUS
voltage
protection
level
F1
Protected Line
Practically, however, to cope with the effect of sub-synchronous oscillations, one may need to reduce the reach even more.
As the characteristics of sub-synchronous oscillations are in complex relations with fault and system parameters, no solid
setting recommendations are given with respect to extra security margin for sub-synchronous oscillations. It is strongly recommended to use a power system simulator to verify the reach settings or to use an adaptive D60 feature for dynamic
reach control.
If the adaptive reach control feature is used, the PHS DIST Z1 VOLT LEVEL setting shall be set accordingly.
GE Multilin
9-11
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
This setting is a sum of the overvoltage protection levels for all the series capacitors located between the relay potential
source and the far-end busbar, or location for which the zone must not overreach. The setting is entered in pu of the phase
VT nominal voltage (RMS, not peak value).
If a minimum fault current level (phase current) is causing a voltage drop across a given capacitor that prompts its air gap to
flash over or its MOV to carry practically all the current, then the series capacitor shall be excluded from the calculations
(the capacitor is immediately by-passed by its overvoltage protection system and does not cause any overreach problems).
If a minimum fault current does not guarantee an immediate capacitor by-pass, then the capacitor must be included in the
calculation: its overvoltage protection level, either air gap flash-over voltage or MOV knee-point voltage, shall be used
(RMS, not peak value).
Assuming none of the series capacitors in the sample system is guaranteed to get by-passed, the following calculations
apply:
For the Sending Bus:
Ground directional overcurrent function (negative-sequence or neutral) uses an offset impedance to guarantee correct fault
direction discrimination. The following setting rules apply.
1.
If the net impedance between the potential source and the local equivalent system is inductive, then there is no need
for an offset. Otherwise, the offset impedance shall be at least the net capacitive reactance.
2.
The offset cannot be higher than the net inductive reactance between the potential source and the remote equivalent
system. For simplicity and extra security, the far-end busbar may be used rather than the remote equivalent system.
As the ground directional functions are meant to provide maximum fault resistance coverage, it is justified to assume that
the fault current is very low and none of the series capacitors is guaranteed to get by-passed. Consider settings of the negative-sequence directional overcurrent protection element for the Sample Series Compensated System.
For the Sending Bus relay, bus-side VTs:
Net inductive reactance from the relay into the local system = 2 + 3 = 1 > 0; there is no need for offset.
Net inductive reactance from relay through far-end busbar = 4 + 10 3 = 3 ; the offset cannot be higher than 3 .
Net inductive reactance from relay into local system = 2 + 3 4 = 3 < 0; an offset impedance 3 must be used.
Net inductive reactance from relay through far-end busbar = 10 3 = 7 ; the offset cannot be higher than 7 .
Net inductive reactance from relay into local system = 5 + 7 = 2 > 0; there is no need for offset.
Net inductive reactance from relay through far-end busbar = 3 + 10 4 = 3 ; the offset cannot be higher than 3 .
Net inductive reactance from relay into local system = 3 5 + 7 = 1 < 0; an offset impedance 1 must be used.
Net inductive reactance from relay through far-end busbar = 10 4 = 6 ; the offset cannot be higher than 6 .
The setting rules for high-set overcurrent protection are explained in the High-Set Overcurrent Elements section.
9-12
GE Multilin
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
a) DESCRIPTION
Phase distance elements of the D60 could be set to respond to faults beyond any three-phase power transformer. The relay
guarantees accurate reach and targeting for any phase fault. Moreover, the current and voltage transformers may be
located independently on different sides of the transformer.
The following setting rules apply to this feature:
1.
A given distance zone is terminated by location of the VTs, not the CTs.
2.
Consequently, the positive-sequence impedance of a transformer must be included in the reach setting only if the
transformer is located between the potential source and the intended reach point.
3.
The current signals require compensation if the transformer is located between the CTs and the intended reach point.
If this is the case the CT connection setting shall be set to transformer connection and vector group as seen from the
CTs toward the reach point. Otherwise, the CT connection setting shall be set to "None".
4.
The voltage signals require compensation if the transformer is located between the VTs and the intended reach point.
If this is the case the VT connection setting shall be set to transformer connection and vector group as seen from the
VTs toward the reach point. Otherwise, the VT connection setting shall be set to "None".
5.
The reach setting is entered in secondary ohms and as such must take into account location and ratios of VTs and CTs
as well as voltage ratio of the involved power transformer.
The following equations explain the setting rules. Consider two applications as shown in the figure below:
(a)
(b)
ZH
Z4
ZX
ZT
ZH
Z1
ZX
ZT
Z4
Z1
GE Multilin
(EQ 9.4)
9-13
9 APPLICATION OF SETTINGS
(EQ 9.5)
(EQ 9.6)
(EQ 9.7)
9.5.2 EXAMPLE
Given the following for the system shown in the previous section:
ZX = 30 85 (intended reach of Zone 1)
ZH = 0.06 88 (intended reach of Zone 4)
nCT = 8000:5 = 1600 (located at H)
nVT = 315000:120 = 2625 (located at X)
Transformer: 13.8/315 kV, 150 MVA, 10%, delta/wye, 315 kV side lagging 30
Transformer impedance:
2
10 ( 13.8 )
Z T ( at H ) = ---------- ------------------- = 0.127 90
150
100
(EQ 9.8)
13.8 1600
Z 1 = 30 ----------- ------------- = 0.8011 85
315 2625
(EQ 9.9)
(EQ 9.10)
9-14
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
A
Table A1: FLEXANALOG DATA ITEMS (Sheet 1 of 10)
ADDRESS
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
6144
SRC 1 Ia RMS
Amps
6146
SRC 1 Ib RMS
Amps
6148
SRC 1 Ic RMS
Amps
6150
SRC 1 In RMS
Amps
6152
SRC 1 Ia Mag
Amps
6154
SRC 1 Ia Angle
Degrees
6155
SRC 1 Ib Mag
Amps
6157
SRC 1 Ib Angle
Degrees
6158
SRC 1 Ic Mag
Amps
6160
SRC 1 Ic Angle
Degrees
6161
SRC 1 In Mag
Amps
6163
SRC 1 In Angle
Degrees
6164
SRC 1 Ig RMS
Amps
6166
SRC 1 Ig Mag
Degrees
6168
SRC 1 Ig Angle
Amps
6169
Degrees
6171
Amps
6172
Degrees
6174
Amps
6175
Degrees
6177
Amps
6178
Degrees
6180
Amps
6208
SRC 2 Ia RMS
Amps
6210
SRC 2 Ib RMS
Amps
6212
SRC 2 Ic RMS
Amps
6214
SRC 2 In RMS
Amps
6216
SRC 2 Ia Mag
Amps
6218
SRC 2 Ia Angle
Degrees
6219
SRC 2 Ib Mag
Amps
6221
SRC 2 Ib Angle
Degrees
6222
SRC 2 Ic Mag
Amps
6224
SRC 2 Ic Angle
Degrees
6225
SRC 2 In Mag
Amps
6227
SRC 2 In Angle
Degrees
6228
SRC 2 Ig RMS
Amps
6230
SRC 2 Ig Mag
Degrees
6232
SRC 2 Ig Angle
Amps
6233
Degrees
6235
Amps
6236
Degrees
6238
Amps
6239
Degrees
6241
Amps
6242
Degrees
GE Multilin
A-1
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
6244
Amps
6272
SRC 3 Ia RMS
Amps
6274
SRC 3 Ib RMS
Amps
6276
SRC 3 Ic RMS
Amps
6278
SRC 3 In RMS
Amps
6280
SRC 3 Ia Mag
Amps
6282
SRC 3 Ia Angle
Degrees
6283
SRC 3 Ib Mag
Amps
6285
SRC 3 Ib Angle
Degrees
6286
SRC 3 Ic Mag
Amps
6288
SRC 3 Ic Angle
Degrees
6289
SRC 3 In Mag
Amps
6291
SRC 3 In Angle
Degrees
6292
SRC 3 Ig RMS
Amps
6294
SRC 3 Ig Mag
Degrees
6296
SRC 3 Ig Angle
Amps
6297
Degrees
6299
Amps
6300
Degrees
6302
Amps
6303
Degrees
6305
Amps
6306
Degrees
6308
Amps
6336
SRC 4 Ia RMS
Amps
6338
SRC 4 Ib RMS
Amps
6340
SRC 4 Ic RMS
Amps
6342
SRC 4 In RMS
Amps
6344
SRC 4 Ia Mag
Amps
6346
SRC 4 Ia Angle
Degrees
6347
SRC 4 Ib Mag
Amps
6349
SRC 4 Ib Angle
Degrees
6350
SRC 4 Ic Mag
Amps
6352
SRC 4 Ic Angle
Degrees
6353
SRC 4 In Mag
Amps
6355
SRC 4 In Angle
Degrees
6356
SRC 4 Ig RMS
Amps
6358
SRC 4 Ig Mag
Degrees
6360
SRC 4 Ig Angle
Amps
6361
Degrees
6363
Amps
6364
Degrees
6366
Amps
6367
Degrees
6369
Amps
6370
Degrees
6372
Amps
A-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
6656
Volts
6658
Volts
6660
Volts
6662
Volts
6664
Degrees
6665
Volts
6667
Degrees
6668
Volts
6670
Degrees
6671
Volts
6673
Volts
6675
Volts
6677
Volts
6679
Degrees
6680
Volts
6682
Degrees
6683
Volts
6685
Degrees
6686
SRC 1 Vx RMS
Volts
6688
SRC 1 Vx Mag
Volts
6690
SRC 1 Vx Angle
Degrees
6691
Volts
6693
Degrees
6694
Volts
6696
Degrees
6697
Volts
6699
Degrees
6720
Volts
6722
Volts
6724
Volts
6726
Volts
6728
Degrees
6729
Volts
6731
Degrees
6732
Volts
6734
Degrees
6735
Volts
6737
Volts
6739
Volts
6741
Volts
6743
Degrees
6744
Volts
6746
Degrees
6747
Volts
6749
Degrees
6750
SRC 2 Vx RMS
Volts
6752
SRC 2 Vx Mag
Volts
GE Multilin
A-3
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
6754
SRC 2 Vx Angle
Degrees
6755
Volts
6757
Degrees
6758
Volts
6760
Degrees
6761
Volts
6763
Degrees
6784
Volts
6786
Volts
6788
Volts
6790
Volts
6792
Degrees
6793
Volts
6795
Degrees
6796
Volts
6798
Degrees
6799
Volts
6801
Volts
6803
Volts
6805
Volts
6807
Degrees
6808
Volts
6810
Degrees
6811
Volts
6813
Degrees
6814
SRC 3 Vx RMS
Volts
6816
SRC 3 Vx Mag
Volts
6818
SRC 3 Vx Angle
Degrees
6819
Volts
6821
Degrees
6822
Volts
6824
Degrees
6825
Volts
6827
Degrees
6848
Volts
6850
Volts
6852
Volts
6854
Volts
6856
Degrees
6857
Volts
6859
Degrees
6860
Volts
6862
Degrees
6863
Volts
6865
Volts
6867
Volts
6869
Volts
A-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
6871
Degrees
6872
Volts
6874
Degrees
6875
Volts
6877
Degrees
6878
SRC 4 Vx RMS
Volts
6880
SRC 4 Vx Mag
Volts
6882
SRC 4 Vx Angle
Degrees
6883
Volts
6885
Degrees
6886
Volts
6888
Degrees
6889
Volts
6891
Degrees
7168
SRC 1 P
Watts
7170
SRC 1 Pa
Watts
7172
SRC 1 Pb
Watts
7174
SRC 1 Pc
Watts
7176
SRC 1 Q
Vars
7178
SRC 1 Qa
Vars
7180
SRC 1 Qb
Vars
7182
SRC 1 Qc
Vars
7184
SRC 1 S
VA
7186
SRC 1 Sa
VA
7188
SRC 1 Sb
VA
7190
SRC 1 Sc
VA
7192
SRC 1 PF
---
7193
SRC 1 Phase A PF
---
7194
SRC 1 Phase B PF
---
7195
SRC 1 Phase C PF
---
7200
SRC 2 P
Watts
7202
SRC 2 Pa
Watts
7204
SRC 2 Pb
Watts
7206
SRC 2 Pc
Watts
7208
SRC 2 Q
Vars
7210
SRC 2 Qa
Vars
7212
SRC 2 Qb
Vars
7214
SRC 2 Qc
Vars
7216
SRC 2 S
VA
7218
SRC 2 Sa
VA
7220
SRC 2 Sb
VA
7222
SRC 2 Sc
VA
7224
SRC 2 PF
---
7225
SRC 2 Phase A PF
---
7226
SRC 2 Phase B PF
---
7227
SRC 2 Phase C PF
---
7232
SRC 3 P
Watts
GE Multilin
A-5
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
7234
SRC 3 Pa
Watts
7236
SRC 3 Pb
Watts
7238
SRC 3 Pc
Watts
7240
SRC 3 Q
Vars
7242
SRC 3 Qa
Vars
7244
SRC 3 Qb
Vars
7246
SRC 3 Qc
Vars
7248
SRC 3 S
VA
7250
SRC 3 Sa
VA
7252
SRC 3 Sb
VA
7254
SRC 3 Sc
VA
7256
SRC 3 PF
---
7257
SRC 3 Phase A PF
---
7258
SRC 3 Phase B PF
---
7259
SRC 3 Phase C PF
---
7264
SRC 4 P
Watts
7266
SRC 4 Pa
Watts
7268
SRC 4 Pb
Watts
7270
SRC 4 Pc
Watts
7272
SRC 4 Q
Vars
7274
SRC 4 Qa
Vars
7276
SRC 4 Qb
Vars
7278
SRC 4 Qc
Vars
7280
SRC 4 S
VA
7282
SRC 4 Sa
VA
7284
SRC 4 Sb
VA
7286
SRC 4 Sc
VA
7288
SRC 4 PF
---
7289
SRC 4 Phase A PF
---
7290
SRC 4 Phase B PF
---
7291
SRC 4 Phase C PF
---
7552
SRC 1 Frequency
Hz
Source 1 frequency
7553
SRC 2 Frequency
Hz
Source 2 frequency
7554
SRC 3 Frequency
Hz
Source 3 frequency
7555
SRC 4 Frequency
Hz
Source 4 frequency
9024
Amps
9026
Degrees
9027
Amps
9029
Degrees
9030
Amps
9032
Degrees
9033
Volts
9035
Degrees
9036
Volts
9038
Degrees
9039
Volts
9041
Degrees
A-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
9042
Amps
9044
Degrees
9045
Amps
9047
Degrees
9048
Amps
9050
Degrees
9051
Volts
9053
Degrees
9054
Volts
9056
Degrees
9057
Volts
9059
Degrees
9060
---
Fault 1 type
9061
---
Fault 1 location
9216
Synchchk 1 Delta V
Volts
9218
Synchchk 1 Delta F
Hz
9219
Degrees
9220
Synchchk 2 Delta V
Volts
9222
Synchchk 2 Delta F
Hz
9223
Degrees
9536
PMU 1 Va Mag
Volts
9538
PMU 1 Va Angle
Degrees
9539
PMU 1 Vb Mag
Volts
9541
PMU 1 Vb Angle
Degrees
9542
PMU 1 Vc Mag
Volts
9544
PMU 1 Vc Angle
Degrees
9545
PMU 1 Vx Mag
Volts
9547
PMU 1 Vx Angle
Degrees
9548
PMU 1 V1 Mag
Volts
9550
PMU 1 V1 Angle
Degrees
9551
PMU 1 V2 Mag
Volts
9553
PMU 1 V2 Angle
Degrees
9554
PMU 1 V0 Mag
Volts
9556
PMU 1 V0 Angle
Degrees
9557
PMU 1 Ia Mag
Amps
9559
PMU 1 Ia Angle
Degrees
9560
PMU 1 Ib Mag
Amps
9562
PMU 1 Ib Angle
Degrees
9563
PMU 1 Ic Mag
Amps
9565
PMU 1 Ic Angle
Degrees
9566
PMU 1 Ig Mag
Amps
9568
PMU 1 Ig Angle
Degrees
9569
PMU 1 I1 Mag
Amps
9571
PMU 1 I1 Angle
Degrees
9572
PMU 1 I2 Mag
Amps
9574
PMU 1 I2 Angle
Degrees
9575
PMU 1 I0 Mag
Amps
GE Multilin
A-7
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
9577
PMU 1 I0 Angle
Degrees
9578
PMU 1 Freq
Hz
9580
PMU 1 df dt
Hz/s
9581
PMU 1 Conf Ch
---
13504
mA
13506
mA
13508
mA
13510
mA
13512
mA
13514
mA
13516
mA
13518
mA
13520
mA
13522
mA
13524
mA
13526
mA
13528
mA
13530
mA
13532
mA
13534
mA
13536
mA
13538
mA
13540
mA
13542
mA
13544
mA
13546
mA
13548
mA
13550
mA
13552
---
13553
---
13554
---
13555
---
13556
---
13557
---
13558
---
13559
---
13560
---
13561
---
13562
---
13563
---
13564
---
13565
---
13566
---
13567
---
13568
---
13569
---
13570
---
A-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
13571
---
13572
---
13573
---
13574
---
13575
---
13576
---
13577
---
13578
---
13579
---
13580
---
13581
---
13582
---
13583
---
13584
---
13585
---
13586
---
13587
---
13588
---
13589
---
13590
---
13591
---
13592
---
13593
---
13594
---
13595
---
13596
---
13597
---
13598
---
13599
---
24459
---
32768
Tracking Frequency
Hz
Tracking frequency
39425
FlexElement 1 Value
---
39427
FlexElement 2 Value
---
39429
FlexElement 3 Value
---
39431
FlexElement 4 Value
---
39433
FlexElement 5 Value
---
39435
FlexElement 6 Value
---
39437
FlexElement 7 Value
---
39439
FlexElement 8 Value
---
45584
GOOSE Analog In 1
---
45586
GOOSE Analog In 2
---
45588
GOOSE Analog In 3
---
45590
GOOSE Analog In 4
---
45592
GOOSE Analog In 5
---
45594
GOOSE Analog In 6
---
45596
GOOSE Analog In 7
---
45598
GOOSE Analog In 8
---
GE Multilin
A-9
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
45600
GOOSE Analog In 9
---
45602
GOOSE Analog In 10
---
45604
GOOSE Analog In 11
---
45606
GOOSE Analog In 12
---
45608
GOOSE Analog In 13
---
45610
GOOSE Analog In 14
---
45612
GOOSE Analog In 15
---
45614
GOOSE Analog In 16
---
61449
---
A-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
B.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The UR-series relays support a number of communications protocols to allow connection to equipment such as personal
computers, RTUs, SCADA masters, and programmable logic controllers. The Modicon Modbus RTU protocol is the most
basic protocol supported by the UR. Modbus is available via RS232 or RS485 serial links or via ethernet (using the Modbus/TCP specification). The following description is intended primarily for users who wish to develop their own master communication drivers and applies to the serial Modbus RTU protocol. Note that:
The UR always acts as a slave device, meaning that it never initiates communications; it only listens and responds to
requests issued by a master computer.
For Modbus, a subset of the Remote Terminal Unit (RTU) protocol format is supported that allows extensive monitoring, programming, and control functions using read and write register commands.
B.1.2 PHYSICAL LAYER
The Modbus RTU protocol is hardware-independent so that the physical layer can be any of a variety of standard hardware configurations including RS232 and RS485. The relay includes a faceplate (front panel) RS232 port and two rear terminal communications ports that may be configured as RS485, fiber optic, 10Base-T, or 10Base-F. Data flow is half-duplex
in all configurations. See chapter 3 for details on communications wiring.
Each data byte is transmitted in an asynchronous format consisting of 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, and possibly 1 parity
bit. This produces a 10 or 11 bit data frame. This can be important for transmission through modems at high bit rates (11 bit
data frames are not supported by many modems at baud rates greater than 300).
The baud rate and parity are independently programmable for each communications port. Baud rates of 300, 1200, 2400,
4800, 9600, 14400, 19200, 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, or 115200 bps are available. Even, odd, and no parity are available. Refer to the Communications section of chapter 5 for further details.
The master device in any system must know the address of the slave device with which it is to communicate. The relay will
not act on a request from a master if the address in the request does not match the relays slave address (unless the
address is the broadcast address see below).
A single setting selects the slave address used for all ports, with the exception that for the faceplate port, the relay will
accept any address when the Modbus RTU protocol is used.
B.1.3 DATA LINK LAYER
Communications takes place in packets which are groups of asynchronously framed byte data. The master transmits a
packet to the slave and the slave responds with a packet. The end of a packet is marked by dead-time on the communications line. The following describes general format for both transmit and receive packets. For exact details on packet formatting, refer to subsequent sections describing each function code.
Table B1: MODBUS PACKET FORMAT
DESCRIPTION
SIZE
SLAVE ADDRESS
1 byte
FUNCTION CODE
1 byte
DATA
N bytes
CRC
2 bytes
DEAD TIME
SLAVE ADDRESS: This is the address of the slave device that is intended to receive the packet sent by the master
and to perform the desired action. Each slave device on a communications bus must have a unique address to prevent
bus contention. All of the relays ports have the same address which is programmable from 1 to 254; see chapter 5 for
details. Only the addressed slave will respond to a packet that starts with its address. Note that the faceplate port is an
exception to this rule; it will act on a message containing any slave address.
A master transmit packet with slave address 0 indicates a broadcast command. All slaves on the communication link
take action based on the packet, but none respond to the master. Broadcast mode is only recognized when associated
with function code 05h. For any other function code, a packet with broadcast mode slave address 0 will be ignored.
GE Multilin
B-1
APPENDIX B
FUNCTION CODE: This is one of the supported functions codes of the unit which tells the slave what action to perform. See the Supported Function Codes section for complete details. An exception response from the slave is indicated by setting the high order bit of the function code in the response packet. See the Exception Responses section
for further details.
DATA: This will be a variable number of bytes depending on the function code. This may include actual values, settings, or addresses sent by the master to the slave or by the slave to the master.
CRC: This is a two byte error checking code. The RTU version of Modbus includes a 16-bit cyclic redundancy check
(CRC-16) with every packet which is an industry standard method used for error detection. If a Modbus slave device
receives a packet in which an error is indicated by the CRC, the slave device will not act upon or respond to the packet
thus preventing any erroneous operations. See the CRC-16 Algorithm section for details on calculating the CRC.
DEAD TIME: A packet is terminated when no data is received for a period of 3.5 byte transmission times (about 15 ms
at 2400 bps, 2 ms at 19200 bps, and 300 s at 115200 bps). Consequently, the transmitting device must not allow gaps
between bytes longer than this interval. Once the dead time has expired without a new byte transmission, all slaves
start listening for a new packet from the master except for the addressed slave.
B.1.4 CRC-16 ALGORITHM
The CRC-16 algorithm essentially treats the entire data stream (data bits only; start, stop and parity ignored) as one continuous binary number. This number is first shifted left 16 bits and then divided by a characteristic polynomial
(11000000000000101B). The 16 bit remainder of the division is appended to the end of the packet, MSByte first. The
resulting packet including CRC, when divided by the same polynomial at the receiver will give a zero remainder if no transmission errors have occurred. This algorithm requires the characteristic polynomial to be reverse bit ordered. The most significant bit of the characteristic polynomial is dropped, since it does not affect the value of the remainder.
A C programming language implementation of the CRC algorithm will be provided upon request.
Table B2: CRC-16 ALGORITHM
SYMBOLS:
ALGORITHM:
B-2
-->
data transfer
Alow
Ahigh
CRC
i,j
loop counters
(+)
Di
16 bit characteristic polynomial = 1010000000000001 (binary) with MSbit dropped and bit order reversed
shr (x)
right shift operator (th LSbit of x is shifted into a carry flag, a '0' is shifted into the MSbit of x, all other bits
are shifted right one location)
1.
2.
0 --> i
3.
0 --> j
4.
5.
j + 1 --> j
6.
shr (A)
7.
Is there a carry?
8.
Is j = 8?
9.
i + 1 --> i
10.
Is i = N?
11.
A --> CRC
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Modbus officially defines function codes from 1 to 127 though only a small subset is generally needed. The relay supports
some of these functions, as summarized in the following table. Subsequent sections describe each function code in detail.
FUNCTION CODE
MODBUS DEFINITION
GE MULTILIN DEFINITION
04
05
Execute operation
06
10
16
HEX
DEC
03
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
EXAMPLE (HEX)
11
FUNCTION CODE
04
FUNCTION CODE
04
06
40
BYTE COUNT
50
DATA #1 - high
00
00
DATA #1 - low
28
03
DATA #2 - high
01
2C
CRC - low
A7
DATA #2 - low
CRC - high
4A
DATA #3 - high
00
DATA #3 - low
00
CRC - low
0D
CRC - high
60
GE Multilin
B-3
APPENDIX B
B.2.3 EXECUTE OPERATION (FUNCTION CODE 05H)
This function code allows the master to perform various operations in the relay. Available operations are shown in the Summary of Operation Codes table below.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows a master device requesting the
slave device 11h (17 decimal) to perform a reset. The high and low code value bytes always have the values FF and 00
respectively and are a remnant of the original Modbus definition of this function code.
Table B4: MASTER AND SLAVE DEVICE PACKET TRANSMISSION EXAMPLE
MASTER TRANSMISSION
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
FUNCTION CODE
05
FUNCTION CODE
05
00
00
01
01
FF
FF
00
00
CRC - low
DF
CRC - low
DF
CRC - high
6A
CRC - high
6A
DEFINITION
DESCRIPTION
0000
NO OPERATION
0001
RESET
0005
Performs the same function as the faceplate CLEAR EVENT RECORDS menu
0006
CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY
1000 to 103F
VIRTUAL IN 1 to 64 ON/OFF
command.
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
FUNCTION CODE
06
FUNCTION CODE
06
40
40
51
51
DATA - high
00
DATA - high
00
DATA - low
C8
DATA - low
C8
CRC - low
CE
CRC - low
CE
CRC - high
DD
CRC - high
DD
B-4
EXAMPLE (HEX)
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
This function code allows the master to modify the contents of a one or more consecutive setting registers in a relay. Setting
registers are 16-bit (two byte) values transmitted high order byte first. The maximum number of setting registers that can be
stored in a single packet is 60. The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows
a master device storing the value 200 at memory map address 4051h, and the value 1 at memory map address 4052h to
slave device 11h (17 decimal).
Table B7: MASTER AND SLAVE DEVICE PACKET TRANSMISSION EXAMPLE
MASTER TRANSMISSION
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
EXMAPLE (HEX)
11
FUNCTION CODE
10
FUNCTION CODE
10
40
40
51
51
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - hi
00
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - hi
00
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - lo
02
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - lo
02
BYTE COUNT
04
CRC - lo
07
00
CRC - hi
64
C8
00
01
12
62
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
B9
FUNCTION CODE
39
FUNCTION CODE
CD
ERROR CODE
01
F2
93
95
GE Multilin
B-5
APPENDIX B
B.3FILE TRANSFERS
a) DESCRIPTION
The UR relay has a generic file transfer facility, meaning that you use the same method to obtain all of the different types of
files from the unit. The Modbus registers that implement file transfer are found in the "Modbus File Transfer (Read/Write)"
and "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" modules, starting at address 3100 in the Modbus Memory Map. To read a file from
the UR relay, use the following steps:
1.
Write the filename to the "Name of file to read" register using a write multiple registers command. If the name is shorter
than 80 characters, you may write only enough registers to include all the text of the filename. Filenames are not case
sensitive.
2.
Repeatedly read all the registers in "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" using a read multiple registers command. It is
not necessary to read the entire data block, since the UR relay will remember which was the last register you read. The
"position" register is initially zero and thereafter indicates how many bytes (2 times the number of registers) you have
read so far. The "size of..." register indicates the number of bytes of data remaining to read, to a maximum of 244.
3.
Keep reading until the "size of..." register is smaller than the number of bytes you are transferring. This condition indicates end of file. Discard any bytes you have read beyond the indicated block size.
4.
If you need to re-try a block, read only the "size of.." and "block of data", without reading the position. The file pointer is
only incremented when you read the position register, so the same data block will be returned as was read in the previous operation. On the next read, check to see if the position is where you expect it to be, and discard the previous
block if it is not (this condition would indicate that the UR relay did not process your original read request).
The UR relay retains connection-specific file transfer information, so files may be read simultaneously on multiple Modbus
connections.
b) OTHER PROTOCOLS
All the files available via Modbus may also be retrieved using the standard file transfer mechanisms in other protocols (for
example, TFTP or MMS).
c) COMTRADE, OSCILLOGRAPHY, AND DATA LOGGER FILES
Oscillography and data logger files are formatted using the COMTRADE file format per IEEE PC37.111 Draft 7c (02 September 1997). The files may be obtained in either text or binary COMTRADE format.
d) READING OSCILLOGRAPHY FILES
Familiarity with the oscillography feature is required to understand the following description. Refer to the Oscillography section in Chapter 5 for additional details.
The Oscillography Number of Triggers register is incremented by one every time a new oscillography file is triggered (captured) and cleared to zero when oscillography data is cleared. When a new trigger occurs, the associated oscillography file
is assigned a file identifier number equal to the incremented value of this register; the newest file number is equal to the
Oscillography_Number_of_Triggers register. This register can be used to determine if any new data has been captured by
periodically reading it to see if the value has changed; if the number has increased then new data is available.
The Oscillography Number of Records register specifies the maximum number of files (and the number of cycles of data
per file) that can be stored in memory of the relay. The Oscillography Available Records register specifies the actual number of files that are stored and still available to be read out of the relay.
Writing Yes (i.e. the value 1) to the Oscillography Clear Data register clears oscillography data files, clears both the Oscillography Number of Triggers and Oscillography Available Records registers to zero, and sets the Oscillography Last
Cleared Date to the present date and time.
To read binary COMTRADE oscillography files, read the following filenames:
OSCnnnn.CFG and OSCnnn.DAT
Replace nnn with the desired oscillography trigger number. For ASCII format, use the following file names
OSCAnnnn.CFG and OSCAnnn.DAT
B-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
To read from a specific time to the end of the log: <space> startTime
Replace <startTime> and <endTime> with Julian dates (seconds since Jan. 1 1970) as numeric text.
GE Multilin
B-7
APPENDIX B
Command and setting passwords each have a 30-minute timer. Each timer starts when you enter the particular password,
and is re-started whenever you use it. For example, writing a setting re-starts the setting password timer and writing a
command register or forcing a coil re-starts the command password timer. The value read at memory location 4010 can be
used to confirm whether a command password is enabled or disabled (a value of 0 represents disabled). The value read at
memory location 4011 can be used to confirm whether a setting password is enabled or disabled.
Command or setting password security access is restricted to the particular port or particular TCP/IP connection on which
the entry was made. Passwords must be entered when accessing the relay through other ports or connections, and the
passwords must be re-entered after disconnecting and re-connecting on TCP/IP.
B-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
B.4MEMORY MAPPING
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
UR Product Type
0 to 65535
---
F001
0002
Product Version
0 to 655.35
---
0.01
F001
1
0
Serial Number
---
---
---
F203
0020
Manufacturing Date
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0022
Modification Number
0 to 65535
---
F001
0040
Order Code
---
---
---
F204
Order Code x
0090
---
---
---
F072
0093
---
---
---
F001
00A0
---
---
---
F203
(none)
00B0
---
---
---
F203
(none)
00C0
---
---
---
F203
(none)
0 to 4294967295
F143
0 to 65535
---
F501
0220
Display Message
---
---
---
F204
(none)
0248
0 to 47
---
F530
0 (None)
0 to 42
---
F190
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0401
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0402
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0403
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0404
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0405
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0406
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0407
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0408
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0409
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0410
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0411
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0412
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0413
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0414
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0415
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0416
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0417
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0418
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0419
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
GE Multilin
B-9
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
041C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0420
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0421
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0422
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0423
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0424
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0425
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0426
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0427
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0428
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0429
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0430
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0431
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0432
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0433
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0434
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0435
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0436
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0437
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0438
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0439
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
-2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
0802
-2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
0804
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0806
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
0808
0810
0818
0820
0828
0830
0838
---
F001
0 to 65535
---
F502
B-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
---
---
---
F200
(none)
0 to 65535
---
F001
Target Sequence
0 to 65535
---
F001
14C1
Number of Targets
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 65535
---
F001
---
---
---
F200
Target to Read
Target Message
0 to 65535
---
F500
1508
0 to 65535
---
F500
1510
0 to 65535
---
F500
1518
0 to 65535
---
F500
1520
0 to 65535
---
F500
1528
0 to 65535
---
F500
1530
0 to 65535
---
F500
0 to 65535
---
F500
1542
0 to 65535
---
F500
1550
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 65535
---
F500
15C8
0 to 65535
ms
F001
15C9
0 to 65535
ms
F001
15CA
0 to 65535
---
F001
15CB
0 to 65535
---
F001
15D0
0 to 65535
---
F500
15D1
Reserved
0 to 65535
---
F001
15D2
0 to 65535
---
F001
15D3
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 2
---
F134
0 (Fail)
1611
0 to 2
---
F134
0 (Fail)
0 to 16
channel
F001
1619
0 to 4294967295
seconds
F050
161B
0 to 4294967295
seconds
F050
161D
0 to 999.9
days
0.1
F001
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1802
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1804
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1806
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1808
180A
180B
180D
180E
1810
1811
1813
GE Multilin
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
B-11
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
1814
REGISTER NAME
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1816
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1818
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
1819
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
181B
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
181C
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
181E
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
---
---
---
F001
181F
1821
1822
1824
1825
1840
1880
18C0
1900
1940
F060
1A02
F060
1A04
1A06
1A08
1A09
F060
0 to 999999.999
V
V
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1A0B
1A0C
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1A0E
1A0F
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1A11
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1A13
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1A15
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
1A17
1A18
1A1A
1A1B
1A1D
1A1E
1A20
1A22
1A23
1A25
1A26
1A29
1A2B
1A2C
1A40
1A80
1B00
1B40
degrees
0.1
F002
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
F060
1A28
1AC0
-359.9 to 0
0 to 999999.999
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
---
---
---
F001
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
0.001
F060
B-12
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
1C02
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
0.001
F060
1C04
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
0.001
F060
1C06
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
0.001
F060
1C08
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
var
0.001
F060
1C0A
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
var
0.001
F060
1C0C
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
var
0.001
F060
1C0E
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
var
0.001
F060
1C10
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
VA
0.001
F060
1C12
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
VA
0.001
F060
1C14
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
VA
0.001
F060
1C16
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
VA
0.001
F060
1C18
-0.999 to 1
---
0.001
F013
1C19
-0.999 to 1
---
0.001
F013
1C1A
-0.999 to 1
---
0.001
F013
1C1B
-0.999 to 1
---
0.001
F013
---
---
---
F001
1C1C
Reserved (4 items)
1C20
1C40
1C60
1C80
1CA0
0 to 1000000000000
Wh
0.001
F060
1D02
0 to 1000000000000
Wh
0.001
F060
1D04
0 to 1000000000000
varh
0.001
F060
1D06
0 to 1000000000000
varh
0.001
F060
1D08
Reserved (8 items)
---
---
---
F001
1D10
1D20
1D30
1D40
1D50
---
F126
0 (No)
---
Hz
---
F003
1D82
---
Hz
---
F003
1D84
---
Hz
---
F003
1D86
---
Hz
---
F003
1D88
---
Hz
---
F003
1D8A
---
Hz
---
F003
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
21A7
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
21A8
0 to 6
---
F211
0 (None)
21A9
0 to 65535
---
F300
21AA
0 to 65535
---
F300
GE Multilin
B-13
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
21AB
21AC
21AD
21AF
21B0
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
0 to 65535
---
F300
DEFAULT
0
0 to 1.5
pu
0.001
F001
850
1000
0 to 100000
F060
0 to 1.5
pu
0.001
F001
600
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
100
21B1
0 to 65535
---
F300
21B2
0 to 65535
---
F300
21B3
0 to 65535
---
F300
21B4
0 to 65535
---
F300
21B5
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
21B6
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-Reset)
21B7
Reserved (4 items)
---
---
---
F001
21BB
0 to 99999999
kA2-cyc
F060
0 to 99999999
kA2-cyc
F060
21E2
0 to 99999999
kA2-cyc
F060
21E4
0 to 99999999
kA2-cyc
F060
21E6
0 to 65535
ms
F001
21E7
0 to 65535
ms
F001
21E8
0 to 65535
ms
F001
21E9
0 to 65535
ms
F001
21EA
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
2225
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
2342
2343
2345
2346
2348
2349
234B
234C
234E
234F
2351
2352
2354
2355
2357
2358
235A
235B
235D
235E
2360
2361
2363
2364
Fault 1 Type
2365
B-14
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
0
0
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
0
0
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
degrees
0.1
F002
0 to 11
---
F148
0 (NA)
-3276.7 to 3276.7
---
0.1
F002
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
F060
238C
23B2
23D8
2402
0 to 655.35
Hz
0.01
F001
2403
0 to 179.9
degrees
0.1
F001
2404
Autoreclose 1 Count
0 to 65535
---
F001
2411
Autoreclose 2 Count
0 to 65535
---
F001
2412
Autoreclose 3 Count
0 to 65535
---
F001
2413
Autoreclose 4 Count
0 to 65535
---
F001
2414
Autoreclose 5 Count
0 to 65535
---
F001
2415
Autoreclose 6 Count
0 to 65535
---
F001
0
0
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
2542
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
2543
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
0
0
2545
2546
2548
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
2549
254B
254C
254E
254F
2551
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
2552
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
2554
2555
2557
2558
255A
255B
255D
255E
2560
2561
2563
2564
2566
2567
2569
256A
PMU 1 Frequency
256C
PMU 1 df/dt
256D
256E
Reserved (4 items)
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
0
0
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F060
-359.9 to 0
0.1
F002
2 to 90
Hz
0.001
F003
-327.67 to 327.67
Hz/s
0.01
F002
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
GE Multilin
B-15
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
2D80
0 to 1
---
F108
DEFAULT
0 (Off)
2E00
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
2F00
0 to 1
---
F155
0 (Offline)
2F80
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 65535
---
F001
3001
0 to 65535
---
F001
3002
0 to 400000000
---
F050
3004
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
3011
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3032
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3034
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3036
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3038
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
303A
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
303C
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
303E
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3040
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3042
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3044
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3046
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
3048
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
304A
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
304C
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
---
---
---
F204
(none)
0
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
3202
0 to 65535
---
F001
3203
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
3402
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
3404
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C2
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C4
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C6
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C8
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34CA
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34CC
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34CE
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D0
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D2
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
B-16
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
34D4
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
DEFAULT
0
34D6
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D8
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34DA
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34DC
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34DE
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E0
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E2
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E4
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E6
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E8
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34EA
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34EC
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34EE
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F1
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F2
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F3
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F4
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F5
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F6
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F7
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F8
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F9
-32768 to 32767
F002
0
0
34FA
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FB
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FC
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FD
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FE
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FF
-32768 to 32767
F002
3500
-32768 to 32767
F002
3501
-32768 to 32767
F002
3502
-32768 to 32767
F002
3503
-32768 to 32767
F002
3504
-32768 to 32767
F002
3505
-32768 to 32767
F002
3506
-32768 to 32767
F002
3507
-32768 to 32767
F002
3508
-32768 to 32767
F002
3509
-32768 to 32767
F002
350A
-32768 to 32767
F002
350B
-32768 to 32767
F002
350C
-32768 to 32767
F002
350D
-32768 to 32767
F002
350E
-32768 to 32767
F002
350F
-32768 to 32767
F002
3510
-32768 to 32767
F002
3511
-32768 to 32767
F002
3512
-32768 to 32767
F002
3513
-32768 to 32767
F002
3514
-32768 to 32767
F002
3515
-32768 to 32767
F002
3516
-32768 to 32767
F002
GE Multilin
B-17
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
3517
-32768 to 32767
F002
3518
-32768 to 32767
F002
3519
-32768 to 32767
F002
351A
-32768 to 32767
F002
351B
-32768 to 32767
F002
351C
-32768 to 32767
F002
351D
-32768 to 32767
F002
351E
-32768 to 32767
F002
351F
-32768 to 32767
F002
0 to 1
---
F155
0 (Offline)
3570
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
Passwords (Read/Write)
4008
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
400A
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4011
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
4049
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0
0 (English)
Language
0 to 3
---
F531
4050
0.5 to 10
0.1
F001
10
4051
10 to 900
F001
300
4052
0 to 3
---
F101
0 (25%)
4053
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4054
1 to 65535
min
F001
30
4055
0.002 to 0.02
pu
0.001
F001
20
4056
0.1 to 1
0.1
F001
10
0 to 1000
ms
10
F001
407F
0 to 1000
ms
10
F001
4080
1 to 254
---
F001
254
4083
0 to 11
---
F112
8 (115200)
4084
0 to 2
---
F113
0 (None)
4085
0 to 11
---
F112
8 (115200)
4086
0 to 2
---
F113
0 (None)
4087
IP Address
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
4089
IP Subnet Mask
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4294966272
408B
Gateway IP Address
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554497
408D
---
---
---
F074
409A
0 to 4
---
F177
0 (None)
0 (None)
409B
409C
DNP Address
409D
Reserved
409E
40A3
B-18
0 to 4
---
F177
0 to 65519
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
1 to 65535
---
F001
502
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
40A4
1 to 65535
---
F001
20000
40A5
1 to 65535
---
F001
80
40A6
1 to 65535
---
F001
69
40A7
0 to 65535
---
F001
40A9
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
40AA
0 to 60
F001
5
10
40AB
40AC
1 to 255
---
F001
0 to 65519
---
F001
40AD
0 to 1
---
F192
0 (Half-Duplex)
40AE
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40AF
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B0
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B1
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
2 (1)
40B2
0 to 8
---
F194
40B3
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B4
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
30000
40B6
0 to 65535
---
F001
40B8
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40BA
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40BE
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40C0
1 to 10080
min
F001
1440
40C1
30 to 2048
---
F001
240
40C2
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40C4
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40C6
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40C8
0 to 16
---
F001
40C9
0 to 16
---
F001
40CA
0 to 1
---
F001
40E0
1 to 65535
---
F001
2404
40E1
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
40E2
0 to 65535
---
F001
40E3
1 to 65535
F001
60
40E4
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40E6
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40E8
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40EA
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40EC
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
40EE
0 to 65535
---
F001
30000
0
40F0
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40FD
0 to 1
---
F001
4140
1 to 2
---
F001
4141
1 to 3
---
F001
4142
0 to 3
---
F523
0 (1)
4143
0 to 3
---
F524
0 (1)
4144
0 to 3
---
F523
0 (1)
0 (1)
4145
0 to 3
---
F523
4146
1 to 5
---
F001
4147
0 to 5
---
F525
0 (1)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
4169
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
416B
1 to 65535
---
F001
123
GE Multilin
B-19
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
---
---
---
F600
0 to 1
---
F260
0 (continuous)
4181
4191
4192
4193
0 to 65535
---
F300
15 to 3600000
ms
F003
60000
0 to 235959
---
F050
0
0
SR Date Format
0 to 4294967295
---
F051
41A4
SR Time Format
0 to 4294967295
---
F052
41A6
0 to 2
---
F114
0 (None)
41A7
0 (Disabled)
41A8
41A9
0 to 1
---
F102
24 to 24
hours
0.5
F002
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
41AA
0 to 11
---
F237
0 (January)
41AB
0 to 6
---
F238
0 (Sunday)
41AC
0 to 4
---
F239
0 (First)
41AD
0 to 23
---
F001
41AE
0 to 11
---
F237
0 (January)
41AF
0 to 6
---
F238
0 (Sunday)
41B0
0 to 4
---
F239
0 (First)
41B1
0 to 23
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
1 to 64
---
F001
15
41C1
0 to 1
---
F118
0 (Auto. Overwrite)
50
41C2
0 to 100
F001
41C3
0 to 65535
---
F300
41C4
0 to 4
---
F183
2 (16 samples/cycle)
41D0
0 to 65535
---
F600
4200
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 65535
---
F300
4261
0 to 65535
---
F300
4281
4282
4284
4286
4288
428A
428C
428E
4290
4292
4294
4296
4298
429A
429C
B-20
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F127
1 (Self-Reset)
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
429E
RANGE
42A0
42A2
42A4
42A6
42A8
42AA
42AC
42AE
42B0
42B2
42B4
42B6
42B8
42BA
42BC
42BE
42C0
42C2
42C4
42C6
42C8
42CA
42CC
42CE
42D0
42D2
42D4
42D6
42D8
42DA
42DC
42DE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
43E1
Relay Name
0 to 1
---
F133
0 (Not Programmed)
---
---
---
F202
Relay-1
1 (Enabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
4442
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4443
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4444
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4445
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4446
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4447
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4448
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
Phase CT 1 Primary
4481
Phase CT 1 Secondary
4482
Ground CT 1 Primary
4483
Ground CT 1 Secondary
4484
4488
448C
4490
GE Multilin
1 to 65000
F001
0 to 1
---
F123
0 (1 A)
1 to 65000
F001
0 to 1
---
F123
0 (1 A)
B-21
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
4500
Phase VT 1 Connection
0 to 1
---
F100
0 (Wye)
4501
Phase VT 1 Secondary
50 to 240
0.1
F001
664
4502
Phase VT 1 Ratio
1 to 24000
:1
F060
4504
Auxiliary VT 1 Connection
0 to 6
---
F166
1 (Vag)
4505
Auxiliary VT 1 Secondary
50 to 240
0.1
F001
664
4506
Auxiliary VT 1 Ratio
1 to 24000
:1
F060
4508
4510
Source 1 Name
---
---
---
F206
4583
Source 1 Phase CT
0 to 63
---
F400
4584
Source 1 Ground CT
0 to 63
---
F400
4585
Source 1 Phase VT
0 to 63
---
F400
4586
Source 1 Auxiliary VT
0 to 63
---
F400
4587
458E
4595
459C
45A3
Nominal Frequency
25 to 60
Hz
F001
60
4601
Phase Rotation
0 to 1
---
F106
0 (ABC)
4602
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
4603
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
0 (Disabled)
Breaker 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
4701
Breaker 1 Name
---
---
---
F206
Bkr 1"
4704
Breaker 1 Mode
0 to 1
---
F157
0 (3-Pole)
4705
Breaker 1 Open
0 to 65535
---
F300
4706
Breaker 1 Close
0 to 65535
---
F300
4707
0 to 65535
---
F300
4708
Breaker 1 Phase B
0 to 65535
---
F300
4709
Breaker 1 Phase C
0 to 65535
---
F300
470A
0 to 65535
---
F300
470B
0 to 1000000
0.001
F003
470D
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
470E
0 to 1000000
0.001
F003
4710
0 to 65535
---
F300
4711
Reserved (7 items)
0 to 65535
---
F300
4718
Synchrocheck 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4781
Synchrocheck 1 V1 Source
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
4782
Synchrocheck 1 V2 Source
0 to 5
---
F167
1 (SRC 2)
4783
0 to 400000
F060
10000
4785
0 to 100
degrees
F001
30
4786
0 to 2
Hz
0.01
F001
100
4787
0 to 5
---
F176
4788
0 to 1.25
pu
0.01
F001
30
4789
0 to 1.25
pu
0.01
F001
30
478A
0 to 1.25
pu
0.01
F001
70
478B
0 to 1.25
pu
0.01
F001
70
B-22
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
478C
Synchrocheck 1 Target
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
478D
478E
Synchrocheck 1 Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
Synchrocheck 1 Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
478F
0 to 0.1
Hz
0.01
F001
4790
0 to 65535
ms
F011
48F0
0 to 65535
ms
F011
0 to 65535
---
F001
---
---
---
F202
4C0A
---
---
---
F202
4C14
0 to 65535
---
F001
4C19
Reserved (7 items)
---
---
---
F001
4C20
4C40
4C60
4C80
4CA0
4CC0
4CE0
4D00
4D20
4D40
4D60
4D80
4DA0
4DC0
4DE0
0 to 2
---
F109
2 (Disabled)
4E01
---
---
---
F202
(none)
4E0B
---
---
---
F202
(none)
4E15
---
---
---
F202
(none)
4E1F
0 to 60
0.05
F001
4E20
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
4E21
4E22
4E23
4E24
4E25
4E26
4E27
4E28
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 600
0.05
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F220
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 65535
---
F300
4E29
0 to 65535
---
F300
4E2A
4E54
4E7E
4EA8
4ED2
4EFC
4F26
4F50
GE Multilin
B-23
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
4F7A
4FA4
4FCE
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 65535
---
F300
16384
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F205
RTD Ip 1
0 to 3
---
F174
5000
5401
RTD Input 1 ID
5407
5413
5426
5439
544C
545F
5472
5485
5498
54AB
54BE
54D1
54E4
54F7
550A
551D
5530
5543
5556
5569
557C
558F
55A2
55B5
55C8
55DB
55EE
5601
5614
5627
563A
564D
5660
5673
5686
5699
56AC
56BF
56D2
56E5
56F8
570B
571E
5731
5744
5757
B-24
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
576A
577D
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 (millisecond)
0 to 2
---
F129
5801
0 to 60000
---
F001
5802
0 to 60000
---
F001
5803
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
5808
5810
5818
5820
5828
5830
5838
5840
5848
5850
5858
5860
5868
5870
5878
5880
5888
5890
5898
58A0
58A8
58B0
58B8
58C0
58C8
58D0
0 (Disabled)
58D8
58E0
58E8
58F0
58F8
0 to 1
---
F102
5901
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
5902
0 to 1
---
F122
0 (Phasor)
5903
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
5904
0 to 16
---
F103
5905
0 to 600
---
0.01
F001
100
5906
0 to 1
---
F104
0 (Instantaneous)
5907
0 (Disabled)
5908
590B
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
590C
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
590D
Reserved (3 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
5910
5920
5930
GE Multilin
B-25
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
5940
5950
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
5A00
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5A01
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
5A02
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
5A03
0 to 600
0.01
F001
5A04
0 to 600
0.01
F001
5A05
0 to 65535
---
F300
5A08
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
5A09
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5A0A
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
5A10
5A20
5A30
5A40
5A50
5A60
5A70
5A80
0 (Disabled)
5A90
5AA0
5AB0
0 to 1
---
F102
5B01
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
5B02
0 to 1
---
F122
0 (Phasor)
5B03
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
5B04
0 to 16
---
F103
5B05
0 to 600
---
0.01
F001
100
5B06
0 to 1
---
F104
0 (Instantaneous)
5B07
0 to 65535
---
F300
5B08
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
5B09
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5B0A
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
5B10
5B20
5B30
5B40
5B50
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5C01
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
5C02
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
5C03
0 to 600
0.01
F001
5C04
0 to 600
0.01
F001
5C05
0 to 65535
---
F300
5C06
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
5C07
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5C08
Reserved (8 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
5C10
5C20
5C30
5C40
B-26
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
5C50
RANGE
5C60
5C70
5C80
5C90
5CA0
5CB0
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F102
5D01
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (Disabled)
0 (SRC 1)
5D02
0 to 1
---
F122
0 (Phasor)
5D03
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
5D04
0 to 16
---
F103
5D05
0 to 600
---
0.01
F001
100
5D06
0 to 1
---
F104
0 (Instantaneous)
5D07
0 to 65535
---
F300
5D08
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
5D09
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5D0A
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
5D10
5D20
5D30
5D40
5D50
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
5E01
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5E02
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
5E03
0 to 600
0.01
F001
5E04
0 to 600
0.01
F001
5E05
0 to 65535
---
F300
5E06
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
5E07
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5E08
Reserved (8 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
5E10
5E20
5E30
5E40
5E50
5E60
5E70
5E80
5E90
5EA0
5EB0
0 to 5
---
F001
5F81
0 to 65535
---
F300
5F82
0 to 65535
---
F300
5F89
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5F8A
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 5
---
F001
GE Multilin
B-27
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
5F8C
---
---
---
F203
(none)
5494
---
---
---
F203
(none)
5F9C
---
---
---
F203
(none)
5FA4
---
---
---
F203
(none)
5FAC
---
---
---
F203
(none)
5FB4
---
---
---
F203
(none)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
6051
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
6052
0 to 1
---
F234
0 (Calculated VN)
0.02 to 3.00
pu
0.01
F001
20
0 to 1
---
F235
(Calculated IN)
0.002 to 30.000
pu
0.001
F001
60
0 to 600
0.01
F001
20
0.001 to 1.2
pu
0.001
F001
100
6053
6054
6055
6056
6057
6058
0 to 360
Lag
F001
6059
0 to 600
0.01
F001
20
605A
605B
605C
605D
0 to 5
---
F236
0 (Definite Time)
0.01 to 2
0.01
F001
100
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
605E
605F
6060
Reserved
6061
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0.001 to 1.2
pu
0.001
F001
500
---
---
---
---
---
0.000 to 1000000.000
0.001
F060
6074
0.000 to 1000000.000
0.001
F060
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6301
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
6302
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
6303
0 to 16
---
F103
6304
0 to 600
---
0.01
F001
100
6305
0 to 1
---
F104
0 (Instantaneous)
6306
0 to 65535
---
F300
6307
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6308
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6309
Reserved (7 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
6310
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6401
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
6402
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
6403
0 to 600
0.01
F001
6404
0 to 600
0.01
F001
6405
0 to 65535
---
F300
6406
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6407
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6408
Reserved (8 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
6410
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
B-28
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
64A1
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
64A2
0 to 1.25
pu
0.001
F001
300
64A3
0 to 600
0.01
F001
50
64A4
0 to 600
0.01
F001
50
64A5
0 to 65535
---
F300
64A6
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
64A7
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
65C1
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
65C2
0 to 1
---
F513
0 (Two Step)
65C3
0.05 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
600
65C4
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
5000
65C5
40 to 90
degrees
F001
75
65C6
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
5000
65C7
40 to 90
degrees
F001
75
65C8
40 to 140
degrees
F001
120
90
65C9
40 to 140
degrees
F001
65CA
40 to 140
degrees
F001
60
65CB
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
30
65CC
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
50
65CD
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
17
65CE
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
65CF
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
17
65D0
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
400
65D1
0 to 1
---
F514
0 (Delayed)
65D2
0 to 65535
---
F300
65D3
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
65D4
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
65D5
0 to 1
---
F085
0 (Mho Shape)
65D6
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
6000
65D7
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
7000
65D8
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
6000
65D9
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
7000
65DA
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
10000
65DB
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
10000
65DC
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
10000
65DD
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
10000
65DE
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
10000
65DF
0.1 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
10000
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6701
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
6702
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
250
6703
0.02 to 250
ohms
0.01
F001
100
6704
5 to 50
degrees
F001
30
6705
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6706
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6707
0 to 65535
---
F300
6708
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6709
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
670A
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 2
---
F195
0 (Disabled)
Trip Mode
GE Multilin
B-29
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
6801
0 to 65535
---
F300
6802
0 to 65535
---
F300
6803
0 to 65535
---
F300
6804
0 to 65535
---
F300
6805
0 to 65535
---
F300
6806
0 to 65535
---
F300
6807
0 to 65535
---
F300
6808
0 to 65535
---
F300
6809
0 to 65535
---
F300
680A
0 to 65535
---
F300
680B
0 to 65535
---
F300
680C
0 to 65535
---
F300
680D
0 to 65535
---
F300
680E
0 to 65535
---
F300
680F
0 to 65535
---
F300
6810
0 to 65535
---
F300
6811
0 to 65535
---
F300
6812
0 to 65535
---
F300
6813
0 to 65535
---
F300
6814
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6815
0 to 65535
---
F300
6816
0 to 65535
---
F300
6817
0 to 65535
---
F300
6818
Trip Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6819
0 to 65535
---
F300
681A
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
681B
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
6821
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 65535
---
F300
6822
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6823
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
50
6824
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6825
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6826
300 to 9999.9
ohms
0.1
F003
99999
6828
300 to 9999.9
ohms
0.1
F003
99999
682A
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
50
682B
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
DUTT Function
6831
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6832
0 to 2
---
F198
0 (1)
6833
6834
DUTT RX1
0 to 65535
---
F300
DUTT RX2
0 to 65535
---
F300
6835
DUTT RX3
0 to 65535
---
F300
6836
DUTT RX4
0 to 65535
---
F300
6837
DUTT 1P Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6838
DUTT 1P Event
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6839
DUTT 1P Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
683A
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
6841
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6842
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
B-30
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 2
---
F198
0 (1)
PUTT 1P Rx1
0 to 65535
---
F300
PUTT 1P Rx2
0 to 65535
---
F300
6843
6844
6845
6846
PUTT 1P Rx3
0 to 65535
---
F300
6847
PUTT 1P Rx4
0 to 65535
---
F300
6848
PUTT 1P Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6849
PUTT 1P Event
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
684A
PUTT 1P Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
684B
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6851
0 to 2
---
F199
0 (Disabled)
6852
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6853
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
20
6854
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
90
6855
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
100
6856
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
250
6857
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
50
6858
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6859
0 to 65535
---
F300
685A
0 to 2
---
F198
0 (1)
685B
POTT 1P Rx1
0 to 65535
---
F300
685C
POTT 1P Rx2
0 to 65535
---
F300
685D
POTT 1P Rx3
0 to 65535
---
F300
685E
POTT 1P Rx4
0 to 65535
---
F300
685F
POTT 1P Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6860
POTT 1P Event
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6861
0 to 65535
---
F300
6862
POTT 1P Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
6863
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6869
0 to 2
---
F199
0 (Disabled)
686A
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
686B
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
20
686C
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
90
686D
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
100
686E
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
250
686F
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
6870
0 to 65535
---
F300
6871
0 to 65535
---
F300
6872
0 to 2
---
F198
0 (1)
6873
0 to 65535
---
F300
6874
0 to 65535
---
F300
6875
0 to 65535
---
F300
6876
0 to 65535
---
F300
6877
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
6878
0 (Disabled)
6879
687A
687B
0 to 65535
---
F300
687B
0 to 65535
---
F300
687C
Reserved (3 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
GE Multilin
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F199
1 (Enabled)
B-31
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 (Disabled)
6880
0 to 1
---
F102
6881
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
10
6882
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
30
6883
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
90
6884
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
6885
0 to 65535
---
F300
6886
0 to 65535
---
F300
6887
0 to 2
---
F198
0 (1)
6888
0 to 65535
---
F300
6889
0 to 65535
---
F300
688A
0 to 65535
---
F300
688B
0 to 65535
---
F300
688C
Blocking 1P Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
688D
Blocking 1P Event
0 (Disabled)
688D
688E
Reserved (2 items)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F001
Autoreclose Mode
0 to 3
---
F080
0 (1 & 3 Pole)
6891
1 to 4
---
F001
6892
0 to 65535
---
F300
6893
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
10
6894
0 to 65535
---
F300
6895
Autoreclose Function
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
6896
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
1000
6897
Autoreclose 1P Initiate
0 to 65535
---
F300
6898
Autoreclose 3P Initiate
0 to 65535
---
F300
6899
Autoreclose 3P TD Initiate
0 to 65535
---
F300
689A
0 to 65535
---
F300
689B
0 to 65535
---
F300
689C
0 to 65535
---
F300
689D
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
50
689E
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
120
689F
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A0
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
50
68A1
Autoreclose Reset
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A2
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
6000
68A3
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A4
Autoreclose Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A5
Autoreclose Pause
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A6
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
500
68A7
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A8
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
10
68A9
Autoreclose Transfer 1 to 2
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
68AA
Autoreclose Transfer 2 to 1
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
68AB
0 to 1
---
F081
0 (Continue)
68AC
0 to 1
---
F081
0 (Continue)
68AD
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
100
68AE
0 to 4
---
F082
3 (1 - 2)
68AF
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
400
68B0
Autoreclose Event
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
68B1
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
200
68B2
0 to 655.35
0.01
F001
400
68B3
0 to 65535
0.01
F300
B-32
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
68B3
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
---
---
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
6891
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 65535
---
F300
6892
0 to 2
---
F199
0 (Disabled)
6893
6894
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 65535
---
F300
6895
0 to 65535
---
F300
6896
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
20
6897
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
90
6898
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
100
6899
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
250
689A
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
50
689A
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
689B
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
15
150
689C
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
689D
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
10
689E
0 to 2
---
F198
0 (1 bit)
689F
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A0
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A1
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A2
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A3
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A4
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A5
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A6
0 to 65535
---
F300
68A7
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-Reset)
68A8
0 to 1
--
F102
0 (Disabled)
68A9
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 1
--
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7001
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7002
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
1000
7003
0 to 1
---
F111
0 (Definite Time)
7004
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7005
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
100
7006
0 to 65535
---
F300
7007
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7008
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7009
0 to 1
---
F186
0 (Phase to Ground)
700A
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
7013
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7041
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7042
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
1000
7043
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7044
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7045
0 to 65535
---
F300
7046
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7047
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7048
Reserved (8 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
GE Multilin
B-33
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
7061
Memory Duration
5 to 25
cycles
F001
10
7062
Force Self-Polarization
0 to 65535
---
F300
7062
0 to 65535
---
F300
0
0 (Disabled)
7070
0 to 1
---
F102
7071
0.05 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
200
7072
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
200
7073
7074
7075
7076
0 to 2
---
F154
0 (Forward)
30 to 90
degrees
F001
90
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
0 to 65535
---
F300
7077
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7078
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7079
0 to 1
---
F120
0 (Mho)
707A
30 to 90
degrees
F001
85
707B
30 to 90
degrees
F001
85
707C
707D
707E
707F
7080
7081
7082
7083
7084
7085
7086
7090
70B0
70D0
70F0
30 to 90
degrees
F001
90
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
1000
60 to 90
degrees
F001
85
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
1000
60 to 90
degrees
F001
85
0 to 5
pu
0.001
F001
0 to 12
---
F153
0 (None)
0 to 12
---
F153
0 (None)
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
200
30 to 90
degrees
F001
85
---
---
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7131
0.05 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
200
7132
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
200
7133
0 to 2
---
F154
0 (Forward)
7134
30 to 90
degrees
F001
90
7135
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
7136
0 to 65535
---
F300
7137
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7138
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7139
0 to 1
---
F120
0 (Mho)
713A
0 to 10
---
0.01
F001
270
713B
-90 to 90
degrees
F002
713C
30 to 90
degrees
F001
85
713D
30 to 90
degrees
F001
85
713E
30 to 90
degrees
F001
90
713F
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
1000
7140
7141
60 to 90
degrees
F001
85
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
1000
60 to 90
degrees
F001
85
0 to 7
---
0.01
F001
7142
7143
7144
-90 to 90
degrees
F002
7145
0 to 5
pu
0.001
F001
B-34
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
7146
-40 to 40
degrees
0.1
F002
7147
0 to 1
---
F521
0 (Zero-seq)
0.02 to 500
ohms
0.01
F001
200
30 to 90
degrees
F001
85
0 to 65535
---
F001
7148
7149
714A
Reserved (7 items)
7151
7172
7193
71B4
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
71F1
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
71F2
0 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1000
71F3
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
700
71F4
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
150
71F5
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
90
71F6
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
40
71F7
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
45
71F8
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
71F9
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
71FA
0 to 65535
---
F300
71FB
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
71FC
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
71FD
Terminal Open
0 to 65535
---
F300
71FE
Autoreclose Accelerate
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7261
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7262
0 to 65535
---
F300
7263
0 to 359
---
F001
30
7264
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
700
7265
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
7266
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7267
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7268
Reserved (8 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
7270
0 to 1
---
F102
7281
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7282
0 to 2
---
F230
0 (Voltage)
7283
-90 to 90
Lag
F002
75
7284
40 to 90
degrees
F001
90
7285
0.002 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
50
7286
40 to 90
degrees
F001
90
7287
0.002 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
50
7288
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7289
0 to 65535
---
F300
728A
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
728B
0 to 1
---
F231
0 (Calculated V0)
728C
0 to 1
---
F196
0 (Calculated 3I0)
728D
0 to 250
ohms
0.01
F001
728E
0 to 0.5
---
0.001
F001
63
0 to 1
---
F001
728F
Reserved
7290
GE Multilin
B-35
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 (Disabled)
72A0
0 to 1
---
F102
72A1
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
72A2
0 to 1
---
F179
0 (Neg Sequence)
72A3
0 to 90
Lag
F002
75
72A4
40 to 90
degrees
F001
90
72A5
0.05 to 30
pu
0.01
F001
72A6
40 to 90
degrees
F001
90
72A7
0.05 to 30
pu
0.01
F001
72A8
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
72A9
0 to 65535
---
F300
72AA
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
72AB
0 to 250
ohms
0.01
F001
72AC
0 to 0.5
---
0.001
F001
63
0 to 1
---
F001
72AD
Reserved (3 items)
72B0
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
72C1
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
72C2
0 to 65535
---
F300
72C3
0 to 65535
---
F300
72C4
0 to 65535
---
F300
72C5
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
0
1000
72C6
0 to 50000
kA2-cyc
F001
72C7
0 to 65535
---
F300
72C8
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
72C9
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
72CA
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F205
DCMA I 1"
72D4
72DE
7301
dcmA Inputs 1 ID
7307
Reserved 1 (4 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
730B
---
---
---
F206
mA
730E
0 to 6
---
F173
6 (4 to 20 mA)
730F
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
0.001
F004
4000
7311
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
0.001
F004
20000
7313
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
7318
7330
7348
7360
7378
7390
73A8
73C0
73D8
73F0
7408
7420
7438
7450
7468
B-36
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
7498
74B0
74C8
74E0
74F8
7510
7528
0 to 2
---
F109
2 (Disabled)
7B61
---
---
---
F202
(none)
7B6B
---
---
---
F202
(none)
7B75
---
---
---
F202
(none)
7B7F
0 to 60
0.05
F001
7B80
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7B81
7B82
7B83
7B84
7B85
7B86
7B87
7B88
7B89
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 600
0.05
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F220
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 65535
---
F300
7B8A
7BB4
7BDE
7C08
7C32
7C5C
7C86
7CB0
7CDA
7D04
7D2E
7D58
7D82
7DAC
7DD6
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7F01
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7F02
0 to 3.00
pu
0.001
F001
300
7F03
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7F04
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7F05
0 to 65535
---
F300
7F06
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7F07
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7F08
0 to 3
---
F116
0 (Definite Time)
7F09
Reserved (8 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
7F10
7F20
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
GE Multilin
B-37
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
7F31
REGISTER NAME
Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Signal Source
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7F32
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
300
7F33
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7F34
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7F35
0 to 65535
---
F300
7F36
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7F37
7F38
Reserved (8 items)
7F40
7F50
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
7F61
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
7F62
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
700
7F63
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
7F64
0 to 1
---
F111
0 (Definite Time)
7F65
0 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
100
7F66
0 to 65535
---
F300
7F67
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7F68
7F69
Reserved (7 items)
7F70
7F80
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F001
---
Hz
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
Tracking Frequency
0 to 1
---
F102
8601
0 to 1
---
F157
0 (3-Pole)
8602
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
8603
0 to 1
---
F126
1 (Yes)
8604
0 to 1
---
F126
1 (Yes)
8605
0 to 65535
---
F300
8606
0 to 65535
---
F300
8607
0.001 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1050
8608
0.001 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1050
8609
0 to 1
---
F126
1 (Yes)
860A
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
860B
0 to 1
---
F126
1 (Yes)
860C
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
860D
0 to 1
---
F126
1 (Yes)
860E
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
860F
0 to 65535
---
F300
8610
0 to 65535
---
F300
8611
0 to 65535
---
F300
8612
0.001 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1050
8613
0.001 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1050
8614
0.001 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1050
8615
0.001 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1050
8616
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
8617
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
8618
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
8619
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
861A
0 to 65535
---
F300
861B
0 to 65535
---
F300
B-38
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
861C
0 to 65535
---
F300
861D
0 to 65535
---
F300
861E
0 to 65535
---
F300
861F
0 to 65535
---
F300
8620
0 to 65535
---
F300
8621
8642
8663
---
---
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F203
Dig Element 1
8684
86A5
8A01
8A09
0 to 65535
---
F300
8A0A
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F003
8A0C
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F003
8A0E
0 to 65535
---
F300
8A0F
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
8A10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
8A11
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
8A12
Reserved (2 items)
---
---
---
F001
8A14
8A28
8A3C
8A50
8A64
8A78
8A8C
8AA0
8AB4
8AC8
8ADC
8AF0
8B04
8B18
8B2C
8B40
8B54
8B68
8B7C
8B90
8BA4
8BB8
8BCC
8BE0
8BF4
8C08
8C1C
8C30
8C44
8C58
8C6C
GE Multilin
B-39
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
8C80
8C94
8CA8
8CBC
8CD0
8CE4
8CF8
8D0C
8D20
8D34
8D48
8D5C
8D70
8D84
8D98
8DAC
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
F300
0
0
8E01
8E02
0 to 600
0.01
F001
8E03
0 to 600
0.01
F001
8E04
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E05
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E06
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E07
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E08
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E09
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E0A
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E0B
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E0C
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E0D
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E0E
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E0F
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E10
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E11
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E12
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E13
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E14
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
8E15
0 to 65535
---
F300
8E16
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
8E16
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
8E18
Reserved (8 items)
---
---
---
F001
8E20
8E40
8E60
8E80
8EA0
FlexElement 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
9001
FlexElement 1 Name
---
---
---
F206
FxE 1
9004
FlexElement 1 InputP
0 to 65535
---
F600
9005
FlexElement 1 InputM
0 to 65535
---
F600
9006
FlexElement 1 Compare
0 to 1
---
F516
0 (LEVEL)
9007
FlexElement 1 Input
0 to 1
---
F515
0 (SIGNED)
B-40
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F517
0 (OVER)
FlexElement 1 Hysteresis
0.1 to 50
0.1
F001
30
900A
FlexElement 1 Pickup
-90 to 90
pu
0.001
F004
1000
9008
FlexElement 1 Direction
9009
900C
0 to 2
---
F518
0 (Milliseconds)
900D
FlexElement 1 DeltaT
20 to 86400
---
F003
20
900F
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
9010
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
9011
FlexElement 1 Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
9012
FlexElement 1 Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
9013
FlexElement 1 Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
9014
9028
0 (SRC 1)
903C
9050
9064
9078
908C
90A0
90B4
90C8
90DC
90F0
9104
9118
912C
0 to 5
---
F167
9201
0 to 65535
---
F300
9202
0.01 to 250
ohms
0.01
F001
300
9203
9204
9205
9206
9207
9208
9208
9208
920B
9216
9221
922C
25 to 90
degrees
F001
75
0.01 to 650
ohms
0.01
F001
900
25 to 90
degrees
F001
75
0 to 1
---
F147
0 (km)
0 to 2000
0.1
F001
1000
---
F270
0 (None)
0.01 to 650.00
ohms
0.01
F001
900
25 to 90
degrees
F001
75
0 to 2
0 to 65535
---
F600
9301
0 to 2
---
F522
0 (1 to 1 mA)
9302
90 to 90
pu
0.001
F004
9304
90 to 90
pu
0.001
F004
1000
9306
930C
9312
9318
931E
9324
932A
9330
GE Multilin
B-41
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
9336
933C
9342
9348
934E
9354
935A
9360
9366
936C
9372
9378
937E
9384
938A
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 96
---
F205
Dir Ip 1
9406
1 to 96
---
F205
Dir Out 1
940C
9418
9424
9430
943C
9448
9454
9460
946C
9478
9484
9490
949C
94A8
94B4
94C0
94CC
94D8
94E4
94F0
94FC
9508
9514
9520
952C
9538
9544
9550
955C
9568
9574
FlexElement 1 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9A03
FlexElement 2 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9A05
FlexElement 3 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9A07
FlexElement 4 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
B-42
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
9A09
FlexElement 5 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9A0B
FlexElement 6 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9A0D
FlexElement 7 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9A0F
FlexElement 8 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
Teleprotection Function
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
9B01
2 to 3
---
F001
2
1
9B02
1 to 2
---
F001
9B03
0 to 255
---
F001
9B04
Teleprotection Terminal 1 ID
0 to 255
---
F001
0
0
9B05
Teleprotection Terminal 2 ID
0 to 255
---
F001
9B06
0 to 1
---
---
F001
9B10
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
9B30
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
9B50
0 to 65535
---
F300
9B70
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
1 (OK)
9B92
9B93
9B94
9B95
0 to 2
---
F134
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 2
---
F134
1 (OK)
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 2
---
F134
2 (n/a)
9BA0
0 to 1
---
F500
9BA1
0 to 1
---
F500
9BB0
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
9BC0
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A041
A042
A043
A044
A045
1 to 7
---
F001
A211
1 to 7
---
F001
1
0 (Disabled)
Selector 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
A281
Selector 1 Range
1 to 7
---
F001
A282
Selector 1 Timeout
3 to 60
0.1
F001
50
A283
Selector 1 Step Up
0 to 65535
---
F300
A284
0 to 1
---
F083
0 (Time-out)
A285
Selector 1 Acknowledge
0 to 65535
---
F300
A286
Selector 1 Bit0
0 to 65535
---
F300
A287
Selector 1 Bit1
0 to 65535
---
F300
A288
Selector 1 Bit2
0 to 65535
---
F300
A289
0 to 1
---
F083
0 (Time-out)
A28A
0 to 65535
---
F300
A28B
0 to 2
---
F084
0 (Restore)
A28C
Selector 1 Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
A28D
Selector 1 Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A28E
---
---
F001
GE Multilin
B-43
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
A298
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
A300
0 to 65535
---
F300
A400
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 65535
ms
F011
A680
0 to 65535
ms
F011
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A701
0 to 1
---
F519
0 (Reset Dominant)
0
A702
0 to 65535
---
F300
A703
0 to 65535
---
F300
A704
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
A705
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A706
Reserved (4 items)
---
---
---
F001
A70A
A714
A71E
A728
A732
A73C
A746
A750
A75A
A764
A76E
A778
A782
A78C
A796
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A801
---
---
---
F205
Counter 1"
A807
---
---
---
F206
(none)
A80A
0 to 65535
---
F300
A80B
Digital Counter 1 Up
0 to 65535
---
F300
A80C
0 to 65535
---
F300
A80D
2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
A80F
2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
0
0
A811
0 to 65535
---
F300
A812
0 to 65535
---
F300
A813
0 to 65535
---
F300
A814
0 to 65535
---
F300
A815
---
---
---
F001
A820
A840
A860
A880
A8A0
1000000 to 1000000
---
0.001
F060
1000
A8C0
A8E0
B-44
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
AA02
AA03
AA05
AA07
AA0E
AA15
AA1C
AA23
AA2A
AA31
AA38
AA3F
AA46
AA4D
AA54
AA5B
AA62
AA69
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F491
0 (Default Value)
---
---
---
F207
(none)
0 to 999999999.999
---
0.001
F060
1 to 60
F001
60
AA81
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
AA82
AAA3
---
---
---
F209
GSSEOut
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
AAA4
AAA7
---
---
---
F072
---
---
---
F209
GOOSEOut
0
AAC8
AACB
---
---
---
F072
0 to 7
---
F001
AACC
0 to 4095
---
F001
AACD
0 to 16383
---
F001
AACE
Reserved (2 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
1 to 65535
---
F001
102
---
---
---
F213
IECName
AAD1
AAE1
---
---
---
F213
LDInst
AAF1
---
---
---
F204
Location
AB19
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
AB1A
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
AB1B
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
AB1C
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
AB1D
---
F001
---
---
---
F600
AF11
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
100000
AF13
1000000000000 to
1000000000000
---
0.001
F060
AF15
1000000000000 to
1000000000000
---
0.001
F060
1000000
AF17
AF1E
AF25
AF2C
AF33
AF3A
GE Multilin
B-45
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
AF41
RANGE
AF48
AF4F
AF56
AF5D
AF64
AF6B
AF72
AF79
AF80
AF87
AF8E
AF95
AF9C
AFA3
AFAA
AFB1
AFB8
AFBF
AFC6
AFCD
AFD4
AFDB
AFE2
AFE9
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AB33
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AC0B
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AC53
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AC77
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AC8F
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
ACAD
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
ACF5
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
ACF8
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD0A
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD1C
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD28
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD37
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD3D
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD43
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
AD4F
0 to 65534
---
F206
(None)
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C6
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C8
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0CA
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0CC
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0CE
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D0
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B-46
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
B0D6
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D8
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0DA
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0DC
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0DE
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E0
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E6
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E8
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0EA
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0EC
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0EE
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F0
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F6
B12C
B162
B198
B1CE
0 to 2
---
F001
B241
0 to 2
---
F001
B242
0 to 2
---
F001
B243
0 to 2
---
F001
B244
0 to 2
---
F001
B245
0 to 2
---
F001
B246
0 to 2
---
F001
B247
0 to 2
---
F001
B248
0 to 2
---
F001
B249
0 to 2
---
F001
B24A
0 to 2
---
F001
B24B
0 to 2
---
F001
B24C
0 to 2
---
F001
B24D
0 to 2
---
F001
B24E
0 to 2
---
F001
B24F
0 to 2
---
F001
B250
0 to 2
---
F001
B251
0 to 2
---
F001
B252
0 to 2
---
F001
B253
0 to 2
---
F001
B254
0 to 2
---
F001
B255
0 to 2
---
F001
B256
0 to 2
---
F001
B257
0 to 2
---
F001
B258
0 to 2
---
F001
B259
0 to 2
---
F001
B25A
0 to 2
---
F001
B25B
0 to 2
---
F001
B25C
0 to 2
---
F001
B25D
0 to 2
---
F001
B25E
0 to 2
---
F001
B25F
0 to 2
---
F001
GE Multilin
B-47
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
B260
0 to 2
---
F001
B261
0 to 2
---
F001
B262
0 to 2
---
F001
B263
0 to 2
---
F001
B264
0 to 2
---
F001
B265
0 to 2
---
F001
B266
0 to 2
---
F001
B267
0 to 2
---
F001
B268
0 to 2
---
F001
B269
0 to 2
---
F001
B26A
0 to 2
---
F001
B26B
0 to 2
---
F001
B26C
0 to 2
---
F001
B26D
0 to 2
---
F001
B26E
0 to 2
---
F001
B26F
0 to 2
---
F001
B270
0 to 2
---
F001
B271
0 to 2
---
F001
B272
0 to 2
---
F001
B273
0 to 2
---
F001
B274
0 to 2
---
F001
B275
0 to 2
---
F001
B276
0 to 2
---
F001
B277
0 to 2
---
F001
B278
0 to 2
---
F001
B279
0 to 2
---
F001
B27A
0 to 2
---
F001
B27B
0 to 2
---
F001
B27C
0 to 2
---
F001
B27D
0 to 2
---
F001
B27E
0 to 2
---
F001
F209
---
---
---
B2A1
0 to 65535
---
F001
B2A2
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
B2A4
0 to 65535
---
F001
B2A5
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
B2A7
B2CE
8 to 128
---
F001
B2F5
B31C
B343
B36A
B391
B3B8
B3DF
B406
B42D
B454
B47B
B4A2
B4C9
B-48
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
B501
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
---
---
F300
B5A1
B5C2
B5C5
B5C6
B5C7
B5C8
B5CA
B60A
B674
B6DE
B748
B7B2
B81C
B886
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (None)
---
---
---
F209
GOOSEOut_x_
0
---
---
---
F072
0 to 7
---
F001
0 to 4095
---
F001
0 to 16383
---
F001
1 to 4294967295
---
F003
0 to 256
---
F232
0 (None)
---
F233
0 (None)
B940
B980
B9C0
BA00
BA40
BA80
BAC0
0 to 128
---
---
---
F205
Cont Ip 1
BB06
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
BB07
0 to 16
ms
0.5
F001
20
BB08
BB10
BB18
BB20
BB28
BB30
BB38
BB40
BB48
BB50
BB58
BB60
BB68
BB70
BB78
BB80
BB88
BB90
BB98
BBA0
BBA8
BBB0
BBB8
BBC0
GE Multilin
B-49
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
BBC8
BBD0
BBD8
BBE0
BBE8
BBF0
BBF8
BC00
BC08
BC10
BC18
BC20
BC28
BC30
BC38
BC40
BC48
BC50
BC58
BC60
BC68
BC70
BC78
BC80
BC88
BC90
BC98
BCA0
BCA8
BCB0
BCB8
BCC0
BCC8
BCD0
BCD8
BCE0
BCE8
BCF0
BCF8
BD00
BD08
BD10
BD18
BD20
BD28
BD30
BD38
BD40
BD48
BD50
BD58
BD60
BD68
BD70
B-50
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
BD78
BD80
BD88
BD90
BD98
BDA0
BDA8
BDB0
BDB8
BDC0
BDC8
BDD0
BDD8
BDE0
BDE8
BDF0
BDF8
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 3
---
F128
1 (33 Vdc)
0 to 1
---
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
F205
Virt Ip 1
F127
0 (Latched)
BE31
BE37
0 to 1
---
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F001
BE38
BE39
Reserved (3 items)
BE3C
BE48
BE54
BE60
BE6C
BE78
BE84
BE90
BE9C
BEA8
BEB4
BEC0
BECC
BED8
BEE4
BEF0
BEFC
BF08
BF14
BF20
BF2C
BF38
BF44
BF50
BF5C
BF68
BF74
BF80
BF8C
GE Multilin
B-51
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
BF98
BFA4
BFB0
BFBC
BFC8
BFD4
BFE0
BFEC
BFF8
C004
C010
C01C
C028
C034
C040
C04C
C058
C064
C070
C07C
C088
C094
C0A0
C0AC
C0B8
C0C4
C0D0
C0DC
C0E8
C0F4
C100
C10C
C118
C124
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
---
---
---
F205
Virt Op 1
C136
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C137
Reserved
---
---
---
F001
C138
C140
C148
C150
C158
C160
C168
C170
C178
C180
C188
C190
C198
C1A0
C1A8
C1B0
B-52
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
C1B8
C1C0
C1C8
C1D0
C1D8
C1E0
C1E8
C1F0
C1F8
C200
C208
C210
C218
C220
C228
C230
C238
C240
C248
C250
C258
C260
C268
C270
C278
C280
C288
C290
C298
C2A0
C2A8
C2B0
C2B8
C2C0
C2C8
C2D0
C2D8
C2E0
C2E8
C2F0
C2F8
C300
C308
C310
C318
C320
C328
C330
C338
C340
C348
C350
C358
C360
GE Multilin
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
B-53
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
C368
C370
C378
C380
C388
C390
C398
C3A0
C3A8
C3B0
C3B8
C3C0
C3C8
C3D0
C3D8
C3E0
C3E8
C3F0
C3F8
C400
C408
C410
C418
C420
C428
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C431
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C432
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
Synchrophasors active
---
---
---
F205
Cont Op 1"
C446
0 to 65535
---
F300
C447
0 to 65535
---
F300
C448
0 to 65535
---
F300
C449
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
C44A
0 to 1
---
F090
0 (Operate-dominant)
---
---
---
F001
C44B
Reserved
C44C
C458
C464
C470
C47C
C488
C494
C4A0
C4AC
C4B8
C4C4
C4D0
C4DC
B-54
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
C4E8
C4F4
C500
C50C
C518
C524
C530
C53C
C548
C554
C560
C56C
C578
C584
C590
C59C
C5A8
C5B4
C5C0
C5CC
C5D8
C5E4
C5F0
C5FC
C608
C614
C620
C62C
C638
C644
C650
C65C
C668
C674
C680
C68C
C698
C6A4
C6B0
C6BC
C6C8
C6D4
C6E0
C6EC
C6F8
C704
C710
C71C
C728
C734
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
GE Multilin
B-55
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
C761
C762
C764
C766
C768
C76A
C76C
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
C772
0 to 65535
---
F300
C773
0 to 65535
---
F300
C774
0 to 65535
---
F300
C775
0 to 65535
---
F300
C776
0 to 65535
---
F300
C777
0 to 65535
---
F300
C778
0 to 65535
---
F300
C77D
0 to 65535
---
F300
C77F
0 to 65535
---
F300
C781
0 to 65535
---
F300
C782
---
---
---
F001
0 to 2
---
F144
0 (Disabled)
C800
0 to 3
---
F131
0 (Disabled)
Direct Device ID
1 to 16
---
F001
C881
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C882
64 to 128
kbps
64
F001
64
C883
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C884
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 16
---
F001
C891
0 to 96
---
F001
C892
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
C893
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C894
C898
C89C
C8A0
C8A4
C8A8
C8AC
C8B0
C8B4
C8B8
C8BC
C8C0
C8C4
C8C8
C8CC
C8D0
C8D4
C8D8
B-56
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
C8DC
C8E0
C8E4
C8E8
C8EC
C8F0
C8F4
C8F8
C8FC
C900
C904
C908
C90C
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
CA11
CA12
CA14
CA16
CA18
CA1A
CA1C
CA1E
CA20
CA22
CA24
CA26
CA28
CA2A
CA2C
CA2E
CA30
CA32
CA34
CA36
CA38
CA3A
CA3C
CA3E
CA40
CA42
CA44
CA46
CA48
CA4A
CA4C
CA4E
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
CAD1
CAD2
CAD3
CAD4
Reserved (4 items)
CAD8
GE Multilin
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
100 to 10000
---
F001
600
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
B-57
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
CAD9
CADA
CADB
CADC
Reserved (4 items)
CAE0
CAE1
CAE2
CAE3
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
100 to 10000
---
F001
600
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
100 to 10000
---
F001
600
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
600
CAE4
Reserved (4 items)
CAE8
CAE9
100 to 10000
---
F001
CAEA
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
CAEB
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
CAEC
Reserved (4 items)
---
---
F001
10
Remote Device 1
CB21
CB22
CB23
CB46
CB69
CB8C
CBAF
CBD2
CBF5
CC18
CC3B
CC5E
CC81
CCA4
CCC7
CCEA
CD0D
---
---
---
F209
0 to 16383
---
F001
0 to 8
---
F184
0 (Fixed)
1 to 16
---
F001
CFA1
0 to 64
---
F156
0 (None)
CFA2
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
CFA3
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
CFA4
1 to 64
---
F205
Rem Ip 1
CFAA
CFB4
CFBE
CFC8
CFD2
CFDC
CFE6
CFF0
CFFA
D004
D00E
D018
D022
D02C
D036
B-58
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
D040
D04A
D054
D05E
D068
D072
D07C
D086
D090
D09A
D0A4
D0AE
D0B8
D0C2
D0CC
D0D6
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 65535
---
F300
D221
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
D222
Reserved (2 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
D224
D228
D22C
D230
D234
D238
D23C
D240
D244
D248
D24C
D250
D254
D258
D25C
D260
D264
D268
D26C
D270
D274
D278
D27C
D280
D284
D288
D28C
D290
D294
D298
D29C
D2A1
GE Multilin
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
B-59
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
D2A2
Reserved (2 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
D2A4
D2A8
D2AC
D2B0
D2B4
D2B8
D2BC
D2C0
D2C4
D2C8
D2CC
D2D0
D2D4
D2D8
D2DC
D2E0
D2E4
D2E8
D2EC
D2F0
D2F4
D2F8
D2FC
D300
D304
D308
D30C
D310
D314
D318
D31C
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
D382
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
D384
D388
D38C
D390
D394
D398
D39C
D3A0
D3A4
D3A8
D3AC
D3B0
D3B4
D3B8
D3BC
D3C0
D3C4
D3C8
D3CC
B-60
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
D3D0
D3D4
D3D8
D3DC
D3E0
D3E4
D3E8
D3EC
D3F0
D3F4
D3F8
D3FC
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 3
---
F545
0 (Network)
D401
0 to 3
---
F545
0 (Network)
D402
0 to 3
---
F545
0 (Network)
D403
0 to 14
---
F543
1 (Va)
D411
0 to 14
---
F543
1 (Va)
D41F
0 to 14
---
F543
1 (Va)
D42D
---
---
---
F203
GE-UR-PMU-PHS 1
D49D
---
---
---
F203
GE-UR-PMU-PHS 1
D50D
---
---
---
F203
GE-UR-PMU-PHS 1
D57D
0 to 65535
---
F600
D585
0 to 65535
---
F600
D58D
0 to 65535
---
F600
D595
---
---
---
F203
AnalogChannel 1
D5D5
---
---
---
F203
AnalogChannel 1
D615
---
---
---
F203
AnalogChannel 1
D655
0 to 65535
---
F300
D665
0 to 65535
---
F300
D675
0 to 65535
---
F300
D685
---
---
---
F203
Dig Channel 1
D705
---
---
---
F203
Dig Channel 1
D785
---
---
---
F203
Dig Channel 1
D705
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
D715
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
D725
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
E4D5
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 10
---
F544
3 (10/sec.)
---
---
F001
1 to 128
---
F001
---
F542
0 (Auto Overwrite)
10
E4DD
Reserved
E4DE
E4DF
0 to 1
E4E0
1 to 50
F001
E4E1
Reserved
---
---
F001
E4E2
0 to 14
---
F543
1 (Va)
GE-UR-PMU-PHS 1
E4F0
E560
E568
E5A8
E5B8
GE Multilin
---
---
---
F203
0 to 65535
---
F600
---
---
---
F203
AnalogChannel 1
0 to 65535
---
F300
---
---
---
F203
Dig Channel 1
B-61
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 (Disabled)
EA58
PMU 1 Function
EA59
PMU 1 IDcode
EA5A
PMU 1 STN
0 to 1
---
F102
1 to 65534
---
F001
---
---
---
F203
GE-UR-PMU
EA62
PMU 1 Source
0 to 5
---
F167
0 (SRC 1)
EA63
PMU 1 Post-Filter
0 to 3
---
F540
1 (Symm-3-point)
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA89
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA8A
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA8B
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA8C
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA8D
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA8E
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA8F
-5 to 5
0.05
F002
EA90
-180 to 180
30
F002
EA91
-180 to 180
30
F002
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
EAB5
0.1 to 30
pu
0.001
F001
1800
EAB6
0 to 600
0.01
F001
10
EAB7
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
EAB8
0 to 65535
---
F300
EABB
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
EABC
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
EAD9
0.1 to 15
Hz/s
0.01
F001
25
EADA
0.1 to 15
Hz/s
0.01
F001
25
EADB
0 to 600
0.01
F001
10
EADC
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
EADD
0 to 65535
---
F300
EAE0
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
EAE1
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
EB01
20 to 70
Hz
0.01
F001
4900
EB02
20 to 70
Hz
0.01
F001
6100
EB03
0 to 600
0.01
F001
10
EB04
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
EB05
0 to 65535
---
F300
EB08
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
EB09
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
EB29
0.25 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
1250
EB2A
0.25 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
1250
1250
EB2B
0.25 to 3
pu
0.001
F001
EB2C
0 to 600
0.01
F001
10
EB2D
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
EB2E
0 to 65535
---
F300
EB31
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
B-62
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
EB32
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
EB55
0.25 to 1.25
pu
0.001
F001
800
EB56
0.75 to 1.75
pu
0.001
F001
1200
EB57
0 to 600
0.01
F001
10
EB58
0 to 600
0.01
F001
100
EB59
0 to 65535
---
F300
EB5C
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
EB5D
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
EB7D
1 to 65534
---
F001
EB7E
0 to 10
---
F544
3 (10/sec.)
EB7F
0 to 1
---
F546
0 (Polar)
EB80
0 to 1
---
F547
0 (Integer)
EB81
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
EB83
0 to 59
---
F001
EB84
0 to 235959
---
F050
EB87
EB89
EB8A
EB8C
EB8D
EB8F
EB90
EB92
EB93
EB95
EB96
EB98
EB99
EB9B
EB9C
EB9E
EB9F
EBA1
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 700
kV
0.01
F003
50000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
0 to 700
kV
0.01
F003
50000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
-120
0 to 700
kV
0.01
F003
50000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
120
0 to 700
kV
0.01
F003
50000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
0 to 9.999
kA
0.001
F004
1000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
-10
0 to 9.999
kA
0.001
F004
1000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
-130
0 to 9.999
kA
0.001
F003
1000
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
110
0 to 9.999
kA
0.001
F004
-180 to 180
0.05
F002
20 to 70
Hz
0.001
F003
60000
-10 to 10
Hz/s
0.001
F002
F126
0 (No)
0 to 1
---
0 to 65535
---
F001
EBFB
0 to 6553.5
---
0.1
F001
EBFD
0 to 400000000
---
F050
0 to 65535
samples
F001
GE Multilin
B-63
APPENDIX B
B.4.2 DATA FORMATS
F001
UR_UINT16 UNSIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER
F040
UR_UINT48 48-BIT UNSIGNED INTEGER
F002
UR_SINT16 SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER
F050
UR_UINT32 TIME and DATE (UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER)
F003
UR_UINT32 UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
High order word is stored in the first register.
Low order word is stored in the second register.
F004
UR_SINT32 SIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
High order word is stored in the first register/
Low order word is stored in the second register.
F051
UR_UINT32 DATE in SR format (alternate format for F050)
First 16 bits are Month/Day (MM/DD/xxxx). Month: 1=January,
2=February,...,12=December; Day: 1 to 31 in steps of 1
Last 16 bits are Year (xx/xx/YYYY): 1970 to 2106 in steps of 1
F052
UR_UINT32 TIME in SR format (alternate format for F050)
First 16 bits are Hours/Minutes (HH:MM:xx.xxx).
Hours: 0=12am, 1=1am,...,12=12pm,...23=11pm;
Minutes: 0 to 59 in steps of 1
F005
UR_UINT8 UNSIGNED 8 BIT INTEGER
F006
UR_SINT8 SIGNED 8 BIT INTEGER
(xx:xx:.SS.SSS):
0=00.000s,
F060
FLOATING_POINT IEEE FLOATING POINT (32 bits)
F011
UR_UINT16 FLEXCURVE DATA (120 points)
A FlexCurve is an array of 120 consecutive data points (x, y) which
are interpolated to generate a smooth curve. The y-axis is the user
defined trip or operation time setting; the x-axis is the pickup ratio
and is pre-defined. Refer to format F119 for a listing of the pickup
ratios; the enumeration value for the pickup ratio indicates the offset into the FlexCurve base address where the corresponding time
value is stored.
F070
HEX2 2 BYTES - 4 ASCII DIGITS
F071
HEX4 4 BYTES - 8 ASCII DIGITS
F072
HEX6 6 BYTES - 12 ASCII DIGITS
F012
DISPLAY_SCALE DISPLAY SCALING
(unsigned 16-bit integer)
MSB indicates the SI units as a power of ten. LSB indicates the
number of decimal points to display.
Example: Current values are stored as 32 bit numbers with three
decimal places and base units in Amps. If the retrieved value is
12345.678 A and the display scale equals 0x0302 then the displayed value on the unit is 12.35 kA.
F013
POWER_FACTOR (SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER)
Positive values indicate lagging power factor; negative values
indicate leading.
B-64
F073
HEX8 8 BYTES - 16 ASCII DIGITS
F074
HEX20 20 BYTES - 40 ASCII DIGITS
F081
ENUMERATION: AUTORECLOSE 1P/3P BKR FAIL OPTION
0 = Continue, 1 = Lockout
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F082
ENUMERATION: AUTORECLOSE SINGLE-PHASE /
THREE-PHASE BREAKER SEQUENCE
0 = 1, 1 = 2, 2 = 1 & 2, 3 = 1 2, 4 = 2 1
F103
ENUMERATION: CURVE SHAPES
bitmask
curve shape
bitmask
curve shape
IAC Inverse
10
F083
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR MODES
11
I2t
IEC Curve A
12
Definite Time
0 = Time-Out, 1 = Acknowledge
IEC Curve B
13
FlexCurve A
IEC Curve C
14
FlexCurve B
15
FlexCurve C
16
FlexCurve D
F084
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR POWER UP
0 = Restore, 1 = Synchronize, 2 = Sync/Restore
F104
ENUMERATION: RESET TYPE
F085
ENUMERATION: POWER SWING SHAPE
F086
ENUMERATION: DIGITAL INPUT DEFAULT STATE
0 = Off, 1 = On, 2= Latest/Off, 3 = Latest/On
F108
ENUMERATION: OFF/ON
F100
ENUMERATION: VT CONNECTION TYPE
0 = Off, 1 = On
0 = Wye; 1 = Delta
F101
ENUMERATION: MESSAGE DISPLAY INTENSITY
0 = Disabled; 1 = Enabled
0 = ABC, 1 = ACB
0 = Operate-dominant, 1 = Reset-dominant
F102
ENUMERATION: DISABLED/ENABLED
F105
ENUMERATION: LOGIC INPUT
F106
ENUMERATION: PHASE ROTATION
F090
ENUMERATION: LATCHING OUTPUT TYPE
F109
ENUMERATION: CONTACT OUTPUT OPERATION
0 = Self-reset, 1 = Latched, 2 = Disabled
F110
ENUMERATION: CONTACT OUTPUT LED CONTROL
0 = Trip, 1 = Alarm, 2 = None
F111
ENUMERATION: UNDERVOLTAGE CURVE SHAPES
0 = Definite Time, 1 = Inverse Time
GE Multilin
B-65
APPENDIX B
F112
ENUMERATION: RS485 BAUD RATES
bitmask
value
F119
ENUMERATION: FLEXCURVE PICKUP RATIOS
bitmask
value
bitmask
mask
value
mask
value
mask
value
mask
value
300
9600
value
115200
0.00
30
0.88
60
2.90
90
5.90
1200
19200
14400
0.05
31
0.90
61
3.00
91
6.00
2400
38400
10
28800
0.10
32
0.91
62
3.10
92
6.50
4800
57600
11
33600
0.15
33
0.92
63
3.20
93
7.00
0.20
34
0.93
64
3.30
94
7.50
0.25
35
0.94
65
3.40
95
8.00
0.30
36
0.95
66
3.50
96
8.50
0.35
37
0.96
67
3.60
97
9.00
0.40
38
0.97
68
3.70
98
9.50
0.45
39
0.98
69
3.80
99
10.00
F113
ENUMERATION: PARITY
0 = None, 1 = Odd, 2 = Even
F114
ENUMERATION: IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE
10
0.48
40
1.03
70
3.90
100
10.50
11
0.50
41
1.05
71
4.00
101
11.00
12
0.52
42
1.10
72
4.10
102
11.50
13
0.54
43
1.20
73
4.20
103
12.00
14
0.56
44
1.30
74
4.30
104
12.50
F115
ENUMERATION: BREAKER STATUS
15
0.58
45
1.40
75
4.40
105
13.00
16
0.60
46
1.50
76
4.50
106
13.50
0 = Auxiliary A, 1 = Auxiliary B
17
0.62
47
1.60
77
4.60
107
14.00
18
0.64
48
1.70
78
4.70
108
14.50
19
0.66
49
1.80
79
4.80
109
15.00
20
0.68
50
1.90
80
4.90
110
15.50
21
0.70
51
2.00
81
5.00
111
16.00
22
0.72
52
2.10
82
5.10
112
16.50
23
0.74
53
2.20
83
5.20
113
17.00
24
0.76
54
2.30
84
5.30
114
17.50
F117
ENUMERATION: NUMBER OF OSCILLOGRAPHY RECORDS
25
0.78
55
2.40
85
5.40
115
18.00
26
0.80
56
2.50
86
5.50
116
18.50
27
0.82
57
2.60
87
5.60
117
19.00
28
0.84
58
2.70
88
5.70
118
19.50
29
0.86
59
2.80
89
5.80
119
20.00
F116
ENUMERATION: NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE CURVES
0 = Definite Time, 1 = FlexCurve A, 2 = FlexCurve B,
3 = FlexCurve C
F118
ENUMERATION: OSCILLOGRAPHY MODE
0 = Automatic Overwrite, 1 = Protected
F120
ENUMERATION: DISTANCE SHAPE
0 = Mho, 1 = Quad
F122
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT INPUT SIGNAL TYPE
0 = Phasor, 1 = RMS
F123
ENUMERATION: CT SECONDARY
0 = 1 A, 1 = 5 A
B-66
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F124
ENUMERATION: LIST OF ELEMENTS
element
228
229
element
232
233
234
235
242
24
272
Breaker 1
25
273
Breaker 2
32
280
Breaker Failure 1
33
281
Breaker Failure 2
282
Breaker Failure 3
283
Breaker Failure 4
288
289
290
291
292
293
80
294
Breaker 1 Flashover
81
295
Breaker 2 Flashover
311
312
Synchrocheck 1
313
Synchrocheck 2
112
336
Setting Group
113
337
Reset
360
Trip Output
121
362
Phase Selector
122
364
140
Auxiliary Undervoltage 1
365
144
Phase Undervoltage 1
366
Phase Undervoltage 2
368
148
Auxiliary Overvoltage 1
370
152
Phase Overvoltage 1
372
Neutral Overvoltage 1
374
160
376
161
388
Selector 1
389
Selector 2
390
Control pushbutton 1
391
Control pushbutton 2
Line Pickup
392
Control pushbutton 3
393
Control pushbutton 4
394
Control pushbutton 5
395
Control pushbutton 6
396
Control pushbutton 7
400
FlexElement 1
Load Enchroachment
401
FlexElement 2
402
FlexElement 3
403
FlexElement 4
404
FlexElement 5
405
FlexElement 6
406
FlexElement 7
407
FlexElement 8
bitmask
0
1
16
17
48
49
56
57
60
61
64
65
96
97
101
120
145
156
162
163
164
168
172
173
174
175
176
180
190
224
225
226
227
GE Multilin
B-67
element
APPENDIX B
bitmask
element
420
Non-volatile Latch 1
721
Digital Element 30
421
Non-volatile Latch 2
722
Digital Element 31
422
Non-volatile Latch 3
723
Digital Element 32
423
Non-volatile Latch 4
724
Digital Element 33
424
Non-volatile Latch 5
725
Digital Element 34
425
Non-volatile Latch 6
726
Digital Element 35
426
Non-volatile Latch 7
727
Digital Element 36
427
Non-volatile Latch 8
728
Digital Element 37
428
Non-volatile Latch 9
729
Digital Element 38
429
Non-volatile Latch 10
730
Digital Element 39
430
Non-volatile Latch 11
731
Digital Element 40
431
Non-volatile Latch 12
732
Digital Element 41
432
Non-volatile Latch 13
733
Digital Element 42
433
Non-volatile Latch 14
734
Digital Element 43
434
Non-volatile Latch 15
735
Digital Element 44
435
Non-volatile Latch 16
736
Digital Element 45
544
Digital Counter 1
737
Digital Element 46
545
Digital Counter 2
738
Digital Element 47
546
Digital Counter 3
739
Digital Element 48
547
Digital Counter 4
740
548
Digital Counter 5
746
549
Digital Counter 6
752
550
Digital Counter 7
758
551
Digital Counter 8
764
692
Digital Element 1
770
693
Digital Element 2
842
Trip Bus 1
694
Digital Element 3
843
Trip Bus 2
695
Digital Element 4
844
Trip Bus 3
696
Digital Element 5
845
Trip Bus 4
697
Digital Element 6
846
Trip Bus 5
698
Digital Element 7
847
Trip Bus 6
699
Digital Element 8
849
RTD Input 1
700
Digital Element 9
849
RTD Input 1
701
Digital Element 10
850
RTD Input 2
702
Digital Element 11
851
RTD Input 3
703
Digital Element 12
852
RTD Input 4
704
Digital Element 13
853
RTD Input 5
705
Digital Element 14
854
RTD Input 6
706
Digital Element 15
855
RTD Input 7
707
Digital Element 16
856
RTD Input 8
708
Digital Element 17
857
RTD Input 9
709
Digital Element 18
858
RTD Input 10
710
Digital Element 19
859
RTD Input 11
711
Digital Element 20
860
RTD Input 12
712
Digital Element 21
861
RTD Input 13
713
Digital Element 22
862
RTD Input 14
714
Digital Element 23
863
RTD Input 15
715
Digital Element 24
864
RTD Input 16
716
Digital Element 25
865
RTD Input 17
717
Digital Element 26
866
RTD Input 18
718
Digital Element 27
867
RTD Input 19
719
Digital Element 28
868
RTD Input 20
720
Digital Element 29
869
RTD Input 21
B-68
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
bitmask
element
F127
ENUMERATION: LATCHED OR SELF-RESETTING
870
RTD Input 22
871
RTD Input 23
872
RTD Input 24
873
RTD Input 25
874
RTD Input 26
875
RTD Input 27
876
RTD Input 28
877
RTD Input 29
878
RTD Input 30
879
RTD Input 31
880
RTD Input 32
881
RTD Input 33
882
RTD Input 34
883
RTD Input 35
884
RTD Input 36
885
RTD Input 37
886
RTD Input 38
887
RTD Input 39
888
RTD Input 40
889
RTD Input 41
F131
ENUMERATION: FORCED CONTACT OUTPUT STATE
890
RTD Input 42
891
RTD Input 43
892
RTD Input 44
893
RTD Input 45
894
RTD Input 46
895
RTD Input 47
0 = Latched, 1 = Self-Reset
F128
ENUMERATION: CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLD
F129
ENUMERATION: FLEXLOGIC TIMER TYPE
0 = millisecond, 1 = second, 2 = minute
F130
ENUMERATION: SIMULATION MODE
0 = Off. 1 = Pre-Fault, 2 = Fault, 3 = Post-Fault
F133
ENUMERATION: PROGRAM STATE
0 = Not Programmed, 1 = Programmed
896
RTD Input 48
900
User-Programmable Pushbutton 1
901
User-Programmable Pushbutton 2
F134
ENUMERATION: PASS/FAIL
902
User-Programmable Pushbutton 3
903
User-Programmable Pushbutton 4
904
User-Programmable Pushbutton 5
905
User-Programmable Pushbutton 6
906
User-Programmable Pushbutton 7
907
User-Programmable Pushbutton 8
908
User-Programmable Pushbutton 9
909
User-Programmable Pushbutton 10
910
User-Programmable Pushbutton 11
911
User-Programmable Pushbutton 12
912
User-Programmable Pushbutton 13
913
User-Programmable Pushbutton 14
914
User-Programmable Pushbutton 15
915
User-Programmable Pushbutton 16
F135
ENUMERATION: GAIN CALIBRATION
0 = 0x1, 1 = 1x16
F136
ENUMERATION: NUMBER OF OSCILLOGRAPHY RECORDS
0 = 31 x 8 cycles, 1 = 15 x 16 cycles, 2 = 7 x 32 cycles
3 = 3 x 64 cycles, 4 = 1 x 128 cycles
F137
ENUMERATION: USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTON
FUNCTION
F125
ENUMERATION: ACCESS LEVEL
F126
ENUMERATION: NO/YES CHOICE
F138
ENUMERATION: OSCILLOGRAPHY FILE TYPE
0 = Data File, 1 = Configuration File, 2 = Header File
0 = No, 1 = Yes
GE Multilin
B-69
APPENDIX B
F140
ENUMERATION: CURRENT, SENS CURRENT, VOLTAGE,
DISABLED
0 = Disabled, 1 = Current 46 A, 2 = Voltage 280 V,
3 = Current 4.6 A, 4 = Current 2 A, 5 = Notched 4.6 A,
6 = Notched 2 A
F141
ENUMERATION: SELF TEST ERRORS
bitmask
0
error
error
56
Maintenance Alert
F142
ENUMERATION: EVENT RECORDER ACCESS FILE TYPE
0 = All Record Data, 1 = Headers Only, 2 = Numeric Event Cause
F143
UR_UINT32: 32 BIT ERROR CODE (F141 specifies bit number)
A bit value of 0 = no error, 1 = error
Maintenance Alert
10
11
Equipment Mismatch
13
14
System Exception
15
Maintenance Alert
16
Maintenance Alert
17
Maintenance Alert
18
Maintenance Alert
19
Maintenance Alert
20
Maintenance Alert
21
Maintenance Alert
27
28
29
Maintenance Alert
30
31
32
DSP Error
33
No DSP Interrupts
34
35
36
37
Program Memory
38
Watchdog Error
39
Low On Memory
40
Prototype Firmware
41
Module Failure 01
42
Module Failure 02
43
Module Failure 03
44
Module Failure 04
45
Module Failure 05
46
Module Failure 06
47
Module Failure 07
48
Module Failure 08
49
Module Failure 09
50
Incompatible H/W
51
Maintenance Alert
52
Maintenance Alert
53
Maintenance Alert
54
Maintenance Alert
55
Maintenance Alert
B-70
bitmask
F144
ENUMERATION: FORCED CONTACT INPUT STATE
0 = Disabled, 1 = Open, 2 = Closed
F145
ENUMERATION: ALPHABET LETTER
bitmask type
bitmask type
bitmask type
bitmask type
null
14
21
15
22
U
V
16
23
10
17
24
11
18
25
12
19
26
13
20
F146
ENUMERATION: MISCELLANEOUS EVENT CAUSES
bitmask
0
definition
Events Cleared
Oscillography Triggered
Date/time Changed
Test Mode On
Power On
Power Off
Relay In Service
10
Watchdog Reset
11
Oscillography Clear
12
Reboot Command
13
14
Flash Programming
15
16
17
18
19
20
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
bitmask
definition
F153
ENUMERATION: DISTANCE TRANSFORMER CONNECTION
21
22
23
bitmask
type
bitmask
type
bitmask
24
None
Dy9
10
Yd7
25
Dy1
Dy11
11
Yd9
Dy3
Yd1
12
Yd11
Dy5
Yd3
Dy7
Yd5
F147
ENUMERATION: LINE LENGTH UNITS
type
0 = km, 1 = miles
F154
ENUMERATION: DISTANCE DIRECTION
F148
ENUMERATION: FAULT TYPE
bitmask
fault type
bitmask
fault type
NA
AC
AG
ABG
BG
BCG
CG
ACG
AB
10
ABC
BC
11
ABCG
F155
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DEVICE STATE
0 = Offline, 1 = Online
F156
ENUMERATION: REMOTE INPUT BIT PAIRS
F151
ENUMERATION: RTD SELECTION
bitmask
value
bitmask
value
NONE
35
UserSt-3
DNA-1
36
UserSt-4
bitmask
RTD#
bitmask
RTD#
bitmask
RTD#
DNA-2
37
UserSt-5
NONE
17
RTD 17
33
RTD 33
DNA-3
38
UserSt-6
RTD 1
18
RTD 18
34
RTD 34
DNA-4
39
UserSt-7
RTD 2
19
RTD 19
35
RTD 35
DNA-5
40
UserSt-8
RTD 3
20
RTD 20
36
RTD 36
DNA-6
41
UserSt-9
RTD 4
21
RTD 21
37
RTD 37
DNA-7
42
UserSt-10
RTD 5
22
RTD 22
38
RTD 38
DNA-8
43
UserSt-11
RTD 6
23
RTD 23
39
RTD 39
DNA-9
44
UserSt-12
RTD 7
24
RTD 24
40
RTD 40
10
DNA-10
45
UserSt-13
RTD 8
25
RTD 25
41
RTD 41
11
DNA-11
46
UserSt-14
RTD 9
26
RTD 26
42
RTD 42
12
DNA-12
47
UserSt-15
10
RTD 10
27
RTD 27
43
RTD 43
13
DNA-13
48
UserSt-16
11
RTD 11
28
RTD 28
44
RTD 44
14
DNA-14
49
UserSt-17
12
RTD 12
29
RTD 29
45
RTD 45
15
DNA-15
50
UserSt-18
13
RTD 13
30
RTD 30
46
RTD 46
16
DNA-16
51
UserSt-19
14
RTD 14
31
RTD 31
47
RTD 47
17
DNA-17
52
UserSt-20
15
RTD 15
32
RTD 32
48
RTD 48
18
DNA-18
53
UserSt-21
16
RTD 16
19
DNA-19
54
UserSt-22
20
DNA-20
55
UserSt-23
21
DNA-21
56
UserSt-24
22
DNA-22
57
UserSt-25
23
DNA-23
58
UserSt-26
24
DNA-24
59
UserSt-27
25
DNA-25
60
UserSt-28
26
DNA-26
61
UserSt-29
27
DNA-27
62
UserSt-30
28
DNA-28
63
UserSt-31
29
DNA-29
64
UserSt-32
30
DNA-30
65
Dataset Item 1
F152
ENUMERATION: SETTING GROUP
0 = Active Group, 1 = Group 1, 2 = Group 2, 3 = Group 3
4 = Group 4, 5 = Group 5, 6 = Group 6
GE Multilin
B-71
APPENDIX B
bitmask
value
bitmask
value
31
DNA-31
66
Dataset Item 2
32
DNA-32
67
Dataset Item 3
33
UserSt-1
bitmask
34
UserSt-2
128
Dataset Item 64
0 to 1 mA
F173
ENUMERATION: DCMA INPUT/OUTPUT RANGE
F157
ENUMERATION: BREAKER MODE
0 = 3-Pole, 1 = 1-Pole
0 to 1 mA
1 to 1 mA
0 to 5 mA
0 to 10 mA
0 to 20 mA
4 to 20 mA
F158
ENUMERATION: SCHEME CALIBRATION TEST
F174
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER RTD INPUT TYPE
0 = A, 1 = B, 2 = C
F166
ENUMERATION: AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION TYPE
F176
ENUMERATION: SYNCHROCHECK DEAD SOURCE SELECT
bitmask
F167
ENUMERATION: SIGNAL SOURCE
0 = SRC 1, 1 = SRC 2, 2 = SRC 3, 3 = SRC 4,
4 = SRC 5, 5 = SRC 6
F168
ENUMERATION: INRUSH INHIBIT FUNCTION
0 = Disabled, 1 = Adapt. 2nd, 2 = Trad. 2nd
None
DV1 or DV2
F177
ENUMERATION: COMMUNICATION PORT
F170
ENUMERATION: LOW/HIGH OFFSET and GAIN
TRANSDUCER INPUT/OUTPUT SELECTION
0 = LOW, 1 = HIGH
F178
ENUMERATION: DATA LOGGER RATES
F171
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER CHANNEL INPUT TYPE
F179
ENUMERATION: NEGATIVE SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL
OVERCURRENT TYPE
F172
ENUMERATION: SLOT LETTERS
bitmask
slot
bitmask
slot
bitmask
slot
bitmask
slot
12
13
10
14
11
15
F180
ENUMERATION: PHASE/GROUND
0 = PHASE, 1 = GROUND
B-72
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F181
ENUMERATION: ODD/EVEN/NONE
F190
ENUMERATION: SIMULATED KEYPRESS
bitmsk
F183
ENUMERATION: AC INPUT WAVEFORMS
bitmask
definition
Off
8 samples/cycle
16 samples/cycle
32 samples/cycle
64 samples/cycle
F184
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DEVICE GOOSE DATASET
value
keypress
bitmsk
keypress
23
Reset
24
User 1
25
User 2
26
User 3
27
User-programmable key 1
28
User-programmable key 2
29
User-programmable key 3
30
User-programmable key 4
31
User-programmable key 5
32
User-programmable key 6
33
User-programmable key 7
10
34
User-programmable key 8
11
Decimal Pt
35
User-programmable key 9
12
Plus/Minus
36
User-programmable key 10
GOOSE dataset
13
Value Up
37
User-programmable key 11
Off
14
Value Down
38
User-programmable key 12
GooseIn 1
15
Message Up
43
User-programmable key 13
GooseIn 2
16
Message Down
44
User-programmable key 14
GooseIn 3
17
Message Left
45
User-programmable key 15
GooseIn 4
18
Message Right
46
User-programmable key 16
GooseIn 5
19
Menu
47
GooseIn 6
20
Help
48
GooseIn 7
21
Escape
49
GooseIn 8
22
Enter
50
F185
ENUMERATION: PHASE A,B,C, GROUND SELECTOR
F192
ENUMERATION: ETHERNET OPERATION MODE
0 = A, 1 = B, 2 = C, 3 = G
0 = Half-Duplex, 1 = Full-Duplex
F186
ENUMERATION: MEASUREMENT MODE
F194
ENUMERATION: DNP SCALE
F195
ENUMERATION: SINGLE POLE TRIP MODE
0 = Disabled, 1 = 3 Pole Only, 2 = 3 Pole & 1 Pole
F196
ENUMERATION: NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL OVERCURRENT
OPERATING CURRENT
0 = Calculated 3I0, 1 = Measured IG
F198
ENUMERATION: PILOT SCHEME COMMUNICATION BITS
0 = 1, 1 = 2, 2 = 4
GE Multilin
B-73
APPENDIX B
F199
ENUMERATION: DISABLED/ENABLED/CUSTOM
F222
ENUMERATION: TEST ENUMERATION
F200
TEXT40: 40-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F226
ENUMERATION: REMOTE INPUT/OUTPUT TRANSFER
METHOD
F227
ENUMERATION: RELAY SERVICE STATUS
0 = Unknown, 1 = Relay In Service, 2 = Relay Out Of Service
F202
TEXT20: 20-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
10 registers, 16 Bits: 1st Char MSB, 2nd Char. LSB
F230
ENUMERATION: DIRECTIONAL POLARIZING
0 = Voltage, 1 = Current, 2 = Dual
F203
TEXT16: 16-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F231
ENUMERATION: POLARIZING VOLTAGE
0 = Calculated V0, 1 = Measured VX
F204
TEXT80: 80-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F232
ENUMERATION: CONFIGURABLE GOOSE DATASET ITEMS
FOR TRANSMISSION
F205
TEXT12: 12-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
value
F206
TEXT6: 6-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F207
TEXT4: 4-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
None
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.q
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.stVal
255
F208
TEXT2: 2-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.q
256
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.stVal
257
MMXU1.MX.TotW.mag.f
258
MMXU1.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
F211
ENUMERATION: SOURCE SELECTION
259
MMXU1.MX.TotVA.mag.f
260
MMXU1.MX.TotPF.mag.f
261
MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f
262
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
263
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
F220
ENUMERATION: PUSHBUTTON MESSAGE PRIORITY
264
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
265
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
266
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
priority
267
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
Disabled
268
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
Normal
269
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
High Priority
270
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
value
B-74
271
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
272
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
273
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
value
274
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
327
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
275
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
328
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
276
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
329
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
277
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
330
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
278
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
331
MMXU3.MX.TotW.mag.f
279
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
332
MMXU3.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
280
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
333
MMXU3.MX.TotVA.mag.f
281
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
334
MMXU3.MX.TotPF.mag.f
282
MMXU1.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
335
MMXU3.MX.Hz.mag.f
283
MMXU1.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
336
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
284
MMXU1.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
337
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
285
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
338
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
286
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
339
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
287
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
340
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
288
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
341
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
289
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
342
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
290
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
343
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
291
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
344
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
292
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
345
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
293
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
346
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
294
MMXU2.MX.TotW.mag.f
347
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
295
MMXU2.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
348
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
296
MMXU2.MX.TotVA.mag.f
349
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
297
MMXU2.MX.TotPF.mag.f
350
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
298
MMXU2.MX.Hz.mag.f
351
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
299
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
352
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
300
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
353
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
301
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
354
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
302
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
355
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
303
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
356
MMXU3.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
304
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
357
MMXU3.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
305
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
358
MMXU3.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
306
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
359
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
307
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
360
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
308
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
361
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
309
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
362
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
310
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
363
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
311
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
364
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
312
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
365
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
313
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
366
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
314
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
367
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
315
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
368
MMXU4.MX.TotW.mag.f
316
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
369
MMXU4.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
317
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
370
MMXU4.MX.TotVA.mag.f
318
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
371
MMXU4.MX.TotPF.mag.f
319
MMXU2.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
372
MMXU4.MX.Hz.mag.f
320
MMXU2.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
373
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
321
MMXU2.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
374
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
322
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
375
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
323
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
376
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
324
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
377
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
325
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
378
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
326
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
379
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
GE Multilin
B-75
APPENDIX B
value
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
433
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
381
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
434
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
382
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
435
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
383
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
436
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
384
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
437
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
385
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
438
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
386
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
439
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
387
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
440
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
388
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
441
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
389
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
442
MMXU6.MX.TotW.mag.f
390
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
443
MMXU6.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
391
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
444
MMXU6.MX.TotVA.mag.f
392
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
445
MMXU6.MX.TotPF.mag.f
393
MMXU4.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
446
MMXU6.MX.Hz.mag.f
394
MMXU4.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
447
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
395
MMXU4.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
448
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
396
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
449
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
397
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
450
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
398
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
451
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
399
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
452
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
400
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
453
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
401
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
454
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
402
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
455
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
403
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
456
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
404
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
457
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
405
MMXU5.MX.TotW.mag.f
458
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
406
MMXU5.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
459
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
407
MMXU5.MX.TotVA.mag.f
460
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
408
MMXU5.MX.TotPF.mag.f
461
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
409
MMXU5.MX.Hz.mag.f
462
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
410
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
463
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
411
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
464
412
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
465
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
413
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
466
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
414
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
467
MMXU6.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
415
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
468
MMXU6.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
416
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
469
MMXU6.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
417
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
470
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
418
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
471
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
419
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
472
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
420
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
473
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
421
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
474
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
422
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
475
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
423
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
476
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
424
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
477
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
425
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
478
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
426
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
479
GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
427
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
480
GGIO4.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
428
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
481
GGIO4.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
429
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
482
GGIO4.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
430
MMXU5.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
483
GGIO4.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
431
MMXU5.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
484
GGIO4.MX.AnIn6.mag.f
432
MMXU5.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
485
GGIO4.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
B-76
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
value
486
value
GGIO4.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
143
GGIO3.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
487
GGIO4.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
144
GGIO3.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
488
GGIO4.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
489
GGIO4.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
490
GGIO4.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
491
GGIO4.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
492
GGIO4.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
value
493
GGIO4.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
Calculated VN
494
GGIO4.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
Measured VX
495
GGIO4.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
496
GGIO4.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
497
GGIO4.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
498
GGIO4.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
499
GGIO4.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
value
500
GGIO4.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
Calculated IN
501
GGIO4.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
Measured IG
502
GGIO4.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
503
GGIO4.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
504
GGIO4.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
505
GGIO4.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
506
GGIO4.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
value
month
507
GGIO4.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
January
508
GGIO4.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
February
509
GGIO4.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
March
510
GGIO4.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
April
May
June
July
F234
ENUMERATION: WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT VOLTAGE
F235
ENUMERATION: WATTMETRIC GROUND FAULT CURRENT
None
GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q
GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal
GGIO3.ST.Ind2.q
GGIO3.ST.Ind2.stVal
127
GGIO1.ST.Ind64q
128
GGIO1.ST.Ind64.stVal
129
GGIO3.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
130
GGIO3.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
131
GGIO3.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
132
GGIO3.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
133
GGIO3.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
134
GGIO3.MX.AnIn6.mag.f
135
GGIO3.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
136
GGIO3.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
137
GGIO3.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
138
GGIO3.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
139
GGIO3.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
140
GGIO3.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
141
GGIO3.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
142
GGIO3.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
GE Multilin
current
F237
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK MONTH
F233
ENUMERATION: CONFIGURABLE GOOSE DATASET ITEMS
FOR RECEPTION
value
voltage
August
September
October
10
November
11
December
F238
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK DAY
value
day
Sunday
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
Thursday
Friday
Saturday
F239
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK DAYLIGHT SAVINGS
TIME START DAY INSTANCE
value
0
instance
First
B-77
APPENDIX B
[48] TIMER (1 to 32)
[50] ASSIGN VIRTUAL OUTPUT (1 to 96)
[52] SELF-TEST ERROR (see F141 for range)
[56] ACTIVE SETTING GROUP (1 to 6)
[62] MISCELLANEOUS EVENTS (see F146 for range)
[64 to 127] ELEMENT STATES
instance
Second
Third
Fourth
Last
F260
ENUMERATION: DATA LOGGER MODE
F400
UR_UINT16: CT/VT BANK SELECTION
0 = Continuous, 1 = Trigger
bitmask
bank selection
Card 1 Contact 1 to 4
Card 1 Contact 5 to 8
Card 2 Contact 1 to 4
Card 2 Contact 5 to 8
magnitude
Card 3 Contact 1 to 4
None
Card 3 Contact 5 to 8
I0
V0
F239
ENUMERATION: FAULT REPORT SYSTEM Z0 MAGNITUDE
value
F491
ENUMERATION: ANALOG INPUT MODE
F300
UR_UINT16: FLEXLOGIC BASE TYPE (6-bit type)
The FlexLogic BASE type is 6 bits and is combined with a 9 bit
descriptor and 1 bit for protection element to form a 16 bit value.
The combined bits are of the form: PTTTTTTDDDDDDDDD,
where P bit if set, indicates that the FlexLogic type is associated
with a protection element state and T represents bits for the BASE
type, and D represents bits for the descriptor.
The values in square brackets indicate the base type with P prefix
[PTTTTTT] and the values in round brackets indicate the descriptor range.
[0] Off(0) this is boolean FALSE value
[0] On (1) this is boolean TRUE value
[2] CONTACT INPUTS (1 to 96)
[3] CONTACT INPUTS OFF (1 to 96)
[4] VIRTUAL INPUTS (1 to 64)
[6] VIRTUAL OUTPUTS (1 to 96)
[10] CONTACT OUTPUTS VOLTAGE DETECTED (1 to 64)
[11] CONTACT OUTPUTS VOLTAGE OFF DETECTED (1 to 64)
[12] CONTACT OUTPUTS CURRENT DETECTED (1 to 64)
[13] CONTACT OUTPUTS CURRENT OFF DETECTED (1 to 64)
[14] REMOTE INPUTS (1 to 32)
[28] INSERT (via keypad only)
[32] END
[34] NOT (1 INPUT)
[36] 2 INPUT XOR (0)
[38] LATCH SET/RESET (2 inputs)
[40] OR (2 to 16 inputs)
[42] AND (2 to 16 inputs)
[44] NOR (2 to 16 inputs)
[46] NAND (2 to 16 inputs)
B-78
F500
UR_UINT16: PACKED BITFIELD
First register indicates input/output state with bits 0 (MSB) to 15
(LSB) corresponding to input/output state 1 to 16. The second register indicates input/output state with bits 0 to 15 corresponding to
input/output state 17 to 32 (if required) The third register indicates
input/output state with bits 0 to 15 corresponding to input/output
state 33 to 48 (if required). The fourth register indicates input/output state with bits 0 to 15 corresponding to input/output state 49 to
64 (if required).
The number of registers required is determined by the specific
data item. A bit value of 0 = Off and 1 = On.
F501
UR_UINT16: LED STATUS
Low byte of register indicates LED status with bit 0 representing
the top LED and bit 7 the bottom LED. A bit value of 1 indicates
the LED is on, 0 indicates the LED is off.
F502
BITFIELD: ELEMENT OPERATE STATES
Each bit contains the operate state for an element. See the F124
format code for a list of element IDs. The operate bit for element ID
X is bit [X mod 16] in register [X/16].
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F504
BITFIELD: 3-PHASE ELEMENT STATE
bitmask
F512
ENUMERATION: HARMONIC NUMBER
element state
Pickup
Operate
Pickup Phase A
Pickup Phase B
Pickup Phase C
Operate Phase A
Operate Phase B
Operate Phase C
F505
BITFIELD: CONTACT OUTPUT STATE
0 = Contact State, 1 = Voltage Detected, 2 = Current Detected
bitmask
harmonic
bitmask
2ND
12
harmonic
14TH
3RD
13
15TH
4TH
14
16TH
5TH
15
17TH
6TH
16
18TH
7TH
17
19TH
8TH
18
20TH
9TH
19
21ST
10TH
20
22ND
11TH
21
23RD
10
12TH
22
24TH
11
13TH
23
25TH
F506|
BITFIELD: 1 PHASE ELEMENT STATE
F513
ENUMERATION: POWER SWING MODE
0 = Pickup, 1 = Operate
F507
BITFIELD: COUNTER ELEMENT STATE
F514
ENUMERATION: POWER SWING TRIP MODE
0 = Delayed, 1 = Early
F508
BITFIELD: DISTANCE ELEMENT STATE
F515
ENUMERATION ELEMENT INPUT MODE
bitmask
0 = Signed, 1 = Absolute
Pickup
Operate
Pickup AB
Pickup BC
Pickup CA
Operate AB
Operate BC
F516
ENUMERATION ELEMENT COMPARE MODE
0 = Level, 1 = Delta
Operate CA
F517
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT DIRECTION OPERATION
Timed
0 = Over, 1 = Under
Operate IAB
10
Operate IBC
11
Operate ICA
F518
ENUMERATION: FLEXELEMENT UNITS
0 = Milliseconds, 1 = Seconds, 2 = Minutes
F509
BITFIELD: SIMPLE ELEMENT STATE
F519
ENUMERATION: NON-VOLATILE LATCH
0 = Operate
0 = Reset-Dominant, 1 = Set-Dominant
F511
BITFIELD: 3-PHASE SIMPLE ELEMENT STATE
0 = Operate, 1 = Operate A, 2 = Operate B, 3 = Operate C
F521
ENUMERATION: GROUND DISTANCE POLARIZING CURRENT
0 = Zero-Sequence; 1 = Negative-Sequence
GE Multilin
B-79
APPENDIX B
F522
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER DCMA OUTPUT RANGE
0 = 1 to 1 mA; 1 = 0 to 1 mA; 2 = 4 to 20 mA
F523
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECTS 20, 22, AND 23 DEFAULT
VARIATION
F530
ENUMERATION: FRONT PANEL INTERFACE KEYPRESS
bitmask
keypress
bitmask
keypress
None
22
Value Down
Menu
23
Reset
Message Up
24
User 1
25
User 2
26
User 3
bitmask
default variation
31
User PB 1
Help
32
User PB 2
Message Left
33
User PB 3
34
User PB 4
F524
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECT 21 DEFAULT VARIATION
35
User PB 5
10
36
User PB 6
11
Escape
37
User PB 7
12
Message Right
38
User PB 8
13
39
User PB 9
14
40
User PB 10
bitmask
Default Variation
15
41
User PB 11
16
Enter
42
User PB 12
17
Message Down
44
User 4
10
18
45
User 5
19
Decimal
46
User 6
20
+/
47
User 7
21
Value Up
F525
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION
bitmask
default variation
F531
ENUMERATION: LANGUAGE
F540
ENUMERATION: PMU POST-FILTER
0 = None, 1 = Symm-3-Point, 2 = Symm-5-Point,
3 = Symm-7-Point
F542
ENUMERATION: PMU TRIGGERING MODE
0 = Automatic Overwrite, 1 = Protected
F543
ENUMERATION: PMU PHASORS
B-80
value
phasor
value
Off
Ig
Va
V_1
Vb
10
V_2
Vc
11
V_0
Vx
12
I_1
Ia
13
I_2
Ib
14
I_0
Ic
phasor
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F544
ENUMERATION: PMU RECORDING/REPORTING RATE
value
rate
F546
ENUMERATION: PMU REPORTING STYLE
0 = Polar, 1 = Rectangular
value
rate
1/second
20second
2/second
25/second
5/second
30/second
F547
ENUMERATION: PMU REPORTING FORMAT
10/second
50/second
0 = Integer, 1 = Floating
12/second
10
60/second
15/second
F600
UR_UINT16: FLEXANALOG PARAMETER
F545
ENUMERATION: PMU COM PORT TYPE
0 = Network, 1 = RS485, 2 = Dir Comm Ch1, 3 = Dir Comm Ch2
GE Multilin
B-81
APPENDIX B
B-82
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
C.1 OVERVIEW
C.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The IEC 61850 standard is the result of electric utilities and vendors of electronic equipment to produce standardized communications systems. IEC 61850 is a series of standards describing client/server and peer-to-peer communications, substation design and configuration, testing, environmental and project standards. The complete set includes:
IEC 61850-5: Communications and requirements for functions and device models
IEC 61850-6: Configuration description language for communication in electrical substations related to IEDs
IEC 61850-7-1: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment - Principles and models
IEC 61850-7-2: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment - Abstract communication service
interface (ACSI)
IEC 61850-7-3: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment Common data classes
IEC 61850-7-4: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment Compatible logical node classes
and data classes
IEC 61850-8-1: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) Mappings to MMS (ISO 9506-1 and ISO 9506-2)
and to ISO/IEC 8802-3
IEC 61850-9-1: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) Sampled values over serial unidirectional multidrop point to point link
IEC 61850-9-2: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) Sampled values over ISO/IEC 8802-3
These documents can be obtained from the IEC (http://www.iec.ch). It is strongly recommended that all those involved with
any IEC 61850 implementation obtain this document set.
C.1.2 COMMUNICATION PROFILES
IEC 61850 specifies the use of the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) at the upper (application) layer for transfer
of real-time data. This protocol has been in existence for several of years and provides a set of services suitable for the
transfer of data within a substation LAN environment. Actual MMS protocol services are mapped to IEC 61850 abstract services in IEC 61850-8-1.
The D60 relay supports IEC 61850 server services over both TCP/IP and TP4/CLNP (OSI) communication protocol stacks.
The TP4/CLNP profile requires the D60 to have a network address or Network Service Access Point (NSAP) to establish a
communication link. The TCP/IP profile requires the D60 to have an IP address to establish communications. These
addresses are located in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK menu. Note that the D60
supports IEC 61850 over the TP4/CLNP or TCP/IP stacks, and also operation over both stacks simultaneously. It is possible to have up to five simultaneous connections (in addition to DNP and Modbus/TCP (non-IEC 61850) connections).
Client/server: This is a connection-oriented type of communication. The connection is initiated by the client, and communication activity is controlled by the client. IEC 61850 clients are often substation computers running HMI programs
or SOE logging software. Servers are usually substation equipment such as protection relays, meters, RTUs, transformer tap changers, or bay controllers.
Peer-to-peer: This is a non-connection-oriented, high speed type of communication usually between substation equipment such as protection relays. GSSE and GOOSE are methods of peer-to-peer communication.
Substation configuration language (SCL): A substation configuration language is a number of files used to describe
the configuration of substation equipment. Each configured device has an IEC Capability Description (ICD) file. The
substation single line information is stored in a System Specification Description (SSD) file. The entire substation configuration is stored in a Substation Configuration Description (SCD) file. The SCD file is the combination of the individual ICD files and the SSD file.
GE Multilin
C-1
APPENDIX C
C.2.1 OVERVIEW
IEC 61850 defines an object-oriented approach to data and services. An IEC 61850 physical device can contain one or
more logical device(s). Each logical device can contain many logical nodes. Each logical node can contain many data
objects. Each data object is composed of data attributes and data attribute components. Services are available at each
level for performing various functions, such as reading, writing, control commands, and reporting.
Each D60 IED represents one IEC 61850 physical device. The physical device contains one logical device, and the logical
device contains many logical nodes. The logical node LPHD1 contains information about the D60 IED physical device. The
logical node LLN0 contains information about the D60 IED logical device.
C.2.2 GGIO1: DIGITAL STATUS VALUES
The GGIO1 logical node is available in the D60 to provide access to as many 128 digital status points and associated timestamps and quality flags. The data content must be configured before the data can be used. GGIO1 provides digital status
points for access by clients.
It is intended that clients use GGIO1 in order to access digital status values from the D60. Configuration settings are provided to allow the selection of the number of digital status indications available in GGIO1 (8 to 128), and to allow the choice
of the D60 FlexLogic operands that drive the status of the GGIO1 status indications. Clients can utilize the IEC 61850
buffered and unbuffered reporting features available from GGIO1 in order to build sequence of events (SOE) logs and HMI
display screens. Buffered reporting should generally be used for SOE logs since the buffering capability reduces the
chances of missing data state changes. Unbuffered reporting should generally be used for local status display.
C.2.3 GGIO2: DIGITAL CONTROL VALUES
The GGIO2 logical node is available to provide access to the D60 virtual inputs. Virtual inputs are single-point control
(binary) values that can be written by clients. They are generally used as control inputs. GGIO2 provides access to the virtual inputs through the IEC 61850 standard control model (ctlModel) services:
Status only
Configuration settings are available to select the control model for each point. Each virtual input used through GGIO2
should have its VIRTUAL INPUT 1(64) FUNCTION setting programmed as Enabled and its corresponding GGIO2 CF SPSCO1(64)
CTLMODEL setting programmed to the appropriate control configuration.
C.2.4 GGIO3: DIGITAL STATUS AND ANALOG VALUES FROM RECEIVED GOOSE DATA
The GGIO3 logical node is available to provide access for clients to values received via configurable GOOSE messages.
The values of the digital status indications and analog values in GGIO3 originate in GOOSE messages sent from other
devices.
C.2.5 GGIO4: GENERIC ANALOG MEASURED VALUES
The GGIO4 logical node provides access to as many as 32 analog value points, as well as associated timestamps and
quality flags. The data content must be configured before the data can be used. GGIO4 provides analog values for access
by clients.
It is intended that clients use GGIO4 to access generic analog values from the D60. Configuration settings allow the selection of the number of analog values available in GGIO4 (4 to 32) and the choice of the FlexAnalog values that determine
the value of the GGIO4 analog inputs. Clients can utilize polling or the IEC 61850 unbuffered reporting feature available
from GGIO4 in order to obtain the analog values provided by GGIO4.
C-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
A limited number of measured analog values are available through the MMXU logical nodes.
Each MMXU logical node provides data from a D60 current and voltage source. There is one MMXU available for each configurable source (programmed in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES menu). MMXU1 provides data
from D60 source 1, and MMXU2 provides data from D60 source 2.
MMXU data is provided in two forms: instantaneous and deadband. The instantaneous values are updated every time a
read operation is performed by a client. The deadband values are calculated as described in IEC 61850 parts 7-1 and 7-3.
The selection of appropriate deadband settings for the D60 is described in chapter 5 of this manual.
IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting capability is available in all MMXU logical nodes. MMXUx logical nodes provide the following data for each source:
MMXU1.MX.Hz: frequency
The following list describes the protection elements for all UR-series relays. The D60 relay will contain a subset of protection elements from this list.
GE Multilin
C-3
APPENDIX C
PIOC: phase instantaneous overcurrent, neutral instantaneous overcurrent, ground instantaneous overcurrent, negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent.
PTOC: phase time overcurrent, neutral time overcurrent, ground time overcurrent, negative-sequence time overcurrent, neutral directional overcurrent, negative-sequence directional overcurrent
PTOV: phase overvoltage, neutral overvoltage, auxiliary overvoltage, negative sequence overvoltage
RREC: autoreclosure
The protection elements listed above contain start (pickup) and operate flags. For example, the start flag for PIOC1 is
PIOC1.ST.Str.general. The operate flag for PIOC1 is PIOC1.ST.Op.general. For the D60 protection elements, these flags
take their values from the pickup and operate FlexLogic operands for the corresponding element.
Some protection elements listed above contain directional start values. For example, the directional start value for PDIS1 is
PDIS1.ST.Str.dirGeneral. This value is built from the directional FlexLogic operands for the element.
The RFLO logical node contains the measurement of the distance to fault calculation in kilometers. This value originates in
the fault locator function.
The XCBR logical node is directly associated with the breaker control feature.
XCBR1.ST.Loc: This is the state of the XCBR1 local/remote switch. A setting is provided to assign a FlexLogic operand to determine the state. When local mode is true, IEC 61850 client commands will be rejected.
XCBR1.ST.Opcnt: This is an operation counter as defined in IEC 61850. Command settings are provided to allow the
counter to be cleared.
XCBR1.ST.Pos: This is the position of the breaker. The breaker control FlexLogic operands are used to determine
this state. If the breaker control logic indicates that the breaker, or any single pole of the breaker, is closed, then the
breaker position state is on. If the breaker control logic indicates that the breaker is open, then the breaker position
state is off.
XCBR1.ST.BlkOpn: This is the state of the block open command logic. When true, breaker open commands from IEC
61850 clients will be rejected.
XCBR1.ST.BlkCls: This is the state of the block close command logic. When true, breaker close commands from IEC
61850 clients will be rejected.
XCBR1.CO.Pos: This is where IEC 61850 clients can issue open or close commands to the breaker. SBO control with
normal security is the only supported IEC 61850 control model.
XCBR1.CO.BlkOpn: This is where IEC 61850 clients can issue block open commands to the breaker. Direct control
with normal security is the only supported IEC 61850 control model.
XCBR1.CO.BlkCls: This is where IEC 61850 clients can issue block close commands to the breaker. Direct control
with normal security is the only supported IEC 61850 control model.
C-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting is provided in the GGIO1 logical nodes (for binary status values) and MMXU1
to MMXU6 (for analog measured values). Report settings can be configured using the EnerVista UR Setup software, substation configurator software, or via an IEC 61850 client. The following items can be configured:
TrgOps: Trigger options. The following bits are supported by the D60:
Bit 1: data-change
Bit 4: integrity
OptFlds: Option Fields. The following bits are supported by the D60:
Bit 1: sequence-number
Bit 2: report-time-stamp
Bit 3: reason-for-inclusion
Bit 4: data-set-name
Bit 5: data-reference
Bit 8: conf-revision
Bit 9: segmentation
MMS file services are supported to allow transfer of oscillography, event record, or other files from a D60 relay.
C.3.3 TIMESTAMPS AND SCANNING
The timestamp values associated with all IEC 61850 data items represent the time of the last change of either the value or
quality flags of the data item. To accomplish this functionality, all IEC 61850 data items must be regularly scanned for data
changes, and the timestamp updated when a change is detected, regardless of the connection status of any IEC 61850 clients. For applications where there is no IEC 61850 client in use, the IEC 61850 SERVER SCANNING setting can be programmed as Disabled. If a client is in use, this setting should be programmed as Enabled to ensure the proper
generation of IEC 61850 timestamps.
C.3.4 LOGICAL DEVICE NAME
The logical device name is used to identify the IEC 61850 logical device that exists within the D60. This name is composed
of two parts: the IED name setting and the logical device instance. The complete logical device name is the combination of
the two character strings programmed in the IEDNAME and LD INST settings. The default values for these strings are IEDName and LDInst. These values should be changed to reflect a logical naming convention for all IEC 61850 logical
devices in the system.
C.3.5 LOCATION
The LPHD1 logical node contains a data attribute called location (LPHD1.DC.PhyNam.location). This is a character string
meant to describe the physical location of the D60. This attribute is programmed through the LOCATION setting and its
default value is Location. This value should be changed to describe the actual physical location of the D60.
GE Multilin
C-5
APPENDIX C
C.3.6 LOGICAL NODE NAME PREFIXES
IEC 61850 specifies that each logical node can have a name with a total length of 11 characters. The name is composed of:
Complete names are of the form xxxxxxPIOC1, where the xxxxxx character string is configurable. Details regarding the
logical node naming rules are given in IEC 61850 parts 6 and 7-2. It is recommended that a consistent naming convention
be used for an entire substation project.
C-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
C.4.1 OVERVIEW
IEC 61850 specifies two types of peer-to-peer data transfer services: Generic Substation State Events (GSSE) and Generic
Object Oriented Substation Events (GOOSE). GSSE services are compatible with UCA 2.0 GOOSE. IEC 61850 GOOSE
services provide virtual LAN (VLAN) support, Ethernet priority tagging, and Ethertype Application ID configuration. The support for VLANs and priority tagging allows for the optimization of Ethernet network traffic. GOOSE messages can be given
a higher priority than standard Ethernet traffic, and they can be separated onto specific VLANs. Because of the additional
features of GOOSE services versus GSSE services, it is recommended that GOOSE be used wherever backwards compatibility with GSSE (or UCA 2.0 GOOSE) is not required.
Devices that transmit GSSE and/or GOOSE messages also function as servers. Each GSSE publisher contains a GSSE
control block to configure and control the transmission. Each GOOSE publisher contains a GOOSE control block to configure and control the transmission. The transmission is also controlled via device settings. These settings can be seen in
the ICD and/or SCD files, or in the device configuration software or files.
IEC 61850 recommends a default priority value of 4 for GOOSE. Ethernet traffic that does not contain a priority tag has a
default priority of 1. More details are specified in IEC 61850 part 8-1.
IEC 61850 recommends that the Ethertype Application ID number be configured according to the GOOSE source. In the
D60, the transmitted GOOSE Application ID number must match the configured receive Application ID number in the
receiver. A common number may be used for all GOOSE transmitters in a system. More details are specified in IEC 61850
part 8-1.
C.4.2 GSSE CONFIGURATION
IEC 61850 Generic Substation Status Event (GSSE) communication is compatible with UCA GOOSE communication.
GSSE messages contain a number of double point status data items. These items are transmitted in two pre-defined data
structures named DNA and UserSt. Each DNA and UserSt item is referred to as a bit pair. GSSE messages are transmitted in response to state changes in any of the data points contained in the message. GSSE messages always contain the
same number of DNA and UserSt bit pairs. Depending the on the configuration, only some of these bit pairs may have values that are of interest to receiving devices.
The GSSE FUNCTION, GSSE ID, and GSSE DESTINATION MAC ADDRESS settings are used to configure GSSE transmission.
GSSE FUNCTION is set to Enabled to enable the transmission. If a valid multicast Ethernet MAC address is entered for the
GSSE DESTINATION MAC ADDRESS setting, this address will be used as the destination MAC address for GSSE messages. If
a valid multicast Ethernet MAC address is not entered (for example, 00 00 00 00 00 00), the D60 will use the source Ethernet MAC address as the destination, with the multicast bit set.
C.4.3 FIXED GOOSE
The D60 supports two types of IEC 61850 Generic Object Oriented Substation Event (GOOSE) communication: fixed
GOOSE and configurable GOOSE. All GOOSE messages contain IEC 61850 data collected into a dataset. It is this dataset
that is transferred using GOOSE message services. The dataset transferred using the D60 fixed GOOSE is the same data
that is transferred using the GSSE feature; that is, the DNA and UserSt bit pairs. The FlexLogic operands that determine
the state of the DNA and UserSt bit pairs are configurable via settings, but the fixed GOOSE dataset always contains the
same DNA/UserSt data structure. Upgrading from GSSE to GOOSE services is simply a matter of enabling fixed GOOSE
and disabling GSSE. The remote inputs and outputs are configured in the same manner for both GSSE and fixed GOOSE.
It is recommended that the fixed GOOSE be used for implementations that require GOOSE data transfer between URseries IEDs. Configurable GOOSE may be used for implementations that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers.
C.4.4 CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
The configurable GOOSE feature allows for the configuration of the datasets to be transmitted or received from the D60.
The D60 supports the configuration of eight (8) transmission and reception datasets, allowing for the optimization of data
transfer between devices.
GE Multilin
C-7
APPENDIX C
Items programmed for dataset 1 will have changes in their status transmitted as soon as the change is detected. Dataset 1
should be used for high-speed transmission of data that is required for applications such as transfer tripping, blocking, and
breaker fail initiate. At least one digital status value needs to be configured in dataset 1 to enable transmission of all data
configured for dataset 1. Configuring analog data only to dataset 1 will not activate transmission.
Items programmed for datasets 2 through 8 will have changes in their status transmitted at a maximum rate of every
100 ms. Datasets 2 through 8 will regularly analyze each data item configured within them every 100 ms to identify if any
changes have been made. If any changes in the data items are detected, these changes will be transmitted through a
GOOSE message. If there are no changes detected during this 100 ms period, no GOOSE message will be sent.
For all datasets 1 through 8, the integrity GOOSE message will still continue to be sent at the pre-configured rate even if no
changes in the data items are detected.
The GOOSE functionality was enhanced to prevent the relay from flooding a communications network with GOOSE messages due to an oscillation being created that is triggering a message.
The D60 has the ability of detecting if a data item in one of the GOOSE datasets is erroneously oscillating. This can be
caused by events such as errors in logic programming, inputs improperly being asserted and de-asserted, or failed station
components. If erroneously oscillation is detected, the D60 will stop sending GOOSE messages from the dataset for a minimum period of one second. Should the oscillation persist after the one second time-out period, the D60 will continue to
block transmission of the dataset. The D60 will assert the MAINTENANCE ALERT: GGIO Ind XXX oscill self-test error message on the front panel display, where XXX denotes the data item detected as oscillating.
The configurable GOOSE feature is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers. Fixed GOOSE is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data
transfer between UR-series IEDs.
IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging contains a number of configurable parameters, all of which must be correct to achieve the
successful transfer of data. It is critical that the configured datasets at the transmission and reception devices are an exact
match in terms of data structure, and that the GOOSE addresses and name strings match exactly. Manual configuration is
possible, but third-party substation configuration software may be used to automate the process. The EnerVista UR Setupsoftware can produce IEC 61850 ICD files and import IEC 61850 SCD files produced by a substation configurator (refer to
the IEC 61850 IED configuration section later in this appendix).
The following example illustrates the configuration required to transfer IEC 61850 data items between two devices. The
general steps required for transmission configuration are:
1.
2.
3.
2.
3.
This example shows how to configure the transmission and reception of three IEC 61850 data items: a single point status
value, its associated quality flags, and a floating point analog value.
The following procedure illustrates the transmission configuration.
1.
Configure the transmission dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO1 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO1 status indication 1.
The transmission dataset now contains a set of quality flags and a single point status Boolean value. The reception
dataset on the receiving device must exactly match this structure.
2.
C-8
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1 settings menu:
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
3.
Set CONFIG GSE 1 ID to an appropriate descriptive string (the default value is GOOSEOut_1).
Set CONFIG GSE 1 DST MAC to a multicast address (for example, 01 00 00 12 34 56).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN PRIORITY; the default value of 4 is OK for this example.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN ID value; the default value is 0, but some switches may require this value to be 1.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 ETYPE APPID value. This setting represents the Ethertype application ID and must match the
configuration on the receiver (the default value is 0).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 CONFREV value. This value changes automatically as described in IEC 61850 part 7-2. For
this example it can be left at its default value.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC 61850 PROTOsettings menu:
Set GGIO1 INDICATION 1 to a FlexLogic operand used to provide the status of GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal (for example,
a contact input, virtual input, a protection element status, etc.).
The D60 must be rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The following procedure illustrates the reception configuration.
1.
Configure the reception dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC
61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO3 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO3 status indication 1.
The reception dataset now contains a set of quality flags, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog value. This matches the transmission dataset configuration above.
2.
3.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 settings menu:
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID to match the GOOSE ID string for the transmitting device. Enter GOOSEOut_1.
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID to match the Ethertype application ID from the transmitting device. This is 0 in
the example above.
Set the REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET value. This value represents the dataset number in use. Since we are using
configurable GOOSE 1 in this example, program this value as GOOSEIn 1.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE INPUTS REMOTE INPUT 1
settings menu:
Set REMOTE IN 1 ITEM to Dataset Item 2. This assigns the value of the GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal single point status
item to remote input 1.
Remote input 1 can now be used in FlexLogic equations or other settings. The D60 must be rebooted (control power
removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of remote input 1 (Boolean on or off) in the receiving device will be determined by the GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal value
in the sending device. The above settings will be automatically populated by the EnerVista UR Setup software when a complete SCD file is created by third party substation configurator software.
C.4.5 ETHERNET MAC ADDRESS FOR GSSE/GOOSE
Ethernet capable devices each contain a unique identifying address called a Media Access Control (MAC) address. This
address cannot be changed and is unique for each Ethernet device produced worldwide. The address is six bytes in length
and is usually represented as six hexadecimal values (for example, 00 A0 F4 01 02 03). It is used in all Ethernet frames as
the source address of the frame. Each Ethernet frame also contains a destination address. The destination address can
be different for each Ethernet frame depending on the intended destination of the frame.
GE Multilin
C-9
APPENDIX C
A special type of destination address called a multicast address is used when the Ethernet frame can be received by more
than one device. An Ethernet MAC address is multicast when the least significant bit of the first byte is set (for example, 01
00 00 00 00 00 is a multicast address).
GSSE and GOOSE messages must have multicast destination MAC addresses.
By default, the D60 is configured to use an automated multicast MAC scheme. If the D60 destination MAC address setting
is not a valid multicast address (that is, the least significant bit of the first byte is not set), the address used as the destination MAC will be the same as the local MAC address, but with the multicast bit set. Thus, if the local MAC address is 00 A0
F4 01 02 03, then the destination MAC address will be 01 A0 F4 01 02 03.
C.4.6 GSSE ID AND GOOSE ID SETTINGS
GSSE messages contain an identifier string used by receiving devices to identify the sender of the message, defined in IEC
61850 part 8-1 as GsID. This is a programmable 65-character string. This string should be chosen to provide a descriptive
name of the originator of the GSSE message.
GOOSE messages contain an identifier string used by receiving devices to identify the sender of the message, defined in
IEC 61850 part 8-1 as GoID. This programmable 65-character string should be a descriptive name of the originator of the
GOOSE message. GOOSE messages also contain two additional character strings used for identification of the message:
DatSet - the name of the associated dataset, and GoCBRef - the reference (name) of the associated GOOSE control block.
These strings are automatically populated and interpreted by the D60; no settings are required.
C-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
C.5.1 OVERVIEW
The D60 can be configured for IEC 61850 via the EnerVista UR Setup software as follows.
1.
An ICD file is generated for the D60 by the EnerVista UR Setup software that describe the capabilities of the IED.
2.
The ICD file is then imported into a system configurator along with other ICD files for other IEDs (from GE or other vendors) for system configuration.
3.
The result is saved to a SCD file, which is then imported back to EnerVista UR Setup to create one or more settings
file(s). The settings file(s) can then be used to update the relay(s) with the new configuration information.
IED (UR-series)
OR
EnerVista
UR Setup
Setting files
(.URS)
Process of
creating ICD
(vendor 2)
Process of
creating ICD
(vendor 3)
Process of
creating ICD
(vendor N)
ICD file 2
ICD file 3
ICD file N
ICD file 1
System
specification data
Import
SSD file
System configurator
System Configuration
(network, crosscommunications, IED setting
modification, etc.)
SCD file
URS 1
Write settings
file to device
URS X
URS 2
UR relay 1
UR relay 2
UR relay X
Vendor relay 2
Vendor relay 3
Vendor relay N
Ethernet
842790A1.CDR
GE Multilin
C-11
APPENDIX C
SCL: Substation Configuration Description Language. The configuration language is an application of the Extensible
Markup Language (XML) version 1.0.
SDI: Instantiated Sub DATA; middle name part of a structured DATA name
The following IEC related tools are referenced in the procedures that describe the IED configuration process for IEC 61850:
System configurator or Substation configurator: This is an IED independent system level tool that can import or
export configuration files defined by IEC 61850-6. It can import configuration files (ICD) from several IEDs for system
level engineering and is used to add system information shared by different IEDs. The system configuration generates
a substation related configuration file (SCD) which is fed back to the IED configurator (for example, EnerVista UR
Setup) for system related IED configuration. The system configurator should also be able to read a system specification file (SSD) to use as base for starting system engineering, or to compare it with an engineered system for the same
substation.
IED configurator: This is a vendor specific tool that can directly or indirectly generate an ICD file from the IED (for
example, from a settings file). It can also import a system SCL file (SCD) to set communication configuration parameters (that is, required addresses, reception GOOSE datasets, IDs of incoming GOOSE datasets, etc.) for the IED. The
IED configurator functionality is implemented in the GE Multilin EnerVista UR Setup software.
C.5.2 CONFIGURING IEC 61850 SETTINGS
Before creating an ICD file, the user can customize the IEC 61850 related settings for the IED. For example, the IED name
and logical device instance can be specified to uniquely identify the IED within the substation, or transmission GOOSE
datasets created so that the system configurator can configure the cross-communication links to send GOOSE messages
from the IED. Once the IEC 61850 settings are configured, the ICD creation process will recognize the changes and generate an ICD file that contains the updated settings.
Some of the IED settings will be modified during they system configuration process. For example, a new IP address may be
assigned, line items in a Transmission GOOSE dataset may be added or deleted, or prefixes of some logical nodes may be
changed. While all new configurations will be mapped to the D60 settings file when importing an SCD file, all unchanged
settings will preserve the same values in the new settings file.
These settings can be configured either directly through the relay panel or through the EnerVista UR Setup software (preferred method). The full list of IEC 61850 related settings for are as follows:
Network configuration: IP address, IP subnet mask, and default gateway IP address (access through the Settings >
Product Setup > Communications > Network menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
Server configuration: IED name and logical device instance (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Server Configuration menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
Logical node prefixes, which includes prefixes for all logical nodes except LLN0 (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Logical Node Prefixes menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
C-12
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
MMXU deadbands, which includes deadbands for all available MMXUs. The number of MMXUs is related to the number of CT/VT modules in the relay. There are two MMXUs for each CT/VT module. For example, if a relay contains two
CT/VT modules, there will be four MMXUs available (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > MMXU Deadbands menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
GGIO1 status configuration, which includes the number of status points in GGIO1 as well as the potential internal mappings for each GGIO1 indication. However only the number of status points will be used in the ICD creation process
(access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO1 Status Configuration
menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
GGIO2 control configuration, which includes ctlModels for all SPCSOs within GGIO2 (access through the Settings >
Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO2 Control Configuration menu tree in EnerVista UR
Setup).
Configurable transmission GOOSE, which includes eight configurable datasets that can be used for GOOSE transmission. The GOOSE ID can be specified for each dataset (it must be unique within the IED as well as across the whole
substation), as well as the destination MAC address, VLAN priority, VLAN ID, ETYPE APPID, and the dataset items.
The selection of the dataset item is restricted by firmware version; for version 5.4x, only GGIO1.ST.Indx.stVal and
GGIO1.ST.Indx.q are valid selection (where x is between 1 to N, and N is determined by number of GGIO1 status
points). Although configurable transmission GOOSE can also be created and altered by some third-party system configurators, we recommend configuring transmission GOOSE for GE Multilin IEDs before creating the ICD, and strictly
within EnerVista UR Setup software or the front panel display (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GSSE/GOOSE Configuration > Transmission > Tx Configurable GOOSE menu tree
in EnerVista UR Setup).
Configurable reception GOOSE, which includes eight configurable datasets that can be used for GOOSE reception.
However, unlike datasets for transmission, datasets for reception only contains dataset items, and they are usually created automatically by process of importing the SCD file (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GSSE/GOOSE Configuration > Reception > Rx Configurable GOOSE menu tree in
EnerVista UR Setup).
Remote devices configuration, which includes remote device ID (GOOSE ID or GoID of the incoming transmission
GOOSE dataset), ETYPE APPID (of the GSE communication block for the incoming transmission GOOSE), and
DATASET (which is the name of the associated reception GOOSE dataset). These settings are usually done automatically by process of importing SCD file (access through the Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Remote Devices menu tree
in EnerVista UR Setup).
Remote inputs configuration, which includes device (remote device ID) and item (which dataset item in the associated
reception GOOSE dataset to map) values. Only the items with cross-communication link created in SCD file should be
mapped. These configurations are usually done automatically by process of importing SCD file (access through the
Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Remote Inputs menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
C.5.3 ABOUT ICD FILES
The SCL language is based on XML, and its syntax definition is described as a W3C XML Schema. ICD is one type of SCL
file (which also includes SSD, CID and SCD files). The ICD file describes the capabilities of an IED and consists of four
major sections:
Header
Communication
IEDs
DataTypeTemplates
GE Multilin
C-13
APPENDIX C
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
842795A1.CDR
The Header node identifies the ICD file and its version, and specifies options for the mapping of names to signals
The Communication node describes the direct communication connection possibilities between logical nodes by means of
logical buses (sub-networks) and IED access ports. The communication section is structured as follows.
Communication
SubNetwork (name)
ConnectedAP (iedName, apName)
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Other P elements
C-14
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
GetDataSetValue
ReadWrite
ConfLogControl (max)
GetDirectory
SetDataSetValue
TimerActivatedControl
GSEDir
GetDateObjectDefinition
DataSetDirectory
ConfReportControl (max)
GOOSE (max)
DataObjectDirectory
GetCBValues
GSSE (max)
AccessPoint (name)
Server
Authentication (none)
LDevice (inst)
LN0 (InType, InClass, inst)
DataSet (name)
FCDA (fc, doName, daName, IdInst, prefix, InClass, InInst)
Other FCDA elements
Other DataSet elements
ReportControl (name, datSet, intgPd, rptID, confRev, buffered)
TrgOps (dchg)
RptEnabled
OptFields (seqNum)
DOI (name)
SDI (name)
DAI (name)
Val
Text
SDI (name)
DAI (name)
Val
Text
OptFields (seqNum)
RptEnabled
DAI (name)
Val
Text
SDI (name)
DAI (name)
Val
Text
Other LN elements
842797A1.CDR
GE Multilin
C-15
APPENDIX C
The DataTypeTemplates node defines instantiable logical node types. A logical node type is an instantiable template of the
data of a logical node. A LnodeType is referenced each time that this instantiable type is needed with an IED. A logical
node type template is built from DATA (DO) elements, which again have a DO type, which is derived from the DATA classes
(CDC). DOs consist of attributes (DA) or of elements of already defined DO types (SDO). The attribute (DA) has a functional constraint, and can either have a basic type, be an enumeration, or a structure of a DAType. The DAType is built from
BDA elements, defining the structure elements, which again can be BDA elements of have a base type such as DA.
DataTypeTemplates
LNodeType (id, InClass)
DO (name, type)
Other DO elements
Other DA elements
Val
Text
DAType (id)
BDA (name, bType, type)
Other BDA elements
Other DAType elements
EnumType (id)
EnumVal (ord)
Text
C-16
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
An ICD file can be created directly from a connected D60 IED or from an offline D60 settings file with the EnerVista UR
Setup software using the following procedure:
1.
Right-click the connected UR-series relay or settings file and select Create ICD File.
2.
The EnerVista UR Setup will prompt to save the file. Select the file path and enter the name for the ICD file, then click
OK to generate the file.
The time to create an ICD file from the offline D60 settings file is typically much quicker than create an ICD file directly from
the relay.
C.5.5 ABOUT SCD FILES
System configuration is performed in the system configurator. While many vendors (including GE Multilin) are working their
own system configuration tools, there are some system configurators available in the market (for example, Siemens DIGSI
version 4.6 or above and ASE Visual SCL Beta 0.12).
Although the configuration tools vary from one vendor to another, the procedure is pretty much the same. First, a substation
project must be created, either as an empty template or with some system information by importing a system specification
file (SSD). Then, IEDs are added to the substation. Since each IED is represented by its associated ICD, the ICD files are
imported into the substation project, and the system configurator validates the ICD files during the importing process. If the
ICD files are successfully imported into the substation project, it may be necessary to perform some additional minor steps
to attach the IEDs to the substation (see the system configurator manual for details).
Once all IEDs are inserted into the substation, further configuration is possible, such as:
creating cross-communication links (configuring GOOSE messages to send from one IED to others)
When system configurations are complete, the results are saved to an SCD file, which contains not only the configuration
for each IED in the substation, but also the system configuration for the entire substation. Finally, the SCD file is passed
back to the IED configurator (vendor specific tool) to update the new configuration into the IED.
The SCD file consists of at least five major sections:
GE Multilin
C-17
Header
Substation
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
APPENDIX C
Substation
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
842791A1.CDR
Power Transformer
GeneralEquipment
EquipmentContainer
VoltageLevel
Bay
Voltage
PowerSystemResource
Function
SubFunction
GeneralEquipment
842792A1.CDR
C-18
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
The Communication node describes the direct communication connection possibilities between logical nodes by means of
logical buses (sub-networks) and IED access ports. The communication section is structured as follows.
Communication
SubNetwork (name)
ConnectedAP (IED 1)
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Address
P (type)
Text
Other GSE elements
Other P elements
GE Multilin
C-19
APPENDIX C
DataSet elements
ReportControl elements
DOI elements
Inputs
GSEControl elements
842794A1.CDR
Right-click anywhere in the files panel and select the Import Contents From SCD File item.
2.
C-20
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
3.
The software will open the SCD file and then prompt the user to save a UR-series settings file. Select a location and
name for the URS (UR-series relay settings) file.
If there is more than one GE Multilin IED defined in the SCD file, the software prompt the user to save a UR-series settings file for each IED.
4.
After the URS file is created, modify any settings (if required).
5.
To update the relay with the new settings, right-click on the settings file in the settings tree and select the Write Settings File to Device item.
6.
The software will prompt for the target device. Select the target device from the list provided and click Send. The new
settings will be updated to the selected device.
GE Multilin
C-21
APPENDIX C
C.6ACSI CONFORMANCE
SERVICES
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR-FAMILY
Yes
CLIENT-SERVER ROLES
B11
c1
B12
---
SCSMS SUPPORTED
B21
B22
B23
B24
SCSM: other
Yes
Publisher side
Yes
B32
Subscriber side
---
Yes
Publisher side
B42
Subscriber side
---
NOTE
c1: shall be "M" if support for LOGICAL-DEVICE model has been declared
O: Optional
M: Mandatory
C.6.2 ACSI MODELS CONFORMANCE STATEMENT
SERVICES
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR-FAMILY
Logical device
c2
Yes
M2
Logical node
c3
Yes
M3
Data
c4
Yes
M4
Data set
c5
Yes
M5
Substitution
M6
REPORTING
M7
M7-1
sequence-number
M7-2
report-time-stamp
M7-3
reason-for-inclusion
M7-4
data-set-name
M7-5
data-reference
M7-6
buffer-overflow
M7-7
entryID
M7-8
BufTm
M7-9
IntgPd
M7-10
GI
M8
M8-1
sequence-number
M8-2
report-time-stamp
M8-3
reason-for-inclusion
C-22
Yes
Yes
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
SERVICES
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
M8-4
UR-FAMILY
data-set-name
M8-5
data-reference
M8-6
BufTm
M8-7
IntgPd
M8-8
GI
Logging
M9
Log control
M9-1
IntgPd
M10
Log
M11
Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
entryID
M12-2
DataReflnc
M13
GSSE
Multicast SVC
M15
Unicast SVC
M16
Time
Yes
M17
File transfer
Yes
NOTE
c2: shall be "M" if support for LOGICAL-NODE model has been declared
c3: shall be "M" if support for DATA model has been declared
c4: shall be "M" if support for DATA-SET, Substitution, Report, Log Control, or Time models has been declared
c5: shall be "M" if support for Report, GSE, or SMV models has been declared
M: Mandatory
C.6.3 ACSI SERVICES CONFORMANCE STATEMENT
In the table below, the acronym AA refers to Application Associations (TP: Two Party / MC: Multicast). The c6 to c10 entries
are defined in the notes following the table.
SERVICES
AA: TP/MC
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR FAMILY
TP
Yes
SERVER (CLAUSE 6)
S1
ServerDirectory
Associate
Yes
S3
Abort
Yes
S4
Release
Yes
TP
Yes
LogicalDeviceDirectory
LogicalNodeDirectory
TP
Yes
S7
GetAllDataValues
TP
Yes
GetDataValues
TP
Yes
Yes
SetDataValues
TP
S10
GetDataDirectory
TP
Yes
S11
GetDataDefinition
TP
Yes
GE Multilin
C-23
APPENDIX C
AA: TP/MC
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR FAMILY
Yes
GetDataSetValues
TP
S13
SetDataSetValues
TP
S14
CreateDataSet
TP
S15
DeleteDataSet
TP
S16
GetDataSetDirectory
TP
TP
Yes
SetDataValues
S18
SelectActiveSG
TP
S19
SelectEditSG
TP
S20
SetSGValues
TP
S21
ConfirmEditSGValues
TP
S22
GetSGValues
TP
S23
GetSGCBValues
TP
Report
S24-1
data-change (dchg)
S24-2
qchg-change (qchg)
S24-3
TP
c6
Yes
Yes
data-update (dupd)
S25
GetBRCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
S26
SetBRCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
S27
Report
c6
Yes
data-change (dchg)
S27-2
qchg-change (qchg)
S27-3
TP
Yes
data-update (dupd)
S28
GetURCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
S29
SetURCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
GetLCBValues
TP
S31
SetLCBValues
TP
M
M
LOG
S32
QueryLogByTime
TP
S33
QueryLogByEntry
TP
S34
GetLogStatusValues
TP
SendGOOSEMessage
MC
c8
S36
GetReference
TP
c9
Yes
S37
GetGOOSEElementNumber
TP
c9
S38
GetGoCBValues
TP
Yes
S39
SetGoCBValues
TP
Yes
Yes
GSSE-CONTROL-BLOCK
S40
SendGSSEMessage
MC
c8
S41
GetReference
TP
c9
C-24
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
SERVICES
AA: TP/MC
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR FAMILY
S42
GetGSSEElementNumber
TP
c9
S43
GetGsCBValues
TP
Yes
S44
SetGsCBValues
TP
Yes
SendMSVMessage
MC
c10
S46
GetMSVCBValues
TP
S47
SetMSVCBValues
TP
UNICAST SVC
S48
SendUSVMessage
MC
c10
S49
GetUSVCBValues
TP
S50
SetUSVCBValues
TP
Select
S52
SelectWithValue
TP
Yes
S53
Cancel
TP
Yes
S54
Operate
TP
Yes
S55
Command-Termination
TP
S56
TimeActivated-Operate
TP
GetFile
TP
S58
SetFile
TP
S59
DeleteFile
TP
S60
GetFileAttributeValues
TP
Yes
Yes
T2
T3
NOTE
20
20
GE Multilin
C-25
APPENDIX C
C.7LOGICAL NODES
The UR-series of relays supports IEC 61850 logical nodes as indicated in the following table. Note that the actual instantiation of each logical node is determined by the product order code. For example. the logical node PDIS (distance protection) is available only in the D60 Line Distance Relay.
Table 01: IEC 61850 LOGICAL NODES (Sheet 1 of 3)
NODES
UR-FAMILY
Yes
Yes
Yes
---
PDIS: Distance
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
PTOF: Overfrequency
---
PTOV: Overvoltage
Yes
Yes
Yes
PTUC: Undercurrent
---
PTUV: Undervoltage
Yes
---
PTUF: Underfrequency
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
Yes
Yes
RREC: Autoreclosing
Yes
C-26
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
UR-FAMILY
---
---
---
CILO: Interlocking
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
MMTR: Metering
---
Yes
MMXU: Measurement
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
GE Multilin
C-27
APPENDIX C
UR-FAMILY
---
ZBAT: Battery
---
ZBSH: Bushing
---
---
---
ZCON: Converter
---
ZGEN: Generator
---
---
---
ZMOT: Motor
---
ZREA: Reactor
---
---
---
---
---
C-28
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
This document is adapted from the IEC 60870-5-104 standard. For ths section the boxes indicate the following: 4 used in
standard direction; not used; cannot be selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
1.
SYSTEM OR DEVICE:
System Definition
Controlling Station Definition (Master)
4 Controlled Station Definition (Slave)
2.
3.
NETWORK CONFIGURATION:
Point-to-Point
Multipoint
Multiple Point-to-Point
Multipoint Star
PHYSICAL LAYER
Transmission Speed (control direction):
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard:
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended
if >1200 bits/s:
100 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec.
19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec.
38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
Transmission Speed (monitor direction):
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard:
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended
if >1200 bits/s:
100 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec.
19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec.
38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
4.
LINK LAYER
Balanced Transmision
Unbalanced Transmission
One Octet
Two Octets
Structured
Unstructured
Frame Length (maximum length, number of octets): Not selectable in companion IEC 60870-5-104 standard
GE Multilin
D-1
APPENDIX D
When using an unbalanced link layer, the following ADSU types are returned in class 2 messages (low priority) with the
indicated causes of transmission:
The standard assignment of ADSUs to class 2 messages is used as follows:
A special assignment of ADSUs to class 2 messages is used as follows:
5.
APPLICATION LAYER
Transmission Mode for Application Data:
Mode 1 (least significant octet first), as defined in Clause 4.10 of IEC 60870-5-4, is used exclusively in this companion
stanadard.
Common Address of ADSU:
One Octet
4 Two Octets
Information Object Address:
One Octet
4 Structured
Two Octets
4 Unstructured
4 Three Octets
Cause of Transmission:
One Octet
4 Two Octets (with originator address). Originator address is set to zero if not used.
Maximum Length of APDU: 253 (the maximum length may be reduced by the system.
Selection of standard ASDUs:
For the following lists, the boxes indicate the following: 4 used in standard direction; not used; cannot be
selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
Process information in monitor direction
D-2
M_SP_NA_1
M_SP_TA_1
M_DP_NA_1
M_DP_TA_1
M_ST_NA_1
M_ST_TA_1
M_BO_NA_1
M_BO_TA_1
M_ME_NA_1
M_NE_TA_1
M_ME_NB_1
M_NE_TB_1
M_ME_NC_1
<14> := Measured value, short floating point value with time tag
M_NE_TC_1
M_IT_NA_1
M_IT_TA_1
M_EP_TA_1
M_EP_TB_1
<19> := Packed output circuit information of protection equipment with time tag
M_EP_TC_1
M_SP_NA_1
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
M_ME_ND_1
M_SP_TB_1
M_DP_TB_1
M_ST_TB_1
M_BO_TB_1
M_ME_TD_1
M_ME_TE_1
<36> := Measured value, short floating point value with time tag CP56Time2a
M_ME_TF_1
M_IT_TB_1
M_EP_TD_1
<39> := Packed start events of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a
M_EP_TE_1
<40> := Packed output circuit information of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a
M_EP_TF_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <2>, <4>, <6>, <8>, <10>, <12>, <14>, <16>, <17>, <18>, and <19> or of the set
<30> to <40> are used.
Process information in control direction
4 <45> := Single command
C_SC_NA_1
C_DC_NA_1
C_RC_NA_1
C_SE_NA_1
C_SE_NB_1
C_SE_NC_1
C_BO_NA_1
C_SC_TA_1
C_DC_TA_1
C_RC_TA_1
<61> := Set point command, normalized value with time tag CP56Time2a
C_SE_TA_1
<62> := Set point command, scaled value with time tag CP56Time2a
C_SE_TB_1
<63> := Set point command, short floating point value with time tag CP56Time2a
C_SE_TC_1
C_BO_TA_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <45> to <51> or of the set <58> to <64> are used.
System information in monitor direction
4 <70> := End of initialization
M_EI_NA_1
C_IC_NA_1
C_CI_NA_1
C_RD_NA_1
C_CS_NA_1
C_TS_NA_1
C_RP_NA_1
C_CD_NA_1
C_TS_TA_1
GE Multilin
D-3
APPENDIX D
PE_ME_NA_1
PE_ME_NB_1
PE_ME_NC_1
PE_AC_NA_1
File transfer
<120> := File Ready
F_FR_NA_1
F_SR_NA_1
F_SC_NA_1
F_LS_NA_1
F_AF_NA_1
<125> := Segment
F_SG_NA_1
C_CD_NA_1
D-4
M_DP_TA_1
<5>
M_ST_NA_1
<6>
M_ST_TA_1
<7>
M_BO_NA_1
<8>
M_BO_TA_1
<9>
M_ME_NA_1
FILE TRANSFER
10
11
12
13
20
to
36
37
to
41
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
DEACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
DEACTIVATION
M_DP_NA_1
<4>
ACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
<3>
ACTIVATION
M_SP_TA_1
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
M_SP_NA_1
<2>
INITIALIZED
<1>
SPONTANEOUS
MNEMONIC
BACKGROUND SCAN
NO.
CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
TYPE IDENTIFICATION
44
45
46
47
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
<10>
M_ME_TA_1
<11>
M_ME_NB_1
<12>
M_ME_TB_1
<13>
M_ME_NC_1
<14>
M_ME_TC_1
<15>
M_IT_NA_1
<16>
M_IT_TA_1
<17>
M_EP_TA_1
<18>
M_EP_TB_1
<19>
M_EP_TC_1
<20>
M_PS_NA_1
<21>
M_ME_ND_1
<30>
M_SP_TB_1
<31>
M_DP_TB_1
<32>
M_ST_TB_1
<33>
M_BO_TB_1
<34>
M_ME_TD_1
<35>
M_ME_TE_1
<36>
M_ME_TF_1
<37>
M_IT_TB_1
<38>
M_EP_TD_1
<39>
M_EP_TE_1
<40>
M_EP_TF_1
<45>
C_SC_NA_1
<46>
C_DC_NA_1
<47>
C_RC_NA_1
<48>
C_SE_NA_1
<49>
C_SE_NB_1
<50>
C_SE_NC_1
<51>
C_BO_NA_1
<58>
C_SC_TA_1
<59>
C_DC_TA_1
<60>
C_RC_TA_1
GE Multilin
ACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
DEACTIVATION
DEACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
FILE TRANSFER
10
11
12
13
20
to
36
37
to
41
ACTIVATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
INITIALIZED
SPONTANEOUS
MNEMONIC
BACKGROUND SCAN
NO.
CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
TYPE IDENTIFICATION
44
45
46
47
D-5
APPENDIX D
6.
<61>
C_SE_TA_1
<62>
C_SE_TB_1
<63>
C_SE_TC_1
ACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
DEACTIVATION
DEACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
FILE TRANSFER
10
11
12
13
20
to
36
37
to
41
<64>
C_BO_TA_1
<70>
M_EI_NA_1*)
<100>
C_IC_NA_1
<101>
C_CI_NA_1
<102>
C_RD_NA_1
<103>
C_CS_NA_1
<104>
C_TS_NA_1
<105>
C_RP_NA_1
<106>
C_CD_NA_1
<107>
C_TS_TA_1
<110>
P_ME_NA_1
<111>
P_ME_NB_1
<112>
P_ME_NC_1
<113>
P_AC_NA_1
<120>
F_FR_NA_1
<121>
F_SR_NA_1
<122>
F_SC_NA_1
<123>
F_LS_NA_1
<124>
F_AF_NA_1
<125>
F_SG_NA_1
<126>
F_DR_TA_1*)
ACTIVATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
INITIALIZED
SPONTANEOUS
MNEMONIC
BACKGROUND SCAN
NO.
CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
TYPE IDENTIFICATION
44
45
46
47
X
X
X
X
X
X
D-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
Spontaneous Transmission:
4 Spontaneous transmission
Double transmission of information objects with cause of transmission spontaneous:
The following type identifications may be transmitted in succession caused by a single status change of an information
object. The particular information object addresses for which double transmission is enabled are defined in a projectspecific list.
Single point information: M_SP_NA_1, M_SP_TA_1, M_SP_TB_1, and M_PS_NA_1
Double point information: M_DP_NA_1, M_DP_TA_1, and M_DP_TB_1
Step position information: M_ST_NA_1, M_ST_TA_1, and M_ST_TB_1
Bitstring of 32 bits: M_BO_NA_1, M_BO_TA_1, and M_BO_TB_1 (if defined for a specific project)
Measured value, normalized value: M_ME_NA_1, M_ME_TA_1, M_ME_ND_1, and M_ME_TD_1
Measured value, scaled value: M_ME_NB_1, M_ME_TB_1, and M_ME_TE_1
Measured value, short floating point number: M_ME_NC_1, M_ME_TC_1, and M_ME_TF_1
Station interrogation:
4 Global
4 Group 1
4 Group 5
4 Group 9
4 Group 13
4 Group 2
4 Group 6
4 Group 10
4 Group 14
4 Group 3
4 Group 7
4 Group 11
4 Group 15
4 Group 4
4 Group 8
4 Group 12
4 Group 16
Clock synchronization:
4 Clock synchronization (optional, see Clause 7.6)
Command transmission:
4 Direct command transmission
Direct setpoint command transmission
4 Select and execute command
Select and execute setpoint command
4 C_SE ACTTERM used
4 No additional definition
4 Short pulse duration (duration determined by a system parameter in the outstation)
4 Long pulse duration (duration determined by a system parameter in the outstation)
4 Persistent output
4 Supervision of maximum delay in command direction of commands and setpoint commands
Maximum allowable delay of commands and setpoint commands: 10 s
Transmission of integrated totals:
4 Mode A: Local freeze with spontaneous transmission
4 Mode B: Local freeze with counter interrogation
4 Mode C: Freeze and transmit by counter-interrogation commands
4 Mode D: Freeze by counter-interrogation command, frozen values reported simultaneously
4 Counter read
4 Counter freeze without reset
GE Multilin
D-7
APPENDIX D
DEFAULT
VALUE
REMARKS
SELECTED
VALUE
t0
30 s
120 s
t1
15 s
15 s
t2
10 s
10 s
t3
20 s
20 s
D-8
PARAMETER
DEFAULT
VALUE
REMARKS
12 APDUs
12 APDUs
8 APDUs
8 APDUs
SELECTED
VALUE
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
Portnumber:
PARAMETER
VALUE
REMARKS
Portnumber
2404
In all cases
GE Multilin
D-9
APPENDIX D
D-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
The following table provides a Device Profile Document in the standard format defined in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions
Document.
Table E1: DNP V3.00 DEVICE PROFILE (Sheet 1 of 3)
(Also see the IMPLEMENTATION TABLE in the following section)
Vendor Name: General Electric Multilin
Device Name: UR Series Relay
Highest DNP Level Supported:
Device Function:
For Requests:
Level 2
For Responses: Level 2
Master
4 Slave
Notable objects, functions, and/or qualifiers supported in addition to the Highest DNP Levels Supported (the complete
list is described in the attached table):
Binary Inputs (Object 1)
Binary Input Changes (Object 2)
Binary Outputs (Object 10)
Control Relay Output Block (Object 12)
4 None
Fixed at 3
Configurable
4 None
Configurable
Never
Always
Sometimes
Configurable
GE Multilin
E-1
APPENDIX E
4
4
Never
Always
When reporting Event Data
When sending multi-fragment responses
Sometimes
Configurable
4
4
None
None
None
None
Fixed at ____
Fixed at ____
Fixed at 10 s
Fixed at ____
Variable
Variable
Variable
Variable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Others:
Transmission Delay:
Need Time Interval:
Select/Operate Arm Timeout:
Binary input change scanning period:
Analog input change scanning period:
Counter change scanning period:
Frozen counter event scanning period:
Unsolicited response notification delay:
Unsolicited response retry delay
No intentional delay
Configurable (default = 24 hrs.)
10 s
8 times per power system cycle
500 ms
500 ms
500 ms
100 ms
configurable 0 to 60 sec.
Queue
Clear Queue
4 Never
4 Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
4
4
4
Always
Always
Always
Always
4
4
4
4
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Explanation of Sometimes: Object 12 points are mapped to UR Virtual Inputs. The persistence of Virtual Inputs is
determined by the VIRTUAL INPUT X TYPE settings. Both Pulse On and Latch On operations perform the same function in the UR; that is, the appropriate Virtual Input is put into the On state. If the Virtual Input is set to Self-Reset,
it will reset after one pass of FlexLogic. The On/Off times and Count value are ignored. Pulse Off and Latch Off
operations put the appropriate Virtual Input into the Off state. Trip and Close operations both put the appropriate
Virtual Input into the On state.
E-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
Never
Only time-tagged
Only non-time-tagged
Configurable
No Counters Reported
Configurable (attach explanation)
4 Default Object:
20
Default Variation: 1
4 Point-by-point list attached
Never
Binary Input Change With Time
Binary Input Change With Relative Time
Configurable (attach explanation)
Never
Configurable
Only certain objects
Sometimes (attach explanation)
ENABLE/DISABLE unsolicited Function
codes supported
4 Never
When Device Restarts
When Status Flags Change
No other options are permitted.
4
4
No Counters Reported
Configurable (attach explanation)
16 Bits (Counter 8)
32 Bits (Counters 0 to 7, 9)
Other Value: _____
Point-by-point list attached
GE Multilin
E-3
APPENDIX E
E.1.2 IMPLEMENTATION TABLE
The following table identifies the variations, function codes, and qualifiers supported by the D60 in both request messages
and in response messages. For static (non-change-event) objects, requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be
responded with qualifiers 00 or 01. Static object requests sent with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be responded with qualifiers 17 or
28. For change-event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.
Table E2: IMPLEMENTATION TABLE (Sheet 1 of 4)
OBJECT
OBJECT VARIATION DESCRIPTION
NO.
NO.
1
0
Binary Input (Variation 0 is used to request
default variation)
E
10
12
20
Note 1:
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
Binary Input
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
0
1
1 (read)
1 (read)
1 (read)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
00, 01(start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
RESPONSE
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
129 (response
130 (unsol. resp.)
17, 28 (index)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
129 (response)
echo of request
3 (select)
4 (operate)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
0
Binary Counter
1 (read)
00, 01(start-stop)
7 (freeze)
06(no range, or all)
(Variation 0 is used to request default
8 (freeze noack)
07, 08(limited quantity)
variation)
9 (freeze clear)
17, 28(index)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1
32-Bit Binary Counter
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
7 (freeze)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
8 (freeze noack)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
9 (freeze clear)
17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. Refer to the Communications section in Chapter 5
for details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
1
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the D60 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
E-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
21
22
23
Note 1:
Frozen Counter
(Variation 0 is used to request default
variation)
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
7 (freeze)
8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze clear)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
7 (freeze)
8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze clear)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
7 (freeze)
8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze clear)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
RESPONSE
QUALIFIER
FUNCTION
CODES (HEX)
CODES (DEC)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1
32-Bit Frozen Counter
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
2
16-Bit Frozen Counter
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
9
32-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
10
16-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
0
Counter Change Event (Variation 0 is used 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
to request default variation)
1
32-Bit Counter Change Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2
16-Bit Counter Change Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
5
32-Bit Counter Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
6
16-Bit Counter Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
0
Frozen Counter Event (Variation 0 is used 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
to request default variation)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
1
32-Bit Frozen Counter Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2
16-Bit Frozen Counter Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. Refer to the Communications section in Chapter 5
for details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the D60 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
GE Multilin
E-5
APPENDIX E
E
32
34
Note 1:
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
RESPONSE
QUALIFIER
FUNCTION
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
CODES (DEC) CODES (HEX)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
0
Analog Input (Variation 0 is used to request 1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
default variation)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1
32-Bit Analog Input
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
2
16-Bit Analog Input
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
3
32-Bit Analog Input without Flag
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
4
16-Bit Analog Input without Flag
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
5
short floating point
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06(no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08(limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28(index)
0
Analog Change Event (Variation 0 is used 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
to request default variation)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
1
32-Bit Analog Change Event without Time 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2
16-Bit Analog Change Event without Time 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
3
32-Bit Analog Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
4
16-Bit Analog Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
5
short floating point Analog Change Event 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
without Time
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
7
short floating point Analog Change Event 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
with Time
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
0
Analog Input Reporting Deadband
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
(Variation 0 is used to request default
06 (no range, or all)
variation)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1
16-bit Analog Input Reporting Deadband
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
(default see Note 1)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
2 (write)
00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. Refer to the Communications section in Chapter 5
for details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the D60 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
E-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
contd
2 (write)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07 (limited qty=1)
08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
50
52
60
Class 0 Data
2
3
4
Class 1 Data
Class 2 Data
Class 3 Data
2
3
File authentication
File command
File transfer
File descriptor
5b (free format)
Internal Indications
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
1 (read)
2 (write)
RESPONSE
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
129 (response)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
07 (limited quantity)
(quantity = 1)
70
80
1 (read)
20 (enable unsol)
21 (disable unsol)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
20 (enable unsol)
21 (disable unsol)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
29 (authenticate)
25 (open)
27 (delete)
26 (close)
30 (abort)
1 (read)
2 (write)
5b (free format)
5b (free format)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
5b (free format)
5b (free format)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
5b (free format)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
129 (response)
5b (free format)
5b (free format)
00, 01 (start-stop)
(index =7)
------Note 1:
2 (write)
(see Note 3)
13 (cold restart)
00 (start-stop)
(index =7)
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the D60 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
GE Multilin
E-7
APPENDIX E
The DNP binary input data points are configured through the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT
LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS menu. Refer to the Communications section of Chapter 5 for additional details. When a
freeze function is performed on a binary counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding frozen counter
point.
BINARY INPUT POINTS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 1
Change Event Object Number: 2
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Input with status), Configurable
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Input Change with Time), Configurable
Change Event Scan Rate: 8 times per power system cycle
Change Event Buffer Size: 500
Default Class for All Points: 1
E-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
Supported Control Relay Output Block fields: Pulse On, Pulse Off, Latch On, Latch Off, Paired Trip, Paired Close.
BINARY OUTPUT STATUS POINTS
Object Number: 10
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Default Variation reported when Variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Output Status)
CONTROL RELAY OUTPUT BLOCKS
Object Number: 12
Request Function Codes supported:
NAME/DESCRIPTION
NAME/DESCRIPTION
Virtual Input 1
32
Virtual Input 33
Virtual Input 2
33
Virtual Input 34
Virtual Input 3
34
Virtual Input 35
Virtual Input 4
35
Virtual Input 36
Virtual Input 5
36
Virtual Input 37
Virtual Input 6
37
Virtual Input 38
Virtual Input 7
38
Virtual Input 39
Virtual Input 8
39
Virtual Input 40
Virtual Input 9
40
Virtual Input 41
Virtual Input 10
41
Virtual Input 42
10
Virtual Input 11
42
Virtual Input 43
11
Virtual Input 12
43
Virtual Input 44
12
Virtual Input 13
44
Virtual Input 45
13
Virtual Input 14
45
Virtual Input 46
14
Virtual Input 15
46
Virtual Input 47
15
Virtual Input 16
47
Virtual Input 48
16
Virtual Input 17
48
Virtual Input 49
17
Virtual Input 18
49
Virtual Input 50
18
Virtual Input 19
50
Virtual Input 51
19
Virtual Input 20
51
Virtual Input 52
20
Virtual Input 21
52
Virtual Input 53
21
Virtual Input 22
53
Virtual Input 54
22
Virtual Input 23
54
Virtual Input 55
23
Virtual Input 24
55
Virtual Input 56
24
Virtual Input 25
56
Virtual Input 57
25
Virtual Input 26
57
Virtual Input 58
26
Virtual Input 27
58
Virtual Input 59
27
Virtual Input 28
59
Virtual Input 60
28
Virtual Input 29
60
Virtual Input 61
29
Virtual Input 30
61
Virtual Input 62
30
Virtual Input 31
62
Virtual Input 63
31
Virtual Input 32
63
Virtual Input 64
GE Multilin
E-9
APPENDIX E
E.2.3 COUNTERS
The following table lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21). When a freeze function is performed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding Frozen Counter point.
BINARY COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 20
Change Event Object Number: 22
Request Function Codes supported:
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Binary Counter with Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Counter Change Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
FROZEN COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 21
Change Event Object Number: 23
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
Table E4: BINARY AND FROZEN COUNTERS
POINT
INDEX
NAME/DESCRIPTION
Digital Counter 1
Digital Counter 2
Digital Counter 3
Digital Counter 4
Digital Counter 5
Digital Counter 6
Digital Counter 7
Digital Counter 8
A counter freeze command has no meaning for counters 8 and 9. D60 Digital Counter values are represented as 32-bit
integers. The DNP 3.0 protocol defines counters to be unsigned integers. Care should be taken when interpreting negative
counter values.
E-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
The DNP analog input data points are configured through the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT
menu. Refer to the Communications section of Chapter 5 for additional details.
It is important to note that 16-bit and 32-bit variations of analog inputs are transmitted through DNP as signed numbers.
Even for analog input points that are not valid as negative values, the maximum positive representation is 32767 for 16-bit
values and 2147483647 for 32-bit values. This is a DNP requirement.
The deadbands for all Analog Input points are in the same units as the Analog Input quantity. For example, an Analog Input
quantity measured in volts has a corresponding deadband in units of volts. This is in conformance with DNP Technical Bulletin 9809-001: Analog Input Reporting Deadband. Relay settings are available to set default deadband values according to
data type. Deadbands for individual Analog Input Points can be set using DNP Object 34.
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 30
Change Event Object Number: 32
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 2 (write, deadbands only), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Analog Input)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (Analog Change Event without Time)
Change Event Scan Rate: defaults to 500 ms
Change Event Buffer Size: 256
Default Class for all Points: 2
GE Multilin
E-11
APPENDIX E
E-12
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
D60 REVISION
RELEASE DATE
1601-0089-0.1
1.5x (Beta)
23 August 1999
ECO
N/A
1601-0089-A1
2.0x
17 December 1999
N/A
1601-0089-A2
2.0x
14 January 2000
URD-001
1601-0089-A3
2.2x
12 May 2000
URD-002
1601-0089-A4
2.2x
14 June 2000
URD-003
1601-0089-A4a
2.2x
28 June 2000
URD-003a
1601-0089-B1
2.4x
08 September 2000
URD-004
1601-0089-B2
2.4x
03 November 2000
URD-005
1601-0089-B3
2.6x
08 March 2001
URD-006
1601-0089-B4
2.8x
27 September 2001
URD-007
1601-0089-B5
2.9x
03 December 2001
URD-008
1601-0089-B6
2.9x
07 January 2002
URD-009
1601-0089-B7
2.9x
15 March 2002
URD-010
1601-0089-B8
2.6x
27 February 2004
URX-120
1601-0089-C1
3.0x
02 July 2002
URD-010
1601-0089-C2
3.1x
30 August 2002
URD-012
1601-0089-C3
3.0x
18 November 2002
URD-016
1601-0089-C4
3.1x
18 November 2002
URD-017
1601-0089-C5
3.0x
11 February 2003
URD-020
1601-0089-C6
3.1x
11 February 2003
URD-021
1601-0089-D1
3.2x
11 February 2003
URD-023
1601-0089-D2
3.2x
02 June 2003
URX-084
1601-0089-E1
3.3x
01 May 2003
URX-080
1601-0089-E2
3.3x
29 May 2003
URX-083
1601-0089-F1
3.4x
10 December 2003
URX-111
1601-0089-F2
3.4x
09 February 2004
URX-115
1601-0089-F3
3.4x
27 February 2004
URX-130
1601-0089-G1
4.0x
23 March 2004
URX-123
1601-0089-G2
4.0x
17 May 2004
URX-136
1601-0089-H1
4.2x
30 June 2004
URX-145
1601-0089-H2
4.2x
23 July 2004
URX-151
1601-0089-J1
4.4x
15 September 2004
URX-156
1601-0089-K1
4.6x
15 February 2005
URX-176
1601-0089-L1
4.8x
05 August 2005
URX-202
1601-0089-M1
4.9x
15 December 2005
URX-208
1601-0089-M2
4.9x
27 February 2006
URX-214
1601-0089-N1
5.0x
31 March 2006
URX-217
1601-0089-N2
5.0x
26 May 2006
URX-220
1601-0089-P1
5.2x
23 October 2006
URX-230
1601-0089-P2
5.2x
24 January 2007
URX-232
1601-0089-R1
5.4x
26 June 2007
URX-242
GE Multilin
F-1
APPENDIX F
F.1.2 CHANGES TO THE D60 MANUAL
PAGE
(P2)
PAGE
(R1)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
Title
Title
Update
2-3
2-3
Update
2-8
2-8
Update
3-1
3-1
Update
3-4
3-5
Update
4-4
4-4
Update
4-5
4-5
Update
4-7
4-8
Update
4-13
4-20
Update
5-8
5-8
Update
5-35
5-36
Update
5-39
5-40
Update
5-40
5-41
Update
5-46
5-48
Update
5-84
5-88
Update
5-187
5-193
Update
---
5-229
Add
5-218
5-226
Update
6-19
6-19
Update
7-5
7-5
Update
---
8-33
Add
B-7
B-5
Update
B-8
B-9
Update
---
C-2
Add
C-7
C-7
Update
PAGE
(P2)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
Title
Title
Update
2-3
2-3
Update
2-9
2-8
Update
3-20
3-20
Update
---
4-8
Add
5-123
5-123
Update
F-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
PAGE
(P2)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
5-155
5-154
Update
5-177
5-177
Update
5-232
5-232
Update
6-16
6-16
Update
---
6-17
Add
7-4
7-4
Update
---
9-3
Add
---
9-5
Add
A-1
A-1
Update
B-8
B-8
Update
PAGE
(P1)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
Title
Title
Update
2-2
2-2
Update
2-3
2-3
Update
3-30
3-30
Update
5-14
5-14
Update
5-18
5-18
Update
---
5-66
Add
5-66
5-74
Update
5-133
5-152
Update
5-155
5-174
Update
5-202
5-221
Update
5-204
5-223
Update
5-206
5-225
Update
5-210
5-229
Update
5-214
5-233
Update
---
5-263
Add
---
6-17
Add
---
7-3
Add
B-8
B-8
Update
C-1
C-1
Update
E-1
E-1
Update
E-4
E-4
Update
E-8
E-8
Update
E-10
E-10
Update
GE Multilin
F-3
F.2 ABBREVIATIONS
APPENDIX F
F.2ABBREVIATIONS
A..................... Ampere
AC .................. Alternating Current
A/D ................. Analog to Digital
AE .................. Accidental Energization, Application Entity
AMP ............... Ampere
ANG ............... Angle
ANSI............... American National Standards Institute
AR .................. Automatic Reclosure
ASDU ............. Application-layer Service Data Unit
ASYM ............. Asymmetry
AUTO ............. Automatic
AUX................ Auxiliary
AVG ................ Average
BER................ Bit Error Rate
BF................... Breaker Fail
BFI.................. Breaker Failure Initiate
BKR................ Breaker
BLK ................ Block
BLKG.............. Blocking
BPNT.............. Breakpoint of a characteristic
BRKR ............. Breaker
CAP................ Capacitor
CC .................. Coupling Capacitor
CCVT ............. Coupling Capacitor Voltage Transformer
CFG................ Configure / Configurable
.CFG............... Filename extension for oscillography files
CHK................ Check
CHNL ............. Channel
CLS ................ Close
CLSD.............. Closed
CMND ............ Command
CMPRSN........ Comparison
CO.................. Contact Output
COM............... Communication
COMM............ Communications
COMP ............ Compensated, Comparison
CONN............. Connection
CONT ............. Continuous, Contact
CO-ORD......... Coordination
CPU................ Central Processing Unit
CRC ............... Cyclic Redundancy Code
CRT, CRNT .... Current
CSA................ Canadian Standards Association
CT .................. Current Transformer
CVT ................ Capacitive Voltage Transformer
D/A ................. Digital to Analog
DC (dc)........... Direct Current
DD .................. Disturbance Detector
DFLT .............. Default
DGNST........... Diagnostics
DI.................... Digital Input
DIFF ............... Differential
DIR ................. Directional
DISCREP ....... Discrepancy
DIST ............... Distance
DMD ............... Demand
DNP................ Distributed Network Protocol
DPO ............... Dropout
DSP................ Digital Signal Processor
dt .................... Rate of Change
DTT ................ Direct Transfer Trip
DUTT.............. Direct Under-reaching Transfer Trip
ENCRMNT ..... Encroachment
EPRI............... Electric Power Research Institute
.EVT ............... Filename extension for event recorder files
EXT ................ Extension, External
F ..................... Field
FAIL................ Failure
FD .................. Fault Detector
FDH................ Fault Detector high-set
FDL ................ Fault Detector low-set
FLA................. Full Load Current
FO .................. Fiber Optic
F-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
F.2 ABBREVIATIONS
GE Multilin
F-5
F.3 WARRANTY
APPENDIX F
F.3WARRANTY
GE Multilin is not liable for special, indirect or consequential damages or for loss of profit or for
expenses sustained as a result of a relay malfunction, incorrect application or adjustment.
For complete text of Warranty (including limitations and disclaimers), refer to GE Multilin Standard
Conditions of Sale.
F-6
GE Multilin
INDEX
Index
Numerics
10BASE-F
communications options ................................................. 3-22
description .................................................................... 3-24
interface ........................................................................ 3-34
redundant option ........................................................... 3-22
settings ......................................................................... 5-14
A
ABBREVIATIONS ............................................................... F-4
AC CURRENT INPUTS ................................... 2-15, 3-11, 5-58
AC VOLTAGE INPUTS .............................................2-15, 3-12
ACTIVATING THE RELAY ........................................1-18, 4-21
ACTIVE SETTING GROUP ............................................. 5-111
ACTUAL VALUES
maintenance ................................................................. 6-21
metering .......................................................................... 6-9
product information ........................................................ 6-22
records ......................................................................... 6-19
status .............................................................................. 6-3
ALARM LEDs ................................................................... 5-39
ALTITUDE ....................................................................... 2-18
ANSI DEVICE NUMBERS ................................................... 2-2
APPARENT POWER ................................................2-14, 6-14
APPLICATION EXAMPLES
breaker trip circuit integrity .......................................... 5-217
contact inputs .............................................................. 5-254
pilot schemes .................................................................. 9-6
series compensated lines .......................................8-16, 9-11
stepped distance scheme ................................................. 9-2
APPROVALS ................................................................... 2-19
ARCHITECTURE ............................................................. 5-88
ARCING CURRENT ....................................................... 5-221
AUTORECLOSE
actual values ................................................................... 6-5
description .................................................................. 5-204
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-90
logic ....................................................... 5-211, 5-212, 5-213
Modbus registers .................................................. B-15, B-32
sequence .................................................................... 5-214
settings ............................. 5-203, 5-206, 5-207, 5-209, 5-210
specifications ................................................................ 2-12
AUXILIARY OVERVOLTAGE
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-90
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-37
specifications ................................................................ 2-11
AUXILIARY UNDERVOLTAGE
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-90
logic ............................................................................ 5-185
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-38
settings ....................................................................... 5-185
specifications ................................................................ 2-11
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE CHANNEL ..................................... 3-12
AUXILIARY VOLTAGE METERING ................................... 6-14
B
BANKS ............................................................. 5-6, 5-58, 5-59
BATTERY FAILURE ........................................................... 7-7
BINARY INPUT POINTS ..................................................... E-8
GE Multilin
C
C37.94 COMMUNICATIONS ........................... 3-35, 3-36, 3-38
C37.94SM COMMUNICATIONS ........................................ 3-37
CE APPROVALS .............................................................. 2-19
CHANGES TO D60 MANUAL ..............................................F-2
CHANGES TO MANUAL ............................................. F-2, F-3
CHANNEL COMMUNICATION .......................................... 3-27
CHANNEL TESTS .............................................................. 6-8
CHANNELS
banks ................................................................... 5-58, 5-59
CIRCUIT MONITORING APPLICATIONS ......................... 5-215
CLEANING ....................................................................... 2-19
CLEAR RECORDS .................................................... 5-12, 7-1
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-56
settings ......................................................................... 5-12
CLOCK
setting date and time ........................................................ 7-2
settings ......................................................................... 5-31
COMMANDS MENU ............................................................ 7-1
COMMUNICATIONS
10BASE-F ................................................... 3-22, 3-24, 5-14
INDEX
channel ......................................................................... 3-27
connecting to the UR .............................................. 1-8, 1-15
CRC-16 error checking .................................................... B-2
dnp ........................................................................ 5-15, E-1
G.703 ............................................................................ 3-30
half duplex ...................................................................... B-1
HTTP ............................................................................ 5-28
IEC 60870-5-104 protocol .............................................. 5-29
IEC 61850 ................................................................... 5-259
inter-relay communications ............................................. 2-18
Modbus .................................................. 5-14, 5-30, B-1, B-3
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-18
network ......................................................................... 5-14
overview ........................................................................ 1-17
RS232 ........................................................................... 3-22
RS485 ..........................................................3-22, 3-24, 5-13
settings ...................................... 5-14, 5-15, 5-20, 5-29, 5-30
specifications........................................................ 2-17, 2-18
UCA/MMS ................................................................... 5-261
web server..................................................................... 5-28
COMTRADE ............................................................... B-6, B-7
CONDUCTED RFI ............................................................ 2-19
CONTACT INFORMATION .................................................. 1-1
CONTACT INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-3
dry connections ............................................................. 3-19
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-96
Modbus registers ............................... B-11, B-15, B-49, B-51
module assignments ...................................................... 3-15
settings ....................................................................... 5-253
specifications ................................................................. 2-15
thresholds ................................................................... 5-253
wet connections ............................................................. 3-19
wiring ............................................................................ 3-17
CONTACT OUTPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-4
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-97
Modbus registers .........................................B-11, B-15, B-54
module assignments ...................................................... 3-15
settings ....................................................................... 5-256
wiring ............................................................................ 3-17
CONTROL ELEMENTS ................................................... 5-187
CONTROL POWER
description..................................................................... 3-11
specifications ................................................................. 2-17
CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-90
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-55
settings ......................................................................... 5-41
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
COUNTERS
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
settings ....................................................................... 5-218
CRC ALARM .................................................................... 5-54
CRC-16 ALGORITHM ........................................................ B-2
CRITICAL FAILURE RELAY ..................................... 2-16, 3-10
CSA APPROVAL .............................................................. 2-19
CT BANKS
settings ......................................................................... 5-58
CT INPUTS ...................................................... 3-12, 5-6, 5-58
CT WIRING ...................................................................... 3-12
CURRENT BANK ............................................................. 5-58
CURRENT METERING
actual values ................................................................. 6-12
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-11
specifications ................................................................. 2-14
CURVES
definite time.......................................................5-145, 5-179
ii
D
DATA FORMATS, MODBUS ............................................. B-64
DATA LOGGER
clearing ...................................................................5-12, 7-1
Modbus ........................................................................... B-7
Modbus registers .................................................. B-11, B-20
settings ..........................................................................5-36
specifications .................................................................2-14
via COMTRADE .............................................................. B-6
DATE ................................................................................ 7-2
DCMA INPUTS .................................................................6-18
Modbus registers .................................................. B-16, B-36
settings ........................................................................ 5-268
specifications .................................................................2-15
DCMA OUTPUTS
description .....................................................................3-21
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-41
settings ........................................................................ 5-270
specifications .................................................................2-17
DEFINITE TIME CURVE ...................................... 5-145, 5-179
DESIGN ............................................................................ 1-3
DEVICE ID ..................................................................... 5-259
DEVICE PROFILE DOCUMENT .......................................... E-1
DIELECTRIC STRENGTH ........................................ 2-19, 3-10
DIGITAL COUNTERS
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
FlexLogic operands .....................................................5-91
logic ............................................................................ 5-219
Modbus registers .................................................. B-10, B-44
settings ........................................................................ 5-218
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
application example ...................................................... 5-216
FlexLogic operands .....................................................5-91
logic ............................................................................ 5-215
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-39
settings ........................................................................ 5-215
DIGITAL INPUTS
see entry for CONTACT INPUTS
DIGITAL OUTPUTS
see entry for CONTACT OUTPUTS
DIMENSIONS ............................................................. 3-1, 3-2
DIRECT DEVICES
actual values ................................................................... 6-7
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-18
settings ........................................................................ 5-262
DIRECT I/O
see also DIRECT INPUTS and DIRECT OUTPUTS
application example ........................................... 5-263, 5-264
configuration examples ........................ 5-49, 5-51, 5-54, 5-55
settings ..............................................5-49, 5-54, 5-55, 5-262
DIRECT INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-7
application example ........................................... 5-263, 5-264
clearing counters ............................................................. 7-2
FlexLogic operands .....................................................5-97
Modbus registers ....................... B-11, B-18, B-42, B-56, B-57
settings ........................................................................ 5-262
GE Multilin
INDEX
specifications ................................................................ 2-15
DIRECT INPUTS/OUTPUTS
error messages ............................................................... 7-7
DIRECT OUTPUTS
application example ........................................... 5-263, 5-264
clearing counters ............................................................. 7-2
Modbus registers ................................ B-11, B-42, B-56, B-57
settings ....................................................................... 5-263
DIRECT UNDERREACH TRANSER TRIP
see entry for DUTT
DIRECTIONAL CHARACTERISTIC ..................................... 8-4
DIRECTIONAL COMPARISON BLOCKING
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-32
see BLOCKING SCHEME
DIRECTIONAL COMPARISON UNBLOCKING
see UNBLOCKING SCHEME
DIRECTIONAL OVERCURRENT
see PHASE, GROUND, and NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL entries
DIRECTIONAL POLARIZATION ...................................... 5-150
DISPLAY ........................................................ 1-17, 4-17, 5-10
DISTANCE
analysis of elements ........................................................ 8-7
characteristics ................................................................. 8-2
ground ..................................................................2-9, 5-123
mho characteristic ............................................. 5-117, 5-119
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-33
phase ....................................................................2-8, 5-115
quad characteristic ....................... 5-118, 5-119, 5-125, 5-126
settings ....................................................................... 5-114
stepped distance ............................................................. 9-2
DISTURBANCE DETECTOR
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-96
internal ......................................................................... 5-61
DNA-1 BIT PAIR ............................................................ 5-261
DNP COMMUNICATIONS
binary counters ............................................................. E-10
binary input points ........................................................... E-8
binary output points ......................................................... E-9
control relay output blocks ............................................... E-9
device profile document ................................................... E-1
frozen counters ............................................................. E-10
implementation table ....................................................... E-4
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-18
settings ......................................................................... 5-15
DUPLEX, HALF .................................................................. B-1
DUTT
application of settings ...................................................... 9-6
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-91
logic ............................................................................ 5-234
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-30
settings ....................................................................... 5-232
DYNAMIC REACH CONTROL ........................................... 8-17
E
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE ....................................... 2-19
ELEMENTS ....................................................................... 5-4
ENERGY METERING
actual values ................................................................. 6-15
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-13
specifications ................................................................ 2-14
ENERGY METERING, CLEARING .................................... 5-12
ENERVISTA UR SETUP
creating a site list ............................................................ 4-1
event recorder ................................................................. 4-2
firmware upgrades ........................................................... 4-2
GE Multilin
F
F485 ................................................................................ 1-17
FACEPLATE ............................................................... 3-1, 3-2
FACEPLATE PANELS ............................................... 4-4, 4-17
FAST FORM-C RELAY ..................................................... 2-16
FAST TRANSIENT TESTING ............................................ 2-19
FAULT LOCATOR
logic .............................................................................. 8-35
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-14
operation ....................................................................... 8-33
specifications ................................................................. 2-14
FAULT REPORT
actual values ................................................................. 6-19
clearing .................................................................. 5-12, 7-1
Modbus .......................................................................... B-7
Modbus registers ................................................. B-16, B-20
settings ......................................................................... 5-32
FAULT REPORTS
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-41
FAULT TYPE .................................................................... 8-33
FAX NUMBERS .................................................................. 1-1
FEATURES ........................................................................ 2-1
Fiber ................................................................................ 3-28
FIRMWARE REVISION ..................................................... 6-22
FIRMWARE UPGRADES .................................................... 4-2
FLASH MESSAGES .......................................................... 5-10
FLEX STATE PARAMETERS
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
Modbus registers ................................................. B-15, B-39
settings ......................................................................... 5-46
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
FLEXCURVES
equation ...................................................................... 5-145
Modbus registers ................................................. B-23, B-44
iii
INDEX
settings ......................................................................... 5-65
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
table .............................................................................. 5-65
FLEXELEMENTS
actual values ................................................................. 6-16
direction ...................................................................... 5-108
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
hysteresis .................................................................... 5-108
Modbus registers ..................................................B-40, B-42
pickup ......................................................................... 5-108
scheme logic ............................................................... 5-107
settings .................................................. 5-106, 5-107, 5-109
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
FLEXLOGIC
editing with EnerVista UR Setup ....................................... 4-1
equation editor ............................................................ 5-105
error messages ................................................................ 7-6
evaluation.................................................................... 5-100
example ............................................................. 5-88, 5-100
example equation ........................................................ 5-187
gate characteristics ........................................................ 5-98
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-24
operands .............................................................. 5-89, 5-90
operators ....................................................................... 5-99
rules ............................................................................ 5-100
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
timers .......................................................................... 5-105
worksheet .................................................................... 5-102
FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR ................................ 5-105
FLEXLOGIC TIMERS
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-25
settings ....................................................................... 5-105
FORCE CONTACT INPUTS ............................................ 5-274
FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS ......................................... 5-275
FORCE TRIGGER ............................................................ 6-20
FORM-A RELAY
high impedance circuits .................................................. 3-14
outputs .........................................................3-13, 3-14, 3-19
specifications ................................................................. 2-16
FORM-C RELAY
outputs ................................................................. 3-13, 3-19
specifications ................................................................. 2-16
FREQUENCY METERING
actual values ................................................................. 6-15
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-13
settings ......................................................................... 5-60
specifications ................................................................. 2-14
FREQUENCY TRACKING ........................................ 5-60, 6-16
FREQUENCY, NOMINAL .................................................. 5-59
FUNCTION SETTING ......................................................... 5-4
FUSE ............................................................................... 2-16
FUSE FAILURE
see VT FUSE FAILURE
G
G.703 .................................................... 3-29, 3-30, 3-31, 3-34
GE TYPE IAC CURVES .................................................. 5-144
GROUND CURRENT METERING ...................................... 6-13
GROUND DIRECTIONAL SUPERVISION ........................ 5-130
GROUND DISTANCE
application of settings ...................................................... 9-3
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-34
op scheme ................................................................... 5-130
scheme logic .....................................................5-128, 5-129
iv
H
HALF-DUPLEX .................................................................. B-1
HTTP PROTOCOL ............................................................5-28
HUMIDITY ........................................................................2-18
HYBRID PERMISSIVE OVERREACH TRANSFER TRIP
see entry for HYBRID POTT
HYBRID POTT
application of settings ...................................................... 9-7
FlexLogic operands .....................................................5-92
logic ............................................................................ 5-244
settings ............................................................. 5-241, 5-243
HYRBRID POTT
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-31
I
I2T CURVES .................................................................. 5-145
IAC CURVES .................................................................. 5-144
IEC 60870-5-104 PROTOCOL
interoperability document ................................................. D-1
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-19
settings ..........................................................................5-29
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL
device ID ..................................................................... 5-260
DNA2 assignments ....................................................... 5-261
error messages ............................................................... 7-8
Modbus registers .............. B-44, B-45, B-46, B-47, B-48, B-49
remote device settings .................................................. 5-259
remote inputs ............................................................... 5-260
settings ..........................................................................5-19
UserSt-1 bit pair ........................................................... 5-261
IEC CURVES .................................................................. 5-143
IED ................................................................................... 1-2
IED SETUP ....................................................................... 1-5
IEEE C37.94 COMMUNICATIONS ................... 3-35, 3-36, 3-38
IEEE CURVES ................................................................ 5-142
IMPORTANT CONCEPTS .................................................. 1-4
IN SERVICE INDICATOR ...........................................1-18, 7-5
INCOMPATIBLE HARDWARE ERROR ................................ 7-6
INPUTS
AC current ............................................................ 2-15, 5-58
AC voltage ............................................................ 2-15, 5-59
contact inputs .................................. 2-15, 3-17, 5-253, 5-274
dcmA inputs .......................................................... 2-15, 3-21
direct inputs ...................................................................2-15
IRIG-B .................................................................. 2-15, 3-25
GE Multilin
INDEX
remote inputs ........................................... 2-15, 5-259, 5-260
RTD inputs ............................................................2-15, 3-21
virtual ......................................................................... 5-255
INSPECTION CHECKLIST ................................................. 1-1
INSTALLATION
communications ............................................................ 3-23
contact inputs/outputs ................................... 3-15, 3-17, 3-18
CT inputs ..............................................................3-11, 3-12
RS485 ........................................................................... 3-24
settings ......................................................................... 5-56
INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT
see PHASE, GROUND, and NEUTRAL IOC entries
INSULATION RESISTANCE ............................................. 2-19
INTELLIGENT ELECTRONIC DEVICE ................................ 1-2
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS .................................. 2-18
INTRODUCTION ................................................................ 1-2
INVERSE TIME UNDERVOLTAGE .................................. 5-180
IOC
see PHASE, GROUND, and NEUTRAL IOC entries
IP ADDRESS ................................................................... 5-14
IRIG-B
connection .................................................................... 3-25
error messages ............................................................... 7-7
settings ......................................................................... 5-31
specifications ........................................................2-15, 2-17
ISO-9000 REGISTRATION ............................................... 2-19
K
KEYPAD ..................................................................1-18, 4-17
L
LAMPTEST ........................................................................ 7-2
LANGUAGE ..................................................................... 5-10
LASER MODULE ............................................................. 3-28
LATCHING OUTPUTS
application example ........................................... 5-257, 5-258
error messages ............................................................... 7-8
settings ....................................................................... 5-256
specifications ................................................................ 2-16
LED INDICATORS .............................. 4-5, 4-6, 4-7, 4-16, 5-39
LED TEST
FlexLogic operand ...................................................... 5-97
settings ......................................................................... 5-37
specifications ................................................................ 2-13
LINE
pickup ......................................................................... 5-112
LINE PICKUP
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
logic ............................................................................ 5-113
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-35
settings ....................................................................... 5-112
specifications .................................................................. 2-9
LINK POWER BUDGET .................................................... 2-18
LOAD ENCROACHMENT
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-29
settings ............................................................. 5-139, 5-140
specifications ................................................................ 2-12
LOGIC GATES ................................................................. 5-99
LOST PASSWORD ............................................................ 5-9
GE Multilin
M
MAINTENANCE COMMANDS ............................................. 7-2
MANUFACTURING DATE ................................................. 6-22
MEMORY MAP DATA FORMATS ..................................... B-64
MEMORY POLARIZATION ........................................... 8-6, 9-1
MEMORY VOLTAGE LOGIC ........................................... 5-115
MENU HEIRARCHY ................................................. 1-18, 4-19
MENU NAVIGATION ....................................... 1-18, 4-18, 4-19
METERING
conventions ............................................................ 6-9, 6-10
current ........................................................................... 2-14
frequency ...................................................................... 2-14
power ............................................................................ 2-14
voltage .......................................................................... 2-14
METERING CONVENTIONS ............................................. 6-10
MHO DISTANCE CHARACTERISTIC ....................... 5-117, 8-2
MODBUS
data logger .............................................................. B-6, B-7
event recorder ................................................................ B-7
exception responses ....................................................... B-5
execute operation ........................................................... B-4
fault report ...................................................................... B-7
flex state parameters ..................................................... 5-47
function code 03/04h ....................................................... B-3
function code 05h ........................................................... B-4
function code 06h ........................................................... B-4
function code 10h ........................................................... B-5
introduction .................................................................... B-1
memory map data formats ............................................. B-64
obtaining files ................................................................. B-6
oscillography .................................................................. B-6
passwords ...................................................................... B-7
read/write settings/actual values ...................................... B-3
settings ................................................................ 5-14, 5-30
store multiple settings ..................................................... B-5
store single setting .......................................................... B-4
supported function codes ................................................ B-3
user map ..................................................... 5-30, B-11, B-23
MODEL INFORMATION .................................................... 6-22
MODIFICATION FILE NUMBER ........................................ 6-22
MODULE FAILURE ERROR ................................................ 7-6
MODULES
communications ............................................................. 3-23
contact inputs/outputs .................................. 3-15, 3-17, 3-18
CT ................................................................................. 3-12
CT/VT ..................................................................... 3-11, 5-6
direct inputs/outputs ....................................................... 3-28
insertion ................................................................... 3-5, 3-6
order codes ..................................................................... 2-5
power supply ................................................................. 3-10
transducer I/O ................................................................ 3-21
VT ................................................................................. 3-12
withdrawal ................................................................ 3-5, 3-6
MONITORING ELEMENTS .............................................. 5-220
MOUNTING ................................................................. 3-1, 3-2
N
NAMEPLATE ...................................................................... 1-1
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL OC
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-36
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL OVERCURRENT
characteristics ............................................................. 5-168
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-92
INDEX
logic ............................................................................ 5-169
settings .............................................................5-167, 5-169
specifications ................................................................. 2-10
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE IOC
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
logic ............................................................................ 5-166
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-28
settings ....................................................................... 5-166
specifications ................................................................. 2-10
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OVERVOLTAGE
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
logic ............................................................................ 5-184
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-28
settings ....................................................................... 5-184
specifications ................................................................. 2-11
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE TOC
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ..................................................................5-165, 5-186
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-28
settings .............................................................5-165, 5-186
specifications ................................................................. 2-10
NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL OC
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-35
NEUTRAL DIRECTIONAL OVERCURRENT
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ............................................................................ 5-158
polarization.................................................................. 5-156
settings ....................................................................... 5-154
specifications ................................................................. 2-10
NEUTRAL INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT
see entry for NEUTRAL IOC
NEUTRAL IOC
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ............................................................................ 5-153
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-26
settings ....................................................................... 5-153
specifications ................................................................. 2-10
NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ............................................................................ 5-183
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-37
settings ....................................................................... 5-183
specifications ................................................................. 2-11
NEUTRAL TIME OVERCURRENT
see entry for NEUTRAL TOC
NEUTRAL TOC
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ............................................................................ 5-152
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-26
settings ....................................................................... 5-152
specifications ................................................................... 2-9
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-92
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-44
settings ....................................................................... 5-110
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
NSAP ADDRESS .............................................................. 5-14
O
ONE SHOTS .................................................................... 5-99
OPEN POLE DETECTOR
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ............................................................................ 5-229
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-30
settings ....................................................................... 5-228
vi
specifications .................................................................2-12
OPERATING TEMPERATURE ...........................................2-18
OPERATING TIMES .......................................................... 2-8
ORDER CODES .......................................... 2-4, 2-5, 6-22, 7-2
ORDER CODES, UPDATING ............................................. 7-2
ORDERING ..........................................................2-3, 2-4, 2-5
OSCILLATORY TRANSIENT TESTING ..............................2-19
OSCILLOGRAPHY
actual values ..................................................................6-20
clearing ...................................................................5-12, 7-1
Modbus ........................................................................... B-6
Modbus registers .................................................. B-16, B-20
settings ..........................................................................5-34
specifications .................................................................2-14
via COMTRADE .............................................................. B-6
via EnerVista software ..................................................... 4-2
OSI NETWORK ADDRESS ................................................5-14
OST ...................................................................... 2-12, 5-133
OUT-OF-STEP TRIPPING ...................................... 2-12, 5-133
OUTPUTS
contact outputs .......................................... 3-15, 3-17, 5-256
control power .................................................................2-17
critical failure relay .........................................................2-16
Fast Form-C relay ..........................................................2-16
Form-A relay ....................................... 2-16, 3-13, 3-14, 3-19
Form-C relay ................................................ 2-16, 3-13, 3-19
IRIG-B ...........................................................................2-17
latching outputs ................................................... 2-16, 5-256
remote outputs ............................................................. 5-261
virtual outputs .............................................................. 5-258
OVERCURRENT CURVE TYPES .................................... 5-141
OVERCURRENT CURVES
definite time ................................................................. 5-145
FlexCurves ............................................................... 5-145
I2T ............................................................................... 5-145
IAC .............................................................................. 5-144
IEC .............................................................................. 5-143
IEEE ............................................................................ 5-142
OVERVOLTAGE
auxiliary .........................................................................2-11
negative sequence ....................................................... 5-184
negative-sequence .........................................................2-11
neutral ................................................................ 2-11, 5-183
phase ................................................................. 2-11, 5-182
P
PANEL CUTOUT ........................................................ 3-1, 3-2
PARITY ............................................................................5-13
PASSWORD SECURITY .................................................... 5-8
PASSWORDS
changing ........................................................................4-22
lost password ..........................................................4-22, 5-9
Modbus ........................................................................... B-7
Modbus registers .................................................. B-14, B-18
overview ........................................................................1-19
security ........................................................................... 5-8
settings ........................................................................... 5-8
PC SOFTWARE
see entry for ENERVISTA UR SETUP
PERMISSIVE FUNCTIONS .............................................. 5-179
PERMISSIVE OVERREACH TRANSFER TRIP
see entry for POTT
PERMISSIVE UNDERREACH TRANSFER TRIP
see entry for PUTT
PER-UNIT QUANTITY ........................................................ 5-4
GE Multilin
INDEX
PHASE ANGLE METERING .............................................. 6-10
PHASE CURRENT METERING ......................................... 6-12
PHASE DIRECTIONAL OC
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-35
PHASE DIRECTIONAL OVERCURRENT
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-93
logic ............................................................................ 5-151
phase A polarization .................................................... 5-149
settings ............................................................. 5-149, 5-150
specifications ................................................................ 2-10
PHASE DISTANCE
application of settings ...................................................... 9-2
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-94
logic ............................................................................ 5-123
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-34
op scheme .................................................................. 5-122
settings ....................................................................... 5-115
specifications .................................................................. 2-8
PHASE INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT
see entry for PHASE IOC
PHASE IOC
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-94
logic ............................................................................ 5-148
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-26
specifications ................................................................ 2-10
PHASE MEASUREMENT UNIT
see entry for SYNCHROPHASOR
PHASE OVERVOLTAGE
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-94
logic ............................................................................ 5-182
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-33
settings ....................................................................... 5-182
specifications ................................................................ 2-11
PHASE ROTATION .......................................................... 5-60
PHASE SELECT
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-94
PHASE TIME OVERCURRENT
see entry for PHASE TOC
PHASE TOC
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-94
logic ............................................................................ 5-147
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-25
settings ....................................................................... 5-146
specifications .................................................................. 2-9
PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-95
logic ............................................................................ 5-181
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-33
settings ....................................................................... 5-181
specifications ................................................................ 2-11
PHASOR ESTIMATION ...................................................... 8-1
PHONE NUMBERS ............................................................ 1-1
PILOT SCHEMES
application of settings ...................................................... 9-6
blocking ...................................................................... 5-245
directional comparison blocking ................................... 5-245
directional comparison unblocking ................................ 5-248
DUTT .......................................................................... 5-232
hybrid POTT ................................................................ 5-241
POTT .......................................................................... 5-237
PUTT .......................................................................... 5-235
specifications ................................................................ 2-12
unblocking................................................................... 5-248
PMU
see entry for SYNCHROPHASOR
POTT
application of settings ...................................................... 9-6
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-95
GE Multilin
Q
QUAD DISTANCE CHARACTERISTIC ....... 5-118, 5-119, 5-125,
5-126, 8-5, 8-6
R
REACTIVE POWER ................................................. 2-14, 6-14
REAL POWER ......................................................... 2-14, 6-14
REAL TIME CLOCK
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-20
settings ......................................................................... 5-31
REAR TERMINAL ASSIGNMENTS ...................................... 3-7
RECLOSER CURVES ............................................ 5-68, 5-145
RECLOSING
description ................................................................... 5-204
logic ....................................................... 5-211, 5-212, 5-213
sequence ..................................................................... 5-214
settings ............................. 5-203, 5-206, 5-207, 5-209, 5-210
REDUNDANT 10BASE-F .................................................. 3-22
RELAY ACTIVATION ........................................................ 4-21
RELAY ARCHITECTURE .................................................. 5-88
RELAY MAINTENANCE ...................................................... 7-2
RELAY NAME .................................................................. 5-57
RELAY NOT PROGRAMMED ............................................ 1-18
REMOTE DEVICES
actual values ................................................................... 6-5
device ID ..................................................................... 5-260
vii
INDEX
error messages ................................................................ 7-8
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-97
Modbus registers ............................... B-11, B-16, B-58, B-60
settings ....................................................................... 5-259
statistics .......................................................................... 6-5
REMOTE INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-3
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-97
Modbus registers .........................................B-11, B-16, B-58
settings ....................................................................... 5-260
specifications ................................................................. 2-15
REMOTE OUTPUTS
DNA-1 bit pair .............................................................. 5-261
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-59
UserSt-1 bit pair .......................................................... 5-261
REPLACEMENT MODULES .................................. 2-5, 2-6, 2-7
RESETTING .......................................................... 5-97, 5-262
REVISION HISTORY ..........................................................F-1
RFI SUSCEPTIBILITY ...................................................... 2-19
RFI, CONDUCTED ........................................................... 2-19
RMS CURRENT ............................................................... 2-14
RMS VOLTAGE ................................................................ 2-14
RS232
configuration ................................................................... 1-9
specifications ................................................................. 2-17
wiring ............................................................................ 3-22
RS422
configuration ................................................................. 3-32
timing ............................................................................ 3-33
two-channel application .................................................. 3-32
with fiber interface ......................................................... 3-34
RS485
communications ............................................................. 3-22
configuration ................................................................... 1-7
description..................................................................... 3-24
specifications ................................................................. 2-17
RTD INPUTS
actual values ................................................................. 6-18
Modbus registers ..................................................B-17, B-24
settings ....................................................................... 5-269
specifications ................................................................. 2-15
S
SALES OFFICE .................................................................. 1-1
SCAN OPERATION ............................................................ 1-4
SELECTOR SWITCH
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
application example ..................................................... 5-193
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-95
logic ............................................................................ 5-193
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-43
settings ....................................................................... 5-188
specifications ................................................................. 2-13
timing ................................................................5-191, 5-192
SELF-TESTS
description....................................................................... 7-5
error messages ................................................................ 7-6
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-98
Modbus registers ............................................................ B-9
SERIAL NUMBER ............................................................ 6-22
SERIAL PORTS
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-18
settings ......................................................................... 5-13
SERIES COMPENSATED LINES ............................. 8-16, 9-11
SETTING GROUPS ................... 5-96, 5-111, 5-187, B-27, B-28
viii
T
TARGET MESSAGES ........................................................ 7-5
TARGET SETTING ............................................................ 5-5
TARGETS MENU ............................................................... 7-5
TCP PORT NUMBER ........................................................5-28
TELEPROTECTION
actual values ................................................................... 6-4
clearing counters ............................................................. 7-2
GE Multilin
INDEX
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-96
logic ............................................................................ 5-267
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-43
overview ..................................................................... 5-266
settings .................................................... 5-56, 5-266, 5-267
specifications ................................................................ 2-15
TEMPERATURE, OPERATING ......................................... 2-18
TERMINALS ...................................................................... 3-7
TESTING
force contact inputs ..................................................... 5-274
force contact outputs ................................................... 5-275
lamp test ......................................................................... 7-2
self-test error messages .................................................. 7-5
synchrophasors ........................................................... 5-276
THEORY OF OPERATION .................................................. 8-1
TIME ................................................................................. 7-2
TIME OVERCURRENT
see PHASE, NEUTRAL, and GROUND TOC entries
TIMERS ......................................................................... 5-105
TOC
ground ........................................................................ 5-162
neutral ........................................................................ 5-152
phase .......................................................................... 5-146
specifications .................................................................. 2-9
TRACKING FREQUENCY ........................................ 6-16, B-38
TRANSDUCER I/O
actual values ................................................................. 6-18
settings ............................................................. 5-268, 5-269
specifications ................................................................ 2-15
wiring ............................................................................ 3-21
TRIP BUS
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-96
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-40
settings ....................................................................... 5-230
TRIP LEDs ...................................................................... 5-39
TRIP OUTPUT
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-96
logic ............................................................................ 5-197
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-29
settings ....................................................................... 5-194
specifications ................................................................ 2-12
TROUBLE INDICATOR ............................................. 1-18, 7-5
TYPE TESTS ................................................................... 2-19
U
UL APPROVAL ................................................................ 2-19
UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS
commands .................................................................... 5-12
resetting .......................................................................... 7-2
UNBLOCKING SCHEME
FlexLogic operands .................................................... 5-91
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-33
settings ....................................................................... 5-248
UNDERVOLTAGE
auxiliary ........................................................................ 2-11
phase .................................................................. 2-11, 5-181
UNDERVOLTAGE CHARACTERISTICS .......................... 5-179
UNEXPECTED RESTART ERROR ...................................... 7-8
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED ....................................... 5-57, 7-6
UNPACKING THE RELAY .................................................. 1-1
UNRETURNED MESSAGES ALARM ................................. 5-55
UPDATING ORDER CODE ................................................. 7-2
URPC
see entry for ENERVISTA UR SETUP
USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
GE Multilin
V
VAR-HOURS ........................................................... 2-14, 6-15
VIBRATION TESTING ...................................................... 2-19
VIRTUAL INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-3
commands ....................................................................... 7-1
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-97
logic ............................................................................ 5-255
Modbus registers ................................................... B-9, B-51
settings ....................................................................... 5-255
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-4
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-97
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-52
settings ....................................................................... 5-258
VOLTAGE BANKS ............................................................ 5-59
VOLTAGE DEVIATIONS ................................................... 2-19
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS ................................................... 5-179
VOLTAGE METERING
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-12
specifications ................................................................. 2-14
values ........................................................................... 6-13
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT CHARACTERISTIC ..................... 5-146
VT FUSE FAILURE
logic ............................................................................ 5-227
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-43
settings ....................................................................... 5-227
VT INPUTS ...................................................... 3-12, 5-6, 5-59
VT WIRING ...................................................................... 3-12
VTFF
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-96
see VT FUSE FAILURE
W
WARRANTY .......................................................................F-6
WATT-HOURS ........................................................ 2-14, 6-15
WATTMETRIC ZERO-SEQUENCE DIRECTIONAL
actual values ................................................................. 6-17
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-96
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-28
settings ....................................................................... 5-159
ix
INDEX
specifications ................................................................. 2-11
WEB SERVER PROTOCOL .............................................. 5-28
WEBSITE ........................................................................... 1-1
Z
ZERO SEQUENCE CORE BALANCE .................................3-12
GE Multilin